0001193125-16-508367.txt : 20160317 0001193125-16-508367.hdr.sgml : 20160317 20160317141640 ACCESSION NUMBER: 0001193125-16-508367 CONFORMED SUBMISSION TYPE: 8-K PUBLIC DOCUMENT COUNT: 8 CONFORMED PERIOD OF REPORT: 20160317 0001162387 0001514949 ITEM INFORMATION: Other Events ITEM INFORMATION: Financial Statements and Exhibits FILED AS OF DATE: 20160317 DATE AS OF CHANGE: 20160317 Credit card FILER: COMPANY DATA: COMPANY CONFORMED NAME: CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC CENTRAL INDEX KEY: 0001162387 STANDARD INDUSTRIAL CLASSIFICATION: ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES [6189] IRS NUMBER: 000000000 FILING VALUES: FORM TYPE: 8-K SEC ACT: 1934 Act SEC FILE NUMBER: 333-75276-01 FILM NUMBER: 161512221 BUSINESS ADDRESS: STREET 1: 140 EAST SHORE DRIVE STREET 2: ROOM 1071-B CITY: GLEN ALLEN STATE: VA ZIP: 23059 BUSINESS PHONE: 8042906959 MAIL ADDRESS: STREET 1: 140 EAST SHORE DRIVE STREET 2: ROOM 1071-B CITY: GLEN ALLEN STATE: VA ZIP: 23059 FORMER COMPANY: FORMER CONFORMED NAME: CAPITAL ONE FUNDING LLC DATE OF NAME CHANGE: 20011116 FILER: COMPANY DATA: COMPANY CONFORMED NAME: CAPITAL ONE MULTI ASSET EXECUTION TRUST CENTRAL INDEX KEY: 0001163321 STANDARD INDUSTRIAL CLASSIFICATION: ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES [6189] IRS NUMBER: 000000000 STATE OF INCORPORATION: DE FISCAL YEAR END: 1231 FILING VALUES: FORM TYPE: 8-K SEC ACT: 1934 Act SEC FILE NUMBER: 333-75276 FILM NUMBER: 161512222 BUSINESS ADDRESS: STREET 1: BANKERS TRUST DELAWARE STREET 2: E A DELLE DONNE CORP CTR 1011 CENTRE RD CITY: WILMINGTON STATE: DE ZIP: 19805-1266 BUSINESS PHONE: 3026363382 FORMER COMPANY: FORMER CONFORMED NAME: CAPITAL ONE MULTIPLE ISSUANCE TRUST DATE OF NAME CHANGE: 20011207 FORMER COMPANY: FORMER CONFORMED NAME: CAPITAL ONE UNIVERSAL NOTE TRUST DATE OF NAME CHANGE: 20011206 FILER: COMPANY DATA: COMPANY CONFORMED NAME: CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST CENTRAL INDEX KEY: 0000922869 STANDARD INDUSTRIAL CLASSIFICATION: ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES [6189] IRS NUMBER: 541719855 STATE OF INCORPORATION: NY FISCAL YEAR END: 1231 FILING VALUES: FORM TYPE: 8-K SEC ACT: 1934 Act SEC FILE NUMBER: 000-25762 FILM NUMBER: 161512223 BUSINESS ADDRESS: STREET 1: 11013 W BROAD ST RD CITY: GLEN ALLEN STATE: VA ZIP: 23060 BUSINESS PHONE: 8049671000 MAIL ADDRESS: STREET 1: 11013 WEST BROAD ST RD CITY: GLEN ALLEN STATE: VA ZIP: 23060 FORMER COMPANY: FORMER CONFORMED NAME: SIGNET MASTER TRUST DATE OF NAME CHANGE: 19940509 8-K 1 d125824d8k.htm FORM 8-K Form 8-K

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM 8-K

 

 

CURRENT REPORT

Pursuant to Section 13 OR 15(d)

of The Securities Exchange Act of 1934

Date of Report (Date of earliest event reported) March 17, 2016

 

 

Commission File Number of Depositor: 333-75276-01

Central Index Key Number of Depositor: 0001162387

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC

(Exact name of Depositor as specified in its charter)

ON BEHALF OF

Commission File Number of Issuing Entity: 000-25762

Central Index Key Number of Issuing Entity: 0000922869

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

(Issuing Entity in respect of the COMT Collateral Certificate)

(Exact name of Issuing Entity as specified in its charter)

AND

Commission File Number of Issuing Entity: 333-75276

Central Index Key Number of Issuing Entity: 0001163321

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

(Issuing Entity in respect of the Notes)

(Exact name of Issuing Entity as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Virginia   54-2058720

(State or Other Jurisdiction

of Incorporation)

 

(IRS Employer

Identification Number)

 

140 East Shore Drive

Room 1071-B

Glen Allen, Virginia

  23059
(Address of Principal Executive Office)   (Zip Code)

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code (804) 290-6959

N/A

(Former name or address, if changed since last report)

 

 

Check the appropriate box below if the Form 8-K filing is intended to simultaneously satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant under any of the following provisions (see General Instruction A.2. below):

 

¨ Written communication pursuant to Rule 425 under the Securities Act (17 CFR 230.425)

 

¨ Soliciting material pursuant to Rule 14a-22 under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14a-22)

 

¨ Pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 14d-2(b) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14d-2(b))

 

¨ Pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 13e-4(c) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.13e-4(c))

 

 

 


Section 8 – Other Events.

 

Item 8.01. Other Events.

On March 17, 2016, the documents listed below under “Item 9.01(d). Exhibits” were entered into by the parties identified under that Item for the purpose of, among other things, complying with the Securities and Exchange Commission’s revised Regulation AB.

Section 9 – Financial Statements and Exhibits.

 

Item 9.01 (d). Exhibits.

Each of the following are filed as an Exhibit to this Report.

 

Exhibit 4.1    Second Amendment to Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, between Capital One Funding, LLC and Capital One Bank (USA), National Association.
Exhibit 4.2    Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, among Capital One Funding, LLC, as transferor (the “Transferor”), Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as servicer (the “Servicer”), and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (the “Trustee”).
Exhibit 4.3    Amended and Restated Series 2002-CC Supplement to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated on March 17, 2016, among the Transferor, the Servicer, and the Trustee.
Exhibit 4.4    Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006, and March 17, 2016, between Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust (the “Issuer”) and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”).
Exhibit 4.5    Indenture Supplement, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, between the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee.
Exhibit 4.6    Asset Representations Review Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, among Capital One Funding, LLC, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association and Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC.
Exhibit 4.7    Dispute Resolution Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, among Capital One Funding, LLC, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association and The Bank of New York Mellon.


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned hereunto duly authorized.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC
Acting solely in its capacity as depositor of Capital One Master Trust and Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust
By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

  Name:   Eric D. Bauder
  Title:   Assistant Vice President

March 17, 2016


EXHIBIT INDEX

 

Exhibit

  

Description

Exhibit 4.1    Second Amendment to Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, between Capital One Funding, LLC and Capital One Bank (USA), National Association.
Exhibit 4.2    Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, among Capital One Funding, LLC, as transferor (the “Transferor”), Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as servicer (the “Servicer”), and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (the “Trustee”).
Exhibit 4.3    Amended and Restated Series 2002-CC Supplement to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated on March 17, 2016, among the Transferor, the Servicer, and the Trustee.
Exhibit 4.4    Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006, and March 17, 2016, between Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust (the “Issuer”) and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”).
Exhibit 4.5    Indenture Supplement, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, between the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee.
Exhibit 4.6    Asset Representations Review Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, among Capital One Funding, LLC, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association and Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC.
Exhibit 4.7    Dispute Resolution Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, among Capital One Funding, LLC, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association and The Bank of New York Mellon.
EX-4.1 2 d125824dex41.htm EXHIBIT 4.1 Exhibit 4.1

EXHIBIT 4.1

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

SECOND AMENDMENT TO AMENDED AND

RESTATED RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT

This SECOND AMENDMENT TO AMENDED AND RESTATED RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT, dated as of March 17, 2016 (the “Amendment”) to the Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 1, 2002, as amended and restated as of July 1, 2007, as amended by the First Amendment thereto, dated as of March 1, 2008 (the “Agreement”), is entered into between CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association (the “Bank” or “Capital One”), and CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company (“Funding”).

WHEREAS, pursuant to Section 9.01 of the Agreement, the Bank and Funding desire to amend the Agreement to include dispute resolution provisions as specified herein;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and agreements contained herein and notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in the Agreement, the undersigned parties hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

AMENDMENTS

Section 1.01. Amendments to the Agreement. The Agreement is hereby amended as follows:

(a) Section 1.01 of the Agreement is hereby amended by deleting the term “Pooling and Servicing Agreement” in its entirety and replacing it with the following:

Pooling and Servicing Agreement” shall mean the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, among Funding, as Transferor, Capital One, as Servicer, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, as amended and supplemented from time to time.

(b) Section 1.01 of the Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following defined terms in the appropriate alphabetical order:

AAA” has the meaning specified in subsection 6.03(b)(i).

Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional” shall mean an attorney or retired judge that is independent, impartial, knowledgeable about and experienced with the laws of the State of New York, specializing in commercial litigation with at least 15 years of experience and whose name is on a list of neutral parties maintained by the AAA.


Representing Party” has the meaning specified in subsection 6.03(a).

Requesting Party” has the meaning specified in subsection 6.03(a).

Rules” has the meaning specified in subsection 6.03(b)(i).

(c) Article VI of the Agreement is hereby amended by adding the following as Section 6.03:

Section 6.03. Dispute Resolution.

(a) If any Receivable is subject to repurchase pursuant to Section 6.01 or Section 6.02 of this Agreement, which repurchase is not resolved in accordance with the terms of this Agreement within 180 days after notice is delivered to Capital One as specified in any such Section, the party providing such notice (the “Requesting Party”) will have the right to refer the matter, at its discretion, to either third-party mediation (including nonbinding arbitration) or binding arbitration pursuant to this Section 6.03 and Capital One is hereby deemed to consent to the selected resolution method. At the end of the 180-day period described above, the Representing Party (as defined below) may provide notice informing the Requesting Party of the status of its request or, in the absence of any such notice, the Requesting Party may presume that its request remains unresolved. The Requesting Party must provide written notice of its intention to refer the matter to mediation or arbitration to Capital One (in such capacity, the “Representing Party”) within 30 calendar days following such 180th day. Capital One agrees to participate in the resolution method selected by the Requesting Party.

(b) If the Requesting Party selects mediation as the resolution method, the following provisions will apply:

(i) The mediation will be administered by the American Arbitration Association (the “AAA”) pursuant to its Commercial Arbitration Rules and Mediation Procedures in effect at the time the mediation is initiated (the “Rules”); provided, that if any of the Rules are inconsistent with the procedures for the mediation or arbitration stated in this Agreement, the procedures in this Agreement will control.

(ii) The mediator must be a Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional. Upon being supplied a list, by the AAA, of at least ten potential mediators that are each Qualified Dispute Resolution Professionals, each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will have the right to exercise two peremptory challenges within 14 days and to rank the remaining potential mediators in order of preference. The AAA will select the mediator from the remaining potential mediators on the list, respecting the preference choices of the parties to the extent possible.

 

-2-


(iii) Each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will use commercially reasonable efforts to begin the mediation within 10 Business Days of the selection of the mediator and to conclude the mediation within 30 days of the start of the mediation.

(iv) The fees and expenses of the mediation will be allocated as mutually agreed by the Requesting Party and the Representing Party as part of the mediation.

(v) A failure by the Requesting Party and the Representing Party to resolve a disputed matter through mediation shall not preclude either party from seeking a resolution of such matter through the initiation of a judicial proceeding in a court of competent jurisdiction, subject to subsection 6.03(d) below.

(c) If the Requesting Party selects arbitration as the resolution method, the following provisions will apply:

(i) The arbitration will be held in accordance with the United States Arbitration Act, notwithstanding any choice of law provision in this Agreement, and under the auspices of the AAA and in accordance with the Rules.

(ii) If the repurchase request specified in subsection 6.03(a) involves the repurchase of an aggregate amount of Receivables of less than 5% of the total Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the date of such repurchase request, a single arbitrator will be used. That arbitrator must be a Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional. Upon being supplied a list of at least ten potential arbitrators that are each Qualified Dispute Resolutions Professionals by the AAA, each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will have the right to exercise two peremptory challenges within 14 days and to rank the remaining potential arbitrators in order of preference. The AAA will select the arbitrator from the remaining potential arbitrators on the list respecting the preference choices of the parties to the extent possible.

(iii) If the repurchase request specified in subsection 6.03(a) involves the repurchase of an aggregate amount of Receivables equal to or in excess of 5% of the total Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the date of such repurchase request, a three-arbitrator panel will be used. The arbitral panel will consist of three Qualified Dispute Resolution Professionals, (A) one to be appointed by the Requesting Party within five Business Days of providing notice to the Representing Party of its selection of arbitration, (B) one to be appointed by the Representing Party within five Business Days of the Requesting Party’s appointment of an arbitrator, and (C) the third, who will preside over the arbitral panel, to be chosen by the two party-appointed arbitrators within five Business Days of the Representing Party’s appointment. If any party fails to appoint an arbitrator or the two party-appointed arbitrators fail to appoint the third within the relevant time periods, then the appointments will be made by the AAA pursuant to the Rules.

 

-3-


(iv) Each arbitrator selected for any arbitration will abide by the Code of Ethics for Arbitrators in Commercial Disputes in effect at the time the arbitration is initiated. Prior to accepting an appointment, each arbitrator must promptly disclose any circumstances likely to create a reasonable inference of bias or conflict of interest or likely to preclude completion of the hearings within the prescribed time schedule. Any arbitrator selected may be removed by the AAA for cause consisting of actual bias, conflict of interest or other serious potential for conflict.

(v) The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that after consulting with the parties, the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable, will devise procedures and deadlines for the arbitration, to the extent not already agreed to by the parties, with the goal of expediting the proceeding and completing the arbitration within 30 days after appointment of the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable. The arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will have the authority to schedule, hear, and determine any and all motions, including dispositive and discovery motions, in accordance with New York law then in effect (including prehearing and post hearing motions), and will do so on the motion of any party to the arbitration. Notwithstanding any other discovery that may be available under the Rules, unless otherwise agreed by the parties, each party to the arbitration will be limited to the following discovery in the arbitration:

(A) Consistent with the expedited nature of arbitration, the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will, upon the written request of the other party, promptly provide the other with copies of documents relevant to the issues raised by any claim or counterclaim on which the producing party may rely in support of or in opposition to the claim or defense.

(B) At the request of a party, the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable, shall have the discretion to order examination by deposition of witnesses to the extent the arbitrator or arbitral panel deems such additional discovery relevant and appropriate. Depositions shall be limited to a maximum of three (3) per party and shall be held within thirty (30) calendar days of the making of a request. Additional depositions may be scheduled only with the permission of the arbitrator or arbitral panel, and for good cause shown. Each deposition shall be limited to a maximum of three (3) hours’ duration. All objections are reserved for the arbitration hearing except for objections based on privilege and proprietary or confidential information.

(C) Any dispute regarding discovery, or the relevance or scope thereof, shall be determined by the arbitrator or arbitral panel, which determination shall be conclusive.

(D) All discovery shall be completed within sixty (60) calendar days following the appointment of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable; provided, that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will have the ability to grant the parties, or either of them, additional discovery to the extent that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, determines good cause is shown that such additional discovery is reasonable and necessary.

 

-4-


(vi) The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will resolve the dispute in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, and may not modify or change this Agreement in any way. The arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will not have the power to award punitive damages or consequential damages in any arbitration conducted. The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that in its final determination, the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will determine and award the costs of the arbitration (including the fees of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, cost of any record or transcript of the arbitration, and administrative fees) and reasonable attorneys’ fees to the parties as determined by the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, in its reasonable discretion. The determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, must be consistent with the provisions of this Agreement, including Section 9.06 (with the understanding that any costs allocated to Funding under this subsection 6.03(c)(vi) will be limited as though such costs were claims of Capital One for purposes of Section 9.06), and will be in writing and counterpart copies will be promptly delivered to the parties. The determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, may be reconsidered once by the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, upon the motion and at the expense of either party. Following that single reconsideration, the determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will be final and non-appealable and may be entered in and may be enforced in, any court of competent jurisdiction.

(vii) By selecting binding arbitration, the Requesting Party is giving up the right to sue in court, including the right to a trial by jury.

(viii) No Person may bring a putative or certified class action to arbitration.

(d) The following provisions will apply to both mediations and arbitrations:

(i) Any mediation or arbitration will be held in New York, New York.

(ii) Notwithstanding this dispute resolution provision, the parties will have the right to seek provisional or ancillary relief from a competent court of law, including a temporary restraining order, preliminary injunction or attachment order, provided such relief would otherwise be available by law.

(iii) The details and/or existence of any unfulfilled repurchase request specified in subsection 6.03(a) above, any informal meetings, mediations or arbitration proceedings, including all offers, promises, conduct and statements, whether oral or written, made in the course of the parties’ attempt to informally resolve an unfulfilled repurchase request, and any discovery taken in connection with any arbitration, will be confidential, privileged and inadmissible for any purpose, including impeachment, in any mediation, arbitration or litigation,

 

-5-


or other proceeding; provided, however, that any discovery taken in any arbitration will be admissible in that particular arbitration. Such information will be kept strictly confidential and will not be disclosed or discussed with any third party (excluding a party’s attorneys, experts, accountants and other agents and representatives, as reasonably required in connection with the related resolution procedure), except as otherwise required by law, regulatory requirement or court order. If any party to a resolution procedure receives a subpoena or other request for information from a third party (other than a governmental regulatory body) for such confidential information, the recipient will promptly notify the other party to the resolution procedure and will provide the other party with the opportunity to object to the production of its confidential information. Notwithstanding anything in this Section 6.03 to the contrary, any discovery taken in connection with any arbitration pursuant to subsection 6.03(c) above will be admissible in such arbitration.

ARTICLE II

CONDITIONS PRECEDENT

Section 2.01. Effectiveness. The amendments and assignments provided for by this Amendment shall become effective upon satisfaction of the following conditions:

(a) prior notice from the Bank and Funding to the Trustee and each Rating Agency of this Amendment, delivered pursuant to Section 9.01 of the Agreement;

(b) delivery of written confirmation to Funding from each Rating Agency that this Amendment will not result in the reduction or withdrawal of the respective ratings of such Rating Agency for any securities issued by the Trust, delivered pursuant to Section 9.01 of the Agreement;

(c) delivery of an Officer’s Certificate, from the Bank to Funding, stating that the Bank reasonably believes that such action will not cause a Pay Out Event delivered pursuant to Section 9.01 of the Agreement;

(d) a copy of this Amendment shall be sent to each Rating Agency; and

(e) delivery of counterparts of this Amendment, duly executed by the parties hereto.

ARTICLE III

MISCELLANEOUS

Section 3.01. Waiver of Notice. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in the Agreement, each of the undersigned parties hereby waive any notice or other timing requirements with respect to and gives its consent to the amendments and assignments provided for herein.

 

-6-


Section 3.02. Ratification of Agreement. Except as specifically amended, modified or supplemented by this Amendment, the Agreement is hereby confirmed and ratified in all respects and shall remain in full force and effect. This Amendment shall not constitute a novation of the Agreement, but shall constitute an amendment and assignment thereof. Each of the parties to the Agreement agrees to be bound by the terms of the obligations of the Agreement, as amended and assigned by this Amendment, as though the terms and obligations of such agreement were set forth herein.

Section 3.03. Counterparts. This Amendment may be executed in any number of counterparts and by separate parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which when executed shall be deemed an original, but all such counterparts taken together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

Section 3.04. Governing Law. THIS AMENDMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS (OTHER THAN SECTION 5-1401 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATIONS LAW), AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS, REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 3.05. Defined Terms and Section References. Capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings given to such terms in the Agreement. All Section or Subsection references herein shall mean Sections or Subsections in the Agreement, except as otherwise provided herein.

 

-7-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned parties have caused this Amendment to be duly executed by their respective officers thereunto duly authorized, all as of the date first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
By:  

/s/ Daniel H. Rosen

  Name:   Daniel H. Rosen
  Title:   Managing Vice President, Treasury
CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC
By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

  Name:   Eric D. Bauder
  Title:   Assistant Vice President

 

Acknowledged and Accepted by:

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

as Trustee

By:  

/s/ Michael D. Commisso

  Name:   Michael D. Commisso
  Title:   Vice President

[Signature Page to Second Amendment to COMT Receivables Purchase Agreement]

EX-4.2 3 d125824dex42.htm EXHIBIT 4.2 Exhibit 4.2

EXHIBIT 4.2

 

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,

as Transferor,

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,

as Servicer,

and

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

as the Trustee

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

AMENDED AND RESTATED POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT

Dated as of September 30, 1993,

As amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007

and March 17, 2016

 

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

ARTICLE I

  Definitions      2   

Section 1.01.

 

Definitions

     2   

Section 1.02.

 

Other Definitional Provisions and Rules of Construction

     25   

ARTICLE II

  Transfer of Receivables      26   

Section 2.01.

 

Transfer of Receivables

     26   

Section 2.02.

 

Acceptance by Trustee

     28   

Section 2.03.

 

Representations and Warranties of the Transferor Relating to the Transferor

     29   

Section 2.04.

 

Representations and Warranties of the Transferor Relating to the Agreement and Any Supplement and the Receivables

     31   

Section 2.05.

 

Reassignment of Ineligible Receivables

     33   

Section 2.06.

 

Reassignment of Receivables in Trust Portfolio

     34   

Section 2.07.

 

Covenants of the Transferor

     35   

Section 2.08.

 

Addition of Accounts

     39   

Section 2.09.

 

Removal of Accounts

     43   

Section 2.10.

 

Account Allocations

     45   

Section 2.11.

 

Discount Option

     46   

Section 2.12.

 

Dispute Resolution

     46   

ARTICLE III

  Administration and Servicing of Receivables      50   

Section 3.01.

 

Acceptance of Appointment and Other Matters Relating to the Servicer

     50   

Section 3.02.

 

Servicing Compensation

     52   

Section 3.03.

 

Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Servicer

     52   

Section 3.04.

 

Reports and Records for the Trustee

     55   

Section 3.05.

 

Annual Certificate of Servicer

     56   

Section 3.06.

 

[Reserved]

     56   

Section 3.07.

 

Tax Treatment

     57   

Section 3.08.

 

Notices to Capital One

     57   

Section 3.09.

 

Adjustments

     57   

Section 3.10.

 

Reports to the Commission

     58   

ARTICLE IV

  Rights of Certificateholders and Allocation and Application or Collections      58   

Section 4.01.

 

Rights of Certificateholders

     58   

Section 4.02.

 

Establishment of Collection Account and Excess Funding Account

     59   

Section 4.03.

 

Collections and Allocations

     61   

Section 4.04.

 

Shared Principal Collections

     63   

Section 4.05.

 

Excess Finance Charges

     64   

 

-i-


ARTICLE V

  Distributions and Reports to Certificateholders      64   

ARTICLE VI

  The Certificates      64   

Section 6.01.

 

The Certificates

     64   

Section 6.02.

 

Authentication of Certificates

     65   

Section 6.03.

 

New Issuances

     65   

Section 6.04.

 

Registration of Transfer and Exchange of Certificates

     67   

Section 6.05.

 

Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates

     70   

Section 6.06.

 

Persons Deemed Owners

     70   

Section 6.07.

 

Appointment of Paying Agent

     71   

Section 6.08.

 

Access to List of Registered Certificateholders’ Names and Addresses

     72   

Section 6.09.

 

Authenticating Agent

     72   

Section 6.10.

 

Book-Entry Certificates

     73   

Section 6.11.

 

Notices to Clearing Agency

     74   

Section 6.12.

 

Definitive Certificates

     74   

Section 6.13.

 

Global Certificate; Exchange Date

     75   

Section 6.14.

 

Meetings of Certificateholders

     76   

ARTICLE VII

  Other Matters Relating to the Transferor      78   

Section 7.01.

 

Liability of the Transferor

     78   

Section 7.02.

 

Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Transferor

     78   

Section 7.03.

 

Limitations on Liability of the Transferor

     79   

Section 7.04.

 

Liabilities

     79   

Section 7.05.

 

Assumption of the Transferor’s Obligations

     80   

ARTICLE VIII

  Other Matters Relating to the Servicer      81   

Section 8.01.

 

Liability of the Servicer

     81   

Section 8.02.

 

Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Servicer

     81   

Section 8.03.

 

Limitation on Liability of the Servicer and Others

     82   

Section 8.04.

 

Servicer Indemnification of the Transferor, the Trust and the Trustee

     82   

Section 8.05.

 

The Servicer Not To Resign

     82   

Section 8.06.

 

Access to Certain Documentation and Information Regarding the Receivables

     83   

Section 8.07.

 

Delegation of Duties

     83   

Section 8.08.

 

Examination of Records

     83   

ARTICLE IX

  Pay Out Events      83   

Section 9.01.

 

Pay Out Events

     83   

Section 9.02.

 

Additional Rights upon the Occurrence of Certain Events

     84   

 

-ii-


ARTICLE X

  Servicer Defaults      85   

Section 10.01.

 

Servicer Defaults

     85   

Section 10.02.

 

Trustee To Act; Appointment of Successor

     88   

Section 10.03.

 

Notification to Certificateholders

     89   

ARTICLE XI

  The Trustee      90   

Section 11.01.

 

Duties of Trustee

     90   

Section 11.02.

 

Certain Matters Affecting the Trustee

     91   

Section 11.03.

 

Trustee Not Liable for Recitals in Certificates

     92   

Section 11.04.

 

Trustee May Own Certificates

     93   

Section 11.05.

 

The Servicer To Pay Trustee’s Fees and Expenses

     93   

Section 11.06.

 

Eligibility Requirements for Trustee

     93   

Section 11.07.

 

Resignation or Removal of Trustee

     94   

Section 11.08.

 

Successor Trustees

     94   

Section 11.09.

 

Merger or Consolidation of Trustee

     95   

Section 11.10.

 

Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate Trustee

     95   

Section 11.11.

 

Tax Returns; Tax Liability

     96   

Section 11.12.

 

Trustee May Enforce Claims Without Possession of Certificates

     97   

Section 11.13.

 

Suits for Enforcement

     97   

Section 11.14.

 

Rights of Certificateholders To Direct Trustee

     98   

Section 11.15.

 

Representations and Warranties of Trustee

     99   

Section 11.16.

 

Maintenance of Office or Agency

     99   

Section 11.17.

 

Confidentiality

     99   

ARTICLE XII

  Termination      100   

Section 12.01.

 

Termination of Trust

     100   

Section 12.02.

 

Final Distribution

     100   

Section 12.03.

 

Transferor’s Termination Rights

     101   

Section 12.04.

 

Defeasance

     101   

ARTICLE XIII

  Miscellaneous Provisions      102   

Section 13.01.

 

Amendment; Waiver of Past Defaults

     102   

Section 13.02.

 

Protection of Right, Title and Interest to Trust

     104   

Section 13.03.

 

Limitation on Rights of Certificateholders

     105   

Section 13.04.

 

GOVERNING LAW

     106   

Section 13.05.

 

Notices; Payments

     106   

Section 13.06.

 

Rule 144A Information

     107   

Section 13.07.

 

Severability of Provisions

     107   

Section 13.08.

 

Assignment

     107   

Section 13.09.

 

Certificates Nonassessable and Fully Paid

     107   

Section 13.10.

 

Further Assurances

     107   

 

-iii-


Section 13.11.

 

Nonpetition Covenant

     108   

Section 13.12.

 

No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies

     108   

Section 13.13.

 

Counterparts

     108   

Section 13.14.

 

Third-Party Beneficiaries

     108   

Section 13.15.

 

Actions by Certificateholders

     108   

Section 13.16.

 

Merger and Integration

     109   

Section 13.17.

 

Headings

     109   

Section 13.18.

 

Fiscal Year

     109   

ARTICLE XIV

  Compliance With Regulation AB      109   

Section 14.01.

 

Intent of the Parties; Reasonableness

     109   

Section 14.02.

 

Additional Representations and Warranties of the Trustee

     109   

Section 14.03.

 

Information to Be Provided by the Trustee

     110   

Section 14.04.

 

Report on Assessment of Compliance and Attestation

     111   

Section 14.05.

 

Additional Representations and Warranties of the Servicer

     111   

Section 14.06.

 

Information to Be Provided by the Servicer

     112   

Section 14.07.

 

Report on Assessment of Compliance and Attestation

     114   

Section 14.08.

 

Use of Subservicers and Servicing Participants

     114   

ARTICLE XV

  Asset Representations Review Triggers      115   

Section 15.01.

 

Delinquency Trigger

     115   

Section 15.02.

 

Investor Action to Initiate an Asset Representations Review

     116   

 

-iv-


EXHIBITS

 

Exhibit A

  Form of Base Certificate

Exhibit B

  Form of Assignment of Receivables in Additional Accounts

Exhibit C

  Form of Reassignment of Receivables in Removed Accounts

Exhibit D

  Form of Annual Servicer’s Certificate

Exhibit E-1

  Private Placement Legend

Exhibit E-2

  Representation Letter

Exhibit E-3

  ERISA Legend

Exhibit F

  Form of Depositary Agreement

Exhibit G-1

  Form of Certificate of Foreign Clearing Agency

Exhibit G-2

  Form of Alternate Certificate to be delivered to Foreign Clearing Agency

Exhibit G-3

  Form of Certificate to be delivered to Foreign Clearing Agency

Exhibit H-1

  Form of Opinion of Counsel with respect to Amendments

Exhibit H-2

  Form of Opinion of Counsel with respect to Accounts

Exhibit I

  Form of Assumption Agreement

Exhibit J

  Form of Annual Certification

Exhibit K

  Servicing Criteria to be Addressed in Assessment of Compliance

Exhibit L

  Form of Annual Certification

Exhibit M

  Servicing Criteria to be Addressed in Assessment of Compliance

SCHEDULES

Schedule 1     List of Accounts [Deemed Incorporated]

 

-v-


AMENDED AND RESTATED POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, among CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a National banking association, as Servicer, CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company, as Transferor and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation, as the Trustee.

WHEREAS this Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, was amended and restated on April 9, 2001, and as amended and restated on April 9, 2001, was among Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as a seller, and as Servicer, Capital One, F.S.B., a federal savings bank, as a seller, and the Trustee (the “Prior PSA”);

WHEREAS this Pooling and Servicing Agreement was further amended and restated on August 1, 2002, and as amended and restated on August 1, 2002, was among Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, and the Trustee;

WHEREAS this Pooling and Servicing Agreement was further amended and restated on January 13, 2006, and as amended and restated on January 13, 2006, was among Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, and the Trustee;

WHEREAS, this Pooling and Servicing Agreement was further amended on March 23, 2007, and as amended on March 23, 2007, was among Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, and the Trustee;

WHEREAS, this Pooling and Servicing Agreement was further amended and restated on July 1, 2007, and as amended on July 1, 2007, was among Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, and the Trustee;

WHEREAS, this Pooling and Servicing Agreement was further amended on March 1, 2008, and as amended on March 1, 2008, was among Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, and the Trustee; and

WHEREAS, the parties hereto agree to and do hereby amend and restate the Pooling and Servicing Agreement as of March 17, 2016 to read in its entirety as set forth herein;


NOW, THEREFORE in consideration of the mutual agreements herein contained, this Agreement is hereby amended and restated to read in its entirety as follows and each party agrees as follows for the benefit of the other parties, the Certificateholders and any Series Enhancer (to the extent provided herein and in any Supplement):

ARTICLE I

Definitions

Section 1.01. Definitions. Whenever used in this Agreement, the following words and phrases shall have the following meanings.

60+- Day Delinquency Rate” shall mean, for any Monthly Period, the delinquency rate calculated as a ratio (expressed as a percentage) of the aggregate dollar amount of Receivables that are 60 or more days delinquent to the aggregate dollar amount of all of the Receivables, measured as of the end of such Monthly Period.

AAA” shall have the meaning specified in subsection 2.12(b)(i).

Account” shall mean (a) each Initial Account, (b) each Additional Account, and (c) each Related Account. The term “Account” shall refer to an Additional Account only from and after the Addition Date with respect thereto, and the term “Account” shall refer to any Removed Account only prior to the Removal Date with respect thereto.

Account Owner” shall mean Capital One and its successors and assigns under the Capital One Receivables Purchase Agreement, or any other entity which originated an Account pursuant to a Lending Agreement and owns such Account.

Account Schedule” shall mean a computer file or microfiche list containing a true and complete list of (i) Accounts, identified by account number, and setting forth, with respect to each Account, the aggregate amount outstanding in such Account, the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables outstanding in such Account and any amount on deposit in and/or credited to any related Deposit Account, each (a) on the Initial Cut-Off Date (for the Account Schedule delivered on the Substitution Date), (b) on or prior to the Determination Date immediately succeeding the related Monthly Period (for any Account Schedule relating to Automatic Additional Accounts) and (c) on the Additional Cut-Off Date (for any Account Schedule relating to Additional Accounts designated under Section 2.08(a) or (b)), and (ii) Participation Interests, identified with particularity, and setting forth comparable information.

Accumulation Period” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the period, if any, specified as such in the related Supplement.

Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Addition” shall mean the designation of additional Eligible Accounts to be included as Accounts or Participation Interests to be included as Trust Assets pursuant to Section 2.08(a), (b) or (c).

Addition Date” shall mean (i) with respect to Additional Accounts designated under Section 2.08(a) or (b), the date from and after which such Additional Accounts are included as Accounts pursuant to such Section, (ii) with respect to Automatic Additional

 

-2-


Accounts, the later of the dates on which such Automatic Additional Accounts are originated or designated, and (iii) with respect to Participation Interests, the date from and after which such Participation Interests are to be included as Trust Assets pursuant to Section 2.08(a) or (b).

Addition Discount Receivables” shall mean, as of any applicable Addition Date, the amount of Principal Receivables in Additional Accounts designated by the Transferor to be treated as Finance Charge Receivables; provided, however, that the Transferor may not make such designation unless (i) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such designation will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee and (ii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor, to the effect that the Transferor reasonably believes that the designation will not, based on the facts known to such officer at the time of the certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after the giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series.

Additional Account” shall mean each VISA® and MasterCard®* revolving credit card account or other revolving credit account established pursuant to a Lending Agreement, which account is designated pursuant to Section 2.08(a), (b) or (c) to be included as an Account and is identified on the Account Schedule delivered to the Trustee by the Transferor.

Additional Cut-Off Date” shall mean (i) with respect to Additional Accounts designated under Section 2.08(a) or (b), the date specified as such in the notice delivered with respect thereto, (ii) with respect to Automatic Additional Accounts, the later of the dates on which such Automatic Additional Accounts are originated or designated, and (iii) with respect to Participation Interests, the date specified as such in the notice delivered with respect thereto.

Additional Transferor” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.08(f).

Adjustment Payment” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.09(a).

Affiliate” shall mean, with respect to any specified Person, any other Person controlling or controlled by or under common control with such specified Person. For the purposes of this definition, “control” shall mean the power to direct the management and policies of a Person, directly or indirectly, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise; and the terms “controlling” and “controlled” shall have meanings correlative to the foregoing.

Aggregate Addition Limit” shall mean the number of accounts designated as Automatic Additional Accounts, without prior Rating Agency consent, and designated as Additional Accounts pursuant to Sections 2.08(a) and 2.08(b), without the prior Rating Agency notice described under Section 2.08(d)(v), which would either (x) with respect to any three (3)

 

* VISA® and MasterCard® are registered trademarks of VISA USA, Inc. and of MasterCard International Incorporated, respectively.

 

-3-


consecutive Monthly Periods, commencing with the three (3) Monthly Periods ending December 1993, equal 15% of the number of Accounts at the end of the ninth Monthly Period preceding the commencement of such three (3) Monthly Periods (or, the Trust Cut-Off Date, whichever is later) and (y) with respect to any twelve (12) Monthly Periods, equal 20% of the number of Accounts as of the first day of such twelve (12) Monthly Periods (or, the Trust Cut-Off Date, whichever is later).

Agreement” shall mean this Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and all amendments hereof and supplements hereto, including, with respect to any Series or Class, the related Supplement.

Applicants” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.08.

Appointment Date” shall have the meaning specified in Section 9.02(a).

Asset Representations Review” shall have the meaning assigned to the term “Review” in the Asset Representations Review Agreement.

Asset Representations Review Agreement” shall mean that certain Asset Representations Review Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, among the Transferor, the Bank, the Servicer and the Asset Representations Reviewer.

Asset Representations Reviewer” shall mean Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, and its successors and any entity resulting from or surviving any consolidation or merger to which it or its successors may be a party, and any successor asset representations reviewer appointed as provided in the Asset Representations Review Agreement.

Asset Review Quorum” shall mean Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing at least 5% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of Investor Certificates outstanding.

Assignment” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.08(d).

Assumption Agreement” shall have the meaning specified in Section 7.05.

Assuming Entity” shall have the meaning specified in Section 7.05.

Authorized Newspaper” shall mean any newspaper or newspapers of general circulation (including The Bond Buyer or The Wall Street Journal) in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, printed in the English language (and, with respect to any Series or Class, if and so long as the Investor Certificates of such Series or Class are listed on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange and such exchange shall so require, in Luxembourg, printed in any language satisfying the requirements of such exchange) and customarily published on each Business Day at such place, whether or not published on Saturdays, Sundays or holidays.

 

-4-


Automatic Additional Account” shall mean each VISA and MasterCard revolving credit card account or other revolving credit account established pursuant to a Lending Agreement, which account is designated pursuant to Section 2.08(c) to be included as an Account and is identified on the Account Schedule delivered to the Trustee by the Transferor.

Bank” shall mean Capital One Bank (USA), National Association and its permitted successors and assigns.

Base Certificate” shall mean, if the Transferor elects to evidence its interest in the Transferor’s Interest in certificated form pursuant to Section 6.01, a certificate executed by the Transferor and authenticated by or on behalf of the Trustee, substantially in the form of Exhibit A, as the same may be modified in accordance with Section 2.08(f).

Bearer Certificates” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.01.

Benefit Plan” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.04(c).

Book-Entry Certificates” shall mean Investor Certificates that are registered in the name of a Clearing Agency or a Foreign Clearing Agency, or the nominee of either such entity, ownership and transfers of which shall be made through book entries by such Clearing Agency or such Foreign Clearing Agency as described in Section 6.10.

Business Day” shall mean any day other than (a) a Saturday or Sunday or (b) any other day on which national banking associations or state banking institutions in New York, New York, Richmond, Virginia, Falls Church, Virginia, or, if an Assuming Entity shall be any Additional Transferor designated pursuant to Section 2.08(f), any other State in which the principal executive offices of such Assuming Entity or Additional Transferor are located, are authorized or obligated by law, executive order or governmental decree to be closed.

Capital One” shall mean Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, a National banking association and its permitted successors and assigns.

Capital One Receivables Purchase Agreement” shall mean the Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007, between Capital One and Funding, and acknowledged and accepted by the Trustee, as amended on March 1, 2008 and March 17, 2016, and as further amended and supplemented from time to time.

Cash Advance Fees” shall mean fees or charges for cash advances, as specified in the Lending Agreement applicable to each Account.

Certificate” shall mean any one of the Investor Certificates or the Transferor Certificates.

Certificate Owner” shall mean, with respect to a Book-Entry Certificate, the Person who is the owner of a security entitlement with respect to such Book-Entry Certificate, as reflected on the books of the Clearing Agency, or on the books of a Person maintaining an account with such Clearing Agency (directly or as an indirect participant, in accordance with the rules of such Clearing Agency).

 

-5-


Certificate Rate” shall mean, with respect to any Series or Class, the certificate rate specified therefor in the related Supplement.

Certificate Register” shall mean the register maintained pursuant to Section 6.04, providing for the registration of the Registered Certificates and the Transferor Certificates and transfers and exchanges thereof.

Certificateholder” or “Holder” shall mean an Investor Certificateholder, a Person in whose name a Transferor Certificate is registered in the Certificate Register, or any Person recorded as the owner of any part of an interest in the Transferor’s Interest.

Certificateholders’ Interest” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.01.

Class” shall mean, with respect to any Series, any one of the classes of Investor Certificates of that Series.

Clearing Agency” shall mean an organization registered as a “clearing agency” pursuant to Section 17A of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

Clearing Agency Participant” shall mean a broker, dealer, bank, other financial institution or other Person for whom from time to time a Clearing Agency effects book-entry transfers and pledges of securities deposited with the Clearing Agency pursuant to the rules and regulations of such Clearing Agency.

Clearstream” shall mean Clearstream Banking, société anonyme, a professional depository incorporated under the laws of Luxembourg, and any successor thereto.

Closing Date” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the closing date specified in the related Supplement.

Code” shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time.

Collection Account” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.02.

Collections” shall mean (a) all payments by or on behalf of Obligors (including Insurance Proceeds) received in respect of the Receivables, in the form of cash, checks, wire transfers, electronic transfers, ATM transfers or any other form of payment in accordance with the related Lending Agreement in effect from time to time, (b) amounts, if any, withdrawn from a Deposit Account in accordance with an Assignment and (c) with respect to any Monthly Period, (i) the Interchange received with respect to such Monthly Period, (ii) all Recoveries received during such Monthly Period and (iii) all payments of annual membership fees (including in the case of the first Monthly Period the unamortized portion of annual membership fees relating to the period prior to the Trust Cut-Off Date determined in accordance with Section 3.04(d) hereof) with respect to the Accounts during such Monthly Period.

 

-6-


Commission” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.01(b).

Controlled Amortization Period” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the period, if any, specified as such in the related Supplement.

Corporate Trust Office” shall have the meaning specified in Section 11.16.

Coupon” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.01.

Date of Processing” shall mean, with respect to any transaction, the date on which such transaction is first recorded under the Servicer’s (or, in the case of the Transferor, the Transferor’s) computer file of revolving credit accounts (without regard to the effective date of such recordation).

Debtor Relief Laws” shall mean (a) the United States Bankruptcy Code and (b) all other applicable liquidation, conservatorship, bankruptcy, moratorium, rearrangement, receivership, insolvency, reorganization, suspension of payments, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets, assignment for the benefit of creditors and similar debtor relief laws from time to time in effect in any jurisdiction affecting the rights of creditors generally or the rights of creditors of banks.

Defaulted Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, an amount (which shall not be less than zero) equal to (a) the amount of Principal Receivables which became Defaulted Receivables in such Monthly Period, minus (b) the sum of (i) the amount of any Defaulted Receivables included in any Account the Receivables in which the Transferor or the Servicer became obligated to accept reassignment or assignment in accordance with the terms of this Agreement during such Monthly Period and (ii) the excess, if any, for the immediately preceding Monthly Period of the sum computed pursuant to this clause (b) for such Monthly Period over the amount of Principal Receivables which became Defaulted Receivables in such Monthly Period; provided, however, that, if an Insolvency Event occurs with respect to the Transferor, the amount of such Defaulted Receivables which are subject to reassignment to the Transferor in accordance with the terms of this Agreement shall not be added to the sum so subtracted and, if any of the events described in Section 10.01(d) occur with respect to the Servicer, the amount of such Defaulted Receivables which are subject to reassignment or assignment to the Servicer in accordance with the terms of this Agreement shall not be added to the sum so subtracted.

Defaulted Receivables” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, all Principal Receivables in any Account which are charged off as uncollectible in such Monthly Period in accordance with the Lending Guidelines and the Servicer’s customary and usual servicing procedures for servicing revolving credit card and other revolving credit account receivables comparable to the Receivables other than due to any Adjustment Payment. For purposes of this definition, a Principal Receivable in any Account shall become a Defaulted Receivable on the day on which such Principal Receivable is recorded as charged off on the Servicer’s computer master file of revolving credit accounts.

 

-7-


Defeasance” shall have the meaning specified in Section 12.04.

Defeased Series” shall have the meaning specified in Section 12.04.

Definitive Certificates” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.10.

Definitive Euro-Certificates” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.13.

Delinquency Trigger” shall mean each occurrence, as determined by the Servicer, where the Three-Month Average 60+-Day Delinquency Rate equals or exceeds the then-current Delinquency Trigger Rate.

Delinquency Trigger Rate” shall mean, initially, 9.00%, which percentage will be reviewed and may be adjusted from time to time as set forth in subsections 15.01(b) and (c).

Deposit Account” shall have the meaning specified in the Receivables Purchase Agreements.

Deposit Date” shall mean each day on which the Servicer deposits Collections in the Collection Account.

Depositaries” shall mean the Person specified in the applicable Supplement, in its capacity as depositary for the respective accounts of any Clearing Agency or any Foreign Clearing Agencies.

Depositary Agreement” shall mean, with respect to any Series or Class, the agreement among the Transferor, the Trustee and the initial Clearing Agency, or as otherwise provided in the related Supplement.

Determination Date” shall mean the fourth Business Day prior to each Distribution Date.

Discount Option Receivables” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.11.

Discount Option Receivables Collections” shall mean on any Date of Processing on and after the date on which the Transferor’s exercise of its discount option pursuant to Section 2.11 takes effect, the product of (a) a fraction the numerator of which is the amount of the Discount Option Receivables and the denominator of which is the sum of the Principal Receivables (other than Discount Option Receivables) and the Discount Option Receivables in each case (for both numerator and denominator) at the end of the prior Monthly Period and (b) Collections of Principal Receivables that arise in the Accounts on such day on or after the date such option is exercised that would otherwise be Principal Receivables.

 

-8-


Discount Percentage” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.11.

Distribution Date” shall mean the 15th day of each calendar month during the term hereof, or, if such 15th day is not a Business Day, the next succeeding Business Day.

Early Amortization Period” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the period beginning at the close of business on the Business Day immediately preceding the day on which a Pay Out Event is deemed to have occurred with respect to such Series, and ending upon the earlier to occur of (i) the payment in full to the Investor Certificateholders of such Series of the Invested Amount with respect to such Series and the payment in full to any applicable Series Enhancer with respect to such Series of the Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, with respect to such Series and (ii) the Series Termination Date with respect to such Series.

Eligible Account” shall mean a MasterCard or VISA revolving credit card account or other revolving credit account owned by an Account Owner which (i) in the case of the Initial Accounts, as of the cut-off date related to its date of designation as an “Account” under the Prior PSA or (ii) in the case of the Additional Accounts, as of the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, in each case, meets the following requirements: (a) is in existence and maintained by the Account Owner; (b) is payable in United States dollars; (c) has not been identified by the Account Owner as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen; (d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address); (e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or this Agreement); (f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables; (g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Transferor, the Account Owner or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check; (h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Account Owner or by the Transferor in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding; (i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility; and (j) does not have any Receivables that give rise to any claim against any Governmental Authority. Eligible Accounts may include accounts, the receivables of which have been written off; provided that (a) the balance of all receivables included in such accounts is reflected on the books and records of the Transferor (and is treated for purposes of this Agreement) as “zero,” and (b) charging privileges with respect to all such accounts have been canceled in accordance with the Lending Guidelines of the Account Owner and will not be reinstated by the Account Owner or the Servicer.

Eligible Deposit Account” shall mean either (a) a segregated account with an Eligible Institution (other than any Account Owner) or (b) a segregated trust account with the corporate trust department of a depository institution (other than any Account Owner) organized under the laws of the United States or any one of the states thereof, including the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a foreign bank), or a trust company acceptable to each Rating Agency, and acting as a trustee for funds deposited in such account, so long as any of the securities of such depository institution or trust company shall have a credit rating from each Rating Agency in one of its generic credit rating categories which signifies investment grade.

 

-9-


Eligible Institution” shall mean (a) a depository institution (which may be the Trustee) organized under the laws of the United States or any one of the states thereof, including the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a foreign bank), which at all times (i) has either (x) a long-term unsecured debt rating of A2 or better by Moody’s or (y) a certificate of deposit rating of P-1 by Moody’s, (ii) has either (x) a long-term unsecured debt rating of AAA by Standard & Poor’s or (y) a certificate of deposit rating of A-l+ by Standard & Poor’s, (iii) has either (x) if rated by Fitch, a long-term unsecured debt rating of A- by Fitch or (y) a certificate of deposit rating of F1 by Fitch and (iv) is a member of the FDIC or (b) any other institution that is acceptable to Moody’s, Standard & Poor’s and Fitch.

Eligible Investments” shall mean instruments, investment property or other property, other than securities issued by the Bank or any Affiliate thereof, which evidence:

(a) direct obligations of, and obligations fully guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest by, the United States of America;

(b) demand deposits, time deposits or certificates of deposit (having original maturities of no more than 365 days) of depository institutions or trust companies incorporated under the laws of the United States of America or any one of the states thereof, including the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a foreign bank), and subject to supervision and examination by federal or state banking or depository institution authorities; provided that at the time of the Trust’s investment or contractual commitment to invest therein, the short-term debt rating of such depository institution or trust company shall be in the highest ratings investment category of each Rating Agency;

(c) commercial paper or other short-term obligations having, at the time of the Trust’s investment or contractual commitment to invest therein, a rating from each Rating Agency in its highest ratings investment category;

(d) demand deposits, time deposits and certificates of deposit which are fully insured by the FDIC, with a Person the commercial paper of which has a credit rating from each Rating Agency in its highest ratings investment category;

(e) notes or bankers’ acceptances (having original maturities of no more than 365 days) issued by any depository institution or trust company referred to in (b) above;

(f) investments in money market funds rated in the highest ratings investment category by each Rating Agency or otherwise Approved in writing by each Rating Agency;

(g) time deposits (having maturities of not more than thirty (30) days), other than as referred to in clause (d) above, with a Person the commercial paper of which has a credit rating from each Rating Agency in its highest ratings investment category; or

(h) any other investments approved in writing by each Rating Agency.

 

-10-


Eligible Receivable” shall mean each Receivable:

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Account Owner or the Transferor in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Account Owner or the Transferor of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor or the Trustee will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (including a prior Lien of the Account Owner but excluding any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Transferor is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

(e) which has been the subject of either a valid transfer and assignment from a Transferor to the Trustee of all of the Transferor’s right, title and interest therein (including any proceeds thereof), or the grant of a first priority perfected security interest therein (and in the proceeds thereof), effective until the termination of the Trust, subject to Section 2.07(b);

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trustee is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC;

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, has not been waived or modified;

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the

 

-11-


defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity);

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled; and

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein.

Eligible Servicer” shall mean the Trustee, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Trustee, or an entity which, at the time of its appointment as Servicer, (a) is servicing a portfolio of revolving credit card accounts or other revolving credit accounts, (b) is legally qualified and has the capacity to service the Accounts, (c) is qualified (or licensed) to use the software that the Servicer is then currently using to service the Accounts or obtains the right to use, or has its own, software which is adequate to perform its duties under this Agreement, (d) has, in the reasonable judgment of the Trustee, demonstrated the ability to professionally and competently service a portfolio of similar accounts in accordance with customary standards of skill and care and (e) has a net worth of at least $50,000,000 as of the end of its most recent fiscal quarter.

Eligible to Purge Account” shall mean any Account that (i) has a Receivables balance equal to $0.00, (ii) contains no Defaulted Receivables, (iii) has been irrevocably closed in a manner consistent with the Account Owner’s customary and usual procedures for closing revolving credit accounts, and (iv) has remained inactive after being irrevocably closed for the period then provided for in the Account Owner’s customary and usual procedures for purging closed revolving credit accounts.

Eligible to Purge Removal Date” shall have the meaning specified in Subsection 2.09(d).

Enhancement Agreement” shall mean any agreement, instrument or document governing the terms of any Series Enhancement or pursuant to which any Series Enhancement is issued or outstanding.

Enhancement Invested Amount,” with respect to any Series, shall have the meaning specified in the related Supplement.

ERISA” shall mean the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended.

Euroclear Operator” shall mean Euroclear Bank S.A./N.V., as operator of the Euroclear System, and any successor thereto.

Excess Finance Charges” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.05.

 

-12-


Excess Funding Account” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.02.

Exchange Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1934, as amended.

Exchange Date” shall mean, with respect to any Series, any date that is after the related Series Issuance Date, in the case of Definitive Euro-Certificates in registered form, or upon presentation of certification of non-United States beneficial ownership (as described in Section 6.13), in the case of Definitive Euro-Certificates in bearer form.

Excluded Series” shall mean any Series designated as such in the relevant Supplement.

Finance Charge Receivables” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, all amounts billed to the Obligors on any Account at the beginning of such Monthly Period and in respect of (i) Periodic Rate Finance Charges, (ii) Cash Advance Fees, (iii) Late Charge Fees, (iv) Overlimit Fees, (v) Returned Check Charges, (vi) Discount Option Receivables, if any, and (vii) all other incidental and miscellaneous fees and charges (other than annual membership fees) billed on the Accounts from time to time. Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to any Monthly Period shall include (i) the Interchange received with respect to such Monthly Period, (ii) all Recoveries received during such Monthly Period, (iii) the portion, determined pursuant to Section 3.04(d), of payments of annual membership fees amortized (rather than billed) with respect to the Accounts during such Monthly Period and (iv) the portion, determined pursuant to Section 3.04(e), of payments of Addition Discount Receivables to be deposited into the Collection Account with respect to such Monthly Period.

Finance Charge Shortfalls” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.05.

Fitch” shall mean Fitch, Inc., or any successor thereto.

Floating Allocation Percentage” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the floating allocation percentage specified in the related Supplement.

Foreign Clearing Agency” shall mean Clearstream and the Euroclear Operator.

F.S.B.” shall mean Capital One, F.S.B., a federal savings bank, and its permitted successors and assigns.

Funding” shall mean Capital One Funding, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company, and its permitted successors and assigns.

Funds Collateral” shall mean all Funds Collateral as defined in the Receivables Purchase Agreements that secures a Receivable sold to Funding pursuant to such Receivables Purchase Agreements.

Global Certificate” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.13(a).

 

-13-


Governmental Authority” shall mean the United States of America, any state or other political subdivision thereof and any entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or administrative functions of or pertaining to government and having jurisdiction over the applicable Person.

Group” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the group of Series, if any, in which the related Supplement specifies such Series is to be included.

Ineligible Receivables” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.05(a).

Initial Account” shall mean each VISA and MasterCard revolving credit card account existing on the Trust Cut-Off Date and established pursuant to a Lending Agreement, which account is identified on the Account Schedule delivered to the Trustee by the Transferor on the Substitution Date.

Insolvency Event” shall have the meaning specified in Section 9.01.

Insolvency Proceeds” shall have the meaning specified in Section 9.02(c).

Insurance Proceeds” shall mean all Insurance Proceeds as defined in the Receivables Purchase Agreements that are paid to the Transferor as provided in the Receivables Purchase Agreements.

Interchange” shall mean interchange fees paid to the Transferor pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements.

Invested Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Series and for any date, an amount equal to the invested amount specified in the related Supplement.

Investment Company Act” shall mean the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

Investor Certificateholder” shall mean, subject to Section 6.06, the Person in whose name a Registered Certificate is registered in the Certificate Register or the bearer of any Bearer Certificate (or the Global Certificate, as the case may be) or Coupon.

Investor Certificates” shall mean any one of the certificates (including the Bearer Certificates, the Registered Certificates or any Global Certificate) executed by the Transferor and authenticated by or on behalf of the Trustee, substantially in the form attached to the related Supplement, other than the Transferor Certificates.

Late Charge Fees” shall have the meaning specified in the Lending Agreement applicable to each Account for late payment fees or similar terms with respect to such Account.

Lending Agreement” shall mean, with respect to a revolving credit account, the agreements between the Account Owner and the related Obligor governing the terms and

 

-14-


conditions of such account, as such agreements may be amended, modified or otherwise changed from time to time in conformance with all Requirements of Law, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on the interests hereunder of Investor Certificateholders, and as distributed (including any amendments and revisions thereto) to holders of such account.

Lending Guidelines” shall mean the Account Owner’s established policies and procedures (a) relating to the operation of its credit card business, which are applicable to its entire portfolio of VISA and MasterCard and other revolving credit accounts and are consistent with reasonably prudent practice, including the established policies and procedures for determining the creditworthiness of credit card or other revolving credit account customers, and the extension of credit to credit card and other revolving credit account customers and (b) relating to the maintenance of credit card and other revolving credit accounts and the collection of receivables with respect thereto, as such policies and procedures may be amended, modified, or otherwise changed from time to time in conformance with all Requirements of Law, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on the interests hereunder of Investor Certificateholders.

Lien” shall mean any security interest, mortgage, deed of trust, pledge, hypothecation, assignment, participation, equity interest, deposit arrangement, encumbrance, lien (statutory or other), preference, priority or other security agreement or preferential arrangement of any kind or nature whatsoever, including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement or any financing lease having substantially the same economic effect as any of the foregoing, excluding any lien or filing pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or this Agreement; provided, however, that any assignment or transfer pursuant to Section 6.03(c), Section 7.02 or Section 7.05 shall not be deemed to constitute a Lien.

Manager” shall mean the lead manager, manager or co-manager or person performing a similar function with respect to an offering of Definitive Euro-Certificates.

MasterCard” shall mean MasterCard International Incorporated or any successor thereto.

Miscellaneous Payments” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, the sum of Adjustment Payments and Transfer Deposit Amounts deposited in the Collection Account with respect to such Monthly Period.

Monthly Period” shall mean, with respect to each Distribution Date, a period of approximately thirty (30) days, that (a) contains a full set of processing cycles with respect to the Accounts, (b) commences on the day immediately succeeding the last day of the immediately preceding Monthly Period and (c) ends prior to the Determination Date for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that the initial Monthly Period with respect to any Series will commence on the cut-off date as specified in the related Supplement with respect to such Series.

Monthly Servicing Fee” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.02.

 

-15-


Moody’s” shall mean Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., or any successor thereto.

Non-Code Entity” shall mean a savings and loan association, a national banking association, a bank or other entity that is not eligible to be a debtor under Title 11 of the United States Code.

Notices” shall have the meaning specified in Section 13.05(a).

Obligor” shall mean, with respect to any Account, the Person or Persons obligated to make payments with respect to such Account, including any guarantor thereof.

Officer’s Certificate” shall mean, unless otherwise specified in this Agreement, a certificate delivered to the Trustee signed by any Vice President or more senior officer of the Transferor or by any Vice President or more senior officer of the Servicer, as the case may be, or, in the case of a Successor Servicer, a certificate signed by any Vice President or more senior officer or the financial controller (or an officer holding an office with equivalent or more senior responsibilities) of such Successor Servicer, and delivered to the Trustee.

Opinion of Counsel” shall mean a written opinion of counsel, who may be counsel for, or an employee of, the Person providing the opinion and who shall be reasonably acceptable to the Trustee.

Overlimit Fees” shall have the meaning specified in the Lending Agreement applicable to each Account for overlimit fees or similar terms.

Participation Interests” shall mean participations representing undivided interests in a pool of assets primarily consisting of receivables in revolving credit card accounts or other revolving credit accounts owned by an Account Owner or any Affiliate thereof and collections thereon.

Pay Out Event” shall mean, with respect to any Series, each event specified in Section 9.01 and each additional event, if any, specified in the relevant Supplement as a Pay Out Event with respect to such Series.

Paying Agent” shall mean any paying agent and co-paying agent appointed pursuant to Section 6.07, which shall be, as of the date hereof, The Bank of New York Mellon.

Periodic Rate” shall mean the periodic rate or rates determined in the manner described in the Lending Agreement applicable to each Account.

Periodic Rate Finance Charges” shall mean finance charges based on the Periodic Rate or any similar term specified in the Lending Agreement applicable to each Account.

 

-16-


Permitted Activities” means the primary activities of the Trust, which are:

1. holding Receivables and the other Trust Assets, which assets cannot be contrary to the status of the Trust as a qualified special purpose entity under existing accounting literature, including passive derivative financial instruments that pertain to beneficial interests issued or sold to parties other than the Transferor, their affiliates or their agents;

2. issuing Certificates and other interests in the Trust;

3. receiving Collections and making payments on such Certificates and interests in accordance with the terms of this Agreement and any Supplement; and

4. engaging in other activities that are necessary or incidental to accomplish these limited purposes, which activities cannot be contrary to the status of the Trust as a qualified special purpose entity under existing accounting literature.

Person” shall mean any person or entity, including any individual, corporation, partnership, limited liability company, joint venture, association, joint-stock company, trust, unincorporated organization, Governmental Authority or other entity of similar nature.

Principal Allocation Percentage” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the principal allocation percentage specified in the related Supplement.

Principal Receivables” shall mean all Receivables other than Finance Charge Receivables, but shall not include Defaulted Receivables or amounts billed as annual membership fees. In calculating the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables on any day, the amount of Principal Receivables shall be reduced by the aggregate amount of credit balances in the Accounts on such day. Any Principal Receivables which the Transferor is unable to transfer as provided in Section 2.10 shall not be included in calculating the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables, except to the extent so provided in Section 2.10.

Principal Sharing Series” shall mean a Series that, pursuant to the Supplement therefor, is entitled to, receive Shared Principal Collections.

Principal Shortfalls” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.04.

Principal Terms” shall mean, with respect to any Series, (i) the name or designation; (ii) the initial principal amount (or method for calculating such amount) and the Invested Amount of such Series; (iii) the Certificate Rate (or method for the determination thereof) and the manner, if any, in which such rate may be adjusted from time to time; (iv) the interest payment date or dates and the manner, if any, in which the interest payment date or dates may be reset from time to time and the date or dates from which interest shall accrue; (v) the method for allocating collections to Certificateholders of such Series; (vi) the designation of any Series Accounts and the terms governing the operation of any such Series Accounts; (vii) the method of calculating the servicing fee with respect thereto; (viii) the provider and the terms of any form of Series Enhancement with respect thereto; (ix) the terms on which the Investor Certificates of such Series may be exchanged for Investor Certificates of another Series,

 

-17-


repurchased by the Transferor or remarketed to other investors; (x) the Series Termination Date; (xi) the number of Classes of Investor Certificates of such Series and, if such Series consists of more than one Class, the rights and priorities of each such Class; (xii) the extent to which the Investor Certificates of such Series will be issuable in temporary or permanent global form (and, in such case, the depositary for such Global Certificate or Certificates, the terms and conditions, if any, upon which such Global Certificate may be exchanged, in whole or in part, for Definitive Certificates, and the manner in which any interest payable on a temporary or Global Certificate will be paid); (xiii) whether the Investor Certificates of such Series may be issued as Bearer Certificates and any limitations imposed thereon; (xiv) the priority of such Series with respect to any other Series; (xv) the Rating Agency or Rating Agencies, if any, rating the Series; (xvi) the name of the Clearing Agency, if any; (xvii) the base rate applicable to any Series; (xviii) the minimum amount of Principal Receivables required to be maintained through the designation of Additional Accounts; (xix) any deposit into any account maintained for the benefit of Certificateholders; (xx) the rights of the holders of the Transferor’s Interest that have been transferred to the holders of such Series; (xxi) the Group, if any, to which such Series belongs; (xxii) whether or not such Series is a Principal Sharing Series; and (xxiii) any other terms of such Series.

Prior PSA” shall have the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional” shall mean an attorney or retired judge that is independent, impartial, knowledgeable about and experienced with the laws of the State of New York, specializing in commercial litigation with at least 15 years of experience and whose name is on a list of neutral parties maintained by the AAA.

Rating Agency” shall mean, with respect to any outstanding Series or Class, each statistical rating agency, as specified in the applicable Supplement, selected by the Transferor to rate the Investor Certificates of such Series or Class.

Ratings Effect” shall mean, with respect to any action and any Rating Agency, that such action will not result in such Rating Agency reducing or withdrawing its rating of any outstanding Series or Class of Certificates with respect to which it is a Rating Agency.

Reassignment” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.09.

Receivables” shall mean all amounts payable by Obligors on any Account, from time to time, including amounts payable for Principal Receivables, Finance Charge Receivables and annual membership fees, but only to the extent that such amounts payable have been conveyed by the applicable Account Owner to the Transferor pursuant to the related Receivables Purchase Agreement; provided, however, that such amounts shall not be included as or deemed Receivables on and after the day on which they become Defaulted Receivables; provided further, however, that for purposes of determining the amount of Principal Receivables in the Trust and the deduction of the principal amount of (x) Ineligible Receivables from such total amount of Principal Receivables as required by subsection 2.05(b) and (y) Defaulted Receivables from such total amount of Principal Receivables as required by Section 3.03, the foregoing proviso shall not apply.

 

-18-


Receivables Purchase Agreements” shall mean (i) the Capital One Receivables Purchase Agreement and (ii) any future receivables purchase agreement substantially in the form of the agreement specified in (i) above, entered into between Funding and an Account Owner; provided, that (A) Funding shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that the execution and delivery of such future receivables purchase agreement will not have a Ratings Effect and (B) Funding shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of Funding to the effect that such officer reasonably believes that the execution and delivery of such future receivables purchase agreement will not have an Adverse Effect.

Record Date” shall mean, with respect to any Distribution Date, the last Business Day of the preceding Monthly Period, except as otherwise provided with respect to a Series in the related Supplement.

Recoveries” shall mean all Recoveries as defined in the Receivables Purchase Agreements that are paid to the Transferor as provided in the Receivables Purchase Agreements.

Registered Certificateholder” shall mean the Holder of a Registered Certificate.

Registered Certificates” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.01.

Regulation AB” shall mean Subpart 229.1100 – Asset-Backed Securities (Regulation AB), 17 C.F.R. §§229.1100-229.1125, as such may be amended from time to time, and subject to such clarification and interpretation as have been provided by the Commission in the adopting releases (including Asset-Backed Securities, Securities Act Release No. 33-8518, 70 Fed. Reg. 1,506, 1,531 (January 7, 2005) and Asset-Backed Securities Disclosure and Registration, Securities Act Release No. 33-9638, 79 Fed. Reg. 57,184 (September 24, 2014)) or by the staff of the Commission, or as may be provided by the Commission or its staff from time to time.

Related Account” shall mean each VISA and MasterCard revolving credit card account or other revolving credit account which is related to an Account and which (a) was established in compliance with the Lending Guidelines pursuant to a Lending Agreement; (b) the related Obligor or Obligors are the same Person or Persons as the Obligor or Obligors of such Account; (c) is originated (i) as a result of the credit card with respect to such Account being lost or stolen; (ii) as a result of the related Obligor requesting a change in his or her billing cycle; (iii) as a result of the related Obligor requesting the discontinuance of responsibility with respect to such Account; (iv) as a result of the related Obligor requesting a product change; or (v) for any other reasons permitted by the Lending Guidelines; and (d) can be traced or identified by reference to or by way of the Account Schedule and the computer or other records of the Account Owner.

Removal Date” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.09(a).

Removal Notice Date” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.09(a).

Removed Accounts” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.09.

 

-19-


Representing Party” shall have the meaning specified in subsection 2.12(a).

Requesting Party” shall have the meaning specified in subsection 2.12(a).

Required Designation Date” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.08(a).

Required Principal Balance” shall mean, as of any date of determination, (a) the sum of the “Initial Invested Amount” (as defined in the relevant Supplement) of the Investor Certificates of each Series outstanding on such date plus, as of such date of determination, the aggregate amounts of any increases in the Invested Amounts of each prefunded Series outstanding (in each case, other than any Series or portion thereof which is designated in the relevant Supplement as then being an Excluded Series) minus (b) the principal amount on deposit in the Excess Funding Account on such date; provided, however, if at any time the only Series outstanding are Excluded Series and a Pay Out Event has occurred with respect to one or more of such Series, the Required Principal Balance shall mean (a) the sum of the “Invested Amount” (as defined in the relevant Supplement) of each such Excluded Series as of the earliest date on which any such Pay Out Event is deemed to have occurred, minus (b) the principal amount on deposit in the Excess Funding Account.

Required Transferor’s Interest” shall mean, with respect to any date, an amount equal to the product of the Required Transferor’s Percentage and the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in the Trust.

Required Transferor’s Percentage” shall mean 5%; provided, however, that the Transferor may reduce the Required Transferor’s Percentage upon (w) thirty (30) days prior notice to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled to receive such notice pursuant to the relevant Supplement, (x) receipt of written notice by the Transferor from each Rating Agency that such reduction will not have a Ratings Effect, (y) delivery by the Transferor of copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee and (z) delivery to the Trustee and each such Series Enhancer of an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor stating that the Transferor reasonably believes that such reduction will not, based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after the giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series; provided further that the Required Transferor’s Percentage shall not at any time be less than the Specified Percentage.

Requirements of Law” with respect to any Person shall mean the certificate of incorporation, certificate of formation or articles of association and by-laws, limited liability company agreement or other organizational or governing documents of such Person, and any law, treaty, rule or regulation, or determination of an arbitrator or Governmental Authority, in each case applicable to or binding upon such Person or to which such Person is subject, whether federal, state or local (including usury laws, the Federal Truth in Lending Act and Regulation Z and Regulation B of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System).

Responsible Officer” shall mean, when used with respect to the Trustee, any officers within the corporate trust administration of the Trustee, including any Vice President,

 

-20-


any Assistant Vice President, any Assistant Treasurer, any trust officer, or any other officer of the Trustee who customarily performs functions similar to those performed by any of the above-designated officers and also, with respect to a particular matter, any other officer to whom such matter is referred because of such officer’s knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject.

Revolving Credit Agreement” shall mean the Revolving Credit Agreement by and between the Bank and Funding, dated as of August 1, 2002, as such agreement may be amended from time to time in accordance therewith, or any substantially similar agreement entered into between any lender and Funding.

Returned Check Charges” shall mean the charges specified in the Lending Agreement payable for returned payment checks and direct drafts drawn on an Account.

Revolving Period” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the period specified as such in the related Supplement.

Rule 144A” shall mean Rule 144A under the Act, as such rule may be amended from time to time.

Rules” shall have the meaning specified in subsection 2.12(b)(i).

Sarbanes Certification” shall have the meaning specified in Section 14.04.

Secured Account” shall mean an Account owned by the Account Owner under which the payment obligations of the Obligor are secured by the Funds Collateral.

Securities Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Securitization Transaction” shall mean any new issuance of Investor Certificates, pursuant to Section 6.03, or new notes issued by the Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, whether publicly offered or privately placed, rated or unrated.

Series” shall mean any series of Investor Certificates established pursuant to a Supplement.

Series Account” shall mean any deposit, securities, trust, escrow or similar account maintained for the benefit of the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class, as specified in any Supplement.

Series Enhancement” shall mean the rights and benefits provided to the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class pursuant to any letter of credit, surety bond, cash collateral guaranty, cash collateral account, insurance policy, spread account, reserve account, guaranteed rate agreement, maturity liquidity facility, tax protection agreement, interest rate swap agreement, interest rate cap agreement, currency exchange agreement, other derivative securities agreement or other similar arrangement. The subordination of any Class or Series to another Class or Series shall be deemed to be a Series Enhancement.

 

-21-


Series Enhancer” shall mean the Person or Persons providing any Series Enhancement, other than the Investor Certificateholders of any Class or Series which is subordinated to another Class or Series.

Series Issuance Date” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the date on which the Investor Certificates of such Series are to be originally issued in accordance with Section 6.03 and the related Supplement.

Series Termination Date” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the termination date specified in the related Supplement.

Service Transfer” shall have the meaning specified in Section 10.01.

Servicer” shall mean Capital One, in its capacity as Servicer pursuant to this Agreement, and, after any Service Transfer, the Successor Servicer.

Servicer Default” shall have the meaning specified in Section 10.01.

Servicing Criteria” shall mean the “servicing criteria” set forth in Item 1122(d) of Regulation AB, as such may be amended from time to time.

Servicing Fee” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.02.

Servicing Fee Rate” shall mean, with respect to any Series, the servicing fee rate specified in the related Supplement.

Servicing Officer” shall mean any officer of the Servicer who is involved in, or responsible for, the administration and servicing of the Receivables and whose name appears on a list of servicing officers furnished to the Transferor and the Trustee by the Servicer, as such list may from time to time be amended.

Servicing Participant” shall mean any Person, other than the Trustee, that is a “party participating in the servicing function” as defined in Instruction 2 to Item 1122 of Regulation AB.

Servicing Party” shall have the meaning specified in Section 14.06(a).

Shared Principal Collections” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.04.

Specified Percentage” shall mean 2%.

Standard & Poor’s” shall mean Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services, or any successor thereto.

 

-22-


Subservicer” shall mean any Person, other than the Servicer or the Trustee, that is a “servicer” as defined in 1101(j) of Regulation AB.

Substitution Date” shall mean August 1, 2002.

Successor Servicer” shall have the meaning specified in Section 10.02(a).

Supplement” shall mean, with respect to any Series, a Supplement to this Agreement, executed and delivered in connection with the original issuance of the Investor Certificates of such Series pursuant to Section 6.03, and all amendments thereof and supplements thereto.

Supplemental Certificate” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.03(c).

Tax Opinion” shall mean with respect to any action, an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that, for federal and Virginia income and franchise tax purposes (and, if there has been an assumption of the Servicer’s obligations under this Agreement, for income and franchise tax purposes of the jurisdiction in which the assuming entity engages in its principal servicing activities, if other than Virginia) (a) such action will not affect the tax characterization as debt of Investor Certificates of any outstanding Series or Class that were characterized as debt at the time of their issuance, (b) following such action the Trust will not be deemed to be an association (or publicly traded partnership) taxable as a corporation and (c) such action will not cause a taxable event to any Investor Certificateholders.

Termination Notice” shall have the meaning specified in Section 10.01.

Three-Month Average 60+-Day Delinquency Rate” shall mean, as of any date of determination, (a) the sum of the 60+-Day Delinquency Rates for the three Monthly Periods immediately preceding such date of determination divided by (b) three.

Transfer Agent and Registrar” shall have the meaning specified in Section 6.04.

Transfer Date” shall mean the Business Day immediately preceding each Distribution Date.

Transfer Deposit Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Distribution Date, the amount, if any, deposited into the Collection Account on such Distribution Date in connection with the reassignment of an Ineligible Receivable pursuant to Section 2.05 or 2.07(a) or the reassignment or assignment of a Receivable pursuant to Section 3.03.

Transfer Restriction Event” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.10.

Transferor” shall mean Funding and any permitted successors and assigns thereof under this Agreement and any Additional Transferor.

 

-23-


Transferor Certificates” shall mean, collectively, the Base Certificate and any outstanding Supplemental Certificates.

Transferor’s Interest” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.01.

Transferor’s Participation Amount” shall mean at any time of determination an amount equal to the total amount of Principal Receivables and the principal amount on deposit in the Excess Funding Account and any Principal Funding Account (as defined in any Supplement) in the Trust at such time minus the aggregate Invested Amounts and Enhancement Invested Amounts, if any, for all outstanding Series at such time.

Trust” shall mean the Capital One Master Trust heretofore created and continued by this Agreement.

Trust Assets” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2.01.

Trust Cut-Off Date” shall mean July 26, 2002.

Trustee” shall mean The Bank of New York Mellon in its capacity as trustee on behalf of the Trust, or its successor in interest, or any successor trustee appointed as herein provided.

UCC” shall mean the Uniform Commercial Code, as amended from time to time, as in effect in the applicable jurisdiction.

Unallocated Principal Collections” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.03(c).

Unamortized annual membership fees” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.04(d).

United States” shall mean the United States of America (including any one of the states thereof and the District of Columbia), its territories, its possessions and other areas subject to its jurisdiction.

United States Arbitration Act” shall mean the United States Arbitration Act of 1925, as amended.

U.S. Alien” or “United States Alien” shall mean any corporation, partnership, individual or fiduciary that, as to the United States, and for United States income tax purposes, is (i) a foreign corporation, (ii) a foreign partnership one or more of the members of which is, as to the United States, a foreign corporation, a nonresident alien individual or a nonresident alien fiduciary of a foreign estate or trust, (iii) a nonresident alien individual or (iv) a nonresident alien fiduciary of a foreign estate or trust.

 

-24-


U.S. person” or “United States person” shall mean a citizen or resident of the United States, a corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, or an estate or trust the income of which is subject to United States Federal income taxation regardless of its source.

VISA” shall mean VISA U.S.A., Inc., or any successor thereto.

Section 1.02. Other Definitional Provisions and Rules of Construction.

(a) With respect to any Series, all terms used herein and not otherwise defined herein shall have meanings ascribed to them in the related Supplement.

(b) All terms defined in this Agreement shall have the defined meanings when used in any certificate or other document made or delivered pursuant hereto unless otherwise defined therein.

(c) As used in this Agreement and in any certificate or other document made or delivered pursuant hereto or thereto, accounting terms not defined in this Agreement or in any such certificate or other document, and accounting terms partly defined in this Agreement or in any such certificate or other document to the extent not defined, shall have the respective meanings given to them under generally accepted accounting principles or regulatory accounting principles, as applicable. To the extent that, the definitions of accounting terms in this Agreement or in any such certificate or other document are inconsistent with the meanings of such terms under generally accepted accounting principles or regulatory accounting principles, the definitions contained in this Agreement or in any such certificate or other document shall control.

(d) The agreements, representations and warranties of Funding and any Additional Transferor in this Agreement in its capacity as Transferor shall be deemed to be the agreements, representations and warranties of Funding and any such Additional Transferor solely in such capacity for so long as Funding and any such Additional Transferor act in such capacity under this Agreement; the agreements, representations and warranties of Capital One in this Agreement as Servicer shall be deemed to be the agreements, representations and warranties of Capital One solely in such capacity for so long as Capital One acts in such capacity under this Agreement.

(e) The words “hereof,” “herein” and “hereunder” and words of similar import when used in this Agreement shall refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement; references to any Section, Schedule or Exhibit are references to Sections, Schedules and Exhibits in or to this Agreement unless otherwise specified; and the term “including” means “including without limitation.”

(f) All references herein to laws, statutes, acts and regulations shall mean such laws, statutes, acts and regulations as amended or recodified from time to time.

 

-25-


(g) All references herein (including the terms defined in Section 1.01) to the singular shall include the plural and vice versa, unless the context requires otherwise.

(h) All references herein to the masculine, feminine or neuter gender shall include all other genders.

ARTICLE II

Transfer of Receivables

Section 2.01. Transfer of Receivables. By execution of this Agreement, the Transferor hereby transfers, assigns, sets over and otherwise conveys to the Trustee all of its right, title and interest, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in, to and under the Receivables existing at the close of business on the Trust Cut-Off Date, in the case of Receivables arising in the Initial Accounts (including Related Accounts with respect to such Initial Accounts), and at the close of business on the related Additional Cut-Off Date, in the case of Receivables arising in the Additional Accounts (including Related Accounts with respect to such Additional Accounts), and in each case thereafter created from time to time in such Accounts until the termination of the Trust, the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, all Interchange allocable to the Trust as provided herein, all Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Participation Interests and related property conveyed to the Trustee pursuant to an Assignment, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect to all of the foregoing and all proceeds (including “proceeds” as defined in the UCC) thereof. The Transferor does hereby further transfer, assign, set over and otherwise convey to the Trustee all of its rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims under or with respect to the Receivables Purchase Agreements (whether arising pursuant to the terms of the Receivables Purchase Agreements or otherwise available to the Transferor at law or in equity), including the rights of the Transferor to enforce the Receivables Purchase Agreements and to give or withhold any and all consents, requests, notices, directions, approvals, extensions or waivers under or with respect to the Receivable Purchase Agreements to the same extent as the Transferor could but for the assignment and security interest granted to the Trustee. The property described in the two preceding sentences, together with all monies and other property on deposit in the Collection Account, the Excess Funding Account, the Series Accounts and any Series Enhancement shall constitute the assets of the Trust (the “Trust Assets”). The foregoing does not constitute and is not intended to result in the creation or assumption by the Trust, the Trustee, any Investor Certificateholder or any Series Enhancer of any obligation of the Transferor, the Servicer, an Account Owner or any other Person in connection with the Accounts, the Receivables or the Funds Collateral or under any agreement or instrument relating thereto, including any obligation to Obligors, merchant banks, merchants’ clearance systems, VISA, MasterCard or insurers. Each Account will continue to be owned by the related Account Owner and is not a Trust Asset.

The Transferor agrees to record and file, at its own expense, financing statements (and amendments thereto when applicable) with respect to the Trust Assets meeting the requirements of applicable state law in such manner and in such jurisdictions as are necessary to perfect, and maintain the perfection of, the assignment of such Trust Assets to the Trustee, and to

 

-26-


deliver a file stamped copy of each such financing statement or amendment or other evidence of such filing to the Trustee on or prior to the Substitution Date, in the case of Trust Assets relating to the Initial Accounts, and (if any additional filing is so necessary) on or prior to the applicable Addition Date, in the case of Trust Assets relating to Additional Accounts and Participation Interests. The Trustee shall be under no obligation whatsoever to file such financing statements or amendments thereto or to make any other filing under the UCC in connection with such assignment.

The Transferor further agrees, at its own expense, (i) on or prior to (A) the Substitution Date, in the case of the Initial Accounts, and (B) the applicable Addition Date, in the case of the Additional Accounts and the Participation Interests, to indicate in its books and records (including the appropriate computer files) that Receivables created in connection with the Accounts (other than Removed Accounts and Eligible to Purge Accounts that have been purged from the Transferor’s books and records pursuant to Subsection 2.09(d)), the Participation Interests and the related Trust Assets have been conveyed to the Trustee pursuant to this Agreement and (ii) on or prior to each such date referred to in clause (i), to deliver to the Trustee an Account Schedule (provided that such Account Schedule shall be provided in respect of Automatic Additional Accounts on or prior to the Determination Date immediately succeeding the related Monthly Period during which their respective Addition Dates occur). Each Account Schedule, as supplemented from time to time, shall be marked as Schedule 1 to this Agreement and is hereby incorporated into and made a part of this Agreement. Once the books and records (including the appropriate computer files) referenced in clause (i) of this paragraph have been indicated with respect to any Account or Participation Interest, the Transferor further agrees not to alter such indication during the remaining term of this Agreement, other than pursuant to Section 2.09 with respect to Removed Accounts and Eligible to Purge Accounts, unless and until the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee at least thirty (30) days prior written notice of its intention to do so and has taken such action as is necessary or advisable to cause the interest of the Trustee in the Trust Assets to continue to be perfected with the priority required by this Agreement, and has delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel to such effect.

The parties to this Agreement intend that the conveyance of the Trust Assets pursuant to this Agreement constitute a sale, and not a secured borrowing, for accounting purposes. Nevertheless, this Agreement also shall constitute a security agreement under applicable law, and the Transferor hereby grants to the Trustee a first priority perfected security interest in all of the Transferor’s right, title and interest, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in, to and under the Receivables, the Funds Collateral and the other Trust Assets, and all money, accounts, general intangibles, chattel paper, instruments, documents, goods, investment property, deposit accounts, letters of credit, letter-of-credit rights and oil, gas and other minerals consisting of, arising from or related to the Trust Assets, and all proceeds thereof, to secure its obligations hereunder.

By executing this Agreement and any Receivables Purchase Agreement, the parties hereto and thereto do not intend to cancel, release or in any way impair the conveyance made by Capital One or F.S.B. in their respective capacities as a “Seller” under the Prior PSA. Without limiting the foregoing, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree as follows:

(a) The Trust created by and maintained under the Prior PSA shall continue to exist and be maintained under this Agreement.

 

-27-


(b) All series of investor certificates issued under the Prior PSA shall constitute Series issued and outstanding under this Agreement, and any supplement existing in connection with such series shall constitute a Supplement executed hereunder.

(c) All references to the Prior PSA in any other instruments or documents shall be deemed to constitute references to this Agreement. All references in such instruments or documents to Capital One or F.S.B in their respective capacities as a “Seller” of receivables and related assets under the Prior PSA shall be deemed to include reference to Funding in such capacity hereunder.

(d) Subject to clause (5) below, Funding hereby agrees to perform all obligations of Capital One and F.S.B., in their respective capacities as a “Seller” (but not, in the case of Capital One, as “Servicer”), under or in connection with the Prior PSA (as amended and restated by this Agreement) and any Supplements to the Prior PSA.

(e) To the extent this Agreement requires that certain actions are to be taken as of a date prior to the date of this Agreement, Capital One’s or F.S.B.’s, as applicable, taking of such action under the Prior PSA shall constitute satisfaction of such requirement.

All representations, warranties and covenants of Capital One or F.S.B., as applicable, made in Article II in the Prior PSA and in any Assignment of Additional Accounts with respect to receivables and related assets transferred to the Trustee prior to the Substitution Date, shall remain in full force and effect with respect to Capital One or F.S.B., as applicable.

Section 2.02. Acceptance by Trustee.

(a) The Trustee hereby acknowledges its acceptance of all right, title and interest to the Trust Assets conveyed to the Trustee pursuant to Section 2.01 and declares that it shall maintain such right, title and interest, upon the trust herein set forth, for the benefit of all Certificateholders. The Trustee further acknowledges that, on or prior to the Substitution Date, the Transferor delivered to the Trustee the Account Schedule relating to the Initial Accounts.

(b) The Trustee hereby agrees not to disclose to any Person any of the account numbers or other information contained in the computer files or microfiche lists marked as Schedule 1 or otherwise delivered to the Trustee from time to time, except (i) to a Successor Servicer or as required by a Requirement of Law applicable to the Trustee, (ii) in connection with the performance of the Trustee’s duties hereunder, (iii) in enforcing the rights of Certificateholders or (iv) as requested by any Person in connection with the financing statements filed pursuant to this Agreement, the Prior PSA or the Receivables Purchase Agreements. The Trustee agrees to take such measures as shall be reasonably requested by any Account Owner or the Transferor to protect and maintain the security and confidentiality of such information and, in connection therewith, will allow the Account Owner and the Transferor to inspect the Trustee’s security and confidentiality arrangements from time to time during normal business hours. The Trustee shall provide the Account Owner and the Transferor with notice thirty (30) days prior to any disclosure pursuant to this Section 2.02.

 

-28-


(c) The Trustee shall have no power to create, assume or incur indebtedness or other liabilities in the name of the Trust other than as contemplated in this Agreement or any Supplement.

(d) The Trustee hereby agrees not to use any information it obtains pursuant to this Agreement, including any of the account numbers or other information contained in any Account Schedule delivered by the Transferor to the Trustee, directly or indirectly, to compete or assist any Person in competing with the Transferor or with any Account Owner in its business.

Section 2.03. Representations and Warranties of the Transferor Relating to the Transferor. The Transferor hereby represents and warrants to the Trust as of the Substitution Date and as of each Closing Date (but only if it was a Transferor on such date):

(a) Organization and Good Standing. The Transferor is a limited liability company, validly existing under the laws of the Commonwealth of Virginia, and has, in all material respects, full power and authority to own its properties and conduct its business as such properties are presently owned and such business is presently conducted, and to execute, deliver and perform its obligations under the Receivables Purchase Agreements and under this Agreement and each Supplement and to execute and deliver to the Trustee the Certificates pursuant hereto.

(b) Due Qualification. The Transferor is duly qualified to do business and is in good standing as a foreign company (or is exempt from such requirements), and has obtained all necessary licenses and approvals, in each jurisdiction in which failure to so qualify or to obtain such licenses and approvals would render any Receivable unenforceable by the Transferor, the Servicer or the Trustee or would have a material adverse effect on the interests of the Certificateholders hereunder or under any Supplement; provided, however, that no representation or warranty is made with respect to any qualifications, licenses or approvals which the Trustee has or may be required at any time to obtain, if any, in connection with the transactions contemplated hereby.

(c) Due Authorization. The execution, delivery and performance by the Transferor of this Agreement and each Supplement, the execution and delivery by the Transferor to the Trustee of the Certificates and the consummation by the Transferor of the transactions provided for in this Agreement and each Supplement have been duly authorized by the Transferor by all necessary corporate action on the part of the Transferor.

(d) No Conflict. The execution and delivery by the Transferor of this Agreement, each Supplement and the Certificates, the performance by the Transferor of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and each Supplement and the fulfillment by the Transferor of the terms hereof and thereof applicable to the Transferor will not conflict with or violate the articles of incorporation, articles of association or certificate of formation or by-laws or limited liability company agreement of the Transferor or conflict with, result in any breach of

 

-29-


any of the terms and provisions of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time or both) a material default under, any indenture, contract, agreement, mortgage, deed of trust, or other instrument to which the Transferor is a party or by which it or any of its properties are bound.

(e) No Violation. The execution and delivery by the Transferor of this Agreement, each Supplement and the Certificates, the performance by the Transferor of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and each Supplement and the fulfillment by the Transferor of the terms hereof and thereof applicable to the Transferor will not conflict with or violate any Requirements of Law applicable to the Transferor.

(f) No Proceedings. There are no proceedings or investigations pending or, to the best knowledge of the Transferor, threatened against the Transferor before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency, or other tribunal or governmental instrumentality (i) asserting the invalidity of this Agreement, any Supplement or the Certificates, (ii) seeking to prevent the issuance of the Certificates or the consummation by the Transferor of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, any Supplement or the Certificates, (iii) seeking any determination or ruling that, in the reasonable judgment of the Transferor, would materially and adversely affect the performance of its obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement, (iv) seeking any determination or ruling that would materially and adversely affect the validity or enforceability of this Agreement, any Supplement or the Certificates or (v) seeking to affect adversely the income tax attributes of the Trust under the federal or any state income or franchise tax systems.

(g) All Consents Required. All authorizations, consents, orders or other actions of any Person or of any Governmental Authority required to be obtained by the Transferor in connection with the execution and delivery by the Transferor of this Agreement, each Supplement and the Certificates, the performance by the Transferor of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and each Supplement and the fulfillment by the Transferor of the terms hereof and thereof, have been obtained, except such as are required by state securities or “Blue Sky” laws in connection with the distribution of the Certificates.

(h) Insolvency. No Insolvency Event with respect to the Transferor has occurred and the transfer of the Receivables by the Transferor to the Trustee has not been made in contemplation of the occurrence thereof.

The representations and warranties set forth in this Section 2.03 shall survive the transfer and assignment of the Trust Assets to the Trustee. Upon discovery by the Transferor, the Servicer or the Trustee of a breach of any of the representations and warranties set forth in this Section 2.03, the party discovering such breach shall give prompt written notice to the others and to each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement within three (3) Business Days following such discovery. The Transferor agrees to cooperate with the Servicer and the Trustee in attempting to cure any such breach. For purposes of the representations and warranties set forth in this Section 2.03, each reference to a Supplement shall be deemed to refer only to those Supplements in effect as of the date of the relevant representations or warranties.

 

-30-


Section 2.04. Representations and Warranties of the Transferor Relating to the Agreement and Any Supplement and the Receivables.

(a) Representations and Warranties. The Transferor hereby represents and warrants to the Trust as of the Substitution Date and each subsequent Closing Date, and with respect to any Additional Accounts, on each related Addition Date occurring after the Substitution Date (but only if it was a Transferor on such date) that:

(i) the Receivables Purchase Agreements, this Agreement, each Supplement and, in the case of Additional Accounts, the related Assignment, each constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Transferor enforceable against the Transferor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

(ii) as of the Trust Cut-Off Date, with respect to the Initial Accounts, as of the related Additional Cut-Off Date, with respect to Additional Accounts, and as of the applicable Removal Notice Date, with respect to the Removed Accounts, Schedule 1 to this Agreement and the related Account Schedule, as supplemented to such date, is an accurate and complete listing in all material respects of all the Accounts as of the Trust Cut-Off Date, such Additional Cut-Off Date or such Removal Notice Date, as the case may be, and the information contained therein with respect to the identity of such Accounts and the Receivables existing in such Accounts is true and correct in all material respects as of the Trust Cut-Off Date, such Additional Cut-Off Date or such Removal Notice Date, as the case may be;

(iii) each Receivable has been transferred by the Transferor to the Trustee free and clear of any Lien (other than Liens permitted under subsection 2.07(b));

(iv) all consents, licenses or approvals of or registrations or declarations with any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Transferor in connection with the transfer by the Transferor of Receivables to the Trustee have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

(v) subject, in each case pertaining to proceeds, to Section 9-315 of the UCC, and further subject to any Liens permitted under subsection 2.07(b), each of this Agreement and, in the case of Additional Accounts, the related Assignment constitutes either (x) a valid sale, transfer and assignment to the Trustee of all right, title and interest of the Transferor in the Receivables and the proceeds thereof or (y) a grant of a “security interest” (as defined in the UCC) in such property to the Trustee, which, in the case of existing Receivables and the proceeds thereof, is enforceable upon execution and delivery of this Agreement, or, with respect to then existing Receivables in Additional Accounts, as of the applicable Addition Date, and which will be enforceable with respect to such Receivables hereafter and thereafter created and the proceeds thereof upon such creation. Upon the filing of the financing statements pursuant to Section 2.01 and, in the case of Receivables hereafter created and the proceeds thereof, upon the creation thereof, the Trustee shall have a first priority perfected security or ownership interest in such Receivables and proceeds except for Liens permitted under Section 2.07(b);

 

-31-


(vi) except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement or any Supplement, neither the Transferor nor any Person claiming through or under the Transferor has any claim to or interest in the Collection Account, any Series Account or any Series Enhancement;

(vii) on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each related Additional Account is an Eligible Account;

(viii) on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each Receivable then existing in each related Additional Account is an Eligible Receivable;

(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable transferred by the Transferor to the Trustee, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable; and

(x) no selection procedures reasonably believed by the Transferor to be materially adverse to the interests of the Certificateholders of any Series have been used in selecting such Accounts.

(b) Representations and Warranties of the Transferor Relating to Security Interest. The Transferor hereby makes the following representations and warranties with respect to Receivables transferred by it, and each of the following representations and warranties shall survive until the termination of this Agreement and each shall speak as of the Substitution Date and, with respect to Receivables in Additional Accounts, as of the related Addition Date. None of the following representations and warranties shall be waived by any of the parties to this Agreement unless each Rating Agency shall have notified the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee in writing that such waiver will not have a Ratings Effect.

(i) This Agreement creates a valid and continuing security interest (as defined in the applicable UCC) in favor of the Trustee in the Receivables, and the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, described in Section 2.01 (the “Collateral”), which security interest is prior to all other Liens except as otherwise permitted hereunder, and is enforceable as such against creditors of and purchasers from the Transferor.

(ii) The Receivables transferred by the Transferor constitute “accounts” within the meaning of the applicable UCC.

(iii) At the time of its transfer of any item of Collateral to the Trustee pursuant to this Agreement, the Transferor owned and had good and marketable title to such item of Collateral free and clear of any Lien except as otherwise permitted hereunder.

(iv) The Transferor has caused or will have caused, within ten (10) days of the execution of this Agreement, the filing of all appropriate financing statements in the proper filing office in the appropriate jurisdictions under applicable law in order to perfect the security interest in the Receivables granted by the Transferor to the Trustee pursuant to this Agreement.

 

-32-


(v) Other than the security interest granted to the Trustee pursuant to this Agreement or an Assignment, the Transferor has not pledged, assigned, sold, granted a security interest in, or otherwise conveyed the Receivables described in Section 2.01 of this Agreement. The Transferor has not authorized the filing of and is not aware of any financing statements against the Transferor that include a description of such Receivables other than any financing statement relating to the transfer of such Receivables to the Trustee pursuant to this Agreement or an Assignment, or that has been terminated. The Transferor is not aware of any judgment or tax lien filings against the Transferor.

(c) Notice of Breach. The representations and warranties of the Transferor set forth in this Section 2.04 shall survive the transfer and assignment by the Transferor of Trust Assets to the Trustee. Upon discovery by the Transferor, the Servicer or the Trustee of a breach of any of the representations and warranties by the Transferor set forth in this Section 2.04, the party discovering such breach shall give prompt written notice to the others and to each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement within three (3) Business Days following such discovery. The Transferor agrees to cooperate with the Servicer and the Trustee in attempting to cure any such breach. For purposes of the representations and warranties set forth in this Section 2.04, each reference to a Supplement shall be deemed to refer only to those Supplements in effect as of the date of the relevant representations or warranties.

Section 2.05. Reassignment of Ineligible Receivables.

(a) Reassignment of Receivables. In the event (i) any representation or warranty of the Transferor contained in Section 2.04(a)(ii), (iii), (iv), (vii), (viii) or (ix) is not true and correct in any material respect as of the date specified therein (individually or together with any other breach or breaches then existing) and such breach has a material adverse effect on the Certificateholders’ Interest of all Series in any Receivables transferred to the Trustee (which determination shall be made without regard to the availability of funds under any Series Enhancement) and remains uncured for sixty (60) days (or such longer period, not in excess of 150 days, as may be agreed to by the Trustee) after the earlier to occur of the discovery thereof by the Transferor or receipt by the Transferor of notice thereof given by the Trustee, or (ii) it is so provided in Section 2.07(a) with respect to any Receivables transferred to the Trustee by the Transferor, then the Transferor shall accept reassignment of all Receivables in the related Account (“Ineligible Receivables”) on the terms and conditions set forth in paragraph (b) below; provided, however, that such Receivables will not be deemed to be Ineligible Receivables and will not be reassigned to the Transferor if, on any day prior to the end of such 60-day or longer period, (x) either (A) in the case of an event described in clause (i) above the relevant representation and warranty shall be true and correct in all material respects as if made on such day or (B) in the case of an event described in clause (ii) above the circumstances causing such Receivable to become an Ineligible Receivable shall no longer exist and (y) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor describing the nature of such breach and the manner in which the relevant representation and warranty became true and correct.

 

-33-


(b) Price of Reassignment. The Servicer shall deduct the portion of such Ineligible Receivables reassigned to the Transferor which are Principal Receivables from the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables used to calculate the Transferor’s Participation Amount, the Transferor’s Interest and the Floating Allocation Percentage and the Principal Allocation Percentage applicable to any Series. In the event that, following the exclusion of such Principal Receivables from the calculation of the Transferor’s Participation Amount, the Transferor’s Participation Amount would be a negative number, not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on the first Distribution Date following the Monthly Period in which such reassignment obligation arises, the Transferor shall make a deposit in immediately available funds in an amount equal to the principal portion and the interest portion of the amount by which the Transferor’s Participation Amount would be below zero (up to the amount of such Principal Receivables) into the Excess Funding Account and the Collection Account, respectively. Any amount deposited into the Excess Funding Account and the Collection Account, respectively, in connection with the reassignment of an Ineligible Receivable shall be considered a Transfer Deposit Amount and shall be applied in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

Upon the deposit, if any, required to be made to the Excess Funding Account and the Collection Account, respectively, as provided in this Section 2.05 and the reassignment of Ineligible Receivables, the Trustee shall automatically and without further action sell, transfer, assign, set-over and otherwise convey to the Transferor or its designee, without recourse, representation or warranty, all the right, title and interest of the Trustee and the Trust in and to such Ineligible Receivables, the Funds Collateral securing such Ineligible Receivables, all Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all proceeds thereof. The Trustee shall execute such documents and instruments of transfer or assignment and take such other actions as shall reasonably be requested by the Transferor to effect the transfer of such Ineligible Receivables pursuant to this Section 2.05. The obligation of the Transferor to accept reassignment of any Ineligible Receivables, and to make the deposits, if any, required to be made to the Excess Funding Account and the Collection Account, respectively, as provided in this Section 2.05, shall constitute the sole remedy respecting the event giving rise to such obligation available to Investor Certificateholders (or the Trustee on behalf of the Investor Certificateholders) or any Series Enhancer.

Section 2.06. Reassignment of Receivables in Trust Portfolio. In the event any representation or warranty of the Transferor set forth in Section 2.03 or Section 2.04(a)(i), (v) or (vi) is not true and correct in any material respect and such breach has a material adverse effect on the Certificateholders’ Interest of all Series in the Receivables, then either the Trustee or the Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Investor Certificates, by notice then given to the Transferor, the Servicer (and the Trustee if given by the Investor Certificateholders), may direct the Transferor to accept a reassignment of the Receivables if such breach and any material adverse effect caused by such breach is not cured within sixty (60) days of such notice (or within such longer period, not in excess of 150 days, as may be specified in such notice), and upon those conditions the Transferor shall be obligated to accept such reassignment on the terms set forth below; provided, however, that such Receivables will not be reassigned to the Transferor if, on any day

 

-34-


prior to the end of such 60-day or longer period (i) the relevant representation and warranty shall be true and correct in all material respects as if made on such day and (ii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor describing the nature of such breach and the manner in which the relevant representation and warranty became true and correct and the breach of such representation and warranty shall no longer materially adversely affect the interests of the Investor Certificateholders.

The Transferor shall deposit in the Collection Account in immediately available funds not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on the first Distribution Date following the Monthly Period in which such reassignment obligation arises, in payment for such reassignment, an amount equal to the sum of the amounts specified therefor with respect to each outstanding Series in the related Supplement. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, such amounts shall be distributed on such Distribution Date in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

Upon the deposit, if any, required to be made to the Collection Account as provided in this Section 2.06 and the reassignment of the applicable Receivables, the Trustee shall automatically and without further action sell, transfer, assign, set over and otherwise convey to the Transferor or its designee, without recourse, representation or warranty, all the right, title and interest of the Trustee and the Trust in and to such Receivables, the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, all Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received with respect thereto and all proceeds thereof. The Trustee shall execute such documents and instruments of transfer or assignment and take such other actions as shall reasonably be requested by the Transferor to effect the conveyance of such Receivables pursuant to this Section 2.06. The obligation of the Transferor to accept reassignment of any Receivables and to make the deposits, if any, required to be made to the Collection Account as provided in this Section 2.06 shall constitute the sole remedy respecting the event giving rise to such obligation available to the Certificateholders (or the Trustee on behalf of the Certificateholders) or any Series Enhancer.

Section 2.07. Covenants of the Transferor. The Transferor hereby covenants as follows:

(a) Receivables Not to be Evidenced by Instruments or Chattel Paper. The Transferor will take no action to cause or permit any Receivable to be evidenced by any instrument or chattel paper (as defined in the UCC) and, if any such Receivable is so evidenced, except for any action by the Servicer or an Account Owner, it shall be deemed to be an Ineligible Receivable in accordance with Section 2.05(a) and shall be reassigned to the Transferor in accordance with Section 2.05(b); provided, however, that Receivables evidenced by instruments or chattel paper taken from Obligors in the ordinary course of business of the Servicer’s collection efforts shall not be deemed Ineligible Receivables solely as a result thereof.

(b) Security Interests. Except for the conveyances hereunder, the Transferor will not sell, pledge, assign or transfer to any other Person, or grant, create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien on any Receivable, whether now existing or hereafter created, or any

 

-35-


interest therein; the Transferor will immediately notify the Trustee of the existence of any Lien on any Receivable of which it has knowledge; and the Transferor shall defend the right, title and interest of the Trustee in, to and under the Receivables, whether now existing or hereafter created, against all claims of third parties claiming through or under the Transferor; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 2.07(b) shall prevent or be deemed to prohibit the Transferor from suffering to exist upon any of the Receivables any Liens for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes shall not at the time be due and payable or if the Transferor shall currently be contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and shall have set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto.

(c) Transferor’s Interest. Except for the conveyances hereunder, in connection with any transaction permitted by Section 7.02 or 7.05 and as provided in Sections 2.08(f) and 6.03, the Transferor agrees not to transfer, assign, exchange, convey, pledge, hypothecate or otherwise grant a security interest in the Transferor’s Interest, whether represented by the Base Certificate or any Supplemental Certificate or by any uncertificated interest in the Transferor’s Interest, and any such attempted transfer, assignment, exchange, conveyance, pledge, hypothecation or grant shall be void; provided, however, that nothing in this Section 2.07(c) shall prevent the recorded owner of an interest in the Transferor’s Interest, whether uncertificated or represented by a certificate, from granting to an Affiliate a participation interest or other beneficial interest in the rights to receive cash flows related to the Transferor’s Interest, if (i) such interest does not grant such Affiliate any rights hereunder or delegate to such Affiliate any obligations or duties hereunder, (ii) the transferor of such interest obtains the prior written consent of the Transferor and (iii) after giving effect to such transfer, the aggregate interest in the Transferor’s Interest owned directly by the Transferor represents an undivided ownership interest in two percent (2.0%) or more of the Trust Assets.

(d) Delivery of Collections. In the event that the Transferor receives Collections, the Transferor agrees to deliver to the Servicer all such Collections as soon as practicable after receipt thereof but in no event later than two (2) Business Days after the Date of Processing by the Transferor.

(e) Notice of Liens. The Transferor shall notify the Trustee and each Series Enhancer entitled to such notice pursuant to the relevant Supplement promptly after becoming aware of any Lien on any Receivable other than the conveyances hereunder or Liens permitted under Section 2.07(b).

(f) Enforcement of Receivables Purchase Agreements Covenants. The Transferor shall enforce the covenants and agreements of an Account Owner in the Receivables Purchase Agreements, including the covenants set forth in subsections 5.01(f) and (g).

(g) [Reserved].

(h) [Reserved].

(i) Interchange. On or prior to each Determination Date, the Transferor shall notify the Servicer of the amount of Interchange to be included as Collections of Finance Charge

 

-36-


Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period, which shall be equal to the amount of Interchange paid to the Transferor pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements with respect to such Monthly Period.

(j) [Reserved]

(k) Separate Corporate Existence. The Transferor shall:

(i) Maintain in full effect its existence, rights and franchises as a limited liability company under the laws of the state of its formation and will obtain and preserve its qualification to do business in each jurisdiction in which such qualification is or shall be necessary to protect the validity and enforceability of this Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreements and each other instrument or agreement necessary or appropriate to proper administration hereof and to permit and effectuate the transactions contemplated hereby.

(ii) Except as provided herein, maintain its own deposit, securities and other account or accounts, separate from those of any Affiliate of the Transferor, with financial institutions. The funds of the Transferor will not be diverted to any other Person or for other than the company use of the Transferor, and, except as may be expressly permitted by this Agreement or the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the funds of the Transferor shall not be commingled with those of any other Person.

(iii) Ensure that, to the extent that it shares the same officers or other employees as any of its members or other Affiliates, the salaries of and the expenses related to providing benefits to such officers and other employees shall be fairly allocated among such entities, and each such entity shall bear its fair share of the salary and benefit costs associated with all such common officers and employees.

(iv) Ensure that, to the extent that it jointly contracts with any of its members or other Affiliates to do business with vendors or service providers or to share overhead expenses, the costs incurred in so doing shall be allocated fairly among such entities, and each such entity shall bear its fair share of such costs. To the extent that the Transferor contracts or does business with vendors or service providers where the goods and services provided are partially for the benefit of any other Person, the costs incurred in so doing shall be fairly allocated to or among such entities for whose benefit the goods and services are provided, and each such entity shall bear its fair share of such costs.

(v) Ensure that all material transactions between the Transferor and any of its Affiliates shall be only on an arm’s-length basis and shall not be on terms more favorable to either party than the terms that would be found in a similar transaction involving unrelated third parties.

(vi) Maintain a principal executive and administrative office through which its business is conducted and a telephone number separate from those of its members and other Affiliates. To the extent that the Transferor and any of its members or other Affiliates have offices in contiguous space, there shall be fair and appropriate allocation of overhead costs (including rent) among them, and each such entity shall bear its fair share of such expenses.

 

-37-


(vii) Conduct its affairs strictly in accordance with its certificate of formation and limited liability company agreement and observe all necessary, appropriate and customary company formalities, including, but not limited to, holding all regular and special members’ and directors’ meetings appropriate to authorize all action, keeping separate and accurate minutes of such meetings, passing all resolutions or consents necessary to authorize actions taken or to be taken, and maintaining accurate and separate books, records and accounts, including, but not limited to, intercompany transaction accounts. Regular members’ and directors’ meetings shall be held at least annually.

(viii) Ensure that its board of directors shall at all times include at least one Independent Director (for purposes hereof, “Independent Director” shall mean any member of the board of directors of the Transferor that is not and has not at any time been (x) an officer, agent, advisor, consultant, attorney, accountant, employee, member or shareholder of any Affiliate of the Transferor which is not a special purpose entity, (y) a director of any Affiliate of the Transferor other than an independent director of any Affiliate which is a special purpose entity or (z) a member of the immediate family of any of the foregoing).

(ix) Ensure that decisions with respect to its business and daily operations shall be independently made by the Transferor (although the officer making any particular decision may also be an officer or director of an Affiliate of the Transferor) and shall not be dictated by an Affiliate of the Transferor.

(x) Act solely in its own company name and through its own authorized officers and agents, and no Affiliate of the Transferor shall be appointed to act as agent of the Transferor. The Transferor shall at all times use its own stationery and business forms and describe itself as a separate legal entity.

(xi) Other than as provided in the Revolving Credit Agreement, ensure that no Affiliate of the Transferor shall advance funds or loan money to the Transferor, and no Affiliate of the Transferor will otherwise guaranty debts of the Transferor.

(xii) Other than organizational expenses and as expressly provided herein, pay all expenses, indebtedness and other obligations incurred by it using its own funds.

(xiii) Not enter into any guaranty, or otherwise become liable, with respect to or hold its assets or creditworthiness out as being available for the payment of any obligation of any Affiliate of the Transferor nor shall the Transferor make any loans to any Person.

(xiv) Ensure that any financial reports required of the Transferor shall comply with generally accepted accounting principles and shall be issued separately from, but may be consolidated with, any reports prepared for any of its Affiliates so long as such consolidated reports contain footnotes describing the effect of the transactions between the Transferor and such Affiliate and also state that the assets of the Transferor are not available to pay creditors of the Affiliate.

(xv) Ensure that at all times it is adequately capitalized to engage in the transactions contemplated in its certificate of formation and its limited liability company agreement.

 

-38-


Section 2.08. Addition of Accounts.

(a) Required Additions. (i) If, as of the close of business on the last Business Day of any Monthly Period, (x) the Transferor’s Participation Amount is less than the Required Transferor’s Interest or (y) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables is less than the Required Principal Balance, each on such date, the Transferor shall on or prior to the close of business on the tenth Business Day following the last Business Day of such Monthly Period (the “Required Designation Date”), unless the Transferor’s Participation Amount exceeds the Required Transferor’s Interest as of the close of business on any day after the last Business Day of such Monthly Period and prior to the Required Designation Date, designate additional Eligible Accounts to be included as Accounts as of the Required Designation Date or any earlier date in a sufficient amount such that, after giving effect to such addition, (x) the Transferor’s Participation Amount as of the close of business on the Addition Date is at least equal to the Required Transferor’s Interest and (y) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables equals or exceeds the Required Principal Balance, each on such date. The failure of any condition set forth in paragraph (c) or (d) below, as the case may be, shall not relieve the Transferor of its obligation pursuant to this paragraph; provided, however, that the failure of the Transferor to transfer Receivables to the Trustee as provided in this paragraph solely as a result of the unavailability of a sufficient amount of Eligible Receivables shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement; provided further that any such failure which has not been timely cured (as specified in the related Supplement) will nevertheless result in the occurrence of a Pay Out Event with respect to each Series for which, pursuant to the Supplement therefor, a failure by the Transferor to convey Receivables in Additional Accounts or Participation Interests to the Trustee by the day on which it is required to convey such Receivables or Participation Interests pursuant to Section 2.08(a) constitutes a “Pay Out Event” (as defined in such Supplement).

(ii) In lieu of, or in addition to, designating Additional Accounts pursuant to clause (i) above, the Transferor may, subject to the conditions specified in paragraph (d) below, convey to the Trustee Participation Interests. The addition of Participation Interests in the Trust pursuant to this paragraph (a) or paragraph (b) below shall be effected by an amendment hereto, dated the applicable Addition Date, pursuant to Section 13.01(a).

(b) Permitted Additions. The Transferor may from time to time, at its sole discretion, subject to the conditions specified in paragraph (c) or (d) below, as the case may be, designate additional Eligible Accounts to be included as Accounts or Participation Interests to be included as Trust Assets, in either case as of the applicable Addition Date.

(c) Automatic Additional Accounts. (i) The Transferor may from time to time, at its sole discretion, subject to and in compliance with the limitations specified in clause

 

-39-


(ii) below and the applicable conditions specified in paragraph (d) below, designate Eligible Accounts to be included as Accounts as of the applicable Addition Date. For purposes of this paragraph, Eligible Accounts shall be deemed to include only revolving credit card accounts or other revolving credit accounts which are (x) originated by an Account Owner or any Affiliate of an Account Owner and (y) of a type included as Initial Accounts or which have previously been included in any Addition which has been effected in accordance with all of the conditions specified in paragraph (d) below.

(ii) The Transferor shall not be permitted to designate Automatic Additional Accounts pursuant to clause (i) above with respect to any of the three (3) consecutive Monthly Periods commencing in January, April, July and October of each calendar year unless on or before the first Business Day of such three (3) consecutive Monthly Periods, the Transferor shall have requested each Rating Agency to notify, and each Rating Agency shall have notified, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee of the limitations (other than the limitations described in this Agreement), if any, to the right of the Transferor to designate Automatic Additional Accounts during such three (3) consecutive Monthly Periods; provided, however, that on or before twenty (20) days following the last Business Day of such three (3) consecutive Monthly Periods, the Transferor shall have received written confirmation from each Rating Agency that each such designation of Automatic Additional Accounts will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such confirmation to the Servicer and the Trustee. Unless Standard & Poor’s otherwise consents, the number of Automatic Additional Accounts plus the number of Accounts added pursuant to Section 2.08(a), without the prior notice of Standard & Poor’s as described under Section 2.08(d)(v), shall not at any time exceed the Aggregate Addition Limit; provided, however, if the Aggregate Addition Limit is exceeded for purposes of Section 2.08(a), the Transferor shall have delivered written notice to Moody’s of any such Addition. Unless Moody’s otherwise consents, the number of Automatic Additional Accounts added pursuant to Section 2.08(c), without prior notice of Moody’s as described under Section 2.08(d)(v), shall not at any time exceed the Aggregate Addition Limit.

(iii) On or before March 31, June 30, September 30 and December 31 of each calendar year, commencing on December 31, 2002, the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Opinion of Counsel in accordance with Section 13.02(d), with respect to the Automatic Additional Accounts included as Accounts during the preceding three-month period confirming the creation and perfection of the security interest granted by the Transferor in the Receivables in such Automatic Additional Accounts; provided, however, if the long-term unsecured debt rating or certificate of deposit rating of the related Account Owner is withdrawn or reduced below BBB- by Standard & Poor’s (and only for so long as the applicable rating is below BBB- by Standard & Poor’s), the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Opinion of Counsel in accordance with Section 13.02(d) on or before the last Business Day of each calendar month, commencing on the last Business Day of the calendar month immediately following the month in which such withdrawal or reduction occurs, with respect to the Automatic Additional Accounts owned by such Account Owner included as Accounts during the preceding one-month period confirming the creation and perfection of the security interest granted by the Transferor in the Receivables in such Automatic Additional Accounts. Such

 

-40-


Opinion of Counsel shall be provided by outside counsel. If such Opinion of Counsel with respect to any Automatic Additional Accounts is not so received, the ability of the Transferor to designate Automatic Additional Accounts will be suspended until such time as each Rating Agency otherwise consents in writing or such accounts are removed from the Trust. If the applicable Transferor is unable to deliver such Opinion of Counsel with respect to the Receivables in any Automatic Additional Account, such inability shall be deemed to be a breach of the representation in Section 2.04(a)(viii) with respect to the Receivables in such Automatic Additional Account for purposes of Section 2.05.

(d) Conditions to Addition. On the Addition Date with respect to any Additional Accounts or Participation Interests, the Trustee shall acquire the Receivables in such Additional Accounts (and such Additional Accounts shall be Accounts for purposes of this Agreement) or shall acquire such Participation Interests, in each case as of the close of business on the applicable Addition Date, subject to the satisfaction of the following conditions (provided, however, that the conditions set forth in clauses (i), (v), (vi) and (vii) shall not apply to the transfer to the Trustee of Receivables in Automatic Additional Accounts which are governed by Section 2.08(c)):

(i) on or before the fifth Business Day immediately preceding the Addition Date, the Transferor shall have given the Trustee, the Servicer, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement written notice that the Additional Accounts or Participation Interests will be included and specifying the applicable Addition Date, the Additional Cut-Off Date, the approximate number of accounts or other assets expected to be added and the approximate aggregate balances expected to be outstanding in the accounts or other assets to be added;

(ii) in the case of Additional Accounts, the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee copies of UCC financing statements covering such Additional Accounts, if necessary to perfect the Trustee’s interest in the Receivables arising therein;

(iii) in the case of Additional Accounts, to the extent required by Section 4.03, the Transferor shall have deposited in the Collection Account, or caused to be deposited into the Collection Account, all Collections with respect to such Additional Accounts since the Additional Cut-Off Date (plus an amount representing unamortized annual membership fees for such Additional Accounts determined as of such Additional Cut-Off Date in accordance with Section 3.04(d));

(iv) as of each of the Additional Cut-Off Date and the Addition Date, no Insolvency Event with respect to the Transferor or the applicable Account Owner shall have occurred nor shall the transfer of the Receivables arising in the Additional Accounts or of the Participation Interests to the Trustee have been made in contemplation of the occurrence thereof;

(v) (A) except in the case of an Addition pursuant to Section 2.08(a), the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such Addition will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee, and (B) in the case of an Addition pursuant to Section 2.08(a) during

 

-41-


any of the three (3) consecutive Monthly Periods commencing in January, April, July and October of each calendar year, if applicable, the Transferor shall have received, to the extent not previously received, not later than 20 days following the last Business Day of the relevant three (3) consecutive Monthly Periods, written notice from each Rating Agency that such Addition will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee; provided, however, that in the case of an Addition pursuant to Section 2.08(a) which would exceed the Aggregate Addition Limit, the Transferor shall have provided each Rating Agency with at least 15 days prior written notice of such Addition and at or prior to the end of such 15-day period, each Rating Agency shall have notified the Transferor in writing that such Addition will not have a Ratings Effect, and the Transferor shall have delivered copies of such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee;

(vi) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Opinion of Counsel that for federal and Virginia income and franchise tax purposes (and, if there has been an assumption of the Servicer’s obligations under this Agreement for income and franchise tax purposes of the jurisdiction in which the assuming entity engages in its principal servicing activities, if other than Virginia), such Addition will not cause a taxable event to the holders of the Certificates;

(vii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Opinion of Counsel, dated the Addition Date, in accordance with Section 13.02(d);

(viii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor, dated the Addition Date, to the effect that (A) the Transferor reasonably believes that such Addition will not, based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after the giving of notice or the lapse of time would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series and (B) in the case of Additional Accounts no selection procedure was utilized by the Transferor that would result in a selection of Additional Accounts (from the Eligible Accounts available to the Transferor) that would be materially adverse to the interests of the Certificateholders of any Series as of the date of the Addition; and

(ix) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee a written assignment executed by the Transferor and the Trustee, substantially in the form of Exhibit B (an “Assignment”), and an Account Schedule containing a true and complete list of the related Additional Accounts or Participation Interests.

(e) Representations and Warranties. The Transferor hereby represents and warrants to the Trustee as of the related Addition Date as to the matters relating to it set forth in paragraph (d)(iv) and (viii) above and that, in the case of Additional Accounts, the related Account Schedule is, as of the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, true and complete in all material respects.

 

-42-


(f) Additional Transferors. The Transferor may designate Affiliates of the Transferor to be included as a Transferor (“Additional Transferors”) under this Agreement by an amendment hereto pursuant to Section 13.01(a). Any Additional Transferor may cease to transfer newly arising Receivables to the Trustee so long as each Rating Agency provides written notice that such cessation will not have a Ratings Effect. If any Transferor elects to have all or a portion of its interest in the Transferor’s Interest evidenced by the Base Certificate as provided in Section 6.01 hereof, then in connection with such designation, the Transferor shall surrender the Base Certificate to the Trustee in exchange for a newly issued Base Certificate modified to reflect such Additional Transferor’s Interest. If the Transferor elects to have its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be uncertificated as provided in Section 6.01, the Transferor shall instruct the Trustee in writing to register the Additional Transferor as the owner of the appropriate interest in the Transferor’s Interest on the books and records of the Trust. Prior to any such designation of an Additional Transferor and, if applicable, exchange of certificates, the conditions set forth in Section 6.03(c) shall have been satisfied.

Section 2.09. Removal of Accounts. (a) On any day of any Monthly Period the Transferor shall have the right to require the reassignment to it or its designee of all the Trustee’s right, title and interest in, to and under the Receivables then existing and thereafter created in Accounts designated by the Transferor (the “Removed Accounts”),the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, all Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect to all of the foregoing and all proceeds thereof, upon satisfaction of the following conditions:

(i) on or before the fifth Business Day immediately preceding the Removal Date (the “Removal Notice Date”), the Transferor shall have given the Trustee, the Servicer, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement written notice of such removal and specifying the date for removal of the Removed Accounts (the “Removal Date”);

(ii) on the Removal Date, the Transferor shall have amended Schedule 1 by delivering to the Trustee an Account Schedule containing a true and complete list of the Removed Accounts specifying for each such Account, as of the Removal Notice Date, its account number, the aggregate amount outstanding in such Account, the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables outstanding in such Account and, for any Funds Collateral relating to such Account, the account number for, and the amount of funds on deposit in, the applicable Deposit Account;

(iii) the Transferor shall have represented and warranted as of the Removal Date that the list of Removed Accounts delivered pursuant to paragraph (ii) above, as of the Removal Notice Date, is true and complete in all material respects;

(iv) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such removal will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee;

 

-43-


(v) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor, dated the Removal Date, to the effect that the Transferor reasonably believes that such removal will not based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after the giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series; and

(vi) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables to be removed shall not equal or exceed 5% of the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in the Trust.

(b) Upon satisfaction of the above conditions, the Transferor and the Trustee shall execute and deliver a written reassignment in substantially the form of Exhibit C (the “Reassignment”), and the Trustee shall, without further action, sell, transfer, assign, set over and otherwise convey to the Transferor or its designee, on the Removal Date, without recourse, representation or warranty, all the right, title and interest of the Trustee in and to the Receivables existing at the close of business on the Removal Notice Date and thereafter created in the Removed Accounts, the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, all Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect to all of the foregoing and all proceeds thereof. In addition, the Trustee shall execute such other documents and instruments of transfer or assignment and take such other actions as shall reasonably be requested by the Transferor to effect the conveyance of Receivables pursuant to this Section 2.09.

In addition to the foregoing, on the date when any Receivable in an Account becomes a Defaulted Receivable (including any related Finance Charge Receivables), the Trustee shall automatically and without further action or consideration transfer, set over and otherwise convey to the Transferor, without recourse, representation or warranty, all right, title and interest of the Trustee in and to the Defaulted Receivables (including any related Finance Charge Receivables) in such Account, the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, all Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect to all of the foregoing and all proceeds thereof; provided that Recoveries of such Defaulted Receivables shall be applied as provided herein. The Trustee shall execute and deliver such instruments of transfer and assignment (including any UCC termination statements), in each case without recourse, as shall be reasonably requested by the Transferor to vest in the Transferor or its designee all right, title and interest that the Trustee had in such Defaulted Receivables (including any related Finance Charge Receivables).

In addition to the foregoing, the Transferor may designate Removed Accounts as provided in and subject to the terms and conditions contained in this Section 2.09 if the Removed Accounts are designated in response to a third-party action or decision not to act and not the unilateral action of the Transferor.

(c) In addition to the foregoing requirements, except for Removed Accounts described in the second and third paragraphs of Section 2.09(b), there shall be no more than one

 

-44-


Removal Date in any Monthly Period; for each Removal Date, the Accounts to be designated as Removed Accounts shall be selected at random by the Transferor and the Removed Accounts shall not, as of the Removal Notice Date, contain Principal Receivables which in the aggregate exceed an amount equal to the positive difference, if any, between the Transferor’s Interest and the Required Transferor’s Interest.

(d) The Transferor may purge Eligible to Purge Accounts from its books and records, including appropriate computer files, without any prior notice to any Person. On or before the tenth Business Day immediately following the date of any such purge (each an “Eligible to Purge Removal Date”), the Transferor shall (i) remove the related Eligible to Purge Accounts from Schedule 1 by delivering to the Trustee a computer file or microfiche list containing a true and complete list of all of those Eligible to Purge Accounts, specifying for each such Eligible to Purge Account its account number as of the related Eligible to Purge Removal Date and (ii) deliver to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor certifying that the computer file or microfiche list delivered pursuant to clause (i) above, as of the related Eligible to Purge Removal Date, is true and complete in all material respects. Each Eligible to Purge Account will not be an Account from and after the related Eligible to Purge Removal Date.

Section 2.10. Account Allocations. In the event that any Transferor is unable for any reason to transfer Receivables to the Trustee in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement, including by reason of the application of the provisions of Section 9.02 or any binding order of any Governmental Authority (a “Transfer Restriction Event”), then, in any such event, (a) the Transferor agrees (except as prohibited by any such order) to allocate and pay to the Trustee, after the date of such inability, all Collections, including Collections of Receivables transferred to the Trustee prior to the occurrence of such event, and all amounts which would have constituted Collections but for the Transferor’s inability to transfer Receivables (up to an aggregate amount equal to the amount of Receivables in the Trust on such date), (b) the Transferor agrees that such amounts will be applied as Collections in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement and (c) for so long as the allocation and application of all Collections and all amounts that would have constituted Collections are made in accordance with clauses (a) and (b) above, Principal Receivables and all amounts which would have constituted Principal Receivables but for the Transferor’s inability to transfer Receivables to the Trustee and Principal Receivables and all amounts which would have constituted Principal Receivables as aforesaid that are written off as uncollectible in accordance with this Agreement shall continue to be allocated in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement. For the purpose of the immediately preceding sentence, the Transferor shall treat the first received Collections with respect to the Accounts as allocable to the Trustee until the Trustee shall have been allocated and paid Collections in an amount equal to the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in such Accounts as of the date of the occurrence of such event. If the Transferor is unable pursuant to any Requirements of Law to allocate Collections as described above, the Transferor agrees that, after the occurrence of such event, payments on each Account with respect to the principal balance of such Account shall be allocated first to the oldest principal balance of such Account and shall have such payments applied as Collections in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement. The parties hereto agree that Finance Charge Receivables, whenever created, accrued in respect of Principal Receivables which have been conveyed to the Trustee

 

-45-


shall continue to be a part of the Trust notwithstanding any cessation of the transfer of additional Principal Receivables to the Trustee and Collections with respect thereto shall continue to be allocated and paid in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

Section 2.11. Discount Option.

(a) The Transferor shall have the option to designate at any time a percentage, which may be a fixed percentage or a variable percentage based on a formula (the “Discount Percentage”), of the amount of Receivables arising in the Accounts on or after the date such designation becomes effective that would otherwise constitute Principal Receivables to be treated as Finance Charge Receivables (“Discount Option Receivables”). The Transferor shall also have the option of reducing or withdrawing the Discount Percentage, at any time and from time to time, on and after the date such designation becomes effective. The Transferor shall provide to the Servicer, the Trustee, any Series Enhancer and each Rating Agency thirty (30) days prior written notice of such designation (or reduction or withdrawal), and such designation (or reduction or withdrawal) shall become effective on the date designated therein only if (i) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor stating that the Transferor reasonably believes that such designation (or reduction or withdrawal) will not, based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after the giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series, (ii) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such designation (or reduction or withdrawal) will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee and (iii) in the case of a reduction or withdrawal, the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor to the effect that, in the reasonable belief of the Transferor, such reduction or withdrawal shall not have adverse regulatory or other accounting implications for the Transferor.

(b) On each Date of Processing after the date on which the Transferor’s exercise of its discount option takes effect, the Transferor shall, to the extent required by Section 4.03, (i) deposit into the Collection Account in immediately available funds an amount equal to the product of (a) the aggregate Floating Allocation Percentages with respect to all Series and (b) the aggregate amount of the Discount Option Receivable Collections processed on such day and (ii) pay to the Holders of the Transferor Certificates, and if any owner of an interest in the Transferor’s Interest elects to have such interest be uncertificated as provided in Section 6.01 hereof, then to the recorded owner of such uncertificated interest in the Transferor’s Interest, the balance of such Discount Option Receivables Collections. The deposit made by the Transferor into the Collection Account under the preceding sentence shall be considered a payment of such Discount Option Receivables and shall be applied as Finance Charge Receivables in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

Section 2.12. Dispute Resolution.

(a) If any Receivable is subject to repurchase pursuant to subsection 2.05(a), or Section 2.06 of this Agreement, which repurchase is not resolved in accordance with the terms

 

-46-


of this Agreement within 180 days after notice is delivered to the Transferor as specified in either such subsection, the party providing such notice (the “Requesting Party”) will have the right to refer the matter, at its discretion, to either third-party mediation (including nonbinding arbitration) or binding arbitration pursuant to this Section 2.12 and the Transferor is hereby deemed to consent to the selected resolution method. At the end of the 180-day period described above, the Representing Party (as defined below) may provide notice informing the Requesting Party of the status of its request or, in the absence of any such notice, the Requesting Party may presume that its request remains unresolved. The Requesting Party must provide written notice of its intention to refer the matter to mediation or arbitration to the Transferor (in such capacity, the “Representing Party”) within 30 calendar days following such 180th day. The Transferor agrees to participate in the resolution method selected by the Requesting Party.

(b) If the Requesting Party selects mediation as the resolution method, the following provisions will apply:

(i) The mediation will be administered by the American Arbitration Association (the “AAA”) pursuant to its Commercial Arbitration Rules and Mediation Procedures in effect at the time the mediation is initiated (the “Rules”); provided, that if any of the Rules are inconsistent with the procedures for the mediation or arbitration stated in this Agreement or the Series 2002-CC Supplement, the procedures in such applicable document will control.

(ii) The mediator must be a Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional. Upon being supplied a list, by the AAA, of at least ten potential mediators that are each Qualified Dispute Resolution Professionals, each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will have the right to exercise two peremptory challenges within 14 days and to rank the remaining potential mediators in order of preference. The AAA will select the mediator from the remaining potential mediators on the list, respecting the preference choices of the parties to the extent possible.

(iii) Each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will use commercially reasonable efforts to begin the mediation within 10 Business Days of the selection of the mediator and to conclude the mediation within 30 days of the start of the mediation.

(iv) The fees and expenses of the mediation will be allocated as mutually agreed by the Requesting Party and the Representing Party as part of the mediation.

(v) A failure by the Requesting Party and the Representing Party to resolve a disputed matter through mediation shall not preclude either party from seeking a resolution of such matter through the initiation of a judicial proceeding in a court of competent jurisdiction, subject to subsection 2.12(d) below.

(c) If the Requesting Party selects arbitration as the resolution method, the following provisions will apply:

(i) The arbitration will be held in accordance with the United States Arbitration Act, notwithstanding any choice of law provision in this Agreement, and under the auspices of the AAA and in accordance with the Rules.

 

-47-


(ii) If the repurchase request specified in subsection 2.12(a) involves the repurchase of an aggregate amount of Receivables of less than 5% of the total Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the date of such repurchase request, a single arbitrator will be used. That arbitrator must be a Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional. Upon being supplied a list of at least ten potential arbitrators that are each Qualified Dispute Resolutions Professionals by the AAA, each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will have the right to exercise two peremptory challenges within 14 days and to rank the remaining potential arbitrators in order of preference. The AAA will select the arbitrator from the remaining potential arbitrators on the list respecting the preference choices of the parties to the extent possible.

(iii) If the repurchase request specified in subsection 2.12(a) involves the repurchase of an aggregate amount of Receivables equal to or in excess of 5% of the total Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the date of such repurchase request, a three-arbitrator panel will be used. The arbitral panel will consist of three Qualified Dispute Resolution Professionals, (A) one to be appointed by the Requesting Party within five Business Days of providing notice to the Representing Party of its selection of arbitration, (B) one to be appointed by the Representing Party within five Business Days of the Requesting Party’s appointment of an arbitrator, and (C) the third, who will preside over the arbitral panel, to be chosen by the two party-appointed arbitrators within five Business Days of the Representing Party’s appointment. If any party fails to appoint an arbitrator or the two party-appointed arbitrators fail to appoint the third within the relevant time periods, then the appointments will be made by the AAA pursuant to the Rules.

(iv) Each arbitrator selected for any arbitration will abide by the Code of Ethics for Arbitrators in Commercial Disputes in effect at the time the arbitration is initiated. Prior to accepting an appointment, each arbitrator must promptly disclose any circumstances likely to create a reasonable inference of bias or conflict of interest or likely to preclude completion of the hearings within the prescribed time schedule. Any arbitrator selected may be removed by the AAA for cause consisting of actual bias, conflict of interest or other serious potential for conflict.

(v) The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that after consulting with the parties, the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable, will devise procedures and deadlines for the arbitration, to the extent not already agreed to by the parties, with the goal of expediting the proceeding and completing the arbitration within 30 days after appointment of the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable. The arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will have the authority to schedule, hear, and determine any and all motions, including dispositive and discovery motions, in accordance with New York law then in effect (including prehearing and post hearing motions), and will do so on the motion of any party to the arbitration.

 

-48-


Notwithstanding any other discovery that may be available under the Rules, unless otherwise agreed by the parties, each party to the arbitration will be limited to the following discovery in the arbitration:

(A) Consistent with the expedited nature of arbitration, the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will, upon the written request of the other party, promptly provide the other with copies of documents relevant to the issues raised by any claim or counterclaim on which the producing party may rely in support of or in opposition to the claim or defense.

(B) At the request of a party, the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable, shall have the discretion to order examination by deposition of witnesses to the extent the arbitrator or arbitral panel deems such additional discovery relevant and appropriate. Depositions shall be limited to a maximum of three (3) per party and shall be held within thirty (30) calendar days of the making of a request. Additional depositions may be scheduled only with the permission of the arbitrator or arbitral panel, and for good cause shown. Each deposition shall be limited to a maximum of three (3) hours’ duration. All objections are reserved for the arbitration hearing except for objections based on privilege and proprietary or confidential information.

(C) Any dispute regarding discovery, or the relevance or scope thereof, shall be determined by the arbitrator or arbitral panel, which determination shall be conclusive.

(D) All discovery shall be completed within sixty (60) calendar days following the appointment of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable; provided, that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will have the ability to grant the parties, or either of them, additional discovery to the extent that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, determines good cause is shown that such additional discovery is reasonable and necessary.

(vi) The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will resolve the dispute in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, and may not modify or change this Agreement in any way. The arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will not have the power to award punitive damages or consequential damages in any arbitration conducted. The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that in its final determination, the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will determine and award the costs of the arbitration (including the fees of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, cost of any record or transcript of the arbitration, and administrative fees) and reasonable attorneys’ fees to the parties as determined by the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, in its reasonable discretion. The determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, must be consistent with the provisions of this Agreement, including Section 7.01 and Section 13.11, and will be in writing and counterpart copies will be promptly delivered to the parties. The

 

-49-


determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, may be reconsidered once by the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, upon the motion and at the expense of either party. Following that single reconsideration, the determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will be final and non-appealable and may be entered in and may be enforced in, any court of competent jurisdiction.

(vii) By selecting binding arbitration, the Requesting Party is giving up the right to sue in court, including the right to a trial by jury.

(viii) No Person may bring a putative or certified class action to arbitration.

(d) The following provisions will apply to both mediations and arbitrations:

(i) Any mediation or arbitration will be held in New York, New York.

(ii) Notwithstanding this dispute resolution provision, the parties will have the right to seek provisional or ancillary relief from a competent court of law, including a temporary restraining order, preliminary injunction or attachment order, provided such relief would otherwise be available by law.

(iii) The details and/or existence of any unfulfilled repurchase request specified in subsection 2.12(a) above, any informal meetings, mediations or arbitration proceedings, including all offers, promises, conduct and statements, whether oral or written, made in the course of the parties’ attempt to informally resolve an unfulfilled repurchase request, and any discovery taken in connection with any arbitration, will be confidential, privileged and inadmissible for any purpose, including impeachment, in any mediation, arbitration or litigation, or other proceeding; provided, however, that any discovery taken in any arbitration will be admissible in that particular arbitration. Such information will be kept strictly confidential and will not be disclosed or discussed with any third party (excluding a party’s attorneys, experts, accountants and other agents and representatives, as reasonably required in connection with the related resolution procedure), except as otherwise required by law, regulatory requirement or court order. If any party to a resolution procedure receives a subpoena or other request for information from a third party (other than a governmental regulatory body) for such confidential information, the recipient will promptly notify the other party to the resolution procedure and will provide the other party with the opportunity to object to the production of its confidential information. Notwithstanding anything in this Section 2.12 to the contrary, any discovery taken in connection with any arbitration pursuant to subsection 2.12(c) above will be admissible in such arbitration.

ARTICLE III

Administration and Servicing of Receivables

Section 3.01. Acceptance of Appointment and Other Matters Relating to the Servicer.

(a) Capital One agrees to act as the Servicer under this Agreement and the Certificateholders by their acceptance of Certificates consent to Capital One acting as Servicer.

 

-50-


(b) The Servicer shall service and administer the Receivables, shall collect payments due under the Receivables and shall charge off as uncollectible Receivables, all in accordance with its customary and usual servicing procedures for servicing revolving credit card and other revolving credit receivables comparable to the Receivables and in accordance with the Lending Guidelines. The Servicer shall have full power and authority, acting alone or through any Person properly designated by it hereunder, to do any and all things in connection with such servicing and administration which it may deem necessary or desirable. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, subject to Section 10.01, the Servicer is hereby authorized and empowered (i) to make withdrawals and payments or to instruct the Trustee to make withdrawals and payments from the Collection Account and any Series Account, as set forth in this Agreement or any Supplement, (ii) to take any action required or permitted under any Series Enhancement, as set forth in this Agreement or any Supplement, and (iii) to execute and deliver, on behalf of the Trust or the Trustee, any and all instruments of satisfaction or cancellation, or of partial or full release or discharge, and all other comparable instruments, with respect to the Receivables and, after the delinquency of any Receivable and to the extent permitted under and in compliance with applicable Requirements of Law, to commence collection proceedings with respect to such Receivable. In any action or proceeding that is described in clause (iii) of the immediately preceding sentence, (I) the Servicer, whether acting in its own name or on behalf of another and whether acting alone or through another, adequately represents each of the Transferor’s, the Trust’s, and the Trustee’s interests, (II) each of the Transferor, the Trust, and the Trustee will be bound by that action or by any judgment or other ruling in that proceeding, and (III) complete and final relief can be accorded among the parties to that action or proceeding without joining the Transferor, the Trust, or the Trustee. Nothing in the immediately preceding sentence applies to interests of or claims against the Trustee in its individual capacity or will relieve the Servicer of its obligation to service and administer the Receivables in accordance with the Servicer’s customary and usual servicing procedures for servicing revolving credit receivables comparable to the Receivables, the Lending Guidelines, and the applicable terms of this Agreement.

(c) The Servicer shall not be obligated to use separate servicing procedures, offices, employees or accounts for servicing the Receivables from the procedures, offices, employees and accounts used by the Servicer in connection with servicing other credit card and revolving credit receivables.

(d) The Servicer shall comply with and perform its servicing obligations with respect to the Accounts and Receivables in accordance with the Lending Agreements relating to the Accounts and the Lending Guidelines and all applicable rules and regulations of VISA, MasterCard and any other similar entity or organization relating to any other type of revolving credit card accounts included as Accounts, except insofar as any failure to so comply or perform would not materially and adversely affect the Trust or the Investor Certificateholders.

(e) The Servicer shall pay out of its own funds, without reimbursement, all expenses incurred in connection with the servicing activities hereunder including expenses

 

-51-


related to enforcement of the Receivables, fees and disbursements of the Trustee, any Paying Agent and any Transfer Agent and Registrar (including the reasonable fees and expenses of its counsel) in accordance with Section 11.05 and fees and disbursements of independent accountants for the Servicer.

(f) The Transferor will use its best efforts to obtain and maintain the listing of the Investor Certificates of any Series or Class on any specified securities exchange. The Transferor shall give notice to the Trustee on the date on which such Investor Certificates are approved for such listing and within three (3) Business Days following receipt of notice by the Transferor of any actual, proposed or contemplated delisting of such Investor Certificates by any such securities exchange. The Trustee or the Transferor, each in its sole discretion, may terminate any listing on any such securities exchange at any time subject to the notice requirements set forth in the preceding sentence.

Section 3.02. Servicing Compensation. As full compensation for its servicing activities hereunder and as reimbursement for any expense incurred by it in connection therewith, the Servicer shall be entitled to receive a servicing fee (the “Servicing Fee”) with respect to each Monthly Period, payable monthly on the related Distribution Date, in an amount equal to one-twelfth of the product of (a) the weighted average of the Servicing Fee Rates with respect to each outstanding Series (based upon the Servicing Fee Rate for each Series and the outstanding principal amount of each Series) and (b) the amount of Principal Receivables on the last day of the prior Monthly Period. The share of the Servicing Fee allocable to (i) the Certificateholders’ Interest of a particular Series with respect to any Monthly Period (the “Monthly Servicing Fee”) and (ii) the Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, of a particular Series with respect to any Monthly Period will each be determined in accordance with the relevant Supplement. The portion of the Servicing Fee with respect to any Monthly Period not so allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest or the Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, of a particular Series shall be paid by the Transferor on the related Distribution Date and in no event shall the Trust, the Trustee, the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or any Series Enhancer be liable for the share of the Servicing Fee with respect to any Monthly Period allocable to the Transferor.

Section 3.03. Representations, Warranties and Covenants of the Servicer. Capital One, as Servicer, hereby makes, and any Successor Servicer by its appointment hereunder shall make, on each Closing Date on which it is the Servicer (and on the date of any such appointment), the following representations, warranties and covenants:

(a) Organization and Good Standing. The Servicer is a national banking association, a state banking association or corporation, or other corporation validly existing under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation and has, in all material respects, full power and authority to execute, deliver and perform its obligations under this Agreement and each Supplement and to own its properties and conduct its servicing business as such properties are presently owned and as such business is presently conducted.

(b) Due Qualification. The Servicer is duly qualified to do business and is in good standing as a foreign corporation or other foreign entity (or is exempt from such

 

-52-


requirements), and has obtained all necessary licenses and approvals, in each jurisdiction in which the servicing of the Receivables as required by the Agreement requires such qualification except where failure to so qualify or to obtain such licenses and approvals would not have a material adverse effect on its ability to perform its obligations hereunder or under any Supplement.

(c) Due Authorization. The execution, delivery, and performance by the Servicer of this Agreement, each Supplement and the other agreements and instruments executed or to be executed by the Servicer as contemplated hereby, have been duly authorized by the Servicer by all necessary corporate action on the part of the Servicer and this Agreement and each Supplement will remain, from the time of its execution, an official record of the Servicer.

(d) Binding Obligation. This Agreement and each Supplement constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Servicer, enforceable against the Servicer in accordance with its terms, except as enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and general principles of equity.

(e) No Conflict and No Violation. The execution and delivery of this Agreement and each Supplement by the Servicer, and the performance by the Servicer of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and each Supplement and the fulfillment by the Servicer of the terms hereof and thereof applicable to the Servicer, will not conflict with or violate or result in any breach of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time or both) a default under, any indenture, contract, agreement, mortgage, deed of trust or other instrument to which the Servicer is a party or by which it or any of its properties are bound. The execution and delivery of this Agreement by the Servicer, the performance by the Servicer of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and the fulfillment by the Servicer of the terms hereof applicable to the Servicer will not conflict with or violate any Requirements of Law applicable to the Servicer.

(f) No Proceedings. There are no proceedings or investigations pending or, to the best knowledge of the Servicer, threatened against the Servicer before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency or other Governmental Authority seeking to prevent the issuance of the Certificates or the consummation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement or any Supplement, or seeking any determination or ruling that would materially and adversely affect the performance by the Servicer of its obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement.

(g) Compliance with Requirements of Law. The Servicer shall duly satisfy all obligations on its part to be fulfilled under or in connection with the Receivables and the related Accounts, will maintain in effect all qualifications required under Requirements of Law in order to properly service the Receivables and the related Accounts and will comply in all material respects with all other Requirements of Law in connection with servicing the Receivables and the related Accounts, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on the interests of the Certificateholders.

 

-53-


(h) No Rescission or Cancellation. The Servicer shall not authorize any rescission or cancellation of a Receivable except as ordered by a court of competent jurisdiction or other Governmental Authority or in accordance with the Lending Guidelines.

(i) Protection of Rights. The Servicer shall take no action which, nor omit to take any action the omission of which, would substantially impair the rights of the Trustee in any Receivable, nor shall it, except in the ordinary course of its business and in accordance with the Lending Guidelines, reschedule, revise or defer Collections due on the Receivables.

(j) Receivables Not To Be Evidenced by Instruments or Chattel Paper. The Servicer will take no action to cause any Receivable to be evidenced by any instrument or chattel paper (as defined in the UCC) and, if any Receivable is so evidenced as a result of the Servicer’s action, it shall be deemed to be an Ineligible Receivable and shall be assigned to the Servicer as provided in this Section 3.03; provided, however, that Receivables evidenced by instruments or chattel paper taken from Obligors in the ordinary course of the Servicer’s collection efforts shall not be deemed Ineligible Receivables solely as a result thereof.

(k) All Consents. All approvals, authorizations, consents, orders or other actions of any Person or of any Governmental Authority required to be obtained by the Servicer in connection with the execution and delivery by the Servicer of this Agreement and each Supplement, the performance by the Servicer of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and each Supplement and the fulfillment by the Servicer of the terms hereof and thereof, have been obtained.

For purposes of the representations and warranties set forth in this Section 3.03, each reference to a Supplement shall be deemed to refer only to those Supplements in effect as of the relevant Closing Date or the date of appointment of a Successor Servicer, as applicable.

In the event any of the representations, warranties or covenants of the Servicer contained in paragraph (g), (h), (i) or (j) with respect to any Receivable or the related Account is breached, and such breach has a material adverse effect on the Trustee’s interest in the Receivables (which determination shall be made without regard to the availability of funds under any Series Enhancement) and remains uncured for sixty (60) days (or such longer period, not in excess of 150 days, as may be agreed to by the Trustee) from the earlier to occur of the discovery of such event by the Servicer, or receipt by the Servicer of written notice of such event given by the Transferor or the Trustee, all Receivables in the Account or Accounts to which such event relates shall be assigned to the Servicer on the terms and conditions set forth below; provided, however, that such Receivables will not be assigned to the Servicer if, on any day prior to the end of such 60-day or longer period, (i) the relevant representation and warranty shall be true and correct, or the relevant covenant shall have been complied with, in all material respects and (ii) the Servicer shall have delivered to the Transferor and the Trustee a certificate of an authorized officer of the Servicer describing the nature of such breach and the manner in which such breach was cured.

The Servicer shall effect such assignment by making a deposit into the Collection Account in immediately available funds on the Transfer Date following the Monthly Period in

 

-54-


which such assignment obligation arises in an amount equal to the amount of such Receivables, which deposit shall be considered a Transfer Deposit Amount and shall be applied in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

Upon each such assignment to the Servicer, the Trustee shall automatically and without further action sell, transfer, assign, set over and otherwise convey to the Servicer, without recourse, representation or warranty, all right, title and interest of the Trustee in and to such Receivables, the Funds Collateral securing such Receivables, all Recoveries and Insurance Proceeds allocable to all of the foregoing, all Collections with respect to all of the foregoing, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received with respect to all of the foregoing and all proceeds thereof. The Trustee shall execute such documents and instruments of transfer or assignment and take such other actions as shall be reasonably requested by the Servicer to effect the transfer of any such Receivables pursuant to this Section 3.03. The obligation of the Servicer to accept assignment and transfer of any such Receivables, and to make the deposits, if any, required to be made to the Collection Account as provided in the preceding paragraph, shall constitute the sole remedy respecting the event giving rise to such obligation available to Investor Certificateholders (or the Trustee) or any Series Enhancer, except as provided in Section 8.04.

Section 3.04. Reports and Records for the Trustee.

(a) Daily Records. On each Business Day, the Servicer shall make or cause to be made available at the office of the Servicer during normal business hours for inspection by the Transferor and the Trustee upon request a record setting forth (i) the Collections in respect of Principal Receivables and in respect of Finance Charge Receivables processed by the Servicer on the second preceding Business Day in respect of the Accounts and (ii) the amount of Receivables as of the close of business on the second preceding Business Day in each Account. The Servicer shall, at all times, maintain its computer files with respect to the Accounts in such a manner so that the Accounts may be specifically identified and shall make available to the Transferor and the Trustee at the office of the Servicer on any Business Day during normal business hours any computer programs necessary to make such identification.

(b) Monthly Servicer’s Certificate. Not later than the third Business Day preceding each Distribution Date, the Servicer shall, with respect to each outstanding Series, deliver to the Trustee, the Transferor, the Paying Agent, each Rating Agency and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement a certificate of a Servicing Officer in substantially the form set forth in the related Supplement.

(c) Related Accounts. The Servicer covenants and agrees hereby to deliver to the Trustee, within a reasonable time period after it receives notice that a Related Account has been created, but in any event not later than 15 days after the end of the month within which it receives notice that such Related Account has been created, a notice specifying the new account number for such Related Account.

(d) Annual Membership Fees. On or prior to each Determination Date, the Servicer shall deliver to the Trustee and the Transferor a certificate of a Servicing Officer setting

 

-55-


forth (or shall set forth in the Monthly Servicer’s Certificate) (a) the amount of annual membership fees to be included as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period, which shall be equal to the amount of annual membership fees transferred to the Trustee during the preceding 12 Monthly Periods (or during the equivalent monthly periods occurring prior to the first Monthly Period) divided by 12 and (b) the portion of such annual membership fees (“unamortized annual membership fees”) which have not been treated as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period.

(e) Addition Discount Receivables. On or prior to each Determination Date, the Servicer shall deliver to the Trustee and the Transferor a certificate of a Servicing Officer setting forth (or shall set forth in the Monthly Servicer’s Certificate) (a) the amount of Addition Discount Receivables to be included as Collection of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period, as calculated in accordance with the formula set forth in the applicable Assignment or accretion designation letter delivered by the Transferor to the Trustee and the Servicer and (b) the portion of such Addition Discount Receivables which have not been treated as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period.

(f) Certain Recoveries. On or prior to each Determination Date, the Servicer shall deliver to the Trustee and the Transferor a certificate of a Servicing Officer setting forth (or shall set forth in the Monthly Servicer’s Certificate) (a) the amount of Recoveries equal to the net proceeds of any sale or initial securitization (excluding any residual payments from such securitization) of Defaulted Receivables (including the related Finance Charge Receivables) to be included as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period, which shall be equal to the amount of any such Recoveries received during the preceding three (3) Monthly Periods divided by three (3) and (b) the portion of any such Recoveries (“unamortized Recoveries”) which have not been treated as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the preceding Monthly Period.

Section 3.05. Annual Certificate of Servicer. The Servicer shall deliver to the Trustee, the Transferor, each Rating Agency and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement, on or before the 90th day following the end of each fiscal year, beginning with the fiscal year ending December 31, 2006, the statement of compliance required under Item 1123 of Regulation AB with respect to such fiscal year, which statement will be in the form of an Officer’s Certificate of the Servicer (with appropriate insertions) to the effect that (a) a review of the activities of the Servicer during such fiscal year and of its performance under this Agreement was made under the supervision of the officer signing such certificate and (b) to the best of such officer’s knowledge, based on such review, the Servicer has fulfilled all its obligations under this Agreement throughout such fiscal year or, if there has been a failure to fulfill any such obligation in any material respect, specifying each such failure known to such officer and the nature and status thereof.

Section 3.06. [Reserved].

 

-56-


Section 3.07. Tax Treatment. The Transferor has entered into this Agreement, and the Certificates will be issued, with the intention that, for Federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes only, the Investor Certificates of each Series which are characterized as indebtedness at the time of their issuance will qualify as indebtedness of the Transferor secured by the Receivables. The Transferor, by entering into this Agreement, and each Certificateholder, by the acceptance of any such Certificate (and each Certificate Owner, by its acceptance of an interest in the applicable Certificate), agree to treat such Investor Certificates for Federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness of the Transferor.

Section 3.08. Notices to Capital One. In the event that Capital One is no longer acting as Servicer, any Successor Servicer shall deliver to Capital One each certificate and report required to be provided thereafter pursuant to Section 3.04(b), 3.05 or 3.06.

Section 3.09. Adjustments.

(a) If the Servicer adjusts downward the amount of any Principal Receivable (other than any Ineligible Receivable to be reassigned or assigned to the Transferor or the Servicer pursuant to this Agreement) because of a rebate, refund, unauthorized charge or billing error to an accountholder, or because such Principal Receivable was created in respect of merchandise which was refused or returned by an accountholder, or if the Servicer otherwise adjusts downward the amount of any Principal Receivable without receiving Collections therefor or charging off such amount as uncollectible, then, in any such case (other than cases resulting from Servicer error), the amount of Principal Receivables used to calculate the Transferor’s Participation Amount, the Transferor’s Interest and the Floating Allocation Percentage and the Principal Allocation Percentage applicable to any Series will be reduced by the amount of the adjustment. Similarly, the amount of Principal Receivables used to calculate the Transferor’s Participation Amount, the Transferor’s Interest and the Floating Allocation Percentage and the Principal Allocation Percentage applicable to any Series will be reduced by the amount of any Principal Receivable which was discovered as having been created through a fraudulent or counterfeit charge. Any adjustment required pursuant to either of the two (2) preceding sentences shall be made on or prior to the end of the Monthly Period in which such adjustment obligation arises. In the event that, following the exclusion of such Principal Receivables from the calculation of the Transferor’s Participation Amount, the Transferor’s Participation Amount would be a negative number, not later than the close of business on the fifth (5th) succeeding Business Day following such adjustment, the Transferor shall make a deposit into the Collection Account in immediately available funds in an amount equal to the amount by which the Transferor’s Participation Amount would be below zero (up to the amount of such Principal Receivables). Any amount deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to the preceding sentence shall be considered an “Adjustment Payment” and shall be applied in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

(b) If (i) the Servicer makes a deposit into the Collection Account in respect of a Collection of a Receivable and such Collection was received by the Servicer in the form of a check which is not honored for any reason or (ii) the Servicer makes a mistake with respect to the amount of any Collection and deposits an amount that is less than or more than the actual amount of such Collection, the Servicer shall appropriately adjust the amount subsequently

 

-57-


deposited into the Collection Account to reflect such dishonored check or mistake. Any Receivable in respect of which a dishonored check is received shall be deemed not to have been paid.

Section 3.10. Reports to the Commission.

(a) The Servicer shall, on behalf of the Trust and at the expense of the Transferor, cause to be filed with the Commission any periodic reports required to be filed under the provisions of the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder. The Transferor shall, at the expense of the Servicer, cooperate in any reasonable request of the Transferor in connection with such filings.

(b) With respect to any Monthly Period in which the Servicer or the Transferor receives a request from any Certificate Owner to communicate with another Certificate Owner, the Servicer or the Transferor, as applicable, shall include the following information in the related distribution report on Form 10-D:

(i) the name of the Certificate Owner making such request;

(ii) the date the Servicer or the Transferor, as applicable, received such request;

(iii) a statement to the effect that the Servicer or the Transferor, as applicable, has received a request from such Certificate Owner stating that it is interested in communicating with other such Certificate Owners with regard to the possible exercise of rights under this Agreement and the other transaction documents; and

(iv) a description of the method other such Certificate Owners may use to contact the requesting Certificate Owner;

provided, however, that prior to disclosing the information listed above on Form 10-D, the Servicer or the Transferor, as applicable, shall be entitled to verify the identity of such requesting Certificate Owner by requiring it to provide written certification that it is such a Certificate Owner and one other form of documentation, such as a trade confirmation, an account statement, a letter from such Certificate Owner’s broker or dealer, or another similar document.

ARTICLE IV

Rights of Certificateholders and Allocation and

Application or Collections

Section 4.01. Rights of Certificateholders. The Investor Certificates shall represent fractional undivided interests in the Trust, which, with respect to each Series, shall consist of the right to receive, to the extent necessary to make the required payments with respect to such Series at the times and in the amounts specified in the related Supplement, the portion of Collections allocable to such Series pursuant to this Agreement and such Supplement, funds on

 

-58-


deposit in the Collection Account or the Excess Funding Account allocable to such Series pursuant to this Agreement and such Supplement, funds on deposit in any related Series Account and funds available pursuant to any related Series Enhancement (collectively, with respect to all Series, the “Certificateholders’ Interest”), it being understood that the Investor Certificates of any Series or Class shall not represent any interest in any Series Account or Series Enhancement for the benefit of any other Series or Class. The Transferor Certificates shall represent the ownership interest in the remainder of the Trust Assets not allocated pursuant to this Agreement or any Supplement to the Certificateholders’ Interest, including the right to receive Collections with respect to the Receivables and other amounts at the times and in the amounts specified in this Agreement or any Supplement to be paid to the Transferor on behalf of all of the holders of the Transferor Certificates (the “Transferor’s Interest”); provided, however, that if any Transferor or any Additional Transferor elects to have all or a portion of its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be uncertificated as provided in Section 6.01 hereof, then such uncertificated interest, together with any Transferor Certificates, shall represent the “Transferor’s Interest”; provided further that the Transferor Certificates, or any uncertificated interest in the Transferor’s Interest, shall not represent any interest in the Collection Account, the Excess Funding Account, any Series Account or any Series Enhancement, except as specifically provided in this Agreement or any Supplement; provided further that the foregoing shall not be construed to limit the Trustee’s obligation to make payments to the Transferor and the Servicer as and when required under this Agreement and any Supplement.

Section 4.02. Establishment of Collection Account and Excess Funding Account. The Servicer, for the benefit of the Certificateholders, shall establish and maintain in the name of the Trustee an Eligible Deposit Account bearing a designation clearly indicating that the funds deposited therein are held for the benefit of the Certificateholders (the “Collection Account”). The Collection Account currently is maintained with The Bank of New York Mellon. The Trustee shall possess all right, title and interest in all funds and property from time to time on deposit in or credited to the Collection Account and in all proceeds thereof. The Collection Account shall be under the sole dominion and control of the Trustee. Except as expressly provided in this Agreement, the Servicer agrees that it shall have no right of setoff or banker’s lien against, and no right to otherwise deduct from, any funds or property held in the Collection Account for any amount owed to it by the Trustee, the Trust, any Certificateholder or any Series Enhancer. If, at any time, the Collection Account ceases to be an Eligible Deposit Account, the Trustee (or the Servicer on its behalf) shall within ten (10) Business Days (or such longer period, not to exceed thirty (30) calendar days, as to which each Rating Agency may consent) establish a new Collection Account meeting the conditions specified above, transfer any funds or property to such new Collection Account and from the date such new Collection Account is established, it shall be the “Collection Account.”

Funds on deposit in the Collection Account (other than amounts deposited pursuant to Section 2.06, 9.02, 10.01 or 12.02) shall at the direction of the Servicer be invested by the Trustee in Eligible Investments selected by the Servicer. All such Eligible Investments shall be held by the Trustee. The Trustee shall (i) hold each Eligible Investment that constitutes investment property through a securities intermediary, which securities intermediary shall agree with the Trustee that (A) such investment property shall at all times be credited to a securities account of the Trustee, (B) such securities intermediary shall treat the Trustee as entitled to

 

-59-


exercise the rights that comprise each financial asset credited to such securities account, (C) all property credited to such securities account shall be treated as a financial asset, (D) such securities intermediary shall comply with entitlement orders originated by the Trustee without the further consent of any other person or entity, (E) such securities intermediary shall not agree with any person or entity other than the Trustee to comply with entitlement orders originated by any person or entity other than the Trustee, (F) such securities account and the property credited thereto shall not be subject to any lien or encumbrance on, security interest in, or right of set-off in favor of such securities intermediary or anyone claiming through it (other than the Trustee), (G) such agreement shall be governed by the laws of the State of New York, and (H) the State of New York shall be the securities intermediary’s jurisdiction for purposes of the UCC; and (ii) maintain possession of each other Eligible Investment not described in clause (i) above in the State of New York, separate and apart from all other property held by the Trustee. Terms used in clause (i) above that are defined in the New York UCC and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meaning set forth in the New York UCC. Investments of funds representing Collections collected during any Monthly Period shall be invested in Eligible Investments that will mature so that all funds will be available at the close of business on the Transfer Date following such Monthly Period. No Eligible Investment shall be disposed of prior to its maturity. Unless directed by the Servicer, funds deposited in the Collection Account on a Transfer Date with respect to the next following Distribution Date are not required to be invested overnight. On each Distribution Date, all interest and other investment earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) on funds on deposit in the Collection Account shall be paid to or at the direction of the Transferor, except as otherwise specified in any Supplement. For purposes of determining the availability of funds or the balances in the Collection Account for any reason under this Agreement, all investment earnings net of investment expenses and losses on such funds shall be deemed not to be available or on deposit.

The Servicer, for the benefit of the Certificateholders, shall establish and maintain in the name of the Trustee an Eligible Deposit Account bearing a designation clearly indicating that the funds deposited therein are held for the benefit of the Certificateholders (the “Excess Funding Account”). The Excess Funding Account currently is maintained with The Bank of New York Mellon. The Trustee shall possess all right, title and interest in all funds and property from time to time on deposit in or credited to the Excess Funding Account and in all proceeds thereof. The Excess Funding Account shall be under the sole dominion and control of the Trustee. Except as expressly provided in this Agreement, the Servicer agrees that it shall have no right of setoff or banker’s lien against, and no right to otherwise deduct from, any funds held in the Excess Funding Account for any amount owed to it by the Trustee, the Trust, any Certificateholder or any Series Enhancer. If, at any time, the Excess Funding Account ceases to be an Eligible Deposit Account, the Trustee (or the Servicer on its behalf) shall within ten (10) Business Days (or such longer period, not to exceed thirty (30) calendar days, as to which each Rating Agency may consent) establish a new Excess Funding Account meeting the conditions specified above, transfer any funds and property to such new Excess Funding Account and from the date such new Excess Funding Account is established, it shall be the “Excess Funding Account.”

Funds on deposit in the Excess Funding Account shall at the direction of the Servicer be invested by the Trustee in Eligible Investments selected by the Servicer. All such

 

-60-


Eligible Investments shall be held by the Trustee. The Trustee shall (i) hold each Eligible Investment that constitutes investment property through a securities intermediary, which securities intermediary shall agree with the Trustee that (A) such investment property shall at all times be credited to a securities account of the Trustee, (B) such securities intermediary shall treat the Trustee as entitled to exercise the rights that comprise each financial asset credited to such securities account, (C) all property credited to such securities account shall be treated as a financial asset, (D) such securities intermediary shall comply with entitlement orders originated by the Trustee without the further consent of any other person or entity, (E) such securities intermediary shall not agree with any person or entity other than the Trustee to comply with entitlement orders originated by any person or entity other than the Trustee, (F) such securities account and the property credited thereto shall not be subject to any lien or encumbrance on, security interest in, or right of set-off in favor of such securities intermediary or anyone claiming through it (other than the Trustee), (G) such agreement shall be governed by the laws of the State of New York, and (H) the State of New York shall be the securities intermediary’s jurisdiction for purposes of the UCC; and (ii) maintain possession of each other Eligible Investment not described in clause (i) above in the State of New York, separate and apart from all other property held by the Trustee. Terms used in clause (i) above that are defined in the New York UCC and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meaning set forth in the New York UCC. Funds on deposit in the Excess Funding Account on any Distribution Date will be invested in Eligible Investments that will mature so that all funds will be available at the close of business on the Transfer Date following such Monthly Period. No Eligible Investment shall be disposed of prior to its maturity. Unless directed by the Servicer, funds deposited in the Excess Funding Account on a Transfer Date with respect to the next following Distribution Date are not required to be invested overnight. On each Distribution Date, all interest and other investment earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) on funds on deposit in the Excess Funding Account shall be treated as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables with respect to the last day of the related Monthly Period. Funds on deposit in the Excess Funding Account will be withdrawn and paid to the Transferor on any Business Day to the extent that the Transferor’s Participation Amount exceeds the Required Transferor’s Interest and the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables exceeds the Required Principal Balance on such date; provided, however, that, if an Accumulation Period, Controlled Amortization Period or Early Amortization Period has commenced and is continuing with respect to one or more outstanding Series, any funds on deposit in the Excess Funding Account shall be treated as Shared Principal Collections and shall be allocated and distributed in accordance with Section 4.04 and the terms of the Supplements for the Principal Sharing Series. For purposes of determining the availability of funds or the balances in the Excess Funding Account for any reason under this Agreement, all investment earnings net of investment expenses and losses on such funds shall be deemed not to be available or on deposit.

Section 4.03. Collections and Allocations.

(a) The Servicer will apply or will instruct the Trustee to apply all funds on deposit in the Collection Account as described in this Article IV and in each Supplement. Except as otherwise provided below, the Servicer shall deposit Collections into the Collection Account no later than the second Business Day following the Date of Processing of such Collections or, in the case of any Collections consisting of Interchange, not later than

 

-61-


12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on each Distribution Date. Subject to the express terms of any Supplement, but notwithstanding anything else in this Agreement to the contrary, for so long as Capital One remains the Servicer and (x) maintains a certificate of deposit rating of A-1 or better by Standard & Poor’s and P-1 by Moody’s, or (y) Capital One has provided to the Transferor and the Trustee a letter of credit covering collection risk of the Servicer acceptable to the Rating Agency (as evidenced by a letter from the Rating Agency), the Servicer need not make the daily deposits of Collections into the Collection Account as provided in the preceding sentence, but may make a single deposit in the Collection Account in immediately available funds not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on the Transfer Date immediately preceding the Distribution Date or, in the case of any Collections consisting of Interchange, not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on each Distribution Date. Subject to the first proviso in Section 4.04, but notwithstanding anything else in this Agreement to the contrary, with respect to any Monthly Period, whether the Servicer is required to make deposits of Collections pursuant to the first or the second preceding sentence, (i) the Servicer will only be required to deposit Collections into the Collection Account up to (x) the aggregate amount of Collections required to be deposited into any Series Account or, without duplication, distributed on or prior to the related Distribution Date to Investor Certificateholders or to any Series Enhancer pursuant to the terms of any Supplement or Enhancement Agreement plus (y) the aggregate amount of the portion of Collections representing annual membership fees (including any annual membership fees relating to the period prior to the Trust Cut-Off Date) which will not have been amortized in accordance with Section 3.04(d) with respect to the end of such Monthly Period plus (z) the aggregate amount of the portion of Collections representing Recoveries which will not have been amortized in accordance with Section 3.04(f) with respect to the end of such Monthly Period and (ii) if at any time prior to such Distribution Date the amount of Collections deposited in the Collection Account exceeds the amount required to be deposited pursuant to clause (i) above, the Servicer shall withdraw the excess from the Collection Account and pay it to the Holder of the Transferor’s Interest.

(b) (i) Collections of Finance Charge Receivables will be allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of a Series in an amount equal to the product of the amount of such Collections and the Floating Allocation Percentage of such Series, (ii) the Defaulted Amount will be allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of a Series in an amount equal to the product of such Defaulted Amount and the Floating Allocation Percentage of such Series, (iii) Collections of Principal Receivables will be allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of such Series in an amount equal to the product of the amount of such Collections and the Principal Allocation Percentage of such Series and (iv) Miscellaneous Payments will be allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of such Series in an amount equal to the product of the amount of such Miscellaneous Payments and a fraction the numerator of which is the Invested Amount and Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, of such Series and the denominator of which is the sum of the Invested Amounts and the Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, for all outstanding Series, in each case for such Monthly Period. Collections of Receivables with respect to any Monthly Period will be allocated by the Servicer first to annual membership fees transferred to the Trustee during the preceding Monthly Period, second to Finance Charge Receivables, to the extent of Finance Charge Receivables billed during the preceding Monthly Period, and third to Principal Receivables. Subject to Sections 4.03(c) and 4.04, amounts not allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of any Series will be allocated to the Transferor’s Interest.

 

-62-


(c) On the earlier of (A) the second Business Day after the Date of Processing and (B) the day on which the Servicer actually deposits any Collections into the Collection Account or, in the case of any Collections consisting of Interchange, not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on each Distribution Date, the Servicer will pay to the Transferor (i) the Transferor’s allocable portion of Collections of Finance Charge Receivables and (ii) the Transferor’s allocable portion of Collections of Principal Receivables; provided, however, that in the case of Collections of Principal Receivables allocated to the Transferor’s Interest, such amount shall only be paid to the Transferor if the Transferor’s Participation Amount exceeds the Required Transferor’s Interest and the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables exceeds the Required Principal Balance, but otherwise such amounts shall be deposited into the Excess Funding Account. Collections consisting of annual membership fees or Recoveries resulting from the sale or securitization of Defaulted Receivables (including the related Finance Charge Receivables) which have not yet been amortized in accordance with Section 3.04(d) or (e), as the case may be, and which are therefore not treated as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables or Principal Receivables, shall not be paid to the Transferor or allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest.

The payments to be made to the Transferor pursuant to this Section 4.03(c) do not apply to deposits to the Collection Account or other amounts that do not represent Collections, including Miscellaneous Payments, payment of the acquisition price for Receivables pursuant to Section 2.06 or 10.01, proceeds from the sale, disposition or liquidation of Receivables pursuant to Section 9.02 or 12.02 or payment of the purchase price for the Certificateholders’ Interest of a specific Series pursuant to the related Supplement.

(d) The Principal Receivables in Additional Accounts added during any Monthly Period having an Additional Cut-Off Date as of any day during the preceding Monthly Period shall be treated as Principal Receivables outstanding on and after such Additional Cut-Off Date for purposes of calculating the Floating Allocation Percentage and Principal Allocation Percentage for the Monthly Period in which such Additional Accounts are added. Any such recalculation of the Floating Allocation Percentage and Principal Allocation Percentage for a Monthly Period shall be effective only on and after the Addition Date, but the Servicer shall determine the amounts of Collections and the Defaulted Amounts which would have been allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of each Series for the portion of such Monthly Period preceding such Addition Date as if such recalculated Floating Allocation Percentage and Principal Allocation Percentage had been in effect and shall adjust the amounts to be allocated for the remainder of such Monthly Period so that the amounts allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest of each Series and the Transferor’s Interest are equal to the amounts which would have been allocated to them if such recalculated percentages had been in effect for the entire Monthly Period.

Section 4.04. Shared Principal Collections. On each Distribution Date, (a) the Servicer shall allocate Shared Principal Collections to each Principal Sharing Series, pro rata, in proportion to the Principal Shortfalls, if any, with respect to each such Series and (b) the Servicer shall withdraw from the Collection Account or the Excess Funding Account and pay to the Transferor an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (x) the aggregate amount for all outstanding Series of Collections of Principal Receivables and Miscellaneous Payments which the related

 

-63-


Supplements or this Agreement specify are to be treated as “Shared Principal Collections” for such Distribution Date over (y) the aggregate amount for all outstanding Principal Sharing Series which the related Supplements specify are “Principal Shortfalls” for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that such amounts shall be paid to the Transferor only if the Transferor’s Participation Amount for such Distribution Date exceeds the Required Transferor’s Interest and the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables exceeds the Required Principal Balance, but otherwise such amounts shall be deposited into the Excess Funding Account.

Section 4.05. Excess Finance Charges. On each Distribution Date, (a) the Servicer shall allocate Excess Finance Charges with respect to the Series in a Group to each Series in such Group, pro rata, in proportion to the Finance Charge Shortfalls, if any, with respect to each such Series and (b) the Servicer shall withdraw (or shall instruct the Trustee to withdraw) from the Collection Account and pay to the Transferor an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (x) the aggregate amount for all outstanding Series in a Group of the amounts which the related Supplements specify are to be treated as “Excess Finance Charges” for such Distribution Date over (y) the aggregate amount for all outstanding Series in such Group which the related Supplements specify are “Finance Charge Shortfalls” for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that the sharing of Excess Finance Charges among Series in a Group will continue only until such time, if any, at which the Transferor shall deliver to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor to the effect that the continued sharing of Excess Finance Charges among Series in any Group would have adverse regulatory implications with respect to the Transferor. Following the delivery by the Transferor of such an Officer’s Certificate to the Trustee there will not be any further sharing of Excess Finance Charges among Series in any Group.

ARTICLE V

Distributions and Reports to Certificateholders

Distributions shall be made to, and reports shall be provided to, Certificateholders as set forth in the applicable Supplement.

ARTICLE VI

The Certificates

Section 6.01. The Certificates. The Investor Certificates of any Series or Class may be issued in bearer form (“Bearer Certificates”) with attached interest coupons and any other applicable coupon (collectively, the “Coupons”) or in fully registered form (“Registered Certificates”) and shall be substantially in the form of the exhibits with respect thereto attached to the applicable Supplement. The Transferor may elect at any time, by written notice to the Trustee, to have all or a portion of its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be (i) an uncertificated interest or (ii) evidenced by a certificate. If the Transferor elects to have all or a portion of its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be uncertificated, it shall deliver to the Trustee for cancellation any Base Certificate previously issued. If the Transferor elects to have all or a

 

-64-


portion of its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be evidenced by a certificate, the Base Certificate will be issued in registered form, substantially in the form of Exhibit A, and shall upon issue be executed and delivered by the Transferor to the Trustee for authentication and redelivery as provided in Section 6.02. The Trustee shall keep with the books and records of the Trust a register, of each Person owning any uncertificated interest in the Transferor’s Interest. Except as otherwise provided in Section 6.03 or in any Supplement, Bearer Certificates shall be issued in minimum denominations of $1,000 and Registered Certificates shall be issued in minimum denominations of $1,000 and in integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof. If specified in any Supplement, the Investor Certificates of any Series or Class shall be issued upon initial issuance as a single certificate evidencing the aggregate original principal amount of such Series or Class as described in Section 6.13. The Base Certificate shall be a single certificate and shall initially represent the entire Transferor’s Interest. Each Certificate shall be executed by manual or facsimile signature on behalf of the Transferor by its respective President or any Vice President. Certificates bearing the manual or facsimile signature of an individual who was, at the time when such signature was affixed, authorized to sign on behalf of the Transferor shall not be rendered invalid, notwithstanding that such individual ceased to be so authorized prior to the authentication and delivery of such Certificates or does not hold such office at the date of such Certificates. Any Certificate which was executed by the manual or facsimile signature of a duly authorized officer of Capital One, F.S.B. or other Person which was the Transferor at the time of execution of the Certificate, shall not be rendered invalid, notwithstanding that Capital One, F.S.B. or other Person ceases to be the Transferor under this Agreement. No Certificates shall be entitled to any benefit under this Agreement, or be valid for any purpose, unless there appears on such Certificate a certificate of authentication substantially in the form provided for herein executed by or on behalf of the Trustee by the manual signature of a duly authorized signatory, and such certificate upon any Certificate shall be conclusive evidence, and the only evidence, that such Certificate has been duly authenticated and delivered hereunder. Bearer Certificates shall be dated the Series Issuance Date. All Registered Certificates and the Transferor Certificates shall be dated the date of their authentication.

Section 6.02. Authentication of Certificates. The Trustee shall authenticate and deliver the Investor Certificates of each Series and Class that are issued upon original issuance to or upon the order of the Transferor against payment to the Transferor of the purchase price therefor. The Trustee shall authenticate and deliver the Base Certificate to the Transferor simultaneously with its delivery of the Investor Certificates of the first Series to be issued hereunder. If specified in the related Supplement for any Series or Class, the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver outside the United States the Global Certificate that is issued upon original issuance thereof.

Section 6.03. New Issuances.

(a) The Transferor may from time to time direct the Trustee to authenticate one or more new Series of Investor Certificates. The Investor Certificates of all outstanding Series shall be equally and ratably entitled as provided herein to the benefits of this Agreement without preference, priority or distinction, all in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Agreement and the applicable Supplement except, with respect to any Series or Class, as provided in the related Supplement.

 

-65-


(b) On or before the Series Issuance Date relating to any new Series, the parties hereto will execute and deliver a Supplement which will specify the Principal Terms of such new Series. The terms of such Supplement may modify or amend the terms of this Agreement solely as applied to such new Series. The obligation of the Trustee to authenticate the Investor Certificates of such new Series and to execute and deliver the related Supplement is subject to the satisfaction of the following conditions:

(i) on or before the fifth Business Day immediately preceding the Series Issuance Date, the Transferor shall have given the Trustee, the Servicer, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement notice of such issuance and the Series Issuance Date;

(ii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee the related Supplement, in form satisfactory to the Trustee, executed by each party hereto other than the Trustee;

(iii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee any related Enhancement Agreement executed by each of the parties thereto, other than the Trustee;

(iv) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such issuance will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee;

(v) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor, dated the Series Issuance Date, to the effect that the Transferor reasonably believes that such issuance will not, based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after the giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series;

(vi) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement a Tax Opinion, dated the Series Issuance Date, with respect to such issuance; and

(vii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor, dated the Series Issuance Date to the effect that the Transferor’s Participation Amount (excluding the interest represented by any Supplemental Certificate) shall not be less than the Specified Percentage of the total amount of Principal Receivables, in each case as of the Series Issuance Date, and after giving effect to such issuance.

In addition, the Transferor agrees to provide notice of new issuances of Series of Investor Certificates as may be required by and in accordance with Item 1121(a)(14) of Regulation AB.

Upon satisfaction of the above conditions, the Trustee shall execute the Supplement and authenticate the Investor Certificates of such Series upon execution thereof by the Transferor.

 

-66-


(c) If the Transferor elects to have all or a portion of its interest in the Transferor’s Interest evidenced by the Base Certificate as provided in Section 6.01 hereof, then the Transferor may surrender the Base Certificate to the Trustee in exchange for a newly issued Base Certificate and one or more additional certificates (each, a “Supplemental Certificate”), the terms of which shall be defined in a Supplement (which Supplement shall be subject to Section 13.01(a) to the extent that it amends any of the terms of this Agreement), to be delivered to or upon the order of the Transferor (or the Holder of a Supplemental Certificate, in the case of the transfer or exchange thereof, as provided below), upon satisfaction of the following conditions:

(i) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such exchange (or transfer or exchange as provided below) will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee; and

(ii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement a Tax Opinion dated the date of such exchange (or transfer or exchange as provided in the next sentence), with respect thereto.

Any Supplemental Certificate may be transferred or exchanged only upon satisfaction of the conditions set forth in clauses (i) and (ii) above.

Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary and subject to the related Supplement, any Holder of a Supplemental Certificate that is an Affiliate of the Transferor may elect at any time, by written notice to the Trustee, to have its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be (i) an uncertificated interest or (ii) evidenced by a certificate. If the Holder of a Supplemental Certificate elects to have its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be uncertificated, it shall deliver to the Trustee for cancellation any Supplemental Certificate previously issued and the Trustee shall make the appropriate entry in the books and records of the Trust registering such uncertificated interest in the Transferor’s Interest. If the recorded owner of any such uncertificated interest elects to have its interest in the Transferor’s Interest be evidenced by a certificate, a Supplemental Certificate will be issued in registered form and in the form provided in the related Supplement.

Section 6.04. Registration of Transfer and Exchange of Certificates.

(a) The Trustee shall cause to be kept at the office or agency to be maintained in accordance with the provisions of Section 11.16 a register (the “Certificate Register”) in which, subject to such reasonable regulations as it may prescribe, a transfer agent and registrar (which may be the Trustee) (the “Transfer Agent and Registrar”) shall provide for the registration of the Registered Certificates and of transfers and exchanges of the Registered Certificates as herein provided. The Transfer Agent and Registrar shall be, as of the date hereof, The Bank of New York Mellon and any co-transfer agent and co-registrar chosen by the Transferor and acceptable to the Trustee, including if and so long as any Series or Class is listed on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange and such exchange shall so require, a co-transfer agent and co-registrar in Luxembourg. So long as any Investor Certificates are outstanding, the Transferor

 

-67-


shall maintain a co-transfer agent and co-registrar in New York City. Any reference in this Agreement to the Transfer Agent and Registrar shall include any co-transfer agent and co-registrar unless the context requires otherwise.

The Trustee may revoke such appointment and remove any Transfer Agent and Registrar if the Trustee determines in its sole discretion that such Transfer Agent and Registrar failed to perform its obligations under this Agreement in any material respect. Any Transfer Agent and Registrar shall be permitted to resign as Transfer Agent and Registrar upon thirty (30) days notice to the Transferor, the Trustee and the Servicer; provided, however, that such resignation shall not be effective and such Transfer Agent and Registrar shall continue to perform its duties as Transfer Agent and Registrar until the Transferor has appointed a successor Transfer Agent and Registrar reasonably acceptable to the Trustee.

Subject to paragraph (c) below, upon surrender for registration of transfer of any Registered Certificate at any office or agency of the Transfer Agent and Registrar maintained for such purpose, one or more new Registered Certificates (of the same Series and Class) in authorized denominations of like aggregate fractional undivided interests in the Certificateholders’ Interest shall be executed, authenticated and delivered, in the name of the designated transferee or transferees.

At the option of a Registered Certificateholder, Registered Certificates (of the same Series and Class) may be exchanged for other Registered Certificates of authorized denominations of like aggregate fractional undivided interests in the Certificateholders’ Interest, upon surrender of the Registered Certificates to be exchanged at any such office or agency; Registered Certificates, including Registered Certificates received in exchange for Bearer Certificates, may not be exchanged for Bearer Certificates. At the option of the Holder of a Bearer Certificate, subject to applicable laws and regulations, Bearer Certificates may be exchanged for other Bearer Certificates or Registered Certificates (of the same Series and Class) of authorized denominations of like aggregate fractional undivided interests in the Certificateholders’ Interest, upon surrender of the Bearer Certificates to be exchanged at an office or agency of the Transfer Agent and Registrar located outside the United States. Each Bearer Certificate surrendered pursuant to this Section shall have attached thereto all unmatured Coupons; provided that any Bearer Certificate, so surrendered after the close of business on the Record Date preceding the relevant payment date or distribution date after the expected final payment date need not have attached the Coupon relating to such payment date or distribution date (in each case, as specified in the applicable Supplement).

Whenever any Investor Certificates are so surrendered for exchange, the Transferor shall execute, the Trustee shall authenticate and the Transfer Agent and Registrar shall deliver (in the case of Bearer Certificates, outside the United States) the Investor Certificates which the Investor Certificateholder making the exchange is entitled to receive. Every Investor Certificate presented or surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange shall be accompanied by a written instrument of transfer in a form satisfactory to the Trustee or the Transfer Agent and Registrar duly executed by the Investor Certificateholder or the attorney-in-fact thereof duly authorized in writing.

 

-68-


No service charge shall be made for any registration of transfer or exchange of Investor Certificates, but the Transfer Agent and Registrar may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or governmental charge that may be imposed in connection with any such transfer or exchange.

All Investor Certificates (together with any Coupons) surrendered for registration of transfer and exchange or for payment shall be canceled and disposed of in a manner satisfactory to the Trustee. The Trustee shall cancel and destroy any Global Certificate upon its exchange in full for Definitive Euro-Certificates and shall deliver a certificate of destruction to the Transferor. Such certificate shall also state that a certificate or certificates of a Foreign Clearing Agency to the effect referred to in Section 6.13 was received with respect to each portion of the Global Certificate exchanged for Definitive Euro-Certificates.

The Transferor shall execute and deliver to the Trustee Bearer Certificates and Registered Certificates in such amounts and at such times as are necessary to enable the Trustee to fulfill its responsibilities under this Agreement, each Supplement and the Certificates.

(b) The Transfer Agent and Registrar will maintain at its expense in each of the Borough of Manhattan, the City of New York, and, if and so long as any Series or Class is listed on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange, Luxembourg, an office or agency where Investor Certificates may be surrendered for registration of transfer or exchange (except that Bearer Certificates may not be surrendered for exchange at any such office or agency in the United States).

(c) (i) Registration of transfer of Investor Certificates containing a legend substantially to the effect set forth on Exhibit E-1 shall be effected only if such transfer (x) is made pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Act, or is exempt from the registration requirements under the Act, and (y) is made to a Person which is not an employee benefit plan, trust or account, including an individual retirement account, that is subject to ERISA or that is described in Section 4975(e)(1) of the Code or an entity whose underlying assets include plan assets by reason of a plan’s investment in such entity (a “Benefit Plan”). In the event that registration of a transfer is to be made in reliance upon an exemption from the registration requirements under the Act, the transferor or the transferee shall deliver, at its expense, to the Transferor, the Servicer and the Transfer Agent and Registrar, an investment letter from the transferee, substantially in the form of the investment and ERISA representation letter attached hereto as Exhibit E-2, and no registration of transfer shall be made until such letter is so delivered.

Investor Certificates issued upon registration or transfer of, or Investor Certificates issued in exchange for, Investor Certificates bearing the legend referred to above shall also bear such legend unless the Transferor, the Servicer, the Trustee and the Transfer Agent and Registrar receive an opinion of counsel, satisfactory to each of them, to the effect that such legend may be removed.

Whenever an Investor Certificate containing the legend referred to above is presented to the Transfer Agent and Registrar for registration of transfer, the Transfer Agent and

 

-69-


Registrar shall promptly seek instructions from the Transferor regarding such transfer and shall be entitled to receive instructions signed by an officer of the Transferor prior to registering any such transfer. The Transferor hereby agree to indemnify the Transfer Agent and Registrar and the Trustee and to hold each of them harmless against any loss, liability or expense incurred without negligence or bad faith on their part arising out of or in connection with actions taken or omitted by them in relation to any such instructions furnished pursuant to this clause (i). The Transferor’s obligations pursuant to this Section 6.04(c)(i) shall not constitute a claim against the Transferor to the extent the Transferor does not have funds sufficient to make payment of such obligations.

(ii) Registration of transfer of Investor Certificates containing a legend to the effect set forth on Exhibit E-3 shall be effected only if such transfer is made to a Person which is not a Benefit Plan. By accepting and holding any such Investor Certificate, an Investor Certificateholder shall be deemed to have represented and warranted that it is not a Benefit Plan. By acquiring any interest in a Book-Entry Certificate which contains such legend, a Certificate Owner shall be deemed to have represented and warranted that it is not a Benefit Plan.

(iii) If so requested by the Transferor, the Trustee will make available to any prospective purchaser of Investor Certificates who so requests, a copy of a letter provided to Trustee by or on behalf of the Transferor relating to the transferability of any Series or Class to a Benefit Plan.

Section 6.05. Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates. If (a) any mutilated Certificate (together, in the case of Bearer Certificates, with all unmatured Coupons (if any) appertaining thereto) is surrendered to the Transfer Agent and Registrar, or the Transfer Agent and Registrar receives evidence to its satisfaction of the destruction, loss or theft of any Certificate and (b) in the case of a destroyed, lost or stolen Certificate, there is delivered to the Transfer Agent and Registrar and the Trustee such security or indemnity as may be required by them to save each of them harmless, then, in the absence of notice to the Trustee that such Certificate has been acquired by a protected purchaser, the Transferor shall execute, the Trustee shall authenticate and the Transfer Agent and Registrar shall deliver (in the case of Bearer Certificates, outside the United States), in exchange for or in lieu of any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Certificate, a new Certificate of like tenor and aggregate fractional undivided interest. In connection with the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 6.05, the Trustee or the Transfer Agent and Registrar may require the payment by the Certificateholder of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other expenses (including the fees and expenses of the Trustee and Transfer Agent and Registrar) connected therewith. Any duplicate Certificate issued pursuant to this Section 6.05 shall constitute complete and indefeasible evidence of ownership in the Trust, as if originally issued, whether or not the lost, stolen or destroyed Certificate shall be found at any time.

Section 6.06. Persons Deemed Owners. The Trustee, the Transferor, the Servicer, the Paying Agent, the Transfer Agent and Registrar and any agent of any of them may (a) prior to due presentation of a Registered Certificate for registration of transfer, treat the Person in whose name any Registered Certificate is registered as the owner of such Registered

 

-70-


Certificate for the purpose of receiving distributions pursuant to the terms of the applicable Supplement and for all other purposes whatsoever, and (b) treat the bearer of a Bearer Certificate or Coupon as the owner of such Bearer Certificate or Coupon for the purpose of receiving distributions pursuant to the terms of the applicable Supplement and for all other purposes whatsoever; and, in any such case, neither the Trustee, the Transferor, the Servicer, the Paying Agent, the Transfer Agent and Registrar nor any agent of any of them shall be affected by any notice to the contrary. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in determining whether the Holders of the requisite Investor Certificates have given any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent or waiver hereunder, certificates owned by any Transferor, the Servicer, any other holder of a Transferor Certificate, the Trustee or any Affiliate thereof, and in addition, in the case of such determination pursuant to subsection 15.02(a) or 15.02(b), Investor Certificates owned by the Account Owner, the Asset Representations Reviewer or any Affiliate thereof, shall be disregarded and deemed not to be outstanding, except that, in determining whether the Trustee shall be protected in relying upon any such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent or waiver, only Certificates which the Trustee actually knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded. Certificates so owned which have been pledged in good faith shall not be disregarded and may be regarded as outstanding if the pledgee establishes to the satisfaction of the Trustee the pledgee’s right so to act with respect to such Certificates and that the pledgee is not a Transferor, the Servicer, any other holder of a Transferor Certificate or any Affiliate thereof, and in addition, in the case of subsection 15.02(a) or 15.02(b), the pledgee is not the Account Owner, the Asset Representations Reviewer or any Affiliate thereof.

Section 6.07. Appointment of Paying Agent. The Paying Agent shall make distributions to Investor Certificateholders from the Collection Account or any applicable Series Account pursuant to the provisions of the applicable Supplement and shall report the amounts of such distributions to the Trustee. Any Paying Agent shall have the revocable power to withdraw funds from the Collection Account or any applicable Series Account for the purpose of making the distributions referred to above. The Trustee may revoke such power and remove the Paying Agent if the Trustee determines in its sole discretion that the Paying Agent shall have failed to perform its obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement in any material respect. The Paying Agent shall be, as of the date hereof, The Bank of New York Mellon and any co-paying agent chosen by the Transferor and acceptable to the Trustee, including, if and so long as any Series or Class is listed on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange and such exchange so requires, a co-paying agent in Luxembourg or another western European city. Any Paying Agent shall be permitted to resign as Paying Agent upon thirty (30) days notice to the Trustee, the Servicer and the Transferor. In the event that any Paying Agent shall resign, the Transferor shall appoint a successor to act as Paying Agent, reasonably acceptable to the Trustee. The initial and each successor or additional Paying Agent shall execute and deliver to the Trustee an instrument in which such successor or additional Paying Agent shall agree with the Trustee that: (i) it will hold all sums, if any, held by it for payment to the Investor Certificateholders in trust for the benefit of the Investor Certificateholders entitled thereto until such sums shall be paid to such Investor Certificateholders and (ii) during the continuance of any Pay Out Event or Servicer Default, upon the written request of the Trustee, it will forthwith pay to the Trustee all sums held in trust by such Paying Agent for payment in respect of the Investor Certificates. The Paying Agent shall return all unclaimed funds to the Trustee and upon removal shall also return all funds in its possession to the Trustee. If and for so long as the Trustee shall act as Paying Agent, the

 

-71-


provisions of Sections 11.01, 11.02, 11.03 and 11.05 shall apply to the Trustee also in its role as Paying Agent. Any reference in this Agreement to the Paying Agent shall include any co-paying agent unless the context requires otherwise.

Section 6.08. Access to List of Registered Certificateholders’ Names and Addresses. The Trustee will furnish or cause to be furnished by the Transfer Agent and Registrar to the Servicer, the Transferor or the Paying Agent, within five (5) Business Days after receipt by the Trustee of a request therefor, a list in such form as the Servicer, the Transferor or the Paying Agent, may reasonably require, of the names and addresses of the Registered Certificateholders. If any Holder or group of Holders of Investor Certificates of any Series or all outstanding Series, as the case may be, evidencing not less than 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of such Series or all outstanding Series, as applicable (the “Applicants”), apply to the Trustee, and such application states that the Applicants desire to communicate with other Investor Certificateholders with respect to their rights under this Agreement or any Supplement or under the Investor Certificates and is accompanied by a copy of the communication which such Applicants propose to transmit, then the Trustee, after having been adequately indemnified by such Applicants for its costs and expenses shall afford or shall cause the Transfer Agent and Registrar to afford such Applicants access during normal business hours to the most recent list of Registered Certificateholders of such Series or all outstanding Series, as applicable held by the Trustee, within five (5) Business Days after the receipt of such application. Such list shall be as of a date no more than forty-five (45) days prior to the date of receipt of such Applicants’ request.

Every Registered Certificateholder, by receiving and holding a Registered Certificate, agrees with the Trustee that neither the Trustee, the Servicer, the Transferor, the Transfer Agent and Registrar, nor any of their respective agents, shall be held accountable by reason of the disclosure of any such information as to the names and addresses of the Registered Certificateholders hereunder regardless of the sources from which such information was derived.

Section 6.09. Authenticating Agent. (a) The Trustee may appoint one or more authenticating agents with respect to the Certificates which shall be authorized to act on behalf of the Trustee in authenticating the Certificates in connection with the issuance, delivery, registration of transfer, exchange or repayment of the Certificates. Whenever reference is made in this Agreement to the authentication of Certificates by the Trustee or the Trustee’s certificate of authentication, such reference shall be deemed to include authentication on behalf of the Trustee by an authenticating agent and certificate of authentication executed on behalf of the Trustee by an authenticating agent. Each authenticating agent must be acceptable to the Transferor and the Servicer.

(b) Any institution succeeding to the corporate agency business of an authenticating agent shall continue to be an authenticating agent without the execution or filing of any power or any further act on the part of the Trustee or such authenticating agent. An authenticating agent may at any time resign by giving notice of resignation to the Trustee, the Servicer and the Transferor. The Trustee may at any time terminate the agency of an authenticating agent by giving notice of termination to such authenticating agent and to the Transferor and the Servicer. Upon receiving such a notice of resignation or upon such a

 

-72-


termination, or in case at any time an authenticating agent shall cease to be acceptable to the Trustee or a Transferor, the Trustee promptly may appoint a successor authenticating agent. Any successor authenticating agent upon acceptance of its appointment hereunder shall become vested with all the rights, powers and duties of its predecessor hereunder, with like effect as if originally named as an authenticating agent. No successor authenticating agent shall be appointed unless acceptable to the Trustee and the Transferor. The Transferor agrees to pay to each authenticating agent from time to time reasonable compensation for its services under this Section 6.09. The provisions of Sections 11.01, 11.02 and 11.03 shall be applicable to any authenticating agent.

(c) Pursuant to an appointment made under this Section 6.09, the Certificates may have endorsed thereon, in lieu of the Trustee’s certificate of authentication, an alternate certificate of authentication in substantially the following form:

This is one of the Certificates described in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

 

 

 

 

 

  as Authenticating Agent for the Trustee
By  

 

  Authorized Officer

Section 6.10. Book-Entry Certificates. Unless otherwise specified in the related Supplement for any Series or Class, the Investor Certificates, upon original issuance, shall be issued in the form, of one or more typewritten Investor Certificates representing the Book-Entry Certificates, to be delivered to the Clearing Agency, by, or on behalf of, the Transferor. The Investor Certificates shall initially be registered on the Certificate Register in the name of the Clearing Agency or its nominee, and no Certificate Owner will receive a definitive certificate representing such Certificate Owner’s interest in the Investor Certificates, except as provided in Section 6.12. Unless and until definitive, fully registered Investor Certificates (“Definitive Certificates”) have been issued to the applicable Certificate Owners pursuant to Section 6.12 or as otherwise specified in any such Supplement:

(a) the provisions of this Section 6.10 shall be in full force and effect;

(b) the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee may deal with the Clearing Agency and the Clearing Agency Participants for all purposes (including the making of distributions) as the authorized representatives of the respective Certificate Owners;

(c) to the extent that the provisions of this Section 6.10 conflict with any other provisions of this Agreement, the provisions of this Section 6.10 shall control; and

(d) the rights of the respective Certificate Owners shall be exercised only through the Clearing Agency and the Clearing Agency Participants and shall be limited to those

 

-73-


established by law and agreements between such Certificate Owners and the Clearing Agency and/or the Clearing Agency Participants. Pursuant to the Depositary Agreement, unless and until Definitive Certificates are issued pursuant to Section 6.12, the Clearing Agency will make book-entry transfers among the Clearing Agency Participants and receive and transmit distributions of principal and interest on the related Investor Certificates to such Clearing Agency Participants.

For purposes of any provision of this Agreement requiring or permitting actions with the consent of, or at the direction of, Investor Certificateholders evidencing a specified percentage of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of Investor Certificates, such direction or consent may be given by Certificate Owners (acting through the Clearing Agency and the Clearing Agency Participants) owning Investor Certificates evidencing the requisite percentage of principal amount of Investor Certificates.

Section 6.11. Notices to Clearing Agency. Whenever any notice or other communication is required to be given to Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class with respect to which Book-Entry Certificates have been issued, unless and until Definitive Certificates shall have been issued to the related Certificate Owners, the Trustee shall give all such notices and communications to the applicable Clearing Agency.

Section 6.12. Definitive Certificates. If Book-Entry Certificates have been issued with respect to any Series or Class and (a) the Transferor advises the Trustee that the Clearing Agency is no longer willing or able to discharge properly its responsibilities under the Depositary Agreement with respect to such Series or Class and the Trustee or the Transferor is unable to locate a qualified successor, (b) the Transferor, at its option, advises the Trustee that it elects to terminate the book-entry system with respect to such Series or Class through the Clearing Agency or (c) after the occurrence of a Servicer Default, Certificate Owners of such Series or Class evidencing not less than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of such Series or Class advise the Trustee, the Transferor and the Clearing Agency through the Clearing Agency Participants that the continuation of a book-entry system with respect to the Investor Certificates of such Series or Class through the Clearing Agency is no longer in the best interests of the Certificate Owners with respect to such Certificates, then the Trustee shall notify all Certificate Owners of such Certificates, through the Clearing Agency, of the occurrence of any such event and of the availability of Definitive Certificates to Certificate Owners requesting the same. Upon surrender to the Trustee of any such Certificates by the Clearing Agency, accompanied by registration instructions from the Clearing Agency for registration, the Transferor shall execute and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver such Definitive Certificates. Neither the Transferor nor the Trustee shall be liable for any delay in delivery of such instructions and may conclusively rely on, and shall be protected in relying on, such instructions. Upon the issuance of such Definitive Certificates all references herein to obligations imposed upon or to be performed by the Clearing Agency shall be deemed to be imposed upon and performed by the Trustee, to the extent applicable with respect to such Definitive Certificates and the Trustee shall recognize the Holders of such Definitive Certificates as Investor Certificateholders hereunder.

 

-74-


Section 6.13. Global Certificate; Exchange Date.

(a) If specified in the related supplement for any Series or Class, the Investor Certificates for such Series or Class will initially be issued in the form of a single temporary global Certificate (the “Global Certificate”) in bearer form, without interest coupons, in the denomination of the entire aggregate principal amount of such Series or Class and substantially in the form set forth in the exhibit with respect thereto attached to the related Supplement. The Global Certificate will be executed by the Transferor and authenticated by the Trustee upon the same conditions, in substantially the same manner and with the same effect as the Definitive Certificates. The Global Certificate may be exchanged as described below for Bearer or Registered Certificates in definitive form (the “Definitive Euro-Certificates”).

(b) The Manager shall, upon its determination of the date of completion of the distribution of the Investor Certificates of such Series or Class, so advise the Trustee, the Transferor, the Depositaries, and each Foreign Clearing Agency forthwith. Without unnecessary delay, but in any event not prior to the Exchange Date, the Transferor will execute and deliver to the Trustee at its London office or its designated agent outside the United States definitive Bearer Certificates in an aggregate principal amount equal to the entire aggregate principal amount of such Series or Class. All Bearer Certificates so issued and delivered will have Coupons attached. The Global Certificate may be exchanged for an equal aggregate principal amount of Definitive Euro-Certificates only on or after the Exchange Date. An institutional investor that is a U.S. Person may exchange the portion of the Global Certificate beneficially owned by it only for an equal aggregate principal amount of Registered Certificates bearing the applicable legend set forth in the form of Registered Certificate attached to the related Supplement and having a minimum denomination of $500,000, which may be in temporary form if the Transferor so elects. The Transferor may waive the $500,000 minimum denomination requirement if it so elects. Upon any demand for exchange for Definitive Euro-Certificates in accordance with this paragraph, the Transferor shall cause the Trustee to authenticate and deliver the Definitive Euro-Certificates to the Holder (x) outside the United States, in the case of Bearer Certificates, and (y) according to the instructions of the Holder, in the case of Registered Certificates, but in either case only upon presentation to the Trustee of a written statement substantially in the form of Exhibit G-1 with respect to the Global Certificate or portion thereof being exchanged signed by a Foreign Clearing Agency and dated on the Exchange Date or a subsequent date, to the effect that it has received in writing or by tested telex a certification substantially in the form of (i) in the case of beneficial ownership of the Global Certificate or a portion thereof being exchanged by a United States institutional investor pursuant to the second preceding sentence, the certificate in the form of Exhibit G-2 signed by the Manager which sold the relevant Certificates or (ii) in all other cases, the certificate in the form of Exhibit G-3, the certificate referred to in this clause (ii) being dated on the earlier of the first actual payment of interest in respect of such Certificates and the date of the delivery of such Certificate in definitive form. Upon receipt of such certification, the Trustee shall cause the Global Certificate to be endorsed in accordance with paragraph (d) below. Any exchange as provided in this Section 6.13 shall be made free of charge to the holders and the beneficial owners of the Global Certificate and to the beneficial owners of the Definitive Euro-Certificates issued in exchange, except that a person receiving Definitive Euro-Certificates must bear the cost of insurance, postage, transportation and the like in the event that such person does not receive such Definitive Euro-Certificates in person at the offices of a Foreign Clearing Agency.

 

-75-


(c) The delivery to the Trustee by a Foreign Clearing Agency of any written statement referred to above may be relied upon by the Transferor and the Trustee as conclusive evidence that a corresponding certification or certifications has or have been delivered to such Foreign Clearing Agency pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.

(d) Upon any such exchange of all or a portion of the Global Certificate for a Definitive Euro-Certificate or Certificates, such Global Certificate shall be endorsed by or on behalf of the Trustee to reflect the reduction of its principal amount by an amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of such Definitive Euro-Certificate or Certificates. Until so exchanged in full, such Global Certificate shall in all respects be entitled to the same benefits under this Agreement as Definitive Euro-Certificates authenticated and delivered hereunder except that the beneficial owners of such Global Certificate shall not be entitled to receive payments of interest on the Certificates until they have exchanged their beneficial interests in such Global Certificate for Definitive Euro-Certificates.

Section 6.14. Meetings of Certificateholders.

(a) If at the time any Bearer Certificates are issued and outstanding with respect to any Series or Class to which any meeting described below relates, the Transferor or the Trustee may at any time call a meeting of Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class or of all Series, to be held at such time and at such place as the Transferor or the Trustee, as the case may be, shall determine, for the purpose of approving a modification of or amendment to, or obtaining a waiver of any covenant or condition set forth in, this Agreement, any Supplement or the Investor Certificates or of taking any other action permitted to be taken by Investor Certificateholders hereunder or under any Supplement. Notice of any meeting of Investor Certificateholders, setting forth the time and place of such meeting and in general terms the action proposed to be taken at such meeting, shall be given in accordance with Section 13.05, the first mailing and publication to be not less than twenty (20) nor more than 180 days prior to the date fixed for the meeting. To be entitled to vote at any meeting of Investor Certificateholders a person shall be (i) a Holder of one or more Investor Certificates of the applicable Series or Class or (ii) a person appointed by an instrument in writing as proxy by the Holder of one or more such Investor Certificates. The only persons who shall be entitled to be present or to speak at any meeting of Investor Certificateholders shall be the persons entitled to vote at such meeting and their counsel and any representatives of the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee and their respective counsel.

(b) At a meeting of Investor Certificateholders, persons entitled to vote Investor Certificates evidencing a majority of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the applicable Series or Class or all outstanding Series, as the case may be, shall constitute a quorum. No business shall be transacted in the absence of a quorum, unless a quorum is present when the meeting is called to order. In the absence of a quorum at any such meeting, the meeting may be adjourned for a period of not less than ten (10) days; in the absence of a quorum at any such adjourned meeting, such adjourned meeting may be further adjourned for a period of not less than ten (10) days; at the reconvening of any meeting further adjourned for lack of a quorum, the persons entitled to vote Investor Certificates evidencing at least 25% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the applicable Series or Class or all outstanding Series, as

 

-76-


the case may be, shall constitute a quorum for the taking of any action set forth in the notice of the original meeting. Notice of the reconvening of any adjourned meeting shall be given as provided above except that such notice must be given not less than five (5) days prior to the date on which the meeting is scheduled to be reconvened. Notice of the reconvening of an adjourned meeting shall state expressly the percentage of the aggregate principal amount of the outstanding applicable Investor Certificates which shall constitute a quorum.

(c) Any Investor Certificateholder who has executed an instrument in writing appointing a person as proxy shall be deemed to be present for the purposes of determining a quorum and be deemed to have voted; provided that such Investor Certificateholder shall be considered as present or voting only with respect to the matters covered by such instrument in writing. Subject to the provisions of Section 13.01, any resolution passed or decision taken at any meeting of Investor Certificateholders duly held in accordance with this Section 6.14 shall be binding on all Investor Certificateholders whether or not present or represented at the meeting.

(d) The holding of Bearer Certificates shall be proved by the production of such Bearer Certificates or by a certificate, satisfactory to the Transferor, executed by any bank, trust company or recognized securities dealer, wherever situated, satisfactory to the Transferor. Each such certificate shall be dated and shall state that on the date thereof a Bearer Certificate bearing a specified serial number was deposited with or exhibited to such bank, trust company or recognized securities dealer by the person named in such certificate. Any such certificate may be issued in respect of one or more Bearer Certificates specified therein. The holding by the person named in any such certificate of any Bearer Certificate specified therein shall be presumed to continue for a period of one year from the date of such certificate unless at the time of any determination of such holding (i) another certificate bearing a later date issued in respect of the same Bearer Certificate shall be produced, (ii) the Bearer Certificate specified in such certificate shall be produced by some other person or (iii) the Bearer Certificate specified in such certificate shall have ceased to be outstanding. The appointment of any proxy shall be proved by having the signature of the person executing the proxy guaranteed by any bank, trust company or recognized securities dealer satisfactory to the Transferor and the Trustee.

(e) The Trustee shall appoint a temporary chairman of the meeting. A permanent chairman and a permanent secretary of the meeting shall be elected by vote of the holders of Investor Certificates evidencing a majority of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of Investor Certificates of the applicable Series or Class or all outstanding Series, as the case may be, represented at the meeting. No vote shall be cast or counted at any meeting in respect of any Investor Certificate challenged as not outstanding and ruled by the chairman of the meeting to be not outstanding. The chairman of the meeting shall have no right to vote except as an Investor Certificateholder or proxy. Any meeting of Investor Certificateholders duly called at which a quorum is present may be adjourned from time to time, and the meeting may be held as so adjourned without further notice.

(f) The vote upon any resolution submitted to any meeting of Investor Certificateholders shall be by written ballot on which shall be subscribed the signatures of Investor Certificateholders or proxies and on which shall be inscribed the serial number or

 

-77-


numbers of the Investor Certificates held or represented by them. The permanent chairman of the meeting shall appoint two (2) inspectors of votes who shall count all votes cast at the meeting for or against any resolution and who shall make and file with the secretary of the meeting their verified written reports in duplicate of all votes cast at the meeting. A record in duplicate of the proceedings of each meeting of Investor Certificateholders shall be prepared by the secretary of the meeting and there shall be attached to said record the original reports of the inspectors of votes on any vote by ballot taken thereat and affidavits by one or more persons having knowledge of the facts setting forth a copy of the notice of the meeting and showing that said notice was published as provided above. The record shall be signed and verified by the permanent chairman and secretary of the meeting and one of the duplicates shall be delivered to the Transferor and the other to the Trustee to be preserved by the Trustee, the latter to have attached thereto the ballots voted at the meeting. Any record so signed and verified shall be conclusive evidence of the matters therein stated.

ARTICLE VII

Other Matters Relating to the Transferor

Section 7.01. Liability of the Transferor. The Transferor shall be liable in all respects for the obligations, covenants, representations and warranties of the Transferor arising under or related to this Agreement or any Supplement. The Transferor shall be liable only to the extent of the obligations specifically undertaken by it in its capacity as Transferor.

Section 7.02. Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Transferor.

(a) The Transferor shall not consolidate with or merge into any other corporation or entity or convey or transfer its properties and assets substantially as an entirety to any Person unless:

(i) (x) the corporation or other entity formed by such consolidation or into which the Transferor is merged or the Person which acquires by conveyance or transfer the properties and assets of the Transferor substantially as an entirety shall be, if the Transferor is not the surviving entity, a corporation or limited liability company organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America or any State or the District of Columbia, and shall be a savings association, a national banking association, a bank or other entity which is not eligible to be a debtor in a case under Title 11 of the United States Code or a special purpose corporation or other special purpose entity whose powers and activities are limited to substantially the same degree as provided in the governing documents of Funding, and, if the Transferor is not the surviving entity, such surviving entity shall expressly assume, by an agreement supplemental hereto, executed and delivered to the Trustee and the Servicer, in form satisfactory to the Trustee, the performance of every covenant and obligation of the Transferor hereunder, including its obligations under Section 7.04; and (y) the Transferor has delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor and an Opinion of Counsel each stating that such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer and such supplemental agreement comply with this Section, that such supplemental agreement is a valid and binding obligation of such

 

-78-


surviving entity enforceable against such surviving entity in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity), and that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been complied with;

(ii) if the surviving entity is a Non-Code Entity, the Transferor shall have delivered notice of such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer to each Rating Agency or, if the surviving entity is not a Non-Code Entity, the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee; and

(iii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement a Tax Opinion, dated the date of such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer, with respect thereto.

(b) The obligations of the Transferor hereunder shall not be assignable nor shall any Person succeed to the obligations of the Transferor hereunder except in each case in accordance with the provisions of the foregoing paragraph or Section 7.05.

Section 7.03. Limitations on Liability of the Transferor. Subject to Sections 7.01 and 7.04, neither the Transferor nor any of the directors, officers, employees or agents of the Transferor acting in such capacity shall be under any liability to the Trust, the Trustee, the Certificateholders, any Series Enhancer or any other Person for any action taken or for refraining from the taking of any action in good faith in such capacity pursuant to this Agreement; provided, however, that this provision shall not protect the Transferor or any such Person against any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of its duties or by reason of reckless disregard of its obligations and duties hereunder. The Transferor and any director, officer, employee or agent of the Transferor may rely in good faith on any document of any kind prima facie properly executed and submitted by any Person (other than the Transferor) respecting any matters arising hereunder.

Section 7.04. Liabilities. Notwithstanding Section 7.03 (and notwithstanding Sections 8.03 and 8.04), by entering into this Agreement, the Transferor agrees to be liable, directly to the injured party, for the entire amount of any losses, claims, damages or liabilities (other than those incurred by an Investor Certificateholder in the capacity of an investor in the Investor Certificates or those which arise from any action by any Investor Certificateholder) arising out of or based on the arrangement created by this Agreement (to the extent Trust Assets remaining after the Investor Certificateholders and Series Enhancers have been paid in full are insufficient to pay such losses, claims, damages or liabilities) and the actions of the Transferor taken pursuant hereto as though this Agreement created a partnership under the New York Uniform Partnership Act in which the Transferor was a general partner. The Transferor’s obligations pursuant to this Section 7.04 shall not constitute a claim against the Transferor to the extent the Transferor does not have funds sufficient to make payment of such obligations. In the

 

-79-


event of the appointment of a Successor Servicer, the Successor Servicer will (from its own assets and not from the assets of the Trust) indemnify and hold harmless the Transferor against and from any losses, claims, damages and liabilities of the Transferor as described in this Section 7.04 arising from the actions or omissions of such Successor Servicer.

Section 7.05. Assumption of the Transferor’s Obligations. Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 7.02, the Transferor may assign, convey and transfer all of its remaining interest in the Receivables arising in the Accounts, its interest in the Participation Interests and its Transferor’s Interest (collectively, the “Assigned Assets”), together with all of its obligations under this Agreement or relating to the transactions contemplated hereby (collectively, the “Assumed Obligations”), to another entity (the “Assuming Entity”) which may be an entity that is not affiliated with the Transferor, and the Transferor may assign, convey and transfer the Assigned Assets and the Assumed Obligations to the Assuming Entity, without the consent or approval of the holders of any Certificates, upon satisfaction of the following conditions:

(a) the Assuming Entity, the Transferor and the Trustee shall have entered into an assumption agreement (the “Assumption Agreement”) providing for the Assuming Entity to assume the Assumed Obligations, including the obligation under this Agreement to transfer the Receivables arising under the Accounts and the Receivables arising under any Additional Accounts to the Trustee, and the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor and an opinion of Counsel each stating that such transfer and assumption comply with this Section 7.05, that such Assumption Agreement is a valid and binding obligation of such Assuming Entity enforceable against such Assuming Entity in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity), and that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been complied with;

(b) each provider of Series Enhancement, if any, shall have consented to such transfer and assumption;

(c) the Transferor or the Assuming Entity shall have delivered to the Trustee copies of UCC financing statements covering such Accounts to perfect the Trustee’s interest in the Receivables arising herein;

(d) if the Assuming Entity is a Non-Code Entity, the Transferor shall have delivered notice of such transfer and assumption to each Rating Agency or, if the Assuming Entity is not a Non-Code Entity, the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such transfer and assumption will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee;

(e) the Trustee shall have received an Opinion of Counsel with respect to clause (c) above and as to certain other matters specified in Exhibit H-2; and

(f) the Trustee shall have received a Tax Opinion.

 

-80-


Upon such transfer to and assumption by the Assuming Entity, the Transferor shall surrender the Base Certificate, if any, evidencing its interest in the Trust to the Transfer Agent and Registrar for registration of transfer and the Transfer Agent and Registrar shall issue a new Base Certificate, if applicable, in the name of the Assuming Entity. Notwithstanding such assumption, the Transferor shall continue to be liable for all representations and warranties and covenants made by it and all obligations performed or to be performed by it in its capacity as a Transferor prior to such transfer.

ARTICLE VIII

Other Matters Relating to the Servicer

Section 8.01. Liability of the Servicer. The Servicer shall be liable under this Article only to the extent of the obligations specifically undertaken by the Servicer in its capacity as Servicer.

Section 8.02. Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Servicer. The Servicer shall not consolidate with or merge into any other entity or convey or transfer its properties and assets substantially as an entirety to any Person, unless:

(a) (i) the entity formed by such consolidation or into which the Servicer is merged or the Person which acquires by conveyance or transfer the properties and assets of the Servicer substantially as an entirety shall be, if the Servicer is not the surviving entity, an entity organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America or any State or the District of Columbia, and, if the Servicer is not the surviving entity, such entity shall expressly assume, by an agreement supplemental hereto, executed and delivered to the Trustee and the Transferor, in form satisfactory to the Trustee and the Transferor, the performance of every covenant and obligation of the Servicer hereunder;

(ii) the Servicer has delivered to the Trustee and the Transferor an Officer’s Certificate of the Servicer and an Opinion of Counsel each stating that such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer and such supplemental agreement comply with this Section 8.02, that such supplemental agreement is a valid and binding obligation of such surviving entity enforceable against such surviving entity in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity), and that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been complied with;

(b) if the surviving entity is a Non-Code Entity, the Servicer shall have delivered notice of such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer to each Rating Agency or, if the surviving entity is not a Non-Code Entity, the Servicer shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such assignment and succession will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such notice to the Transferor and the Trustee; and

(c) the entity formed by such consolidation or into which the Servicer is merged or the Person which acquires by conveyance or transfer the properties and assets of the Servicer substantially as an entirety shall be an Eligible Servicer.

 

-81-


Section 8.03. Limitation on Liability of the Servicer and Others. Except as provided in Section 8.04, neither the Servicer nor any of the directors, officers, employees or agents of the Servicer in its capacity as Servicer shall be under any liability to the Transferor, the Trust, the Trustee, the Certificateholders, any Series Enhancer or any other person for any action taken or for refraining from the taking of any action in good faith in its capacity as Servicer pursuant to this Agreement; provided, however, that this provision shall not protect the Servicer or any such Person against any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of its duties or by reason of reckless disregard of its obligations and duties hereunder. The Servicer and any director, officer, employee or agent of the Servicer may rely in good faith on any document of any kind prima facie properly executed and submitted by any Person (other than the Servicer) respecting any matters arising hereunder. The Servicer shall not be under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which is not incidental to its duties as Servicer in accordance with this Agreement and which in its reasonable judgment may involve it in any expense or liability. The Servicer may, in its sole discretion but only within the scope of its role as Servicer, undertake any such legal action which it may deem necessary or desirable for the benefit of the Certificateholders with respect to this Agreement and the rights and duties of the parties hereto and the interests of the Certificateholders hereunder.

Section 8.04. Servicer Indemnification of the Transferor, the Trust and the Trustee. The Servicer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Transferor, the Trust and the Trustee from and against any loss, liability, expense, damage or injury suffered or sustained by reason of any acts or omissions of the Servicer with respect to the Trust pursuant to this Agreement, including any judgment, award, settlement, reasonable attorneys’ fees and other costs or expenses incurred in connection with the defense of any action, proceeding or claim. Indemnification pursuant to this Section 8.04 shall not be payable from the Trust Assets.

Section 8.05. The Servicer Not To Resign. Except as provided in Section 8.02, the Servicer shall not resign from the obligations and duties hereby imposed on it except upon determination that (i) the performance of its duties hereunder is no longer permissible under Requirements of Law (other than the charter and by-laws of the Servicer) and (ii) there is no reasonable action which the Servicer could take to make the performance of its duties hereunder permissible under such Requirements of Law. Any determination permitting the resignation of the Servicer shall be evidenced by an Officer’s Certificate of the Servicer and an Opinion of Counsel to such effect delivered to the Transferor and the Trustee. No resignation shall become effective until the Trustee or a Successor Servicer shall have assumed the responsibilities and obligations of the Servicer in accordance with Section 10.02. If within 120 days of the date of the determination that the Servicer may no longer act as Servicer the Trustee is unable to appoint a Successor Servicer, the Trustee shall serve as Successor Servicer. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Trustee shall, if it is legally unable so to act, petition a court of competent jurisdiction to appoint any established institution having a net worth of not less than $50,000,000 and whose regular business includes the servicing of credit card accounts and who has the ability

 

-82-


to service the Receivables as the Successor Servicer hereunder. The Trustee shall give prompt notice to the Transferor and each Rating Agency and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto under the terms of the applicable Supplement upon the appointment of a Successor Servicer.

Section 8.06. Access to Certain Documentation and Information Regarding the Receivables. The Servicer shall provide to the Trustee and the Transferor access to the documentation regarding the Accounts and the Receivables in such cases where the Trustee or the Transferor is required in connection with the enforcement of the rights of the Transferor or Certificateholders or by applicable statutes or regulations to review such documentation, such access being afforded without charge but only (a) upon reasonable request, (b) during normal business hours, (c) subject to the Servicer’s normal security and confidentiality procedures and (d) at the Servicer’s principal office or at the Servicer’s office in the continental United States where the documentation regarding the Accounts and the Receivables normally is kept. Nothing in this Section 8.06 shall derogate from the obligation of the Transferor, the Trustee and the Servicer to observe any applicable law prohibiting disclosure of information regarding the Obligors and the failure of the Servicer to provide access as provided in this Section 8.06 as a result of such obligation shall not constitute a breach of this Section 8.06.

Section 8.07. Delegation of Duties. In the ordinary course of business, the Servicer may at any time delegate any duties hereunder to any Person who agrees to conduct such duties in accordance with the Lending Guidelines and this Agreement; provided, however, in the case of significant delegation to a Person other than any Affiliate of the Servicer or Electronic Data Services, (i) at least thirty (30) days prior written notice shall be given to the Trustee, the Transferor, each Rating Agency and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement, of such delegation and (ii) at or prior to the end of such 30-day period the Servicer shall not have received a notice in writing from a Rating Agency that such delegation will have a Ratings Effect. Any such delegation shall not relieve the Servicer of its liability and responsibility with respect to such duties, and shall not constitute a resignation within the meaning of Section 8.05 hereof.

Section 8.08. Examination of Records. The Transferor and the Servicer shall clearly and unambiguously indicate in their computer files or other records that the Trust Assets have been conveyed to the Trustee, pursuant to this Agreement. The Transferor and the Servicer shall, prior to the sale or transfer to a third party of any receivable held in its custody, examine its computer and other records to determine that such receivable is not a Receivable.

ARTICLE IX

Pay Out Events

Section 9.01. Pay Out Events. If any one of the following events shall occur with respect to any Series:

(a) an Account Owner shall consent to the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings of or relating to an Account Owner or of or relating to all or

 

-83-


substantially all of its property, or a decree or order of a court or agency or supervisory authority having jurisdiction in the premises for the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings, or for the winding-up or liquidation of its affairs, shall have been entered against an Account Owner; or an Account Owner shall admit in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as they become due, file a petition to take advantage of any applicable insolvency or reorganization statute, make any assignment for the benefit of its creditors or voluntarily suspend payment of its obligations; provided that an Insolvency Event shall be a Pay Out Event with respect to an Account Owner only if, at the time such Insolvency Event occurs, Receivables transferred by an Account Owner are then included in the Trust;

(b) the Transferor (or any Additional Transferor) shall consent to the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, bankruptcy, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings of or relating to the Transferor or relating to all or substantially all of its property, or a decree or order of a court or agency or supervisory authority having jurisdiction in the premises for the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, bankruptcy, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings, or for the winding-up or liquidation of its affairs, shall have been entered against the Transferor; or the Transferor shall admit in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as they become due, file a petition to take advantage of any applicable insolvency, bankruptcy or reorganization statute, make an assignment for the benefit of its creditors or voluntarily suspend payment of its obligations (any such event described in this clause (b) or in clause (a) above, an “Insolvency Event”);

(c) the Trust shall become an “investment company” within the meaning of the Investment Company Act; or

(d) a Transfer Restriction Event as defined in the Receivables Purchase Agreements shall occur between an Account Owner and the Transferor;

then, in the case of any such event, a Pay Out Event shall occur with respect to such Series without any notice or other action on the part of the Trustee or the Investor Certificateholders, immediately upon the occurrence of such event.

Section 9.02. Additional Rights upon the Occurrence of Certain Events.

(a) If an Insolvency Event occurs with respect to the Transferor or the Transferor violates Section 2.07(c) for any reason, the Transferor shall on the day any such Insolvency Event or violation occurs (the “Appointment Date”), immediately cease to transfer Principal Receivables to the Trustee and shall promptly give notice to the Trustee and the Servicer thereof. Notwithstanding any cessation of the transfer to the Trustee of additional Principal Receivables, Principal Receivables transferred to the Trustee prior to the occurrence of such Insolvency Event and Collections in respect of such Principal Receivables and Finance Charge Receivables whenever created, accrued in respect of such Principal Receivables, shall continue to be a part of the Trust. So long as any Series issued prior to April 1, 2001 remains Outstanding, within fifteen (15) days after receipt of such notice by the Trustee of the occurrence

 

-84-


of such Insolvency Event or violation of Section 2.07(c), the Trustee shall (i) publish a notice in an Authorized Newspaper that an Insolvency Event or violation has occurred and that the Trustee intends to sell, dispose of or otherwise liquidate the Receivables and (ii) give notice to Investor Certificateholders and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement describing the provisions of this Section 9.02 and requesting instructions from such Holders. Unless the Trustee shall have received instructions within ninety (90) days from the date notice pursuant to clause (i) above is first published from (x) Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of each Series or, with respect to any Series with two (2) or more Classes, of each Class, to the effect that such Investor Certificateholders disapprove of the liquidation of the Receivables and wish to continue having Principal Receivables transferred to the Trustee as before such Insolvency Event or violation, (y) to the extent provided in the relevant Supplement, the Series Enhancer with respect to such Series, to such effect, and (z) each holder (other than the Transferor) of a Transferor Certificate to such effect, the Trustee shall promptly use its best efforts to sell, dispose of or otherwise liquidate the Receivables by the solicitation of competitive bids and on terms equivalent to the best purchase offer as determined by the Trustee. The Trustee may obtain a prior determination from any such conservator, receiver or liquidator that the terms and manner of any proposed sale, disposition or liquidation are commercially reasonable. The provisions of Sections 9.01 and 9.02 shall not be deemed to be mutually exclusive.

(b) If an Insolvency Event occurs with respect to any Additional Transferor or any such Additional Transferor violates Section 2.07(c) for any reason, such Additional Transferor shall on the day any such Insolvency Event or violation occurs (the “Appointment Date”), immediately cease to transfer Principal Receivables to the Trustee and shall promptly give notice to the Trustee and the Servicer thereof. Notwithstanding any cessation of the transfer to the Trustee of additional Principal Receivables, Principal Receivables transferred to the Trustee prior to the occurrence of such Insolvency Event and Collections in respect of such Principal Receivables and Finance Charge Receivables whenever created, accrued in respect of such Principal Receivables, shall continue to be a part of the Trust.

(c) The proceeds from the sale, disposition or liquidation of the Receivables pursuant to paragraph (a) (“Insolvency Proceeds”) shall be immediately deposited in the Collection Account. The Trustee shall determine conclusively the amount of the Insolvency Proceeds which are deemed to be Finance Charge Receivables and Principal Receivables. The Insolvency Proceeds shall be allocated and distributed to Investor Certificateholders in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement and the Trust shall terminate immediately thereafter.

ARTICLE X

Servicer Defaults

Section 10.01. Servicer Defaults. If any one of the following events (a “Servicer Default”) shall occur and be continuing:

(a) any failure by the Servicer to make any payment, transfer or deposit or to give instructions or notice to the Trustee pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or any Supplement on or before the date occurring ten (10) Business Days after the date such payment, transfer or deposit or such instruction or notice is required to be made or given, as the case may be, under the terms of this Agreement or any Supplement;

 

-85-


(b) failure on the part of the Servicer duly to observe or perform in any material respect any other covenants or agreements of the Servicer set forth in this Agreement or any Supplement which has a material adverse effect on the interests hereunder of the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class (which determination shall be made without regard to whether funds are then available pursuant to any Series Enhancement) and which continues unremedied for a period of sixty (60) days after the date on which written notice of such failure, requiring the same to be remedied, shall have been given to the Servicer by the Trustee or the Transferor, or to the Servicer, the Transferor and the Trustee by Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any such failure that does not relate to all Series, 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Series to which such failure relates); or the Servicer shall delegate its duties under this Agreement, except as permitted by Sections 8.02 and 8.07, a Responsible Officer of the Trustee has actual knowledge of such delegation and such delegation continues unremedied for 15 days after the date on which written notice thereof, requiring the same to be remedied, shall have been given to the Servicer by the Trustee or the Transferor, or to the Servicer, the Transferor and the Trustee by Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates;

(c) any representation, warranty or certification made by the Servicer in this Agreement or any Supplement or in any certificate delivered pursuant to this Agreement or any Supplement shall prove to have been incorrect when made, which has a material adverse effect on the rights of the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class (which determination shall be made without regard to whether funds are then available pursuant to any Series Enhancement) and which continues to be incorrect in any material respect for a period of sixty (60) days after the date on which written notice of such failure, requiring the same to be remedied, shall have been given to the Servicer by the Trustee or the Transferor, or to the Servicer, the Transferor and the Trustee by the Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any such representation, warranty or certification that does not relate to all Series, 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Series to which such representation, warranty or certification relates); or

(d) the Servicer shall consent to the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings of or relating to the Servicer or of or relating to all or substantially all of its property, or a decree or order of a court or agency or supervisory authority having jurisdiction in the premises for the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings, or for the winding-up or liquidation of its affairs, shall have been entered against the Servicer, and such decree or order shall have remained in force undischarged or unstayed for a period of sixty (60) days; or the Servicer shall admit in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as

 

-86-


they become due, file a petition to take advantage of any applicable insolvency or reorganization statute, make any assignment for the benefit of its creditors or voluntarily suspend payment of its obligations; then, in the event of any Servicer Default, so long as the Servicer Default shall not have been remedied, either the Trustee, the Transferor or the Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Series, by written notice then given to the Servicer (and to the Trustee, the Transferor, and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement if given by the Investor Certificateholders) (a “Termination Notice”), may terminate all but not less than all the rights and obligations of the Servicer as Servicer under this Agreement and in and to the Receivables and the proceeds thereof; provided, however, if within sixty (60) days of receipt of a Termination Notice the Trustee does not receive any bids from Eligible Servicers in accordance with Section 10.02(c) to act as a Successor Servicer and receives an Officer’s Certificate of the Servicer to the effect that the Servicer cannot in good faith cure the Servicer Default which gave rise to the Termination Notice, the Trustee shall grant a right of first refusal to the Transferor which would permit the Transferor at its option to purchase the Certificateholders’ Interest on the Distribution Date in the next calendar month; provided further, however, the foregoing right of first refusal shall not apply in the case of a Servicer Default set forth in subsection 10.01(d). The purchase price for the Certificateholders’ Interest shall be equal to the sum of the amounts specified therefor with respect to each outstanding Series in the related Supplement. The Transferor shall notify the Trustee prior to the Record Date for the Distribution Date of the purchase if they are exercising such option. If it exercises such option, the Transferor shall (x) deliver to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel (which must be an independent outside counsel) to the effect that, in reliance on certain certificates to the effect that the Receivables constitute fair value for consideration paid therefor and as to the solvency of the Transferor, the purchase would not be considered a fraudulent conveyance and (y) deposit the purchase price into the Collection Account not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on such Distribution Date in immediately available funds. The purchase price shall be allocated and distributed to Investor Certificateholders in accordance with Article IV and the terms of each Supplement.

After receipt by the Servicer of such Termination Notice, and on the date that a Successor Servicer shall have been appointed by the Trustee pursuant to Section 10.02, all authority and power of the Servicer under this Agreement shall pass to and be vested in a Successor Servicer; and, without limitation, the Trustee is hereby authorized and empowered (upon the failure of the Servicer to cooperate) to execute and deliver, on behalf of the Servicer, as attorney-in-fact or otherwise, all documents and other instruments upon the failure of the Servicer to execute or deliver such documents or instruments, and to do and accomplish all other acts or things necessary or appropriate to effect the, purposes of such transfer of servicing rights. The Servicer agrees to cooperate with the Trustee and such Successor Servicer in effecting the termination of the responsibilities and rights of the Servicer to conduct servicing hereunder including the transfer to such Successor Servicer of all authority of the Servicer to service the Receivables provided for under this Agreement, including all authority over all Collections which shall on the date of transfer be held by the Servicer for deposit, or which have been deposited by the Servicer, in the Collection Account, or which shall thereafter be received with respect to the Receivables, and in assisting the Successor Servicer and in enforcing all rights to Insurance Proceeds. The Servicer shall promptly transfer its electronic records relating to the Receivables to the Successor Servicer in such electronic form as the Successor Servicer may

 

-87-


reasonably request and shall promptly transfer to the Successor Servicer all other records, correspondence and documents necessary for the continued servicing of the Receivables in the manner and at such times as the Successor Servicer shall reasonably request. To the extent that compliance with this Section 10.01 shall require the Servicer to disclose to the Successor Servicer information of any kind which the Servicer reasonably deems to be confidential, the Successor Servicer shall be required to enter into such customary licensing and confidentiality agreements as the Servicer shall deem necessary to protect its interests.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, any delay in or failure of performance under Section 10.01(a) for a period of five (5) Business Days or under Section 10.01(b) or (c) for a period of sixty (60) days (in addition to any period provided in Section 10.01(a), (b) or (c)) shall not constitute a Servicer Default until the expiration of such additional five (5) Business Days or sixty (60) days, respectively, if such delay or failure could not be prevented by the exercise of reasonable diligence by the Servicer and such delay or failure was caused by an act of God or the public enemy, acts of declared or undeclared war or terrorism, public disorder, rebellion or sabotage, epidemics, landslides, lightning, fire, hurricanes, earthquakes, floods or similar causes. The preceding sentence shall not relieve the Servicer from using its best efforts to perform its respective obligations in a timely manner in accordance with the terms of this Agreement and any Supplement and the Servicer shall provide the Trustee, each Rating Agency, any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement, each Holder of a Transferor Certificate and the Investor Certificateholders with an Officer’s Certificate of the Servicer giving prompt notice of such failure or delay by it, together with a description of its efforts to so perform its obligations.

Section 10.02. Trustee To Act; Appointment of Successor.

(a) On and after the receipt by the Servicer of a Termination Notice pursuant to Section 10.01, the Servicer shall continue to perform all servicing functions under this Agreement until the date specified in the Termination Notice or otherwise specified by the Trustee and the Transferor or until a date mutually agreed upon by the Servicer, the Transferor and Trustee. The Trustee shall as promptly as possible after the giving of a Termination Notice appoint an Eligible Servicer as a successor servicer (the “Successor Servicer”), and such Successor Servicer shall accept its appointment by a written assumption in a form acceptable to the Trustee and the Transferor. In the event that a Successor Servicer has not been appointed or has not accepted its appointment at the time when the Servicer ceases to act as Servicer, the Trustee without further action shall automatically be appointed the Successor Servicer. The Trustee may delegate any of its servicing obligations to an Affiliate of the Trustee or agent in accordance with Sections 3.01(b) and 8.07. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Trustee shall, if it is legally unable so to act, petition a court of competent jurisdiction to appoint any established institution having a net worth of not less than $50,000,000 and whose regular business includes the servicing of credit card receivables and who has the ability to service the Receivables as the Successor Servicer hereunder. The Trustee shall give prompt notice to the Transferor, each Rating Agency and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the applicable Supplement upon the appointment of a Successor Servicer.

 

-88-


(b) Upon its appointment, the Successor Servicer shall be the successor in all respects to the Servicer with respect to servicing functions under this Agreement and shall be subject to all the responsibilities, duties and liabilities relating thereto placed on the Servicer by the terms and provisions hereof, and all references in this Agreement to the Servicer shall be deemed to refer to the Successor Servicer.

(c) In connection with any Termination Notice, the Trustee will review any bids which it obtains from Eligible Servicers and shall be permitted to appoint any Eligible Servicer submitting such a bid as a Successor Servicer for servicing compensation not in excess of the aggregate Servicing Fees for all Series; provided, however, that the Transferor shall be responsible for payment of the Transferor’s portion of such aggregate Servicing Fees and that no such monthly compensation paid out of Collections shall be in excess of such aggregate Servicing Fees. Each holder of a Transferor Certificate agrees that, if Capital One (or any Successor Servicer) is terminated as Servicer hereunder, the portion of the Collections in respect of Finance Charge Receivables that the Transferor is entitled to receive pursuant to this Agreement or any Supplement shall be reduced by an amount sufficient to pay the Transferor’s share (determined by reference to the Supplements with respect to any outstanding Series) of the compensation of the Successor Servicer.

(d) All authority and power granted to the Servicer under this Agreement shall automatically cease and terminate upon termination of the Trust pursuant to Section 12.01 and shall pass to and be vested in the Transferor and, without limitation, the Transferor is hereby authorized and empowered to execute and deliver, on behalf of the Servicer, as attorney-in-fact or otherwise, all documents and other instruments, and to do and accomplish all other acts or things necessary or appropriate to effect the purposes of such transfer of servicing rights. The Servicer agrees to cooperate with the Transferor in effecting the termination of the responsibilities and rights of the Servicer to conduct servicing on the Receivables. The Servicer shall transfer its electronic records relating to the Receivables to the Transferor in such electronic form as the Transferor may reasonably request and shall transfer all other records, correspondence and documents to the Transferor in the manner and at such times as the Transferor shall reasonably request. To the extent that compliance with this Section 10.02 shall require the Servicer to disclose to the Transferor information of any kind which the Servicer deems to be confidential, the Transferor shall be required to enter into such customary licensing and confidentiality agreements as the Servicer shall deem necessary to protect its interests.

Section 10.03. Notification to Certificateholders. Within two (2) Business Days after the Servicer becomes aware of any Servicer Default, the Servicer shall give notice thereof to the Trustee, the Transferor, each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement and the Trustee shall give notice to the Investor Certificateholders. Upon any termination or appointment of a Successor Servicer pursuant to this Article X, the Trustee shall give prompt notice thereof to the Transferor and to the Investor Certificateholders.

 

-89-


ARTICLE XI

The Trustee

Section 11.01. Duties of Trustee. (a) The Trustee, prior to the occurrence of a Servicer Default and after the curing of all Servicer Defaults which may have occurred, undertakes to perform such duties and only such duties as are specifically set forth in this Agreement. If a Servicer Default has occurred (which has not been cured or waived) the Trustee shall exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it by this Agreement, and use the same degree of care and skill in its exercise, as a prudent person would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of such person’s own affairs.

(b) The Trustee, upon receipt of all resolutions, certificates, statements, opinions, reports, documents, orders or other instruments furnished to the Trustee which are specifically required to be furnished pursuant to any provision of this Agreement, shall examine them to determine whether they conform to the requirements of this Agreement. The Trustee shall give prompt written notice to the Certificateholders of any material lack of conformity of any such instrument to the applicable requirements of this Agreement discovered by the Trustee which would entitle a specified percentage of the Certificateholders to take any action pursuant to this Agreement.

(c) Subject to Section 11.01(a), no provision of this Agreement shall be construed to relieve the Trustee from liability for its own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act or its own misconduct; provided, however, that:

(i) the Trustee shall not be personally liable for an error of judgment made in good faith by a Responsible Officer or Responsible Officers of the Trustee, unless it shall be proved that the Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent facts;

(ii) the Trustee shall not be personally liable with respect to any action taken, suffered or omitted to be taken by it in good faith in accordance with the direction of the Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any such action that does not relate to all Series, 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of all Series to which such action relates) relating to the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee, or exercising any trust or power conferred upon the Trustee, under this Agreement; and

(iii) the Trustee shall not be charged with knowledge of any failure by the Servicer referred to in clauses (a) and (b) of Section 10.01 unless a Responsible Officer of the Trustee obtains actual knowledge of such failure or the Trustee receives written notice of such failure from the Servicer, the Transferor or any Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any such failure that does not relate to all Series, 10% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates of all Series to which such failure relates, or the Series Enhancers for all Series to which such failure relates).

 

-90-


(d) The Trustee shall not be required to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur financial liability in the performance of any of its duties hereunder or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers hereunder or thereunder, if there is reasonable ground for believing that the repayment of such funds or adequate indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it, and none of the provisions contained in this Agreement shall in any event require the Trustee to perform, or be responsible for the manner of performance of, any of the obligations of the Servicer under this Agreement except during such time, if any, as the Trustee shall be the successor to, and be vested with the rights, duties, powers and privileges of, the Servicer in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

(e) Except for actions expressly authorized by this Agreement, the Trustee shall take no action reasonably likely to (i) impair the interests of the Trustee or the Trust in any Receivable now existing or hereafter created or (ii) impair the value of any Receivable now existing or hereafter created.

(f) The Trustee shall have no power to vary the corpus of the Trust, except as expressly provided in this Agreement.

(g) Subject to Section 11.01(d), in the event that the Paying Agent or the Transfer Agent and Registrar shall fail to perform any obligation, duty or agreement in the manner or on the day required to be performed by the Paying Agent or the Transfer Agent and Registrar, as the case may be, under this Agreement, the Trustee shall be obligated as soon as possible upon knowledge of a Responsible Officer thereof and receipt of appropriate records, if any, to perform such obligation, duty or agreement in the manner so required.

(h) If an Account Owner has agreed to transfer any of its receivables (other than the Receivables) to another Person, upon the written request of such Account Owner, the Trustee will enter into such intercreditor agreements with the transferee of such receivables as are customary and necessary to separately identify the rights of the Trust and such other Person in such Account Owner’s receivables; provided that the Trustee shall not be required to enter into any intercreditor agreement which could adversely affect the interests of the Certificateholders and, upon the request of the Trustee, such Account Owner will deliver an Opinion of Counsel on any matters relating to such intercreditor agreement, reasonably requested by the Trustee.

Section 11.02. Certain Matters Affecting the Trustee. Except as otherwise provided in Section 11.01:

(a) the Trustee may rely on and shall be protected in acting on, or in refraining from acting in accord with, any resolution, Officer’s Certificate, certificate of auditors or any other certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, consent, order, appraisal, bond or other paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented to it pursuant to this Agreement by the proper party or parties;

(b) the Trustee may consult with counsel, and any advice of such counsel, or Opinion of Counsel shall be full and complete authorization and protection in respect of any action taken or suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in accordance with such advice or Opinion of Counsel;

 

-91-


(c) the Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers vested in it by this Agreement or any Enhancement Agreement, or to institute, conduct or defend any litigation hereunder or thereunder or in relation to this Agreement or any Enhancement Agreement or institute or conduct any proceeding (including, without limitation, any arbitration or mediation provided for under Section 2.12), at the request, order or direction of any of the Certificateholders, pursuant to the provisions of this Agreement or any Enhancement Agreement, unless such Certificateholders (in all cases other than those specified in Section 15.02) or the Servicer (in cases specified in Section 15.02) shall have offered to the Trustee reasonable security or indemnity against the costs, expenses and liabilities which may be incurred therein or thereby; nothing contained herein shall, however, relieve the Trustee of the obligations, upon the occurrence of any Servicer Default (which has not been cured) to exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it by this Agreement, and to use the same degree of care and skill in its exercise, as a prudent person would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of such person’s own affairs;

(d) the Trustee shall not be personally liable for any action taken, suffered or omitted by it in good faith and believed by it to be authorized or within the discretion or rights or powers conferred upon it by this Agreement;

(e) the Trustee shall not be bound to make any investigation into the facts of matters stated in any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, consent, order, approval, bond or other paper or document, unless requested in writing so to do by Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 25% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any such matters that do not relate to all Series, 25% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of all Series to which such matters relate);

(f) the Trustee may execute any of the trusts or powers hereunder or perform any duties hereunder either directly or by or through agents or attorneys or a custodian, and the Trustee shall not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any such agent, attorney or custodian appointed with due care by it hereunder; provided, however, that the Trustee shall not hold any Eligible Investment through an agent or nominee except as expressly permitted by Section 4.02; and

(g) except as may be required by Section 11.01(a) hereof, the Trustee shall not be required to make any initial or periodic examination of any documents or records related to the Receivables or the Accounts for the purpose of establishing the presence or absence of defects, the compliance by each Transferor with its representations and warranties or for any other purpose.

Section 11.03. Trustee Not Liable for Recitals in Certificates. The Trustee assumes no responsibility for the correctness of the recitals contained herein and in the Certificates (other than the certificate of authentication on the Certificates). Except as set forth

 

-92-


in Section 11.15, the Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency of this Agreement or any Supplement or of the Certificates (other than the certificate of authentication on the Certificates) or of any Receivable or related document. The Trustee shall not be accountable for the use or application by the Transferor of any of the Certificates or of the proceeds of such Certificates, or for the use or application of any funds paid to the Transferor or the Holders of the Transferor Certificates in respect of the Receivables or deposited in or withdrawn from the Collection Account, any Series Accounts or any other accounts hereafter established to effectuate the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

Section 11.04. Trustee May Own Certificates. Subject to Section 6.06, the Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or pledgee of Investor Certificates with the same rights as it would have if it were not the Trustee.

Section 11.05. The Servicer To Pay Trustee’s Fees and Expenses. The Servicer covenants and agrees to pay to the Trustee from time to time, and the Trustee shall be entitled to receive, reasonable compensation (which shall not be limited by any provision of law in regard to the compensation of a trustee of an express trust) for all services rendered by it in the execution of the trust hereby created and in the exercise and performance of any of the powers and duties hereunder of the Trustee, and the Servicer will pay or reimburse the Trustee (without reimbursement from the Collection Account or otherwise) upon its request for all reasonable expenses, disbursements and advances incurred or made by the Trustee in accordance with any of the provisions of this Agreement or any Enhancement Agreement (including the reasonable fees and expenses of its agents, any co-trustee and counsel) except any such expense, disbursement or advance as may arise from its own negligence or bad faith and except as provided in the following sentence. If the Trustee is appointed Successor Servicer pursuant to Section 10.02, the provisions of this Section 11.05 shall not apply to expenses, disbursements and advances made or incurred by the Trustee in its capacity as Successor Servicer.

The obligations of the Servicer under Section 8.04 and this Section 11.05 shall survive the termination of the Trust and the resignation or removal of the Trustee.

Section 11.06. Eligibility Requirements for Trustee. The Trustee hereunder shall at all times be a bank or a corporation organized and doing business under the laws of the United States of America or any state thereof authorized under such laws to exercise corporate trust powers, having a combined capital and surplus of at least $50,000,000 and subject to supervision or examination by Federal or state authority and maintain any credit or deposit rating required by any Rating Agency (as of the date hereof Baa3 for Moody’s). If such bank or corporation publishes reports of condition at least annually, pursuant to law or to the requirements of the aforesaid supervising or examining authority, then for the purpose of this Section 11.06, the combined capital and surplus of such bank or corporation shall be deemed to be its combined capital and surplus as set forth in its most recent report of condition so published. In case at any time the Trustee shall cease to be eligible in accordance with the provisions of this Section 11.06, the Trustee shall resign immediately in the manner and with the effect specified in Section 11.07.

 

-93-


Section 11.07. Resignation or Removal of Trustee.

(a) The Trustee may at any time resign and be discharged from the trust hereby created by giving written notice thereof to the Servicer, the Transferor and each Rating Agency. Upon receiving such notice of resignation, the Transferor shall promptly appoint a successor trustee by written instrument, in duplicate, one copy of which instrument shall be delivered to the resigning Trustee and one copy to the successor trustee. If no successor trustee shall have been so appointed and have accepted within thirty (30) days after the giving of such notice of resignation, the resigning Trustee may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor trustee.

(b) If at any time the Trustee shall cease to be eligible in accordance with the provisions of Section 11.06 and shall fail to resign after written request therefor by the Transferor, or if at any time the Trustee shall be legally unable to act, or shall be adjudged a bankrupt or insolvent, or a receiver of the Trustee or of its property shall be appointed, or any public officer shall take charge or control of the Trustee or of its property or affairs for the purpose of rehabilitation, conservation or liquidation, the Transferor shall remove the Trustee and promptly appoint a successor trustee by written instrument, in duplicate, one copy of which instrument shall be delivered to the Trustee so removed and one copy to the successor trustee.

(c) Any resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor trustee pursuant to any of the provisions of this Section 11.07 shall not become effective until acceptance of appointment by the successor trustee as provided in Section 11.08 and any liability of the Trustee arising hereunder shall survive such appointment of a successor trustee.

Section 11.08. Successor Trustees.

(a) Any successor trustee appointed as provided in Section 11.07 shall execute, acknowledge and deliver to the Transferor, to the Servicer and to its predecessor Trustee an instrument accepting such appointment hereunder, and thereupon the resignation or removal of the predecessor Trustee shall become effective and such successor trustee, without any further act, deed or conveyance, shall become fully vested with all the rights, powers, duties and obligations of its predecessor hereunder, with the like effect as if originally named as Trustee herein. The predecessor Trustee shall deliver to the successor trustee all documents and statements held by it hereunder, and the Transferor, the Servicer and the predecessor Trustee shall execute and deliver such instruments and do such other things as may reasonably be required for fully and certainly vesting and confirming in the successor trustee all such rights, powers, duties and obligations.

(b) No successor trustee shall accept appointment as provided in this Section 11.08 unless at the time of such acceptance such success or trustee shall be eligible under the provisions of Section 11.06.

(c) Upon acceptance of appointment by a successor trustee as provided in this Section 11.08, such successor trustee shall provide notice of such succession hereunder to all Investor Certificateholders and the Servicer shall provide such notice to each Rating Agency and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement.

 

-94-


Section 11.09. Merger or Consolidation of Trustee. Any Person into which the Trustee may be merged or converted or with which it may be consolidated, or any Person resulting from any merger, conversion or consolidation to which the Trustee shall be a party, or any Person succeeding to the corporate trust business of the Trustee, shall be the successor of the Trustee hereunder, provided such corporation shall be eligible under the provisions of Section 11.06, without the execution or filing of any paper or any further act on the part of any of the parties hereto, anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding.

Section 11.10. Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate Trustee.

(a) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Agreement, at any time, for the purpose of meeting any legal requirements of any jurisdiction in which any part of the Trust may at the time be located, the Trustee shall have the power and may execute and deliver all instruments, subject to the prior written consent of the Transferor, to appoint one or more Persons to act as a co-trustee or co-trustees, or separate trustee or separate trustees, of all or any part of the Trust, and to vest in such Person or Persons, in such capacity and for the benefit of the Certificateholders, such title to the Trust, or any part thereof, and, subject to the other provisions of this Section 11.10, such powers, duties, obligations, rights and trusts as the Trustee may consider necessary or desirable; provided, however, that the Trustee shall exercise due care in the appointment of any co-trustee. No co-trustee or separate trustee hereunder shall be required to meet the terms of eligibility as a successor trustee under Section 11.06 and no notice to Certificateholders of the appointment of any co-trustee or separate trustee shall be required under Section 11.08.

(b) Every separate trustee and co-trustee shall, to the extent permitted by law, be appointed and act subject to the following provisions and conditions:

(i) all rights, powers, duties and obligations conferred or imposed upon the trustee shall be conferred or imposed upon and exercised or performed by the Trustee and such separate trustee or co-trustee jointly (it being understood that such separate trustee or co-trustee is not authorized to act separately without the Trustee joining in such act) except to the extent that under any laws of any jurisdiction in which any particular act or acts are to be performed (whether as Trustee hereunder or as successor to the Servicer hereunder) the Trustee shall be incompetent or unqualified to perform such act or acts, in which event such rights, powers, duties and obligations (including the holding of title to the Trust or any portion thereof in any such jurisdiction) shall be exercised and performed singly by such separate trustee or co-trustee, but solely at the direction of the Trustee;

(ii) no trustee hereunder shall be personally liable by reason of any act or omission of any other trustee hereunder; and

(iii) the Trustee may at any time accept the resignation of or remove any separate trustee or co-trustee.

 

-95-


(c) Any notice, request or other writing given to the Trustee shall be deemed to have been given to each of the then separate trustees and co-trustees, as effectively as if given to each of them. Every instrument appointing any separate trustee or co-trustee shall refer to this Agreement and the conditions of this Article XI. Each separate trustee and co-trustee, upon its acceptance of the trusts conferred, shall be vested with the estates or property specified in its instrument of appointment, either jointly with the Trustee or separately, as may be provided therein, subject to all the provisions of this Agreement, specifically including every provision of this Agreement relating to the conduct of, affecting the liability of, or affording protection to, the Trustee. Every such instrument shall be filed with the Trustee and a copy thereof given to the Transferor and the Servicer.

(d) Any separate trustee or co-trustee may at any time constitute the Trustee its agent or attorney-in-fact with full power and authority, to the extent not prohibited by law, to do any lawful act under or in respect to this Agreement on its behalf and in its name. If any separate trustee or co-trustee shall die, become incapable of acting, resign or be removed, all of its estates, properties, rights, remedies and trusts shall vest in and be exercised by the Trustee, to the extent permitted by law, without the appointment of a new or successor trustee.

Section 11.11. Tax Returns; Tax Liability. (a) In the event the Trust shall be required to file tax returns, the Servicer, at the expense of the Transferor, shall prepare or shall cause to be prepared any tax returns required to be filed by the Trust and shall remit such returns to the Trustee for signature at least five (5) days before such returns are due to be filed; the Trustee shall promptly sign such returns and deliver such returns after signature to the Servicer and such returns shall be filed, with a copy to the Transferor, by the Servicer. The Servicer in accordance with the terms of each Supplement shall also prepare or shall cause to be prepared all tax information required by law to be distributed to Investor Certificateholders. The Trustee, upon request, will furnish the Servicer with all such information known to the Trustee as may be reasonably required in connection with the preparation of all tax returns of the Trust. In no event shall the Trustee, the Servicer (except as provided in Section 8.04) or the Transferor be liable for any liabilities, costs or expenses of the Trust or the Investor Certificateholders arising under any tax law, including federal, state, local or foreign income or excise taxes or any other tax imposed on or measured by income (or any interest or penalty with respect thereto or arising from a failure to comply therewith).

(b) In the event that the Trust is classified as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, beginning with each taxable year after December 31, 2017, or if later, the date that Sections 6221 through 6241 of the Code apply to the Trust, the Transferor (or a U.S. Affiliate of the Transferor if the Transferor is ineligible) is hereby designated as the partnership representative under Section 6223(a) of the Code to the extent allowed under the law, and the Transferor agrees to cause the Trust to make such elections and take such other actions as may be required of it by this subsection 11.11(b). The Trust shall, to the extent eligible, make the election under Section 6221(b) of the Code with respect to determinations of adjustments at the partnership level and take any other action such as filings, disclosures and notifications necessary to effectuate such election. If the election described in the preceding sentence is not available, the Trust shall, to the extent eligible, make the election under Section 6226(a) of the Code with respect to the alternative to payment of imputed underpayments by a partnership and take any

 

-96-


other action such as filings, disclosures and notifications necessary to effectuate such election. Notwithstanding the foregoing, each of the Trust, the Transferor and the Servicer are authorized, in its sole discretion, to make any available election related to Sections 6221 through 6241 of the Code and take any action it deems necessary or appropriate to comply with the requirements of the Code and conduct the Trust’s affairs under Sections 6221 through 6241 of the Code.

Section 11.12. Trustee May Enforce Claims Without Possession of Certificates. All rights of action and claims under this Agreement or the Certificates may be prosecuted and enforced by the Trustee without the possession of any of the Certificates or the production thereof in any proceeding relating thereto, and any such proceeding instituted by the Trustee shall be brought in its own name as trustee. Any recovery of judgment shall, after provision for the payment of the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, be for the ratable benefit of the Certificateholders in respect of which such judgment has been obtained.

Section 11.13. Suits for Enforcement.

(a) If a Servicer Default shall occur and be continuing, the Trustee, in its discretion may, subject to the provisions of Sections 10.01 and 11.14, proceed to protect and enforce its rights and the rights of the Certificateholders under this Agreement by a suit, action or proceeding in equity or at law or otherwise, whether for the specific performance of any covenant or agreement contained in this Agreement or in aid of the execution of any power granted in this Agreement or for the enforcement of any other legal, equitable or other remedy as the Trustee, being advised by counsel, shall deem most effectual to protect and enforce any of the rights of the Trustee or the Certificateholders.

(b) In case there shall be pending, relative to the Transferor or any other obligor upon the Certificates of the affected Series or any Person having or claiming an ownership interest in the Trust Assets, proceedings under Title 11 of the United States Code or any other applicable federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar law, now or hereafter in effect, or in case a receiver, conservator, assignee, trustee in bankruptcy or reorganization, liquidator, sequestrator, custodian or other similar official shall have been appointed for or taken possession of the Transferor or its property or such other obligor or Person, or in case of any other comparable judicial proceedings relative to the Transferor or the property of the Trust or such other obligor or Person, the Trustee, regardless whether the principal of any Certificates shall then be due and payable as therein expressed or by declaration or otherwise and regardless whether the Trustee shall have made any demand pursuant to the provisions of this Section 11.13, shall be entitled and empowered, by intervention in such proceedings or otherwise:

(i) to file and prove a claim or claims for the whole amount of principal and interest owing and unpaid in respect of the Certificates of such Series, and to file such other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee (including any claim for reasonable compensation to the Trustee and each predecessor Trustee, and their respective agents, attorneys and counsel, and for reimbursement of all expenses and liabilities incurred, and all advances made, by the

 

-97-


Trustee and each predecessor Trustee, except as a result of negligence or bad faith) and of the Certificateholders of such Series, allowed in any proceedings relative to the Transferor or other obligor upon the Certificates, or to the property of the Transferor or such other obligor;

(ii) unless prohibited by applicable law and regulations, to vote on behalf of the Certificateholders of such Series, in any election of a trustee or a standby trustee in arrangement, reorganization, liquidation or other bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings or a Person performing similar functions in comparable proceedings; and

(iii) to collect and receive any monies or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims, and to distribute all amounts received with respect to the claims of the Certificateholders of such Series and of the Trustee on their behalf and to file such proofs of claim and other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee or the Holders of the Certificates of such Series, allowed in any judicial proceedings relative to the Transferor;

and any trustee, receiver, liquidator, custodian or other similar official in any such proceeding is hereby authorized by each of such Certificateholders to make payments to the Trustee, and, in the event that the Trustee shall consent to the making of payments directly to such Certificateholders, to pay to the Trustee such amounts as shall be sufficient to cover reasonable compensation to the Trustee, each predecessor Trustee and their respective agents, attorneys and counsel (including disbursements), and all other expenses and liabilities incurred, and all advances made, by the Trustee and each predecessor Trustee except as a result of negligence or bad faith.

(c) Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Certificateholder any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Investor Certificates or the rights of any Holder thereof, or to authorize the Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Certificateholder in any such proceeding; provided, however, that the Trustee may, on behalf of the Investor Certificateholders, vote for the election of a trustee in bankruptcy or similar official and be a member of a creditor’s or other similar committee.

Section 11.14. Rights of Certificateholders To Direct Trustee. Subject to Sections 2.12 and 15.02, Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any remedy, trust or power that does not relate to all Series, 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of all Series to which such remedy, trust or power relates) shall have the right to direct the time, method, and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee, or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee relating to such proceeding; provided, however, that, subject to Section 11.01, the Trustee shall have the right to decline to follow any such direction if the Trustee being advised by counsel determines that the action so directed may not lawfully be taken, or if the Trustee in good faith shall, by a Responsible Officer or Responsible Officers of the Trustee, determine that the proceedings so directed would be illegal or involve it in personal liability or be unduly prejudicial to the rights

 

-98-


of Certificateholders not parties to such direction; and provided further that nothing in this Agreement shall impair the right of the Trustee to take any action deemed proper by the Trustee and which is not inconsistent with such direction.

Section 11.15. Representations and Warranties of Trustee. The Trustee represents and warrants as of each Closing Date that:

(a) the Trustee is a banking corporation organized, existing and in good standing under the laws of the State of New York;

(b) the Trustee has full power, authority and right to execute, deliver and perform this Agreement and each Supplement, and has taken all necessary action to authorize the execution, delivery and performance by it of this Agreement and each Supplement; and

(c) this Agreement and each Supplement has been duly executed and delivered by the Trustee.

Section 11.16. Maintenance of Office or Agency. The Trustee will maintain at its expense an office or agency (the “Corporate Trust Office”) where notices and demands to or upon the Trustee in respect of the Certificates and this Agreement may be served (a) in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, in the case of Registered Certificates and Holders thereof, and (b) in London or Luxembourg, in the case of Bearer Certificates and Holders thereof, if and for so long as any Bearer Certificates are outstanding. The Corporate Trust Office shall initially be located at 101 Barclay Street, Floor 7 West, New York, New York 10286, Attention: Corporate Trust Administration-Asset Backed Securities. The Trustee will give prompt notice to the Servicer, the Transferor and Investor Certificateholders of any change in the location of the Certificate Register or any such office or agency.

Section 11.17. Confidentiality. Information provided by the Transferor or an Account Owner to the Trustee related to the transaction effected hereunder, including all information related to the Obligors with respect to the Receivables, and any computer software provided to the Trustee in connection with the transaction effected hereunder or under any Supplement, in each case whether in the form of documents, reports, lists, tapes, discs or any other form, shall be “Confidential Information.” The Trustee and its agents, representatives or employees shall at all times maintain the confidentiality of all Confidential Information and shall not, without the prior written consent of the Transferor or such Account Owner, disclose to third parties (including Certificateholders) or use such information, in any manner whatsoever, in whole or in part, except as expressly permitted under this Agreement or under any Supplement or as required to fulfill an obligation of the Trustee under this Agreement or under any Supplement, in which case such Confidential Information shall be revealed only to the extent expressly permitted or only to the Trustee’s agents, representatives and employees who need to know such Confidential Information to the extent required for the purpose of fulfilling an obligation of the Trustee under this Agreement or under any Supplement. Notwithstanding the above, Confidential Information may be disclosed to the extent required by law or legal process, provided that the Trustee gives prompt written notice to the Transferor or such Account Owner of the nature and scope of such disclosure.

 

-99-


ARTICLE XII

Termination

Section 12.01. Termination of Trust. The Trust and the respective obligations and responsibilities of the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee created hereby (other than the obligation of the Trustee to make payments to Investor Certificateholders as hereinafter set forth) shall terminate, except with respect to the duties described in Sections 7.04, 8.04 and 12.02(b), upon the earlier of (i) September 1, 2030, (ii) the day following the Distribution Date on which the Invested Amount and Enhancement Invested Amount for each Series is zero and (iii) the time provided in Section 9.02(c).

Section 12.02. Final Distribution.

(a) The Servicer shall give the Transferor and the Trustee at least thirty (30) days prior notice of the Distribution Date on which the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class may surrender their Investor Certificates for payment of the final distribution on and cancellation of such Investor Certificates (or, in the event of a final distribution resulting from the application of Section 2.06, 9.02 or 10.01, notice of such Distribution Date promptly after the Servicer has determined that a final distribution will occur, if such determination is made less than thirty (30) days prior to such Distribution Date). Such notice shall be accompanied by an Officer’s Certificate of the Servicer setting forth the information specified in Section 3.05 covering the period during the then-current calendar year through the date of such notice. Not later than the fifth day of the month in which the final distribution in respect of such Series or Class is payable to Investor Certificateholders, the Trustee shall provide notice to Investor Certificateholders of such Series or Class specifying (i) the date upon which final payment of such Series or Class will be made upon presentation and surrender of Investor Certificates of such Series or Class at the office or offices therein designated, (ii) the amount of any such final payment and (iii) that the Record Date otherwise applicable to such payment date is not applicable, payments being made only upon presentation and surrender of such Investor Certificates at the office or offices therein specified (which, in the case of Bearer Certificates, shall be outside the United States). The Trustee shall give such notice to the Transfer Agent and Registrar, the Transferor and the Paying Agent at the time such notice is given to Investor Certificateholders.

(b) Notwithstanding a final distribution to the Investor Certificateholders of any Series or Class (or the termination of the Trust), except as otherwise provided in this paragraph, all funds then on deposit in the Collection Account and any Series Account allocated to such Investor Certificateholders shall continue to be held in trust for the benefit of such Investor Certificateholders and the Paying Agent or the Trustee shall pay such funds to such Investor Certificateholders upon surrender of their Investor Certificates (and any excess shall be paid in accordance with the terms of any relevant Enhancement Agreement). In the event that all such Investor Certificateholders shall not surrender their Investor Certificates for cancellation within six (6) months after the date specified in the notice from the Trustee described in paragraph (a), the Trustee shall give a second notice to the remaining such Investor Certificateholders to surrender their Investor Certificates for cancellation and receive the final

 

-100-


distribution with respect thereto (which surrender and payment, in the case of Bearer Certificates, shall be outside the United States). If within one year after the second notice all such Investor Certificates shall not have been surrendered for cancellation, the Trustee may take appropriate steps, or may appoint an agent to take appropriate steps, to contact the remaining such Investor Certificateholders concerning surrender of their Investor Certificates, and the cost thereof shall be paid out of the funds in the Collection Account or any Series Account held for the benefit of such Investor Certificateholders. The Trustee and the Paying Agent shall pay to the Transferor any moneys held by them for the payment of principal or interest that remains unclaimed for two (2) years. After payment to the Transferor, Investor Certificateholders entitled to the money must look to the Transferor for payment as general creditors unless an applicable abandoned property law designates another Person.

(c) In the event that the Invested Amount (or Enhancement Invested Amount) with respect to any Series is greater than zero on the related Series Termination Date or such earlier date as is specified in the related Supplement (after giving effect to deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on such date), the Trustee will sell or cause to be sold on such Series Termination Date, in accordance with the procedures and subject to the conditions described in such Supplement, Principal Receivables and the related Finance Charge Receivables (or interests therein) in an amount equal to the Invested Amount and the Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, with respect to such Series on such date (after giving effect to such deposits and distributions; provided, however, that in no event shall such amount exceed such Series’ allocable share of Receivables on such Series Termination Date). The proceeds from any such sale shall be allocated and distributed in accordance with the terms of the applicable Supplement.

Section 12.03. Transferor’s Termination Rights. Upon the termination of the Trust pursuant to Section 12.01 and, if any part of the Transferor’s Interest is then evidenced by a certificate, the surrender of such part of the Transferor Certificates, the Trustee shall sell, assign and convey to the Transferor or its designee, without recourse, representation or warranty, all right, title and interest of the Trust in the Receivables and all other Trust Assets except for amounts held by the Trustee pursuant to Section 12.02(b). The Trustee shall execute and deliver such instruments of transfer and assignment, in each case without recourse, as shall be reasonably requested by the Transferor to vest in the Transferor or their designee all right, title and interest which the Trust had in the Receivables and such other Trust Assets.

Section 12.04. Defeasance. If so provided in the applicable Supplement:

(a) The Transferor may at its option be discharged from its obligations hereunder with respect to any Series or all outstanding Series (the “Defeased Series”) on the date the applicable conditions set forth in Section 12.04(c) are satisfied (“Defeasance”); provided, however, that the following rights, obligations, powers, duties and immunities shall survive with respect to the Defeased Series until otherwise terminated or discharged hereunder: (i) the rights of Holders of Investor Certificates of the Defeased Series to receive, solely from the trust fund provided for in Section 12.04(c), payments in respect of principal of and interest on such Investor Certificates when such payments are due; (ii) the Transferor’s obligations with respect to such Certificates under Sections 6.04 and 6.05; (iii) the rights, powers, trusts, duties and immunities of the Trustee, the Paying Agent and the Transfer Agent and Registrar hereunder; and (iv) this Section 12.04.

 

-101-


(b) Subject to Section 12.04(c), the Transferor at its option may cause Collections allocated to the Defeased Series and available to acquire additional Receivables to be applied to acquire Eligible Investments rather than additional Receivables.

(c) The following shall be the conditions to Defeasance under Section 12.04(a): (i) the Transferor irrevocably shall have deposited or caused to be deposited with the Trustee, under the terms of an irrevocable trust agreement in form and substance satisfactory to the Trustee, as trust funds in trust for making the payments described below, (A) Dollars in an amount, or (B) Eligible Investments which through the scheduled payment of principal and interest in respect thereof will provide, not later than the due date of payment thereon, money in an amount, or (C) a combination thereof, in each case sufficient to pay and discharge, and, which shall be applied by the Trustee to pay and discharge, all remaining scheduled interest and principal payments on all outstanding Investor Certificates of the Defeased Series on the dates scheduled for such payments in this Agreement and the applicable Supplements and all amounts owing to the Series Enhancers with respect to the Defeased Series; (ii) prior to its first exercise of its right pursuant to this Section 12.04 with respect to a Defeased Series to substitute money or Eligible Investments for Receivables, the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee a Tax Opinion with respect to such deposit and termination of obligations and an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that such deposit and termination of obligations will not result in the Trust being required to register as an “investment company” within the meaning of the Investment Company Act; (iii) the Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor stating that the Transferor reasonably believes that such deposit and termination of obligations will not, based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, then cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, with the giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series; and (iv) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that such deposit and termination of obligations will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee.

ARTICLE XIII

Miscellaneous Provisions

Section 13.01. Amendment; Waiver of Past Defaults.

(a) This Agreement or any Supplement may be amended from time to time (including in connection with (v) the issuance of a Supplemental Certificate, (w) the addition of Participation Interests to the Trust, (x) the designation of an Additional Transferor, (y) the assumption by an Assuming Entity of the Transferor’s obligations hereunder, or (z) the provision of additional Series Enhancement for the benefit of Certificateholders of any Series) by the Servicer, the Transferor and the Trustee without the consent of any of the Certificateholders; provided that (i) the Transferor shall have received written notice from each Rating Agency that

 

-102-


such amendment will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Servicer and the Trustee, (ii) if such amendment relates to the provision of additional Series Enhancement for any Series, each Transferor shall have delivered to the Trustee and each provider of Series Enhancement an Officer’s Certificate of the Transferor stating that the Transferor reasonably believes that such amendment will not based on the facts known to such officer at the time of such certification, have a material adverse effect on the interests of the Certificateholders, (iii) in the case of an amendment relating to the assumption by the Assuming Entity of a Transferor’s obligation, all other conditions to such assumption specified herein shall have been satisfied and (iv) the conditions set forth in Section 13.02(d) shall have been satisfied; provided further that an amendment pursuant to this Section 13.01(a) shall not effect a significant change in the Permitted Activities of the Trust.

(b) This Agreement or any Supplement may also be amended from time to time by the Servicer, the Transferor and the Trustee, (A) in the case of a significant change in the Permitted Activities of the Trust, with the consent of Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing Undivided Interests aggregating not less than 50% of the Invested Amount of each outstanding Series affected by such change, and (B) in all other cases with the consent of the Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 66 23% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of all adversely affected Series, for the purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of this Agreement or any Supplement or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Certificateholders; provided, however, that no such amendment shall (i) reduce in any manner the amount of or delay the timing of any distributions to be made to Investor Certificateholders or deposits of amounts to be so distributed or the amount available under any Series Enhancement without the consent of each affected Certificateholder, (ii) change the definition of or the manner of calculating the interest of any Investor Certificateholder without the consent of each affected Investor Certificateholder, (iii) reduce the aforesaid percentage required to consent to any such amendment without the consent of each Investor Certificateholder or (iv) adversely affect the rating of any Series or Class by any Rating Agency without the consent of the Holders of Investor Certificates of such Series or Class evidencing not less than 66 23% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of such Series or Class. Any amendment to be effected pursuant to this paragraph shall be deemed to adversely affect all outstanding Series, other than any Series with respect to which such action shall not, as evidenced by an Opinion of Counsel for the Transferor, addressed and delivered to the Trustee, adversely affect in any material respect the interests of any Investor Certificateholder of such Series. The Trustee may, but shall not be obligated to, enter into any such amendment which affects the Trustee’s rights, duties or immunities under this Agreement or otherwise.

(c) Promptly after the execution of any such amendment or consent (other than an amendment pursuant to paragraph (a)), the Trustee shall furnish notification of the substance of such amendment to each Investor Certificateholder, and the Servicer shall furnish notification of the substance of such amendment to each Rating Agency and each Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement.

(d) It shall not be necessary for the consent of Investor Certificateholders under this Section 13.01 to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment, but it shall

 

-103-


be sufficient if such consent shall approve the substance thereof. The manner of obtaining such consents and of evidencing the authorization of the execution thereof by Investor Certificateholders shall be subject to such reasonable requirements as the Trustee may prescribe.

(e) Any Supplement executed in accordance with the provisions of Section 6.03 shall not be considered an amendment to this Agreement for the purposes of this Section 13.01.

(f) The Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 66 23% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of each Series, or, with respect to any Series with two (2) or more Classes, of each Class (or, with respect to any default that does not relate to all Series, 66 23% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of each Series to which such default relates or, with respect to any such Series with two (2) or more classes, of each Class) may, on behalf of all Certificateholders, waive any default by the Transferor or the Servicer in the performance of their obligations hereunder and its consequences, except the failure to make any distributions required to be made to Investor Certificateholders or to make any required deposits of any amounts to be so distributed. Upon any such waiver of a past default, such default shall cease to exist, and any default arising therefrom shall be deemed to have been remedied for every purpose of this Agreement. No such waiver shall extend to any subsequent or other default or impair any right consequent thereon except to the extent expressly so waived.

Section 13.02. Protection of Right, Title and Interest to Trust.

(a) The Transferor shall cause this Agreement, all amendments and supplements hereto and all financing statements and amendments thereto and any other necessary documents covering the Certificateholders’ and the Trustee’s right, title and interest to the Trust and the Trust Assets to be promptly recorded, registered and filed, and at all times to be kept recorded, registered and filed, all in such manner and in such places as may be required by law fully to preserve and protect the right, title and interest of the Certificateholders and the Trustee hereunder to all property comprising the Trust and the Trust Assets. The Transferor shall deliver to the Trustee file stamped copies of, or filing receipts for, any document recorded, registered or filed as provided above, as soon as available following such recording, registration or filing. The Transferor shall cooperate fully with the Servicer in connection with the obligations set forth above and will execute any and all documents reasonably required to fulfill the intent of this paragraph.

(b) The Transferor shall not change its name or its type or jurisdiction of organization unless it has first (i) made all filings in all relevant jurisdictions under the UCC and other applicable law as are necessary to continue and maintain the first-priority perfected ownership or security interest of the Trustee in the Trust Assets, and (ii) delivered to the Trustee, with a copy to any Series Enhancer, an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that all necessary filings have been made under the UCC in all relevant jurisdictions as are necessary to continue and maintain the first-priority perfected ownership or security interest of the Trustee in the Trust Assets.

 

-104-


(c) [Reserved].

(d) The Transferor will deliver to the Trustee and any Series Enhancer entitled thereto pursuant to the relevant Supplement: (i) upon the execution and delivery of each amendment of this Agreement or any Supplement, an Opinion of Counsel to the effect specified in Exhibit H-1; (ii) on each Addition Date on which any Additional Accounts (other than Automatic Additional Accounts) are to be designated as Accounts pursuant to Section 2.08(a) or (b) and on each date specified in Section 2.08(c)(iii) with respect to the inclusion of Automatic Additional Accounts as Accounts, an Opinion of Counsel substantially in the form of Exhibit H-2, and on each Addition Date on which any Participation Interests are to be included in the Trust pursuant to Section 2.08(a) or (b), an Opinion of Counsel covering the same substantive legal issues addressed by Exhibit H-2 but conformed to the extent appropriate to relate to Participation Interests; and (iii) on or before April 30 of each year, beginning with April 30, 2003, an Opinion of Counsel substantially in the form of Exhibit H-2.

Section 13.03. Limitation on Rights of Certificateholders.

(a) The death or incapacity of any Certificateholder shall not operate to terminate this Agreement or the Trust, nor shall such death or incapacity entitle such Certificateholders’ legal representatives or heirs to claim an accounting or to take any action or commence any proceeding in any court for a partition or winding-up of the Trust, nor otherwise affect the rights, obligations and liabilities of the parties hereto or any of them.

(b) No Investor Certificateholder shall have any right to vote (except as expressly provided in this Agreement) or in any manner otherwise control the operation and management of the Trust, or the obligations of the parties hereto, nor shall anything herein set forth, or contained in the terms of the Certificates, be construed so as to constitute the Investor Certificateholders from time to time as partners or members of an association, nor shall any Investor Certificateholder be under any liability to any third person by reason of any action taken by the parties to this Agreement pursuant to any provision hereof.

(c) No Investor Certificateholder shall have any right by virtue of any provisions of this Agreement to institute any suit, action or proceeding in equity or at law upon or under or with respect to this Agreement, unless such Investor Certificateholder previously shall have made, and unless the Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all Investor Certificates (or, with respect to any such action, suit or proceeding that does not relate to all Series, 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Investor Certificates of all Series to which such action, suit or proceeding relates) shall have made, a request to the Trustee to institute such action, suit or proceeding in its own name as Trustee hereunder and shall have offered to the Trustee such reasonable indemnity as it may require against the costs, expenses and liabilities to be incurred therein or thereby, and the Trustee, for sixty (60) days after such request and offer of indemnity, shall have neglected or refused to institute any such action, suit or proceeding; it being understood and intended, and being expressly covenanted by each Investor Certificateholder with every other Investor Certificateholder and the Trustee, that no one or more Investor Certificateholders shall have any right in any manner whatever by virtue or by availing itself or themselves of any provisions of

 

-105-


this Agreement to affect, disturb or prejudice the rights of the holders of any other of the Investor Certificates, or to obtain or seek to obtain priority over or preference to any other such Investor Certificateholder, or to enforce any right under this Agreement, except in the manner herein provided and for the equal, ratable and common benefit of all Investor Certificateholders except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement. For the protection and enforcement of the provisions of this Section 13.03, each and every Investor Certificateholder and the Trustee shall be entitled to such relief as can be given either at law or in equity.

Section 13.04. GOVERNING LAW. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 13.05. Notices; Payments.

(a) All demands, notices, instructions, directions and communications (collectively, “Notices”) under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if personally delivered at, mailed by certified mail, return receipt requested and postage prepaid, sent by facsimile transmission, or sent by electronic mail or by such other means acceptable to the recipient (i) in the case of Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, to Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, 1680 Capital One Drive, McLean, VA 22102, Attention: General Counsel, with a copy to Managing Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets, (ii) in the case of Capital One Funding, LLC, to Capital One Funding, LLC, 140 East Shore Drive, Room 1071-B, Glen Allen, Virginia 23059, Attention: Assistant Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets, (iii) in the case of the Trustee, to The Bank of New York Mellon, 101 Barclay Street, 7W, New York, New York 10286, Attention: Corporate Trust Administration-Asset Backed Securities (facsimile no. 212-815-2493), (iv) in the case of Moody’s, to 99 Church Street, New York, New York 10007, Attention: ABS Monitoring (facsimile no. 212-298-7139), (v) in the case of Standard & Poor’s, to 55 Water Street, New York, New York 10041, Attention: Asset Backed Group (facsimile nos. 212-438-2648 and 617-557-5197), (vi) in the case of Fitch, to One State Street Plaza, New York, New York 10004, Attention: Asset Backed Surveillance (facsimile no. 212-635-0476), (vii) in the case of the Paying Agent or the Transfer Agent and Registrar, to The Bank of New York Mellon, 101 Barclay Street, 7W, New York, New York 10286, Attention: Corporate Trust Administration-Asset Backed Securities (facsimile no. 212-815-2493, electronic mail addresses stepper@bankofny.com and rbittner@bankofny.com), and (viii) to any other Person as specified in any Supplement; or, as to each party, at such other address, facsimile number or electronic mail address as shall be designated by such party in a written notice to each other party.

(b) Any Notice required or permitted to be given to a Holder of Registered Certificates shall be given by first-class mail, postage prepaid, at the address of such Holder as shown in the Certificate Register. No Notice shall be required to be mailed to a Holder of Bearer Certificates or Coupons but shall be given as provided below. Any Notice so mailed within the time prescribed in this Agreement shall be conclusively presumed to have been duly given, whether or not the Investor Certificateholder receives such Notice. In addition, (a) if and so long

 

-106-


as any Series or Class is listed on the Luxembourg Stock Exchange and such exchange shall so require, any Notice to Investor Certificateholders shall be published in an Authorized Newspaper of general circulation in Luxembourg within the time period prescribed in this Agreement and (b) in the case of any Series or Class with respect to which any Bearer Certificates are outstanding, any Notice required or permitted to be given to Investor Certificateholders of such Series or Class shall be published in an Authorized Newspaper within the time period prescribed in this Agreement.

(c) All Notices to be given to Funding, as Transferor, shall be deemed given if the Notice is provided to the address of Funding. All payments hereunder to Funding, as Transferor, or Capital One, as the Servicer, shall be made to such account as such party may specify in writing. All payments hereunder to the Transferor shall be deemed made if made to the account of Funding, as the case may be, as provided above.

Section 13.06. Rule 144A Information. For so long as any of the Investor Certificates of any Series or Class are “restricted securities” within the meaning of Rule 144(a)(3) under the Act, the Transferor, the Trustee, the Servicer and any Series Enhancer agree to cooperate with each other to provide to any Investor Certificateholders of such Series or Class and to any prospective purchaser of Certificates designated by such an Investor Certificateholder, upon the request of such Investor Certificateholder or prospective purchaser, any information required to be provided to such holder or prospective purchaser to satisfy the condition set forth in Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Act.

Section 13.07. Severability of Provisions. If any one or more of the covenants, agreements, provisions or terms of this Agreement shall for any reason whatsoever be held invalid, then such provisions shall be deemed severable from the remaining provisions of this Agreement and shall in no way affect the validity or enforceability of the remaining provisions or of the Certificates or the rights of the Certificateholders.

Section 13.08. Assignment. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, except as provided in Section 7.05 or Section 8.02, this Agreement may not be assigned by the Servicer unless the Servicer shall have (i) delivered notice to each Rating Agency of such assignment and (ii) received the prior consent of Holders of Investor Certificates evidencing not less than 66 23% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Investor Certificates.

Section 13.09. Certificates Nonassessable and Fully Paid. It is the intention of the parties to this Agreement that the Certificateholders shall not be personally liable for obligations of the Trust, that the interests in the Trust represented by the Certificates shall be nonassessable for any losses or expenses of the Trust or for any reason whatsoever and that Certificates upon authentication thereof by the Trustee pursuant to Section 6.02 are and shall be deemed fully paid.

Section 13.10. Further Assurances. The Transferor and the Servicer agree to do and perform, from time to time, any and all acts and to execute any and all further instruments required or reasonably requested by the Trustee more fully to effect the purposes of this Agreement, including the execution of any financing statements or amendments thereto relating to the Trust Assets for filing under the provisions of the UCC of any applicable jurisdiction.

 

-107-


Section 13.11. Nonpetition Covenant. Notwithstanding any prior termination of this Agreement, the Servicer, the Trustee, the Transferor, each Series Enhancer and each holder of a Supplemental Certificate shall not, prior to the date which is one year and one day after the termination of this Agreement with respect to the Trust, acquiesce, petition or otherwise invoke or cause the Trust to invoke the process of any Governmental Authority for the purpose of commencing or sustaining a case against the Trust under any federal or state bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law or appointing a receiver, liquidator, assignee, trustee, custodian, sequestrator or other similar official of the Trust or any substantial part of its property or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of the affairs of the Trust.

Notwithstanding any prior termination of this Agreement, neither the Servicer, the Trustee, any Series Enhancer, any holder of a Supplemental Certificate nor the Certificateholders shall institute, or join in instituting a proceeding against the Transferor under any Debtor Relief Law or other proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or similar law.

Section 13.12. No Waiver; Cumulative Remedies. No failure to exercise and no delay in exercising, on the part of the Trustee, the Transferor, the Servicer or the Certificateholders, any right, remedy, power or privilege under this Agreement shall operate as a waiver thereof; nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right, remedy, power or privilege under this Agreement preclude any other or further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other right, remedy, power or privilege. The rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided under this Agreement are cumulative and not exhaustive of any rights, remedies, powers and privileges provided by law.

Section 13.13. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in two (2) or more counterparts (and by different parties on separate counterparts), each of which shall be an original, but all of which together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

Section 13.14. Third-Party Beneficiaries. This Agreement will inure to the benefit of and be binding upon the parties hereto, the Certificateholders, any Series Enhancer (to the extent provided in this Agreement and the related Supplement) and their respective successors and permitted assigns. Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, no other Person will have any right or obligation hereunder.

Section 13.15. Actions by Certificateholders.

(a) Wherever in this Agreement a provision is made that an action may be taken or a Notice given by Certificateholders, such action or Notice may be taken or given by any Certificateholder, unless such provision requires a specific percentage of Certificateholders.

(b) Any Notice, request, authorization, direction, consent, waiver or other act by the Holder of a Certificate shall bind such Holder and every subsequent Holder of such Certificate and of any Certificate issued upon the registration of transfer thereof or in exchange

 

-108-


therefor or in lieu thereof in respect of anything done or omitted to be done by the Trustee, the Transferor or the Servicer in reliance thereon, whether or not notation of such action is made upon such Certificate.

Section 13.16. Merger and Integration. Except as specifically stated otherwise herein, this Agreement sets forth the entire understanding of the parties relating to the subject matter hereof, and all prior understandings, written or oral, are superseded by this Agreement. This Agreement may not be modified, amended, waived or supplemented except as provided herein.

Section 13.17. Headings. The headings herein are for purposes of reference only and shall not otherwise affect the meaning or interpretation of any provision hereof.

Section 13.18. Fiscal Year. The fiscal year of the Trust will end on the last day of each calendar year.

ARTICLE XIV

Compliance With Regulation AB

Section 14.01. Intent of the Parties; Reasonableness. The Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee acknowledge and agree that the purpose of this Article XIV is to facilitate compliance by the Transferor with the provisions of Regulation AB and related rules and regulations of the Commission. The Transferor shall not exercise its right to request delivery of information or other performance under these provisions other than in good faith, or for purposes other than the Transferor’s compliance with the Securities Act, the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder (or the provision in a private offering of disclosure comparable to that required under the Securities Act). The Trustee agrees to cooperate in good faith with any reasonable request by the Transferor for information regarding the Trustee which is required in order to enable the Transferor to comply with the provisions of Items 1103(a)(1), 1109(a)(1), 1109(a)(2), 1117, 1118, 1119 and 1122 of Regulation AB as it relates to the Trustee or to the Trustee’s obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement. The Servicer agrees to cooperate in good faith with any reasonable request by the Transferor for information regarding the Servicer which is required in order to enable the Transferor to comply with the provisions of Regulation AB as it relates to the Servicer or to the Servicer’s obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement.

Section 14.02. Additional Representations and Warranties of the Trustee. The Trustee shall be deemed to represent to the Transferor, as of the date on which information is provided to the Transferor under Section 14.03 that, except as disclosed in writing to the Transferor prior to such date to the best of its knowledge, but without independent investigation: (i) neither the execution, delivery and performance by the Trustee of this Agreement or any Supplement, the performance by the Trustee of its obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement nor the consummation of any of the transactions by the Trustee contemplated thereby, is in violation of any indenture, mortgage, bank credit agreement, note or bond purchase agreement, long-term lease, license or other agreement or instrument to which the Trustee is a

 

-109-


party or by which it is bound, which violation would have a material adverse effect on the Trustee’s ability to perform its obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement, or of any judgment or order applicable to the Trustee; and (ii) there are no proceedings pending or threatened against the Trustee in any court or before any governmental authority, agency or arbitration board or tribunal which, individually or in the aggregate, would have a material adverse effect on the right, power and authority of the Trustee to enter into this Agreement or any Supplement or to perform its obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement.

Section 14.03. Information to Be Provided by the Trustee. The Trustee shall (i) on or before the fifth Business Day of each month, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such information regarding the Trustee as is requested for the purpose of compliance with Item 1117 of Regulation AB, and (ii) as promptly as practicable following notice to or discovery by the Trustee of any changes to such information, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such updated information.

The Trustee shall (i) on or before the fifth Business Day of each January, April, July and October, provide to the Transferor such information regarding the Trustee as is requested for the purpose of compliance with Items 1103(a)(1), 1109(a)(1), 1109(a)(2), 1117, 1118 and 1119 of Regulation AB, and (ii) as promptly as practicable following notice to or discovery by the Trustee of any changes to such information, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such updated information. Such information shall include, at a minimum:

(A) the Trustee’s name and form of organization;

(B) a description of the extent to which the Trustee has had prior experience serving as a Trustee for asset-backed securities transactions involving credit card receivables;

(C) a description of any affiliation between the Trustee and any of the following parties to a Securitization Transaction, as such parties are identified to the Trustee by the Transferor in writing in advance of such Securitization Transaction:

(1) the sponsor;

(2) any depositor;

(3) the issuing entity;

(4) any servicer;

(5) any trustee;

(6) any originator;

(7) any significant obligor;

(8) any enhancement or support provider; and

(9) any other material transaction party.

In connection with the above-listed parties, a description of whether there is, and if so the general character of, any business relationship, agreement, arrangement, transaction or understanding that is entered into outside the ordinary course of business or is on terms other than would be obtained in an arm’s length transaction with an unrelated third party, apart from the asset-backed securities transaction, that currently exists or that existed during the past two years and that is material to an investor’s understanding of the asset-backed securities.

 

-110-


Section 14.04. Report on Assessment of Compliance and Attestation. On or before March 1 of each calendar year, commencing in 2007, the Trustee shall:

(i) deliver to the Transferor a report regarding the Trustee’s assessment of compliance with the Servicing Criteria during the immediately preceding calendar year, as required under Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 of the Exchange Act and Item 1122 of Regulation AB. Such report shall be addressed to the Transferor and signed by an authorized officer of the Trustee, and shall address each of the Servicing Criteria specified in Exhibit K or such criteria as mutually agreed upon by the Transferor and the Trustee;

(ii) deliver to the Transferor a report of a registered public accounting firm reasonably acceptable to the Transferor that attests to, and reports on, the assessment of compliance made by the Trustee and delivered pursuant to the preceding paragraph. Such attestation shall be in accordance with Rules 1-02(a)(3) and 2-02(g) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act;

(iii) deliver to the Transferor, in furtherance of Item 1122(c) of Regulation AB, written information sufficient to allow the Transferor, in cases where the Trustee identifies any material instance of noncompliance with the Servicing Criteria in the report delivered pursuant to Section 14.04(i), to disclose in its related annual report on Form 10-K whether such material instance of noncompliance relates to the Receivables or the Investor Certificates and whether and to what extent the Trustee has instituted steps to remediate each such material instance of noncompliance; and

(iv) deliver to the Transferor and any other Person that will be responsible for signing the certification (a “Sarbanes Certification”) required by Rules 13a-14(d) and 15d-14(d) under the Exchange Act (pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002) on behalf of the Trust, Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust or the Transferor with respect to a Securitization Transaction a certification substantially in the form attached hereto as Exhibit J or such form as mutually agreed upon by the Transferor and the Trustee.

The Trustee acknowledges that the parties identified in clause (iv) above may rely on the certification provided by the Trustee pursuant to such clause in signing a Sarbanes Certification and filing such with the Commission.

Section 14.05. Additional Representations and Warranties of the Servicer. The Servicer shall be deemed to represent to the Transferor, as of the date on which information is provided to the Transferor under Section 14.06 that, except as disclosed in writing to the Transferor prior to such date to the best of its knowledge: (i) the Servicer is not aware and has not received notice that any default, early amortization or other performance triggering event has occurred as to any other securitization due to any act or failure to act of the Servicer; (ii) the

 

-111-


Servicer has not been terminated as servicer in a securitization involving credit card receivables, either due to a servicing default or to application of a servicing performance test or trigger; (iii) no material noncompliance with the applicable servicing criteria with respect to other securitizations of credit card receivables involving the Servicer as servicer has been disclosed or reported by the Servicer; (iv) no material changes to the Servicer’s policies or procedures with respect to the servicing function it will perform under this Agreement and any Supplement have occurred during the three-year period immediately preceding the related Securitization Transaction; (v) there are no aspects of the Servicer’s financial condition that could have a material adverse effect on the performance by the Servicer of its servicing obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement; and (vi) there are no material legal or governmental proceedings pending (or known to be contemplated) against the Servicer, any Subservicer or any unaffiliated third-party originator of Receivables.

Section 14.06. Information to Be Provided by the Servicer. In connection with any Securitization Transaction, the Servicer shall (i) within five (5) Business Days following request by the Transferor, provide to the Transferor, in writing, the information specified in this Section, and (ii) as promptly as practicable following notice to or discovery by the Servicer of any changes to such information, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such updated information.

(a) If so requested by the Transferor, the Servicer shall provide to the Transferor such information regarding the Servicer and each Subservicer (each of the Servicer and each Subservicer, for purposes of this paragraph, a “Servicing Party”), as is requested for the purpose of compliance with Item 1108 of Regulation AB. Such information shall include, at a minimum:

(A) the Servicing Party’s name and form of organization;

(B) a description of how long the Servicing Party has been servicing credit card receivables; a general discussion of the Servicing Party’s experience in servicing assets of any type as well as a more detailed discussion of the Servicing Party’s experience in, and procedures for, the servicing function it will perform under this Agreement and any Supplement; information regarding the size, composition and growth of the Servicing Party’s portfolio of credit card accounts of a type similar to the Accounts and information on factors related to the Servicing Party that may be material, in the good faith judgment of the Transferor, to any analysis of the servicing of the Receivables or the related asset-backed securities, as applicable, including, without limitation:

(1) whether any prior securitizations of credit card receivables involving the Servicing Party defaulted or experienced an early amortization or other performance triggering event because of servicing during the three-year period immediately preceding the related Securitization Transaction;

(2) the extent of outsourcing the Servicing Party utilizes;

 

-112-


(3) whether there has been previous disclosure of material noncompliance with the applicable servicing criteria with respect to other securitizations of credit card receivables involving the Servicing Party as a servicer during the three-year period immediately preceding the related Securitization Transaction;

(4) whether the Servicing Party has been terminated as servicer in a securitization of credit card receivables, either due to a servicing default or to application of a servicing performance test or trigger; and

(5) such other information as the Transferor may reasonably request for the purpose of compliance with Item 1108(b)(2) of Regulation AB;

(C) a description of any material changes during the three-year period immediately preceding the related Securitization Transaction to the Servicing Party’s policies or procedures with respect to the servicing function it will perform under this Agreement and any Supplement;

(D) information regarding the Servicing Party’s financial condition, to the extent that there is a material risk that an adverse financial event or circumstance involving the Servicing Party could have a material adverse effect on the performance by the Servicing Party of its servicing obligations under this Agreement or any Supplement;

(E) a description of the Servicing Party’s processes and procedures designed to address any special or unique factors involved in servicing;

(F) a description of the Servicing Party’s processes for handling delinquencies, losses, bankruptcies and recoveries, such as sale of defaulted receivables; and

(G) information as to how the Servicing Party defines or determines delinquencies and charge-offs, including the effect of any grace period, re-aging, restructuring, partial payments considered current or other practices with respect to delinquency and loss experience.

(b) In addition to such information as the Servicer is obligated to provide pursuant to other provisions of this Agreement and any Supplement, if so requested by the Transferor, the Servicer shall provide to the Transferor such information regarding the performance or servicing of the Receivables as is reasonably required to facilitate preparation of distribution reports in accordance with Item 1121 of Regulation AB. Such information shall be provided concurrently with the distribution reports otherwise required to be delivered monthly by the Servicer under this Agreement and any Supplement, commencing with the first such report due not less than ten (10) Business Days following such request.

 

-113-


Section 14.07. Report on Assessment of Compliance and Attestation.

(a) The Servicer shall:

(i) on or before the 90th day following the end of each calendar year, commencing in 2007, deliver to the Transferor a report regarding the Servicer’s assessment of compliance with the Servicing Criteria during the immediately preceding calendar year, as required under Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 of the Exchange Act and Item 1122 of Regulation AB. Such report shall be addressed to the Transferor and signed by an authorized officer of the Servicer, and shall address each of the Servicing Criteria specified in Exhibit M or such criteria as mutually agreed upon by the Transferor and the Servicer;

(ii) on or before the 90th day following the end of each calendar year, commencing in 2007, deliver to the Transferor, the Trustee and each Rating Agency a report of a registered public accounting firm reasonably acceptable to the Transferor that attests to, and reports on, the assessment of compliance made by the Servicer and delivered pursuant to the preceding paragraph. Such attestation shall be in accordance with Rules 1-02(a)(3) and 2-02(g) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act;

(iii) cause each other Servicing Participant to deliver to the Transferor, the Servicer, the Trustee and Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust an assessment of compliance and accountants’ attestation as and when provided in paragraphs (i) and (ii) of this Section; provided, however, that if such other Servicing Participant is not an Affiliate of the Servicer, such assessment of compliance and accountants’ attestation shall be delivered on or before March 1 of each calendar year, commencing in 2007; and

(iv) cause each other Servicing Participant to deliver to the Transferor and any other Person that will be responsible for signing the Sarbanes Certification on behalf of the Trust, Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust or the Transferor with respect to a Securitization Transaction a certification on or before the 90th day following the end of each calendar year, commencing in 2007 in the form attached hereto as Exhibit L; provided, however, that if such other Servicing Participant is not an Affiliate of the Servicer, such certification shall be delivered on or before March 1 of each calendar year, commencing in 2007.

(b) The Servicer shall cause each other Servicing Participant to prepare an assessment of compliance that addresses each of the applicable Servicing Criteria specified in a document substantially in the form of Exhibit M hereto, and to deliver such assessment of compliance to the Transferor upon reasonable request of the Transferor.

Section 14.08. Use of Subservicers and Servicing Participants. The Servicer shall use its best efforts to hire or otherwise utilize only the services of Subservicers that agree to comply with the provisions of paragraph (a) of this Section. The Servicer shall use its best efforts to hire or otherwise utilize only the services of Servicing Participants, and shall use its

 

-114-


best efforts to ensure that Subservicers hire or otherwise utilize only the services of Servicing Participants, to fulfill any of the obligations of the Servicer as servicer under this Agreement or any Supplement, if those Servicing Participants agree to comply with the provisions of paragraph (b) of this Section.

(a) Except as may otherwise be required pursuant to Section 8.07, it shall not be necessary for the Servicer to seek the consent of the Transferor to the utilization of any Subservicer. The Servicer shall use its best efforts to cause any Subservicer used by the Servicer (or by any Subservicer) for the benefit of the Transferor to comply with the provisions of this Section and with Sections 3.05, 14.05, 14.06 and 14.07 of this Agreement to the same extent as if such Subservicer were the Servicer; provided, however, that this sentence shall not apply to Section 3.05 for Subservicers that only meet the criteria in Section 1108(a)(2)(iv) of Regulation AB and do not meet the criteria in Section 1108(a)(2)(i) through (iii) of Regulation AB. The Servicer shall be responsible for obtaining from each Subservicer and delivering to the Transferor any servicer compliance statement required to be delivered by such Subservicer under Section 3.05, any assessment of compliance and attestation required to be delivered by such Subservicer under Section 14.07 and any certification required to be delivered to the Person that will be responsible for signing the Sarbanes Certification under Section 14.07, in each case, as and when required to be delivered as determined by the Transferor.

(b) Except as may otherwise be required pursuant to Section 8.07, it shall not be necessary for the Servicer to seek the consent of the Transferor to the utilization of any Servicing Participant. The Servicer shall promptly upon request provide to the Transferor a written description (in form and substance satisfactory to the Transferor) of the role and function of each Servicing Participant utilized by the Servicer or any Subservicer, specifying (i) the identity of each such Servicing Participant and (ii) which elements of the Servicing Criteria will be addressed in assessments of compliance provided by each Servicing Participant.

As a condition to the utilization of any Servicing Participant, the Servicer shall use its best efforts to cause any such Servicing Participant used by the Servicer (or by any Subservicer) for the benefit of the Transferor to comply with the provisions of Sections 14.07 of this Agreement to the same extent as if such Servicing Participant were the Servicer. The Servicer shall be responsible for obtaining from each Servicing Participant and delivering to the Transferor any assessment of compliance and attestation required to be delivered by such Servicing Participant under Section 14.07, in each case as and when required to be delivered.

ARTICLE XV

Asset Representations Review Triggers

Section 15.01. Delinquency Trigger.

(a) The Servicer or the Transferor shall, on behalf of the Trust, provide written notice to the Trustee and disclose the occurrence of any Delinquency Trigger in the distribution report on Form 10-D for the distribution period in which such Delinquency Trigger occurs.

 

-115-


(b) The Transferor shall review and may adjust the Delinquency Trigger Rate upon the occurrence of any of the following events: (i) the filing of a registration statement with the Commission relating to any Notes (as defined in the Series 2002-CC Supplement hereto) or Investor Certificates to be offered and sold from time to time by the Transferor; and (ii) a change in law or regulation (including any new or revised interpretation of an existing law or regulation) that, in the Transferor’s judgment, could reasonably be expected to have a material effect on the delinquency rate for Obligor payments on the Accounts or the manner by which delinquencies are defined or determined; provided, however, that for so long as a Delinquency Trigger has occurred and is continuing, a review of the Delinquency Trigger Rate that would otherwise be required as specified above will be delayed until the date on which the Servicer or the Transferor shall, on behalf of the Trust, report in the applicable distribution report on Form 10-D that the Delinquency Trigger is no longer continuing.

(c) In the case of a review of the Delinquency Trigger Rate undertaken upon the occurrence of an event described in clause (i) of subsection 15.01(b), the Transferor may increase or decrease the Delinquency Trigger Rate by any amount it reasonably determines to be appropriate based on the composition of the Receivables at the time of the review. In the case of a review undertaken upon the occurrence of any event described in clause (ii) of subsection 15.01(b), the Transferor may increase or decrease the Delinquency Trigger Rate by any amount it reasonably determines to be appropriate as a result of the related change in law or regulation. The Servicer or the Transferor shall, on behalf of the Trust, disclose the Delinquency Trigger Rate, as adjusted, in the distribution report on Form 10-D for the distribution period in which the adjustment occurs, which report shall also include a description of how the adjusted Delinquency Trigger Rate was determined to be appropriate.

Section 15.02. Investor Action to Initiate an Asset Representations Review.

(a) Within 90 days following the date on which the Servicer or the Transferor, on behalf of the Trust, discloses the occurrence of a Delinquency Trigger pursuant to subsection 15.01(a), Holders of Investor Certificates holding at least 5% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Investor Certificates may submit a written petition to the Transferor and the Trustee directing that a vote be taken on whether to initiate an Asset Representations Review. For the avoidance of doubt, for so long as a Delinquency Trigger has occurred and is continuing, a new 90-day petition period shall commence each month, beginning on the date on which the Servicer or the Transferor, on behalf of the Trust, discloses in the related distribution report on Form 10-D that the Delinquency Trigger is continuing.

(b) If Holders of Investor Certificates submit a written petition directing that a vote be taken in accordance with subsection 15.02(a), then the Trustee shall (i) promptly provide written notice of such direction to all Holders of Investor Certificates by delivering notice of such direction to Holders of Investor Certificates at their addresses appearing on the Certificate Register and (ii) conduct a solicitation of votes of Holders of Investor Certificates to initiate a review, which solicitation of votes shall occur within 90 days of the delivery of such notice by the Trustee. If (x) a vote in which an Asset Review Quorum participates occurs within such 90-day period and (y) Holders of Investor Certificates holding more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Investor Certificates casting a vote direct that a

 

-116-


review be undertaken, then the Trustee shall promptly provide written notice to the Transferor, the Servicer, Capital One, and Holders of Investor Certificates in the same manner as described above. Upon receipt of such notice from the Trustee, the Servicer will promptly provide written notice to the Asset Representations Reviewer and an Asset Representations Review will commence in accordance with the terms set forth in the Asset Representations Review Agreement.

(c) Notwithstanding any provisions of this Article XV to the contrary, and subject to the additional requirements and conditions set forth in this Article XV, for so long as a petition to direct that a vote be taken, a vote itself, or an Asset Representations Review is underway in accordance with subsection 15.02(a), subsection 15.02(b), or the terms of the Asset Representations Review Agreement, respectively, Holders of Investor Certificates may not initiate another petition, vote, or Asset Representations Review unless and until such prior petition, vote, or Asset Representations Review is completed. For purposes of this subsection 15.02(c):

(i) a petition will be considered completed only (A) if the petition does not result in a vote, (B) if a vote occurs, such vote does not result in an Asset Representations Review, or (C) if an Asset Representations Review occurs, at such time as the Servicer or the Transferor, on behalf of the Trust, includes a summary of the Asset Representations Reviewer’s final report setting out the findings of its Asset Representations Review in a distribution report on Form 10-D in accordance with the terms of the Asset Representations Review Agreement;

(ii) a vote will be considered completed only (A) if the vote does not result in an Asset Representations Review or (B) if an Asset Representations Review occurs, at such time as the Servicer or the Transferor, on behalf of the Trust, includes a summary of the Asset Representations Reviewer’s final report setting out the findings of its Asset Representations Review in a distribution report on Form 10-D in accordance with the terms of the Asset Representations Review Agreement; and

(iii) an Asset Representations Review will be considered completed only at such time as the Servicer or the Transferor, on behalf of the Trust, includes a summary of the Asset Representations Reviewer’s final report setting out the findings of its Asset Representations Review in a distribution report on Form 10-D in accordance with the terms of the Asset Representations Review Agreement.

(d) If at the completion of an Asset Representations Review undertaken in accordance with the terms set forth in the Asset Representations Review Agreement, the Asset Representations Reviewer’s findings and conclusions indicate that any Receivables reviewed did not comply with the related representations and warranties, the Transferor shall investigate any such findings of non-compliance contained in the report and make a determination regarding whether any such non-compliance constitutes a breach of any contractual provision of this Agreement or the Receivables Purchase Agreement. If the Transferor determines that such a breach has occurred, it will provide notice of such breach to the Servicer and the Trustee.

 

-117-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,

as Transferor

By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

  Name:   Eric D. Bauder
  Title:   Assistant Vice President

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,

as Servicer

By:  

/s/ Daniel H. Rosen

  Name:   Daniel H. Rosen
  Title:   Managing Vice President, Treasury

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

not in its individual capacity but solely as the Trustee

By:  

/s/ Michael D. Commisso

  Name:   Michael D. Commisso
  Title:   Vice President


EXHIBIT A

FORM OF BASE CERTIFICATE

THIS BASE CERTIFICATE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED. NEITHER THIS BASE CERTIFICATE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED OR SOLD EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF SUCH ACT OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION PROVISIONS.

THIS BASE CERTIFICATE IS NOT PERMITTED TO BE TRANSFERRED, ASSIGNED, EXCHANGED OR OTHERWISE PLEDGED OR CONVEYED EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE TERMS OF THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN.

 

No. R-    One Unit

 

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

BASE CERTIFICATE

 

THIS CERTIFICATE REPRESENTS AN INTEREST

IN CERTAIN ASSETS OF THE

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

Evidencing an interest in a trust, the corpus of which consists primarily of receivables generated from time to time in the ordinary course of business in a portfolio of revolving credit card accounts and other revolving credit accounts owned by Capital One Bank (USA), National Association (the “Bank”) and, in certain circumstances, certain Additional Account Owners (as defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement referred to below).

(Not an interest in or obligation of the Transferor

or any affiliate thereof)

This certifies that CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC (“Funding”) is the registered owner of a fractional interest in the assets of a trust (the “Trust”) not allocated to the Certificateholders’ Interest or the interest of any holder of a Supplemental Certificate pursuant to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (as amended and supplemented, the “Agreement”), among the Bank, a national banking association, as the Servicer, Funding, a Virginia limited liability company, as Transferor (the “Transferor”), and The Bank of New York Mellon, a New York banking corporation, as Trustee (the “Trustee”). The corpus of the Trust consists of (i) a portfolio of all receivables (the “Receivables”) existing in the revolving credit card accounts and other revolving credit accounts identified under the Agreement from time to time (the “Accounts”), (ii) all Receivables generated under the Accounts from time to time thereafter, (iii) funds collected or to be collected

 

A-1


from accountholders in respect of the Receivables, (iv) all funds which are from time to time on deposit in the Collection Account and in the Series Accounts, (v) an interest in any Funds Collateral relating to secured accounts, (vi) the benefits of any Series Enhancements issued and to be issued by Series Enhancers with respect to one or more Series of Investor Certificates, (vii) the rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of the Transferor with respect to the Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007, as amended on March 1, 2008 and March 17, 2016, between the Bank and Funding, and (viii) all other assets and interests constituting the Trust Assets. Although a summary of certain provisions of the Agreement is set forth below, this Certificate does not purport to summarize the Agreement and reference is made to the Agreement for information with respect to the interests, rights, benefits, obligations, proceeds and duties evidenced hereby and the rights, duties and obligations of the Trustee. A copy of the Agreement may be requested from the Trustee by writing to the Trustee at the Corporate Trust Office. To the extent not defined herein, the capitalized terms used herein have the meanings ascribed to them in the Agreement.

This Certificate is issued under and is subject to the terms, provisions and conditions of the Agreement, to which Agreement, as amended and supplemented from time to time, the Transferor by virtue of the acceptance hereof assents and is bound.

The Receivables consist of Principal Receivables which arise generally from the purchase of merchandise and services and amounts advanced to cardholders as cash advances and Finance Charge Receivables which arise generally from Periodic Finance Charges, Late Charges, annual membership fees and other fees and charges with respect to the Accounts.

This Certificate is the Base Certificate, which represents the Transferor’s Interest in certain assets of the Trust, including the right to receive a portion of the Collections and other amounts at the times and in the amounts specified in the Agreement. The aggregate interest represented by the Base Certificate at any time in the Receivables in the Trust shall not exceed the Transferor’s Interest at such time. In addition to the Base Certificate, (i) Investor Certificates will be issued to investors pursuant to the Agreement, which will represent the Certificateholders’ Interest, and (ii) Supplemental Certificates may be issued pursuant to the Agreement, which will represent that portion of the Transferor’s Interest not allocated to the Transferor. This Base Certificate shall not represent any interest in the Collection Account or the Series Accounts, except as expressly provided in the Agreement, or any Series Enhancements.

The Transferor has entered into the Agreement, and this Certificate is issued, with the intention that, for Federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes only, the Investor Certificates will qualify as indebtedness of the Transferor secured by the Receivables. The Transferor, by entering into the Agreement and by the acceptance of this Certificate, agrees to treat such Investor Certificates for Federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes as indebtedness.

Subject to certain conditions and exceptions specified in the Agreement, the obligations created by the Agreement and the Trust created thereby shall terminate upon the earlier of (i) September 1, 2030, (ii) the day following the Distribution Date on which the Invested Amount and Enhancement Invested Amount, if any, for each Series is zero and (iii) the time provided in Section 9.02(c) of the Agreement.

 

A-2


Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by or on behalf of the Trustee, by manual signature, this Certificate shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Agreement or be valid for any purpose.

 

A-3


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Transferor has caused this Certificate to be duly executed.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,
as Transferor
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

Dated:             , 20        

 

A-4


TRUSTEE’S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is the Base Certificate described in the within-mentioned Agreement.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,  
as Trustee,  
By  

 

 
  Authorized Officer  
Or  
By  

 

 

,

 

as Authenticating Agent

for the Trustee

 
By  

 

 
  Authorized Officer  

 

A-5


EXHIBIT B

FORM OF ASSIGNMENT OF RECEIVABLES IN ADDITIONAL ACCOUNTS

(As required by Section 2.08 of

the Pooling and Servicing Agreement)

ASSIGNMENT No.     OF RECEIVABLES IN ADDITIONAL ACCOUNTS, dated as of              , 20    1 (the “Assignment”), by and among CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association, as Servicer (the “Servicer”), CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company, as Transferor (the “Transferor), and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation, as Trustee (the “Trustee”), pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement referred to below.

WITNESSETH

WHEREAS, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee are parties to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (as amended and supplemented from time to time, the “Agreement”);

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Agreement, Capital One Funding, LLC (the “Transferor”) wishes to designate Additional Accounts (which may include Secured Accounts) owned by the Transferor to be included as Accounts and to convey the (i) Receivables of such Additional Accounts, whether existing on the Additional Cut-Off Date or thereafter created, and (ii), with respect to Additional Accounts that are Secured Accounts, the Funds Collateral relating to such Additional Accounts, to the Trust as part of the corpus of the Trust; and

WHEREAS, the Trustee is willing to accept such designation and conveyance subject to the terms and conditions hereof;

NOW, THEREFORE, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee hereby agree as follows:

1. Defined Terms. All capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings ascribed to them in the Agreement unless otherwise defined herein.

“Additional Account” shall have the meaning specified in Section 2 of this Assignment.

 

1  To be dated as of the applicable Document Delivery Date

 

B-1


“Addition Date” shall mean, with respect to the Additional Accounts designated hereby,              , 20    .

“Additional Cut-Off Date” shall mean, with respect to the Additional Accounts designated hereby,              , 20    .

2. Designation of Additional Accounts. The Transferor does hereby deliver to the Trustee herewith a computer file or a microfiche list containing a true and complete schedule identifying all of the Additional Accounts (including any Secured Accounts) designated hereby (the “Additional Accounts”) specifying for each Additional Account, as of the Additional Cut-Off Date, its account number, the collection status, the aggregate amount of Receivables outstanding in such Additional Account, the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables outstanding in such Additional Account and, for any Funds Collateral with respect to Additional Accounts that are Secured Accounts, if any, the account number for, and the amount of funds on deposit in, the Deposit Account with respect to such Additional Account, which computer file or microfiche list shall supplement Schedule 1 to the Agreement. Such computer file or microfiche list shall be, as of the date of this Assignment, incorporated into and made part of this Agreement and the Agreement and is marked as Schedule 1 to this Assignment.

3. Conveyance. (a) The Transferor does hereby transfer, assign, set over and otherwise convey to the Trustee, without recourse, all of its right, title and interest in, to and under the Receivables of the Additional Accounts existing at the close of business on the Additional Cut-Off Date and thereafter created from time to time until the termination of the Trust, the Funds Collateral, if any, relating to such Additional Accounts, all moneys due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect thereto and all proceeds (including “proceeds” as defined in the UCC and including Insurance Proceeds and Recoveries) thereof, and the related Interchange payable pursuant to Section 2.07(i) of the Agreement. This paragraph 3(a) does not constitute and is not intended to result in the creation or assumption by the Trust, the Trustee, any Investor Certificateholder or any Series Enhancer of any obligation of the Servicer, the Transferor or any other Person in connection with the Accounts, the Receivables, the Funds Collateral or under any agreement or instrument relating thereto, including any obligation to Obligors, merchant banks, merchants’ clearance systems, VISA, MasterCard or insurers.

(b) If necessary, in connection with such transfer, assignment, set over and conveyance, the Transferor agrees to record and file, at its own expense, financing statements (and continuation statements when applicable) with respect to the Receivables and the Funds Collateral, if any, now existing or hereafter created in such Additional Accounts, meeting the requirements of applicable state law in such manner and in such jurisdictions as are necessary or appropriate to perfect, and maintain the perfection of, the sale and assignment of such Receivables and Funds Collateral to the Trust, and to deliver a file stamped copy of each such financing statement or other evidence of such filing to the Trustee on or prior to the Addition Date. The Trustee shall be under no obligation whatsoever to file such financing statement, continuation statement or amendment to such financing statement, or make any other filing under the UCC in connection with such sale and assignment.

 

B-2


(c) In connection with such conveyance, the Transferor has, at its own expense, on or prior to the date of this Assignment, indicated clearly and unambiguously in its computer files, and caused the Depository to indicate in its files, that all Receivables created in connection with, and all Funds Collateral, if any, relating to, the Additional Accounts have been conveyed to the Trustee pursuant to the Agreement and this Assignment for the benefit of the Certificateholders.

(d) The parties hereto intend that the transfer of Receivables, any Funds Collateral, and other property pursuant to this Assignment constitute a sale, and not a secured borrowing, for accounting purposes. If the transfer pursuant to this Assignment is not deemed to be a sale, the Transferor shall be deemed hereunder to have granted and does hereby grant to the Trustee a security interest in all of its right, title and interest, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in, to and under the Receivables of the Additional Accounts existing at the close of business on the Additional Cut-Off Date and thereafter created from time to time until the termination of the Trust, the Funds Collateral, if any, relating to the Additional Accounts, all moneys due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect thereto and all proceeds (including “proceeds” as defined in the UCC and including Insurance Proceeds and Recoveries) thereof and the related Interchange payable pursuant to Section 2.07(i) of the Agreement. This Assignment constitutes a security agreement under the UCC.

(e) The Transferor hereby appoints the Trustee as its attorney-in-fact with full authority in the place and stead of the Transferor and in the name of the Transferor or otherwise from time to time in the Trustee’s discretion to take any action and to execute any instrument that the Trustee may deem necessary or advisable to accomplish the purposes of this Assignment, including, without limitation, to ask, demand, collect, sue for, recover, compromise, receive and give acquittances and receipts for moneys due or to become due under or in connection with the Funds Collateral, receive, endorse and collect all drafts or other instruments and documents made payable to the Transferor in connection therewith or representing any payment, dividend or other distribution in respect of the Funds Collateral or any part thereof and to give full discharge for the same and the Trustee may as such attorney-in-fact, file any claims or take any action or institute any proceedings which the Trustee may deem to be necessary or desirable for the collection thereon or to enforce compliance with the terms and conditions of this Assignment and the Agreement.

4. Acceptance by Trustee. The Trustee hereby acknowledges its acceptance on behalf of the Trust of all right, title and interest to the property, now existing and hereafter created, conveyed to the Trust pursuant to Section 3 of this Assignment, and declares that it shall maintain such right, title and interest, upon the trust set forth in the Agreement for the benefit of all Certificateholders. The Trustee further acknowledges that, prior to or simultaneously with the execution and delivery of this Assignment, the Transferor delivered to the Trustee the computer file or microfiche list described in Section 2 of this Assignment.

5. Withdrawal of Funds from the Deposit Account. (a) Acting in accordance with its customary and usual servicing procedures for servicing Secured Accounts and in accordance with the Lending Guidelines, the Servicer shall, upon withdrawing funds from a Deposit Account, apply an amount up to the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables

 

B-3


outstanding in the Additional Account for which such amounts are being withdrawn, plus any Finance Charge Receivables related to such Additional Account, and deposit such amount into the Collection Account for treatment as Collections of Principal Receivables and Finance Charge Receivables, respectively. Any proceeds of the Funds Collateral received by the Transferor shall be held in trust by the Transferor for and as the Trustee’s property and shall not be commingled with the Transferor’s other funds or properties.

(b) The Transferor shall, at its own cost and expense, maintain satisfactory and complete records of the Funds Collateral, including, without limitation, a record of all deposits made by or on behalf of each Obligor into the Deposit Account, all credits granted and debits made with respect to such Obligor’s interest in the Deposit Account, and all other dealings with the Deposit Account. The Transferor will deliver and turn over to the Trustee or to its representatives at any time on demand of the Trustee the Deposit Documents

6. Representations and Warranties of the Transferor. The Transferor hereby represents and warrants to the Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, as of the date of this Assignment and as of the Addition Date, that:

(a) Legal, Valid and Binding Obligation. This Assignment constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Transferor enforceable against the Transferor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship or other similar laws now or hereafter in effect affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights in general or the rights of creditors of a Virginia limited liability company and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity).

(b) Eligibility of Accounts. Each Additional Account designated hereby is an Eligible Account.

(c) No Lien. Each Receivable created in connection with, and all Funds Collateral relating to, the Additional Accounts have been transferred to the Trust free and clear of any Lien other than (i) Liens permitted under subsection 2.07(b) of the Agreement, (ii) any tax or governmental lien or other nonconsensual lien and (iii) with respect to Funds Collateral, Liens granted in favor of the Transferor by an Obligor.

(d) Classification. The Receivables described in Section 3 of this Assignment constitute “accounts” within the meaning of the applicable UCC.

(e) Federal Deposit Insurance. Each Obligor of a Secured Account holds a beneficial ownership interest in the Funds sufficient to afford such Obligor separate federal deposit insurance with respect to the portion of the Deposit Account attributable to such Obligor.

(f) Insolvency. As of each of the Additional Cut-Off Date and the Addition Date, no Insolvency Event with respect to the Transferor has occurred and the transfer by the Transferor of Receivables arising in the Additional Accounts to the Trust has not been made in contemplation of the occurrence thereof.

 

B-4


(g) Pay Out Event. The Transferor reasonably believes that the addition of the Receivables arising in the Additional Accounts will not, based on the facts known to the Transferor, cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series.

(h) Security Interest. This Assignment constitutes a valid sale, transfer and assignment to the Trustee of all right, title and interest of the Transferor in the Receivables now existing or hereafter created in the Additional Accounts and the Funds Collateral, if any, relating to the Additional Accounts, all moneys due or to become due and all amounts received with respect thereto and the proceeds (including “proceeds” as defined in the UCC as in effect in the Commonwealth of Virginia and including Insurance Proceeds and Recoveries) thereof, and the Interchange payable pursuant to Section 2.07(i) of the Agreement or, if this Assignment does not constitute a sale of such property, it constitutes a grant of a security interest in such property to the Trustee, which, in the case of existing Receivables, Funds Collateral, and the proceeds thereof is enforceable upon execution and delivery of this Assignment, and which will be enforceable with respect to such Receivables and Funds Collateral hereafter created and the proceeds thereof upon such creation. Upon the filing of the financing statements described in Section 3 of this Assignment and, in the case of the Receivables and Funds Collateral hereafter created and the proceeds thereof, upon the creation thereof, the Trustee shall have a first priority perfected security or ownership interest in the Transferor’s rights in such property and proceeds.

(i) Creation. At the time of its transfer of any Receivable to the Trustee pursuant to this Assignment, the Transferor owned and had good and marketable title to such Receivable free and clear of any lien, claim or encumbrance of any Person.

(j) Perfection. The Transferor has caused or will cause, within ten (10) days of the initial execution of this Assignment, the filing of all appropriate financing statements in the proper filing office in the appropriate jurisdictions under applicable law in order to perfect the security interest in the Receivables granted to the Trustee pursuant to this Assignment.

(k) Priority. Other than the transfer and security interest granted to the Trustee pursuant to this Assignment, the Transferor has not pledged, assigned, sold, granted a security interest in, or otherwise conveyed the Receivables described in Section 3 of this Assignment. The Transferor has not authorized the filing of and is not aware of any financing statements against the Transferor that include a description of such Receivables other than any financing statement relating to the transfer and security interest granted to the Trustee pursuant to the Agreement and this Assignment or that has been terminated. The Transferor is not aware of any judgment or tax lien filings against the Transferor.

 

B-5


(l) No Conflict. The execution and delivery by the Transferor of this Assignment, the performance of the transactions contemplated by this Assignment and the fulfillment of the terms hereof applicable to the Transferor, will not conflict with or violate the articles of incorporation or bylaws of the Transferor or conflict with, result in any breach of any of the terms and provisions of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time or both) a material default under, any indenture, contract, agreement, mortgage, deed of trust or other instrument to which the Transferor is a party or by which it or its properties are bound.

(m) No Proceedings. There are no Proceedings or investigations pending or, to the best knowledge of the Transferor, threatened against the Transferor, before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency or other tribunal or governmental instrumentality (i) asserting the invalidity of this Assignment, (ii) seeking to prevent the consummation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Assignment, (iii) seeking any determination or ruling that, in the reasonable judgment of the Transferor, would materially and adversely affect the performance by the Transferor of its obligations under this Assignment or (iv) seeking any determination or ruling that would materially and adversely affect the validity or enforceability of this Assignment.

(n) All Consents. All authorizations, consents, orders or other actions of any Person or of any Governmental Authority required to be obtained by the Transferor in connection with the execution and delivery of this Assignment by the Transferor and the performance of the transactions contemplated by this Assignment by the Transferor, have been obtained.

(o) No Material Adverse Effect. None of the terms of this Assignment, including the addition to the Trust of the Receivables created in connection with, and the Funds Collateral relating to, the Additional Accounts, will have a material adverse effect on the interests of the Certificateholders.

The representations and warranties in clauses (d) and (g) through (j) above shall survive until the termination of the Agreement. Such representations and warranties speak of the date of this Assignment and as of the Addition Date but shall not be waived by any of the parties to this Assignment unless each Rating Agency shall have notified the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee in writing that such waiver will not result in a reduction or withdrawal of the rating of any outstanding Series or Class to which it is a Rating Agency.

7. Covenants of the Transferor. The Transferor hereby covenants and agrees with the Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, as follows:

(a) Transfers, Liens, Etc. Except for the conveyances hereunder, and except as otherwise provided under the Agreement, the Transferor shall not sell, pledge, assign or transfer to any other Person, or grant, create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien upon or with respect to any Receivable created in connection with, or the Funds Collateral relating to, the Additional Accounts, whether now existing or hereafter created.

 

B-6


(b) Notice of Liens. The Transferor shall notify the Trustee and each Series Enhancer entitled to such notice pursuant to the relevant Supplement promptly after becoming aware of any Lien on any Receivable created in connection with, or on the Funds Collateral relating to, the Additional Accounts, other than (i) the conveyances hereunder, (ii) Liens permitted under Section 2.07(b) of the Agreement, (iii) any tax or governmental lien or other nonconsensual lien or (iv) with respect to Funds Collateral, Liens granted in favor of the Seller by an Obligor.

(c) Federal Deposit Insurance. The Transferor will maintain or cause to be maintained records regarding each Obligor’s beneficial ownership interest in the Funds sufficient to afford such Obligor separate federal deposit insurance with respect to the portion of the Deposit Account attributable to such Obligor.

(d) Location of Deposit Account. The Transferor shall not move the location of any Deposit Account without the prior written consent of Moody’s, Standard & Poor’s and Fitch.

(e) Servicer Default. If the Servicer is the Depository, the Transferor shall, upon the occurrence of a Servicer Default, immediately move the location of the Deposit Account to an Eligible Institution.

8. Covenant of Servicer. The Servicer hereby covenants and agrees with the Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, that it will take no action which, nor omit to take any action the omission of which, would substantially impair the rights of the Certificateholders in the Receivables created in connection with, or the Funds Collateral relating to, the Additional Accounts.

9. Reassignment of Receivables and Funds Collateral.

(a) The parties hereto hereby agree that any reassignment or assignment of Receivables to the Transferor or the Servicer required pursuant to Section 2.05, 2.06 or 3.03 of the Agreement shall include the Receivables of the Additional Accounts and the Funds Collateral, if any, related to such Receivables.

(b) In the event any representation or warranty of the Transferor contained in Section 6(c), (d) or (e) hereof is not true and correct in any material respect as of the date hereof or the date specified therein, as applicable, and such breach (individually or together with any other breach or breaches then existing) has a material adverse effect on the Certificateholders’ Interests of all Series in the Receivables of the Additional Accounts or related Funds Collateral, if any, transferred to the Trust (which determination shall be made without regard to the availability of funds under any Series Enhancement) and remains uncured for 60 days (or such longer period, not in excess of 150 days, as may be agreed to by the Trustee) after the earlier to occur of the discovery thereof by the Transferor or receipt by the Transferor of notice thereof given by the Trustee, then the remedy provided under Section 2.05 of the Agreement (including the proviso thereto) shall apply with respect to each of the Receivables and the related Funds Collateral, if any, transferred to the Trust pursuant to this Assignment as if set forth herein.

(c) In the event any representation or warranty of the Transferor contained in Section 6(h) hereof is not true and correct in any material respect and such breach has a material adverse effect on the Certificateholders’ Interests of all Series in the Receivables of the Additional Accounts or the related Funds Collateral, if any, then the remedy provided under Section 2.06 of the Agreement (including the proviso thereto) shall apply with respect to each of the Receivables and the related Funds Collateral, if any, transferred to the Trust pursuant to this Assignment as if set forth herein.

 

B-7


10. Ratification of Agreement. As amended and supplemented by this Assignment, the Agreement is in all respects ratified and confirmed and the Agreement as so supplemented by this Assignment shall be read, taken and construed as one and the same instrument.

11. Counterparts. This Assignment may be executed in two or more counterparts (and by different parties on separate counterparts), each of which shall be an original, but all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument.

12. GOVERNING LAW. THIS ASSIGNMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

 

B-8


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee have caused this Assignment to be duly executed by their respective officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,
as Transferor
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
as Servicer
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,
as Trustee
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

B-9


EXHIBIT C

FORM OF REASSIGNMENT OF RECEIVABLES IN REMOVED ACCOUNTS

(As required by Section 2.09 of

the Pooling and Servicing Agreement)

REASSIGNMENT OF RECEIVABLES, dated as of             , 20    , by and among CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association, as Servicer (the “Servicer”), CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company as Transferor (the “Transferor”), and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation, as Trustee (the “Trustee”), pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement referred to below.

WITNESSETH:

WHEREAS, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee are parties to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (as amended and supplemented, the “Agreement”);

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Agreement, Capital One Funding, LLC (the “Transferor”) wishes to remove from the Trust all Receivables in certain designated Accounts and to cause the Trustee to reconvey the Receivables of such Removed Accounts, whether now existing or hereafter created, from the Trust to the Transferor; and

WHEREAS, the Trustee is willing to accept such designation and to reconvey the Receivables in the Removed Accounts subject to the terms and conditions hereof;

NOW, THEREFORE, the Transferor and the Trustee hereby agree as follows:

1. Defined Terms. All terms defined in the Agreement and used herein shall have such defined meanings when used herein, unless otherwise defined herein.

Removal Date” shall mean, with respect to the Removed Accounts designated hereby,             , 20    .

2. Designation of Removed Accounts. On or before the date that is 10 Business Days after the Removal Date, the Transferor will deliver to the Trustee a computer file or microfiche list containing a true and complete list of the Accounts designated for removal hereby (the “Removed Accounts”) specifying for each such Account, as of the Removal Date, its account number, the aggregate amount outstanding in such Account, the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in such Account and, for any Funds Collateral relating to such Account, the account number for, and the amount of funds on deposit in, the applicable Deposit Account, which computer file or microfiche list shall be marked as Schedule 1 to this Reassignment and shall supplement Schedule 1 to the Agreement.

 

C-1


3. Conveyance of Receivables. (a) The Trustee does hereby release its lien on and security interest in, and does hereby sell, transfer, assign, set over and otherwise convey to the Transferor, without recourse, all of its right, title and interest of the Trust in, to and under the Receivables existing at the close of business on the Removal Date and thereafter created from time to time in the Removed Accounts, the Funds Collateral, if any, relating to such Additional Accounts, all moneys due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect thereto and all proceeds (including “proceeds” as defined in the UCC and including Insurance Proceeds and Recoveries) thereof, and the related Interchange otherwise payable pursuant to Section 2.07(i) of the Agreement.

(b) In connection with such transfer, the Trustee agrees to execute and deliver to the Transferor on or prior to the date this Reassignment is delivered, applicable termination statements with respect to the Receivables existing at the close of business on the Removal Date and thereafter created from time to time in the Removed Accounts and the proceeds thereof evidencing the release by the Trust of its interest in such Receivables and proceeds, and meeting the requirements of applicable state law, in such manner and such jurisdictions as are necessary to terminate such interest.

4. Representations and Warranties of the Transferor. The Transferor hereby represents and warrants to the Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, as of the Removal Date:

(a) Legal, Valid and Binding Obligation. This Reassignment constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Transferor enforceable against the Transferor, in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship or other similar laws now or hereafter in effect affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights in general or the rights of creditors of a Virginia limited liability company, and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity); and

(b) Pay Out Event. The Transferor reasonably believes that (A) the removal of the Receivables existing in the Removed Accounts will not, based on the facts known to the Transferor, cause a Pay Out Event or any event that, after giving of notice or the lapse of time, would constitute a Pay Out Event to occur with respect to any Series and (B) no selection procedure reasonably believed by the Transferor to be materially adverse to the interests of the Investor Certificateholders was used in selecting the Removed Accounts.

(c) List of Removed Accounts. The list of Removed Accounts delivered pursuant to Section 2.09(a) of the Agreement, as of the Removal Date, is true and complete in all material respects.

5. Ratification of Agreement. As amended and supplemented by this Reassignment, the Agreement is in all respects ratified and confirmed and the Agreement as so supplemented by this Reassignment shall be read, taken and construed as one and the same instrument.

 

C-2


6. Counterparts. This Reassignment may be executed in two or more counterparts (and by different parties on separate counterparts), each of which shall be an original, but all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument.

7. GOVERNING LAW. THIS REASSIGNMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Transferor and the Trustee have caused this Reassignment to be duly executed by their respective officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,
as Transferor
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,
at Trustee
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

C-3


EXHIBIT D

FORM OF ANNUAL SERVICER’S CERTIFICATE

(To be delivered on or before March 31 of

each calendar year beginning with March 31, 2006,

pursuant to Section 3.05 of the Pooling and

Servicing Agreement referred to below)

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION

 

 

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

 

 

The undersigned, a duly authorized representative of Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer (the “Bank”), pursuant to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (as amended and supplemented, the “Agreement”), among the Bank, as Servicer, Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, does hereby certify that:

1. The Bank is, as of the date hereof, the Servicer under the Agreement. Capitalized terms used in this Certificate have their respective meanings as set forth in the Agreement.

2. The undersigned is a Servicing Officer who is duly authorized pursuant to the Agreement to execute and deliver this Certificate to the Trustee.

3. A review of the activities of the Servicer during the calendar year ended December 31, 20    , and of its performance under the Agreement was conducted under my supervision.

4. Based on such review, the Servicer has, to the best of my knowledge, performed in all material respects its obligations under the Agreement throughout such calendar year and no default in the performance of such obligations in any material respect has occurred or is continuing except as set forth in paragraph 5 below.

5. The following is a description of each default in the performance of the Servicer’s obligations under the provisions of the Agreement known to me to have been made by the Servicer during the year ended December 31, 20    , which sets forth in detail (i) the nature of each such default, (ii) the action taken by the Servicer, if any, to remedy each such default and (iii) the current status of each such default: [If applicable, insert “None.”]

 

D-1


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has duly executed this Certificate this     day of         , 20    .

 

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION
as Servicer
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

D-2


EXHIBIT E-1

THIS CERTIFICATE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “1933 ACT”). NEITHER THIS CERTIFICATE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED OR SOLD EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF THE 1933 ACT AND ANY APPLICABLE PROVISIONS OF ANY STATE BLUE SKY OR SECURITIES LAWS OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS CERTIFICATE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN.

THIS CERTIFICATE MAY NOT BE ACQUIRED BY OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A BENEFIT PLAN (AS DEFINED BELOW).

 

E-1-1


EXHIBIT E-2

[FORM OF REPRESENTATION LETTER]

[Date]

The Bank of New York Mellon

101 Barclay Street, 7W

New York, New York 10286

Attention: Corporate Trust Administration - Asset Backed Securities

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association

1680 Capital One Drive

McLean, Virginia 22102

Capital One Funding, LLC

140 East Shore Drive

Room 1071-B

Glen Allen, Virginia 23059

 

  Re: Purchase of $        1/ principal amount of Capital One

Master Trust Series [    ] [    %] [Floating Rate] Asset

Backed Certificates

Dear Ladies and Gentlemen:

In connection with our purchase of the above Asset Backed Certificates (the “Certificates”) we confirm that:

(i) we understand that the Certificates are not being registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “1933 Act”), and are being sold to us in a transaction that is exempt from the registration requirements of the 1933 Act;

(ii) any information we desire concerning the Certificates or any other matter relevant to our decision to purchase the Certificates is or has been made available to us;

(iii) we have such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters as to be capable of evaluating the merits and risks of an investment in the Certificates, and we (and any account for which we are purchasing under paragraph (iv) below) are able to bear the economic risk of an investment in the Certificates; we (and any account for which we are purchasing under paragraph (iv) below) are an “accredited investor” (as such term is defined in Rule 501(a)(1), (2) or (3) of Regulation D under the 1933 Act); and we are not, and none of such accounts is, a Benefit Plan;

 

1      /     Not less than $250,000 minimum principal amount.

 

E-2-1


(iv) we are acquiring the Certificates for our own account or for accounts as to which we exercise sole investment discretion and not with a view to any distribution of the Certificates, subject, nevertheless, to the understanding that the disposition, of our property shall at all times be and remain within our control;

(v) we agree that the Certificates must be held indefinitely by us unless subsequently registered under the 1933 Act or an exemption from any registration requirements of that Act and any applicable state securities law is available;

(vi) we agree that in the event that at some future time we wish to dispose of or exchange any of the Certificates (such disposition or exchange not being currently foreseen or contemplated), we will not transfer or exchange any of the Certificates unless:

(A)(1) the sale is of at least U.S. $250,000 principal amount of Certificates to an Eligible Purchaser (as defined below), (2) a letter to substantially the same effect as paragraphs (i), (ii), (iii), (iv), (v) and (vi) of this letter is executed promptly by the purchaser and (3) all offers or solicitations in connection with the sale, whether directly or through any agent acting on our behalf, are limited only to Eligible Purchasers and are not made by means of any form of general solicitation or general advertising whatsoever; or

(B) the Certificates are transferred pursuant to Rule 144 under the 1933 Act by us after we have held them for more than three (3) years; or

(C) the Certificates are sold in any other transaction that does not require registration under the 1933 Act and, if the Transferor, the Servicer, the Trustee or the Transfer Agent and Registrar so requests, we theretofore have furnished to such party an opinion of counsel satisfactory to such party, in form and substance satisfactory to such party, to such effect; or

(D) the Certificates are transferred pursuant to an exception from the registration requirements of the 1933 Act under Rule 144A under the 1933 Act; and

(vii) we understand that the Certificates will bear a legend to substantially the following effect:

“THIS CERTIFICATE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “1933 ACT”). NEITHER THIS CERTIFICATE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF THE 1933 ACT AND ANY APPLICABLE PROVISIONS OF ANY STATE BLUE SKY OR SECURITIES LAWS OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS CERTIFICATE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN.”

 

E-2-2


[“THE HOLDER OF THIS CERTIFICATE BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF REPRESENTS AND WARRANTS, FOR THE BENEFIT OF CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, THAT SUCH HOLDER IS NOT (1) AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN THAT IS SUBJECT TO THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED, (2) A PLAN OR OTHER ARRANGEMENT (INCLUDING AN INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ACCOUNT OR KEOGH PLAN) THAT IS SUBJECT TO SECTION 4975 OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED, OR (3) AN ENTITY WHOSE UNDERLYING ASSETS INCLUDE “PLAN ASSETS” UNDER THE PLAN ASSET REGULATION BY REASON OF ANY SUCH PLAN’S INVESTMENT IN THE ENTITY.”]

The first paragraph of this legend may be removed if the Transferor, the Servicer, the Trustee and the Transfer Agent and Registrar have received an opinion of counsel satisfactory to them, in form and substance satisfactory to them, to the effect that such paragraph may be removed.

Eligible Purchaser” means either an Eligible Dealer or a corporation, partnership or other entity which we have reasonable grounds to believe and do believe can make representations with respect to itself to substantially the same effect as the representations set forth herein. “Eligible Dealer” means any corporation or other entity the principal business of which is acting as a broker and/or dealer in securities. “Benefit Plan” means any employee benefit plan, trust or account, including an individual retirement account, that is subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 or that is described in Section 4975(e)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 or an entity whose underlying assets include plan assets by reason of a plan’s investment in such entity. Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings given to such terms in the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, among Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as servicer, Capital One Funding, LLC, as transferor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee.

 

Very truly yours,

 

  (Name of Purchaser)
by  

 

  (Authorized Officer)

 

E-2-3


EXHIBIT E-3

THE HOLDER OF THIS CERTIFICATE BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF REPRESENTS AND WARRANTS, FOR THE BENEFIT OF CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, THAT SUCH HOLDER IS NOT (1) AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN THAT IS SUBJECT TO THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED, (2) A PLAN OR OTHER ARRANGEMENT (INCLUDING AN INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ACCOUNT OR KEOGH PLAN) THAT IS SUBJECT TO SECTION 4975 OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED, OR (3) AN ENTITY WHOSE UNDERLYING ASSETS INCLUDE “PLAN ASSETS” UNDER THE PLAN ASSET REGULATION BY REASON OF ANY SUCH PLAN’S INVESTMENT IN THE ENTITY.

 

E-3-1


EXHIBIT F

[RESERVED]

 

F-1


EXHIBIT G-1

(FORM OF CLEARANCE SYSTEM CERTIFICATE

TO BE GIVEN TO THE TRUSTEE BY EUROCLEAR OR

CLEARSTREAM FOR DELIVERY OF DEFINITIVE CERTIFICATES

IN EXCHANGE FOR A PORTION OF A

TEMPORARY GLOBAL SECURITY]

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST,

Series [    ] [    %] [Floating Rate]

Asset Backed Certificates

[Insert title or sufficient description

of Certificates to be delivered]

We refer to that portion of the temporary Global Certificate in respect of the above-captioned issue which is herewith submitted to be exchanged for definitive Certificates (the “Submitted Portion”) as provided in the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, (as amended and supplemented, the “Agreement”) in respect of such issue. This is to certify that (i) we have received a certificate or certificates, in writing or by tested telex, with respect to each of the-persons appearing in our records as being entitled to a beneficial interest in the Submitted Portion and with respect to such persons beneficial interest either (a) from such person, substantially in the form of Exhibit G-2 to the Agreement, or (b) from             , substantially in the form of Exhibit G-3 to the Agreement, and (ii) the Submitted Portion includes no part of the temporary Global Certificate excepted in such certificates.

We further certify that as of the date hereof we have not received any notification from any of the persons giving such certificates to the effect that the statements made by them with respect to any part of the Submitted Portion are no longer true and cannot be relied on as of the date hereof.

 

G-1-1


We understand that this certificate is required in connection with certain securities and tax laws in the United States of America. If administrative or legal proceedings are commenced or threatened in connection with which this certificate is or would be relevant, we irrevocably authorize you to produce this certificate or a copy thereof to any interested party in such proceedings.

 

Dated:            ,    1/     [Euroclear Bank, S.A./N.V.,
    as operator of the
    Euroclear System]2/
    [Clearstream Banking, société anonyme]2/
    by  

 

 

1      /     To be dated on the Exchange Date.
2      /     Delete the inappropriate reference.

 

G-1-2


EXHIBIT G-2

[FORM OF CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED

TO EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM

BY [INSERT NAME OF MANAGER]

WITH RESPECT TO REGISTERED CERTIFICATES SOLD TO

QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYERS]

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST,

Series [    ] [    %] [Floating Rate]

Asset Backed Certificates

In connection with the initial issuance and placement of the above referenced Asset Backed Certificates (the “Certificates”), an institutional investor in the United States (“institutional investor”) is purchasing U.S. $        aggregate principal amount of the Certificates held in our account at [Euroclear Bank, S.A./N.V., as operator of the Euroclear System] [Clearstream Banking, société anonyme] on behalf of such investor.

We reasonably believe that such institutional investor is a qualified institutional buyer as such term is defined under Rule 144A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

[We understand that this certificate is required in connection with United States laws. We irrevocably authorize you to produce this certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceedings or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered by this certificate.]

The Definitive Certificates in respect of this certificate are to be issued in registered form in the minimum denomination of U.S. $500,000 and such Definitive Certificates (and, unless the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Supplement relating to the Certificates otherwise provides, any Certificates issued in exchange or substitution for or on registration of transfer of Certificates) shall bear the following legend:

“THIS CERTIFICATE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE UNITED STATES SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED. NEITHER THIS CERTIFICATE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED OR SOLD, DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, IN THE UNITED STATES OR TO U.S. PERSONS (EACH AS DEFINED HEREIN), EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF SUCH ACT OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS CERTIFICATE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE AMENDED AND RESTATED POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN. THIS CERTIFICATE CANNOT BE EXCHANGED FOR A BEARER CERTIFICATE.”

Dated:         , 20    

 

[                    ],
  by  

 

  Authorized Officer

 

G-2-1


EXHIBIT G-3

[FORM OF CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED

TO EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM BY A BENEFICIAL OWNER

OF CERTIFICATES, OTHER THAN A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER]

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST,

Series [    ] [    %] [Floating Rate]

Asset Backed Certificates

This is to certify that as of the date hereof and except as provided in the third paragraph hereof, the above-captioned Certificates held by you for our account (i) are owned by a person that is a United States person, or (ii) are owned by a United States person that is (A) the foreign branch of a United States financial institution (as defined in U.S. Treasury Regulations Section 1.165-12(c)(1)(v)) (a “financial institution”) purchasing for its own account or for resale, or (B) a United States person who acquired the Certificates through the foreign branch of a financial institution and who holds the Certificates through the financial institution oh the date hereof (and in either case (A) or (B), the financial institution hereby agrees to comply with the requirements of Section 165(j)(3)(A), (B) or (C) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the regulations thereunder), or (iii) are owned by a financial institution for purposes of resale during the Restricted Period (as defined in U.S. Treasury Regulations Section 1.163-5(6)(2)(i)(D)(7)). In addition, financial institutions described in clause (iii) of the preceding sentence (whether or not also described in clause (i) or (ii)) certify that they have not acquired the Certificates for purposes of resale directly or indirectly to a United States person or to a person within the United States or its possessions.

We undertake to advise you by tested telex if the above statement as to beneficial ownership is not correct on the date of delivery of the above-captioned Certificates in bearer form with respect to such of said Certificates as then appear in your books as being held for our account.

This certificate excepts and does not relate to U.S. $        principal amount of Certificates held by you for our account, as to which we are not yet able to certify beneficial ownership. We understand that delivery of Definitive Certificates in such principal amount cannot be made until we are able to so certify.

We understand that this certificate is required in connection with certain securities and tax laws in the United States of America. If administrative or legal proceedings are commenced or threatened in connection with which this certificate is or would be relevant, we irrevocably authorize you to produce this certificate or a copy thereof to any interested party in such proceedings. As used herein, “United States” means the United States of America (including the States and the District of Columbia), its territories, its possessions and other areas subject to its jurisdiction; and “United States person” means a citizen or resident of the United States, a corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, or any political subdivision thereof, or an estate or trust the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source.

 

G-3-1


Dated:    1/     by  

 

      As, or as agent for, the
      beneficial owner(s) of the
      interest in the Certificates to
      which this certificate relates.

 

1      /     This Certificate must be dated on the earliest of the date of the first actual payment of interest in respect of the Certificates and the date of the delivery of the Certificates in definitive form.

 

G-3-2


EXHIBIT H-1

FORM OF OPINION OF COUNSEL

WITH RESPECT TO AMENDMENTS

Provisions to be included in

Opinion of Counsel to be delivered pursuant

to Section 13.02(d)(i)

The opinions to the effect of the matters set forth below may be subject to all the qualifications, assumptions, limitations and exceptions taken or made in the Opinions of Counsel delivered on any applicable Closing Date and may reflect the form and substance of such previously delivered Opinions of Counsel.

(i) The amendment to the [Pooling and Servicing Agreement], [Supplement], attached hereto as Schedule 1 (the “Amendment”), has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Transferor and constitutes the legal, valid and binding agreement of the Transferor, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or other laws from time to time in effect affecting creditors’ rights generally or the rights of creditors of a national banking association. The enforceability of the Transferor’s obligations is also subject to general principles of equity (regardless of whether such enforceability is considered in a proceeding in equity or at law).

(ii) The Amendment has been entered into in accordance with the terms and provisions of Section 13.01 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

 

H-1-1


EXHIBIT H-2

FORM OF OPINION OF COUNSEL

WITH RESPECT TO ACCOUNTS

PROVISIONS TO BE INCLUDED IN

opinion of Counsel to be

delivered pursuant to

Section 13.02(d)(ii) or (iii)

The opinions to the effect of the matters set forth below may be subject to all the qualifications, assumptions, limitations and exceptions taken or made in the Opinions of Counsel delivered on any applicable Closing Date and may reflect the form and substance of such previously delivered Opinions of Counsel.

1. The Receivables constitute “accounts,” as defined in the UCC.

2. The Amended and Restated Pooling and Services Agreement creates in favor of the Trustee a security interest in the Receivables and the proceeds thereof. Such security interest is perfected and of first priority.

 

H-2-1


EXHIBIT I

FORM OF ASSUMPTION AGREEMENT

ASSUMPTION AGREEMENT (the “Agreement”), dated as of             , 20    (the “Assumption Date”), by and among CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association (the “Bank”),CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company (“Funding”), [                    ] (the “Assuming Entity”), a [                    ], and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation (the “Trustee”), pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement referred to below.

WHEREAS, Funding and the Trustee are parties to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (hereinafter as such agreement may have been, or from time to time be, amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “Pooling and Servicing Agreement”);

WHEREAS, Funding wishes to assign, transfer and convey all of its revolving credit card accounts and other revolving credit accounts and the receivables arising thereunder, which may include all, but not less than all, of the Accounts and Funding’s remaining interest in the receivables arising thereunder, its interest in the Participation Interests and its Transferor’s Interest (collectively, the “Assigned Assets”), together with all servicing functions and other obligations under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or relating to the transactions contemplated thereby (collectively, the “Assumed Obligations”) pursuant to Section 7.05 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement;

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Assuming Entity and Funding must comply with the provisions of Section 7.05 thereof in order for the bank to transfer such Assigned Assets and Assumed obligations to the Assuming Entity; and

WHEREAS, the Trustee is willing to accept an assumption by the Assuming Entity subject to the terms and conditions hereof and of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

NOW, THEREFORE, Funding, the Assuming Entity and the Trustee hereby agree as follows:

1. Defined Terms. All terms defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and used herein shall have such defined meanings when used herein, unless otherwise defined herein.

2. Designation of Accounts. In connection with such conveyance, the Assuming Entity agrees, at its own expense, on or prior to the Assumption Date, to deliver to the Trustee, a computer file or microfiche list containing a true and complete list of all such Accounts or Participation Interests transferred by the Funding to the Assuming Entity pursuant to this Agreement, specifying (x) for each such Account, as of the Assumption Date, (i) its account number, (ii) the collection status, (iii) the aggregate amount of Receivables outstanding in such

 

I-1


Account and (iv) the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables outstanding in such Account and (y) for each such Participation Interests, as of the Assumption Date, information comparable to the information delivered under (x) above. Such file shall be marked as Schedule 1 to this Agreement and, as of the Assumption Date, shall be incorporated into and made a part of this Agreement.

3. Assumption of Assigned Assets and Assumed Obligations. (a) The Assuming Entity hereby agrees that on and after the Assumption Date it shall be bound by all the provisions and requirements of and assume all of the responsibilities and duties under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement applicable to the Servicer.

(b) In connection with such assumption, the Assuming Entity agrees to record and file at its own expense, any financing statements (and continuation statements with respect to such financing statements when applicable) with respect to (i) the Receivables now existing and created on or after the Assumption Date in the Accounts designated hereby (which may be a single financing statement with respect to all such Receivables) for the transfer of or the grant of a security interest in “accounts” or as defined in the UCC as in effect in the State of [            ] and (ii) all other Trust Assets as defined in Section 2.01 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement now existing and created an or after the Assumption Date, meeting the requirements of applicable state law in such manner and in such jurisdiction as are necessary to perfect the transfer and assignment of such Receivables and other Trust Assets to the Trustee, and to deliver a file-stamped copy of such financing statement or financing statements or other evidence of such filing (which may, for purposes of this Section 3, consist of telephone confirmation of such filing, confirmed within 24 hours in writing) to the Trustee on or prior to the Assumption Date.

(c) In connection with such transfer, the Assuming Entity further agrees, at its own expense, on or prior to the date of this Agreement to clearly indicate in its computer files that Receivables created In connection with the Accounts or Participation Interests designated hereby have been conveyed to the Trust pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and this Agreement for the benefit of the Investor Certificateholders.

4. Accepted by Trustee. The Trustee hereby acknowledges its acceptance on behalf of the Trust of such assumption. The Trustee further acknowledges that, prior to or simultaneously with the execution and delivery of this Agreement, the Assuming Entity delivered to the Trustee the computer, file, or microfiche list described in Section 2 of this Agreement. The foregoing assumption does not constitute and is not intended to result in a creation or an assumption by the Trust, the Trustee or any Investor Certificateholder of any obligation of the Servicer, Funding, the Assuming Entity or any other Person in connection with the Account, the Receivables or any agreement or instrument relating thereto, including, without limitation, any obligation to any obligors, merchant banks, merchants clearance system, VISA, MasterCard or insurers, except as expressly provided herein.

5. Representations and Warranties of the Assuming Entity and Funding. In addition to the representations and warranties deemed to have been made by the Assuming Entity in respect of the Accounts and Receivables thereunder pursuant to Section 7.05 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Assuming Entity and Funding hereby also represent and warrant to the Trust as of the Assumption Date:

(a) Legal, Valid and Binding Obligation. This Agreement constitutes a legal, valid, and binding Obligation of the Assuming Entity and Funding, enforceable against the Assuming Entity and Funding in accordance with its terms, subject to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship or other similar laws now or hereafter in affect affecting creditors’ rights in general and the rights of creditors of a Virginia limited liability company and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity).

 

I-2


(b) Insolvency. None of the Assuming Entity or Funding is insolvent or bankrupt; and, after giving effect to the conveyance of the Assigned Assets and the Assumed Obligations to the Assuming Entity by Funding, neither the Assuming Entity nor Funding will be insolvent or bankrupt;

(c) Security Interest. The security interest of the Trustee in the Receivables and other Trust Assets continues to remain in full force and effect and has not been interrupted or impaired by the signing of this Agreement and such security interest remains prior to all others except as set forth in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement; and

(d) Qualification. The Assuming Entity (i) is legally qualified to service the Accounts, (ii) is eligible to maintain the Collection Account as set forth in Section 4.02 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and (iii) is qualified to use the software that the Servicer is currently using to service the Account or has obtained the right to use or has its own software that is adequate to perform its duties as Servicer under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

6. Conditions Precedent. The acceptance of the Trustee set forth in Section 4 and the amendment of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement set forth in Section 7 are subject to the satisfaction, on or prior to the Assumption Date, of the conditions precedent referred to in Section 7.05 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and of the following additional conditions precedent:

(a) Funding shall have transferred the Base Certificate to the Assuming Entity as set forth in Section 7.05 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and references to the Bank as it relates to the Base Certificate shall refer to only the Assuming Entity.

(b) The payment of any other consideration has been completed as certified by the Assuming Entity to the Trustee.

(c) The Assuming Entity shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate, dated the Assumption Date, stating that the Assuming Entity is eligible to maintain the Collection Account pursuant to section 4.02 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

(d) The Assuming Entity shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate, dated the Assumption Date, in which an officer of the Assuming Entity shall state that the representations and warranties of the Assuming Entity in its capacity as Transferor under Section 2.03 and Section 7.04 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement are true and correct.

 

I-3


7. Amendment of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. The Pooling and Servicing Agreement is hereby amended to provide that all references therein to the “Pooling and Servicing Agreement,” to “this Agreement” and “herein” shall be deemed from and after the Assumption Date to be a dual reference to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement as supplemented by this Agreement and all other Supplements thereto. The Assuming Entity and Funding hereby agree that from and after the Assumption Date the term “Transferor” in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement shall refer to the Assuming Entity. Except as expressly amended hereby, all of the representations, warranties, terms, covenants and conditions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement shall remain unamended and shall continue to be, and shall remain, in full force and effect in accordance with its terms and, except as expressly provided herein, the execution and delivery of this Agreement by the Trustee shall not constitute or be deemed to constitute a waiver of compliance with or a consent to non-compliance with any term or provision of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

8. Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

9. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in two (2) or more counterparts (and by different parties on separate counterparts), each of which shall be an original, but all of which together shall constitute but one and the same instrument.

 

I-4


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have caused this Agreement to be duly executed and delivered by their respective duly authorized officers on the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
as Servicer
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
[ASSUMING ENTITY],
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

as Trustee,

By:  

 

  Title:

 

I-5


EXHIBIT J

FORM OF ANNUAL CERTIFICATION

 

  Re: The [            ] agreement dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “Agreement”), among [IDENTIFY PARTIES]

I,                                         , the                                                  of [NAME OF COMPANY] (the “Company”), certify to the Transferor, and its officers, with the knowledge and intent that they will rely upon this certification, that:

(1) I have reviewed the report on assessment of the Company’s compliance provided in accordance with Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), and Item 1122 of Regulation AB (the “Servicing Assessment”), the registered public accounting firm’s attestation report provided in accordance with Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 under the Exchange Act and Section 1122(b) of Regulation AB (the “Attestation Report”), and any other information provided in furtherance of Section 1122(c) of Regulation AB pursuant to Section 14.04(iii) of the Agreement (the “Servicing Assessment Supplemental Information”), that were delivered by the Company to the Transferor pursuant to the Agreement (collectively, the “Company Information”);

(2) To the best of my knowledge, the Servicing Assessment and any Servicing Assessment Supplemental Information, taken as a whole, does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in the light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period of time covered by the Servicing Assessment;

(3) To the best of my knowledge, all of the Company Information required to be provided by the Company under the Agreement has been provided to the Transferor; and

(4) To the best of my knowledge, except as disclosed in the Servicing Assessment or the Attestation Report, the Company has fulfilled its obligations under the Agreement.

 

Date:  

 

By:  

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

J-1


EXHIBIT K

SERVICING CRITERIA TO BE ADDRESSED IN ASSESSMENT OF COMPLIANCE

The assessment of compliance to be delivered by the Trustee shall address, at a minimum, the criteria identified as below as “Applicable Servicing Criteria”:

 

Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable
Servicing Criteria

Reference

  

Criteria

    
   General Servicing Considerations   
1122(d)(1)(i)    Policies and procedures are instituted to monitor any performance or other triggers and events of default in accordance with the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(1)(ii)    If any material servicing activities are outsourced to third parties, policies and procedures are instituted to monitor the third party’s performance and compliance with such servicing activities.   
1122(d)(1)(iii)    Any requirements in the transaction agreements to maintain a back-up servicer for the credit card accounts or accounts are maintained.   
1122(d)(1)(iv)    A fidelity bond and errors and omissions policy is in effect on the party participating in the servicing function throughout the reporting period in the amount of coverage required by and otherwise in accordance with the terms of the transaction agreements.   

1122(d)(1)(v)

   Aggregation of information, as applicable, is mathematically accurate and the information conveyed accurately reflects the information.   
   Cash Collection and Administration   
1122(d)(2)(i)    Payments on credit card accounts are deposited into the appropriate custodial bank accounts and related bank clearing accounts no more than two business days following receipt, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.    ü1
1122(d)(2)(ii)    Disbursements made via wire transfer on behalf of an obligor or to an investor are made only by authorized personnel.    ü
1122(d)(2)(iii)    Advances of funds or guarantees regarding collections, cash flows or distributions, and any interest or other fees charged for such advances, are made, reviewed and approved as specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(2)(iv)    The related accounts for the transaction, such as cash reserve accounts or accounts established as a form of overcollateralization, are separately maintained (e.g., with respect to commingling of cash) as set forth in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(2)(v)    Each custodial account is maintained at a federally insured depository institution as set forth in the transaction agreements. For purposes of this criterion, “federally insured depository institution” with respect to a foreign financial institution means a foreign financial institution that meets the requirements of Rule 13k-1(b)(1) of the Securities Exchange Act.   
1122(d)(2)(vi)    Unissued checks are safeguarded so as to prevent unauthorized access.   

 

1  Solely with regard to deposits made by the Trustee.

 

K-1


Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable
Servicing Criteria

Reference

  

Criteria

    
1122(d)(2)(vii)    Reconciliations are prepared on a monthly basis for all asset-backed securities related bank accounts, including custodial accounts and related bank clearing accounts. These reconciliations are (A) mathematically accurate; (B) prepared within 30 calendar days after the bank statement cutoff date, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements; (C) reviewed and approved by someone other than the person who prepared the reconciliation; and (D) contain explanations for reconciling items. These reconciling items are resolved within 90 calendar days of their original identification, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
   Investor Remittances and Reporting   
1122(d)(3)(i)    Reports to investors, including those to be filed with the Commission, are maintained in accordance with the transaction agreements and applicable Commission requirements. Specifically, such reports (A) are prepared in accordance with timeframes and other terms set forth in the transaction agreements; (B) provide information calculated in accordance with the terms specified in the transaction agreements; (C) are filed with the Commission as required by its rules and regulations; and (D) agree with investors’ or the trustee’s records as to the total unpaid principal balance and number of credit card accounts serviced by the Servicer.   
1122(d)(3)(ii)    Amounts due to investors are allocated and remitted in accordance with timeframes, distribution priority and other terms set forth in the transaction agreements.    ü
1122(d)(3)(iii)    Disbursements made to an investor are posted within two business days to the Servicer’s investor records, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.    ü
1122(d)(3)(iv)    Amounts remitted to investors per the investor reports agree with cancelled checks, or other form of payment, or custodial bank statements.    ü
   Pool Asset Administration   
1122(d)(4)(i)    Collateral or security on credit card accounts is maintained as required by the transaction agreements or related asset pool documents.    ü
1122(d)(4)(ii)    Account and related documents are safeguarded as required by the transaction agreements    ü
1122(d)(4)(iii)    Any additions, removals or substitutions to the asset pool are made, reviewed and approved in accordance with any conditions or requirements in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(iv)    Payments on credit card accounts, including any payoffs, made in accordance with the related credit card accounts documents are posted to the Servicer’s obligor records maintained no more than two business days after receipt, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements, and allocated to principal, interest or other items (e.g., escrow) in accordance with the related asset pool documents.   
1122(d)(4)(v)    The Servicer’s records regarding the accounts and the accounts agree with the Servicer’s records with respect to an obligor’s unpaid principal balance.   
1122(d)(4)(vi)    Changes with respect to the terms or status of an obligor’s account (e.g., loan modifications or re-agings) are made, reviewed and approved by authorized personnel in accordance with the transaction agreements and related pool asset documents.   
1122(d)(4)(vii)    Loss mitigation or recovery actions (e.g., forbearance plans, modifications and deeds in lieu of foreclosure, foreclosures and repossessions, as applicable) are initiated, conducted and concluded in accordance with the timeframes or other requirements established by the transaction agreements.   

 

K-2


Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable
Servicing Criteria

Reference

  

Criteria

    
1122(d)(4)(viii)    Records documenting collection efforts are maintained during the period a Account is delinquent in accordance with the transaction agreements. Such records are maintained on at least a monthly basis, or such other period specified in the transaction agreements, and describe the entity’s activities in monitoring delinquent Accounts including, for example, phone calls, letters and payment rescheduling plans in cases where delinquency is deemed temporary (e.g., illness or unemployment).   
1122(d)(4)(ix)    Adjustments to interest rates or rates of return for Accounts with variable rates are computed based on the related Account documents.   
1122(d)(4)(x)    Regarding any funds held in trust for an obligor (such as escrow accounts): (A) such funds are analyzed, in accordance with the obligor’s Account documents, on at least an annual basis, or such other period specified in the transaction agreements; (B) interest on such funds is paid, or credited, to obligors in accordance with applicable Account documents and state laws; and (C) such funds are returned to the obligor within 30 calendar days of full repayment of the related Accounts, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xi)    Payments made on behalf of an obligor (such as tax or insurance payments) are made on or before the related penalty or expiration dates, as indicated on the appropriate bills or notices for such payments, provided that such support has been received by the servicer at least 30 calendar days prior to these dates, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xii)    Any late payment penalties in connection with any payment to be made on behalf of an obligor are paid from the servicer’s funds and not charged to the obligor, unless the late payment was due to the obligor’s error or omission.   
1122(d)(4)(xiii)    Disbursements made on behalf of an obligor are posted within two business days to the obligor’s records maintained by the servicer, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xiv)    Delinquencies, charge-offs and uncollectible accounts are recognized and recorded in accordance with the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xv)    Any external enhancement or other support, identified in Item 1114(a)(1) through (3) or Item 1115 of Regulation AB, is maintained as set forth in the transaction agreements.   

 

[NAME OF TRUSTEE]
Date:  

 

By:  

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

K-3


EXHIBIT L

FORM OF ANNUAL CERTIFICATION

 

  Re: The [            ] agreement dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “Agreement”), among [IDENTIFY PARTIES]

I,                                         , the                                         of [NAME OF COMPANY] (the “Company”), certify to the Transferor, and its officers, with the knowledge and intent that they will rely upon this certification, that:

(1) I have reviewed the report on assessment of the Company’s compliance provided in accordance with Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”) and Item 1122 of Regulation AB (the “Servicing Assessment”), and the registered public accounting firm’s attestation report provided in accordance with Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 under the Exchange Act and Section 1122(b) of Regulation AB (the “Attestation Report”), that were delivered by the Company to the Transferor pursuant to the Agreement (collectively, the “Company Information”);

(2) To the best of my knowledge, the Company Information, taken as a whole, does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in the light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period of time covered by the Company Information;

(3) To the best of my knowledge, all of the Company Information required to be provided by the Company under the Agreement has been provided to the Transferor; and

(4) To the best of my knowledge, except as disclosed in the Servicing Assessment or the Attestation Report, the Company has fulfilled its obligations under the Agreement.

 

Date:  

 

By:  

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

L-1


EXHIBIT M

SERVICING CRITERIA TO BE ADDRESSED IN ASSESSMENT OF COMPLIANCE

The assessment of compliance to be delivered by the [Servicer] [Subservicer] [Subcontractor] shall address, at a minimum, the criteria identified as below as “Applicable Servicing Criteria”:

 

Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for
Servicer

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for a
Subservicer

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for a
Subcontractor

Reference

  

Criteria

              
   General Servicing Considerations         
1122(d)(1)(i)    Policies and procedures are instituted to monitor any performance or other triggers and events of default in accordance with the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(1)(ii)    If any material servicing activities are outsourced to third parties, policies and procedures are instituted to monitor the third party’s performance and compliance with such servicing activities.         
1122(d)(1)(iii)    Any requirements in the transaction agreements to maintain a back-up servicer for the credit card accounts or accounts are maintained.         
1122(d)(1)(iv)    A fidelity bond and errors and omissions policy is in effect on the party participating in the servicing function throughout the reporting period in the amount of coverage required by and otherwise in accordance with the terms of the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(1)(v)    Aggregation of information, as applicable, is mathematically accurate and the information conveyed accurately reflects the information.         
   Cash Collection and Administration         
1122(d)(2)(i)    Payments on credit card accounts are deposited into the appropriate custodial bank accounts and related bank clearing accounts no more than two business days following receipt, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(2)(ii)    Disbursements made via wire transfer on behalf of an obligor or to an investor are made only by authorized personnel.         
1122(d)(2)(iii)    Advances of funds or guarantees regarding collections, cash flows or distributions, and any interest or other fees charged for such advances, are made, reviewed and approved as specified in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(2)(iv)    The related accounts for the transaction, such as cash reserve accounts or accounts established as a form of overcollateralization, are separately maintained (e.g., with respect to commingling of cash) as set forth in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(2)(v)    Each custodial account is maintained at a federally insured depository institution as set forth in the transaction agreements. For purposes of this criterion, “federally insured depository institution” with respect to a foreign financial institution means a foreign financial institution that meets the requirements of Rule 13k-1(b)(1) of the Securities Exchange Act.         
1122(d)(2)(vi)    Unissued checks are safeguarded so as to prevent unauthorized access.         

 

M-1


Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for
Servicer

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for a
Subservicer

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for a
Subcontractor

Reference

  

Criteria

              
1122(d)(2)(vii)    Reconciliations are prepared on a monthly basis for all asset-backed securities related bank accounts, including custodial accounts and related bank clearing accounts. These reconciliations are (A) mathematically accurate; (B) prepared within 30 calendar days after the bank statement cutoff date, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements; (C) reviewed and approved by someone other than the person who prepared the reconciliation; and (D) contain explanations for reconciling items. These reconciling items are resolved within 90 calendar days of their original identification, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.         
   Investor Remittances and Reporting         
1122(d)(3)(i)    Reports to investors, including those to be filed with the Commission, are maintained in accordance with the transaction agreements and applicable Commission requirements. Specifically, such reports (A) are prepared in accordance with timeframes and other terms set forth in the transaction agreements; (B) provide information calculated in accordance with the terms specified in the transaction agreements; (C) are filed with the Commission as required by its rules and regulations; and (D) agree with investors’ or the trustee’s records as to the total unpaid principal balance and number of credit card accounts serviced by the Servicer.         
1122(d)(3)(ii)    Amounts due to investors are allocated and remitted in accordance with timeframes, distribution priority and other terms set forth in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(3)(iii)    Disbursements made to an investor are posted within two business days to the Servicer’s investor records, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(3)(iv)    Amounts remitted to investors per the investor reports agree with cancelled checks, or other form of payment, or custodial bank statements.         
   Pool Asset Administration         
1122(d)(4)(i)    Collateral or security on credit card accounts is maintained as required by the transaction agreements or related asset pool documents.         
1122(d)(4)(ii)    Account and related documents are safeguarded as required by the transaction agreements         
1122(d)(4)(iii)    Any additions, removals or substitutions to the asset pool are made, reviewed and approved in accordance with any conditions or requirements in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(4)(iv)    Payments on credit card accounts, including any payoffs, made in accordance with the related credit card accounts documents are posted to the Servicer’s obligor records maintained no more than two business days after receipt, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements, and allocated to principal, interest or other items (e.g., escrow) in accordance with the related asset pool documents.         
1122(d)(4)(v)    The Servicer’s records regarding the accounts and the accounts agree with the Servicer’s records with respect to an obligor’s unpaid principal balance.         
1122(d)(4)(vi)    Changes with respect to the terms or status of an obligor’s account (e.g., loan modifications or re-agings) are made, reviewed and approved by authorized personnel in accordance with the transaction agreements and related pool asset documents.         
1122(d)(4)(vii)    Loss mitigation or recovery actions (e.g., forbearance plans, modifications and deeds in lieu of foreclosure, foreclosures and repossessions, as applicable) are initiated, conducted and concluded in accordance with the timeframes or other requirements established by the transaction agreements.         

 

M-2


Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for
Servicer

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for a
Subservicer

  

Applicable
Servicing
Criteria for a
Subcontractor

Reference

  

Criteria

              
1122(d)(4)(viii)    Records documenting collection efforts are maintained during the period a Account is delinquent in accordance with the transaction agreements. Such records are maintained on at least a monthly basis, or such other period specified in the transaction agreements, and describe the entity’s activities in monitoring delinquent Accounts including, for example, phone calls, letters and payment rescheduling plans in cases where delinquency is deemed temporary (e.g., illness or unemployment).         
1122(d)(4)(ix)    Adjustments to interest rates or rates of return for Accounts with variable rates are computed based on the related Account documents.         
1122(d)(4)(x)    Regarding any funds held in trust for an obligor (such as escrow accounts): (A) such funds are analyzed, in accordance with the obligor’s Account documents, on at least an annual basis, or such other period specified in the transaction agreements; (B) interest on such funds is paid, or credited, to obligors in accordance with applicable Account documents and state laws; and (C) such funds are returned to the obligor within 30 calendar days of full repayment of the related Accounts, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(4)(xi)    Payments made on behalf of an obligor (such as tax or insurance payments) are made on or before the related penalty or expiration dates, as indicated on the appropriate bills or notices for such payments, provided that such support has been received by the servicer at least 30 calendar days prior to these dates, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(4)(xii)    Any late payment penalties in connection with any payment to be made on behalf of an obligor are paid from the servicer’s funds and not charged to the obligor, unless the late payment was due to the obligor’s error or omission.         
1122(d)(4)(xiii)    Disbursements made on behalf of an obligor are posted within two business days to the obligor’s records maintained by the servicer, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(4)(xiv)    Delinquencies, charge-offs and uncollectible accounts are recognized and recorded in accordance with the transaction agreements.         
1122(d)(4)(xv)    Any external enhancement or other support, identified in Item 1114(a)(1) through (3) or Item 1115 of Regulation AB, is maintained as set forth in the transaction agreements.         
           

 

[NAME OF [SERVICER] [SUBSERVICER] [SUBCONTRACTOR]]
Date:  

 

By:  

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

M-3

EX-4.3 4 d125824dex43.htm EXHIBIT 4.3 Exhibit 4.3

EXHIBIT 4.3

 

 

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED

SERIES 2002-CC SUPPLEMENT

Dated as of October 9, 2002

As amended and restated as of March 17, 2016

to

AMENDED AND RESTATED POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT

Dated as of September 30, 1993,

As amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007

and March 17, 2016

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

SERIES 2002-CC

among

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION

Servicer

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC

Transferor

and

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON

Trustee

on behalf of the Series 2002-CC Certificateholder


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

         Page  
ARTICLE I  

Creation of the Series 2002-CC Certificate

     1   

Section 1.01.

 

Designation

     1   
ARTICLE II  

Definitions

     2   

Section 2.01.

 

Definitions

     2   

Section 2.02.

 

Amendment to Section 2.08 of the Agreement

     9   
ARTICLE III  

Servicer and Trustee

     10   

Section 3.01.

 

Servicing Compensation

     10   
ARTICLE IV  

Rights of Series 2002-CC Certificateholders and Allocation and Application of Collections

     10   

Section 4.01.

 

Collections and Allocations

     10   

Section 4.02.

 

Application of Available Funds and Available Investor Principal Collections

     12   

Section 4.03.

 

Excess Finance Charges

     12   

Section 4.04.

 

Shared Principal Collections

     12   

Section 4.05.

 

Collections of Finance Charge Receivables Allocable to Segregated Transferor Interest

     13   
ARTICLE V  

Distributions and Reports to Series 2002-CC Certificateholders

     13   

Section 5.01.

 

Distributions

     13   

Section 5.02.

 

Reports and Statements to Series 2002-CC Certificateholders

     14   
ARTICLE VI  

Additional Pay Out Events

     14   
ARTICLE VII  

[Reserved]

     15   
ARTICLE VIII  

Final Distributions

     15   

Section 8.01.

 

Transfer of Receivables or Certificateholders’ Interest pursuant to Section 2.06 or 10.01 of the Agreement

     15   

Section 8.02.

 

Distribution of Proceeds of Sale, Disposition or Liquidation of the Receivables pursuant to Section 9.02 of the Agreement

     16   
ARTICLE IX  

Sale of Receivables

     17   

Section 9.01.

 

Sale of Receivables

     17   

 

- i -


ARTICLE X  

New Issuances

     18   

Section 10.01.

 

New Issuances

     18   
ARTICLE XI  

Miscellaneous Provisions

     18   

Section 11.01.

 

Ratification of Agreement

     18   

Section 11.02.

 

Counterparts

     18   

Section 11.03.

 

GOVERNING LAW

     18   

Section 11.04.

 

Certain Tax Related Amendments

     18   

Section 11.05.

 

Treatment of Noteholders

     18   

Section 11.06.

 

Transfer of the Series 2002-CC Certificate

     19   

 

- ii -


EXHIBITS

 

EXHIBIT A    Form of Series 2002-CC Certificate
EXHIBIT B    Form of Monthly Certificateholders’ Statement
EXHIBIT C    Form of Monthly Servicing Officer’s Certificate
EXHIBIT D    List of Account Designation


AMENDED AND RESTATED SERIES 2002-CC SUPPLEMENT, dated as of March 17, 2016 (the “Supplement”), among CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, national banking association, as the Servicer, CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company, as the Transferor, and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation, as the Trustee.

WHEREAS, pursuant to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016 (as amended and restated and as amended and supplemented, the “Agreement”), among the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee, the Transferor has created Capital One Master Trust (the “Trust”). Section 6.03 of the Agreement provides that the Transferor may from time to time direct the Trustee to authenticate one or more new Series of Investor Certificates representing fractional undivided interests in the Trust;

WHEREAS, the Trustee, the Servicer, and the Transferor and have heretofore executed and delivered a Series 2002-CC Supplement, dated as of October 9, 2002 (as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “Original Series 2002-CC Supplement”); and

WHEREAS, the parties hereto desire to amend and restate in its entirety the Original Series 2002-CC Supplement as set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the promises and the agreements contained herein, the Original Series 2002-CC Supplement is hereby amended and restated in its entirety as follows:

ARTICLE I

Creation of the Series 2002-CC Certificate

Section 1.01. Designation.

(a) There is hereby created a Series consisting of an Investor Certificate to be issued pursuant to the Agreement and this Supplement to be known as “Capital One Master Trust, Series 2002-CC.” The Series 2002-CC Certificate shall be known as the “Asset Backed Certificate, Series 2002-CC.” The Series 2002-CC Certificate shall constitute a “security” within the meaning of (i) Article 8 of the Uniform Commercial Code (including Section 8-102(a)(15) thereof) as in effect from time to time in the State of New York and (ii) the Uniform Commercial Code of any other applicable jurisdiction that presently or hereafter substantially includes the 1994 revisions to Article 8 thereof as adopted by the American Law Institute and the National Conference of Commissioners on Uniform State Laws and approved by the American Bar Association on February 14, 1995.

(b) Series 2002-CC shall be included in Group One and shall be a Principal Sharing Series. Series 2002-CC shall not be subordinated to any other Series. Notwithstanding any provision in the Agreement or in this Supplement to the contrary, the first Distribution Date with respect to Series 2002-CC shall be the November 2002 Distribution Date.


(c) In the event that any term or provision contained herein shall conflict with or be inconsistent with any term or provision contained in the Agreement, the terms and provisions of this Supplement shall govern.

(d) This Supplement is the Series 2002-CC Supplement referred to in the Transfer and Administration Agreement, dated as of October 9, 2002, among Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, as issuer, the Transferor, as transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as administrator, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee.

(e) Except as expressly provided herein, (i) the provisions of Article VI and Article XII of the Agreement relating to the registration, authentication, delivery, presentation, cancellation and surrender of Registered Certificates and (ii) the provisions of Section 3.07 of the Agreement shall not apply to cause the Series 2002-CC Certificate to be treated as debt for federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes, but rather the Transferor intends and, together with the Series 2002-CC Certificateholder, agrees to treat the Series 2002-CC Certificate for federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes as representing an equity interest in the assets of the Trust.

ARTICLE II Definitions

Section 2.01. Definitions.

(a) Whenever used in this Supplement, the following words and phrases shall have the following meanings, and the definitions of such terms are applicable to the singular as well as the plural forms of such terms and the masculine as well as the feminine and neuter genders of such terms.

Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount” shall have the meaning specified in the Indenture.

Agreement” has the meaning specified in the recitals hereto.

Asset Pool 1” shall mean the Asset Pool (as such term is defined in the Indenture) designated pursuant to the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Asset Pool 1 Excess Finance Charges” is defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Asset Pool 1 Finance Charge Shortfall” is defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Asset Pool 1 Principal Shortfall” is defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

 

- 2 -


Asset Pool 1 Supplement” shall mean the Asset Pool 1 Supplement to the Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, between Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, as issuer, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee, as amended and supplemented from time to time.

Available Funds” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the Collections of Finance Charge Receivables (other than Finance Charge Receivables allocated to Servicer Interchange with respect to such Monthly Period) allocated to the Series 2002-CC Certificate (including any investment earnings that are to be treated as Collections of Finance Charge Receivables in accordance with the Agreement and this Supplement).

Available Investor Principal Collections” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the sum of (a) an amount equal to the Principal Allocation Percentage of all Collections of Principal Receivables received during such Monthly Period, plus (b) the amount of Miscellaneous Payments, if any, for such Monthly Period that are allocated to Series 2002-CC pursuant to Section 4.03 of the Agreement, plus (c) any Shared Principal Collections with respect to other Series that are allocated to Series 2002-CC in accordance with Section 4.04 of the Agreement and Section 4.04 hereof.

Certificate Representative” shall mean (a) if there is one Holder of the Series 2002-CC Certificate, such Holder or the designee of such Holder, and (b) if there is more than one Holder of the Series 2002-CC Certificate, the designee of the Holders of a majority of the outstanding principal balance of the Series 2002-CC Certificate.

Certificateholder Servicing Fee” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.01.

Collateral Certificate” shall have meaning specified in the Indenture.

Closing Date” shall mean October 9, 2002.

Cut-Off Date” shall mean October 1, 2002.

Excess Shared Principal Collections” shall mean the excess of the Shared Principal Collections over the aggregate amount of Principal Shortfalls for all Series, as defined in each related Supplement, which are Principal Sharing Series for such Distribution Date.

Finance Charge Shortfall” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.03.

Floating Allocation Amount” shall mean, on any date of determination during any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the sum of the numerators used in the calculation of the Floating Allocation Percentage (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement) for all series of Notes for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the numerators used to calculate the floating allocation percentage (as defined in the related series supplement) for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

 

- 3 -


Floating Allocation Percentage” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, the percentage equivalent (which percentage shall never exceed 100%) of a fraction, the numerator of which is the Floating Allocation Amount as of the last day of the preceding Monthly Period and the denominator of which is the sum of (a) the total amount of Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period (or, with respect to the first Monthly Period, the Cut-Off Date) and (b) the principal amount on deposit in the Excess Funding Account as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period; provided, however, that the amount calculated above pursuant to clause (a) of the denominator shall be increased by the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in Additional Accounts added to the Trust during such Monthly Period as though such Receivables had been added to the Trust as of the first day of such Monthly Period and decreased by the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables removed from the Trust during such Monthly Period as though such Receivables had been removed from the Trust as of the first day of such Monthly Period.

Group One” shall mean Series 2002-CC and each other series specified in the related Supplement to be included in Group One.

Indenture” shall mean the Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, between Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, as issuer, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee, as amended and supplemented from time to time.

Indenture Supplement” shall have the meaning specified in the Indenture.

Initial Invested Amount” shall mean, with respect to Series 2002-CC on any date of determination, the Principal Allocation Amount on such date of determination.

Insolvency Proceeds” shall mean any proceeds arising out of a sale, disposition or liquidation of Receivables (or interests therein) pursuant to subsection 9.02(a) of the Agreement.

Invested Amount” shall mean, with respect to Series 2002-CC, on any date of determination, an amount equal to the sum of the Nominal Liquidation Amounts for each tranche of Asset Pool 1 Notes Outstanding as of such date of determination minus the aggregate invested amounts (as defined in the related series supplement) for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Legal Maturity Date,” with respect to any tranche of Asset Pool 1 Notes, shall have the meaning specified in the Indenture.

Monthly Interest Proxy Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, as determined on any date of determination, an amount equal to the amount that would be deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Accounts for all Outstanding Tranches of Notes for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the monthly interest proxy amounts, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1 assuming, unless

 

- 4 -


the Servicer shall have knowledge to the contrary, that (i) the Floating Allocation Amount on such date of determination will be the Floating Allocation Amount on each day remaining in such Interest Period and (ii) the rate at which amounts are deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Accounts for all Outstanding Tranches of Notes for such Monthly Period is 120% of the corresponding rate for the immediately preceding Interest Period.

Monthly Interest Target” shall mean, with respect to each Monthly Period, an amount equal to the aggregate Targeted Interest Deposit Amounts (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement) for all series of Asset Pool 1 Notes for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the monthly interest targets (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Monthly Principal Target” shall mean, with respect to each Monthly Period, an amount equal to the aggregate Targeted Principal Deposit Amounts (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement) for all series of Notes for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the monthly principal targets (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Monthly Servicing Fee” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.01.

Monthly Servicing Fee Proxy Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, as determined on any date of determination, an amount equal to the Monthly Servicing Fee calculated assuming, unless the Servicer shall have knowledge to the contrary, that the Floating Allocation Amount on such date of determination will be the Floating Allocation Amount on each day remaining in such Monthly Period.

Net Servicing Fee Rate” shall mean (a) so long as Capital One or The Bank of New York Mellon is the Servicer, 1.25% per annum and (b) if Capital One or The Bank of New York Mellon is no longer the Servicer, 2.0% per annum.

Netting Conditions” shall mean, with respect to any date of determination (i) no Series 2002-CC Adverse Event shall have occurred and be continuing, (ii) the Servicer shall have a long-term unsecured debt rating of not lower than Baa3 by Moody’s and (iii) all amounts required to be deposited by the Transferor into the Excess Funding Account shall be on deposit in the Excess Funding Account on such date of determination.

Nominal Liquidation Amount,” with respect to any tranche of Notes, shall have the meaning specified in the Indenture or any supplement thereto.

Nonvariable Accumulation Series” shall mean each outstanding Series that is not a Variable Funding Series or a Variable Accumulation Series.

Note” shall mean any Asset Pool 1 Note (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement).

 

- 5 -


Noteholder” shall mean any Asset Pool 1 Noteholder as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Outstanding” shall have the meaning specified in the Indenture.

Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount” shall have the meaning specified in the Indenture.

Permitted Assignee” shall mean any Person who, if it were the holder of an interest in the Trust, would not cause the Trust to be taxable as a publicly traded partnership for federal income tax purposes.

Principal Allocation Amount” shall mean, on any date of determination during any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the sum of the numerators used in the calculation of the Principal Allocation Percentage (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement) for all series of Notes for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the numerators used to calculate the principal allocation percentage (as defined in the related series supplement) for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Principal Allocation Percentage” shall mean, with respect to any day during a Monthly Period, the percentage equivalent (which percentage shall never exceed 100%) of a fraction, the numerator of which is the Principal Allocation Amount for such date and the denominator of which is the greater of (a) the sum of the total amount of Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the last day of the immediately preceding Monthly Period and the principal amount on deposit in the Excess Funding Account as of such last day (or, in the case of the first Monthly Period, the Cut-Off Date) and (b) the sum of the numerators used to calculate the principal allocation percentages for all Series outstanding as of the date as to which such determination is being made; provided, however, that the amount calculated above pursuant to clause (a) of the denominator shall be increased by the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables in Additional Accounts added to the Trust during such Monthly Period as though such Receivables had been added to the Trust as of the first day of such Monthly Period and decreased by the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables removed from the Trust during such Monthly Period as though such Receivables had been removed from the Trust as of the first day of such Monthly Period.

Principal Shortfall” shall have the meaning specified in Section 4.04.

Reallocation Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, the sum of the Reallocated Principal Amounts (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement) for Asset Pool 1 for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the reallocation amounts (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Reassignment Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Distribution Date, the sum of (a) the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Notes on such Distribution Date, (b) the Monthly Interest Target with respect to the immediately preceding Monthly Period

 

- 6 -


and (c) any other fees and expenses of the Indenture Trustee payable by the Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust pursuant to the Indenture, each after giving effect to any deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on such Distribution Date minus the sum of the reassignment amounts (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Required Deposit Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, as determined on any date of determination, the sum of (a) the Monthly Interest Proxy Amount for the related Interest Period plus, (b) the Monthly Servicing Fee Proxy Amount for such Monthly Period and any Monthly Servicing Fee previously due but not distributed to the Servicer pursuant to the Indenture or any supplement thereto, plus (c) the Series Default Proxy Amount for such Monthly Period, plus (d) the aggregate amount of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement), plus (e) any other amounts identified in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement minus the sum of the required deposit amounts (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 20 02-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Segregated Transferor Interest” shall mean a dollar amount of the Transferor Interest equal to the aggregate prefunded amounts on deposit in the principal funding accounts for each series of Notes minus the sum of the segregated transferor interests, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1, as notified to the Servicer pursuant to Section 4.05.

Series 2002-CC” shall mean the Series of Investor Certificates, the terms of which are specified in this Supplement, represented by the Series 2002-CC Certificate.

Series 2002-CC Adverse Event” shall mean any of the following events:

(i) a Pay Out Event with respect to Series 2002-CC;

(ii) an Early Redemption Event as described in Section 4.01(a)(i) of the Card Series Indenture Supplement with respect to any Card Series Notes or similar early redemption event relating to excess spread amounts or portfolio yield as described in the Indenture Supplement for any other Outstanding Series of Notes in Asset Pool 1; or

(iii) an Event of Default and acceleration as described in Section 601(a) or (b) of the Indenture with respect to any Outstanding Notes.

Series 2002-CC Certificate” shall mean the Certificate executed by the Transferor and authenticated by or on behalf of the Trustee, substantially in the form of Exhibit A.

Series 2002-CC Certificateholder” shall mean a Person in whose name the Series 2002-CC Certificate is registered in the Certificate Register.

 

- 7 -


Series 2002-CC Monthly Principal Payment” shall mean, with respect to each Monthly Period, an amount equal to the aggregate Monthly Principal Payments (as defined in the Asset Pool 1 Supplement) for each series of Notes for such Monthly Period minus the sum of the series monthly principal payments (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1 for such Monthly Period.

Series Default Proxy Amount” shall mean, with respect to any Monthly Period, as determined on any date of determination, an amount equal to 200% of the Asset Pool 1 Defaulted Amount (as defined in the Indenture or any supplement thereto) for the prior Monthly Period minus the sum of the series default proxy amounts (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1 for such Monthly Period.

Servicing Base Amount” shall have the meaning specified in Section 3.01.

Servicing Fee Rate” shall mean 2.00%.

Subordinated Interest Percentage” means, with respect to any date of determination during any Monthly Period, the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of the numerators used in the calculation of the Principal Allocation Percentage (as defined in the related Indenture Supplements) for such date calculated for those Notes that are subordinated to any senior Notes and the denominator of which is the sum of the numerators used in the calculation of the Principal Allocation Percentage (as defined in the related Indenture Supplements) for such date calculated for all the Notes.

Targeted Reallocation Deposit” shall mean, with respect to each Monthly Period, an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (a) the sum of (i) the Monthly Interest Proxy Amount for the related Interest Period, plus (ii) the Monthly Servicing Fee Proxy Amount for such Monthly Period and any Monthly Servicing Fee previously due but not distributed to the Servicer pursuant to the Indenture or any supplement thereto, minus (iii) the sum of the targeted reallocation deposit, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1 over (b) the aggregate amount of Collections of Finance Charge Receivables allocated to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders for the preceding Monthly Period assuming, unless the Servicer shall have knowledge to the contrary, that the Floating Allocation Amount on such date of determination was the Floating Allocation Amount for each day during such preceding Monthly Period.

Termination Date” shall mean the date designated by the Transferor following the last Legal Maturity Date of any series, class or tranche of Asset Pool 1 Notes.

Trust” has the meaning specified in the recitals hereto.

Variable Accumulation Series” shall mean each outstanding Series, other than any Variable Funding Series, for which, pursuant to the terms of the related Supplement, at the time a determination is made pursuant to Section 4.03(f), the commencement date of the Accumulation Period may be changed.

 

- 8 -


Variable Funding Series” shall mean any Series designated in the related Supplement as a Variable Funding Series.

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Supplement or the Agreement, the term “Rating Agency” shall mean, whenever used in this Supplement or the Agreement with respect to Series 2002-CC, Moody’s and Standard & Poor’s and Fitch. As used in this Supplement and in the Agreement with respect to Series 2002-CC, “highest investment ratings category” shall mean (i) in the case of Standard & Poor’s, A-1+, AAA, AAAm or AAAm-G, as applicable, (ii) in the case of Moody’s, P-1 or Aaa, as applicable and (iii) in the case of Fitch, if rated by Fitch, F1+ or AAA, as applicable.

(c) Notwithstanding any provision of the Agreement or this Supplement, the term “Paying Agent” when used in the Agreement or this Supplement with respect to Series 2002-CC, shall mean, the Paying Agent specified pursuant to the Agreement, and any successor paying agents with respect to the Series 2002-CC Certificate as the Transferor may appoint from time to time in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement.

(d) All capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined herein have the meanings ascribed to them in the Agreement.

(e) The words “hereof,” “herein” and “hereunder” and words of similar import when used in this Supplement shall refer to this Supplement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Supplement; references to any Article, Section or Exhibit are references to Articles, Sections and Exhibits in or to this Supplement unless otherwise specified; and the term “including” means “including without limitation.”

Section 2.02. Amendment to Section 2.08 of the Agreement. Subsection 2.08(c)(i) of the Agreement is hereby amended and restated in its entirety to read as follows:

(a) Automatic Additional Accounts. (i) The Transferor may from time to time, at its sole discretion, subject to and in compliance with the limitations specified in clause (ii) below and the applicable conditions specified in paragraph (d) below, designate Eligible Accounts to be included as Accounts as of the applicable Addition Date. For purposes of this paragraph, Eligible Accounts shall be deemed to include only revolving credit card accounts or other revolving credit accounts which (x) are originated by an Account Owner or any Affiliate of an Account Owner, (y) are of a type included as Initial Accounts or which have previously been included in any Addition which has been effected in accordance with all of the conditions specified in paragraph (d) below and (z) have a designation in the Transferor’s credit card master file other than the designations listed on Exhibit D, as such exhibit may be supplemented, revised or amended in writing by the Transferor.

 

- 9 -


ARTICLE III

Servicer and Trustee

Section 3.01. Servicing Compensation. The share of the Servicing Fee allocable to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders with respect to any Distribution Date (the “Monthly Servicing Fee”) shall be equal to one-twelfth of the product of (a) the Servicing Fee Rate and (b) the Floating Allocation Amount for the Monthly Period preceding such Distribution Date (the amount calculated pursuant to this clause (b) is referred to as the “Servicing Base Amount”); provided, however, with respect to the first Distribution Date, the Monthly Servicing Fee shall be equal to the product of (i) the Servicing Base Amount for the first Monthly Period, (ii) the Servicing Fee Rate and (iii) a fraction, the numerator of which is 22 and the denominator of which is 360. On each Distribution Date, but only if a Transferor or The Bank of New York Mellon is the Servicer, Servicer Interchange with respect to the related Monthly Period that is on deposit in the Collection Account shall be withdrawn from the Collection Account and paid to the Servicer in payment of a portion of the Monthly Servicing Fee with respect to such Monthly Period. In the case of any insufficiency of Servicer Interchange on deposit in the Collection Account, a portion of the Monthly Servicing Fee with respect to such Monthly Period will not be paid to the extent of such insufficiency of Servicer Interchange. The share of the Monthly Servicing Fee allocable to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders (after giving effect to the distribution of Servicer Interchange, if any, to the Servicer) with respect to any Distribution Date (the “Certificateholder Servicing Fee”) shall be equal to one-twelfth of the product of (a) the Net Servicing Fee Rate and (b) the Servicing Base Amount; provided, however, that with respect to the first Distribution Date, the Certificateholder Servicing Fee shall be equal to the product of (i) the Servicing Base Amount for the first Monthly Period, (ii) the Net Servicing Fee Rate and (iii) a fraction, the numerator of which is 22 and the denominator of which is 360. The remainder of the Servicing Fee shall be paid by the Transferor or the Certificateholders of other Series (as provided in the related Supplements) and in no event shall the Trust, the Trustee or the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders be liable for the share of the Servicing Fee to be paid by the Transferor or the Certificateholders of any other Series.

ARTICLE IV

Rights of Series 2002-CC Certificateholders and

Allocation and Application of Collections

Section 4.01. Collections and Allocations.

(a) Collections. The Servicer will apply, or will instruct the Trustee to apply, all funds on deposit in the Collection Account allocable to the Series 2002-CC Certificate as described in this Article IV.

(b) Allocations of Collections of Finance Charge Receivables to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders. Notwithstanding any provisions of Section 4.03 of the Agreement to the contrary, the Servicer shall, prior to the close of business on any Date of Processing during any Monthly Period, allocate Collections of Finance Charge Receivables to the Series 2002-CC

 

- 10 -


Certificateholders, for deposit into the Collection Account on such date and application as provided herein, in an amount equal to the product of (A) the Floating Allocation Percentage for such Monthly Period and (B) the aggregate amount of Collections of Finance Charge Receivables received by the Servicer on the Date of Processing relating to such Date of Processing; provided that so long as the Netting Conditions are satisfied, after the date on which an amount of such Collections of Finance Charge Receivables equal to the Required Deposit Amount for such Monthly Period has been deposited into the Collection Account and allocated to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders, any amounts in excess thereof may be withdrawn from the Collection Account and retained by the Servicer until applied pursuant to Section 4.02 on the related Distribution Date.

(c) Allocations of Collections of Principal Receivables to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders. Notwithstanding any provisions of Section 4.03 of the Agreement to the contrary, the Servicer shall, prior to the close of business on any Date of Processing during each Monthly Period, allocate Collections of Principal Receivables to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders, for deposit into the Collection Account on such date and application as provided herein, in an amount equal to the product of (A) the Principal Allocation Percentage for such Monthly Period and (B) the aggregate amount of Collections of Principal Receivables received by the Servicer on such Date of Processing; provided that, so long as (x) a Pay Out Event with respect to Series 2002-CC shall not have occurred and be continuing and (y) an event as described in clause (ii) of the definition of Series 2002-CC Adverse Event shall not have occurred with respect to all Outstanding Notes, after the date on which an amount of such Collections of Principal Receivables equal to the sum of:

(i) the Monthly Principal Target for such Monthly Period,

(ii) an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the Targeted Reallocation Deposit, if any, on the related Distribution Date and (ii) the product of (x) the Principal Allocation Percentage for such Monthly Period, (y) the aggregate amount of Collections of Principal Receivables received by the Servicer on or prior to such Date of Processing and (z) the Subordinated Interest Percentage for such Monthly Period, and

(iii) if any other Principal Sharing Series is outstanding and in its revolving period or accumulation period, the amount necessary to be treated as Shared Principal Collections, for such other Series, if any, on the related Distribution Date,

has been deposited into the Collection Account and allocated to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders, any amounts in excess thereof may be withdrawn from the Collection Account and paid to the Transferor, but only if (i) the Transferor’s Participation Amount exceeds the Required Transferor’s Interest and the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables exceeds the Required Principal Balance, and otherwise such amounts shall be deposited into the Excess Funding Account.

In addition, on each Distribution Date, the Transferor will deposit in the Collection Account for application in accordance with Section 4.02 an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the product of (x) the Principal Allocation Percentage for such Monthly Period, (y) the

 

- 11 -


aggregate amount of Collections of Principal Receivables received by the Servicer for such Monthly Period and (z) the Subordinated Interest Percentage for such Monthly Period, and (ii) the Reallocation Amount for such Distribution Date minus the amount, if any, previously deposited in clause (c)(ii) above.

Section 4.02. Application of Available Funds and Available Investor Principal Collections. The Servicer shall cause the Trustee to apply, on each Distribution Date, Available Funds and Available Investor Principal Collections with respect to such Distribution Date to make the following distributions:

(a) On each Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Available Funds with respect to such Distribution Date will be distributed to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders.

(b) On each Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Available Investor Principal Collections deposited in the Collection Account for the related Monthly Period will be distributed in the following priority:

(i) an amount equal to the Series 2002-CC Monthly Principal Payment for the related Monthly Period shall be distributed to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders; and

(ii) for each Distribution Date, after giving effect to paragraph (i) above, an amount equal to the balance, if any, of such Available Investor Principal Collections then on deposit in the Collection Account shall be treated as Shared Principal Collections and applied in accordance with Section 4.04 of the Agreement.

Section 4.03. Excess Finance Charges. Series 2002-CC shall be included in Group One. Subject to Section 4.05 of the Agreement, Excess Finance Charges with respect to the Series in Group One for any Distribution Date will be allocated to Series 2002-CC in an amount equal to the product of (x) the aggregate amount of Excess Finance Charges with respect to all the Series in Group One for such Distribution Date and (y) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Finance Charge Shortfall for Series 2002-CC for such Distribution Date and the denominator of which is the aggregate amount of Finance Charge Shortfalls for all the Series in Group One for such Distribution Date. The amount of Excess Finance Charges for Series 2002-CC for any Distribution Date shall be an amount equal to the Asset Pool 1 Excess Finance Charges minus the excess finance charges (as defined in the related series supplement), if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1. The “Finance Charge Shortfall” for Series 2002-CC for any Distribution Date will be equal to the Asset Pool 1 Finance Charge Shortfall minus the finance charge shortfall, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Section 4.04. Shared Principal Collections. Subject to Section 4.04 of the Agreement, Shared Principal Collections for any Distribution Date will be allocated to Series 2002-CC in an amount equal to the product of (x) the aggregate amount of Shared Principal

 

- 12 -


Collections with respect to all Series for such Distribution Date and (y) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Principal Shortfall for Series 2002-CC for such Distribution Date and the denominator of which is the aggregate amount of Principal Shortfalls for all the Series which are Principal Sharing Series for such Distribution Date. The “Principal Shortfall” for Series 2002-CC will be equal to, for any Distribution Date, the excess, if any, of the Asset Pool 1 Principal Shortfall minus the principal shortfall, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1.

Section 4.05. Collections of Finance Charge Receivables Allocable to Segregated Transferor Interest. The Certificate Representative may from time to time notify the Servicer of the existence of a prefunding target amount and of the amount of the Transferor Interest that is to be the Segregated Transferor Interest in an amount equal to the prefunded amounts on deposit in the Principal Funding Accounts (as defined in the Indenture and any supplement thereto) for any series of Notes minus the sum of the segregated transferor amounts, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1. Prior to the close of business on the day any Collections are deposited in the Collection Account during the Monthly Period in which such notice was given from and after the date of such notice, the Servicer will:

(a) allocate to the Segregated Transferor Interest and deposit in the Collection Account the aggregate amount of all Collections of Finance Charge Receivables allocable to the Segregated Transferor Interest with respect to such Monthly Period, and

(b) on the following Distribution Date, (i) pay to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders an amount equal to the lesser of (x) the aggregate amount deposited in the Collection Account pursuant to clause (a) above, and (y) the aggregate amount of all Prefunding Earnings Shortfalls (as defined in the Indenture and the related supplements thereto) for all tranches of Notes with respect to such Monthly Period minus the aggregate amount paid to the Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust in respect of segregated transferor interest finance charge collections, if any, for each Collateral Certificate (other than the Series 2002-CC Certificate) included in Asset Pool 1 and (ii) pay to the Holder of the Transferor Interest an amount equal to any excess; provided, however, that within two (2) Business Days of the occurrence of an Insolvency Event, the aggregate amount deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to clause (a) on or prior to the occurrence of such Insolvency Event will, to the extent not previously paid to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders, be paid to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders.

ARTICLE V

Distributions and Reports to Series 2002-CC Certificateholders

Section 5.01. Distributions.

(a) On each Distribution Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to the Certificate Representative the aggregate amount payable to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders pursuant to Section 4.02 and Section 4.05 to the account of the Certificate Representative, as specified in writing by the Certificate Representative, in immediately available funds.

(b) The distributions to be made pursuant to this Section 5.01 are subject to the provisions of Sections 2.06, 9.02, 10.01 and 12.02 of the Agreement and Sections 8.01 and 8.02 of this Supplement.

 

- 13 -


Section 5.02. Reports and Statements to Series 2002-CC Certificateholders.

(a) On each Distribution Date, the Paying Agent, on behalf of the Trustee, shall make available for inspection upon request to each Series 2002-CC Certificateholder free of charge at the office of such Paying Agent a statement substantially in the form of Exhibit C prepared by the Servicer for a period of six months commencing on such Distribution Date.

(b) Not later than each Determination Date, the Servicer shall deliver to the Certificate Representative, the Trustee, the Paying Agent, the Transferor and each Rating Agency (i) a statement substantially in the form of Exhibit B prepared by the Servicer and (ii) a certificate of a Servicing Officer substantially in the form of Exhibit C.

ARTICLE VI

Additional Pay Out Events

Section 6.01. Additional Pay Out Events. If any one of the following events shall occur with respect to the Series 2002-CC Certificate:

(a) failure on the part of the Transferor (i) to make any payment or deposit required by the terms of the Agreement or this Supplement on or before the date occurring five Business Days after the date such payment or deposit is required to be made therein or herein or (ii) duly to observe or perform any other covenants or agreements of the Transferor set forth in the Agreement or this Supplement, which failure has a material adverse effect on the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate and which continues unremedied for a period of 60 days after the date on which written notice of such failure, requiring the same to be remedied, shall have been given to the Transferor by the Trustee, or to the Transferor and the Trustee by any Holder of the Series 2002-CC Certificate;

(b) any representation or warranty made by the Transferor in the Agreement or this Supplement, or any information contained in the Account Schedule required to be delivered by the Transferor pursuant to Section 2.01 of the Agreement, shall prove to have been incorrect in any material respect when made or when delivered, which continues to be incorrect in any material respect for a period of 60 days after the date on which written notice of such failure, requiring the same to be remedied, shall have been given to the Transferor by the Trustee, or to the Transferor and the Trustee by any Holder of the Series 2002-CC Certificateholder’s Interest and as a result of which the interests of the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate are materially and adversely affected and continue to be materially and

 

- 14 -


adversely affected for such period; provided, however, that a Pay Out Event pursuant to this subsection 6.01(b) shall not be deemed to have occurred hereunder if the Transferor has accepted reassignment of the related Receivable, or all of such Receivables, if applicable, during such period in accordance with the provisions of the Agreement;

(c) a failure by the Transferor to convey Receivables in Additional Accounts or Participation Interests to the Trustee within five Business Days after the day on which it is required to convey such Receivables or Participation Interests pursuant to subsection 2.08(a) of the Agreement;

(d) any Servicer Default shall occur; or

(e) a Transfer Restriction Event shall occur;

then, in the case of any event described in subparagraph (a), (b) or (d), after the applicable grace period, if any, set forth in such subparagraphs, either the Trustee or the holders of Investor Certificates of Series 2002-CC evidencing more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of Investor Certificates by notice then given in writing to the Transferor and the Servicer (and to the Trustee if given by the holders of Investor Certificates of Series 2002-CC) may declare that a Pay Out Event has occurred with respect to Series 2002-CC as of the date of such notice, and, in the case of any event described in subparagraph (c) or (e) a Pay Out Event shall occur with respect to Series 2002-CC without any notice or other action on the part of the Trustee or holders of Investor Certificates of Series 2002-CC immediately upon the occurrence of such event.

ARTICLE VII

[Reserved]

ARTICLE VIII

Final Distributions

Section 8.01. Transfer of Receivables or Certificateholders’ Interest pursuant to Section 2.06 or 10.01 of the Agreement.

(a) Acquisition Price. (i) The amount to be paid by the Transferor with respect to Series 2002-CC in connection with a reassignment of Receivables to the Transferor pursuant to Section 2.06 of the Agreement shall equal the Reassignment Amount for the first Distribution Date following the Monthly Period in which the reassignment obligation arises under the Agreement.

(ii) The amount to be paid by the Transferor with respect to Series 2002-CC in connection with a reassignment of the Certificateholders’ Interest pursuant to Section 10.01 of the Agreement shall equal the sum of (x) the Reassignment Amount for

 

- 15 -


the Distribution Date of such reassignment and (y) the excess, if any, of (I) a price equivalent to the average of bids quoted on the Record Date preceding the date of repurchase (or, if not a Business Day, on the next succeeding Business Day) by at least two recognized dealers selected by the Trustee at the written direction of the Servicer, for the purchase by such dealers of a security which is similar to the Notes with a remaining maturity approximately equal to the remaining maturity of the Notes and rated by each rating agency in the rating category originally assigned to the Notes over (II) the portion of the Reassignment Amount attributable to the Series 2002-CC Certificate.

(b) Distributions Pursuant to Section 10.01 of the Agreement. With respect to the Reassignment Amount deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to subsection 8.01(a)(ii) or any amounts allocable to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders’ Interest deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to Section 12.02, the Trustee shall, not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on the related Distribution Date, make deposits or distributions of the following amounts (in the priority set forth below and, in each case, after giving effect to any deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on such date) in immediately available funds: (i) the aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Outstanding Asset Pool 1 Notes on such Distribution Date will be distributed to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders and (ii) an amount equal to the Monthly Interest Target for such Distribution Date will be distributed to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Supplement or the Agreement, the amount of any excess determined pursuant to paragraph (a)(ii)(y) shall be distributed to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders.

(c) Distributions Pursuant to Section 2.06 of the Agreement. With respect to any amounts deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to subsection 8.01(a)(i), the Trustee shall, not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on the related Distribution Date, distribute the portion of such amounts that are allocable to the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholder.

(d) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Supplement or the Agreement, all amounts distributed to the Paying Agent pursuant to subsection 8.01(b) for payment to the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate shall be deemed distributed in full to the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate on the date on which such funds are distributed to the Paying Agent pursuant to this Section and shall be deemed to be a final distribution pursuant to Section 12.02 of the Agreement.

Section 8.02. Distribution of Proceeds of Sale, Disposition or Liquidation of the Receivables pursuant to Section 9.02 of the Agreement.

(a) Not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on the Distribution Date following the date on which the Insolvency Proceeds are deposited into the Collection Account pursuant to subsection 9.02(b) of the Agreement, the Trustee shall (in the following priority and, in each case, after giving effect to any deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on such Distribution Date), deduct an amount equal to the aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Outstanding Asset Pool 1 Notes on such Distribution Date from the

 

- 16 -


portion of the Insolvency Proceeds allocated to Collections of Principal Receivables and distribute such amount to the Paying Agent for payment to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholders, provided that the amount of such distribution shall not exceed the product of (x) the portion of the Insolvency Proceeds allocated to Collections of Principal Receivables and (y) the Principal Allocation Percentage with respect to the related Monthly Period.

(b) Not later than 12:00 noon, Richmond, Virginia time, on such Distribution Date, the Trustee shall (in the following priority and, in each case, after giving effect to any deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on such Distribution Date) deduct an amount equal to the Monthly Interest Target for such Distribution Date, from the portion of the Insolvency Proceeds allocated to Collections of Finance Charge Receivables and distribute such amount to the Paying Agent for payment to the Series 2002-CC Certificateholder, provided that the amount of such distribution shall not exceed the product of (A) the portion of the Insolvency Proceeds allocated to Collections of Finance Charge Receivables and (B) the Floating Allocation Percentage with respect to the related Monthly Period.

(c) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Supplement or the Agreement, all amounts distributed to the Paying Agent pursuant to this Section for payment to the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate shall be distributed in full to the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate on the date on which funds are distributed to the applicable Paying Agents pursuant to this Section and shall be deemed to be a final distribution pursuant to Section 12.02 of the Agreement.

(d) Notwithstanding any provision of the Agreement or this Supplement, for purposes of subsection 9.02(a) of the Agreement, the Holders of the Series 2002-CC Certificate shall be deemed to have irrevocably disapproved a liquidation of the Receivables following an Insolvency Event with respect to the Transferor.

ARTICLE IX

Sale of Receivables

Section 9.01. Sale of Receivables. Upon notice to the Servicer and the Transferor by the Certificate Representative pursuant to the Indenture with respect to any tranche of accelerated Notes or any tranche of Notes which has reached its Legal Maturity Date, the Trustee will sell to a Permitted Assignee Principal Receivables and the related Finance Charge Receivables (or interests therein) in an amount specified by the Certificate Representative which shall be a portion of the Invested Amount of Series 2002-CC equal to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the affected tranche of Notes, calculated as of the end of the prior Monthly Period (after giving effect to deposits and distributions otherwise to be made with respect to such Monthly Period, minus the aggregate amount of principal receivables to be sold upon the providing of a related notice by the trustee of another master trust or securitization special purpose entity which has transferred a Collateral Certificate to the Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust for inclusion in Asset Pool 1). The proceeds from such sale shall be immediately paid to the Certificate Representative.

 

- 17 -


ARTICLE X

New Issuances

Section 10.01. New Issuances. The obligation of the Trustee to authenticate the Investor Certificates of a new Series and to execute and deliver the related Supplement shall be subject to the conditions set forth in subsection 6.03(b) of the Agreement and to the additional condition that, as of the Series Issuance Date and after giving effect to such issuance, the aggregate amount of Principal Receivables equals or exceeds the Required Principal Balance.

ARTICLE XI

Miscellaneous Provisions

Section 11.01. Ratification of Agreement. As supplemented by this Supplement, the Agreement is in all respects ratified and confirmed and the Agreement as so supplemented by this Supplement shall be read, taken and construed as one and the same instrument.

Section 11.02. Counterparts. This Supplement may be executed in two or more counterparts, and by different parties on separate counterparts, each of which shall be an original, but all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument.

Section 11.03. GOVERNING LAW . THIS SUPPLEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, INCLUDING SECTION 5-1401 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATION LAW, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 11.04. Certain Tax Related Amendments. In addition to being subject to amendment pursuant to any other provisions relating to amendments in either the Agreement or this Supplement, this Supplement may be amended by the Transferor without the consent of the Servicer, the Trustee or any Series 2002-CC Certificateholder if the Transferor provides the Trustee with (i) an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that such amendment or modification would reduce the risk the Trust would be treated as taxable as a publicly traded partnership pursuant to Code section 7704 and (ii) a certificate that such amendment or modification would not materially and adversely affect any Series 2002-CC Certificateholder; provided, that no such amendment shall be deemed effective without the Trustee’s consent, if the Trustee’s rights, duties and obligations hereunder are thereby modified. Promptly after the effectiveness of any amendment pursuant to this Section 11.04, the Transferor shall deliver a copy of such amendment to each of the Servicer, the Trustee and each Rating Agency.

Section 11.05. Treatment of Noteholders. Subject to subsection 8.02(d), for purposes of any provision of the Agreement, this Supplement, or the Asset Representations

 

- 18 -


Review Agreement requiring or permitting actions with the consent of, or at the direction of Investor Certificateholders generally or Series 2002-CC Certificateholders specifically holding a specified percentage of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of the applicable Investor Certificates (a) each Noteholder will be deemed to be a Series 2002-CC Certificateholder; (b) each Noteholder will be deemed to be the Holder of an aggregate unpaid principal amount of the Series 2002-CC Certificate equal to the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Noteholder’s Notes; (c) each series of Notes under the Indenture will be deemed to be a separate Series of Investor Certificates and the Holder of a Note of such series will be deemed to be the Holder of an aggregate unpaid principal amount of such Series of Investor Certificates equal to the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Noteholder’s Notes of such series; (d) each tranche of Notes under the Asset Pool 1 Supplement will be deemed to be a separate Class of Investor Certificates and the Holder of a Note of such tranche will be deemed to be the Holder of an aggregate unpaid principal amount of such Class of Investor Certificates equal to the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Noteholder’s Notes of such tranche and (e) any Notes owned by the Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, the Transferor, the Servicer, any other holder of the Transferor Interest or any Affiliate thereof, and in addition, for purposes of subsections 15.02(a) and 15.02(b) of the Agreement and any provision of the Asset Representations Review Agreement, Notes owned by the Account Owner, the Asset Representations Reviewer or any Affiliate thereof, will be deemed not to be outstanding, except that, in determining whether the Trustee shall be protected in relying upon any such consent or direction, only Notes which a Responsible Officer in the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee knows to be so owned shall be so disregarded. Notes so owned that have been pledged in good faith shall not be disregarded and may be regarded as outstanding if the pledgee establishes to the satisfaction of the Trustee the pledgee’s right so to act with respect to such Notes and that the pledgee is not the Transferor, the Servicer, any other holder of the Transferor Interest or any Affiliate thereof, and in addition, for purposes of subsection 15.02(a) or 15.02(b) of the Agreement and any provision of the Asset Representations Review Agreement, the pledgee is not the Account Owner, the Asset Representations Reviewer or any Affiliate thereof.

Section 11.06. Transfer of the Series 2002-CC Certificate. After the Closing Date, the Series 2002-CC Certificate may not be sold, participated, transferred, assigned, exchanged or otherwise pledged or conveyed in whole or in part except upon the prior delivery to the Master Trust Trustee and the Owner Trustee of a Master Trust Tax Opinion and an Issuer Tax Opinion (each as defined in the Indenture), respectively, with respect thereto.

 

- 19 -


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have caused this Supplement to be duly executed and delivered by their respective duly authorized officers on the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
Servicer
By:  

/s/ Daniel H. Rosen

Name:   Daniel H. Rosen
Title:   Managing Vice President, Treasury
CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,
Transferor
By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

Name:   Eric D. Bauder
Title:   Assistant Vice President

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

as Trustee and not in its individual capacity

By:  

/s/ Michael D. Commisso

Name:   Michael D. Commisso
Title:   Vice President

[Signature Page to Series 2002-CC Supplement]


EXHIBIT A

FORM OF CERTIFICATE

THE HOLDER HEREOF, BY PURCHASING THIS SERIES 2002-CC CERTIFICATE, AGREES THAT IT IS ACQUIRING THIS SERIES 2002-CC CERTIFICATE FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT (AND NOT FOR THE ACCOUNT OF OTHERS) AND NOT WITH A VIEW TO, OR FOR SALE IN CONNECTION WITH, THE PUBLIC DISTRIBUTION HEREOF AND THAT NEITHER THIS SERIES 2002-CC CERTIFICATE NOR ANY INTEREST HEREIN MAY BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED, OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED, EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED AND ANY APPLICABLE PROVISIONS OF ANY STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS SERIES 2002-CC CERTIFICATE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN.

TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER THIS SERIES 2002-CC CERTIFICATE NOR ANY INTEREST HEREIN MAY BE TRANSFERRED, ASSIGNED, EXCHANGED OR OTHERWISE PLEDGED OR CONVEYED, EXCEPT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REFERRED TO HEREIN.

No.     

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

SERIES 2002-CC CERTIFICATE

ASSET BACKED CERTIFICATE, SERIES 2002-CC

Evidencing an Undivided Interest in a trust, the corpus of which consists of a portfolio of MasterCard® and VISA® credit card receivables acquired by Capital One Funding, LLC and other assets and interests constituting the Trust under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement described below.

(Not an interest in or obligation of

Capital One Funding, LLC or any Affiliate thereof.)

This certifies that                                          (the “Investor Certificateholder”) is the registered owner of an Undivided Interest in a trust (the “Trust”), the corpus of which consists of a portfolio of receivables (the “Receivables”) existing in the consumer revolving credit card accounts and other consumer revolving credit accounts identified under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement from time to time (the “Accounts”), all Receivables generated under the Accounts from time to time thereafter, funds collected or to be collected from accountholders in respect of the Receivables, all funds which are from time to time on deposit in a Collection Account and in the Series Accounts, an interest in any Funds Collateral

 

A - 1


relating to Secured Accounts, the benefits of any Series Enhancements issued and to be issued by Series Enhancers with respect to one or more series of Investor Certificates, the rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims of the Transferor with respect to (A) the Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002 between Capital One Bank (USA), National Association and Capital One Funding, LLC (as amended and supplemented from time to time) and (B) the Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002, between Capital One, F.S.B. and Capital One Funding, LLC, and all other assets and interests constituting the Trust Assets pursuant to an Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, as supplemented by the Amended and Restated Series 2002-CC Supplement, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016 (collectively, the “Pooling and Servicing Agreement”), by and between Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor (the “Transferor”), Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer (the “Servicer”), and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee (the “Trustee”), a summary of certain of the pertinent provisions of which is set forth hereinbelow.

To the extent not defined herein, capitalized terms used herein have the respective meanings assigned to them in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. This Investor Certificate is issued under and is subject to the terms, provisions and conditions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, to which Pooling and Servicing Agreement, as amended from time to time, the Investor Certificateholder by virtue of the acceptance hereof assents and by which the Investor Certificateholder is bound.

Although a summary of certain provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement is set forth below, this Investor Certificate is qualified in its entirety by the terms and provisions of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and reference is made to that Pooling and Servicing Agreement for information with respect to the interests, rights, benefits, obligations, proceeds, and duties evidenced hereby and the rights, duties and obligations of the Trustee.

Beginning on November 14, 2002 and on each Transfer Date thereafter, the Trustee shall distribute to the Investor Certificateholders of record as of the last Business Day of the calendar month preceding such Transfer Date such amounts as are payable pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and as are requested by the certificate delivered to the Trustee by the Servicer pursuant to Section 5.01 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. The Series 2002-CC Termination Date is the earlier the occur of (i) the date designated by the Seller following the last occurring Legal Maturity Date of any tranche of Notes and (ii) the Trust Termination Date. Principal with respect to the Series 2002-CC Certificates will be paid under the circumstances described in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by or on behalf of the Trustee, by manual signature, this Investor Certificate shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, or be valid for any purpose.

This Investor Certificate shall constitute a “security” within the meaning of (i) Article 8 of the Uniform Commercial Code (including Section 8-102(a)(15) thereof) as in effect from time to time in the State of New York and (ii) the Uniform Commercial Code of any

 

A - 2


other applicable jurisdiction that presently or hereafter substantially includes the 1994 revisions to Article 8 thereof as adopted by the American Law Institute and the National Conference of Commissioners on Uniform State Laws and approved by the American Bar Association on February 14, 1995.

This Investor Certificate shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York, without regard to conflict of law principles thereof.

 

A - 3


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Capital One Funding, LLC has caused this Series 2002-CC Certificate to be duly executed on this     day of             .

 

By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

A - 4


Form of Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication

CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is one of the Series 2002-CC Certificates referred to in the within-mentioned Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,
Trustee
By:  

 

  Authorized Signatory

Date:                  , 2002

 

A - 5


EXHIBIT B

FORM OF MONTHLY STATEMENT

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

SERIES 2002-CC

Pursuant to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (hereinafter as such agreement may have been or may be from time to time, supplement, amended or otherwise modified, the “Pooling and Servicing Agreement”), among Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee (the “Trustee”), Capital One as Servicer is required to prepare certain information each month regarding current distributions to Certificateholders and the performance of the Capital One Master Trust (the “Trust”) during the previous month. The information which is required to be prepared with respect to the Distribution Date of                  ,         , and with respect to the performance of the Trust during the month of                       is set forth below. Certain of the information is presented on the basis of an original principal amount of $1,000 per Investor Certificate (a “Certificate”). Certain other information is presented based on the aggregate amounts for the Trust as a whole. Capitalized terms used in this monthly statement have their respective meanings set forth in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

 

B-1


EXHIBIT C

FORM OF MONTHLY SERVICER’S CERTIFICATE

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION

 

 

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

SERIES 2002-CC

 

 

The undersigned, a duly authorized representative of Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, pursuant to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016 (as amended and supplemented, the “Agreement”), as supplemented by the Series 2002-CC Supplement (as amended and supplemented, the “Series Supplement”), dated as of October 9, 2002, each among Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, as Servicer, Capital One Funding, LLC, as Transferor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, does hereby certify as follows:

1. Capitalized terms used in this Certificate have their respective meanings as set forth in the Agreement or Series Supplement, as applicable.

2. Capital One Bank (USA), National Association is, as of the date hereof, the Servicer under the Agreement.

3. The undersigned is a Servicing Officer.

4. This Certificate relates to the Distribution Date occurring on                     .

5. As of the date hereof, to the best knowledge of the undersigned, the Servicer has performed in all material respects all its obligations under the Agreement through the Monthly Period preceding such Distribution Date [or, if there has been a default in the performance of any such obligation, set forth in detail the (i) nature of such default, (ii) the action taken by the Sellers and Servicer, if any, to remedy such default and (iii) the current status of each such default; if applicable, insert “None”].

 

C-1


6. As of the date hereof, to the best knowledge of the undersigned, no Pay Out Event occurred on or prior to such Distribution Date.

7. As of the date hereof, to the best knowledge of the undersigned, no Lien has been placed on any of the Receivables other than pursuant to the Agreement [or, if there is a Lien, such Lien consists of                     ].

 

C- 2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has duly executed and delivered this Certificate this      day of             , 20    .

 

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
as Servicer
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  

 

C- 3


EXHIBIT D

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

SERIES 2002-CC

LIST OF ACCOUNT DESIGNATIONS

 

Associate 18

Associate 19

Associate 20

Associate 21

Associate 31

Associate 33

Associate 42

Associate 54

Associate 77

Associate 79

Associate 85

Associate 87

Associate 91

Associate 100

Associate 101

Associate 102

Associate 103

Associate 104

Associate 105

Associate 106

Associate 107

Associate 108

Associate 109

Associate 120

Associate 121

Associate 122

Associate 123

Associate 185

Associate 186

Associate 190

Associate 191

Associate 195

Associate 196

Associate 197

Associate 198

Associate 199

 

Associate 302

Associate 303

Associate 308

Associate 309

Associate 310

Associate 311

Associate 312

Associate 313

Associate 314

Associate 332

Associate 333

Associate 336

Associate 337

Associate 338

Associate 339

Associate 345

Associate 347

Associate 360

Associate 361

Associate 367

Associate 368

Associate 369

Associate 370

Associate 371

Associate 372

Associate 373

Associate 374

Associate 375

Associate 376

Associate 390

Associate 391

Associate 392

Associate 393

Associate 394

Associate 395

Associate 407

 

Associate 408

Associate 409

Associate 410

Associate 411

Associate 412

Associate 413

Associate 414

Associate 415

Associate 416

Associate 417

Associate 433

Associate 439

Associate 440

Associate 508

Associate 509

Associate 567

Associate 568

Associate 570

Associate 571

Associate 572

Associate 573

Associate 574

Associate 575

Associate 576

Associate 577

Associate 578

Associate 579

Associate 620

Associate 621

Associate 622

Associate 623

Associate 624

Associate 706

Associate 770

Associate 771

Associate 772

 

Associate 773

Associate 774

Associate 777

Associate 780

Associate 785

Associate 786

Associate 869

Associate 870

Associate 871

Associate 874

Associate 875

Associate 876

Associate 877

Associate 878

Associate 879

Associate 880

 

D-1

EX-4.4 5 d125824dex44.htm EXHIBIT 4.4 Exhibit 4.4

EXHIBIT 4.4

 

 

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

as Issuer

and

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON

as Indenture Trustee

 

 

INDENTURE

Dated as of October 9, 2002,

As amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016

 

 

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

         Page  
ARTICLE I  

DEFINITIONS AND OTHER PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION

     3   

Section 101.

 

Definitions

     3   

Section 102.

 

Compliance Certificates and Opinions

     17   

Section 103.

 

Form of Documents Delivered to Indenture Trustee

     18   

Section 104.

 

Acts of Noteholders

     18   

Section 105.

 

Notices, etc., to Indenture Trustee and Issuer

     20   

Section 106.

 

Notices to Noteholders; Waiver

     21   

Section 107.

 

Conflict with Trust Indenture Act

     21   

Section 108.

 

Effect of Headings and Table of Contents

     22   

Section 109.

 

Successors and Assigns

     22   

Section 110.

 

Severability of Provisions

     22   

Section 111.

 

Benefits of Indenture

     22   

Section 112.

 

Governing Law

     22   

Section 113.

 

Counterparts

     22   

Section 114.

 

Indenture Referred to in the Trust Agreement

     22   

Section 115.

 

Legal Holidays

     22   
ARTICLE II  

NOTE FORMS

     24   

Section 201.

 

Forms Generally

     24   

Section 202.

 

Forms of Notes

     24   

Section 203.

 

Form of Indenture Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication

     24   

Section 204.

 

Notes Issuable in the Form of a Global Note

     25   

Section 205.

 

Temporary Global Notes and Permanent Global Notes

     27   

Section 206.

 

Beneficial Ownership of Global Notes

     29   

Section 207.

 

Notices to Depository

     29   
ARTICLE III  

THE NOTES

     30   

Section 301.

 

General Title; General Limitations; Issuable in Series; Terms of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes

     30   

Section 302.

 

Denominations

     33   

Section 303.

 

Execution, Authentication and Delivery and Dating

     34   

Section 304.

 

Temporary Notes

     34   

Section 305.

 

Registration, Transfer and Exchange

     35   

Section 306.

 

Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost and Stolen Notes

     38   

Section 307.

 

Payment of Interest; Interest Rights Preserved; Withholding Taxes

     38   

Section 308.

 

Persons Deemed Owners

     39   

Section 309.

 

Cancellation

     39   

Section 310.

 

New Issuances of Notes

     39   

 

- i -


TABLE OF CONTENTS

(continued)

 

         Page  

Section 311.

 

Specification of Required Subordinated Amount and other Terms with Respect to each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes

     42   
ARTICLE IV  

ISSUER ACCOUNTS AND INVESTMENTS

     43   

Section 401.

 

Collections

     43   

Section 402.

 

Issuer Accounts

     43   

Section 403.

 

Investment of Funds in the Issuer Accounts

     44   
ARTICLE V  

SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE; CANCELLATION OF NOTES HELD BY THE ISSUER OR THE BANK

     46   

Section 501.

 

Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture

     46   

Section 502.

 

Application of Trust Money

     46   

Section 503.

 

Cancellation of Notes Held by the Issuer or the Transferor

     47   
ARTICLE VI  

EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES

     48   

Section 601.

 

Events of Default

     48   

Section 602.

 

Acceleration of Maturity; Rescission and Annulment

     49   

Section 603.

 

Collection of Indebtedness and Suits for Enforcement by Indenture Trustee

     50   

Section 604.

 

Indenture Trustee May File Proofs of Claim

     51   

Section 605.

 

Indenture Trustee May Enforce Claims Without Possession of Notes

     51   

Section 606.

 

Application of Money Collected

     52   

Section 607.

 

Indenture Trustee May Elect to Hold the Collateral Certificate

     52   

Section 608.

 

Sale of Collateral for Accelerated Notes

     52   

Section 609.

 

Noteholders Have the Right to Direct the Time, Method and Place of Conducting Any Proceeding for Any Remedy Available to the Indenture Trustee

     52   

Section 610.

 

Limitation on Suits

     53   

Section 611.

 

Unconditional Right of Noteholders to Receive Principal and Interest; Limited Recourse

     53   

Section 612.

 

Restoration of Rights and Remedies

     54   

Section 613.

 

Rights and Remedies Cumulative

     54   

Section 614.

 

Delay or Omission Not Waiver

     54   

Section 615.

 

Control by Noteholders

     54   

Section 616.

 

Waiver of Past Defaults

     55   

Section 617.

 

Undertaking for Costs

     55   

Section 618.

 

Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws

     55   

 

- ii -


TABLE OF CONTENTS

(continued)

 

         Page  
ARTICLE VII  

THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE

     56   

Section 701.

 

Certain Duties and Responsibilities

     56   

Section 702.

 

Notice of Defaults

     57   

Section 703.

 

Certain Rights of Indenture Trustee

     57   

Section 704.

 

Not Responsible for Recitals or Issuance of Notes

     58   

Section 705.

 

May Hold Notes

     59   

Section 706.

 

Money Held in Trust

     59   

Section 707.

 

Compensation and Reimbursement, Limit on Compensation, Reimbursement and Indemnity

     59   

Section 708.

 

Disqualification; Conflicting Interests

     60   

Section 709.

 

Corporate Indenture Trustee Required; Eligibility

     60   

Section 710.

 

Resignation and Removal; Appointment of Successor

     60   

Section 711.

 

Acceptance of Appointment by Successor

     62   

Section 712.

 

Merger, Conversion, Consolidation or Succession to Business

     63   

Section 713.

 

Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer

     63   

Section 714.

 

Appointment of Authenticating Agent

     63   

Section 715.

 

Tax Returns

     65   

Section 716.

 

Representations and Covenants of the Indenture Trustee

     65   

Section 717.

 

Indenture Trustee’s Application for Instructions from the Issuer

     66   

Section 718.

 

Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate Indenture Trustee

     66   
ARTICLE VIII  

NOTEHOLDERS’ MEETINGS, LISTS, REPORTS BY INDENTURE TRUSTEE, ISSUER AND BENEFICIARY

     68   

Section 801.

 

Issuer To Furnish Indenture Trustee Names and Addresses of Noteholders

     68   

Section 802.

 

Preservation of Information; Communications to Noteholders

     68   

Section 803.

 

Reports by Indenture Trustee

     69   

Section 804.

 

Meetings of Noteholders; Amendments and Waivers

     70   

Section 805.

 

Reports by Issuer to the Commission

     72   
ARTICLE IX  

INDENTURE SUPPLEMENTS; AMENDMENTS TO THE POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT; AMENDMENTS TO THE ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEW AGREEMENT AND AMENDMENTS TO THE TRUST AGREEMENT

     73   

Section 901.

 

Supplemental Indentures and Amendments Without Consent of Noteholders

     73   

Section 902.

 

Supplemental Indentures with Consent of Noteholders

     75   

Section 903.

 

Execution of Amendments and Supplemental Indentures

     76   

 

- iii -


TABLE OF CONTENTS

(continued)

 

         Page  

Section 904.

 

Effect of Amendments and Supplemental Indentures

     76   

Section 905.

 

Conformity with Trust Indenture Act

     77   

Section 906.

 

Reference in Notes to Supplemental Indentures

     77   

Section 907.

 

Amendments to the Trust Agreement

     77   

Section 908.

 

Amendments to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Amendments to the Asset Representations Review Agreement; Treatment of Noteholders and Note Owners.

     77   

Section 909.

 

Notice.

     78   
ARTICLE X  

REPRESENTATIONS, WARRANTIES AND COVENANTS OF ISSUER

     80   

Section 1001.

 

Payment of Principal and Interest

     80   

Section 1002.

 

Maintenance of Office or Agency

     80   

Section 1003.

 

Money for Note Payments to be Held in Trust

     80   

Section 1004.

 

Statement as to Compliance

     82   

Section 1005.

 

Legal Existence

     82   

Section 1006.

 

Further Instruments and Acts

     82   

Section 1007.

 

Compliance with Laws

     83   

Section 1008.

 

Notice of Events of Default

     83   

Section 1009.

 

Certain Negative Covenants

     83   

Section 1010.

 

No Other Business

     83   

Section 1011.

 

Rule 144A Information

     83   

Section 1012.

 

Performance of Obligations

     84   

Section 1013.

 

Issuer May Consolidate, Etc., Only on Certain Terms

     84   

Section 1014.

 

Successor Substituted

     86   

Section 1015.

 

Guarantees, Loans, Advances and Other Liabilities

     86   

Section 1016.

 

Capital Expenditures

     86   

Section 1017.

 

Restricted Payments

     86   

Section 1018.

 

No Borrowing

     87   
ARTICLE XI  

EARLY REDEMPTION OF NOTES

     88   

Section 1101.

 

Applicability of Article

     88   

Section 1102.

 

Optional Repurchase

     89   

Section 1103.

 

Notice

     90   
ARTICLE XII  

MISCELLANEOUS

     91   

Section 1201.

 

No Petition

     91   

Section 1202.

 

Trust Obligations

     91   

Section 1203.

 

Limitations on Liability

     91   

Section 1204.

 

Tax Treatment

     92   

Section 1205.

 

Actions Taken by the Issuer

     92   

Section 1206.

 

Alternate Payment Provisions

     92   

 

- iv -


TABLE OF CONTENTS

(continued)

 

         Page  

Section 1207.

 

Termination of Issuer

     92   

Section 1208.

 

Final Distribution

     92   

Section 1209.

 

Termination Distributions

     93   

Section 1210.

 

Derivative Counterparty, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Provider and Supplemental Liquidity Provider as Third-Party Beneficiary

     93   
ARTICLE XIII  

COMPLIANCE WITH REGULATION AB

     94   

Section 1301.

 

Intent of the Parties; Reasonableness

     94   

Section 1302.

 

Additional Representations and Warranties of the Indenture Trustee

     94   

Section 1303.

 

Information to Be Provided by the Indenture Trustee

     94   

Section 1304.

 

Report on Assessment of Compliance and Attestation

     95   

Section 1305.

 

Investor Communication

     96   

 

- v -


EXHIBITS

 

EXHIBIT A    [FORM OF] INVESTMENT LETTER
EXHIBIT B-1    [FORM OF] CLEARANCE SYSTEM CERTIFICATE TO BE GIVEN TO THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE BY EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM, LUXEMBOURG FOR DELIVERY OF DEFINITIVE NOTES IN EXCHANGE FOR A PORTION OF A TEMPORARY GLOBAL NOTE
EXHIBIT B-2    [FORM OF] CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED TO EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM, LUXEMBOURG BY [●] WITH RESPECT TO REGISTERED NOTES SOLD TO QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYERS
EXHIBIT B-3    [FORM OF] CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED TO EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM, LUXEMBOURG BY A BENEFICIAL OWNER OF NOTES, OTHER THAN A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER
EXHIBIT C    [FORM OF] ANNUAL CERTIFICATION
EXHIBIT D    SERVICING CRITERIA TO BE ADDRESSED IN ASSESSMENT OF COMPLIANCE

 

- vi -


 

RECONCILIATION AND TIE BETWEEN TRUST INDENTURE

ACT OF 1939 AND INDENTURE PROVISIONS*

 

Trust Indenture Act Section

 

Indenture Section

310(a)(1)

    709

      (a)(2)

    709

      (a)(3)

    718

      (a)(4)

    Not Applicable

      (a)(5)

    709

      (b)

    708, 710(d)(i)

      (c)

    Not Applicable

311(a)

    713

      (b)

    713

      (c)

    Not Applicable

      312(a)

    801, 802

      (b)

    802(b)

      (c)

    802(c)

313(a)

    803

      (b)

    803(c)

      (c)

    803, 803(c)

      (d)

    805

314(a)

    805, 1004

      (b)

  See related Asset Pool Supplement

      (c)(1)

  See related Asset Pool Supplement

      (c)(2)

  See related Asset Pool Supplement

      (c)(3)

  See related Asset Pool Supplement

      (d)(1)

  See related Asset Pool Supplement

      (d)(2)

    Not Applicable

      (d)(3)

    Not Applicable

      (e)

    102

315(a)

    701(a), 701(b)

      (b)

    702

      (c)

    701(b)

      (d)

    701(d)

      (d)(1)

    701(d)

      (d)(2)

    701(d)(ii)

      (d)(3)

    701(d)(ii)

      (e)

    617

316(a)(1)(A)

    609

316(a)(1)(B)

    616

316(a)(2)

    Not Applicable

316(b)

    611

317(a)(1)

    603

317(a)(2)

    604

317(b)

    1103

318(a)

    107

 

* This reconciliation and tie shall not, for any purpose be part of the within indenture.

 

- vii -


THIS INDENTURE between CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST, a statutory trust organized under the laws of the State of Delaware (the “Issuer”), having its principal office at E.A. Delle Donne Corporate Center, Montgomery Building, 1011 Centre Road, Wilmington, DE 19805-1266, and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation, in its capacity as Indenture Trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”), is made and entered into as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016.

RECITALS OF THE ISSUER

The Issuer duly authorized the execution and delivery of the Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 (the “Original Indenture”), to provide for the issuance of its Notes to be issued in one or more fully registered or bearer Series, Classes or Tranches.

The Issuer and the Indenture Trustee desire to amend and restate in its entirety the Original Indenture as set forth herein.

All things necessary to make this Indenture a valid agreement of the Issuer, in accordance with its terms, have been done.

GRANTING CLAUSE

Pursuant to an Asset Pool Supplement, the Issuer shall grant to the Indenture Trustee for the related Asset Pool for the benefit and security of (a) the Noteholders secured by such Asset Pool, (b) each Derivative Counterparty to a Derivative Agreement entered into in connection with the issuance of a Tranche of Notes that expressly states that such Derivative Counterparty is entitled to the benefit of the Collateral and (c) the Indenture Trustee, in its individual capacity, a security interest in all of its right, title and interest, whether now owned or hereafter acquired, in and to, the Collateral specified in the related Asset Pool Supplement.

The Security Interest in the Collateral designated for inclusion in an Asset Pool is granted to secure the Notes issued with respect to that Asset Pool (and the obligations under this Indenture, the related Asset Pool Supplement, the related Indenture Supplement or any applicable Derivative Agreement) equally and ratably without prejudice, priority or distinction between any Note and any other Note that is expressly secured by such Asset Pool by reason of difference in time of issuance or otherwise, except as otherwise expressly provided in this Indenture, in any Asset Pool Supplement or in the Indenture Supplement which establishes any Tranche of Notes, and to secure (i) the payment of all amounts due on such Notes (and, to the extent so specified, the obligations under any applicable Derivative Agreements) in accordance with their terms, (ii) the payment of all other sums payable by the Issuer under this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement relating to such secured Notes and (iii) compliance by the Issuer with the provisions of this Indenture or any Indenture Supplement or any Asset Pool Supplement relating to such Notes. This Indenture, as may be supplemented, including by each Asset Pool Supplement, is a security agreement within the meaning of the UCC.


The Indenture Trustee acknowledges the grant of such Security Interest, and agrees to perform the duties herein such that the interests of the Noteholders secured by such Asset Pool may be adequately and effectively protected.

Particular Notes, Derivative Agreements, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreements and Supplemental Liquidity Agreements will benefit from the Security Interest to the extent (and only to the extent) proceeds of and distributions on the Collateral are allocated for their benefit pursuant to this Indenture, the applicable Asset Pool Supplement and the applicable Indenture Supplement.

AGREEMENTS OF THE PARTIES

To set forth or to provide for the establishment of the terms and conditions upon which the Notes are to be authenticated, issued and delivered, and in consideration of the premises and the purchase of Notes by the Holders thereof, it is mutually covenanted and agreed as follows, for the equal and proportionate benefit of all Holders of the Notes or of a Series, Class or Tranche thereof, as the case may be.

LIMITED RECOURSE

The obligation of the Issuer to make payments of principal, interest and other amounts on the Notes and to make payments in respect of Derivative Agreements, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreements or Supplemental Liquidity Agreements is limited in recourse as set forth in Section 611.

 

- 2 -


ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS AND OTHER PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION

Section 101. Definitions. For all purposes of this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement and any Indenture Supplement, except as otherwise expressly provided or unless the context otherwise requires:

(1) the terms defined in this Article have the meanings assigned to them in this Article, and include the plural as well as the singular;

(2) all other terms used herein which are defined in the Trust Indenture Act or by Commission rule under the Trust Indenture Act or in the related Transfer and Administration Agreement or the related Asset Pool Supplement, either directly or by reference therein, have the meanings assigned to them therein;

(3) all accounting terms not otherwise defined herein have the meanings assigned to them in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and, except as otherwise herein expressly provided, the term “generally accepted accounting principles” with respect to any computation required or permitted hereunder means such accounting principles as are generally accepted in the United States of America at the date of such computation;

(4) all references in this Indenture to designated “Articles,” “Sections” and other subdivisions are to the designated Articles, Sections and other subdivisions of this Indenture as originally executed. The words “herein,” “hereof” and “hereunder” and other words of similar import refer to this Indenture as a whole and not to any particular Article, Section or other subdivision; and

(5) “including” and words of similar import will be deemed to be followed by “without limitation.”

Act,” when used with respect to any Noteholder, is defined in Section 104(a).

Action,” when used with respect to any Noteholder, is defined in Section 104(a).

Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount” means at any time with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes at such time, less any funds on deposit in respect of principal in any Issuer Account or the related Sub-Account, as applicable, for the benefit of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes at such time.

Administrator” means Capital One, in its capacity as Administrator.

 

- 3 -


Adverse Effect” means, whenever used in this Indenture with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes with respect to any Action, that such Action will at the time of its occurrence (a) result in the occurrence of an Early Redemption Event or Event of Default relating to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, as applicable, (b) adversely affect the amount of funds available to be distributed to the Noteholders of any such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes pursuant to this Indenture or the timing of such distributions, or (c) adversely affect the Security Interest of the Indenture Trustee in the Collateral securing the Outstanding Notes in the related Asset Pool unless otherwise permitted by this Indenture or any related Asset Pool Supplement.

Affiliate” means, with respect to any specified Person, any other Person directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified Person. For the purposes of this definition, “control” when used with respect to any specified Person means the power to direct the management and policies of such Person, directly or indirectly, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise; and the terms “controlling” and “controlled” have meanings correlative to the foregoing.

Asset Pool” means a pool of Collateral designated for inclusion in a particular Asset Pool pursuant to an Asset Pool Supplement, that secures a particular Tranche of Notes or more than one Tranche of Notes as specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement for each Tranche of Notes.

Asset Pool Supplement” means, with respect to any Asset Pool, a supplement to this Indenture, executed and delivered in conjunction with the first issuance of Notes secured by that Asset Pool, including all amendments thereof and supplements thereto.

Asset Representations Review Agreement” is defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Asset Representations Reviewer” is defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Authenticating Agent” means any Person authorized by the Indenture Trustee to authenticate Notes under Section 714.

Authorized Newspaper” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, publication in the newspaper of record specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement for that Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, or if and so long as Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes are listed on any securities exchange and that exchange so requires, in the newspaper of record required by the applicable securities exchange, printed in any language specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement or satisfying the requirements of such exchange.

Bearer Note” means a Note in bearer form.

Beneficiary” is defined in the Trust Agreement.

 

- 4 -


Business Day,” unless otherwise specified in the Indenture Supplement for any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, means any day other than (a) a Saturday or Sunday or (b) any other day on which national banking associations or state banking institutions in New York, New York or Richmond, Virginia (or, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, any additional city specified in the related Indenture Supplement), are authorized or obligated by law, executive order or governmental decree to be closed.

Capital One” means Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, a national banking association, and its successors and permitted assigns.

Certificate of Authentication” means the certificate of authentication of the Indenture Trustee, the form of which is described in Section 203, or the alternative certificate of authentication of the Authenticating Agent, the form of which is described in Section 714.

Class” means, with respect to any Note, the class specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement.

Collateral” with respect to each Asset Pool, is defined in the granting clause in the Asset Pool Supplement for such Asset Pool.

Collateral Certificate” means any Investor Certificate issued pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the related Series Supplement that is included as Collateral in the granting clause of the related Asset Pool Supplement.

Collection Account” with respect to each Asset Pool, is defined in the Asset Pool Supplement for such Asset Pool.

Commission” means the Securities and Exchange Commission, as from time to time constituted, created under the Securities Exchange Act, or, if at any time after the execution of this Indenture such Commission is not existing and performing the duties now assigned to it under the Trust Indenture Act, then the body performing such duties on such date.

Corporate Trust Office” means the principal office of the Indenture Trustee in New York, New York at which at any particular time its corporate trust business will be principally administered, which office at the date hereof is located at 101 Barclay Street, Floor 7 West, New York, New York 10286, Attention: Corporate Trust Administration-Asset-Backed Securities.

Depository” means a U.S. Depository or a Foreign Depository, as the case may be.

Derivative Agreement” means any currency, interest rate or other swap, cap, collar, guaranteed investment contract or other derivative agreement.

Derivative Counterparty” means any party to any Derivative Agreement other than the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee.

 

- 5 -


Discount Note” means a Note that provides for an amount less than the Stated Principal Amount (but not less than the Initial Dollar Principal Amount) thereof to be due and payable upon the occurrence of an Early Redemption Event or other optional or mandatory redemption or the occurrence of an Event of Default and the acceleration of such Note, in each case before the Expected Principal Payment Date of the applicable Note.

Dollar,” “$” or “U.S. $” means United States dollars.

Early Redemption Event” is defined in Section 1101.

Eligible Deposit Account” means either (a) a segregated account (including a securities account) with an Eligible Institution or (b) a segregated trust account with the corporate trust department of a depository institution (other than Capital One or any Affiliate thereof) organized under the laws of the United States of America or any one of the states thereof or the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a foreign bank), or a trust company acceptable to each Note Rating Agency, and acting as a trustee for funds deposited in such account, so long as any of the securities of such depository institution or trust company shall have a credit rating from each Note Rating Agency in one of its generic credit rating categories which signifies investment grade.

Eligible Institution” means (a) a depository institution (which may be the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee or any affiliate thereof, but not Capital One or any Affiliate thereof) organized under the laws of the United States of America or any one of the states thereof, including the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a foreign bank), which at all times (i) has either (x) a long-term unsecured debt rating of A2 or better by Moody’s or (y) a certificate of deposit rating of P-1 by Moody’s, (ii) has either (x) a long-term unsecured debt rating of AAA by Standard & Poor’s or (y) a certificate of deposit rating of A-l+ by Standard & Poor’s, (iii) has either (x) if such institution is rated by Fitch, a long-term unsecured debt rating of A- by Fitch or (y) a certificate of deposit rating of F1 by Fitch and (iv) is a member of the FDIC or (b) any other institution that is acceptable to Moody’s, Standard & Poor’s and Fitch.

Eligible Investments” means, unless otherwise provided in the Indenture Supplement with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, investment property or negotiable instruments which evidence:

(a) direct obligations of, and obligations fully guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest by, the United States of America;

(b) demand deposits, time deposits or certificates of deposit (having original maturities of no more than 365 days) of depository institutions or trust companies incorporated under the laws of the United States of America or any one of the states thereof or the District of Columbia (or any domestic branch of a foreign bank), and subject to supervision and examination by federal or state banking or depository institution authorities; provided that at the time of the Trust’s investment or contractual commitment to invest therein, the short-term debt rating of such depository institution or trust company shall be in the highest ratings investment category of each Note Rating Agency (which, in the case of Standard & Poor’s, shall be A-1+);

 

- 6 -


(c) commercial paper or other short-term obligations having, at the time of the Trust’s investment or contractual commitment to invest therein, a rating from each Note Rating Agency in its highest ratings investment category (which, in the case of Standard & Poor’s, shall be A-1+);

(d) demand deposits, time deposits and certificates of deposit which are fully insured by the FDIC, with a Person the commercial paper of which has a credit rating from each Note Rating Agency in its highest ratings investment category (which, in the case of Standard & Poor’s shall be A-1+);

(e) notes or bankers’ acceptances (having original maturities of no more than 365 days) issued by any depository institution or trust company referred to in (b) above;

(f) investments in money market funds rated in the highest ratings investment category by each Note Rating Agency or otherwise approved in writing by each Note Rating Agency;

(g) time deposits (having maturities of not more than thirty (30) days), other than as referred to in clause (d) above, with a Person the commercial paper of which has a credit rating from each Note Rating Agency in its highest ratings investment category; or

(h) any other investment if each Note Rating Agency confirms in writing that such investment will not cause a Ratings Effect; provided, however, that no security issued by or other obligation of Capital One or any Affiliated thereof shall be an Eligible Investment.

Entity” means any Person other than an individual or government (including any agency or political subdivision thereof).

Event of Default” is defined in Section 601.

Exchange Date” means, with respect to any Tranche of Notes, the latest of:

(a) in the case of exchanges of beneficial interests in Temporary Global Notes for beneficial interests in Permanent Global Notes in registered form, any date that is after the related issuance date;

(b) in the case of exchanges of beneficial interests in Temporary Global Notes for beneficial interests in Permanent Global Notes in bearer form, the date of presentation of certification of non-United States beneficial ownership (as described in Section 205); and

(c) the earliest date on which such an exchange of a beneficial interest in a Temporary Global Note for a beneficial interest in a Permanent Global Note is permitted by applicable law.

 

- 7 -


Expected Principal Payment Date” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the scheduled due date of any payment of principal on such Notes, as specified in the related Indenture Supplement, or if such day is not a Business Day, the next following Business Day, unless such day is in the next calendar month, in which case such Expected Principal Payment Date, unless otherwise specified in the related Indenture Supplement, will be the last Business Day of the current calendar month.

FDIC” means the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any successor thereto.

Federal Bankruptcy Code” means Title 11 of the United States Code, as amended from time to time.

Fitch” means Fitch, Inc., or any successor thereto.

Foreign Currency” means (a) a currency other than Dollars or (b) denominated in a currency other than Dollars.

Foreign Currency Note” means a Note denominated in a Foreign Currency.

Foreign Depository” means the Person specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement, in its capacity as depository for the accounts of any clearing agencies located outside the United States.

Global Note” means any Note issued pursuant to Section 204.

Group” means any one or more Series of Notes which are specified as belonging to a common Group (including any Group established by an Indenture Supplement) in the applicable Indenture Supplement. A particular Series may be included in more than one Group if the Indenture Supplement for such Series so provides.

Holder,” when used with respect to any Note, means a Noteholder.

Indenture” or “this Indenture” means this Indenture as originally executed and as amended, supplemented, restated or otherwise modified from time to time including by Indenture Supplements for the issuance of Series of Notes and Asset Pool Supplements for the establishment of Asset Pools entered into pursuant to the applicable provisions hereof.

Indenture Supplement” means, with respect to any Series of Notes, a supplement to this Indenture, executed and delivered in conjunction with the issuance of such Notes pursuant to Section 301, together with any applicable Terms Document for any Classes and Tranches of Notes belonging to such Series related to such Indenture Supplement and any amendment to the Indenture Supplement executed pursuant to Section 901 or 902, and, in either case, including all amendments thereof and supplements thereto.

 

- 8 -


Indenture Trustee” means the Person named as the Indenture Trustee in the first paragraph of this Indenture until a successor Indenture Trustee shall have become such pursuant to the applicable provisions of this Indenture, and thereafter “Indenture Trustee” means and includes each Person who is then an Indenture Trustee hereunder. If at any time there is more than one such Person, “Indenture Trustee” as used with respect to the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche means the Indenture Trustee with respect to Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche.

Indenture Trustee Authorized Officer,” when used with respect to the Indenture Trustee, means any vice president, any assistant vice president, the treasurer, any assistant treasurer, any senior trust officer or trust officer, or any other officer of the Indenture Trustee customarily performing functions similar to those performed by any of the above designated officers and also means, with respect to a particular corporate trust matter, any other officer to whom such matter is referred because of his knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject.

Initial Dollar Principal Amount” means (a) unless otherwise specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement, with respect to a Series, Class or Tranche of Dollar Notes, the aggregate initial principal amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, and (b) with respect to a Series, Class or Tranche of Discount Notes or Foreign Currency Notes, the amount specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement as the Initial Dollar Principal Amount thereof.

Interest-bearing Note” means a Note that bears interest at a stated or computed rate on the principal amount thereof. A Note may be both an Interest-bearing Note and a Discount Note.

Interest Payment Date” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the scheduled due date of any payment of interest on such Notes, as specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement, or if such day is not a Business Day, the next following Business Day, unless such day is in the next calendar month, in which case the Interest Payment Date, unless otherwise specified in the related Indenture Supplement, will be the last Business Day of the current calendar month; provided, however, that upon the acceleration of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes following an Event of Default or upon the occurrence of an Early Redemption Event, or other optional or mandatory redemption of that Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, each Monthly Principal Accrual Date will be an Interest Payment Date.

Internal Revenue Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time.

Invested Amount,” with respect to any Collateral Certificate, is defined in the Series Supplement for the applicable Collateral Certificate, and with respect to any other Investor Certificate, is defined in the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the related Series Supplement.

 

- 9 -


Investor Certificate” means an investor certificate, and not a seller certificate or transferor certificate, issued pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the related Series Supplement.

Investor Certificateholder” means the holder of record of an Investor Certificate.

Investment Company Act” means the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended.

Issuer” is defined in the first paragraph of this Indenture.

Issuer Accounts” is defined in the related Asset Pool Supplement.

Issuer Authorized Officer” means (a) an authorized signatory of the Owner Trustee, or (b) the chairman or vice-chairman of the board of directors, chairman or vice-chairman of the executive committee of the board of directors, the president, any vice-president, the secretary, any assistant secretary, the treasurer, or any assistant treasurer, in each case of the Beneficiary, or any other officer or employee of the Beneficiary who is authorized to act on behalf of the Issuer.

Issuer Certificate” means a certificate (including an Officer’s Certificate) signed in the name of an Issuer Authorized Officer, or the Issuer by an Issuer Authorized Officer and, in each case delivered to the Indenture Trustee relating to, among other things, the issuance of a new Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. Wherever this Indenture requires that an Issuer Certificate be signed also by an accountant or other expert, such accountant or other expert (except as otherwise expressly provided in this Indenture) may be an employee of the Beneficiary.

Issuer Tax Opinion” means, with respect to any action, an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that, for United States federal income tax purposes, (a) such action will not adversely affect the tax characterization as debt of any Outstanding Series, Class or Tranche of Notes that were characterized as debt at the time of their issuance, (b) following such action the Issuer will not be treated as an association (or publicly traded partnership) taxable as a corporation, (c) such action will not cause or constitute an event in which gain or loss would be recognized by any Holder of any such Notes, and (d) except as provided in the related Indenture Supplement, where such action is the issuance of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, following such action such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will be properly characterized as debt.

Legal Maturity Date” means, with respect to a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the date specified in the Indenture Supplement for such Note as the fixed date on which the principal of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes is due and payable.

Majority Holders” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes or all Outstanding Notes, the Holders of greater than 50% in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche or of all Outstanding Notes, as the case may be.

 

- 10 -


Master Trust” means a master trust or other securitization special purpose entity for which Capital One or an Affiliate of Capital One acts as transferor or seller or servicer, established pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Master Trust Tax Opinion” means, with respect to any action, an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that, for United States federal income tax purposes, (a) such action will not adversely affect the tax characterization as debt of the Investor Certificates of any outstanding series or class under the applicable Master Trust that were characterized as debt at the time of their issuance, (b) following such action such Master Trust will not be treated as an association (or publicly traded partnership) taxable as a corporation and (c) such action will not cause or constitute an event in which gain or loss would be recognized by any Investor Certificateholder.

Monthly Period” means the period from and including the first day of a calendar month to and including the last day of a calendar month.

Monthly Principal Accrual Date” with respect to any Class or Tranche of Notes, is defined in the Indenture Supplement.

Moody’s” means Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., or any successor thereto.

Nominal Liquidation Amount” means, with respect to any Outstanding Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, an amount determined in accordance with the applicable Indenture Supplement. The Nominal Liquidation Amount for a Series of Notes will be the sum of the Nominal Liquidation Amounts of all of the Classes or Tranches of Notes of such Series.

Non-Receivables Asset Pool” means any Asset Pool designated as such in the related Asset Pool Supplement.

Note” or “Notes” means any note or notes of any Series, Class or Tranche authenticated and delivered from time to time under this Indenture.

Note Owner” means the beneficial owner of an interest in a Global Note.

Note Rating Agency” means, with respect to any Outstanding Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, each statistical note rating agency selected by the Issuer to rate such Notes.

Note Register” is defined in Section 305.

Note Registrar” means the Person who keeps the Note Register specified in Section 305.

Noteholder” means a Person in whose name a Note is registered in the Note Register or the bearer of any Bearer Note (including a Global Note in bearer form), as the case may be.

 

- 11 -


Officer’s Certificate” means a certificate signed by the Beneficiary or the Owner Trustee and delivered to the Indenture Trustee. Wherever this Indenture requires that an Officer’s Certificate be signed also by an accountant or other expert, such accountant or other expert (except as otherwise expressly provided in this Indenture) may be an employee of the Beneficiary.

Opinion of Counsel” means a written opinion of counsel acceptable to the Indenture Trustee, who may, without limitation, and except as otherwise expressly provided in this Indenture, be an employee of or of counsel to the Issuer, the Beneficiary or any of their Affiliates.

Outstanding” means, with respect to all Notes, all Notes in all Asset Pools and, with respect to a Note or with respect to Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche means, as of the date of determination, all such Notes theretofore authenticated and delivered under this Indenture, except:

(a) any Notes theretofore canceled by the Indenture Trustee or delivered to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation, or canceled by the Issuer and delivered to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 309;

(b) any Notes for whose full payment (including principal and interest) or redemption money in the necessary amount has been theretofore deposited with the Indenture Trustee or any Paying Agent in trust for the Holders of such Notes; provided that, if such Notes are to be redeemed, notice of such redemption has been duly given if required pursuant to this Indenture, the related Indenture Supplement, or provision therefor satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee has been made;

(c) any Notes which are canceled pursuant to Section 503; and

(d) any Notes in exchange for or in lieu of which other Notes have been authenticated and delivered pursuant to this Indenture, or which will have been paid pursuant to the terms of Section 306 (except with respect to any such Note as to which proof satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee is presented that such Note is held by a person in whose hands such Note is a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Issuer).

For purposes of determining the amounts of deposits, allocations, reallocations or payments to be made, unless the context clearly requires otherwise, references to “Notes” will be deemed to be references to “Outstanding Notes.” In determining whether the Holders of the requisite principal amount of such Outstanding Notes have taken any Action hereunder, and for purposes of Section 804, Notes beneficially owned by the Issuer or the Transferor or any Affiliate of the Issuer or the Transferor will be disregarded and deemed not to be Outstanding. In determining whether the Indenture Trustee will be protected in relying upon any such Action, only Notes which an Indenture Trustee Authorized Officer knows to be owned by the Issuer or the Transferor, or any Affiliate of the Issuer or the Transferor, will be so disregarded. Notes so owned which have been pledged in good faith may be regarded as Outstanding if the pledgee proves to the satisfaction of the Indenture Trustee the pledgee’s right to act as owner with respect to such Notes and that the pledgee is not the Issuer or the Transferor or any other obligor upon the Notes or any Affiliate of the Issuer, the Transferor or such other obligor.

 

- 12 -


Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount” means at any time, either:

(a) with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes (other than Discount Notes), the aggregate Initial Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche at such time, less the amount of any withdrawals from any Issuer Account or Sub-Account for such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes for payment of principal to the Holders of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes or the applicable Derivative Counterparty pursuant to the related Indenture Supplement, or

(b) with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Discount Notes, an amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche calculated by reference to the applicable formula set forth in the applicable Indenture Supplement, taking into account the amount and timing of payments of principal made to the Holders of such Series, Class or Tranche or to the applicable Derivative Counterparty and accretions of principal, each pursuant to the related Indenture Supplement;

plus, in either case, the amount of any increase in the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes due to the issuance of additional Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche pursuant to Section 310.

Owner Trustee” is defined in the Trust Agreement.

Paying Agent” means any Person authorized by the Issuer to pay the principal of or interest on any Notes on behalf of the Issuer as provided in Section 1002 hereof.

Payment Date” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the applicable Principal Payment Date or Interest Payment Date.

Payment Instruction” means with respect to any Series of Notes, an instruction, the form of which is attached as an exhibit to the related Indenture Supplement.

Permanent Global Note” is defined in Section 205.

Person” means any individual, corporation, estate, partnership, limited liability company, limited liability partnership, joint venture, association, joint-stock company, business trust, statutory trust, trust, unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision thereof, or other entity of a similar nature.

Place of Payment” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes issued hereunder, the city or political subdivision so designated with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 301.

 

- 13 -


Pooling and Servicing Agreement” means a pooling and servicing agreement, indenture or other agreement for the issuance of securities from time to time from a Master Trust and the servicing of the receivables in such Master Trust, as such agreement may be amended, restated and supplemented from time to time.

Predecessor Notes” of any particular Note means every previous Note evidencing all or a portion of the same debt as that evidenced by such particular Note; and, for the purposes of this definition, any Note authenticated and delivered under Section 306 in lieu of a mutilated, lost, destroyed or stolen Note will be deemed to evidence the same debt as the mutilated, lost, destroyed or stolen Note.

Principal Payment Date” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, each Expected Principal Payment Date or upon the acceleration of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes following an Event of Default or upon the occurrence of an Early Redemption Event, or other optional or mandatory redemption of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, each Monthly Principal Accrual Date.

Ratings Effect” means a reduction, qualification with negative implications or withdrawal of any then current rating of the Notes (other than as a result of the termination of a Note Rating Agency).

Record Date” for the interest or principal payable on any Note on any applicable Payment Date means the last day of the month before the related Interest Payment Date or Principal Payment Date, as applicable, unless otherwise specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement.

Registered Note” means a Note issued in registered form.

Registered Noteholder” means a holder of a Registered Note.

Regulation AB” means Subpart 229.1100 – Asset-Backed Securities (Regulation AB), 17 C.F.R. §§229.1100-229.1125, as such may be amended from time to time, and subject to such clarification and interpretation as have been provided by the Commission in the adopting releases (including Asset-Backed Securities, Securities Act Release No. 33-8518, 70 Fed. Reg. 1,506, 1,531 (Jan. 7, 2005) and Asset-Backed Securities Disclosure and Registration, Securities Act Release No. 33-9638, 79 Fed. Reg. 57,184 (September 24, 2014)) or by the staff of the Commission, or as may be provided by the Commission or its staff from time to time.

Required Subordinated Amount” means, with respect to any Tranche of a Senior Class of Notes, the amount specified in the related Indenture Supplement.

Sarbanes Certification” has the meaning specified in Section 1304(iii).

Securities Act” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended from time to time.

 

- 14 -


Securities Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time.

Securitization Transaction” means any issuance of new Notes of any series, class or tranche, pursuant to Section 310, whether publicly offered or privately placed, rated or unrated.

Security Interest” means the security interest granted pursuant to the granting clause in any Asset Pool Supplement.

Senior Class,” with respect to a Class of Notes of any Series, is defined in the related Indenture Supplement.

Series” means, with respect to any Note, the Series specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement.

Series Supplement” means a series supplement to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement or similar document setting forth the terms of a Collateral Certificate, as such agreement may be amended, supplemented, restated or otherwise modified from time to time.

Servicing Criteria” means the “servicing criteria” set forth in Item 1122(d) of Regulation AB, as such may be amended from time to time.

Standard & Poor’s” means Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services or any successor thereto.

Stated Principal Amount,” with respect to any Note, has the meaning specified in the related Indenture Supplement or Terms Document.

Sub-Account” means each portion of an Issuer Account designated as such pursuant to this Indenture, the related Indenture Supplement or the applicable Asset Pool Supplement.

Subordinated Class,” with respect to a Class of Notes of any Series, has the meaning specified in the related Indenture Supplement.

Subordinated Notes” means Notes of a Subordinated Class of a Series.

Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement” means a letter of credit, cash collateral account or surety bond or other similar arrangement with any credit enhancement provider which provides the benefit of one or more forms of credit enhancement which is referenced in the applicable Indenture Supplement for any Tranche of Notes in an Asset Pool.

Supplemental Credit Enhancement Provider” means any party to any Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement other than the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee.

 

- 15 -


Supplemental Issuer Accounts” means the trust account or accounts designated as such and established pursuant to Section 402(a).

Supplemental Liquidity Agreement” means any liquidity facility or other liquidity agreement which provides the benefit of liquidity for any Tranche of Notes in an Asset Pool which is referenced in the applicable Indenture Supplement for such Tranche of Notes.

Supplemental Liquidity Provider” means any party to any Supplemental Liquidity Agreement other than the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee.

Temporary Global Note” is defined in Section 205.

Terms Document” means, with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, a supplement to the Indenture Supplement that establishes such Class or Tranche.

Tranche” means, with respect to any Class of Notes, Notes of such Class which have identical terms, conditions and Tranche designation. Notes of a single Tranche may be issued on different dates.

Transfer and Administration Agreement” means any Transfer and Administration Agreement between the Issuer, the applicable Transferor or Transferors, the Administrator and the Indenture Trustee, which by its terms is identified as being a Transfer and Administration Agreement referred to herein, as the same may be amended, restated, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

Transferor” is defined in the related Transfer and Administration Agreement.

Trust Agreement” means the Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust Second Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of January 13, 2006, between the Beneficiary and the Owner Trustee, as the same may be amended, supplemented and modified from time to time.

Trust Estate” is defined in the Trust Agreement.

Trust Indenture Act” means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended by the Trust Indenture Reform Act of 1990, as in force at the date as of which this Indenture was executed except as provided in Section 905.

UCC” means the Uniform Commercial Code, as in effect in the relevant jurisdiction.

United States Person” means a citizen or resident of the United States, a corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the laws of the United States of America, any one of the states thereof, the District of Columbia or any political subdivision thereof, or an estate or trust the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source.

 

- 16 -


U.S. Depository” means, unless otherwise specified by the Issuer pursuant to any of Section 204, 206 or 301, with respect to Notes of any Tranche issuable or issued as a Global Note within the United States, The Depository Trust Company, New York, New York, or any successor thereto registered as a clearing agency under the Securities Exchange Act, or other applicable statute or regulation.

Section 102. Compliance Certificates and Opinions. Upon any application or request by the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee to take any action under any provision of this Indenture, the Issuer will furnish to the Indenture Trustee (i) an Officer’s Certificate stating that all conditions precedent, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the proposed action have been complied with and (ii) an Opinion of Counsel stating that in the opinion of such counsel all such conditions precedent, if any, have been complied with, except that in the case of any such application or request as to which the furnishing of such documents is specifically required by any provision of this Indenture relating to such particular application or request, no additional certificate or opinion need be furnished.

Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 310 and of the preceding paragraph, if all Notes of a Tranche are not to be originally issued at one time, it will not be necessary to deliver the Issuer Certificate otherwise required pursuant to Section 310 or the Officer’s Certificate and Opinion of Counsel otherwise required pursuant to such preceding paragraph at or before the time of authentication of each Note of such Tranche if such documents are delivered at or prior to the authentication upon original issuance of the first Note of such Tranche to be issued.

The Indenture Trustee may rely, as to authorization by the Issuer of any Tranche of Notes, the form and terms thereof and the legality, validity, binding effect and enforceability thereof, upon the Opinion of Counsel and the other documents delivered pursuant to Section 310 and this Section, as applicable, in connection with the first authentication of Notes of such Tranche.

Every certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture (except for the written statement required by Section 1004) will include:

(a) a statement that each individual signing such certificate or opinion has read such covenant or condition and the definitions herein relating thereto;

(b) a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the statements or opinions contained in such certificate or opinion are based;

(c) a statement that such individual has made such examination or investigation as is necessary to express an informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been complied with; and

(d) a statement as to whether, in the opinion of each such individual, such condition or covenant has been complied with.

 

- 17 -


Section 103. Form of Documents Delivered to Indenture Trustee. In any case where several matters are required to be certified by, or covered by an opinion of, one or more specified Persons, one such Person may certify or give an opinion with respect to some matters and one or more other such Persons as to the other matters, and any such Person may certify or give an opinion as to such matters in one or several documents.

Any certificate or opinion of the Issuer may be based, insofar as it relates to legal matters, upon a certificate or opinion of, or representations by, counsel, unless the Issuer knows, or in the exercise of reasonable care should know, that the certificate or opinion or representations are erroneous. Any such certificate or opinion of, or representation by, counsel may be based, insofar as it relates to factual matters, upon a certificate or opinion of, or representations by, the Issuer stating that the information with respect to such factual matters is in the possession of the Issuer, unless such counsel knows, or in the exercise of reasonable care should know, that the certificate or opinion or representations are erroneous.

Where any Person is required to make, give or execute two or more applications, requests, consents, certificates, statements, opinions or other instruments under this Indenture, they may, but need not, be consolidated and form one instrument.

Section 104. Acts of Noteholders.

(a) Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action (collectively, “Action”) provided by this Indenture to be given or taken by Noteholders of any Series, Class or Tranche may be embodied in and evidenced by one or more instruments of substantially similar tenor signed by such Noteholders in person or by an agent duly appointed in writing. If Notes of a Series, Class or Tranche are issuable in whole or in part as Bearer Notes, any Action provided by this Indenture to be given or taken by such Noteholders may, alternatively, be embodied in and evidenced by the record of such Noteholders voting in favor thereof, either in person or by proxies duly appointed in writing, at any meeting of Noteholders duly called and held in accordance with the provisions of Section 804, or a combination of such instruments and any such record. Except as herein otherwise expressly provided, such Action will become effective when such instrument or instruments are delivered to the Indenture Trustee, and, where it is hereby expressly required, to the Issuer. Such instrument or instruments and any such record (and the Action embodied therein and evidenced thereby) are herein sometimes referred to as the “Act” of the Noteholders signing such instrument or instruments and so voting at any meeting. Proof of execution of any such instrument or of a writing appointing any such agent, or the holding by any Person of a Note, will be sufficient for any purpose of this Indenture and (subject to Section 701) conclusive in favor of the Indenture Trustee and the Issuer, if made in the manner provided in this Section 104. The record of any meeting of Noteholders shall be proved in the manner provided in Section 804.

 

- 18 -


(b) The fact and date of the execution by any Person of any such instrument or writing may be proved by the affidavit of a witness to such execution or by the certificate of any notary public or other officer authorized by law to take acknowledgments of deeds, certifying that the individual signing such instrument or writing acknowledged to him the execution thereof. Where such execution is by an officer of a corporation or a member of a partnership, on behalf of such corporation or partnership, such certificate or affidavit will also constitute sufficient proof of his authority. The fact and date of the execution of any such instrument or writing, or the authority of the person executing the same, may also be proved in any other manner which the Indenture Trustee deems sufficient.

(c) (i) The ownership of Registered Notes will be proved by the Note Register.

(ii) The ownership of Bearer Notes or coupons will be proved by the production of such Bearer Notes or coupons or by a certificate, satisfactory to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, executed, as depositary, by any bank, trust company, recognized securities dealer, as depositary, wherever situated, satisfactory to the Issuer. Each such certificate will be dated and will state that on the date thereof a Bearer Note or coupon bearing a specified serial number was deposited with or exhibited to such bank, trust company or recognized securities dealer by the Person named in such certificate. Any such certificate may be issued in respect of one or more Bearer Notes or coupons specified therein. The holding by the Person named in any such certificate of any Bearer Note specified therein will be presumed to continue for a period of one year from the date of such certificate unless at the time of any determination of such holding (A) another certificate bearing a later date issued in respect of the same Bearer Note or coupon produced, (B) the Bearer Note or coupon specified in such certificate is produced by some other Person or (C) the Bearer Note or coupon specified in such certificate has ceased to be Outstanding.

(d) The fact and date of execution of any such instrument or writing, the authority of the Person executing the same and the principal amount and serial numbers of Bearer Notes held by the Person so executing such instrument or writing and the date of holding the same may also be proved in any other manner which the Indenture Trustee deems sufficient; and the Indenture Trustee may in any instance require further proof with respect to any of the matters referred to in this Section.

(e) If the Issuer will solicit from the Holders any Action, the Issuer may, at its option, by an Officer’s Certificate and consistent with the Trust Indenture Act, fix in advance a record date for the determination of Holders entitled to give such Action, but the Issuer will have no obligation to do so. If the Issuer does not so fix a record date, such record date will be the later of thirty (30) days before the first solicitation of such Action or the date of the most recent list of Noteholders furnished to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 801 before such solicitation. Such Action may be given before or after the record date, but only the Holders of record at the close of business on the record date will be deemed to be Holders for the purposes of determining whether Holders of the requisite proportion of Notes Outstanding have authorized or agreed or consented to such Action, and for that purpose the Notes Outstanding will be

 

- 19 -


computed as of the record date; provided that no such authorization, agreement or consent by the Holders on the record date will be deemed effective unless it will become effective pursuant to the provisions of this Indenture not later than six months after the record date.

(f) Any Action by the Holder of any Note will bind the Holder of every Note issued upon the transfer thereof or in exchange therefor or in lieu thereof, in respect of anything done or suffered to be done by the Indenture Trustee or the Issuer in reliance thereon whether or not notation of such Action is made upon such Note.

(g) Without limiting the foregoing, a Holder entitled hereunder to take any Action hereunder with regard to any particular Note may do so with regard to all or any part of the principal amount of such Note or by one or more duly appointed agents each of which may do so pursuant to such appointment with regard to all or any part of such principal amount. Any notice given or Action taken by a Holder or its agents with regard to different parts of such principal amount pursuant to this paragraph shall have the same effect as if given or taken by separate Holders of each such different part.

(h) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, unless otherwise specified pursuant to Section 301 or pursuant to one or more Indentures Supplements, a Holder, including a Depository that is the Holder of a Global Note, may make, give or take, by a proxy or proxies duly appointed in writing, any Action provided in this Indenture to be made, given or taken by Holders, and a Depository that is the Holder of a Global Note may provide its proxy or proxies to the beneficial owners of interests in or security entitlements to any such Global Note through such Depository’s standing instructions and customary practices.

(i) The Issuer may fix a record date for the purpose of determining the Persons who are beneficial owners of interests in or security entitlements to any Global Note held by a Depository entitled under the procedures of such Depository to make, give or take, by a proxy or proxies duly appointed in writing, any Action provided in this Indenture to be made, given or taken by Holders. If such a record date is fixed, the Holders on such record date or their duly appointed proxy or proxies, and only such Persons, shall be entitled to make, give or take such Action, whether or not such Holders remain Holders after such record date. No such Action shall be valid or effective if made, given or taken more than 90 days after such record date.

Section 105. Notices, etc., to Indenture Trustee and Issuer. Any Action of Noteholders or other document provided or permitted by this Indenture to be made upon, given or furnished to, or filed with, the Indenture Trustee by any Noteholder or by the Issuer will be sufficient for every purpose hereunder if in writing and mailed, first-class postage prepaid or sent via facsimile transmission to the Indenture Trustee at its Corporate Trust Office, or the Issuer by the Indenture Trustee or by any Noteholder will be sufficient for every purpose hereunder (except as provided in Subsection 601(c)) if in writing and mailed, first-class postage prepaid, to the Issuer addressed to it at the address of its principal office specified in the first paragraph of this Indenture or at any other address previously furnished in writing to the Indenture Trustee by the Issuer.

 

- 20 -


Section 106. Notices to Noteholders; Waiver.

(a) Where this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement, any Indenture Supplement or any Registered Note provides for notice to Registered Noteholders of any event, such notice will be sufficiently given (unless otherwise herein, in such Indenture Supplement or in such Registered Note expressly provided) if in writing and mailed, first-class postage prepaid, sent by facsimile, sent by electronic transmission or personally delivered to each Holder of a Registered Note affected by such event, at such Noteholder’s address as it appears in the Note Register, not later than the latest date, and not earlier than the earliest date, prescribed for the giving of such notice. In any case where notice to Registered Noteholders is given by mail, facsimile, electronic transmission or delivery neither the failure to mail, send by facsimile, send by electronic transmission or deliver such notice, nor any defect in any notice so mailed, to any particular Noteholders will affect the sufficiency of such notice with respect to other Noteholders and any notice that is mailed, sent by facsimile, sent by electronic transmission or delivered in the manner herein provided shall conclusively have been presumed to have been duly given.

Where this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement, any Indenture Supplement or any Registered Note provides for notice in any manner, such notice may be waived in writing by the Person entitled to receive such notice, either before or after the event, and such waiver will be the equivalent of such notice. Waivers of notice by Registered Noteholders will be filed with the Indenture Trustee, but such filing will not be a condition precedent to the validity of any action taken in reliance upon such waiver.

(b) In case, by reason of the suspension of regular mail service as a result of a strike, work stoppage or otherwise, it will be impractical to mail notice of any event to any Holder of a Registered Note when such notice is required to be given pursuant to any provision of this Indenture, then any method of notification as will be satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee and the Issuer will be deemed to be a sufficient giving of such notice.

(c) No notice will be given by mail, facsimile, electronic transmission or otherwise delivered to a Holder of Bearer Notes or coupons in bearer form. In the case of any Series, Class or Tranche with respect to which any Bearer Notes are Outstanding, any notice required or permitted to be given to Holders of such Bearer Notes will be published in an Authorized Newspaper within the time period prescribed in this Indenture or the applicable Indenture Supplement.

(d) With respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the applicable Indenture Supplement may specify different or additional means of giving notice to the Holders of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche.

(e) Where this Indenture provides for notice to any Note Rating Agency, failure to give such notice will not affect any other rights or obligations created hereunder and will not under any circumstance constitute an Adverse Effect.

Section 107. Conflict with Trust Indenture Act. If and to the extent that any provision of this Indenture limits, qualifies or conflicts with the duties imposed by, or with

 

- 21 -


another provision (an “incorporated provision”) included in this Indenture by operation of, Sections 310 to 318, inclusive, of the Trust Indenture Act, such imposed duties or incorporated provision will control. If any provision of this Indenture modifies or excludes any provision of the Trust Indenture Act that may be so modified or excluded, the latter provision will be deemed to apply to this Indenture as so modified or excluded, as the case may be.

Section 108. Effect of Headings and Table of Contents. The Article and Section headings herein and the Table of Contents are for convenience only and will not affect the construction hereof.

Section 109. Successors and Assigns. All covenants and agreements in this Indenture by the Issuer will bind its successors and assigns, whether so expressed or not. All covenants and agreements of the Indenture Trustee in this Indenture shall bind its successors, co-trustees and agents of the Indenture Trustee.

Section 110. Severability of Provisions. In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Notes will be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions will not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.

Section 111. Benefits of Indenture. Nothing in this Indenture or in any Notes, express or implied, will give to any Person, other than the parties hereto and their successors hereunder, any Authenticating Agent or Paying Agent, the Note Registrar, Derivative Counterparties (to the extent specified in the applicable Derivative Agreement), Supplemental Credit Enhancement Providers and Supplemental Liquidity Providers (each to the extent specified in the applicable Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement and Supplemental Liquidity Agreement, as applicable) and the Holders of Notes (or such of them as may be affected thereby), any benefit or any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under this Indenture.

Section 112. Governing Law. THIS INDENTURE WILL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, INCLUDING SECTION 5-1401 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATION LAW, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 113. Counterparts. This Indenture may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which so executed will be deemed to be an original, but all such counterparts will together constitute but one and the same instrument.

Section 114. Indenture Referred to in the Trust Agreement. This is the Indenture referred to in the Trust Agreement.

Section 115. Legal Holidays. In any case where the date on which any payment is due shall not be a Business Day, then (notwithstanding any other provision of the Notes or this Indenture) payment need not be made on such date, but may be made on the next succeeding Business Day with the same force and effect as if made on the date on which nominally due, and no interest shall accrue for the period from and after any such nominal date.

 

- 22 -


[END OF ARTICLE I]

 

- 23 -


ARTICLE II

NOTE FORMS

Section 201. Forms Generally. The Notes will have such appropriate insertions, omissions, substitutions and other variations as are required or permitted by this Indenture or the applicable Indenture Supplement and may have such letters, numbers or other marks of identification and such legends or endorsements placed thereon, as may be required to comply with applicable laws or regulations or with the rules of any securities exchange, or as may, consistently herewith, be determined by the Issuer, as evidenced by the Issuer’s execution of such Notes. Any portion of the text of any Note may be set forth on the reverse thereof, with an appropriate reference thereto on the face of the Note.

The definitive Notes will be typewritten, printed, lithographed or engraved or produced by any combination of these methods (with or without steel engraved borders) or may be produced in any other manner, all as determined by the Issuer, as evidenced by the Issuer’s execution of such Notes, subject, with respect to the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, to the rules of any securities exchange on which such Notes are listed.

Section 202. Forms of Notes. Each Note will be in one of the forms approved from time to time by or pursuant to an Indenture Supplement. Before the delivery of a Note to the Indenture Trustee for authentication in any form approved by or pursuant to an Issuer Certificate, the Issuer will deliver to the Indenture Trustee the Issuer Certificate by or pursuant to which such form of Note has been approved, which Issuer Certificate will have attached thereto a true and correct copy of the form of Note which has been approved thereby or, if an Issuer Certificate authorizes a specific officer or officers of the Beneficiary to approve a form of Note, a certificate of such officer or officers approving the form of Note attached thereto. Any form of Note approved by or pursuant to an Issuer Certificate must be acceptable as to form to the Indenture Trustee, such acceptance to be evidenced by the Indenture Trustee’s authentication of Notes in that form or a certificate signed by an Indenture Trustee Authorized Officer and delivered to the Issuer.

Section 203. Form of Indenture Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication. The form of Indenture Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication for any Note issued pursuant to this Indenture will be substantially as follows:

 

- 24 -


INDENTURE TRUSTEE’S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is one of the Notes of the Series, Class or Tranche designated therein referred to in the within-mentioned Indenture.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,
as Indenture Trustee,
By:  

 

  Authorized Signatory
Dated:  

 

Section 204. Notes Issuable in the Form of a Global Note.

(a) If the Issuer establishes pursuant to Sections 202 and 301 that the Notes of a particular Series, Class or Tranche are to be issued in whole or in part in the form of one or more Global Notes, then the Issuer will execute and the Indenture Trustee or its agent will, in accordance with Section 303 and the Issuer Certificate delivered to the Indenture Trustee or its agent thereunder, authenticate and deliver, such Global Note or Notes, which, unless otherwise provided in the applicable Indenture Supplement (i) will represent, and will be denominated in an amount equal to the aggregate Stated Principal Amount (or in the case of Discount Notes, the aggregate Stated Principal Amount at the Expected Principal Payment Date of such Notes) of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche to be represented by such Global Note or Notes, or such portion thereof as the Issuer will specify in an Issuer Certificate, (ii) in the case of Registered Notes, will be registered in the name of the Depository for such Global Note or Notes or its nominee, (iii) will be delivered by the Indenture Trustee or its agent to the Depository or pursuant to the Depository’s instruction, (iv) if applicable, will bear a legend substantially to the following effect: “Unless this Note is presented by an authorized representative of The Depository Trust Company, a New York corporation (“DTC”), to the Issuer or its agent for registration of transfer, exchange or payment, and any Note issued is registered in the name of Cede & Co. or in such other name as is requested by an authorized representative of DTC (and any payment is made to Cede & Co. or to such other entity as is requested by an authorized representative of DTC), any transfer, pledge or other use hereof for value or otherwise by or to any person is wrongful inasmuch as the registered owner hereof, Cede & Co., has an interest herein” and (v) may bear such other legend as the Issuer, upon advice of counsel, deems to be applicable.

(b) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section 204 or of Section 305, and subject to the provisions of paragraph (c) below, unless the terms of a Global Note or the applicable Indenture Supplement expressly permit such Global Note to be exchanged in whole or in part for individual Notes, a Global Note may be transferred, in whole but not in part and in the manner provided in Section 305, only to a nominee of the Depository for such Global Note, or to the Depository, or a successor Depository for such Global Note selected or approved by the Issuer, or to a nominee of such successor Depository.

 

- 25 -


(c) With respect to Notes issued within the United States, unless otherwise specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement, or with respect to Notes issued outside the United States, if specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement:

(i) If at any time the Depository for a Global Note notifies the Issuer that it is unwilling or unable to continue as Depository for such Global Note or if at any time the Depository for the Notes for such Series, Class or Tranche ceases to be a clearing agency registered under the Securities Exchange Act, or other applicable statute or regulation, the Issuer will appoint a successor Depository with respect to such Global Note. If a successor Depository for such Global Note is not appointed by the Issuer within ninety (90) days after the Issuer receives such notice or becomes aware of such ineligibility, the Issuer will execute, and the Indenture Trustee or its agent, upon receipt of an Issuer Certificate requesting the authentication and delivery of individual Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche in exchange for such Global Note, will authenticate and deliver, individual Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of like tenor and terms in an aggregate Stated Principal Amount equal to the Stated Principal Amount of the Global Note in exchange for such Global Note.

(ii) The Issuer may at any time and in its sole discretion determine that the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche or portion thereof issued or issuable in the form of one or more Global Notes will no longer be represented by such Global Note or Notes. In such event the Issuer will execute, and the Indenture Trustee, upon receipt of a written request by the Issuer for the authentication and delivery of individual Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche in exchange in whole or in part for such Global Note, will authenticate and deliver individual Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of like tenor and terms in definitive form in an aggregate Stated Principal Amount equal to the Stated Principal Amount of such Global Note or Notes representing such Series, Class or Tranche or portion thereof in exchange for such Global Note or Notes.

(iii) If specified by the Issuer pursuant to Sections 202 and 301 with respect to Notes issued or issuable in the form of a Global Note, the Depository for such Global Note may surrender such Global Note in exchange in whole or in part for individual Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of like tenor and terms in definitive form on such terms as are acceptable to the Issuer and such Depository. Thereupon the Issuer will execute, and the Indenture Trustee or its agent will authenticate and deliver, without service charge, (A) to each Person specified by such Depository a new Note or Notes of the same Series, Class or Tranche of like tenor and terms and of any authorized denomination as requested by such Person in aggregate Stated Principal Amount equal to and in exchange for such Person’s beneficial interest in the Global Note; and (B) to such Depository a new Global Note of like tenor and terms and in an authorized denomination equal to the difference, if any, between the Stated Principal Amount of the surrendered Global Note and the aggregate Stated Principal Amount of Notes delivered to the Holders thereof.

 

- 26 -


(iv) If any Event of Default has occurred and is continuing with respect to such Global Notes, and Holders of Notes evidencing more than 50% of the unpaid Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Global Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche advise the Indenture Trustee and the Depository that a Global Note is no longer in the best interest of the Noteholders, the Holders of Global Notes of that Tranche may exchange such Notes for individual Notes.

(v) In any exchange provided for in any of the preceding four paragraphs, the Issuer will execute and the Indenture Trustee or its agent will authenticate and deliver individual Notes in definitive registered form in authorized denominations. Upon the exchange of the entire Stated Principal Amount of a Global Note for individual Notes, such Global Note will be canceled by the Indenture Trustee or its agent. Except as provided in the preceding paragraphs, Notes issued in exchange for a Global Note pursuant to this Section will be registered in such names and in such authorized denominations as the Depository for such Global Note, pursuant to instructions from its direct or indirect participants or otherwise, will instruct the Indenture Trustee or the Note Registrar. The Indenture Trustee or the Note Registrar will deliver such Notes to the Persons in whose names such Notes are so registered.

Section 205. Temporary Global Notes and Permanent Global Notes.

(a) If specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement for any Tranche, all or any portion of a Global Note may initially be issued in the form of a single temporary global Bearer Note or Registered Note (the “Temporary Global Note”), without interest coupons, in the denomination of the entire aggregate principal amount of such Series, Class or Tranche and substantially in the form set forth in the exhibit with respect thereto attached to the applicable Indenture Supplement. The Temporary Global Note will be authenticated by the Indenture Trustee upon the same conditions, in substantially the same manner and with the same effect as the Notes in definitive form. The Temporary Global Note may be exchanged as described below or in the applicable Indenture Supplement for permanent global Bearer Notes or Registered Notes (the “Permanent Global Notes”).

(b) Unless otherwise provided in the applicable Indenture Supplement, exchanges of beneficial interests in or security entitlements to Temporary Global Notes for beneficial interests in or security entitlements to Permanent Global Notes will be made as provided in this clause. The Beneficiary will, upon its determination of the date of completion of the distribution of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, so advise the Indenture Trustee, the Issuer, the Foreign Depository, and each foreign clearing agency forthwith. Without unnecessary delay, but in any event not prior to the Exchange Date, the Issuer will execute and deliver to the Indenture Trustee at the office of its designated agent outside the United States Permanent Global Notes in bearer or registered form (as specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement) in an aggregate principal amount equal to the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. Bearer Notes so issued and delivered may have coupons attached. The Temporary Global Note may be exchanged for an equal aggregate principal amount of Permanent Global Notes only on or after the Exchange Date. A United States Person may exchange its beneficial interest in or security entitlement to the Temporary

 

- 27 -


Global Note only for an equal aggregate principal amount of Permanent Global Notes in registered form bearing the applicable legend set forth in the form of Registered Note attached to the applicable Indenture Supplement and having a minimum denomination of $500,000, which may be in temporary form if the Issuer so elects. The Issuer may waive the $500,000 minimum denomination requirement if it so elects. Upon any demand for exchange for Permanent Global Notes in accordance with this clause, the Issuer will cause the Indenture Trustee to authenticate and deliver the Permanent Global Notes to the Holder (x) outside the United States, in the case of Bearer Notes and (y) according to the instructions of the Holder, in the case of Registered Notes, but in either case only upon presentation to the Indenture Trustee of a written statement substantially in the form of Exhibit B-1 (or such other form as the Issuer may determine) with respect to the Temporary Global Note, or portion thereof being exchanged, signed by a foreign clearing agency or Foreign Depository and dated the Exchange Date or a subsequent date, to the effect that it has received in writing or by tested telex a certification substantially in the form of (i) in the case of beneficial ownership of the Temporary Global Note, or a portion thereof being exchanged, by a United States institutional investor pursuant to this clause, the certificate in the form of Exhibit B-2 (or such other form as the Issuer may determine) signed by the Beneficiary which sold the relevant Notes or (ii) in all other cases, the certificate in the form of Exhibit B-3 (or such other form as the Issuer may determine), the certificate referred to in this clause (ii) being dated on the earlier of the first payment of interest in respect of such Note and the date of the delivery of such Note in definitive form. Upon receipt of such certification, the Indenture Trustee will cause the Temporary Global Note to be endorsed in accordance with clause (d). Any exchange as provided in this Section will be made free of charge to the Holders and the beneficial owners of the Temporary Global Note and to the beneficial owners of the Permanent Global Note issued in exchange, except that a Person receiving the Permanent Global Note must bear the cost of insurance, postage, transportation and the like in the event that such Person does not receive such Permanent Global Note in person at the offices of a foreign clearing agency or Foreign Depository.

(c) The delivery to the Indenture Trustee by a foreign clearing agency or Foreign Depository of any written statement referred to above may be relied upon by the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee as conclusive evidence that a corresponding certification or certifications has or have been delivered to such foreign clearing agency pursuant to the terms of this Indenture.

(d) Upon any such exchange of all or a portion of the Temporary Global Note for a Permanent Global Note or Notes, such Temporary Global Note will be endorsed by or on behalf of the Indenture Trustee to reflect the reduction of its principal amount by an amount equal to the aggregate principal amount of such Permanent Global Note or Notes. Until so exchanged in full, such Temporary Global Note will in all respects be entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture as Permanent Global Notes authenticated and delivered hereunder except that the beneficial owners of such Temporary Global Note will not be entitled to receive payments of interest on the Notes until they have exchanged their beneficial interests or security entitlements to in such Temporary Global Note for Permanent Global Notes.

 

- 28 -


Section 206. Beneficial Ownership of Global Notes. Until definitive Notes have been issued to the applicable Noteholders pursuant to Section 204 or as otherwise specified in any applicable Indenture Supplement:

(a) the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee may deal with the applicable clearing agency or Depository and the clearing agency’s or Depository’s participants for all purposes (including the making of distributions) as the authorized representatives of the respective Note Owners; and

(b) the rights of the respective Note Owners will be exercised only through the applicable clearing agency or Depository and the clearing agency’s or Depository’s participants and will be limited to those established by law and agreements between such Note Owners and the clearing agency or Depository and/or the clearing agency’s or Depository’s participants. Pursuant to the operating rules of the applicable clearing agency, unless and until Notes in definitive form are issued pursuant to Section 204, the clearing agency or Depository will make book-entry transfers among the clearing agency’s or Depository’s participants and receive and transmit distributions of principal and interest on the related Notes to such clearing agency’s or Depository’s participants.

For purposes of any provision of this Indenture requiring or permitting actions with the consent of, or at the direction of, Noteholders evidencing a specified percentage of the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of Outstanding Notes, such direction or consent may be given by Note Owners (acting through the clearing agency and the clearing agency’s participants) owning interests in or security entitlements to Notes evidencing the requisite percentage of principal amount of Notes.

Section 207. Notices to Depository. Whenever any notice or other communication is required to be given to Noteholders with respect to which book-entry Notes have been issued, unless and until Notes in definitive form will have been issued to the related Note Owners, the Indenture Trustee will give all such notices and communications to the applicable clearing agency or Depository.

[END OF ARTICLE II]

 

- 29 -


ARTICLE III

THE NOTES

Section 301. General Title; General Limitations; Issuable in Series; Terms of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes.

(a) The aggregate Stated Principal Amount of Notes which may be authenticated and delivered and Outstanding under this Indenture is not limited.

(b) The Notes may be issued in one or more Series, Classes or Tranches up to an aggregate Stated Principal Amount of Notes as from time to time may be authorized by the Issuer. All Notes of each Series, Class or Tranche under this Indenture will in all respects be equally and ratably entitled to the benefits hereof with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche without preference, priority or distinction on account of (i) the actual time of the authentication and delivery, (ii) Expected Principal Payment Date or (iii) Legal Maturity Date of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, except as specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement for such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes.

(c) Each Note issued must be part of a Series, Class and Tranche of Notes for purposes of allocations pursuant to the related Asset Pool Supplement and the related Indenture Supplement. A Series of Notes is created pursuant to an Indenture Supplement. A Class or Tranche of Notes is created pursuant to an Indenture Supplement or pursuant to a Terms Document, each related to the Indenture Supplement for the applicable Series.

(d) Each Series of Notes will be secured by a particular Asset Pool. The related Indenture Supplement will identify the Asset Pool under which a Series of Notes has been issued.

(e) Each Series of Notes may be assigned to a Group or Groups (now existing or hereafter created) of Notes for purposes of allocations of certain collections pursuant to the related Asset Pool Supplement or the related Indenture Supplement. The related Indenture Supplement will identify the Group or Groups, if any, to which a Series of Notes has been assigned and the manner and extent to which Series in the same Group will share certain amounts.

(f) Each Series of Notes may, but need not be, subdivided into multiple Classes. Notes belonging to a Class in any Series may be entitled to specified payment priorities over other Classes of Notes in that Series.

(g) Notes of a Series that belong to different Classes in that Series belong to different Tranches on the basis of the difference in Class membership.

 

- 30 -


(h) Each Class of Notes may consist of a single Tranche or may be subdivided into multiple Tranches. Notes of a single Class of a Series will belong to different Tranches if they have different terms and conditions. With respect to any Class of Notes, Notes which have identical terms, conditions and Tranche designation will be deemed to be part of a single Tranche.

(i) Before the initial issuance of Notes of each Series, Class or Tranche, there shall also be established in or pursuant to an Indenture Supplement or pursuant to a Terms Document related to the applicable Indenture Supplement, provision for:

(i) the Series designation;

(ii) the Asset Pool designation;

(iii) the Stated Principal Amount of the Notes;

(iv) whether such Series belongs to any Group or Groups;

(v) whether such Notes are of a particular Class of Notes or a Tranche of a Class of Notes;

(vi) the Required Subordinated Amount (if any) for such Class or Tranche of Notes;

(vii) the currency or currencies in which such Notes will be denominated and in which payments of principal of, and interest on, such Notes will or may be payable;

(viii) if the principal of or interest, if any, on such Notes are to be payable, at the election of the Issuer or a Holder thereof, in a currency or currencies other than that in which the Notes are stated to be payable, the period or periods within which, and the terms and conditions upon which, such election may be made;

(ix) if the amount of payments of principal of or interest, if any, on such Notes may be determined with reference to an index based on (A) a currency or currencies other than that in which the Notes are stated to be payable, (B) changes in the prices of one or more other securities or Groups or indexes of securities or (C) changes in the prices of one or more commodities or Groups or indexes of commodities, or any combination of the foregoing, the manner in which such amounts will be determined;

(x) the price or prices at which such Series, Class or Tranche of the Notes will be issued;

(xi) the times at which such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes may, pursuant to any optional or mandatory redemption provisions, be redeemed, and the other terms and provisions of any such redemption provisions;

 

- 31 -


(xii) the rate per annum at which such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will bear interest, if any, or the formula or index on which such rate will be determined, including all relevant definitions, and the date from which interest will accrue;

(xiii) each Interest Payment Date, Expected Principal Payment Date and the Legal Maturity Date for such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes;

(xiv) the Initial Dollar Principal Amount of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, and the means for calculating the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes;

(xv) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, and the means for calculating the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes;

(xvi) whether or not application will be made to list such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes on any securities exchange;

(xvii) any Events of Default or Early Redemption Events with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, if not set forth herein and any additions, deletions or other changes to the Events of Default or Early Redemption Events set forth herein that will be applicable to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes (including a provision making any Event of Default or Early Redemption Event set forth herein inapplicable to the Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche);

(xviii) the appointment by the Indenture Trustee of an Authenticating Agent in one or more places other than the location of the office of the Indenture Trustee with power to act on behalf of the Indenture Trustee and subject to its direction in the authentication and delivery of such Notes in connection with such transactions as will be specified in the provisions of this Indenture or in or pursuant to the applicable Indenture Supplement creating such Series, Class or Tranche;

(xix) if such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will be issued in whole or in part in the form of a Global Note or Global Notes, the terms and conditions, if any, upon which such Global Note or Global Notes may be exchanged in whole or in part for other individual Notes; and the Depository for such Global Note or Global Notes (if other than the Depository specified in Section 101);

(xx) if such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will be issued in whole or in part as Registered Notes, Bearer Notes or both, whether such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes are to be issued with or without coupons or both;

(xxi) the subordination of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes to any other indebtedness of the Issuer, including without limitation, the Notes of any other Series, Class or Tranche;

 

- 32 -


(xxii) if such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes are to have the benefit of any Derivative Agreement, the terms and provisions of such agreement;

(xxiii) if such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes are to have the benefit of any Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement or Supplemental Liquidity Agreement, the terms and provisions of the applicable agreement;

(xxiv) the Record Date for any Payment Date of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, if different from the last day of the month before the related Payment Date;

(xxv) the amount scheduled to be deposited on each Principal Payment Date during an amortization period or accumulation period for such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes;

(xxvi) whether and under what conditions, additional amounts will be payable to Noteholders; and

(xxvii) any other terms of such Notes as stated in the related Indenture Supplement;

all upon such terms as may be determined in or pursuant to an Indenture Supplement with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes.

(j) The form of the Notes of each Series, Class or Tranche will be established pursuant to the provisions of this Indenture and the related Indenture Supplement or Terms Document creating such Series, Class or Tranche. The Notes of each Series, Class or Tranche will be distinguished from the Notes of each other Series, Class or Tranche in such manner, reasonably satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee, as the Issuer may determine.

(k) Any terms or provisions in respect of the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche issued under this Indenture may be determined pursuant to this Section by providing in the applicable Indenture Supplement for the method by which such terms or provisions will be determined.

Section 302. Denominations. The Notes of each Series, Class or Tranche will be issuable in such denominations and currency as will be provided in the provisions of this Indenture or in or pursuant to the applicable Indenture Supplement. In the absence of any such provisions with respect to the Registered Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, the Registered Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche will be issued in denominations of $1,000 and multiples thereof. In the absence of any such provisions with respect to the Bearer Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, the Bearer Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche will be issued in denominations of 1,000, 5,000, 50,000 and 100,000 units of the applicable currency.

 

- 33 -


Section 303. Execution, Authentication and Delivery and Dating.

(a) The Notes will be executed on behalf of the Issuer by an Issuer Authorized Officer. The signature of any officer of the Beneficiary or the Owner Trustee on the Notes may be manual or facsimile.

(b) Notes bearing the manual or facsimile signatures of individuals who were at any time an Issuer Authorized Officer will bind the Issuer, notwithstanding that such individuals or any of them have ceased to hold such offices before the authentication and delivery of such Notes or did not hold such offices at the date of issuance of such Notes.

(c) At any time and from time to time after the execution and delivery of this Indenture, the Issuer may deliver Notes executed by the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee for authentication; and the Indenture Trustee will, upon request by an Officer’s Certificate, authenticate and deliver such Notes as in this Indenture provided and not otherwise.

(d) Before any such authentication and delivery, the Indenture Trustee will be entitled to receive, in addition to any Officer’s Certificate and Opinion of Counsel required to be furnished to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 102, the Issuer Certificate and any other opinion or certificate relating to the issuance of the Series, Class or Tranche of Notes required to be furnished pursuant to Section 202 or Section 310.

(e) The Indenture Trustee will not be required to authenticate such Notes if the issue thereof will adversely affect the Indenture Trustee’s own rights, duties or immunities under the Notes and this Indenture.

(f) Unless otherwise provided in the form of Note for any Series, Class or Tranche, all Notes will be dated the date of their authentication.

(g) No Note will be entitled to any benefit under this Indenture or be valid or obligatory for any purpose unless there appears on such Note a Certificate of Authentication substantially in the form provided for herein executed by the Indenture Trustee by manual signature of an authorized signatory, and such certificate upon any Note will be conclusive evidence, and the only evidence, that such Note has been duly authenticated and delivered hereunder.

Section 304. Temporary Notes.

(a) Pending the preparation of definitive Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, the Issuer may execute, and, upon receipt of the documents required by Section 303, together with an Officer’s Certificate, the Indenture Trustee will authenticate and deliver, temporary Notes which are printed, lithographed, typewritten, mimeographed or otherwise produced, in any authorized denomination, substantially of the tenor of the definitive Notes in lieu of which they are issued and with such appropriate insertions, omissions, substitutions and other variations as the Issuer may determine, as evidenced by the Issuer’s execution of such Notes.

 

- 34 -


(a) If temporary Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche are issued, the Issuer will cause definitive Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche to be prepared without unreasonable delay. After the preparation of definitive Notes, the temporary Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche will be exchangeable for definitive Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche upon surrender of the temporary Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche at the office or agency of the Issuer in a Place of Payment, without charge to the Holder; and upon surrender for cancellation of any one or more temporary Notes the Issuer will execute and the Indenture Trustee will authenticate and deliver in exchange therefor a like Stated Principal Amount of definitive Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of authorized denominations and of like tenor and terms. Until so exchanged the temporary Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche will in all respects be entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture as definitive Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 305. Registration, Transfer and Exchange.

(a) The Issuer will keep or cause to be kept a register (herein sometimes referred to as the “Note Register”) in which, subject to such reasonable regulations as it may prescribe, the Issuer will provide for the registration of Registered Notes, or of Registered Notes of a particular Series, Class or Tranche, and for transfers of Registered Notes or of Registered Notes of such Tranche. Any such register will be in written form or in any other form capable of being converted into written form within a reasonable time. At all reasonable times the information contained in such register or registers will be available for inspection by the Indenture Trustee at the office or agency to be maintained by the Issuer as provided in Section 1002.

(b) Subject to Section 204, upon surrender for transfer of any Registered Note of any Series, Class or Tranche at the office or agency of the Issuer in a Place of Payment, if the requirements of Section 8-401(a) of the UCC are met, the Issuer will execute, and, upon receipt of such surrendered Note, the Indenture Trustee will authenticate and deliver, in the name of the designated transferee or transferees, one or more new Registered Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of any authorized denominations, of a like aggregate Stated Principal Amount, Expected Principal Payment Date and Legal Maturity Date and of like terms.

(c) Subject to Section 204, at the option of the Holder, Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche may be exchanged for other Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche of any authorized denominations, of a like aggregate Stated Principal Amount, Expected Principal Payment Date and Legal Maturity Date and of like terms, upon surrender of the Notes to be exchanged at such office or agency. Registered Notes, including Registered Notes received in exchange for Bearer Notes, may not be exchanged for Bearer Notes. At the option of the Holder of a Bearer Note, subject to applicable laws and regulations, Bearer Notes may be exchanged for other Bearer Notes or Registered Notes (of the same Series, Class and Tranche of Notes) of authorized denominations of like aggregate fractional undivided interests in the Noteholders’ interest, upon surrender of the Bearer Notes to be exchanged at an office or agency of the Note Registrar located outside the United States. Each Bearer Note surrendered pursuant to this Section will have attached thereto all unmatured coupons; provided, however, that any Bearer Note so surrendered after the close of business on the last day of the month preceding the relevant Payment Date need not have attached the coupon relating to such Payment Date.

 

- 35 -


Whenever any Notes are so surrendered for exchange, the Issuer will execute, and the Indenture Trustee will authenticate and deliver (in the case of Bearer Notes, outside the United Sates), the Notes which the Noteholders making the exchange are entitled to receive.

(d) All Notes issued upon any transfer or exchange of Notes will be the valid and legally binding obligations of the Issuer, evidencing the same debt, and entitled to the same benefits under this Indenture, as the Notes surrendered upon such transfer or exchange.

(e) Every Note presented or surrendered for transfer or exchange will (if so required by the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee) be duly indorsed, or be accompanied by a written instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Issuer and the Note Registrar duly executed, by the Holder thereof or his attorney duly authorized in writing.

(f) Unless otherwise provided in the Note to be transferred or exchanged, no service charge will be made on any Noteholder for any transfer or exchange of Notes, but the Issuer may (unless otherwise provided in such Note) require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection with any transfer or exchange of Notes before the transfer or exchange will be complete, other than exchanges pursuant to Section 304 or 906 not involving any transfer.

(g) None of the Issuer, the Note Registrar or the Indenture Trustee shall be required (i) to issue, register the transfer of or exchange any Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche during a period beginning at the opening of business 15 days before the day of selection of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche to be redeemed and ending at the close of business on (A) if Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche are issuable only as Registered Notes, the day of the mailing of the relevant notice of redemption of Registered Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche so selected for redemption or (B) if Notes of the Series, Class or Tranche are issuable as Bearer Notes, the day of the first publication of the relevant notice of redemption or, if Notes of the Series, Class or Tranche are also issuable as Registered Notes and there is no publication, the mailing of the relevant notice of redemption or (ii) to register the transfer or exchange of any Notes or portions thereof so selected for redemption.

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the exchange of Bearer Notes into Registered Notes shall be subject to applicable laws and regulations in effect at the time of exchange; none of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee or the Note Registrar shall exchange any Bearer Notes into Registered Notes if it has received an Opinion of Counsel that as a result of such exchanges the Issuer or any Transferor would suffer adverse consequences under the United States federal income tax laws and regulations then in effect and the Issuer has delivered to the Indenture Trustee an Issuer Certificate directing the Indenture Trustee not to make such exchanges unless and until the Indenture Trustee receives a subsequent Issuer Certificate to the contrary. The Issuer shall deliver copies of such Issuer Certificates to the Note Registrar.

(g) None of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee, any agent of the Indenture Trustee, any Paying Agent or the Note Registrar will have any responsibility or liability for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made on account of beneficial ownership of a Global Note or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any records relating to such beneficial ownership.

 

- 36 -


(h) The Issuer initially appoints The Bank of New York Mellon to act as Note Registrar for the Registered Notes on its behalf. The Issuer may at any time and from time to time authorize any Person to act as Note Registrar in place of the Indenture Trustee with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes issued under this Indenture.

(i) Registration of transfer of Notes containing the following legend or to which the following legend is applicable:

“THIS NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”). NEITHER THIS NOTE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF THE SECURITIES ACT AND ANY APPLICABLE PROVISIONS OF ANY STATE BLUE SKY OR SECURITIES LAWS OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO HEREIN.”

will be effected only if such transfer is made pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act, or is exempt from the registration requirements under the Securities Act. In the event that registration of a transfer is to be made in reliance upon an exemption from the registration requirements under the Securities Act other than Rule 144A under the Securities Act or Rule 903 or Rule 904 of Regulation S under the Securities Act, the transferor or the transferee will deliver, at its expense, to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, an investment letter from the transferee, substantially in the form of the investment letter attached hereto as Exhibit A or such other form as the Issuer may determine, and no registration of transfer will be made until such letter is so delivered.

Notes issued upon registration or transfer of, or Notes issued in exchange for, Notes bearing the legend referred to above will also bear such legend unless the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Note Registrar receive an Opinion of Counsel, satisfactory to each of them, to the effect that such legend may be removed.

Whenever a Note containing the legend referred to above is presented to the Note Registrar for registration of transfer, the Note Registrar will promptly seek instructions from the Issuer regarding such transfer and will be entitled to receive an Issuer Certificate prior to registering any such transfer. The Issuer hereby agrees to indemnify the Note Registrar and the Indenture Trustee and to hold each of them harmless against any loss, liability or expense incurred without negligence or bad faith on their part arising out of or in connection with actions taken or omitted by them in relation to any such instructions furnished pursuant to this clause. The Indenture Trustee shall have no obligation or duty to monitor, determine or inquire as to compliance with any restrictions on transfer imposed under this Indenture or under applicable

 

- 37 -


law with respect to any transfer of any interest in any Note other than to require delivery of such certificates and other documentation or evidence as are expressly required by, and to do so if and when expressly required by the terms of, this Indenture, and to examine the same to determine substantial compliance as to form with the express requirements hereof.

Section 306. Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost and Stolen Notes.

(a) If (i) any mutilated Note (together, in the case of Bearer Notes, with all unmatured coupons, if any, appertaining thereto) is surrendered to the Indenture Trustee or the Note Registrar, or the Issuer, the Note Registrar or the Indenture Trustee receive evidence to their satisfaction of the destruction, loss or theft of any Note, and (ii) there is delivered to the Issuer, the Note Registrar or the Indenture Trustee such security or indemnity as may be required by them to save each of them harmless, then, in the absence of notice to the Issuer, the Note Registrar or the Indenture Trustee that such Note has been acquired by a protected purchaser, the Issuer will execute and upon its request the Indenture Trustee will authenticate and deliver (in the case of Bearer Notes, outside the United States), in exchange for or in lieu of any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note, a new Note of like tenor, Series, Class or Tranche, Expected Principal Payment Date, Legal Maturity Date and Stated Principal Amount, bearing a number not contemporaneously Outstanding.

(b) In case any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Note has become or is about to become due and payable, the Issuer in its discretion may, instead of issuing a new Note, pay such Note.

(c) Upon the issuance of any new Note under this Section, the Issuer may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other expenses (including the fees and expenses of the Indenture Trustee) connected therewith.

(d) Every new Note issued pursuant to this Section in lieu of any destroyed, lost or stolen Note will constitute an original additional contractual obligation of the Issuer, whether or not the destroyed, lost or stolen Note will be at any time enforceable by anyone, and will be entitled to all the benefits of this Indenture equally and proportionately with any and all other Notes of the same Series, Class or Tranche duly issued hereunder.

(e) The provisions of this Section are exclusive and will preclude (to the extent lawful) all other rights and remedies with respect to the replacement or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes.

Section 307. Payment of Interest; Interest Rights Preserved; Withholding Taxes.

(a) Unless otherwise provided with respect to such Note pursuant to Section 301, interest payable on any Registered Note will be paid to the Person in whose name that Note (or one or more Predecessor Notes) is registered at the close of business on the most recent Record Date and interest payable on any Bearer Note will be paid to the bearer of that Note (or the applicable coupon).

 

- 38 -


(b) Subject to clause (a), each Note delivered under this Indenture upon transfer of or in exchange for or in lieu of any other Note will carry the rights to interest accrued or principal accreted and unpaid, and to accrue or accrete, which were carried by such other Note.

(c) The right of any Noteholder to receive interest on or principal of any Note shall be subject to any applicable withholding or deduction imposed pursuant to the Internal Revenue Code or other applicable tax law, including foreign withholding and deduction. Any amounts properly so withheld or deducted shall be treated as actually paid to the appropriate Noteholder.

Section 308. Persons Deemed Owners. Title to any Bearer Note, including any coupons appertaining thereto, shall pass by delivery. The Issuer, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee, the Beneficiary and any agent of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee or the Beneficiary may treat the Person who is proved to be the owner of such Note pursuant to Subsection 104(c) as the owner of such Note for the purpose of receiving payment of principal of and (subject to Section 307) interest on such Note and for all other purposes whatsoever, whether or not such Note is overdue, and neither the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee, nor any agent of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee or the Beneficiary will be affected by notice to the contrary.

Section 309. Cancellation. All Notes surrendered for payment, redemption, transfer, conversion or exchange will, if surrendered to any Person other than the Indenture Trustee, be delivered to the Indenture Trustee and, if not already canceled, will be promptly canceled by it. The Issuer may at any time deliver to the Indenture Trustee for cancellation any Notes previously authenticated and delivered hereunder which the Issuer may have acquired in any manner whatsoever, and all Notes so delivered will be promptly canceled by the Indenture Trustee. No Note will be authenticated in lieu of or in exchange for any Notes canceled as provided in this Section, except as expressly permitted by this Indenture. The Indenture Trustee will dispose of all canceled Notes in accordance with its customary procedures and will deliver a certificate of such disposition to the Issuer.

Section 310. New Issuances of Notes.

(a) Unless otherwise specified in the related Indenture Supplement, the Issuer may issue new Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, so long as the following conditions precedent are satisfied:

(i) on or prior to the third Business Day before the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer delivers to the Indenture Trustee and each Note Rating Agency notice of such new issuance;

 

- 39 -


(ii) on or prior to the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer delivers to the Indenture Trustee and each Note Rating Agency an Issuer Certificate to the effect that:

(A) the Issuer reasonably believes that the new issuance will not cause an Adverse Effect on any Outstanding Notes;

(B) all instruments furnished to the Indenture Trustee conform to the requirements of this Indenture and constitute sufficient authority hereunder for the Indenture Trustee to authenticate and deliver such Notes;

(C) the form and terms of such Notes have been established in conformity with the provisions of this Indenture; and

(D) such other matters as the Indenture Trustee may reasonably request;

(iii) on or prior to the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer will have delivered to the Indenture Trustee and each Note Rating Agency an Opinion of Counsel, which may be from internal counsel of the Issuer, that all laws and requirements with respect to the execution and delivery by the Issuer of such Notes have been complied with, the Issuer has the trust power and authority to issue such Notes and such Notes have been duly authorized and delivered by the Issuer and, assuming due authentication and delivery by the Indenture Trustee, constitute legal, valid and binding obligations of the Issuer enforceable in accordance with their terms (subject, as to enforcement of remedies, to applicable bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, moratorium or other laws and legal principles affecting creditors’ rights generally from time to time in effect and to general equitable principles, whether applied in an action at law or in equity) and are entitled to the benefits of this Indenture, equally and ratably with all other Outstanding Notes, if any, of such Series, Class or Tranche, subject to the terms of this Indenture, each Indenture Supplement and each Terms Document;

(iv) on or prior to the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer will have delivered to the Indenture Trustee and the Note Rating Agencies a Master Trust Tax Opinion for each applicable Master Trust and an Issuer Tax Opinion with respect to such issuance;

(v) if any additional conditions to the new issuance are specified in writing by a Note Rating Agency to the Issuer, either (A) the Issuer satisfies such conditions or (B) the Issuer obtains confirmation from the applicable Note Rating Agency that the new issuance will not have a Ratings Effect on any Outstanding Notes;

(vi) in the case of Bearer Notes described in Section 163(f)(2)(A) of the Internal Revenue Code, such Notes shall be described in section 163(f)(2)(B) of the Internal Revenue Code and such section shall apply to such Notes;

 

- 40 -


(vii) on or prior to the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer will have delivered to the Indenture Trustee an Indenture Supplement and, if applicable, the Issuer Certificate or on or before the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer will have executed with the Indenture Trustee a Terms Document relating to the applicable Class or Tranche of Notes;

(viii) in the case of Foreign Currency Notes, the Issuer will have appointed one or more Paying Agents in the appropriate countries;

(ix) the conditions specified herein or in Section 311; and

(x) any other conditions specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement;

provided, however, that any one of the aforementioned conditions may be eliminated (other than clause (iv)) or modified as a condition precedent to any new issuance of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes if the Issuer has obtained approval from each Note Rating Agency.

(b) The Issuer and the Indenture Trustee will not be required to provide prior notice to or to obtain the consent of any Noteholder of any Outstanding Series, Class or Tranche to issue any additional Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche. In addition, the Issuer agrees to provide notice of new issuances of Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes as may be required by and in accordance with Item 1121(a)(14) of Regulation AB.

(c) There are no restrictions on the timing or amount of any additional issuance of Notes of an Outstanding Class or Tranche of a Series of Notes, so long as the conditions described in Subsection 310(a) are met or waived. As of the date of any additional issuance of Notes of an Outstanding Class or Tranche of Notes, the Stated Principal Amount, Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount and Nominal Liquidation Amount of that Class or Tranche will be increased to reflect the principal amount of the additional Notes. If the additional Notes are a Class or Tranche of Notes that has the benefit of a Derivative Agreement, the Issuer will enter into a Derivative Agreement for the benefit of the additional Notes. In addition, if the additional Notes are a Class or Tranche of Notes that has the benefit of any Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement or any Supplemental Liquidity Agreement, the Issuer will enter into a Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement or Supplemental Liquidity Agreement, as applicable, for the benefit of the additional Notes. Furthermore, the targeted deposits, if any, to any applicable Issuer Account will be increased proportionately to reflect the principal amount of the additional Notes.

When issued, the additional Notes of a Tranche will be identical in all respects to the other Outstanding Notes of that Tranche and will be equally and ratably entitled to the benefits of the Indenture, the related Asset Pool Supplement and the related Indenture Supplement applicable to the previously issued Notes of such Tranche, as the other Outstanding Notes of that Tranche without preference, priority or distinction.

 

- 41 -


Section 311. Specification of Required Subordinated Amount and other Terms with Respect to each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes.

(a) The applicable Indenture Supplement for each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will specify a Required Subordinated Amount of each Subordinated Class or Tranche of Notes, if any.

(b) The Issuer may change the Required Subordinated Amount or method of computing such amount for any Class or Tranche of Notes at any time, without the consent of any Noteholders, so long as the Issuer has (i) received confirmation from the Note Rating Agencies that have rated any Outstanding Notes of the Series to which such Class or Tranche belongs that the change in the Required Subordinated Amount will not result in a Ratings Effect with respect to any Outstanding Notes of such Series and (ii) delivered to the Indenture Trustee and the Note Rating Agencies an Issuer Tax Opinion.

[END OF ARTICLE III]

 

- 42 -


ARTICLE IV

ISSUER ACCOUNTS AND INVESTMENTS

Section 401. Collections. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, the Indenture Trustee may demand payment or delivery of, and shall receive and collect, directly and without intervention or assistance from any fiscal agent or other intermediary, all money and other property payable to or receivable by the Indenture Trustee pursuant to this Indenture including, without limitation, all funds and other property payable to the Indenture Trustee in connection with the Collateral designated for inclusion in each Asset Pool. The Indenture Trustee will hold all such money and property received by it as part of the Collateral designated for inclusion in each Asset Pool and will apply it as provided in this Indenture.

Section 402. Issuer Accounts.

(a) Issuer Accounts; Distributions from Issuer Accounts. On or before the date of initial issuance of Notes secured by the Collateral designated for inclusion in a specific Asset Pool, the Issuer will, pursuant to the related Asset Pool Supplement, cause to be established and maintained for such Asset Pool one or more Eligible Deposit Accounts (each such account as described in the related Asset Pool Supplement) in the name of the Indenture Trustee, bearing a designation clearly indicating that the funds deposited therein are held for the benefit of the Indenture Trustee and the applicable Noteholders. From time to time in connection with the issuance of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the Issuer may cause the Indenture Trustee to establish one or more Eligible Deposit Accounts denominated as “Supplemental Issuer Accounts” in the name of the Indenture Trustee. Each Issuer Account shall be under the control (within the meaning of Section 9-104 or 9-106, as applicable, of the UCC) of the Indenture Trustee for the applicable Asset Pool for the benefit of the Indenture Trustee and the applicable Noteholders whose Notes are secured by the Collateral designated for inclusion in the applicable Asset Pool. Supplemental Issuer Accounts shall be created as specified in the applicable Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement. Any Supplemental Issuer Accounts will receive deposits as specified in the applicable Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement. If, at any time, the institution holding any Issuer Account ceases to be an Eligible Institution, the Issuer shall within ten (10) Business Days (or such longer period, not to exceed thirty (30) calendar days, as to which each Note Rating Agency may consent in writing) establish a new Issuer Account that is an Eligible Deposit Account and shall transfer any cash and/or investments from the existing Issuer Account to such new Issuer Account.

(b) All payments to be made from time to time by or on behalf of the Indenture Trustee to Noteholders out of funds in the Issuer Accounts for a particular Asset Pool pursuant to this Indenture will be made as provided in the Asset Pool Supplement or the applicable Indenture Supplement but only to the extent funds are available in the applicable Issuer Accounts.

 

- 43 -


Section 403. Investment of Funds in the Issuer Accounts.

(a) Funds on deposit in the Issuer Accounts will (unless otherwise stated in the applicable Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement) be invested and reinvested by the Indenture Trustee at the written direction of the Issuer in one or more Eligible Investments. Absent such written direction, the Indenture Trustee shall invest funds in the Eligible Investments described in clause (f) of the definition thereof. The Issuer may authorize the Indenture Trustee to make specific investments pursuant to written instructions, in such amounts as the Issuer will specify. Notwithstanding the foregoing, funds held by the Indenture Trustee in any of the Issuer Accounts will be invested in Eligible Investments that will mature in each case no later than the date on which such funds in the Issuer Accounts are scheduled to be transferred or distributed by the Indenture Trustee pursuant to this Indenture (or as necessary to provide for timely payment of principal or interest on the applicable Principal Payment Date or Interest Payment Date).

(b) All funds deposited from time to time in the Issuer Accounts pursuant to this Indenture and all investments made with such funds will be held by the Indenture Trustee in the Issuer Accounts as part of the Collateral designated for inclusion in such Asset Pool as herein provided, subject to withdrawal by the Indenture Trustee for the purposes set forth herein.

(c) Funds and other property in any of the Issuer Accounts will not be commingled with any other funds or property of the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee. The Indenture Trustee shall hold all Eligible Investments in a manner specified in the related Asset Pool Supplement; provided, that, other than following an Event of Default and acceleration pursuant to Section 602, no Eligible Investment shall be disposed of prior to its maturity.

(d) All interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) on funds on deposit in the Issuer Account will be applied as specified in the applicable Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement. Unless otherwise stated in the related Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement, for purposes of determining the availability of funds or the balance in the Issuer Accounts for any reason under this Indenture or any Indenture Supplement, investment earnings on such funds shall be deemed not to be available or on deposit.

Subject to Subsection 701(d), the Indenture Trustee will not in any way be held liable by reason of any insufficiency in such Issuer Accounts resulting from any loss on any Eligible Investment included therein except for losses attributable to the Indenture Trustee’s failure to make payments on such Eligible Investments issued by the Indenture Trustee, in its commercial capacity, in accordance with their terms.

(e) Funds on deposit in the Issuer Accounts will be invested and reinvested by the Indenture Trustee to the fullest extent practicable, in such manner as the Indenture Trustee will from time to time determine, but only in one or more Eligible Investments, upon the occurrence of any of the following events:

(i) the Issuer will have failed to give investment directions to the Indenture Trustee; or

(ii) an Event of Default will have occurred and is continuing but no Notes have been declared due and payable pursuant to Section 602.

 

- 44 -


[END OF ARTICLE IV]

 

- 45 -


ARTICLE V

SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE; CANCELLATION OF NOTES

HELD BY THE ISSUER OR THE BANK

Section 501. Satisfaction and Discharge of Indenture. This Indenture will cease to be of further effect with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes (except as to any surviving rights of transfer or exchange of Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche expressly provided for herein or in the form of Note for that Series, Class or Tranche), and the Indenture Trustee, on demand of and at the expense of the Issuer, will execute proper instruments acknowledging satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture as to that Series, Class or Tranche, when:

(a) all Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche theretofore authenticated and delivered (other than (A) Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche which have been destroyed, lost or stolen and which have been replaced or paid as provided in Section 306, and (B) Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche for whose payment money has theretofore been deposited in trust or segregated and held in trust by the Issuer and thereafter repaid to the Issuer or discharged from that trust, as provided in Section 1003) have been delivered to the Indenture Trustee canceled or for cancellation;

(b) the Issuer has paid or caused to be paid all other sums payable hereunder (including payments to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 707) by the Issuer with respect to the Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche; and

(c) the Issuer has delivered to the Indenture Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel each stating that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture with respect to the Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche have been complied with.

Notwithstanding the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the obligations of the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee with respect to that Series, Class or Tranche of Notes under Section 707 and the obligations of the Indenture Trustee under Sections 502 and 1003 will survive such satisfaction and discharge.

Section 502. Application of Trust Money. All money and obligations deposited with the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Sections 501 or 503 and all money received by the Indenture Trustee in respect of such obligations will be held in trust and applied by it, in accordance with the provisions of the Series, Class or Tranche of Notes in respect of which it was deposited and this Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent (including the Issuer acting as its own Paying Agent) as the Indenture Trustee may determine, to the Persons entitled thereto, of the principal and interest for whose payment that money and obligations have been deposited with or received by the Indenture Trustee.

 

- 46 -


Section 503. Cancellation of Notes Held by the Issuer or the Transferor. If the Issuer, the Transferor or any of their Affiliates holds any Notes, that Holder may, subject to any provisions of a related Indenture Supplement limiting the repayment of such Notes, by notice from that Holder to the Indenture Trustee cause the Notes to be repaid and canceled, whereupon the Notes will no longer be Outstanding.

[END OF ARTICLE V]

 

- 47 -


ARTICLE VI

EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES

Section 601. Events of Default. “Event of Default,” wherever used herein, means with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes any one of the following events (whatever the reason for such Event of Default and whether it will be voluntary or involuntary or be effected by operation of law or pursuant to any judgment, decree or order of any court or any order, rule or regulation of any administrative or governmental body), unless such event is either expressly stated to be inapplicable to a particular Series, Class or Tranche or specifically deleted or modified in the applicable Indenture Supplement creating such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes or in the form of Note for such Series, Class or Tranche:

(a) with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, as applicable, a default by the Issuer in the payment of any interest on such Notes when such interest becomes due and payable, and continuance of such default for a period of thirty-five (35) days following the date on which such interest became due and payable;

(b) with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, a default by the Issuer in the payment of the Stated Principal Amount of such Tranche of Notes at the applicable Legal Maturity Date;

(c) a default in the performance, or breach, of any covenant or warranty of the Issuer in this Indenture in respect of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche (other than a covenant or warranty in respect of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche a default in the performance of which or the breach of which is elsewhere in this Section specifically dealt with), all of such covenants and warranties in this Indenture which are not expressly stated to be for the benefit of a particular Series, Class and Tranche of Notes being deemed to be in respect of the Notes of all Series, Classes or Tranches for this purpose, and continuance of such default or breach for a period of sixty (60) days after there has been given, by registered or certified mail, to the Issuer by the Indenture Trustee or to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee by the Holders of at least 25% of the aggregate in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of the affected Series, Class or Tranche, a written notice specifying such default or breach and requesting it to be remedied and stating that such notice is a “Notice of Default” hereunder and, as a result of such default, the interests of the Holders of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche are materially and adversely affected and continue to be materially and adversely affected during the sixty (60) day period;

(d) (i) the Issuer shall file a petition or commence a proceeding (A) to take advantage of any bankruptcy, conservatorship, receivership, insolvency, or similar laws or (B) for the appointment of a trustee, conservator, receiver, liquidator, or similar official for or relating to the Issuer or all or substantially all of its property, (ii) the Issuer shall consent or fail to object to any such petition filed or proceeding commenced against or with respect to it or all or substantially all of its property, or any such petition or proceeding shall not have been

 

- 48 -


dismissed or stayed within sixty (60) days of its filing or commencement, or a court, agency, or other supervisory authority with jurisdiction shall have decreed or ordered relief with respect to any such petition or proceeding, (iii) the Issuer shall admit in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as they become due, (iv) the Issuer shall make an assignment for the benefit of its creditors, or (v) the Issuer shall voluntarily suspend payment of its obligations.

(e) with respect to any such Series, Class or Tranche, any additional Event of Default specified in the Indenture Supplement for such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes as applying to such Series, Class or Tranche, or specified in the form of Note for such Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 602. Acceleration of Maturity; Rescission and Annulment.

(a) If an Event of Default described in clause (a), (b), (c) or (e) (if the Event of Default under clause (c) or (e) is with respect to less than all Series, Classes and Tranches of Notes then Outstanding) of Section 601 occurs and is continuing with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche, then and in each and every such case, unless the principal of all the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche shall have already become due and payable, either the Indenture Trustee or the Majority Holders of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche then Outstanding hereunder (each such Series, Class or Tranche acting as a separate Class), by notice in writing to the Issuer (and to the Indenture Trustee if given by the Holders), may declare the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche then Outstanding and all interest accrued or principal accreted and unpaid (if any) thereon to be due and payable immediately, and upon any such declaration the same will become and will be immediately due and payable, anything in this Indenture, the related Asset Pool Supplement, the related Indenture Supplement or in the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche to the contrary notwithstanding. Such payments are subject to the allocation provisions of the applicable Asset Pool Supplement and the allocation, deposits and payment sections of the related Indenture Supplement.

(b) If an Event of Default described in clause (c) or (e) of Section 601 occurs with respect to all Series, Classes and Tranches of Outstanding Notes and is continuing, then and in each and every such case, unless the principal of all the Notes shall have already become due and payable, either the Indenture Trustee or the Majority Holders of all the Outstanding Notes hereunder (treated as one Class), by notice in writing to the Issuer (and to the Indenture Trustee if given by Holders), may declare the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all the Notes then Outstanding and all interest accrued or principal accreted and unpaid (if any) thereon to be due and payable immediately, and upon any such declaration the same will become and will be immediately due and payable, notwithstanding anything in this Indenture, the related Asset Pool Supplement, the related Indenture Supplements or the Notes to the contrary.

(c) If an Event of Default described in clause (d) of Section 601 occurs and is continuing, then the Notes of all Series, Classes and Tranches will automatically be and become immediately due and payable by the Issuer, without notice or demand to any Person, and the Issuer will automatically and immediately be obligated to pay off the Notes.

 

- 49 -


At any time after such a declaration of acceleration has been made or an automatic acceleration has occurred with respect to the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche and before a judgment or decree for payment of the money due has been obtained by the Indenture Trustee as hereinafter in this Article VI provided, the Majority Holders of such Series, Classes or Tranche, by written notice to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, may rescind and annul such declaration and its consequences if:

(x) the Issuer has paid or deposited with the Indenture Trustee a sum sufficient to pay (i) all overdue installments of interest on the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, (ii) the principal of any Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche which have become due otherwise than by such declaration of acceleration, and interest thereon at the rate or rates prescribed therefor by the terms of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, to the extent that payment of such interest is lawful, (iii) interest upon overdue installments of interest at the rate or rates prescribed therefor by the terms of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche to the extent that payment of such interest is lawful, and (iv) all sums paid by the Indenture Trustee hereunder and the reasonable compensation, expenses and disbursements of the Indenture Trustee, its agents and counsel and all other amounts due to the Indenture Trustee under Section 707; and

(y) all Events of Default with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, other than the nonpayment of the principal of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche which has become due solely by such acceleration, have been cured or waived as provided in Section 616.

No such rescission will affect any subsequent default or impair any right consequent thereon.

Section 603. Collection of Indebtedness and Suits for Enforcement by Indenture Trustee. The Issuer covenants that if:

(a) the Issuer defaults in the payment of interest on any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes when such interest becomes due and payable and such default continues for a period of thirty-five (35) days following the date on which such interest became due and payable, or

(b) the Issuer defaults in the payment of the principal of any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes on the Legal Maturity Date thereof;

the Issuer will, upon demand of the Indenture Trustee, pay (subject to the allocation provided in this Article VI and any related Indenture Supplement) to the Indenture Trustee, for the benefit of the Holders of any such Notes of the affected Series, Class or Tranche, the whole amount then due and payable on any such Notes for principal and interest, with interest, to the extent that payment of such interest will be legally enforceable, upon the overdue principal and upon overdue installments of interest, (i) in the case of Interest-bearing Notes, at the rate of interest applicable to the Stated Principal Amount thereof, unless otherwise specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement; and (ii) in the case of Discount Notes, as specified in the applicable

 

- 50 -


Indenture Supplement, and in addition thereto, will pay such further amount as will be sufficient to cover the costs and expenses of collection, including the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Indenture Trustee, its agents and counsel and all other amounts due to the Indenture Trustee under Section 707.

If the Issuer fails to pay such amounts forthwith upon such demand, the Indenture Trustee may, in its own name and as trustee of an express trust, institute a judicial proceeding for the collection of the sums so due and unpaid, and may directly prosecute such proceeding to judgment or final decree, and the Indenture Trustee may enforce the same against the Issuer or any other obligor upon the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche and collect the money adjudged or decreed to be payable in the manner provided by law out of the Collateral or any other obligor upon such Notes, wherever situated.

Section 604. Indenture Trustee May File Proofs of Claim. In case of the pendency of any receivership, insolvency, liquidation, bankruptcy or other similar proceeding relative to the Issuer or any other obligor upon the Notes or the property of the Issuer or of such other obligor, the Indenture Trustee (irrespective of whether the principal of the Notes will then be due and payable as therein expressed or by declaration or otherwise) will be entitled and empowered by intervention in such proceeding or otherwise,

(i) to file and prove a claim for the whole amount of principal and interest owing and unpaid in respect of the Notes and to file such other papers or documents as may be necessary and advisable in order to have the claims of the Indenture Trustee (including any claim for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Indenture Trustee, its agents and counsel and all other amounts due the Indenture Trustee under Section 707) and of the Noteholders allowed in such judicial proceeding, and

(ii) to collect and receive any funds or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and to distribute the same;

and any receiver, assignee, trustee, liquidator or other similar official in any such proceeding is hereby authorized by each Noteholder to make such payment to the Indenture Trustee, and in the event that the Indenture Trustee will consent to the making of such payments directly to the Noteholders, to pay to the Indenture Trustee any amount due to it for the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Indenture Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Indenture Trustee under Section 707.

Nothing herein contained will be deemed to authorize the Indenture Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Noteholder any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Notes or the rights of any Holder thereof, or to authorize the Indenture Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Noteholder in any such proceeding.

Section 605. Indenture Trustee May Enforce Claims Without Possession of Notes. All rights of action and claims under this Indenture or the Notes of any Series, Class or

 

- 51 -


Tranche may be prosecuted and enforced by the Indenture Trustee, without the possession of any of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche or the production thereof in any proceeding relating thereto, and any such proceeding instituted by the Indenture Trustee, will be brought in its own name as trustee of an express trust, and any recovery of judgment will, after provision for the payment of the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Indenture Trustee and its respective agents and counsel, be for the ratable benefit of the Holders of the Notes of the Series, Class or Tranche in respect of which such judgment has been recovered.

Section 606. Application of Money Collected. Any money or other property collected by the Indenture Trustee, with respect to a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes pursuant to this Article VI will be applied in the following order, at the date or dates fixed by the Indenture Trustee and, in case of the distribution of such money on account of principal or interest, upon presentation of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche and the notation thereon of the payment if only partially paid and upon surrender thereof if fully paid:

(a) first, to the payment of all amounts due the Indenture Trustee under Section 707(a);

(b) second, to the payment of the amounts then due and unpaid upon the Notes of that Series, Class or Tranche for principal and interest, in respect of which or for the benefit of which such money has been collected, ratably, without preference or priority of any kind (but subject to the allocation provided in the relevant allocation provisions of the related Asset Pool Supplement and the related Indenture Supplement), according to the amounts due and payable on such Notes for principal and interest, respectively;

(c) third, to pay any servicing fee and any other fees or expenses then owing for that Series, Class or Tranche of Notes; and

(d) fourth, to the Issuer.

Section 607. Indenture Trustee May Elect to Hold the Collateral Certificate. Following an acceleration of any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the Indenture Trustee may elect to continue to hold a Collateral Certificate and apply distributions on a Collateral Certificate in accordance with the regular distribution provisions pursuant to the relevant allocation provisions of the related Asset Pool Supplement, except that principal will be paid on the accelerated Series, Class or Tranche of Notes to the extent funds are received and allocated to the accelerated Series, Class or Tranche, and payment is permitted by the subordination provisions of the accelerated Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 608. Sale of Collateral for Accelerated Notes. In the case of a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes that has been accelerated following an Event of Default, the Indenture Trustee may, and at the direction of the Majority Holders of that Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will, cause the Issuer to sell Collateral as provided in the related Indenture Supplement.

Section 609. Noteholders Have the Right to Direct the Time, Method and Place of Conducting Any Proceeding for Any Remedy Available to the Indenture Trustee. The

 

- 52 -


Majority Holders of any accelerated Series, Class or Tranche of Notes have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Indenture Trustee, or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Indenture Trustee. This right may be exercised only if the direction provided by the Noteholders does not conflict with applicable law or this Indenture and does not have a substantial likelihood of involving the Indenture Trustee in personal liability.

Section 610. Limitation on Suits. No Holder of any Note of any Series, Class or Tranche will have any right to institute any proceeding, judicial or otherwise, with respect to this Indenture, or for the appointment of a receiver or trustee or similar official, or for any other remedy hereunder, unless:

(a) such Holder has previously given written notice to the Indenture Trustee of a continuing Event of Default with respect to Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche;

(b) the Holders of more than 25% in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche have made written request to the Indenture Trustee to institute proceedings in respect of such Event of Default in the name of the Indenture Trustee hereunder;

(c) such Holder or Holders have offered to the Indenture Trustee indemnity reasonably satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses and liabilities to be incurred in compliance with such request; and

(d) the Indenture Trustee, for sixty (60) days after the Indenture Trustee has received such notice, request and offer of indemnity, has failed to institute any such proceeding;

it being understood and intended that no one or more Holders of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche will have any right in any manner whatsoever by virtue of, or by availing of, any provision of this Indenture to affect, disturb or prejudice the rights of any other Holders of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, or to obtain or to seek to obtain priority or preference over any other such Holders or to enforce any right under this Indenture, except in the manner herein provided and for the equal and proportionate benefit of all the Holders of all Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 611. Unconditional Right of Noteholders to Receive Principal and Interest; Limited Recourse. Notwithstanding any other provisions in this Indenture, the Holder of any Note will have the right, which is absolute and unconditional, to receive payment of the principal of and interest on such Note on the Legal Maturity Date expressed in the related Indenture Supplement and to institute suit for the enforcement of any such payment, and such right will not be impaired without the consent of such Holder; provided, however, that notwithstanding any other provision of this Indenture to the contrary, the obligation to pay principal of or interest on the Notes or any other amount payable to any Noteholder will be without recourse to any Transferor, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee or any Affiliate, officer, employee or director of any of them, and the obligation of the Issuer to pay principal of or interest on the Notes or any other amount payable to any Noteholder will be subject to the

 

- 53 -


allocation and payment provisions of the applicable Asset Pool Supplement and the applicable Indenture Supplement and limited to amounts available from the Collateral pledged to secure the Notes of the applicable Asset Pool.

Section 612. Restoration of Rights and Remedies. If the Indenture Trustee or any Noteholder has instituted any proceeding to enforce any right or remedy under this Indenture and such proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned for any reason, then and in every such case the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders will, subject to any determination in such proceeding, be restored severally and respectively to their former positions hereunder, and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Indenture Trustee and the Noteholders will continue as though no such proceeding had been instituted.

Section 613. Rights and Remedies Cumulative. No right or remedy herein conferred upon or reserved to the Indenture Trustee or to the Noteholders is intended to be exclusive of any other right or remedy, and every right and remedy will, to the extent permitted by law, be cumulative and in addition to every other right and remedy given hereunder or now or hereafter existing at law or in equity or otherwise. The assertion or employment of any right or remedy hereunder, or otherwise, will not prevent the concurrent assertion or employment of any other appropriate right or remedy.

Section 614. Delay or Omission Not Waiver. No delay or omission of the Indenture Trustee or of any Holder of any Note to exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Event of Default will impair any such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Event of Default or an acquiescence therein. Every right and remedy given by this Article or by law to the Indenture Trustee or to the Noteholders may be exercised from time to time, and as often as may be deemed expedient, by the Indenture Trustee or by the Noteholders, as the case may be.

Section 615. Control by Noteholders. The Majority Holders of any affected Series, Class or Tranche will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Indenture Trustee, or exercising any trust or power conferred on the Indenture Trustee with respect to the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, provided that:

(a) the Indenture Trustee will have the right to decline to follow any such direction if the Indenture Trustee, being advised by counsel, determines that the action so directed may not lawfully be taken or would conflict with this Indenture or if the Indenture Trustee in good faith determines that the proceedings so directed would involve it in personal liability or be unjustly prejudicial to the Holders not taking part in such direction, and

(b) the Indenture Trustee may take any other action permitted hereunder deemed proper by the Indenture Trustee which is not inconsistent with such direction.

 

- 54 -


Section 616. Waiver of Past Defaults. Holders of more than 66 23% of the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of any Series, Class or Tranche may on behalf of the Holders of all the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche waive any past default hereunder or under the related Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche and its consequences, except a default not theretofore cured:

(a) in the payment of the principal of or interest on any Note of such Series, Class or Tranche, or

(b) in respect of a covenant or provision hereof which under Article IX cannot be modified or amended without the consent of the Holder of each Outstanding Note of such Series, Class or Tranche.

Upon any such waiver, such default will cease to exist, and any Event of Default arising therefrom will be deemed to have been cured, for every purpose of this Indenture; but no such waiver will extend to any subsequent or other default or impair any right consequent thereon.

Section 617. Undertaking for Costs. All parties to this Indenture agree, and each Holder of any Note by his acceptance thereof will be deemed to have agreed, that any court may in its discretion require, in any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Indenture, or in any suit against the Indenture Trustee for any action taken or omitted by it as Indenture Trustee, the filing by any party litigant in such suit of an undertaking to pay the costs of such suit, and that such court may in its discretion assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys’ fees and expenses, against any party litigant in such suit, having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by such party litigant; but the provisions of this Section will not apply to any suit instituted by the Indenture Trustee, to any suit instituted by any Noteholder, or group of Noteholders, holding in the aggregate more than 25% in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche to which the suit relates, or to any suit instituted by any Noteholders for the enforcement of the payment of the principal of or interest on any Note on or after the applicable Legal Maturity Date expressed in such Note.

Section 618. Waiver of Stay or Extension Laws. The Issuer covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it will not at any time insist upon, or plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay or extension law wherever enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, which may affect the covenants or the performance of this Indenture; and the Issuer (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) hereby expressly waives all benefit or advantage of any such law, and covenants that it will not hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein granted to the Indenture Trustee, but will suffer and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law had been enacted.

[END OF ARTICLE VI]

 

- 55 -


ARTICLE VII

THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE

Section 701. Certain Duties and Responsibilities.

(a) The Indenture Trustee undertakes to perform such duties and only such duties as are specifically set forth in this Indenture with respect to the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, and no implied covenants or obligations will be read into this Indenture against the Indenture Trustee.

(b) In the absence of bad faith on its part, the Indenture Trustee may, with respect to Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, conclusively rely, as to the truth of the statements and the correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon certificates or opinions furnished to the Indenture Trustee and conforming to the requirements of this Indenture; but in the case of any such certificates or opinions which by any provision hereof are specifically required to be furnished to the Indenture Trustee, the Indenture Trustee will be under a duty to examine the same to determine whether or not they conform to the requirements of this Indenture but need not confirm or investigate the accuracy of any mathematical calculations or other facts stated therein.

(c) In case an Event of Default with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes has occurred and is continuing, the Indenture Trustee will exercise with respect to the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche such of the rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture, and use the same degree of care and skill in their exercise, as a prudent person would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of such person’s own affairs.

(d) No provision of this Indenture will be construed to relieve the Indenture Trustee from liability for its own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act, or its own willful misconduct, except that:

(i) this subsection (d) will not be construed to limit the effect of subsection (a) of this Section;

(ii) the Indenture Trustee will not be liable for any error of judgment made in good faith by an Indenture Trustee Authorized Officer, unless it will be proved that the Indenture Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent facts;

(iii) the Indenture Trustee will not be liable with respect to any action taken or omitted to be taken by it in good faith in accordance with the direction of the Majority Holders of any Series, Class or Tranche relating to the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Indenture Trustee, or exercising any trust or power conferred upon the Indenture Trustee, under this Indenture with respect to the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche; and

(iv) no provision of this Indenture will require the Indenture Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of any of its duties hereunder, or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers, if it will have reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or indemnity satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it.

 

- 56 -


(e) Whether or not therein expressly so provided, every provision of this Indenture relating to the conduct or affecting the liability of or affording protection to the Indenture Trustee will be subject to the provisions of this Section.

Section 702. Notice of Defaults. Within ninety (90) days after the occurrence of any default hereunder with respect to Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche,

(a) the Indenture Trustee will transmit by mail to all Registered Noteholders of such Series, Class or Tranche, as their names and addresses appear in the Note Register, notice of such default hereunder known to the Indenture Trustee,

(b) the Indenture Trustee will notify all Holders of Bearer Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, by publication of notice of such default in an Authorized Newspaper, or as otherwise provided in the applicable Indenture Supplement, and

(c) the Indenture Trustee will give prompt written notification thereof to the Note Rating Agencies, unless such default will have been cured or waived;

provided, however, that, except in the case of a default in the payment of the principal of or interest on any Note of such Series, Class or Tranche, the Indenture Trustee will be protected in withholding such notice if and so long as an Indenture Trustee Authorized Officer in good faith determines that the withholding of such notice is in the interests of the Noteholders of such Series, Class or Tranche. For the purpose of this Section, the term “default,” with respect to Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche, means any event which is, or after notice or lapse of time or both would become, an Event of Default with respect to Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 703. Certain Rights of Indenture Trustee. Except as otherwise provided in Section 701:

(a) the Indenture Trustee may conclusively rely and will be protected in acting or refraining from acting upon any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, direction, consent, order, bond, debenture or other paper or document (whether in its original or facsimile form) believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties;

(b) whenever in the administration of this Indenture the Indenture Trustee will deem it desirable that a matter be proved or established before taking, suffering or omitting any action hereunder, the Indenture Trustee (unless other evidence be herein specifically prescribed) may, in the absence of bad faith on its part, rely upon an Officer’s Certificate;

 

- 57 -


(c) the Indenture Trustee may consult with counsel of its own selection and the advice of such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel will be full and complete authorization and protection in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in reliance thereon;

(d) the Indenture Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers vested in it by this Indenture at the request or direction of any of the Noteholders pursuant to this Indenture, unless such Noteholders shall have offered to the Indenture Trustee security or indemnity reasonably satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses and liabilities which might be incurred by it in compliance with such request or direction;

(e) the Indenture Trustee will not be bound to make any investigation into the facts or matters stated in any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, direction, consent, order, bond, debenture or other paper or document, but the Indenture Trustee, in its discretion, may make such further inquiry or investigation into such facts or matters as it may see fit, and, if the Indenture Trustee will determine to make such further inquiry or investigation, it will be entitled to examine the books, records and premises of the Issuer, personally or by agent or attorney;

(f) the Indenture Trustee may execute any of the trusts or powers hereunder or perform any duties hereunder either directly or by or through agents or attorneys and the Indenture Trustee will not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any agent or attorney appointed with due care by it hereunder;

(g) the Indenture Trustee will not be responsible for filing any financing statements or continuation statements in connection with the Notes, but will cooperate with the Issuer in connection with the filing of such financing statements or continuation statements;

(h) the Indenture Trustee shall not be deemed to have notice of any default or Event of Default unless an Indenture Trustee Authorized Officer has actual knowledge thereof or unless written notice of any event which is in fact such a default is received by the Indenture Trustee at the Corporate Trust Office of the Indenture Trustee, and such notice references the Notes and this Indenture; and

(i) the rights, privileges, protections, immunities and benefits given to the Indenture Trustee, including, without limitation, its right to be indemnified, are extended to, and shall be enforceable by, the Indenture Trustee in each of its capacities hereunder, and each agent, custodian and other person employed to act hereunder.

Section 704. Not Responsible for Recitals or Issuance of Notes. The recitals contained herein and in the Notes, except the certificates of authentication, will be taken as the statements of the Issuer, and the Indenture Trustee assumes no responsibility for their correctness. The Indenture Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency of this Indenture or of the Notes. The Indenture Trustee will not be accountable for the use or application by the Issuer of Notes or the proceeds thereof.

 

- 58 -


Section 705. May Hold Notes. The Indenture Trustee, any Paying Agent, the Note Registrar or any other agent of the Issuer, in its individual or any other capacity, may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and, subject to Sections 708 and 713, may otherwise deal with the Issuer with the same rights it would have if it were not Indenture Trustee, Paying Agent, Note Registrar or such other agent.

Section 706. Money Held in Trust. The Indenture Trustee will be under no liability for interest on any money received by it hereunder except as otherwise agreed with the Issuer.

Section 707. Compensation and Reimbursement, Limit on Compensation, Reimbursement and Indemnity.

(a) The Issuer agrees:

(i) to pay to the Indenture Trustee from time to time reasonable compensation (or, for so long as The Bank of New York Mellon is the Indenture Trustee, such amount as has been mutually agreed upon in writing) for all services rendered by it hereunder (which compensation will not be limited by any provision of law in regard to the compensation of a trustee of an express trust);

(ii) except as otherwise expressly provided herein, to reimburse the Indenture Trustee upon its request for all reasonable expenses, disbursements and advances incurred or made by the Indenture Trustee in accordance with any provision of this Indenture (including the reasonable compensation and the reasonable expenses and disbursements of its agents and counsel), except any such expense, disbursement or advance as may be attributable to its negligence or bad faith; and

(iii) to indemnify the Indenture Trustee for, and to hold it harmless against, any and all loss, liability or expense incurred without negligence or bad faith on its part, arising out of or in connection with the acceptance or administration of this trust, including the costs and expenses of defending itself against any claim or liability (whether asserted by the Issuer, the Administrator, any Holder or any other Person) in connection with the exercise or performance of any of its powers or duties hereunder.

The Indenture Trustee will have no recourse to any asset of the Issuer other than funds available pursuant to Section 606 or to any Person other than the Administrator or the Issuer. Except as specified in Section 606, any such payment to the Indenture Trustee shall be subordinate to payments to be made to Noteholders.

(b) This Section will survive the termination of this Indenture and the resignation or replacement of the Indenture Trustee under Section 710.

 

- 59 -


Section 708. Disqualification; Conflicting Interests. If the Indenture Trustee has or will acquire a conflicting interest within the meaning of the Trust Indenture Act, the Indenture Trustee will, if so required by the Trust Indenture Act, either eliminate such interest or resign, to the extent and in the manner provided by, and subject to the provisions of, the Trust Indenture Act and this Indenture. Nothing herein will prevent the Indenture Trustee from filing with the Commission the application referred to in the second to last paragraph of Section 310(b) of the Trust Indenture Act.

Section 709. Corporate Indenture Trustee Required; Eligibility. There will at all times be an Indenture Trustee hereunder with respect to each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, which will be either a bank or a corporation organized and doing business under the laws of the United States of America or of any State, authorized under such laws to exercise corporate trust powers, having a combined capital and surplus of at least $50,000,000, subject to supervision or examination by Federal or State authority, and having a rating of at least BBB- by Standard & Poor’s and Baa3 by Moody’s. If such corporation publishes reports of condition at least annually, pursuant to law or to the requirements of the aforesaid supervising or examining authority, then for the purposes of this Section, the combined capital and surplus of such corporation will be deemed to be its combined capital and surplus as set forth in its most recent report of condition so published. The Issuer may not, nor may any Person directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by, or under common control with the Issuer, serve as Indenture Trustee. If at any time the Indenture Trustee with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will cease to be eligible in accordance with the provisions of this Section, it will resign immediately in the manner and with the effect hereinafter specified in this Article.

Section 710. Resignation and Removal; Appointment of Successor.

(a) No resignation or removal of the Indenture Trustee and no appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee pursuant to this Article will become effective until the acceptance of appointment by the successor Indenture Trustee under Section 711.

(b) The Indenture Trustee may resign with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes at any time by giving written notice thereof to the Issuer. If an instrument of acceptance by a successor Indenture Trustee shall not have been delivered to the Indenture Trustee within thirty (30) days after the giving of such notice of resignation, the resigning Indenture Trustee may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee.

(c) The Indenture Trustee may be removed with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes at any time by Action of the Majority Holders of that Series, Class or Tranche, delivered to the Indenture Trustee and to the Issuer. If an instrument of acceptance by a successor Indenture Trustee shall not have been delivered to the Indenture Trustee within 30 days after the giving of such notice of removal, the Indenture Trustee being removed may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee.

 

- 60 -


(d) If at any time:

(i) the Indenture Trustee fails to comply with Section 310(b) of the Trust Indenture Act with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes after written request therefor by the Issuer or by any Noteholder who has been a bona fide Holder of a Note of that Series, Class or Tranche for at least six (6) months, or

(ii) the Indenture Trustee ceases to be eligible under Section 709 with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes and fails to resign after written request therefor by the Issuer or by any such Noteholder, or

(iii) the Indenture Trustee becomes incapable of acting with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, or

(iv) the Indenture Trustee is adjudged bankrupt or insolvent or a receiver of the Indenture Trustee or of its property is appointed or any public officer takes charge or control of the Indenture Trustee or of its property or affairs for the purpose of rehabilitation, conservation or liquidation,

then, in any such case, (A) the Issuer may remove the Indenture Trustee, with respect to the Series, Class or Tranche, or in the case of clause (iv), with respect to all Series, Classes or Tranches, or (B) subject to Section 617, any Noteholder who has been a bona fide Holder of a Note of such Series, Class and Tranche for at least six (6) months may, on behalf of itself and all others similarly situated, petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Indenture Trustee with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche and the appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee with respect to the Series, Class or Tranche, or, in the case of clause (iv), with respect to all Series, Classes and Tranches.

(e) If the Indenture Trustee resigns, is removed or becomes incapable of acting with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, or if a vacancy shall occur in the office of the Indenture Trustee with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes for any cause, the Issuer will promptly appoint a successor Indenture Trustee for that Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. If, within one year after such resignation, removal or incapacity, or the occurrence of such vacancy, a successor Indenture Trustee with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes is appointed by Act of the Majority Holders of such Series, Class or Tranche delivered to the Issuer and the retiring Indenture Trustee, the successor Indenture Trustee so appointed will, forthwith upon its acceptance of such appointment, become the successor Indenture Trustee with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche and supersede the successor Indenture Trustee appointed by the Issuer with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. If no successor Indenture Trustee with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes shall have been so appointed by the Issuer or the Noteholders of such Series, Class or Tranche and accepted appointment in the manner hereinafter provided, any Noteholder who has been a bona fide Holder of a Note of that Series, Class or Tranche for at least six (6) months may, on behalf of itself and all others similarly situated, petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee with respect to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes.

 

- 61 -


(f) The Issuer will give written notice of each resignation and each removal of the Indenture Trustee with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes and each appointment of a successor Indenture Trustee with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche to each Noteholder as provided in Section 106 and to each Note Rating Agency. To facilitate delivery of such notice, upon request by the Issuer, the Note Registrar shall provide to the Issuer a list of the relevant Registered Noteholders. Each notice will include the name of the successor Indenture Trustee and the address of its principal Corporate Trust Office.

Section 711. Acceptance of Appointment by Successor. Every successor Indenture Trustee appointed hereunder will execute, acknowledge and deliver to the Issuer and to the predecessor Indenture Trustee an instrument accepting such appointment, with a copy to the Note Rating Agencies, and thereupon the resignation or removal of the predecessor Indenture Trustee will become effective with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche as to which it is resigning or being removed as Indenture Trustee, and such successor Indenture Trustee, without any further act, deed or conveyance, will become vested with all the rights, powers, trusts and duties of the predecessor Indenture Trustee with respect to any such Series, Class or Tranche; but, on request of the Issuer or the successor Indenture Trustee, such predecessor Indenture Trustee will, upon payment of its reasonable charges, if any, execute and deliver an instrument transferring to such successor Indenture Trustee all the rights, powers and trusts of the predecessor Indenture Trustee, and will duly assign, transfer and deliver to such successor Indenture Trustee all property and money held by such predecessor Indenture Trustee hereunder with respect to all or any such Series, Class or Tranche, subject nevertheless to its lien, if any, provided for in Section 707. Upon request of any such successor Indenture Trustee, the Issuer will execute any and all instruments for more fully and certainly vesting in and confirming to such successor Indenture Trustee all such rights, powers and trusts.

In case of the appointment hereunder of a successor Indenture Trustee with respect to the Notes of one or more (but not all) Series, Classes or Tranches, the Issuer, the predecessor Indenture Trustee and each successor Indenture Trustee with respect to the Notes of any applicable Series, Class or Tranche will execute and deliver an Indenture Supplement which will contain such provisions as shall be deemed necessary or desirable to confirm that all the rights, powers, trusts and duties of the predecessor Indenture Trustee with respect to the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche as to which the predecessor Indenture Trustee is not being succeeded will continue to be vested in the predecessor Indenture Trustee, and will add to or change any of the provisions of this Indenture as shall be necessary to provide for or facilitate the administration of the trusts hereunder by more than one Indenture Trustee, it being understood that nothing herein or in such Indenture Supplement will constitute such Indenture Trustees co-trustees of the same trust and that each such Indenture Trustee will be Indenture Trustee of a trust or trusts hereunder separate and apart from any trust or trusts hereunder administered by any other such Indenture Trustee.

No successor Indenture Trustee with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will accept its appointment unless at the time of such acceptance such successor Indenture Trustee will be qualified and eligible under this Article.

 

- 62 -


Section 712. Merger, Conversion, Consolidation or Succession to Business. Any corporation into which the Indenture Trustee may be merged or converted or with which it may be consolidated, or any corporation resulting from any merger, conversion or consolidation to which the Indenture Trustee shall be a party, or any corporation succeeding to all or substantially all of the corporate trust business of the Indenture Trustee, will be the successor of the Indenture Trustee hereunder, provided such corporation shall be otherwise qualified and eligible under this Article, without the execution or filing of any paper or any further act on the part of any of the parties hereto. The Indenture Trustee will give prompt written notice of such merger, conversion, consolidation or succession to the Issuer and the Note Rating Agencies. In case any Notes shall have been authenticated, but not delivered, by the Indenture Trustee then in office, any successor by merger, conversion or consolidation to such authenticating Indenture Trustee may adopt such authentication and deliver the Notes so authenticated with the same effect as if such successor Indenture Trustee had itself authenticated such Notes.

Section 713. Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer. If and when the Indenture Trustee shall be or become a creditor of the Issuer (or any other obligor upon the Notes), the Indenture Trustee will be subject to the provisions of Section 311 of the Trust Indenture Act. An Indenture Trustee who has resigned or been removed will be subject to Section 311(a) of the Trust Indenture Act to the extent provided therein.

Section 714. Appointment of Authenticating Agent. At any time when any of the Notes remain Outstanding the Indenture Trustee, with the approval of the Issuer, may appoint an Authenticating Agent or Agents with respect to one or more Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes which will be authorized to act on behalf of the Indenture Trustee to authenticate Notes of such Series, Classes or Tranches issued upon exchange, registration of transfer or partial redemption thereof or pursuant to Section 306, and Notes so authenticated will be entitled to the benefits of this Indenture and will be valid and obligatory for all purposes as if authenticated by the Indenture Trustee hereunder. Wherever reference is made in this Indenture to the authentication and delivery of Notes by the Indenture Trustee or the Indenture Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication, such reference will be deemed to include authentication and delivery on behalf of the Indenture Trustee by an Authenticating Agent and a Certificate of Authentication executed on behalf of the Indenture Trustee by an Authenticating Agent. Each Authenticating Agent will be acceptable to the Issuer and will at all times be a corporation organized and doing business under the laws of the United States of America, any State thereof or the District of Columbia, authorized under such laws to act as an Authenticating Agent, having a combined capital and surplus of not less than $50,000,000 and, if other than the Issuer itself, subject to supervision or examination by Federal or State authority. If such Authenticating Agent publishes reports of condition at least annually, pursuant to law or to the requirements of said supervising or examining authority, then for the purposes of this Section, the combined capital and surplus of such Authenticating Agent will be deemed to be its combined capital and surplus as set forth in its most recent report of condition so published. If at any time an Authenticating Agent will cease to be eligible in accordance with the provisions of this Section, such Authenticating Agent will resign immediately in the manner and with the effect specified in this Section. The initial Authenticating Agent for the Notes of all Series, Classes and Tranches will be The Bank of New York Mellon.

 

- 63 -


Any corporation into which an Authenticating Agent may be merged or converted or with which it may be consolidated, or any corporation resulting from any merger, conversion or consolidation to which such Authenticating Agent will be a party, or any corporation succeeding to the corporate agency or corporate trust business of an Authenticating Agent, will continue to be an Authenticating Agent, provided such corporation will be otherwise eligible under this Section, without the execution or filing of any paper or any further act on the part of the Indenture Trustee or the Authenticating Agent.

An Authenticating Agent may resign at any time by giving written notice thereof to the Indenture Trustee and to the Issuer. The Indenture Trustee may at any time terminate the agency of an Authenticating Agent by giving written notice thereof to such Authenticating Agent and to the Issuer. Upon receiving such a notice of resignation or upon such a termination, or in case at any time such Authenticating Agent will cease to be eligible in accordance with the provisions of this Section, the Indenture Trustee, with the approval of the Issuer, may appoint a successor Authenticating Agent which will be acceptable to the Issuer and will give notice to each Noteholder as provided in Section 106. Any successor Authenticating Agent upon acceptance of its appointment hereunder will become vested with all the rights, powers and duties of its predecessor hereunder, with like effect as if originally named as an Authenticating Agent. No successor Authenticating Agent will be appointed unless eligible under the provisions of this Section.

The Indenture Trustee agrees to pay to each Authenticating Agent (other than an Authenticating Agent appointed at the request of the Issuer from time to time) reasonable compensation for its services under this Section, and the Indenture Trustee will be entitled to be reimbursed for such payments, subject to the provisions of Section 707.

If an appointment with respect to one or more Series, Classes or Tranches is made pursuant to this Section, the Notes of such Series, Classes or Tranche may have endorsed thereon, in addition to the Indenture Trustee’s Certificate of Authentication, an alternate Certificate of Authentication in the following form:

This is one of the Notes of the Series, Classes or Tranches designated therein referred to in the within-mentioned Indenture.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, as
as Indenture Trustee,
By:  

 

  As Authenticating Agent
By:  

 

  Authorized Signatory

 

- 64 -


Section 715. Tax Returns. (a) In the event that the Issuer shall be required to file tax returns, the Administrator shall prepare or shall cause to be prepared such tax returns and shall provide such tax returns to the Owner Trustee or the Beneficiary for signature at least five (5) days before such tax returns are due to be filed. The Issuer, in accordance with the terms of each Indenture Supplement, shall also prepare or shall cause to be prepared all tax information required by law to be distributed to Noteholders and shall deliver such information to the Indenture Trustee at least five (5) days prior to the date it is required by law to be distributed to Noteholders. The Indenture Trustee, upon written request, will furnish the Administrator, the Issuer, and the Beneficiary with all such information known to the Indenture Trustee as may be reasonably requested and required in connection with the preparation of all tax returns of the Issuer, and shall, upon request, execute such returns. In no event shall the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee be personally liable for any liabilities, costs or expenses of the Issuer or any Noteholder arising under any tax law, including without limitation, federal, state or local income or excise taxes or any other tax imposed on or measured by income (or any interest or penalty with respect thereto arising from a failure to comply therewith).

(b) In the event that the Issuer is classified as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, beginning with each taxable year after December 31, 2017, or if later, the date that Sections 6221 through 6241 of the Code apply to the Issuer, the Transferor (or a U.S. Affiliate of the Transferor if the Transferor is ineligible) is hereby designated as the partnership representative under Section 6223(a) of the Code to the extent allowed by law. The Issuer shall, to the extent eligible, make the election under Section 6221 (b) of the Code with respect to determinations of adjustments at the partnership level and take any other action such as filings, disclosures and notifications necessary to effectuate such election. If the election described in the preceding sentence is not available, the Issuer shall, to the extent eligible, make the election under Section 6226(a) of the Code with respect to the alternative to payment of imputed underpayments by a partnership and take any other action such as filings, disclosures and notifications necessary to effectuate such election. Notwithstanding the foregoing, each of the Issuer, the Transferor and the Servicer are authorized, in its sole discretion, to make any available election related to Sections 6221 through 6241 of the Code and to take any action it deems necessary or appropriate to comply with the requirements of the Code and conduct the Issuer’s affairs under Sections 6221 through 6241 of the Code.

Section 716. Representations and Covenants of the Indenture Trustee. The Indenture Trustee represents, warrants and covenants that:

(i) The Indenture Trustee is a banking corporation duly organized and validly existing under the laws of the State of New York;

(ii) The Indenture Trustee has full power and authority to deliver and perform this Indenture and has taken all necessary action to authorize the execution, delivery and performance by it of this Indenture and other documents to which it is a party; and

(iii) Each of this Indenture and the other documents to which it is a party has been duly executed and delivered by the Indenture Trustee and constitutes its legal, valid and binding obligation in accordance with its terms.

 

- 65 -


Section 717. Indenture Trustee’s Application for Instructions from the Issuer. Any application by the Indenture Trustee for written instructions from the Issuer may, at the option of the Indenture Trustee, set forth in writing any action proposed to be taken or omitted by the Indenture Trustee under and in accordance with this Indenture and the date on and/or after which such action shall be taken or such omission shall be effective, provided that such application shall make specific reference to this Section 717. The Indenture Trustee shall not be liable for any action taken by, or omission of, the Indenture Trustee in accordance with a proposal included in such application on or after the date specified in such application (which date shall not be less than five (5) Business Days after the date the Issuer actually receives such application, unless the Issuer shall have consented in writing to any earlier date) unless prior to taking any such action (or the effective date in the case of an omission), the Indenture Trustee shall have received written instructions in response to such application specifying the action be taken or omitted.

Section 718. Appointment of Co-Trustee or Separate Indenture Trustee. (a) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Indenture, at any time, for the purpose of meeting any legal requirements of any jurisdiction in which any part of the Trust Estate may at the time be located, the Indenture Trustee shall have the power and shall execute and deliver all instruments to appoint one or more Persons reasonably acceptable to the Issuer to act as a co-trustee or co-trustees, or separate trustee or separate trustees, of all or any part of the Trust Estate, and to vest in such Person or Persons, in such capacity and for the benefit of the Noteholders, such title to the Trust Estate, or any part thereof, and, subject to the other provisions of this Section 718, such powers, duties, obligations, rights and trusts as the Indenture Trustee may consider necessary or desirable. No co-trustee or separate trustee hereunder shall be required to meet the terms of eligibility as a successor trustee under Section 709 and no notice to Noteholders of the appointment of any co-trustee or separate trustee shall be required under Section 710.

(b) Every separate trustee and co-trustee shall, to the extent permitted by law, be appointed and act subject to the following provisions and conditions:

(i) all rights, powers, duties and obligations conferred or imposed upon the Indenture Trustee shall be conferred or imposed upon and exercised or performed by the Indenture Trustee and such separate trustee or co-trustee jointly (it being understood that such separate trustee or co-trustee is not authorized to act separately without the Indenture Trustee joining in such act), except to the extent that under any law of any jurisdiction in which any particular act or acts are to be performed, the Indenture Trustee shall be incompetent or unqualified to perform such act or acts, in which event such rights, powers, duties and obligations (including the holding of title to the Trust Estate or any portion thereof in any such jurisdiction) shall be exercised and performed singly by such separate trustee or co-trustee, but solely at the direction of the Indenture Trustee;

 

- 66 -


(ii) no trustee hereunder shall be personally liable by reason of any act or omission of any other trustee hereunder; and

(iii) the Indenture Trustee may at any time accept the resignation of or remove any separate trustee or co-trustee.

(c) Any notice, request or other writing given to the Indenture Trustee shall be deemed to have been given to each of the then separate trustees and co-trustees, as effectively as if given to each of them. Every instrument appointing any separate trustee or co-trustee shall refer to this Indenture and the conditions of this Article VII. Each separate trustee and co-trustee, upon its acceptance of the trusts conferred, shall be vested with the estates or property specified in its instrument of appointment, either jointly with the Indenture Trustee or separately, as may be provided therein, subject to all the provisions of this Indenture, specifically including every provision of this Indenture relating to the conduct of, affecting the liability of, or affording protection to, the Indenture Trustee. Every such instrument shall be filed with the Indenture Trustee.

(d) Any separate trustee or co-trustee may at any time appoint the Indenture Trustee, its agent or attorney-in-fact with full power and authority, to the extent not prohibited by law, to do any lawful act under or in respect of this Indenture on its behalf and in its name. If any separate trustee or co-trustee shall die, become incapable of acting, resign or be removed, all of its estates, properties, rights, remedies and trusts shall vest in and be exercised by the Indenture Trustee, to the extent permitted by law, without the appointment of a new or successor trustee.

[END OF ARTICLE VII]

 

- 67 -


ARTICLE VIII

NOTEHOLDERS’ MEETINGS, LISTS,

REPORTS BY INDENTURE TRUSTEE,

ISSUER AND BENEFICIARY

Section 801. Issuer To Furnish Indenture Trustee Names and Addresses of Noteholders. The Issuer will furnish or cause to be furnished to the Indenture Trustee:

(a) not more than fifteen (15) days after each Record Date, in each year in such form as the Indenture Trustee may reasonably require, a list of the names and addresses of the Registered Noteholders of such Series, Classes or Tranches as of such date, and

(b) at such other times as the Indenture Trustee may request in writing, within thirty (30) days after the receipt by the Issuer of any such request, a list of similar form and content as of a date not more than fifteen (15) days before the time such list is furnished;

provided, however, that so long as the Indenture Trustee is the Note Registrar, no such list shall be required to be furnished.

Section 802. Preservation of Information; Communications to Noteholders.

(a) The Indenture Trustee will preserve, in as current a form as is reasonably practicable, the names and addresses of Registered Noteholders contained in the most recent list furnished to the Indenture Trustee as provided in Section 801 and the names and addresses of Registered Noteholders received by the Indenture Trustee in its capacity as Note Registrar. The Indenture Trustee may destroy any list furnished to it as provided in Section 801 upon receipt of a new list so furnished.

(b) If three (3) or more Holders of Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche (hereinafter referred to as “applicants”) (or, if there are less than three (3) such Holders, all of the Holders) apply in writing to the Indenture Trustee, and furnish to the Indenture Trustee reasonable proof that each such applicant has owned a Note of such Series, Class or Tranche for a period of at least six (6) months preceding the date of such application, and such application states that the applicants desire to communicate with other Holders of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche or with the Holders of all Notes with respect to their rights under this Indenture or under such Notes and is accompanied by a copy of the form of proxy or other communication which such applicants propose to transmit, then the Indenture Trustee will, within five (5) Business Days after the receipt of such application, at its election, either:

(i) afford such applicants access to the information preserved at the time by the Indenture Trustee in accordance with Subsection 802(a), or

(ii) inform such applicants as to the approximate number of Holders of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche or all Notes, as the case may be, whose names and addresses appear in the information preserved at the time by the Indenture Trustee in accordance with Subsection 802(a), and as to the approximate cost of mailing to such Noteholders the form of proxy or other communication, if any, specified in such application.

 

- 68 -


If the Indenture Trustee shall elect not to afford such applicants access to such information, the Indenture Trustee shall, upon the written request of such applicants, mail to each Holder of a Registered Note of such Series, Class or Tranche or to all Registered Noteholders, as the case may be, whose names and addresses appear in the information preserved at the time by the Indenture Trustee in accordance with Subsection 802(a), a copy of the form of proxy or other communication which is specified in such request, with reasonable promptness after a tender to the Indenture Trustee of the material to be mailed and of payment, or provision for the payment, of the reasonable expenses of mailing, unless, within five (5) days after such tender, the Indenture Trustee shall mail to such applicants and file with the Commission, together with a copy of the material to be mailed, a written statement to the effect that, in the opinion of the Indenture Trustee, such mailing would be contrary to the best interests of the Holders of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche or all Noteholders, as the case may be, or would be in violation of applicable law. Such written statement will specify the basis of such opinion. If the Commission, after opportunity for a hearing upon the objections specified in the written statement so filed, shall enter an order refusing to sustain any of such objections or if, after the entry of an order sustaining one or more of such objections, the Commission shall find, after notice and opportunity for hearing, that all the objections so sustained have been met and shall enter an order so declaring, the Indenture Trustee will mail copies of such material to all Registered Noteholders of such Series, Class or Tranche or all Registered Noteholders, as the case may be, with reasonable promptness after the entry of such order and the renewal of such tender; otherwise the Indenture Trustee will be relieved of any obligation or duty to such applicants respecting their application.

(c) Every Holder of Notes, by receiving and holding the same, agrees with the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee that neither the Issuer nor the Indenture Trustee will be held accountable by reason of the disclosure of any such information as to the names and addresses of the Holders of Notes in accordance with Subsection 802(b), regardless of the source from which such information was derived, and that the Indenture Trustee will not be held accountable by reason of mailing any material pursuant to a request made under Subsection 802(b).

Section 803. Reports by Indenture Trustee.

(a) The term “reporting date” as used in this Section means May 31. Within sixty (60) days after the reporting date in each year, beginning in 2003, the Indenture Trustee will transmit to Noteholders, in the manner and to the extent provided in Section 313(c) of the Trust Indenture Act, a brief report dated as of such reporting date if required by Section 313(a) of the Trust Indenture Act.

 

- 69 -


(b) To the extent required by the Trust Indenture Act, the Indenture Trustee will mail each year to all Registered Noteholders, with a copy to the Note Rating Agencies a report concerning:

(i) its eligibility and qualifications to continue as trustee under this Indenture;

(ii) any amounts advanced by the Indenture Trustee under this Indenture;

(iii) the amount, interest rate and maturity date or indebtedness owing by the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee, in its individual capacity;

(iv) the property and funds physically held by the Indenture Trustee by which the related Notes are secured;

(v) any release or release and substitution of Collateral subject to the lien of the related Asset Pool Supplement which has not previously been reported; and

(vi) any action taken by the Indenture Trustee that materially affects the Notes and that has not previously been reported.

(c) The Indenture Trustee will comply with Subsections 313(b) and 313(c) of the Trust Indenture Act.

(d) A copy of each such report will, at the time of such transmission to Noteholders, be filed by the Indenture Trustee with each stock exchange upon which the Notes are listed, and also with the Commission. The Issuer will notify the Indenture Trustee when the Notes are admitted to trading on any stock exchange.

Section 804. Meetings of Noteholders; Amendments and Waivers.

(a) If Notes of a Series, Class or Tranche are issuable in whole or in part as Bearer Notes, a meeting of Noteholders of the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche may be called at any time and from time to time pursuant to this Section to make, give or take any Action provided by this Indenture or any Indenture Supplement to be made, given or taken by Noteholders of such Series, Class or Tranche.

(b) The Indenture Trustee may call a meeting of the Noteholders of a Series, Class or Tranche issuable in whole or in part as Bearer Notes at any time for any purpose specified hereunder or under any Indenture Supplement. The Indenture Trustee will call a meeting upon request of the Issuer or the Holders of at least 10% in aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche issuable in whole or in part as Bearer Notes. In any case, a meeting will be called after notice is given to such Noteholders pursuant to Section 106.

 

- 70 -


(c) To be entitled to vote at any meeting of Noteholders of any Series, Class or Tranche, a Person shall be (1) a Holder of one or more Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, or (2) a Person appointed by an instrument in writing as proxy for the Noteholder or Noteholders of one or more Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche by the Noteholder or Noteholders. The only Person who shall be entitled to be present or to speak at any meeting of Noteholders of any Series, Class or Tranche shall be the Persons entitled to vote at such meeting and their counsel, any representatives of the Indenture Trustee and its counsel and any representatives of the Issuer and its counsel.

(d) Except for any consent that must be given by the Holders of each Outstanding Note affected or any action to be taken by the Issuer as holder of any Collateral Certificate, any resolution presented at any meeting at which a quorum is present may be adopted by the affirmative vote of the Majority Holders of that Series, Class or Tranche, as the case may be. However, any resolution with respect to any Action which may be given by the Holders of not less than a specified percentage in aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of Outstanding Notes of a Series, Class or Tranche of Bearer Notes may be adopted at any meeting at which a quorum is present only by the affirmative vote of the Holders of not less than the specified percentage in aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche. Any resolution passed or decision taken at any meeting of Noteholders duly held in accordance with this Indenture will be binding on all Noteholders of the affected Series, Class or Tranche.

(e) The quorum at any meeting will be persons holding or representing the Majority Holders of a Series, Class or Tranche or all Notes, as the case may be; provided, however, that if any action is to be taken at that meeting concerning an Action may be given by the Holders of not less than a specified percentage in aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of a Series, Class or Tranche, the persons holding or representing such specified percentage in aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche or all Notes will constitute a quorum.

(f) The ownership of Bearer Notes will be proved as provided in Subsection 104(c)(ii).

(g) The Issuer may make reasonable rules for other matters relating to Action by or a meeting of Noteholders not otherwise covered by this Section, including but not limited to the location or locations for such meeting, the manner of voting at such meeting, the appointment and duties of inspectors of the vote, the submission and examination of proxies, certificates and other evidence of the right to vote and the appointment of a chairperson for the meeting.

(h) As set forth in the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the related Series Supplement, with respect to certain actions requiring the consent or direction of Investor Certificateholders holding a specified percentage of the aggregate unpaid amount outstanding of Investor Certificates (whether by number of series or percentage of all outstanding Investor Certificates depending on the manner of voting or consenting on such matter), including consenting to certain amendments and terminating the related Master Trust,

 

- 71 -


the Issuer, as holder of any Collateral Certificate, will be deemed to have voted in accordance with the Investor Certificateholders holding a majority of the aggregate Invested Amount outstanding of such Investor Certificates which are entitled to vote or consent on such matter; provided, however, that in the event Investor Certificateholders holding equal portions of the Invested Amount of such Investor Certificates vote in the positive and in the negative, without taking into consideration the vote of the Issuer, as holder of such Collateral Certificate, the Issuer shall be deemed to vote in the negative; provided further, that if the Collateral Certificate is the sole Investor Certificate outstanding which is entitled to vote or consent on such matter, the Issuer, as holder thereof, will be deemed to have voted in the negative.

Section 805. Reports by Issuer to the Commission. The Issuer will:

(a) file with the Indenture Trustee, within fifteen (15) days after the Issuer is required to file the same with the Commission, copies of the annual reports and of the information, documents and other reports (or copies of such portions of any of the foregoing as the Commission may from time to time by rules and regulations prescribe) which the Issuer may be required to file with the Commission pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act; or, if the Issuer is not required to file information, documents or reports pursuant to either of said Sections, then it will file with the Indenture Trustee and the Commission, in accordance with rules and regulations prescribed from time to time by the Commission, such of the supplementary and periodic information, documents and reports which may be required pursuant to Section 13 of the Securities Exchange Act in respect of a security listed and registered on a national securities exchange as may be prescribed from time to time in such rules and regulations;

(b) file with the Indenture Trustee and the Commission, in accordance with rules and regulations prescribed from time to time by the Commission, such additional information, documents and reports with respect to compliance by the Issuer with the conditions and covenants of this Indenture as may be required from time to time by such rules and regulations; and

(c) transmit by mail to all Registered Noteholders, as their names and addresses appear in the Note Register, and notify all Holders of Bearer Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche, by publication of such notice in an Authorized Newspaper or as otherwise provided in the applicable Indenture Supplement, within thirty (30) days after the filing thereof with the Indenture Trustee, such summaries of any information, documents and reports required to be filed by the Issuer pursuant to paragraphs (a) and (b) of this Section as may be required by rules and regulations prescribed from time to time by the Commission.

[END OF ARTICLE VIII]

 

- 72 -


ARTICLE IX

INDENTURE SUPPLEMENTS; AMENDMENTS TO THE POOLING AND

SERVICING AGREEMENT; AMENDMENTS TO THE ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEW AGREEMENT AND AMENDMENTS TO THE TRUST AGREEMENT

Section 901. Supplemental Indentures and Amendments Without Consent of Noteholders. Without the consent of the Holders of any Notes but with prior notice to each Note Rating Agency, the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, at any time and from time to time, upon delivery of a Master Trust Tax Opinion for each applicable Master Trust and an Issuer Tax Opinion and upon delivery by the Issuer to the Indenture Trustee of an Officer’s Certificate to the effect that the Issuer reasonably believes that such amendment will not have an Adverse Effect and is not reasonably expected to have an Adverse Effect at any time in the future, the Issuer may amend this Indenture, including any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement, or enter into one or more Asset Pool Supplements or Indenture Supplements, in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee, for any of the following purposes:

(a) to evidence the succession of another Entity to the Issuer, and the assumption by any such successor of the covenants of the Issuer herein and in the Notes; or

(b) to add to the covenants of the Issuer, or to surrender any right or power herein conferred upon the Issuer by the Issuer, for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes of any or all Series, Classes or Tranches (and if such covenants or the surrender of such right or power are to be for the benefit of less than all Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes, stating that such covenants are expressly being included or such surrenders are expressly being made solely for the benefit of one or more specified Series, Classes or Tranches); or

(c) to cure any ambiguity, to correct or supplement any provision herein which may be inconsistent with any other provision herein, or to make any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under this Indenture; or

(d) to add to this Indenture such provisions as may be expressly permitted by the Trust Indenture Act, excluding, however, the provisions referred to in Section 316(a)(2) of the Trust Indenture Act as in effect at the date as of which this Indenture was executed or any corresponding provision in any similar federal statute hereafter enacted; or

(e) to establish any form of Note, as provided in Article II, and to provide for the issuance of any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes as provided in Article III and to set forth the terms thereof, and/or to add to the rights of the Holders of the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche; or

(f) to evidence and provide for the acceptance of appointment by another corporation as a successor Indenture Trustee hereunder with respect to one or more Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes and to add to or change any of the provisions of this Indenture as will be necessary to provide for or facilitate the administration of the trusts hereunder by more than one Indenture Trustee, pursuant to Section 711; or

 

- 73 -


(g) to add any additional Early Redemption Events or Events of Default in respect of the Notes of any or all Series, Classes or Tranches (and if such additional Events of Default are to be in respect of less than all Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes, stating that such Events of Default are expressly being included solely for the benefit of one or more specified Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes); or

(h) to provide for the consolidation of any Master Trust and the Issuer into a single Entity or the transfer of assets in such Master Trust to the Issuer after the termination of all Series of Investor Certificates (other than the related Collateral Certificate or Collateral Certificates); or

(i) if one or more additional Transferors under any Transfer and Administration Agreement or any Pooling and Servicing Agreement are added to, or replaced under, any such Transfer and Administration Agreement or any such Pooling and Servicing Agreement, or one or more additional Beneficiaries under the Trust Agreement are added to, or replaced under, the Trust Agreement, to make any necessary changes to the Indenture or any other related document; or

(j) to establish an Asset Pool and to set forth the terms thereof, including the designation of Collateral thereto, and/or to add to the rights of the Holders of Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche secured by an Asset Pool; or

(k) to provide for additional or alternative forms of credit enhancement for any Tranche of Notes; or

(l) to comply with any regulatory, accounting or tax laws; or

(m) to qualify for sale treatment under generally accepted accounting principles.

Additionally, notwithstanding any provision of this Article IX to the contrary, and in addition to (a) through (m) above, this Indenture, including any Indenture Supplement or any Asset Pool Supplement, may also be amended without the consent of the Indenture Trustee or any of the Noteholders, upon delivery of a Master Trust Tax Opinion for each applicable Master Trust and an Issuer Tax Opinion for the purpose of (i) adding any provisions to, or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of, this Indenture, any Indenture Supplement or any Asset Pool Supplement, (ii) modifying in any manner the rights of the Holders of the Notes under this Indenture, any Indenture Supplement or any Asset Pool Supplement or (iii) adding additional Collateral (including, but not limited to, adding additional Collateral Certificates) to an existing Asset Pool; provided, however, that (i) the Issuer shall deliver to the Indenture Trustee and the Owner Trustee an Officer’s Certificate to the effect that the Issuer reasonably believes that such amendment will not have an Adverse Effect and is not reasonably expected to have an Adverse Effect at any time in the future and (ii) each Note Rating Agency confirms in writing that such amendment will not cause a Ratings Effect.

 

- 74 -


The Indenture Trustee may, but shall not be obligated to, enter into any amendments which adversely affects the Indenture Trustee’s rights, duties, benefits, protections, privileges or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise.

Section 902. Supplemental Indentures with Consent of Noteholders. In addition to any amendment permitted pursuant to Section 901 hereof, with prior notice to each applicable Note Rating Agency and the consent of Holders of more than 66 23% in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes affected by such amendment of this Indenture, including any Asset Pool Supplement and any Indenture Supplement, by Act of said Holders delivered to the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, the Issuer, and the Indenture Trustee, as applicable, upon delivery of a Master Trust Tax Opinion for each applicable Master Trust and an Issuer Tax Opinion, may enter into an amendment of this Indenture for the purpose of adding any provisions to, or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of, this Indenture or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Holders of the Notes of each such Series, Class or Tranche under this Indenture or any Indenture Supplement; provided, however, that no such amendment of an Indenture Supplement will, without the consent of the Holder of each Outstanding Note affected thereby:

(a) change the scheduled payment date of any payment of interest on any Note, or change an Expected Principal Payment Date or Legal Maturity Date of any Note;

(b) reduce the Stated Principal Amount of, or the interest rate on any Note, or change the method of computing the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount, the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount or the Nominal Liquidation Amount in a manner that is adverse to the Holder of any Note;

(c) reduce the amount of a Discount Note payable upon the occurrence of an Early Redemption Event or other optional or mandatory redemption or upon the acceleration of its Legal Maturity Date;

(d) impair the right to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on any Note;

(e) reduce the percentage in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the consent of whose Holders is required for any such amendment, or the consent of whose Holders is required for any waiver of compliance with the provisions of this Indenture or of defaults hereunder and their consequences, provided for in this Indenture;

(f) modify any of the provisions of this Section or Section 618, except to increase any percentage of Holders required to consent to any such amendment or to provide that other provisions of this Indenture cannot be modified or waived without the consent of the Holder of each Outstanding Note affected thereby;

 

- 75 -


(g) permit the creation of any lien or other encumbrance on the Collateral of any Asset Pool that secures any Tranche of Notes that is prior to the lien in favor of the Indenture Trustee for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes of such Tranche;

(h) change any Place of Payment where any principal of, or interest on, any Note is payable, unless otherwise provided in the applicable Indenture Supplement;

(i) change the method of computing the amount of principal of, or interest on, any Note on any date; or

(j) make any other amendment not permitted by Section 901.

An amendment of this Indenture or an Indenture Supplement which changes or eliminates any covenant or other provision of this Indenture which has expressly been included solely for the benefit of one or more particular Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, or which modifies the rights of the Holders of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche with respect to such covenant or other provision, will be deemed not to affect the rights under this Indenture of the Holders of Notes of any other Series, Class or Tranche.

It will not be necessary for any Act of Noteholders under this Section to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment or Indenture Supplement, but it will be sufficient if such Act will approve the substance thereof.

Section 903. Execution of Amendments and Supplemental Indentures. In executing or accepting the additional trusts created by any amendment of this Indenture or Indenture Supplement permitted by this Article IX or the modifications thereby of the trusts created by this Indenture, the Indenture Trustee will be entitled to receive, and (subject to Section 701 or the applicable provisions of the related Asset Pool Supplement) will be fully protected in relying upon, an Opinion of Counsel stating that the execution of such amendment or Indenture Supplement is authorized or permitted by this Indenture and that all conditions precedent thereto have been satisfied. The Indenture Trustee may, but will not (except to the extent required in the case of an amendment or Indenture Supplement entered into under Subsections 901(d) or 901(f)) be obligated to, enter into any such amendment or Indenture Supplement which affects the Indenture Trustee’s own rights, duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise.

Section 904. Effect of Amendments and Supplemental Indentures. Upon the execution of any amendment of this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement, or any supplemental indentures under this Article IX, this Indenture and the related Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement will be modified in accordance therewith with respect to each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes affected thereby, or all Notes, as the case may be, and such amendment or supplemental indenture will form a part of this Indenture and the related Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement for all purposes; and every Holder of Notes theretofore or thereafter authenticated and delivered hereunder will be bound thereby to the extent provided therein.

 

- 76 -


Section 905. Conformity with Trust Indenture Act. Every amendment of this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement and every supplemental indenture executed pursuant to this Article IX will conform to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act as then in effect.

Section 906. Reference in Notes to Supplemental Indentures. Notes authenticated and delivered after the execution of any amendment of this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement or any supplemental indenture pursuant to this Article may, and will if required by the Indenture Trustee, bear a notation in form approved by the Indenture Trustee as to any matter provided for in such amendment or supplemental indenture. If the Issuer will so determine, new Notes so modified as to conform, in the opinion of the Indenture Trustee and the Issuer, to any such amendment or supplemental indenture may be prepared and executed by the Issuer and authenticated and delivered by the Indenture Trustee in exchange for Outstanding Notes.

Section 907. Amendments to the Trust Agreement.

(a) Subject to the provisions of the Trust Agreement, without the consent of the Holders of any Notes or the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee (at the written direction of the Beneficiary) and the Beneficiary may amend the Trust Agreement so long as such amendment will not have an Adverse Effect and is not reasonably expected to have an Adverse Effect at any time in the future.

(b) Subject to the provisions of the Trust Agreement, (A) in the case of a significant change in the permitted activities of the Issuer which is not materially adverse to the Holders of the Notes, with the consent of the Majority Holders of each Class or Tranche of Notes affected by such change, and (B) in all other cases, with the consent of the Holders of more than 66 23% in Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the Outstanding Notes affected by such amendment, by Action of said Holders delivered to the Indenture Trustee, the Beneficiary and the Owner Trustee (at the written direction of the Beneficiary) may amend the Trust Agreement for the purpose of adding, changing or eliminating any provisions of the Trust Agreement or of modifying the rights of those Noteholders.

Section 908. Amendments to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Amendments to the Asset Representations Review Agreement; Treatment of Noteholders and Note Owners.

(a) By their acceptance of a Note, the Noteholders acknowledge that the Transferor, the Servicer and the Master Trust Trustee may amend the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any supplement thereto without the consent of the Holders of any Investor Certificates (including the Issuer) or any Noteholder, so long as such amendment or supplement would not materially adversely affect the interest of the Holders of any Investor Certificates.

 

- 77 -


For purposes of any vote or consent under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or any supplement thereto:

(i) that requires the consent or vote of Investor Certificateholders, each Noteholder will be treated as an Investor Certificateholder under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any related supplement thereto;

(ii) that requires the consent or vote of any series of Investor Certificates, each series of Notes will be treated as a series of Investor Certificates under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any related supplement thereto; and

(iii) that requires the consent or vote of any class of Investor Certificates;

each tranche of Notes will be treated as a class of Investor Certificates under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and any related supplement thereto.

(b) For purposes of subsection 3.10(b) of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, each Note Owner will be treated as a Certificate Owner (as defined in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement).

(c) By their acceptance of a Note, the Noteholders acknowledge that the Transferor, the Servicer, Capital One and the Asset Representations Reviewer may amend the Asset Representations Review Agreement, including the content of any Exhibit to the Asset Representations Review Agreement, (i) without the consent of the Holders of any Investor Certificates (including the Issuer) or any Noteholder; provided, that if such amendment takes effect after the issuance of any tranche of Notes that is registered with the Commission on Form SF-3, such amendment shall not, in the reasonable belief of the Transferor, adversely affect in any material respect the interests of the Holder of any Investor Certificates whose consent has not been obtained (as evidenced by an officer’s certificate of the Transferor delivered to Capital One, the Servicer, and the Master Trust Trustee) and (ii) with the consent of the Holders of Investor Certificates holding more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Investor Certificates, for the purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of the Asset Representations Review Agreement or of modifying in any manner the rights or interests of the Holders of the Investor Certificates.

For purposes of any vote or consent under the Asset Representations Review Agreement that requires the consent or vote of Investor Certificateholders, each Noteholder will be treated as an Investor Certificateholder under the Asset Representations Review Agreement.

Section 909. Notice.

If the Issuer, as holder of the Collateral Certificate for the benefit of the Noteholders, receives a request for a consent to any amendment, modification, waiver or supplement under this Indenture, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Asset Representations Review Agreement, the Trust Agreement or other document contemplated herein, the Issuer, acting with the assistance of the Note Registrar, will forthwith provide notice of such proposed amendment, modification, waiver or supplement, as provided in Section 106, to (i) each Noteholder that is

 

- 78 -


entitled to vote on such matter as of the date the Issuer receives the request specified above and (ii) each Note Rating Agency. The Issuer, acting with the assistance of the Note Registrar, will request from such Noteholders directions as to (i) whether or not the Issuer should take or refrain from taking any action which the holder of the Collateral Certificate has the option to direct, (ii) whether or not to give or execute any waivers, consents, amendments, modifications or supplements as a holder of such Collateral Certificate and (iii) the casting of any vote with respect to the Collateral Certificate or the Noteholders of a series or tranche if a vote has been called for with respect thereto; provided, that, in directing any action or casting any vote or giving any consent as the holder of the Collateral Certificate, the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer will only vote or consent with respect to such Collateral Certificate or the applicable series, class or tranche, as the case may be, in the same proportion as the Notes were actually voted by Holders thereof as notified by such Noteholders to the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer at least two (2) Business Days before the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer takes such action or casts such vote or gives such consent.

[END OF ARTICLE IX]

 

- 79 -


ARTICLE X

REPRESENTATIONS, WARRANTIES AND COVENANTS OF ISSUER

Section 1001. Payment of Principal and Interest. With respect to each Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the Issuer will duly and punctually pay the principal of and interest on such Notes in accordance with their terms and this Indenture, and will duly comply with all the other terms, agreements and conditions contained in, or made in this Indenture for the benefit of, the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 1002. Maintenance of Office or Agency. The Issuer will maintain an office or agency in each Place of Payment where Notes may be presented or surrendered for payment, where Notes may be surrendered for transfer or exchange and where notices and demands to or upon the Issuer in respect of the Notes and this Indenture may be served. The Issuer will give prompt written notice to the Indenture Trustee of the location, and of any change in the location, of such office or agency. If at any time the Issuer will fail to maintain such office or agency or will fail to furnish the Indenture Trustee with the address thereof, such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands may be made or served at the Corporate Trust Office of the Indenture Trustee, and the Issuer hereby appoints the Indenture Trustee its agent to receive all such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands.

The Issuer may also from time to time designate one or more other offices or agencies where the Notes of one or more Series, Classes or Tranches may be presented or surrendered for any or all of such purposes specified above and may constitute and appoint one or more Paying Agents for the payments of such Notes, in one or more other cities, and may from time to time rescind such designations and appointments; provided, however, that no such designation, appointment or rescission shall in any matter relieve the Issuer of its obligations to maintain an office or agency in each Place of Payment for Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche for such purposes. The Issuer will give prompt written notice to the Indenture Trustee of any such designation or rescission and of any change in the location of any such other office or agency. Unless and until the Issuer rescinds one or more of such appointments, the Issuer hereby appoints the Indenture Trustee, at its principal office, as its Paying Agent in New York, New York with respect to all Series, Classes and Tranches of Notes having a Place of Payment in the City of New York, New York.

Section 1003. Money for Note Payments to be Held in Trust. The Paying Agent, on behalf of the Indenture Trustee, will make distributions to Noteholders from the Collection Account of the applicable Asset Pool or other applicable Issuer Account pursuant to the provisions of any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement and will report the amounts of such distributions to the Indenture Trustee. Any Paying Agent will have the revocable power to withdraw funds from the Collection Account of the applicable Asset Pool or other applicable Issuer Account for the purpose of making the distributions referred to above. The Indenture Trustee may revoke such power and remove the Paying Agent if the Indenture Trustee determines in its sole discretion that the Paying Agent has failed to perform its

 

- 80 -


obligations under this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement or any Indenture Supplement in any material respect. The Paying Agent upon removal will return all funds in its possession to the Indenture Trustee.

The Issuer will cause each Paying Agent (other than the Indenture Trustee) for any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes to execute and deliver to the Indenture Trustee an instrument in which such Paying Agent will agree with the Indenture Trustee (and if the Indenture Trustee acts as Paying Agent, it so agrees), subject to the provisions of this Section, that such Paying Agent will:

(a) hold all sums held by it for the payment of principal of or interest on Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche in trust for the benefit of the Persons entitled thereto until such sums will be paid to such Persons or otherwise disposed of as herein provided;

(b) if such Paying Agent is not the Indenture Trustee, give the Indenture Trustee notice of any default by the Issuer (or any other obligor upon the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche) in the making of any such payment of principal or interest on the Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche;

(c) if such Paying Agent is not the Indenture Trustee, at any time during the continuance of any such default, upon the written request of the Indenture Trustee, forthwith pay to the Indenture Trustee all sums so held in trust by such Paying Agent;

(d) immediately resign as a Paying Agent and, if such Paying Agent is not the Indenture Trustee, forthwith pay to the Indenture Trustee all sums held by it in trust for the payment of Notes if at any time it ceases to meet the standards described in this Section required to be met by a Paying Agent at the time of its appointment; and

(e) comply with all requirements of the Internal Revenue Code or any other applicable tax law with respect to the withholding from any payments made by it on any Notes of any applicable withholding taxes imposed thereon and with respect to any applicable reporting requirements in connection therewith.

The Issuer may at any time, for the purpose of obtaining the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes or for any other purpose, pay, or by an Officer’s Certificate direct any Paying Agent to pay, to the Indenture Trustee all sums held in trust by the Issuer or such Paying Agent in respect of each and every Series, Class or Tranche of Notes as to which it seeks to discharge this Indenture or, if for any other purpose, all sums so held in trust by the Issuer in respect of all Notes, such sums to be held by the Indenture Trustee upon the same trusts as those upon which such sums were held by the Issuer or such Paying Agent; and, upon such payment by any Paying Agent to the Indenture Trustee, such Paying Agent will be released from all further liability with respect to such money.

Any money deposited with the Indenture Trustee or any Paying Agent, or then held by the Issuer, in trust for the payment of the principal of or interest on any Note of any Series, Class or Tranche and remaining unclaimed for two years after such principal or interest

 

- 81 -


has become due and payable will be paid to the Issuer upon request in an Officer’s Certificate, or (if then held by the Issuer) will be discharged from such trust; and the Holder of such Note will thereafter, as an unsecured general creditor, look only to the Issuer for payment thereof, and all liability of the Indenture Trustee or such Paying Agent with respect to such trust money, and all liability of the Issuer as trustee thereof, will thereupon cease. The Indenture Trustee or such Paying Agent, before being required to make any such repayment, may at the expense of the Issuer give to the Holders of the Notes as to which the money to be repaid was held in trust, as provided in Section 106, a notice that such funds remain unclaimed and that, after a date specified in the notice, which will not be less than thirty (30) days from the date on which the notice was first mailed or published to the Holders of the Notes as to which the money to be repaid was held in trust, any unclaimed balance of such funds then remaining will be paid to the Issuer free of the trust formerly impressed upon it.

Each Paying Agent will at all times have a combined capital and surplus of at least $50,000,000 and be subject to supervision or examination by a United States Federal or State authority or be regulated by or subject to the supervision or examination of a governmental authority of a nation that is a member of the Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development. If such Paying Agent publishes reports of condition at least annually, pursuant to law or to the requirements of the aforesaid supervising or examining authority, then for the purposes of this Section, the combined capital and surplus of such Paying Agent will be deemed to be its combined capital and surplus as set forth in its most recent report of condition as so published.

Section 1004. Statement as to Compliance. The Issuer will deliver to the Indenture Trustee and the Note Rating Agencies, on or before May 31 of each year, beginning in 2003, a written statement signed by an Issuer Authorized Officer stating that:

(a) a review of the activities of the Issuer during the prior year and of the Issuer’s performance under this Indenture and under the terms of the Notes has been made under such Issuer Authorized Officer’s supervision; and

(b) to the best of such Issuer Authorized Officer’s knowledge, based on such review, the Issuer has complied in all material respects with all conditions and covenants under this Indenture throughout such year, or, if there has been a default in the fulfillment of any such condition or covenant (without regard to any grace period or requirement of notice), specifying each such default known to such Issuer Authorized Officer and the nature and status thereof.

Section 1005. Legal Existence. The Issuer will do or cause to be done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect its legal existence.

Section 1006. Further Instruments and Acts. Upon request of the Indenture Trustee, the Issuer will execute and deliver such further instruments and do such further acts as may be reasonably necessary or proper to carry out more effectively the purpose of this Indenture.

 

- 82 -


Section 1007. Compliance with Laws. The Issuer will comply with the requirements of all applicable laws, the noncompliance with which would, individually or in the aggregate, materially and adversely affect the ability of the Issuer to perform its obligations under the Notes or this Indenture.

Section 1008. Notice of Events of Default. The Issuer agrees to give the Indenture Trustee and the Note Rating Agencies prompt written notice of each Event of Default hereunder and each breach on the part of the Master Trust or the Transferor of their respective obligations under the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the applicable Transfer and Administration Agreement, respectively, and any default of a Derivative Counterparty.

Section 1009. Certain Negative Covenants. The Issuer will not:

(a) claim any credit on, or make any deduction from the principal or interest payable in respect of, the Notes (other than amounts withheld in good faith from such payments under the Internal Revenue Code or other applicable tax law including foreign withholding);

(b) permit the validity or effectiveness of this Indenture to be impaired, or permit the lien in favor of the Indenture Trustee created by this Indenture and the applicable Asset Pool Supplement to be amended, hypothecated, subordinated, terminated or discharged, or permit any Person to be released from any covenants or obligations with respect to the Notes under this Indenture except as may be expressly permitted hereby;

(c) permit any lien, charge, excise, claim, security interest, mortgage or other encumbrance (other than the lien in favor of the Indenture Trustee created by this Indenture) to be created on or extend to or otherwise arise upon or burden the Collateral designated for inclusion in an Asset Pool or any part thereof or any interest therein or the proceeds thereof;

(d) permit the lien in favor of the Indenture Trustee created by this Indenture and the applicable Asset Pool Supplement not to constitute a valid first priority security interest in the Collateral designated for inclusion in an Asset Pool; or

(e) voluntarily dissolve or liquidate.

Section 1010. No Other Business. The Issuer will not engage in any business other than as permitted under the Trust Agreement.

Section 1011. Rule 144A Information. For so long as any of the Notes of any Series, Class or Tranche are “restricted securities” within the meaning of Rule 144(a)(3) under the Securities Exchange Act, the Issuer agrees to provide to any Noteholder of such Series, Class or Tranche and to any prospective purchaser of Notes designated by such Noteholder, upon the request of such Noteholder or prospective purchaser, any information required to be provided to such Holder or prospective purchaser to satisfy the conditions set forth in Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Exchange Act.

 

- 83 -


Section 1012. Performance of Obligations.

(a) The Issuer will not take any action and will use its best efforts not to permit any action to be taken by others that would release any Person from any of such Person’s material covenants or obligations under any instrument or agreement included in the Collateral or that would result in the amendment, hypothecation, subordination, termination or discharge of, or impair the validity or effectiveness of, any such instrument or agreement, except as expressly provided in this Indenture, the Trust Agreement, the applicable Transfer and Administration Agreement, the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement or such other instrument or agreement.

(b) The Issuer will punctually perform and observe all of its obligations and agreements contained in this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement, any Indenture Supplement, the Trust Agreement and in the instruments and agreements (including but not limited to, the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement) relating to the Collateral designated for inclusion in each Asset Pool, including but not limited to filing or causing to be filed all UCC financing statements and amendments thereto required to be filed by the terms of this Indenture and the Trust Agreement in accordance with and within the time periods provided for herein and therein. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein or therein, the Issuer shall not waive, amend, modify, supplement or terminate this Indenture, any Asset Pool Supplement, any Indenture Supplement or the Trust Agreement or any provision thereof without the consent of the Majority Holders of the Notes of each adversely affected Series, Class or Tranche.

Section 1013. Issuer May Consolidate, Etc., Only on Certain Terms.

(a) The Issuer shall not consolidate or merge with or into any other Person, unless:

(1) the Person (if other than the Issuer) formed by or surviving such consolidation or merger (i) shall be a Person organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, any state thereof or the District of Columbia, (ii) shall not be subject to regulation as an “investment company” under the Investment Company Act and (iii) shall expressly assume, by a supplemental indenture, executed and delivered to the Indenture Trustee, in a form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee, the due and punctual payment of the principal of and interest on all Notes and the performance of every covenant of this Indenture on the part of the Issuer to be performed or observed;

(2) immediately after giving effect to such transaction, no Event of Default or Early Redemption Event shall have occurred and be continuing;

(3) the Issuer shall have delivered to the Indenture Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel each stating that (i) such consolidation or merger and such supplemental indenture comply with this Section 1013, (ii) all conditions precedent in this Section 1013 relating to such transaction have been complied with (including any filing required by the Securities Exchange Act), and (iii) such Indenture Supplement is duly authorized, executed and delivered and is valid, binding and enforceable against such Person;

 

- 84 -


(4) the Issuer shall have received written confirmation from each Note Rating Agency that there will be no Ratings Effect with respect to any Outstanding Notes as a result of such consolidation or merger;

(5) the Issuer shall have received an Issuer Tax Opinion and a Master Trust Tax Opinion for each applicable Master Trust;

(6) any action that is necessary to maintain the lien and security interest created by this Indenture shall have been taken; and

(7) such action shall not be contrary to the status of the Issuer as a qualified special purpose entity under existing accounting literature.

(b) The Issuer shall not convey or transfer any of its properties or assets, including those included in the Collateral, substantially as an entirety to any Person, unless:

(1) the Person that acquires by conveyance or transfer the properties and assets of the Issuer the conveyance or transfer of which is hereby restricted shall (A) be a United States citizen or a Person organized and existing under the laws of the United States of America, any state thereof, or the District of Columbia, (B) expressly assume, by a supplemental indenture, executed and delivered to the Indenture Trustee, in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee, the due and punctual payment of the principal of and interest on all Notes and the performance or observance of every agreement and covenant of this Indenture on the part of the Issuer to be performed or observed, all as provided herein, (C) expressly agree by means of such supplemental indenture that all right, title and interest so conveyed or transferred shall be subject and subordinate to the lien and security interest of the Indenture Trustee created by this Indenture, (D) expressly agree by means of such supplemental indenture that such Person (or if a group of Persons, then one specified Person) shall make all filings with the Commission (and any other appropriate Person) required by the Securities Exchange Act in connection with the Notes and (F) not be an “investment company” as defined in the Investment Company Act;

(2) immediately after giving effect to such transaction, no Event of Default or Early Redemption Event shall have occurred and be continuing;

(3) the Issuer shall have received written confirmation from each Note Rating Agency that there will be no Ratings Effect with respect to any Outstanding Notes as a result of such conveyance or transfer;

(4) the Issuer shall have received an Issuer Tax Opinion and a Master Trust Tax Opinion for each applicable Master Trust;

 

- 85 -


(5) any action that is necessary to maintain the lien and security interest created by this Indenture shall have been taken; and

(6) the Issuer shall have delivered to the Indenture Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel each stating that such conveyance or transfer and such Indenture Supplement comply with this Section 1013 and that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been complied with (including any filing required by the Securities Exchange Act).

Section 1014. Successor Substituted. Upon any consolidation or merger, or any conveyance or transfer of the properties and assets of the Issuer substantially as an entirety in accordance with Section 1013 hereof, the Person formed by or surviving such consolidation or merger (if other than the Issuer) or the Person to which such conveyance or transfer is made shall succeed to, and be substituted for, and may exercise every right and power of, the Issuer under this Indenture with the same effect as if such Person had been named as the Issuer herein. In the event of any such conveyance or transfer, the Person named as the Issuer in the first paragraph of this Indenture or any successor which shall theretofore have become such in the manner prescribed in this Section 1014 shall be released from its obligations under this Indenture as issued immediately upon the effectiveness of such conveyance or transfer, provided that the Issuer shall not be released from any obligations or liabilities to the Indenture Trustee or the Noteholders arising prior to such effectiveness.

Section 1015. Guarantees, Loans, Advances and Other Liabilities. Except as contemplated by this Indenture or the Trust Agreement, the Issuer shall not make any loan or advance or credit to, or guarantee (directly or indirectly or by an instrument having the effect of assuring another’s payment or performance on any obligation or capability of so doing or otherwise), endorse or otherwise become contingently liable, directly or indirectly, in connection with the obligations, stocks or dividends of, or own, purchase, repurchase or acquire (or agree contingently to do so) any stock, obligations, assets or securities of, or any other interest in, or make any capital contribution to, any other Person.

Section 1016. Capital Expenditures. The Issuer shall not make any expenditure (by long-term or operating lease or otherwise) for capital assets (either realty or personalty).

Section 1017. Restricted Payments. The Issuer shall not, directly or indirectly, (i) pay any dividend or make any distribution (by reduction of capital or otherwise), whether in cash, property, securities or a combination thereof, to the Owner Trustee or any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or otherwise with respect to any ownership or equity interest or security in or of the Issuer, (ii) redeem, purchase, retire or otherwise acquire for value any such ownership or equity interest or security or (iii) set aside or otherwise segregate any amounts for any such purpose; provided, however, that the Issuer may make, or cause to be made, (x) distributions as contemplated by, and to the extent funds are available for such purpose under, the Trust Agreement and (y) payments to the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 707 hereof. The Issuer will not, directly or indirectly, make payments to or distributions from any Collection Account except in accordance with this Indenture or any Indenture Supplement.

 

- 86 -


Section 1018. No Borrowing. The Issuer will not issue, incur, assume, guarantee or otherwise become liable, directly or indirectly, for any additional indebtedness, except for the Notes.

[END OF ARTICLE X]

 

- 87 -


ARTICLE XI

EARLY REDEMPTION OF NOTES

Section 1101. Applicability of Article. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement related to a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, pursuant to the terms of this Article XI, the Issuer will redeem and pay, provided that funds are available, each affected Series, Class or Tranche of Notes upon the occurrence of any Early Redemption Event. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable Indenture Supplement relating to a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, or in the form of Notes for such Series, Class or Tranche, the following are “Early Redemption Events”:

(a) the occurrence of an Event of Default and acceleration of the Notes of a Series, Class or Tranche pursuant to Article VI hereof;

(b) with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the occurrence of the Expected Principal Payment Date of such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes;

(c) the Issuer becoming an investment company within the meaning of the Investment Company Act;

(d) with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, (i) the related Transferor shall file a petition or commence a proceeding (A) to take advantage of any bankruptcy, conservatorship, receivership, insolvency, or similar laws or (B) for the appointment of a trustee, conservator, receiver, liquidator, or similar official for or relating to such Transferor or all or substantially all of its property, (ii) the related Transferor shall consent or fail to object to any such petition filed or proceeding commenced against or with respect to it or all or substantially all of its property, or any such petition or proceeding shall not have been dismissed or stayed within sixty (60) days of its filing or commencement, or a court, agency, or other supervisory authority with jurisdiction shall have decreed or ordered relief with respect to any such petition or proceeding, (C) the related Transferor shall admit in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as they become due, (D) the related Transferor shall make an assignment for the benefit of its creditors, or (E) the related Transferor shall voluntarily suspend payment of its obligations; or

(e) with respect to any Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, any additional Early Redemption Event specified in the Indenture Supplement for such Series, Class or Tranche as applying to such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes.

The repayment price of a Tranche of Notes so redeemed will equal the Outstanding principal amount of such Tranche, plus accrued, past due and additional interest to but excluding the date of repayment, the payment of which will be subject to the allocations, deposits and payments sections of the related Asset Pool Supplement and Indenture Supplement.

 

- 88 -


If the Issuer is unable to pay the repayment price in full on the Principal Payment Date following the end of the Monthly Period in which the Early Redemption Event occurs, monthly payments on such Tranche of Notes will thereafter be made on each following Principal Payment Date until the Outstanding principal amount of such Series, Class or Tranche, plus all accrued, past due and additional interest, is paid in full or the Legal Maturity Date occurs, whichever is earlier, subject to the allocations, deposits and payments sections of the related Asset Pool Supplement and Indenture Supplement. Any funds in any Supplemental Issuer Accounts for a repaid Tranche will be applied to make the principal and interest payments on that Tranche on the repayment date, subject to the allocations, deposits and payments sections of the related Asset Pool Supplement and Indenture Supplement. Principal payments on redeemed Tranches will be made first to the senior most Notes until paid in full, then to the next subordinated Notes until paid in full.

Section 1102. Optional Repurchase. Unless otherwise provided in the applicable Indenture Supplement for a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, the Servicer (as defined in the applicable Indenture Supplement) or any Affiliate thereof has the right, but not the obligation, to redeem a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes in whole but not in part on any day on or after the day on which the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to all payments, if any, on that day) of such Series, Class or Tranche is reduced to less than 5% of the highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount (or such other percentage as shall be specified from time to time by such Servicer or any Affiliate thereof, consistent with sale treatment under GAAP and regulatory accounting principles); provided, however, that if such Class or Tranche of Notes redeemed is of a Subordinated Class or Tranche of Notes, such Servicer or any Affiliate thereof will not redeem such Notes if the provisions of the related Indenture Supplement would prevent the payment of such Subordinated Notes until a level of prefunding of the applicable Issuer Accounts for the Senior Classes of Notes for that Series has been reached such that the amount of such deficiency in the required subordination of a Senior Class of Notes is no longer required to provide subordination protection for the Senior Classes of that Series.

If such Servicer or any Affiliate thereof elects to redeem a Series, Class or Tranche of Notes, it will cause the Issuer to notify the Holders of such redemption at least thirty (30) days prior to the redemption date. Unless otherwise specified in the Indenture Supplement or Terms Document applicable to the Notes to be so redeemed, the redemption price of a Series, Class or Tranche so redeemed will equal 100% of the Outstanding principal amount of such Tranche, plus accrued, unpaid and additional interest or principal accreted and unpaid on such Tranche to but excluding the date of redemption, the payment of which will be subject to the allocations, deposits and payments sections of the related Asset Pool Supplement and Indenture Supplement.

If the Issuer is unable to pay the redemption price in full on the redemption date, monthly payments on such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes will thereafter be made until the Outstanding principal amount of such Series, Class or Tranche, plus all accrued and unpaid interest, is paid in full or the Legal Maturity Date occurs, whichever is earlier, subject to Article V, Article VI and the allocations, deposits and payments sections of the related Indenture Supplement. Any funds in any Supplemental Issuer Accounts for a redeemed Tranche will be applied to make the principal and interest payments on that Tranche on the redemption date in accordance with the related Indenture Supplement. Principal payments on redeemed Tranches will be made in accordance with the related Indenture Supplement.

 

- 89 -


Section 1103. Notice. Promptly after the occurrence of any Early Redemption Event or a redemption pursuant to Section 1102, the Issuer will notify the Indenture Trustee and the Note Rating Agencies in writing of the identity, Stated Principal Amount and Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the affected Series, Class or Tranche of Notes to be redeemed. Notice of redemption will promptly be given as provided in Section 106. All notices of redemption will state (a) the date on which the redemption of the applicable Series, Class or Tranche of Notes pursuant to this Article will begin, which will be the Principal Payment Date next following the end of the Monthly Period in which the applicable Early Redemption Event or redemption pursuant to Section 1102 occurs, (b) the repayment price for such Series, Class or Tranche of Notes and (c) the Series, Class or Tranche of Notes to be redeemed pursuant to this Article XI.

[END OF ARTICLE XI]

 

- 90 -


ARTICLE XII

MISCELLANEOUS

Section 1201. No Petition. The Indenture Trustee, by entering into this Indenture, each Derivative Counterparty, by accepting its rights as a third party beneficiary hereunder, each Supplemental Credit Enhancement Provider or Supplemental Liquidity Provider, as applicable, by accepting its rights as a third party beneficiary hereunder, and each Noteholder, by accepting a Note, agrees that it will not at any time institute against any Transferor, any Master Trust or the Issuer, or join in any institution against any Transferor, any Master Trust or the Issuer of, any receivership, insolvency, bankruptcy or other similar proceedings, or other proceedings under any United States federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, this Indenture, any Derivative Agreement, any Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement and any Supplemental Liquidity Agreement.

Section 1202. Trust Obligations. No recourse may be taken, directly or indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer on the Notes or under this Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in connection herewith or therewith, against (i) the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director, employee or agent of the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or of any successor or assign of the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, except as any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the Owner Trustee has no such obligations in its individual capacity).

Section 1203. Limitations on Liability.

(a) It is expressly understood and agreed by the parties hereto that (i) this Indenture is executed and delivered by the Owner Trustee not individually or personally but solely as Owner Trustee, in the exercise of the powers and authority conferred and vested in it, (ii) each of the representations, undertakings and agreements herein made on the part of the Issuer is made and intended not as a personal representation, undertaking or agreement by the Owner Trustee but is made and intended for the purpose of binding only the Issuer, (iii) nothing herein contained will be construed as creating any liability on the Owner Trustee individually or personally, to perform any covenant of the Issuer either expressed or implied contained herein, all such liability, if any, being expressly waived by the parties to this Indenture and by any Person claiming by, through or under them and (iv) under no circumstances will the Owner Trustee be personally liable for the payment of any indebtedness or expenses of the Issuer or be liable for the breach or failure of any obligation, representation, warranty or covenant made or undertaken by the Issuer under this Indenture or any related documents.

(b) None of the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee, any Transferor, the Administrator, the Beneficiary or any other beneficiary of the Issuer or any of their respective officers, directors, employees or agents will have any liability with respect to this Indenture, and recourse of any Noteholder may be had solely to the Collateral designated for inclusion in the specific Asset Pool and pledged to secure the applicable Notes.

 

- 91 -


Section 1204. Tax Treatment. The Issuer and the Noteholders agree that the Notes are intended to be debt for federal, state and local income and franchise tax purposes and agree to treat the Notes accordingly for all such purposes, unless otherwise required by a taxing authority. Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent the Issuer is treated as a partnership for federal, state or local income or franchise purposes and a Noteholder is treated as a partner in such partnership, the Noteholders agree that any tax, penalty, interest or other obligation imposed under the Internal Revenue Code with respect to the income tax items arising from such partnership shall be the sole obligation of the Noteholder to whom such items are allocated and not of such deemed partnership.

Section 1205. Actions Taken by the Issuer. Any and all actions that are to be taken by the Issuer may be taken by either the Beneficiary or the Owner Trustee on behalf of the Issuer.

Section 1206. Alternate Payment Provisions. Notwithstanding any provision of this Indenture or any of the Notes to the contrary, the Issuer, with the written consent of the Indenture Trustee, may enter into any agreement with any Holder of a Note providing for a method of payment or notice that is different from the methods provided for in this Indenture for such payments or notices. The Issuer will furnish to the Indenture Trustee a copy of each such agreement and the Indenture Trustee will cause payments or notices, as applicable, to be made in accordance with such agreements.

Section 1207. Termination of Issuer. The Issuer and the respective obligations and responsibilities of the Indenture Trustee created hereby (other than the obligation of the Indenture Trustee to make payments to Noteholders as hereinafter set forth) shall terminate, except with respect to the duties described in Subsection 1208(b), as provided in the Trust Agreement.

Section 1208. Final Distribution.

(a) The Issuer shall give the Indenture Trustee at least thirty (30) days prior written notice of the Payment Date on which the Noteholders of any Series, Class or Tranche may surrender their Notes for payment of the final distribution on and cancellation of such Notes. Not later than the fifth day of the month in which the final distribution in respect of such Series or Class is payable to Noteholders, the Indenture Trustee shall provide notice to Noteholders of such Series, Class or Tranche specifying (i) the date upon which final payment of such Series, Class or Tranche will be made upon presentation and surrender of Notes of such Series, Class or Tranche at the office or offices therein designated, (ii) the amount of any such final payment and (iii) that the Record Date otherwise applicable to such payment date is not applicable, payments being made only upon presentation and surrender of such Notes at the office or offices therein specified (which, in the case of Bearer Notes, shall be outside the United States). The Indenture Trustee shall give such notice to the Note Registrar and the Paying Agent at the time such notice is given to Noteholders.

 

- 92 -


(b) Notwithstanding a final distribution to the Noteholders of any Series, Class or Tranche (or the termination of the Issuer), except as otherwise provided in this paragraph, all funds then on deposit in any Issuer Account allocated to such Noteholders shall continue to be held in trust for the benefit of such Noteholders, and the Paying Agent or the Indenture Trustee shall pay such funds to such Noteholders upon surrender of their Notes, if certificated. In the event that all such Noteholders shall not surrender their Notes for cancellation within six (6) months after the date specified in the notice from the Indenture Trustee described in paragraph (a), the Indenture Trustee shall give a second notice to the remaining such Noteholders to surrender their Notes for cancellation and receive the final distribution with respect thereto (which surrender and payment, in the case of Bearer Notes, shall be outside the United States). If within one year after the second notice all such Notes shall not have been surrendered for cancellation, the Indenture Trustee may take appropriate steps, or may appoint an agent to take appropriate steps, to contact the remaining such Noteholders concerning surrender of their Notes, and the cost thereof shall be paid out of the funds in the Collection Account or any Supplemental Issuer Accounts of the applicable Asset Pool held for the benefit of such Noteholders. The Indenture Trustee and the Paying Agent shall pay to the Issuer any monies held by them for the payment of principal or interest that remains unclaimed for two (2) years. After payment to the Issuer, Noteholders entitled to the money must look to the Issuer for payment as general creditors unless an applicable abandoned property law designates another Person.

Section 1209. Termination Distributions. Upon the termination of the Issuer pursuant to the terms of the Trust Agreement, the Indenture Trustee shall release, assign and convey to the Beneficiary or any of its designees, without recourse, representation or warranty, all of its right, title and interest in the Collateral designated for inclusion in an Asset Pool, whether then existing or thereafter created, all monies due or to become due and all amounts received or receivable with respect thereto (including all moneys then held in any Issuer Account) and all proceeds thereof, except for amounts held by the Indenture Trustee pursuant to Section 1208(b). The Indenture Trustee shall execute and deliver such instruments of transfer and assignment as shall be provided to it, in each case without recourse, as shall be reasonably requested by the Beneficiary to vest in the Beneficiary or any of its designees all right, title and interest which the Indenture Trustee had in the Collateral and such other property designated for inclusion in an Asset Pool.

Section 1210. Derivative Counterparty, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Provider and Supplemental Liquidity Provider as Third-Party Beneficiary. Each Derivative Counterparty, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Provider and Supplemental Liquidity Provider is a third-party beneficiary of this Indenture to the extent specified in the applicable Derivative Agreement, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement, Supplemental Liquidity Agreement or Indenture Supplement.

[END OF ARTICLE XII]

 

- 93 -


ARTICLE XIII

COMPLIANCE WITH REGULATION AB

Section 1301. Intent of the Parties; Reasonableness. The Transferor and the Indenture Trustee acknowledge and agree that the purpose of this Article XIII is to facilitate compliance by the Transferor with the provisions of Regulation AB and related rules and regulations of the Commission. The Transferor shall not exercise its right to request delivery of information or other performance under these provisions other than in good faith, or for purposes other than the Transferor’s compliance with the Securities Act, the Securities Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder (or the provision in a private offering of disclosure comparable to that required under the Securities Act). The Indenture Trustee agrees to cooperate in good faith with any reasonable request by the Transferor for information regarding the Indenture Trustee which is required in order to enable the Transferor to comply with the provisions of Items 1103(a)(1), 1109(a)(1), 1109(a)(2), 1117, 1118, 1119 and 1122 of Regulation AB as it relates to the Indenture Trustee or to the Indenture Trustee’s obligations under this Indenture or any Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement.

Section 1302. Additional Representations and Warranties of the Indenture Trustee. The Indenture Trustee shall be deemed to represent to the Transferor, as of the date on which information is provided to the Transferor under Section 1303 that, except as disclosed in writing to the Transferor prior to such date to the best of its knowledge, but without independent investigation: (i) neither the execution, delivery and performance by the Indenture Trustee of this Indenture or any Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement, the performance by the Indenture Trustee of its obligations under this Indenture or any Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement nor the consummation of any of the transactions by the Indenture Trustee contemplated thereby, is in violation of any indenture, mortgage, bank credit agreement, note or bond purchase agreement, long-term lease, license or other agreement or instrument to which the Indenture Trustee is a party or by which it is bound, which violation would have a material adverse effect on the Indenture Trustee’s ability to perform its obligations under this Indenture or any Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement, or of any judgment or order applicable to the Indenture Trustee; and (ii) there are no proceedings pending or threatened against the Indenture Trustee in any court or before any governmental authority, agency or arbitration board or tribunal which, individually or in the aggregate, would have a material adverse effect on the right, power and authority of the Indenture Trustee to enter into this Indenture or any Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement or to perform its obligations under this Indenture or any Asset Pool Supplement or Indenture Supplement.

Section 1303. Information to Be Provided by the Indenture Trustee. The Indenture Trustee shall (i) on or before the fifth Business Day of each month, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such information regarding the Indenture Trustee as is requested for the purpose of compliance with Item 1117 of Regulation AB, and (ii) as promptly as practicable following notice to or discovery by the Indenture Trustee of any changes to such information, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such updated information.

 

- 94 -


The Indenture Trustee shall (i) on or before the fifth Business Day of each January, April, July and October, provide to the Transferor such information regarding the Indenture Trustee as is requested for the purpose of compliance with Items 1103(a)(1), 1109(a)(1), 1109(a)(2), 1118 and 1119 of Regulation AB, and (ii) as promptly as practicable following notice to or discovery by the Indenture Trustee of any changes to such information, provide to the Transferor, in writing, such updated information. Such information shall include, at a minimum:

(A) the Indenture Trustee’s name and form of organization;

(B) a description of the extent to which the Indenture Trustee has had prior experience serving as trustee for asset-backed securities transactions involving credit card receivables;

(C) a description of any affiliation between the Indenture Trustee and any of the following parties to a Securitization Transaction, as such parties are identified to the Indenture Trustee by the Transferor in writing in advance of such Securitization Transaction:

 

  (1) the sponsor;

 

  (2) any depositor;

 

  (3) the issuing entity;

 

  (4) any servicer;

 

  (5) any trustee;

 

  (6) any originator;

 

  (7) any significant obligor;

 

  (8) any enhancement or support provider; and

 

  (9) any other material transaction party.

In connection with the above-listed parties, a description of whether there is, and if so the general character of, any business relationship, agreement, arrangement, transaction or understanding that is entered into outside the ordinary course of business or is on terms other than would be obtained in an arm’s length transaction with an unrelated third party, apart from the asset-backed securities transaction, that currently exists or that existed during the past two years and that is material to an investor’s understanding of the asset-backed securities.

Section 1304. Report on Assessment of Compliance and Attestation. On or before March 1 of each calendar year, commencing in 2007, the Indenture Trustee shall:

(i) deliver to the Transferor a report regarding the Indenture Trustee’s assessment of compliance with the Servicing Criteria during the immediately preceding calendar year, as required under Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 of the Securities Exchange Act and Item 1122 of Regulation AB. Such report shall be addressed to the Transferor and signed by an authorized officer of the Indenture Trustee, and shall address each of the Servicing Criteria specified in Exhibit D or such criteria as mutually agreed upon by the Transferor and the Indenture Trustee;

 

- 95 -


(ii) deliver to the Transferor a report of a registered public accounting firm reasonably acceptable to the Transferor that attests to, and reports on, the assessment of compliance made by the Indenture Trustee and delivered pursuant to the preceding paragraph. Such attestation shall be in accordance with Rules 1-02(a)(3) and 2-02(g) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Securities Exchange Act;

(iii) deliver to the Transferor, in furtherance of Item 1122(c) of Regulation AB, written information sufficient to allow the Transferor, in cases where the Indenture Trustee identifies any material instance of noncompliance with the Servicing Criteria in the report delivered pursuant to Section 1304(i), to disclose in its related annual report on Form 10-K whether such material instance of noncompliance relates to the Receivables, the Collateral Certificate, or the Notes and whether and to what extent the Indenture Trustee has instituted steps to remediate each such material instance of noncompliance; and

(iv) deliver to the Transferor and any other Person that will be responsible for signing the certification (a “Sarbanes Certification”) required by Rules 13a-14(d) and 15d-14(d) under the Securities Exchange Act (pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002) on behalf of the Master Trust, the Issuer or the Transferor with respect to a Securitization Transaction a certification substantially in the form attached hereto as Exhibit C or such form as mutually agreed upon by the Transferor and the Indenture Trustee.

The Indenture Trustee acknowledges that the parties identified in clause (iv) above may rely on the certification provided by the Indenture Trustee pursuant to such clause in signing a Sarbanes Certification and filing such with the Commission.

Section 1305. Investor Communication. In the event either the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee receives a request from any Person to communicate with a Noteholder or Investor Certificateholder, the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee, as applicable, shall promptly report such request to the Servicer and the Transferor, and shall provide: the name of the Person making such request; the date the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee, as applicable, received such request; to the extent known, a description of the method Noteholders or Investor Certificateholders may use to contact the Person making such request; and copies of any documentation the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee, as applicable, receives in connection with such request that serves to verify the identity of the Person making such request as a Noteholder.

[END OF ARTICLE XIII]

 

- 96 -


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Indenture to be duly executed as of the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,
by Deutsche Bank Trust Company Delaware, as Owner Trustee and not in its individual capacity
By:  

/s/ Michele HY Voon

  Name: Michele HY Voon
  Title: Attorney-in-fact
By:  

/s/ Susan Barstock

  Name: Susan Barstock
  Title: Attorney-in-fact

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

as Indenture Trustee and not in its individual capacity

By:  

/s/ Michael D. Commisso

  Name: Michael D. Commisso
  Title: Vice President

 

Acknowledged By:

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,

as Transferor

By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

  Name: Eric D. Bauder
  Title: Assistant Vice President

 

- 97 -


EXHIBIT A

[FORM OF] INVESTMENT LETTER

[Date]

The Bank of New York Mellon,

as Indenture Trustee

101 Barclay Street

Floor 7 West

New York, New York 10286

Attention: Corporate Trust Administration – Asset Backed Securities

Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust

c/o Deutsche Bank Trust Company Delaware, as Owner Trustee and not

    in its individual capacity

E.A. Delle Donne Corporate Center,

Montgomery Building

1011 Centre Road

Wilmington, Delaware 19805-1266

Attn:                             

 

  Re: Purchase of $        * principal amount of Capital One

Multi-asset Execution Trust, Series [●], Class [●] Notes

Ladies and Gentlemen:

In connection with our purchase of the above Notes (the “Notes”) we confirm that:

(1) We understand that the Notes are not being registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), and are being sold to us in a transaction that is exempt from the registration requirements of the Securities Act;

(2) Any information we desire concerning the Notes or any other matter relevant to our decision to purchase the Notes is or has been made available to us;

(3) We have such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters as to be capable of evaluating the merits and risks of an investment in the Notes, and we (and any account for which we are purchasing under paragraph (4) below) are able to bear the economic risk of an investment in the Notes. We (and any account for which we are purchasing under paragraph (4) below) are an “accredited investor” (as such term is defined in Rule 501(a)(1), (2) or (3) of Regulation D under the Securities Act);

 

* Not less than $250,000 minimum principal amount.

 

A-1


(4) We are acquiring the Notes for our own account or for accounts as to which we exercise sole investment discretion and not with a view to any distribution of the Notes, subject, nevertheless, to the understanding that the disposition of our property shall at all times be and remain within our control;

(5) We agree that the Notes must be held indefinitely by us unless subsequently registered under the Securities Act or an exemption from any registration requirements of the Securities Act and any applicable state securities law is available;

(6) We agree that in the event that at some future time we wish to dispose of or exchange any of the Notes (such disposition or exchange not being currently foreseen or contemplated), we will not transfer or exchange any of the Notes unless:

(a)(i) the sale is of at least U.S. $250,000 principal amount of Notes to an Eligible Purchaser (as defined below), (ii) a letter to substantially the same effect as paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5) and (6) of this letter is executed promptly by the purchaser and (3) all offers or solicitations in connection with the sale, whether directly or through any agent acting on our behalf, are limited only to Eligible Purchasers and are not made by means of any form of general solicitation or general advertising whatsoever; or

(b) the Notes are transferred pursuant to Rule 144 under the Securities Act by us after we have held them for more than three years; or

(c) the Notes are sold in any other transaction that does not require registration under the Securities Act and, if the Issuer, the Beneficiary, the Administrator, the Indenture Trustee or the Note Registrar so requests, we theretofore have furnished to such party an opinion of counsel satisfactory to such party, in form and substance satisfactory to such party, to such effect; or

(d) the Notes are transferred pursuant to an exception from the registration requirements of the Securities Act under Rule 144A under the Securities Act; and

(7) We understand that the Notes will bear a legend to substantially the following effect:

“THIS NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”). NEITHER THIS NOTE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF THE SECURITIES ACT AND ANY APPLICABLE PROVISIONS OF ANY STATE BLUE SKY OR SECURITIES LAWS OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO HEREIN.”

 

A-2


This legend may be removed if the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Note Registrar have received an opinion of counsel satisfactory to them, in form and substance satisfactory to them, to the effect that the legend may be removed.

“Eligible Purchaser” means either an Eligible Dealer or a corporation, partnership or other entity which we have reasonable grounds to believe and do believe can make representations with respect to itself to substantially the same effect as the representations set forth herein. “Eligible Dealer” means any corporation or other entity the principal business of which is acting as a broker and/or dealer in securities. Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings given to such terms in the Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, between Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee.

 

Very truly yours,

 

(Name of Purchaser)
By  

 

(Authorized Officer)

 

A-3


EXHIBIT B-1

[FORM OF] CLEARANCE SYSTEM CERTIFICATE

TO BE GIVEN TO THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE BY

EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM, LUXEMBOURG FOR

DELIVERY OF DEFINITIVE NOTES IN EXCHANGE FOR A PORTION OF A

TEMPORARY GLOBAL NOTE

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,

Series [●], Class [●] Notes

[Insert title or sufficient description of Notes to be delivered]

We refer to that portion of the Temporary Global Note in respect of the Series [●], Class [●] Notes to be exchanged for definitive Notes (the “Submitted Portion”) pursuant to this certificate (the “Notes”) as provided in the Indenture, dated as of                  , 20     (as amended and supplemented, the “Indenture”) in respect of such issue. This is to certify that (i) we have received a certificate or certificates, in writing or by tested telex, with respect to each of the persons appearing in our records as being entitled to a beneficial interest in the Submitted Portion and with respect to such person’s beneficial interest either (a) from such person, substantially in the form of Exhibit B-2 to the Indenture, or (b) from                  ,         , substantially in the form of Exhibit B-3 to the Indenture, and (ii) the Submitted Portion includes no part of the Temporary Global Note excepted in such certificates.

We further certify that as of the date hereof we have not received any notification from any of the persons giving such certificates to the effect that the statements made by them with respect to any part of the Submitted Portion are no longer true and cannot be relied on as of the date hereof.

We understand that this certificate is required in connection with certain securities and tax laws in the United States of America. If administrative or legal proceedings are commenced or threatened in connection with which this certificate is or would be relevant, we irrevocably authorize you to produce this certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in such proceedings.

 

Dated:                  ,         , *  

[                                                                                                              

  as operator of the Euroclear System]
  [Clearstream, Luxembourg]
  By  

 

 

* To be dated on the date of the proposed exchange.

 

B-1-1


EXHIBIT B-2

[FORM OF] CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED TO

EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM, LUXEMBOURG

BY [●] WITH RESPECT TO REGISTERED NOTES SOLD TO QUALIFIED

INSTITUTIONAL BUYERS

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,

Series [●], Class [●] Notes

In connection with the initial issuance and placement of the Series [●], Class [●] Notes (the “Notes”), an institutional investor in the United States (an “institutional investor”) is purchasing [U.S.$/(pound)/(U)/SF] aggregate principal amount of the Notes hold in our account at [                                        , as operator of the Euroclear System] [Clearstream, Luxembourg] on behalf of such investor.

We reasonably believe that such institutional investor is a qualified institutional buyer as such term is defined under Rule 144A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

[We understand that this certificate is required in connection with United States laws. We irrevocably authorize you to produce this certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in any administrative or legal proceedings or official inquiry with respect to the matters covered by this certificate.]

The Definitive Notes in respect of this certificate are to be issued in registered form in the minimum denomination of [U.S.$/(pound)/(U)/SF] and such Definitive Notes (and, unless the Indenture or terms document relating to the Notes otherwise provides, any Notes issued in exchange or substitution for or on registration of transfer of Notes) shall bear the following legend:

“THIS NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE UNITED STATES SECURITIES ACT OF 1933. NEITHER THIS NOTE NOR ANY PORTION HEREOF MAY BE OFFERED OR SOLD, DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, IN THE UNITED STATES OR TO U.S. PERSONS (EACH AS DEFINED HEREIN), EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE REGISTRATION PROVISIONS OF SUCH ACT OR PURSUANT TO AN AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM SUCH REGISTRATION PROVISIONS. THE TRANSFER OF THIS NOTE IS SUBJECT TO CERTAIN CONDITIONS SET FORTH IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO HEREIN. THIS NOTE CANNOT BE EXCHANGED FOR A BEARER NOTE.”

Dated:                  ,         ,

 

[                            ]
By  

 

Authorized Officer

 

B-2-1


EXHIBIT B-3

[FORM OF] CERTIFICATE TO BE DELIVERED

TO EUROCLEAR OR CLEARSTREAM, LUXEMBOURG

BY A BENEFICIAL OWNER

OF NOTES, OTHER THAN A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,

Series [●], Class [●] Notes

This is to certify that as of the date hereof and except as provided in the third paragraph hereof, the Series [●], Class [●] Notes held by you for our account (the “Notes”) (i) are owned by a person that is a United States person, or (ii) are owned by a United States person that is (A) the foreign branch of a United States financial institution (as defined in U.S. Treasury Regulations Section 1.165-12(c)(1)(v)) (a “financial institution”) purchasing for its own account or for resale, or (B) a United States person who acquired the Notes through the foreign branch of a financial institution and who holds the Notes through the financial institution on the date hereof (and in either case (A) or (B), the financial institution hereby agrees to comply with the requirements of Section 165(j)(3)(A), (B) or (C) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the regulations thereunder), or (iii) are owned by a financial institution for purposes of resale during the Restricted Period (as defined in U.S. Treasury Regulations Section 1.163-5(c)(2)(i)(D)(7)). In addition, financial institutions described in clause (iii) of the preceding sentence (whether or not also described in clause (i) or (ii)) certify that they have not acquired the Notes for purposes of resale directly or indirectly to a United States person or to a person within the United States or its possessions.

We undertake to advise you by tested telex if the above statement as to beneficial ownership is not correct on the date of delivery of the Notes in bearer form with respect to such of the Notes as then appear in your books as being held for our account.

This certificate excepts and does not relate to [U.S.$/(pound)/(U)/SF] principal amount of Notes held by you for our account, as to which we are not yet able to certify beneficial ownership. We understand that delivery of Definitive Notes in such principal amount cannot be made until we are able to so certify.

 

B-3-1


We understand that this certificate is required in connection with certain securities and tax laws in the United States of America. If administrative or legal proceedings are commenced or threatened in connection with which this certificate is or would be relevant, we irrevocably authorize you to produce this certificate or a copy hereof to any interested party in such proceedings. As used herein, “United States” means the United States of America, including the States and the District of Columbia, its territories, its possessions and other areas subject to its jurisdiction; and “United States Person” means a citizen or resident of the United States, a corporation, partnership or other entity created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, or any political subdivision thereof, or an estate or trust the income of which is subject to United States federal income taxation regardless of its source.

 

Dated:                  ,         , *   By  

 

  Name:  

As, or as agent for, the beneficial owner(s) of the interest in the Notes to which this certificate relates.

 

* This certificate must be dated on the earlier of the date of the first payment of interest in respect of the Notes and the date of the delivery of the Notes in definitive form.

 

B-3-2


EXHIBIT C

[FORM OF] ANNUAL CERTIFICATION

 

  Re: The [                    ] agreement dated as of [            ], 20[    ] (the “Agreement”), among [IDENTIFY PARTIES]

I,                                         , the                              of [NAME OF COMPANY] (the “Company”), certify to the Transferor, and its officers, with the knowledge and intent that they will rely upon this certification, that:

(1) I have reviewed the report on assessment of the Company’s compliance provided in accordance with Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), and Item 1122 of Regulation AB (the “Servicing Assessment”), the registered public accounting firm’s attestation report provided in accordance with Rules 13a-18 and 15d-18 under the Exchange Act and Section 1122(b) of Regulation AB (the “Attestation Report”), and any other information provided in furtherance of Section 1122(c) of Regulation AB pursuant to Section 1304(iii) of the Agreement (the “Servicing Assessment Supplemental Information”), that were delivered by the Company to the Transferor pursuant to the Agreement (collectively, the “Company Information”);

(2) To the best of my knowledge, the Servicing Assessment and any Servicing Assessment Supplemental Information, taken as a whole, does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in the light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period of time covered by the Servicing Assessment;

(3) To the best of my knowledge, all of the Company Information required to be provided by the Company under the Agreement has been provided to the Transferor; and

(4) To the best of my knowledge, except as disclosed in the Servicing Assessment or the Attestation Report, the Company has fulfilled its obligations under the Agreement.

 

Date:  

 

By:  

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

C-1


EXHIBIT D

SERVICING CRITERIA TO BE ADDRESSED IN ASSESSMENT OF COMPLIANCE

The assessment of compliance to be delivered by the Indenture Trustee shall address, at a minimum, the criteria identified as below as “Applicable Servicing Criteria”:

 

Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable

Servicing Criteria

Reference

  

Criteria

    
   General Servicing Considerations   
1122(d)(1)(i)    Policies and procedures are instituted to monitor any performance or other triggers and events of default in accordance with the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(1)(ii)    If any material servicing activities are outsourced to third parties, policies and procedures are instituted to monitor the third party’s performance and compliance with such servicing activities.   
1122(d)(1)(iii)    Any requirements in the transaction agreements to maintain a back-up servicer for the credit card accounts or accounts are maintained.   
1122(d)(1)(iv)    A fidelity bond and errors and omissions policy is in effect on the party participating in the servicing function throughout the reporting period in the amount of coverage required by and otherwise in accordance with the terms of the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(1)(v)    Aggregation of information, as applicable, is mathematically accurate and the information conveyed accurately reflects the information.   
   Cash Collection and Administration   
1122(d)(2)(i)    Payments on credit card accounts are deposited into the appropriate custodial bank accounts and related bank clearing accounts no more than two business days following receipt, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.    ü1
1122(d)(2)(ii)    Disbursements made via wire transfer on behalf of an obligor or to an investor are made only by authorized personnel.    ü
1122(d)(2)(iii)    Advances of funds or guarantees regarding collections, cash flows or distributions, and any interest or other fees charged for such advances, are made, reviewed and approved as specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(2)(iv)    The related accounts for the transaction, such as cash reserve accounts or accounts established as a form of overcollateralization, are separately maintained (e.g., with respect to commingling of cash) as set forth in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(2)(v)    Each custodial account is maintained at a federally insured depository institution as set forth in the transaction agreements. For purposes of this criterion, “federally insured depository institution” with respect to a foreign financial institution means a foreign financial institution that meets the requirements of Rule 13k-1(b)(1) of the Securities Exchange Act.   

 

1  Solely with regard to deposits made by the Indenture Trustee.

 

D-1


Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable

Servicing Criteria

Reference

  

Criteria

    
1122(d)(2)(vi)    Unissued checks are safeguarded so as to prevent unauthorized access.   
1122(d)(2)(vii)    Reconciliations are prepared on a monthly basis for all asset-backed securities related bank accounts, including custodial accounts and related bank clearing accounts. These reconciliations are (A) mathematically accurate; (B) prepared within 30 calendar days after the bank statement cutoff date, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements; (C) reviewed and approved by someone other than the person who prepared the reconciliation; and (D) contain explanations for reconciling items. These reconciling items are resolved within 90 calendar days of their original identification, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
   Investor Remittances and Reporting   
1122(d)(3)(i)    Reports to investors, including those to be filed with the Commission, are maintained in accordance with the transaction agreements and applicable Commission requirements. Specifically, such reports (A) are prepared in accordance with timeframes and other terms set forth in the transaction agreements; (B) provide information calculated in accordance with the terms specified in the transaction agreements; (C) are filed with the Commission as required by its rules and regulations; and (D) agree with investors’ or the trustee’s records as to the total unpaid principal balance and number of credit card accounts serviced by the Servicer.   
1122(d)(3)(ii)    Amounts due to investors are allocated and remitted in accordance with timeframes, distribution priority and other terms set forth in the transaction agreements.    ü
1122(d)(3)(iii)    Disbursements made to an investor are posted within two business days to the Servicer’s investor records, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.    ü
1122(d)(3)(iv)    Amounts remitted to investors per the investor reports agree with cancelled checks, or other form of payment, or custodial bank statements.    ü
   Pool Asset Administration   
1122(d)(4)(i)    Collateral or security on credit card accounts is maintained as required by the transaction agreements or related asset pool documents.    ü
1122(d)(4)(ii)    Account and related documents are safeguarded as required by the transaction agreements    ü
1122(d)(4)(iii)    Any additions, removals or substitutions to the asset pool are made, reviewed and approved in accordance with any conditions or requirements in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(iv)    Payments on credit card accounts, including any payoffs, made in accordance with the related credit card accounts documents are posted to the Servicer’s obligor records maintained no more than two business days after receipt, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements, and allocated to principal, interest or other items (e.g., escrow) in accordance with the related asset pool documents.   
1122(d)(4)(v)    The Servicer’s records regarding the accounts and the accounts agree with the Servicer’s records with respect to an obligor’s unpaid principal balance.   

 

D-2


Servicing Criteria

  

Applicable

Servicing Criteria

Reference

  

Criteria

    
1122(d)(4)(vi)    Changes with respect to the terms or status of an obligor’s account (e.g., loan modifications or re-agings) are made, reviewed and approved by authorized personnel in accordance with the transaction agreements and related pool asset documents.   
1122(d)(4)(vii)    Loss mitigation or recovery actions (e.g., forbearance plans, modifications and deeds in lieu of foreclosure, foreclosures and repossessions, as applicable) are initiated, conducted and concluded in accordance with the timeframes or other requirements established by the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(viii)    Records documenting collection efforts are maintained during the period a Account is delinquent in accordance with the transaction agreements. Such records are maintained on at least a monthly basis, or such other period specified in the transaction agreements, and describe the entity’s activities in monitoring delinquent Accounts including, for example, phone calls, letters and payment rescheduling plans in cases where delinquency is deemed temporary (e.g., illness or unemployment).   
1122(d)(4)(ix)    Adjustments to interest rates or rates of return for Accounts with variable rates are computed based on the related Account documents.   
1122(d)(4)(x)    Regarding any funds held in trust for an obligor (such as escrow accounts): (A) such funds are analyzed, in accordance with the obligor’s Account documents, on at least an annual basis, or such other period specified in the transaction agreements; (B) interest on such funds is paid, or credited, to obligors in accordance with applicable Account documents and state laws; and (C) such funds are returned to the obligor within 30 calendar days of full repayment of the related Accounts, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xi)    Payments made on behalf of an obligor (such as tax or insurance payments) are made on or before the related penalty or expiration dates, as indicated on the appropriate bills or notices for such payments, provided that such support has been received by the servicer at least 30 calendar days prior to these dates, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xii)    Any late payment penalties in connection with any payment to be made on behalf of an obligor are paid from the servicer’s funds and not charged to the obligor, unless the late payment was due to the obligor’s error or omission.   
1122(d)(4)(xiii)    Disbursements made on behalf of an obligor are posted within two business days to the obligor’s records maintained by the servicer, or such other number of days specified in the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xiv)    Delinquencies, charge-offs and uncollectible accounts are recognized and recorded in accordance with the transaction agreements.   
1122(d)(4)(xv)    Any external enhancement or other support, identified in Item 1114(a)(1) through (3) or Item 1115 of Regulation AB, is maintained as set forth in the transaction agreements.   

 

D-3


[NAME OF INDENTURE TRUSTEE]
Date:  

 

By:  

 

Name:  
Title:  

 

D-4

EX-4.5 6 d125824dex45.htm EXHIBIT 4.5 Exhibit 4.5

EXHIBIT 4.5

 

 

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

as Issuer

and

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON

as Indenture Trustee

CARD SERIES INDENTURE SUPPLEMENT

Dated as of October 9, 2002

As amended and restated as of March 17, 2016

to

ASSET POOL 1 SUPPLEMENT

dated as of October 9, 2002

to

INDENTURE

Dated as of October 9, 2002,

As amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016

 

 

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

ARTICLE I

   DEFINITIONS AND OTHER PROVISIONS OF GENERAL APPLICATION      1   

Section 1.01.

  

Definitions

     1   

Section 1.02.

  

Governing Law

     23   

Section 1.03.

  

Counterparts

     23   

Section 1.04.

  

Ratification of Indenture and Asset Pool 1 Supplement

     23   

ARTICLE II

  

THE NOTES

     24   

Section 2.01.

  

Creation and Designation

     24   

Section 2.02.

  

New Issuances of Notes

     24   

ARTICLE III

  

ALLOCATIONS, DEPOSITS AND PAYMENTS

     26   

Section 3.01.

  

Allocations of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts

     26   

Section 3.02.

  

Targeted Deposits of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts to the Interest Funding Account

     27   

Section 3.03.

  

Allocations of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts to Interest Funding sub-Accounts

     28   

Section 3.04.

  

Amounts to be Treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts; Payments Received from Derivative Counterparties for Interest in Foreign Currencies; Other Deposits to the Interest Funding sub-Accounts

     28   

Section 3.05.

  

Allocations of Reductions to the Nominal Liquidation Amount Due to Investor Charge-Offs

     30   

Section 3.06.

  

Allocations of Reimbursements of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits

     33   

Section 3.07.

  

Application of Card Series Principal Amounts

     34   

Section 3.08.

  

Allocation of Reductions of Nominal Liquidation Amount of Subordinated Notes from Reallocations of Card Series Principal Amounts to Cover Interest Funding Account Shortfalls or Servicing Fee Shortfalls

     37   

Section 3.09.

  

Allocation of Servicing Fee Shortfalls

     41   

Section 3.10.

  

Targeted Deposits of Card Series Principal Amounts to the Principal Funding Account

     41   

Section 3.11.

  

Allocations among Principal Funding sub-Accounts

     43   

Section 3.12.

  

Amounts to be Treated as Card Series Principal Amounts; Payments Received from Derivative Counterparties for Principal; Other Deposits to Principal Funding sub-Accounts

     44   

Section 3.13.

  

Withdrawals from Interest Funding Account

     45   

Section 3.14.

  

Withdrawals from Principal Funding Account

     46   

Section 3.15.

  

Limit on Deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of Subordinated Note; Limit on Repayments of all Tranches

     48   

Section 3.16.

  

Calculation of Nominal Liquidation Amount

     50   

Section 3.17.

  

Reinvestment in the COMT Collateral Certificate

     51   

 

-i-


Section 3.18.

  

Netting of Deposits and Payments

     51   

Section 3.19.

  

Pro rata Payments within a Tranche

     51   

Section 3.20.

  

Sale of Collateral for Accelerated Notes

     51   

Section 3.21.

  

Calculation of Prefunding Target Amount

     52   

Section 3.22.

  

Targeted Deposits to the Class C Reserve Account

     55   

Section 3.23.

  

Withdrawals from the Class C Reserve Account

     56   

Section 3.24.

  

Targeted Deposits to the Accumulation Reserve Account

     57   

Section 3.25.

  

Withdrawals from the Accumulation Reserve Account

     58   

Section 3.26.

  

Computation of Interest

     58   

Section 3.27.

  

Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing

     58   

Section 3.28.

  

Excess Available Principal Amount Sharing

     59   

Section 3.29.

  

Targeted Deposits to the Class D Reserve Account

     60   

Section 3.30.

  

Withdrawals from the Class D Reserve Account

     61   

ARTICLE IV

  

EARLY REDEMPTION OF NOTEs

     62   

Section 4.01.

  

Early Redemption Events

     62   

ARTICLE V

  

ISSUER ACCOUNTS AND INVESTMENTS

     63   

Section 5.01.

  

Issuer Accounts

     63   

 

-ii-


EXHIBITS

 

EXHIBIT A-1

  

[FORM OF] CLASS A NOTE

EXHIBIT A-2

  

[FORM OF] CLASS B NOTE

EXHIBIT A-3

  

[FORM OF] CLASS C NOTE

EXHIBIT A-4

  

[FORM OF] CLASS D NOTE

EXHIBIT B

  

[FORM OF] CARD SERIES SCHEDULE TO PAYMENT INSTRUCTIONS

EXHIBIT C

  

[FORM OF] CARD SERIES SCHEDULE TO MONTHLY NOTEHOLDERS’ STATEMENT

EXHIBIT D

  

THRESHOLD CONDITIONS

 

-iii-


This CARD SERIES INDENTURE SUPPLEMENT (this “Indenture Supplement”), by and between CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST, a statutory trust created under the laws of the State of Delaware (the “Issuer”), having its principal office at E.A. Delle Donne Corporate Center, Montgomery Building, 1011 Centre Road, Wilmington, Delaware 19805, and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, a New York banking corporation, as Indenture Trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”), is made and entered into as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016.

Pursuant to this Indenture Supplement, the Issuer shall create a new Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes and shall specify the principal terms thereof.

ARTICLE I

Definitions and Other Provisions of General Application

Section 1.01. Definitions. For all purposes of this Indenture Supplement, except as otherwise expressly provided or unless the context otherwise requires:

 

  (1) the terms defined in this Article have the meanings assigned to them in this Article, and include the plural as well as the singular;

 

  (2) all other terms used herein which are defined in the Indenture or the Asset Pool 1 Supplement, either directly or by reference therein, have the meanings assigned to them therein;

 

  (3) all accounting terms not otherwise defined herein have the meanings assigned to them in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and, except as otherwise herein expressly provided, the term “generally accepted accounting principles” with respect to any computation required or permitted hereunder means such accounting principles as are generally accepted in the United States of America at the date of such computation;

 

  (4) all references in this Indenture to designated “Articles,” “Sections” and other subdivisions are to the designated Articles, Sections and other subdivisions of this Indenture Supplement. The words “herein,” “hereof” and “hereunder” and other words of similar import refer to this Indenture Supplement as a whole and not to any particular Article, Section or other subdivision;

 

  (5) in the event that any term or provision contained herein shall conflict with or be inconsistent with any term or provision contained in the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement or the Transfer and Administration Agreement, the terms and provisions of this Indenture Supplement shall be controlling;


  (6) each capitalized term defined herein shall relate only to the Card Series Notes and no other Series of Notes issued by the Issuer; and

 

  (7) “including” and words of similar import will be deemed to be followed by “without limitation.”

Accumulation Commencement Date” means, for each Tranche of Notes, the first Business Day of the month that is twelve (12) whole calendar months prior to the Expected Principal Payment Date for such Tranche of Notes; provided, however, that, if the Accumulation Period Length for such Tranche of Notes is less than twelve (12) months, the Accumulation Commencement Date will be the first Business Day of the month that is the number of whole months prior to such Expected Principal Payment Date at least equal to the Accumulation Period Length such that the number of Monthly Periods during the period from the Accumulation Commencement Date to such Expected Principal Payment Date will at least equal the Accumulation Period Length.

Accumulation Period” means, for any Tranche of Card Series Notes, each Monthly Period with respect to which a deposit is required to be made into the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Notes pursuant to Section 3.07(g) and Section 3.10.

Accumulation Period Amount” shall mean, for any Tranche of Notes for each Monthly Period, an amount equal to (x) for any Tranche of Notes not in an Accumulation Period, zero and (y) otherwise, the product of (i) Available Expected Principal for such Monthly Period and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Principal Allocation Amount for such Tranche of Notes and the denominator of which is the sum of (a) the Principal Allocation Amount for all Outstanding Tranches of Notes and (b) the Invested Amounts of all Variable Accumulation Series (as defined in the Series 2002-CC Supplement) of Investor Certificates issued by the Master Trust which are not scheduled to be in their revolving periods as of such Monthly Period; provided that, for purposes of this definition, the commencement date of the accumulation period of each such Variable Accumulation Series shall be deemed to have been postponed to the latest permissible date, determined as if the provisions of Section 3.10(b)(ii) applied to each such Series of Investor Certificates with such changes as may be specified with respect to such Series of Investor Certificates (applying such provisions first to the Variable Accumulation Series with the latest expected final payment date and next to each Series of Investor Certificates with the next preceding expected final payment date).

Accumulation Period Length” is defined in Section 3.10(b)(ii).

Accumulation Reserve Account” means the trust account designated as such and established pursuant to Section 5.01(a).

Accumulation Reserve Sub-Account Earnings” means, for each Distribution Date, the investment earnings on funds in the Accumulation Reserve Account (net of investment expenses and losses) for the period from and including the immediately preceding Distribution Date to but excluding such Distribution Date.

 

-2-


Aggregate Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall” means the sum of the Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in each of the related Indenture Supplements) for each Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A.

Aggregate Series Principal Amounts Shortfall” means the sum of the Series Principal Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in each of the related Indenture Supplements) for each Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A.

Asset Pool 1 Supplement” means the Asset Pool 1 Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002, by and between the Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, as the same may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

Asset Sales Proceeds” means, for any Tranche of Notes, the proceeds of the sale of Collateral with respect to such Tranche pursuant to Section 3.20. Asset Sales Proceeds do not constitute Card Series Principal Amounts.

Asset Sales Proceeds Deposit Amount” means, for any Tranche of Notes in respect of which the Trust has received Asset Sales Proceeds, the amount of Asset Sales Proceeds on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche.

Available Expected Principal” for any date of determination during each Monthly Period shall be equal to the excess of (a) the Expected Monthly Principal for such Monthly Period over (b) the sum, without duplication, of all scheduled amortizations or accumulations of principal for such Monthly Period, including past due shortfalls as of such date of determination, for all Nonvariable Accumulation Series (as defined in the Series 2002-CC Supplement) of Investor Certificates issued by the Master Trust which are not scheduled to be in their revolving periods as of such Monthly Period.

Beneficial Interest” has the meaning specified in the Trust Agreement.

Card Series Defaulted Amount” means, with respect to any Monthly Period, the portion of the Asset Pool 1 Defaulted Amount allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.2(b) of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Card Series Finance Charge Amounts” means, for any Distribution Date, the sum of (a) Asset Pool 1 Finance Charge Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.2(a) of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement, (b) any amounts to be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts pursuant to Sections 3.04(a) and 3.20(d) and (c) any amounts to be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts pursuant to any Terms Document.

 

-3-


Card Series Notes” means the Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes created pursuant to Section 2.01(a).

Card Series Principal Amounts” means, for any Monthly Period, the sum of (a) Asset Pool 1 Principal Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.3 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement and (b) any amounts to be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.12(a).

Card Series Servicing Fee” means, with respect to any Monthly Period, the amount of the Asset Pool 1 Servicing Fee allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.4(b) of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Card Series Servicing Fee Percentage” means, for any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the Net Servicing Fee Rate (as defined in the Series 2002-CC Supplement); provided, however, that if any Collateral Certificate (other than the COMT Collateral Certificate) is included in Asset Pool 1, the Card Series Servicing Fee Percentage will be the rate specified by the Administrator.

Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes minus the Class A Usage Amount of Class B Notes, each for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes minus the Class A Usage Amount of Class C Notes, each for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes minus the Class A Usage Amount of Class D Notes, each for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes minus the Class A Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes, each for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class A Notes” means a Note specified in the applicable Terms Document as belonging to Class A.

Class A Usage Amount of Class B Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Class A Notes, on any Distribution Date, an amount, not to exceed the Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes, equal to the excess, if any, of the Class A Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes over the sum of the Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes and the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes, in each case for such Distribution Date, in each case, for such Tranche of Class A Notes.

 

-4-


Class A Usage Amount of Class C Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Class A Notes for any Distribution Date, an amount, not to exceed the Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes, equal to the excess, if any, of the Class A Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes over the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes, in each case, for such Tranche of Class A Notes.

Class A Usage Amount of Class D Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Class A Notes for any Distribution Date, an amount, not to exceed the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes, equal to the Class A Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes.

Class A Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Class A Notes, zero on the date of issuance of such Tranche and on any Distribution Date thereafter the Class A Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes as of the preceding date of determination for such Tranche, plus the sum of the following amounts (in each case, such amount shall not exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche after giving effect to the previous clauses, if any):

(a) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class B Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period; plus

(b) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class C Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period; plus

(c) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period; plus

(d) the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class A Notes to the Class B Notes, Class C Notes or Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(b) on such date; plus

 

-5-


(e) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class A Notes pursuant to Section 3.07(a) on such date; plus

(f) an amount equal to the product of (i) an amount, not less than zero, equal to the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(d)(i) on such date, minus the aggregate amount reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(e) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class C Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(g) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(d)(ii) or reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(e) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(h) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(f) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(i) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts paid to the Servicer pursuant to Section 3.07(d) on such date; plus

(j) an amount equal to the product of (i) an amount, not less than zero, equal to the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(j)(i) on such date, minus the aggregate amount reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(k) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class C Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(k) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(j)(ii) or reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(k) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(l) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(f) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator

 

-6-


of which is the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; minus

(m) an amount (not to exceed the Class A Usage Amount of Class B Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes after giving effect to the amounts computed pursuant to clauses (a) through (l) above) equal to the product of (i) the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Class B Notes which are reimbursed on such Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.06 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Usage Amount of Class B Notes (prior to giving effect to any reimbursement of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits on such Distribution Date) for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (prior to giving effect to such reimbursement) of all Class B Notes; minus

(n) an amount (not to exceed the Class A Usage Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes after giving effect to the amounts computed pursuant to clauses (a) through (l) above) equal to the product of (i) the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Class C Notes which are reimbursed on such Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.06 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Usage Amount of Class C Notes (prior to giving effect to any reimbursement of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits on such Distribution Date) for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (prior to giving effect to such reimbursement) of all Class C Notes; minus

(o) an amount (not to exceed the Class A Usage Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes after giving effect to the amounts computed pursuant to clauses (a) through (l) above) equal to the product of (i) the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Class D Notes which are reimbursed on such Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.06 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class A Usage Amount of Class D Notes (prior to giving effect to any reimbursement of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits on such Distribution Date) for such Tranche of Class A Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (prior to giving effect to such reimbursement) of all Class D Notes.

Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class B Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes minus the Class B Usage Amount of Class C Notes, each for such Tranche of Class B Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class B Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes minus the Class B Usage Amount of Class D Notes, each for such Tranche of Class B Notes as of such Distribution Date.

 

-7-


Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class B Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes minus the Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes, each for such Tranche of Class B Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class B Notes” means a Note specified in the applicable Terms Document as belonging to Class B.

Class B Principal Allocation” means, for any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the product of (a) the aggregate amount of Asset Pool 1 Principal Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.3 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement for such Monthly Period and (b) the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for such Monthly Period for all Class B Notes in the Card Series and the denominator of which is sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for such Monthly Period for all Notes in the Card Series.

Class B Usage Amount of Class C Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Class B Notes for any Distribution Date, an amount, not to exceed the Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes, equal to the excess, if any, of the Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes over the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes, in each case, for such Tranche of Class B Notes.

Class B Usage Amount of Class D Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Class B Notes for any Distribution Date, an amount, not to exceed the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes, equal to the Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes.

Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Outstanding Class B Notes, zero on the date of issuance of such Tranche and on any Distribution Date thereafter the Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes as of the preceding date of determination for such Tranche, plus the sum of the following amounts (in each case, such amount shall not exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche after giving effect to the previous clauses, if any):

(a) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class C Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Sections 3.05(a) and (b); plus

(b) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount reallocated pursuant to Section 3.05(b)(ii) on such date from all Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero to the Class C Notes and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Sections 3.05(a) and (b); plus

 

-8-


(c) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Sections 3.05(a) and (b); plus

(d) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount reallocated pursuant to Section 3.05(b)(iii) on such date from the Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero to the Class D Notes and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Sections 3.05(a) and (b); plus

(e) the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class B Notes to the Class C Notes or Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(c) on such date; plus

(f) an amount equal to the product of (i) an amount equal to the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(a)(ii) on such date with respect to Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(g) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(a)(iii) on such date with respect to Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(h) the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class B Notes to the Class C Notes and Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(b) on such date; plus

(i) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to Section 3.07(b) on such date; plus

 

-9-


(j) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(f) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) through (e); plus

(k) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(g)(ii) on such date with respect to Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) through (f); plus

(l) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(g)(iii) on such date with respect to Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) through (f); plus

(m) the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class B Notes to the Class C Notes and Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(h) on such date; plus

(n) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts paid to the Servicer pursuant to Section 3.07(e) on such date; plus

(o) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(l) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) and (k); minus

(p) an amount (not to exceed the Class B Usage Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to the amounts computed pursuant to clauses (a) through (o) above) equal to the product of (i) the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Class C Notes which are reimbursed on such Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.06 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Usage Amount of Class C Notes (prior to giving effect to any reimbursement of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits on such Distribution Date) for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (prior to giving effect to such reimbursement) of all Class C Notes, minus;

 

-10-


(q) an amount (not to exceed the Class B Usage Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to the amounts computed pursuant to clauses (a) through (o) above) equal to the product of (i) the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Class D Notes which are reimbursed on such Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.06 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Usage Amount of Class D Notes (prior to giving effect to any reimbursement of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits on such Distribution Date) for such Tranche of Class B Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (prior to giving effect to such reimbursement) of all Class D Notes;

provided, however, that if on any date of determination the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes changes pursuant to any Terms Document, after giving effect to such change, the Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes will be an amount equal to the product of (a) the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to such issuance and (b) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class B Usage Amount of Subordinated Notes prior to giving effect to such issuance and the denominator of which is the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes prior to giving effect to such issuance, subject to further adjustment as described above.

Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes” means, for any Tranche of Class C Notes, with respect to any Distribution Date, an amount equal to the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes minus the Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes, each for such Tranche of Class C Notes as of such Distribution Date.

Class C Notes” means a Note specified in the applicable Terms Document as belonging to Class C.

Class C Principal Allocation” means, for any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the product of (a) the aggregate amount of Asset Pool 1 Principal Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.3 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement for such Monthly Period and (b) the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for such Monthly Period for all Class C Notes in the Card Series and the denominator of which is sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for such Monthly Period for all Notes in the Card Series.

Class C Reserve Account” means the trust account designated as such and established pursuant to Section 5.01(a).

Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes” means, with respect to any Tranche of Outstanding Class C Notes, zero on the date of issuance of such Tranche and on any Distribution Date thereafter the Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes as of the preceding date of determination for such Tranche, plus the sum of the following amounts (in each case, such amount shall not exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche after giving effect to the previous clauses, if any):

(a) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(a) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes, in each case, after giving effect to Sections 3.05(a) and (b); plus

 

-11-


(b) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount reallocated from the Class A Notes or the Class B Notes to the Class D Notes pursuant to Sections 3.05(b)(iii) and 3.05(c)(ii) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Sections 3.05(a) and (b); plus

(c) the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.05(d) on such date; plus

(d) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated or reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Sections 3.08(a)(iii) and 3.08(b)(ii) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05; plus

(e) an amount equal to the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(c) on such date; plus

(f) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(d)(ii) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) through (c); plus

(g) an amount equal to the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(e) on such date; plus

(h) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.07(c) on such date; plus

 

-12-


(i) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated or reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Sections 3.08(g)(iii) and 3.08(h)(ii) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) through (f); plus

(j) an amount equal to the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(i) on such date; plus

(k) an amount equal to the product of (i) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(j)(ii) on such date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes in the Card Series, in each case, after giving effect to Section 3.05 and Sections 3.08(a) through (i); plus

(l) an amount equal to the aggregate amount reallocated from such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.08(k) on such date; plus

(m) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts paid to the Servicer pursuant to Section 3.07(f) on such date; minus

(n) an amount (not to exceed the Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to the amounts computed pursuant to clauses (a) through (m) above) equal to the product of (i) the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Class D Notes which are reimbursed on such Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.06 and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes (prior to giving effect to any reimbursement of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits on such Distribution Date) for such Tranche of Class C Notes and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits (prior to giving effect to such reimbursement) of all Class D Notes;

provided, however, that if on any date of determination the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes changes pursuant to any Terms Document, after giving effect to such change, the Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes will be an amount equal to the product of (a) the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to such issuance and (b) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Class C Usage Amount of Class D Notes prior to giving effect to such issuance and the denominator of which is the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes prior to giving effect to such issuance, subject to further adjustment as described above.

 

-13-


Class D Notes” means a Note specified in the applicable Terms Document as belonging to Class D.

Class D Principal Allocation” means, for any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the product of (a) the aggregate amount of Asset Pool 1 Principal Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.3 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement for such Monthly Period and (b) the percentage equivalent of a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for such Monthly Period for all Class D Notes in the Card Series and the denominator of which is sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for such Monthly Period for all Notes in the Card Series.

Class D Reserve Account” means the trust account designated as such and established pursuant to Section 5.01(a).

Derivative Accrual Date” means, for any Monthly Period with respect to any Tranche of Notes which has a Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, the date in such Monthly Period corresponding numerically to the next payment date under the related Derivative Agreement following the end of the related Monthly Period.

Excess Finance Charges,” for the Card Series for any month, means the aggregate amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts available after giving effect to Sections 3.01(a) through (k) for such month.

Excess Spread Amount” means, with respect to any Monthly Period, the aggregate amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts (exclusive of any amounts to be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts pursuant to Section 3.04(a)(v)) minus the sum of the amounts, without duplication, determined pursuant to Sections 3.01(a) through (g).

Expected Monthly Principal” means, for any Monthly Period, an amount equal to the product of (i) the lowest of the monthly principal payment rates (determined by dividing Collections of Principal Receivables during a calendar month by the amount of Principal Receivables in the Master Trust as of the last day of the preceding month, adjusted for additions to and removals from the Master Trust occurring after such last day), expressed as a decimal for the 12 calendar months preceding the date of such calculation (or such lower principal payment rate as the Transferor may select) and (ii) the sum of (A) the sum of the initial Invested Amounts of all outstanding Series of Investor Certificates issued by the Master Trust, other than Variable Funding Series and (B) the Principal Allocation Amount of each Tranche of Asset Pool 1 Notes. Capitalized terms used in this definition and not otherwise defined herein have the meaning given to such terms in the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Series 2002-CC Supplement.

Finance Charge Shortfall” means, for the Card Series for any month, an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (a) the sum of the amounts, without duplication, determined pursuant to Sections 3.01(a) through (k) over (b) the aggregate amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts.

 

-14-


Floating Allocation Amount” means, for any Monthly Period, for any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes, the sum of:

(a) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes as of the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, or with respect to the first Monthly Period for any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes, the Initial Dollar Principal Amount of such Class or Tranche, plus

(b) the aggregate amount of any increase in the Nominal Liquidation Amount of any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes during the current Monthly Period due to (x) the issuance of additional Notes of such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes during such Monthly Period or (y) the accretion of principal on such Class or Tranche of Card Series Discount Notes during such Monthly Period or (z) the release of Prefunding Excess Amounts (other than amount that were deposited into the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account for such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes during such Monthly Period) for such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes from the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account.

Floating Allocation Percentage” means, for any Monthly Period, for the Card Series Notes, the percentage equivalent (which percentage shall not exceed 100%) of a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of the Floating Allocation Amounts of all Classes and Tranches of Card Series Notes for such Monthly Period (exclusive of (x) any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes which will be paid in full during such Monthly Period and (y) any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes which will have a Nominal Liquidation Amount of zero during such Monthly Period) and the denominator of which is the sum of the numerators used to calculate the Floating Allocation Percentages for all Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes for such Monthly Period.

IFA Reallocation Amount” means, with respect to any Tranche of Notes for any Distribution Date, the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Notes pursuant to Section 3.07.

Indenture” means the Indenture dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, by and between the Issuer and Indenture Trustee.

Interest Funding Account” means the trust account designated as such and established pursuant to Section 5.01(a).

Interest Funding sub-Account Earnings” means, with respect to each Distribution Date, the investment earnings on funds in the Interest Funding Account (net of investment expenses and losses) for the period from and including the immediately preceding Distribution Date to but excluding such Distribution Date.

Investor Charge-Offs” means, with respect to any Distribution Date, the aggregate amount, if any, by which the Card Series Defaulted Amount, if any, for the preceding Monthly Period exceeds the Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for such Distribution Date available after giving effect to clauses (a) through (e) of Section 3.01.

 

-15-


Monthly Interest Accrual Date” means, with respect to any Outstanding Class or Tranche of Asset Pool 1 Notes:

(a) each Interest Payment Date for such Class or Tranche, or as otherwise specified in the applicable Terms Document for such Tranche of Notes, and

(b) for any Monthly Period in which no Interest Payment Date for such Class or Tranche occurs, the date in such Monthly Period corresponding numerically to the next Interest Payment Date for such Class or Tranche of Notes, or in the case of a Class or Tranche of Discount Notes, the Expected Principal Payment Date for that Class or Tranche; provided, however, that

(i) for the Monthly Period in which a Class or Tranche of Notes is issued, the date of issuance of such Class or Tranche will be the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date for such Monthly Period for such Class or Tranche of Notes,

(ii) any date on which proceeds from a sale of assets following an Event of Default and acceleration of any Tranche of Notes are deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Account for such Notes will be a Monthly Interest Accrual Date for such Tranche of Notes,

(iii) if there is no such numerically corresponding date in such Monthly Period, then the Monthly Interest Accrual Date will be the last Business Day of such Monthly Period, and

(iv) if such numerically corresponding date in such Monthly Period is not a Business Day, then the Monthly Interest Accrual Date will be the next following Business Day (unless such Business Day would fall in the following Monthly Period in which case the Monthly Interest Accrual Date will be the last Business Day of such earlier month).

Monthly Principal Accrual Date” means, with respect to any Outstanding Class or Tranche of Asset Pool 1 Notes:

(a) for any Monthly Period in which an Expected Principal Payment Date for such Class or Tranche occurs, such Expected Principal Payment Date, or as otherwise specified in the applicable Terms Document for such Tranche of Notes, and

(b) for any Monthly Period in which no Expected Principal Payment Date for such Class or Tranche occurs, the date in such Monthly Period corresponding numerically to the next Expected Principal Payment Date for such Tranche of Notes (or for any month following the last Expected Principal Payment Date, the date in such month corresponding numerically to the preceding Expected Principal Payment Date for such Tranche of Notes), or as otherwise specified in the applicable Terms Document, for such Tranche of Notes; provided, however, that:

(i) following a Pay Out Event as described in subsection 9.01(a) of the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the second Business Day following such Pay Out Event shall be a Monthly Principal Accrual Date,

 

-16-


(ii) any date on which Prefunded Excess Amounts are released from any Principal Funding sub-Account and deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account of any Tranche of Notes on or after the Expected Principal Payment Date for such Tranche of Notes will be a Monthly Principal Accrual Date for such Tranche of Notes,

(iii) any date on which proceeds from a sale of assets following an Event of Default and acceleration of any Tranche of Notes are deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Notes will be a Monthly Principal Accrual Date for such Tranche of Notes,

(iv) if there is no numerically corresponding date in such Monthly Period, then the Monthly Principal Accrual Date will be the last Business Day of such Monthly Period, and

(v) if such numerically corresponding date in such Monthly Period is not a Business Day, the Monthly Principal Accrual Date will be the next following Business Day (unless such Business Day would fall in the following month in which case the Monthly Principal Accrual Date will be the last Business Day of such earlier Monthly Period).

Monthly Principal Payment” means, for any Monthly Period for the Card Series Notes, an amount, not less than zero, equal to (a) the Targeted Principal Deposit Amount, plus (b) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts applied pursuant to Section 3.07(a) through (f), minus (c) the aggregate amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts treated as Card Series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.01(f) or (g), each with respect to such Monthly Period.

Nominal Liquidation Amount” means, with respect to any Tranche of Notes, the amount calculated pursuant to Section 3.16 of this Indenture Supplement. The Nominal Liquidation Amount for the Card Series will be the sum of the Nominal Liquidation Amounts of all of the Tranches of Notes of the Card Series.

Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit” means, with respect to any Tranche of Notes, the excess of the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of that Tranche over the Nominal Liquidation Amount of that Tranche.

Performing” means, with respect to any Derivative Agreement, no payment default or repudiation of performance by a Derivative Counterparty has occurred, and such Derivative Agreement has not been terminated.

 

-17-


PFA Accumulation Earnings” means, with respect to each Distribution Date, the investment earnings on funds in the Principal Funding Account (net of investment expenses and losses), other than funds in the Principal Funding Account in connection with any Prefunding Target Amounts, for the period from and including the immediately preceding Distribution Date to but excluding such Distribution Date.

PFA Accumulation Earnings Shortfall” means, for any Distribution Date,

(a) the aggregate of the PFA Accumulation Earnings Target for each Tranche of Card Series Notes for such Distribution Date, minus

(b) the PFA Accumulation Earnings for such period.

PFA Accumulation Earnings Target” means, for any Distribution Date, with respect to any amount on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account (prior to giving effect to any deposits to be made on such date), other than any amount in connection with a Prefunding Target Amount, for a Tranche of Notes, the Dollar amount of interest that would have accrued on such deposit (or portion thereof) for the period from and including the preceding Distribution Date to but excluding such Distribution Date if it had borne interest at the following rates:

(a) in the case of a Tranche of Dollar Interest-bearing Notes with no Derivative Agreement for interest, at the rate of interest applicable to that Tranche;

(b) in the case of a Tranche of Discount Notes, at the rate of accretion (converted to an accrual rate) of that Tranche;

(c) in the case of a Tranche of Notes with a Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, at the rate at which payments by the Issuer to the applicable Derivative Counterparty accrue (prior to the netting of such payments, if applicable); and

(d) in the case of a Tranche of Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, at the rate specified in the related Terms Document.

More than one of the aforementioned rates of interest may be applicable to amounts on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account for a Tranche of Notes.

PFA Prefunding Earnings” means, with respect to each Distribution Date, the investment earnings on funds in the Principal Funding Account (net of investment expenses and losses) in connection with any Prefunding Target Amounts for the period from and including the immediately preceding Distribution Date to but excluding such Distribution Date.

PFA Prefunding Earnings Shortfall” means, for any Distribution Date,

(a) the aggregate PFA Prefunding Earnings Targets for each Tranche of Card Series Notes for such Distribution Date, minus

(b) the PFA Prefunding Earnings for such period.

 

-18-


PFA Prefunding Earnings Target” means, for any Distribution Date, with respect to any amount on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account in connection with a Prefunding Target Amount for a Tranche of Notes, the Dollar amount of interest that would have accrued on such deposit (or portion thereof) for the period from and including the preceding Distribution Date to but excluding such Distribution Date if it had borne interest at the following rates:

(a) in the case of a Tranche of Dollar Interest-bearing Notes with no Derivative Agreement for interest, at the rate of interest applicable to that Tranche;

(b) in the case of a Tranche of Discount Notes, at the rate of accretion (converted to an accrual rate) of that Tranche;

(c) in the case of a Tranche of Notes with a Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, at the rate at which payments by the Issuer to the applicable Derivative Counterparty accrue (prior to the netting of such payments, if applicable); and

(d) in the case of a Tranche of Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, at the rate specified in the related Terms Document.

More than one of the aforementioned rates of interest may be applicable to amounts on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account for a Tranche of Notes.

Prefunding Excess Amount” means, with respect to any Senior Class of Notes for any date, after giving effect to all issuances, allocations, deposits and payments with respect to that date, the aggregate amounts on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Accounts of the Notes of that Class that are in excess of the aggregate amount targeted to be on deposit in those Principal Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.10.

Prefunding Target Amount” means the amount calculated pursuant to Section 3.21.

Principal Allocation Amount” means, for any Monthly Period, for the Card Series Notes,

(a) for all Classes or Tranches of Card Series Notes in an Accumulation Period, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes as of the close of business on the day prior to the commencement of the most recent Accumulation Period for such Class or Tranche of the Card Series, and

(b) for all other Classes or Tranches of Outstanding Card Series Notes, the sum of:

(i) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Classes or Tranches of Card Series Notes, as of the close of business on the last day of the immediately

 

-19-


preceding Monthly Period, or with respect to the first Monthly Period for any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes, the Initial Dollar Principal Amount of such Class or Tranche, and

(ii) the aggregate amount of any increase in the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes during the current Monthly Period due to (x) the issuance of additional Notes of such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes during such Monthly Period or (y) the accretion of principal on such Class or Tranche of Card Series Discount Notes during such Monthly Period or (z) the release of Prefunding Excess Amounts (other than amounts that were deposited into the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account for such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes during such Monthly Period) for such Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes from the Principal Funding Account or applicable Principal Funding sub-Account;

provided, however, that if after the commencement of an Accumulation Period for a Tranche of Notes, another Tranche of Notes that was designated in or under the Terms Document therefor as a Tranche that is a “Paired Tranche” with respect to the first Tranche of Notes, the Administrator, on behalf of the Issuer, may, by written notice delivered to the Indenture Trustee, designate an amount (the “Paired Amount”) to be subtracted from the amount calculated pursuant to clause (a) or (b) above for the second Tranche of Notes, provided that (x) such amount shall not exceed 90% of the aggregate amount on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for such first Tranche of Notes and (y) the Issuer shall have received written notice from each Note Rating Agency that such designation will not have a Ratings Effect and shall have delivered copies of each such written notice to the Indenture Trustee and the Issuer shall have delivered to the Indenture Trustee an Officer’s Certificate to the effect that, based on the facts known to such officer at that time, in the reasonable belief of the Issuer, such designation will not have an Adverse Effect with respect to any Outstanding Notes.

Principal Allocation Percentage” means, for any Monthly Period, for the Card Series Notes, the percentage equivalent (which percentage shall not exceed 100%) of a fraction, the numerator of which is equal to the sum of the Principal Allocation Amounts for all Classes or Tranches of Card Series Notes (exclusive of (x) any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes which will be paid in full during such Monthly Period and (y) any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes which will have a Nominal Liquidation Amount of zero during such Monthly Period) and the denominator of which is the sum of the numerators used to calculate the Principal Allocation Percentages for all Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes for such Monthly Period.

Principal Funding Account” means the trust account designated as such and established pursuant to Section 5.01(a).

Principal Funding sub-Account Amount” means, with respect to any Tranche of Notes as of any date, the amount on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Notes on such date.

 

-20-


Principal Shortfall” means, for the Card Series for any month, an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (a) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts over (b) the sum of the amounts, without duplication, determined pursuant to Sections 3.07(a) through (g).

Reallocated Principal Amount” means, with respect to any Distribution Date, the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts which are allocated to be deposited in the Interest Funding sub-Account of any Class A Notes, Class B Notes or Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.07(a), (b) or (c) or allocated to the Servicer pursuant to Section 3.07(d), (e) or (f) on such Distribution Date.

Required Excess Spread Amount” means, with respect to any Monthly Period, an amount equal to zero; provided, however, that the Issuer may, from time to time, change such amount (which will never be less than zero) upon (i) written notice to the Indenture Trustee, (ii) prior written confirmation from the Note Rating Agencies that a Ratings Effect will not occur with respect to such change and (iii) delivery by the Issuer of an Officer’s Certificate to the effect that, in its reasonable belief, such change will not have an Adverse Effect.

Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes” at any time, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, is defined in the Terms Document for such Tranche of Class A Notes.

Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes” at any time, for any Tranche of Class A Notes or Class B Notes, is defined in the related Terms Document for such Tranche of Notes.

Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes” at any time, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, Class B Notes or Class C Notes, is defined in the related Terms Document for such Tranche of Notes.

Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes” at any time, for any Tranche of Class A Notes, Class B Notes or Class C Notes, is equal to the sum of the Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes, if any, the Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes, if any, and the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes, if any, in each case, for such Tranche of Notes.

Senior Class” means (a) with respect to the Class B Notes, the Class A Notes, (b) with respect to the Class C Notes, the Class A Notes or Class B Notes and (c) with respect to the Class D Notes, the Class A Notes, Class B Notes or Class C Notes.

Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall” means, with respect to any Distribution Date with respect to the Card Series, the excess, if any, of (a) the aggregate amount targeted to be paid or applied pursuant to Sections 3.01(a) through (g) for any Distribution Date over (b) the Card Series Finance Charge Amounts (excluding any amounts to be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts pursuant to Section 3.27(a)) for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that the Issuer, when authorized by an Officer’s Certificate, may amend or otherwise modify this definition of Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall provided the Note Rating Agencies confirm in writing that the amendment or modification will not cause a Ratings Effect with respect to any Outstanding Notes.

 

-21-


Series Principal Amounts Shortfall” means, with respect to any Distribution Date with respect to the Card Series, the excess, if any, of (a) the aggregate amount targeted to be paid or applied pursuant to Sections 3.07(a) through (g) for any Distribution Date over (b) the Card Series Principal Amounts (excluding any amounts to be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.28(a)) for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that the Issuer, when authorized by an Officer’s Certificate, may amend or otherwise modify this definition of Series Principal Amounts Shortfall provided the Note Rating Agencies confirm in writing that the amendment or modification will not cause a Ratings Effect with respect to any Outstanding Notes.

Servicer” means the Servicer under the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Servicing Fee Shortfall” means for any Distribution Date, the excess, if any, of (a) the aggregate amount payable to the Servicer pursuant to Section 3.01(d) with respect to such Distribution Date, and (b) the aggregate amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts available after giving effect to Section 3.01(c) on such Distribution Date.

Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts” means, with respect to any Distribution Date with respect to any Series of Notes, either (a) the amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for such Distribution Date available after application in accordance with Sections 3.01(a) through (k) or (b) the amounts allocated to other Series of Notes or Investor Certificates which the applicable Indenture Supplements for such Series of Notes or the applicable Series Supplements for such Investor Certificates specify are to be treated as “Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts.

Shared Excess Principal Amounts” means, with respect to any Distribution Date with respect to any Series of Notes, either (a) the amount of Card Series Principal Amounts for such Distribution Date available after application in accordance with Sections 3.07(a) through (e) or (b) the amounts allocated to other Series of Notes or Investor Certificates which the applicable Indenture Supplements for such Series specify are to be treated as “Shared Excess Principal Amounts.”

Spot Exchange Rate,” for any Tranche of Notes, has the meaning specified in the related Terms Document.

Subordinated Class” means (a) with respect to the Class A Notes, the Class B Notes, Class C Notes or Class D Notes, (b) with respect to the Class B Notes, the Class C Notes or Class D Notes, and (c) with respect to the Class C Notes, the Class D Notes.

Targeted Interest Deposit Amount” means, with respect to the Card Series Notes for any Distribution Date, the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited in the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02 for such Distribution Date.

 

-22-


Targeted Principal Deposit Amount” means, with respect to the Card Series Notes for any Distribution Date, the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited in the Principal Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.10 for such Distribution Date.

Threshold Conditions” shall mean the conditions listed on Exhibit D, which Exhibit D may be amended, modified or supplemented by the Issuer upon receipt of the prior written consent of the Note Rating Agencies.

Weighted Average Interest Rates” means, with respect to any Outstanding Notes of a Class or Tranche of the Card Series, or of all of the Outstanding Notes of the Card Series, on any date, the weighted average (weighted based on the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the related Notes on such date) of the following rates of interest:

(a) in the case of a Tranche of Dollar Interest-bearing Notes with no Derivative Agreement for interest, the annualized rate of interest applicable to that Tranche on that date;

(b) in the case of a Tranche of Discount Notes, the rate of accretion (converted to an annualized accrual rate) of that Tranche on that date;

(c) in the case of a Tranche of Notes with a payment due under a Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, the annualized rate at which payments by the Issuer to the applicable Derivative Counterparty accrue on that date (prior to the netting of such payments, if applicable); and

(d) in the case of a Tranche of Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, the annualized rate specified for that date in the related Terms Document.

Section 1.02. Governing Law. THIS INDENTURE SUPPLEMENT WILL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, INCLUDING SECTION 5-1401 OF THE GENERAL OBLIGATION LAW, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 1.03. Counterparts. This Indenture Supplement may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which so executed will be deemed to be an original, but all such counterparts will together constitute but one and the same instrument.

Section 1.04. Ratification of Indenture and Asset Pool 1 Supplement. As supplemented by this Indenture Supplement, the Indenture and the Asset Pool 1 Supplement are in all respects ratified and confirmed and the Indenture and the Asset Pool 1 Supplement as so supplemented by this Indenture Supplement shall be read, taken and construed as one and the same instrument.

[END OF ARTICLE I]

 

-23-


ARTICLE II

The Notes

Section 2.01. Creation and Designation.

(a) There is hereby created a Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes to be issued pursuant to the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement and this Indenture Supplement to be known as “Capital One Multi-Asset Execution Trust, Card Series” or the “Card Series Notes.” The Card Series Notes will be issued in four Classes, the first of which shall be known as the “Card Series Class A Notes,” the second of which shall be known as the “Card Series Class B Notes,” the third of which shall be known as the “Card Series Class C Notes” and the fourth of which shall be known as the “Card Series Class D Notes.”

(b) The Card Series shall be an Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A and an Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A, and shall not be in any other Group. The Card Series Notes shall not be subordinated to any other Series of Notes.

(c) Notwithstanding the allocation provisions of the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement, each additional Asset Pool Supplement, this Indenture Supplement and the Indenture Supplements for each other Series of Notes, if any, to the extent that the Card Series Noteholders are deemed to have any interest in any assets of the Issuer allocated to other Series of Notes secured by Asset Pool 1 or another Asset Pool, the Card Series Noteholders agree by acceptance of their Card Series Notes that their interest in those assets is subordinate to claims or rights of the Noteholders of such other Series of Notes to those other assets. Further, the Card Series Noteholders shall agree by their acceptance of their Card Series Notes that such agreement constitutes a subordination agreement for purposes of Section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code.

Section 2.02. New Issuances of Notes. The Issuer may issue new Tranches of Notes (including additional Notes of an Outstanding Tranche) to be included in the Card Series, so long as the following conditions precedent are satisfied:

(i) on or before the date that the new issuance is to occur, the Issuer shall have delivered to the Indenture Trustee a Terms Document relating to the applicable Tranche of Notes;

(ii) if the issuance of Notes results in an increase in the targeted deposit amount of any Class C Reserve sub-Account of a Tranche of Class C Notes or any Class D Reserve sub-Account of a Tranche of Class D Notes, on such issuance date the Issuer shall have funded such increase with a cash deposit to such Class C Reserve sub-Account or Class D Reserve sub-Account, as applicable;

(iii) unless the Threshold Conditions with respect to the related Class of Notes have been satisfied, the conditions specified in Section 310 of the Indenture, as applicable, are satisfied;

 

-24-


(iv) immediately after giving effect to such issuance, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class B Notes in the Card Series must be at least equal to the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series;

(v) immediately after giving effect to such issuance, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class C Notes in the Card Series must be at least equal to the sum of (x) the aggregate Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes equal to zero and (y) the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series;

(vi) immediately after giving effect to such issuance, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Class D Notes in the Card Series must be at least equal to the greater of (A) the sum of (x) the aggregate Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes of zero and (y) the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series and (B) the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class C Notes in the Card Series; and

(vii) any other conditions specified in the related Terms Document.

[END OF ARTICLE II]

 

-25-


ARTICLE III

Allocations, Deposits and Payments

Section 3.01. Allocations of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts. On each Distribution Date, the Indenture Trustee will apply Card Series Finance Charge Amounts, as follows:

(a) first, to make the targeted deposits with respect to the Class A Notes to the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02;

(b) second, to make the targeted deposits with respect to the Class B Notes to the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02;

(c) third, to make the targeted deposits with respect to the Class C Notes to the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02;

(d) fourth, to pay the Card Series Servicing Fee plus any previously due and unpaid Card Series Servicing Fee to the Servicer;

(e) fifth, to make the targeted deposits with respect to the Class D Notes to the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02;

(f) sixth, to be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts for application in accordance with Section 3.07 in an amount equal to the Card Series Defaulted Amount, if any, for the preceding Monthly Period;

(g) seventh, to be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts for application in accordance with Section 3.07 in an amount equal to the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits, if any, of all Card Series Notes;

(h) eighth, to make the targeted deposit to the Accumulation Reserve Account, if any, pursuant to Section 3.24;

(i) ninth, to make the targeted deposit to the Class C Reserve Account, if any, pursuant to Section 3.22;

(j) tenth, to make the targeted deposit to the Class D Reserve Account, if any, pursuant to Section 3.29;

(k) eleventh, to make any other payment or deposit required by the Terms Documents of any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes;

(l) twelfth, to be treated as Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts for application in accordance with Section 3.27;

 

-26-


(m) thirteenth, to make any other payment or deposit required by the Terms Documents of any Class or Tranche of Card Series Notes; and

(n) fourteenth, to the holder of Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or, provided that the conditions set forth in Section 10.02 of the Trust Agreement with respect to transfers of a portion of the Beneficial Interest are met, to the designee of the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest as though such designee were a transferee of such portion.

Section 3.02. Targeted Deposits of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts to the Interest Funding Account. The aggregate amount of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts targeted to be deposited into the Interest Funding Account for each Tranche within the related Class of Notes pursuant to Sections 3.01(a), (b), (c) or (e) on each Distribution Date is equal to the sum of the following amounts. The targeted deposit on any Distribution Date will also include any shortfall in the targeted deposit with respect to any prior Distribution Date which has not been previously deposited.

(a) Specified Deposits. If the Terms Document for a Tranche of Notes specifies a deposit to be made to the Interest Funding sub-Account for that Tranche, the deposit targeted for that Tranche of Notes with respect to that Distribution Date is such specified amount.

(b) Interest Payments. The deposit targeted for any Tranche of Outstanding Interest-bearing Notes on each Distribution Date will be equal to the amount of interest accrued on the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of that Tranche during the period from and including the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date in the prior Monthly Period to but excluding the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date for the current Monthly Period.

(c) Amounts Owed to Derivative Counterparties. If a Tranche of Outstanding Dollar Notes or foreign currency Notes that has a Performing or non-Performing Derivative Agreement for interest provides for a payment to the applicable Derivative Counterparty, the deposit targeted for that Tranche of Notes on each Distribution Date with respect to any payment to the Derivative Counterparty will be specified in the related Terms Document.

(d) Discount Notes. The deposit targeted for a Tranche of Outstanding Discount Notes on each Distribution Date is the amount of accretion of principal of that Tranche of Notes from and including the prior Monthly Principal Accrual Date in the related Monthly Period (or in the case of the first Monthly Principal Accrual Date with respect to any Tranche of Discount Notes, from and including the date of issuance of that Tranche of Notes) to but excluding the first Monthly Principal Accrual Date for the next month.

(e) Additional Interest. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable Terms Document, the deposit targeted for any Tranche of Outstanding Notes (other than Discount Notes) for any month that has previously due and unpaid interest will include the interest accrued on that overdue interest during the period from and including the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date in the prior month to but excluding the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date for the current month at the rate of interest applicable to the principal of that Tranche during that period.

 

-27-


Section 3.03. Allocations of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts to Interest Funding sub-Accounts. The aggregate amount to be deposited to the Interest Funding Account for a Class of Notes pursuant to Sections 3.01(a), (b), (c) or (e) for each Monthly Period will be allocated, and a portion deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Account for each Tranche of Notes within such Class, as follows:

(a) Card Series Finance Charge Amounts are at Least Equal to Targeted Amounts. If the amount of funds available for a Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01 (after giving effect to any previous deposits pursuant to Section 3.01 on such Distribution Date) is at least equal to the aggregate amount of the deposits and payments targeted by Section 3.02 for the related Class of Notes, then the targeted amount of each such deposit and payment will be made to the applicable Interest Funding sub-Accounts.

(b) Card Series Finance Charge Amounts are Less than Targeted Amounts. If the amount of funds available for a Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01 (after giving effect to any previous deposits pursuant to Section 3.01 on such Distribution Date) is less than the aggregate amount of the deposits targeted by Section 3.02 for the related Class of Notes, then the amount available will be allocated to each Tranche within such Class of Notes pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the aggregate amount of the deposits targeted by Section 3.02 with respect to that Tranche of Notes, to (B) the aggregate amount of the deposits targeted by Section 3.02 with respect to all Tranches within the related Class of Notes.

Section 3.04. Amounts to be Treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts; Payments Received from Derivative Counterparties for Interest in Foreign Currencies; Other Deposits to the Interest Funding sub-Accounts. The following deposits and payments will be made on the following dates:

(a) Amounts to be Treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts. In addition to Asset Pool 1 Finance Charge Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.2(a) of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement, the following amounts shall be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for application in accordance with this Article III for any Monthly Period:

(i) PFA Accumulation Earnings Shortfall. The aggregate amount withdrawn from the Accumulation Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.25(a) will be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for such Monthly Period.

(ii) PFA Prefunding Earnings Shortfall. On or prior to each Distribution Date, the Issuer will calculate the PFA Prefunding Earnings Shortfall (if any) for the Principal Funding sub-Account for each Tranche of Notes. If there is any PFA Prefunding Earnings Shortfall for any Principal Funding sub-Account for that Distribution Date, or any unpaid PFA Prefunding Earnings Shortfall for any Principal Funding sub-Account from any earlier Distribution Date, in each case for any Tranche of Notes, the Issuer will notify the Transferor and the Master Trust pursuant to the related Series Supplement of that amount. On each Distribution Date, the Indenture Trustee will treat as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts the amount received by the Issuer in respect of segregated transferor interest finance charge amounts payable to the Issuer pursuant to the related

 

-28-


Series Supplement with respect to each Principal Funding sub-Account, if any; provided, however, that any such amounts paid to the Issuer following an insolvency of the related transferor will be deposited directly into the applicable Interest Funding sub-Accounts pro rata based on the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for each Tranche with prefunded amounts in its Principal Funding sub-Account.

(iii) Dollar Payments from Derivative Counterparties for Interest. Dollar payments received under Derivative Agreements for interest for any Tranche of Notes will be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts.

(iv) Sub-Account Earnings. Any PFA Accumulation Earnings, any PFA Prefunding Earnings, any Accumulation Reserve Account Earnings and any Interest Funding sub-Account Earnings for any Distribution Date will be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for such Distribution Date.

(v) Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts. Any Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts allocable to the Card Series will be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts pursuant to Section 3.27(a).

(vi) Other Amounts. This Indenture Supplement or the Terms Document for any Tranche of Notes may include additional amounts which are to be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for any Distribution Date.

(b) Payments Received From Derivative Counterparties. Payments received under Derivative Agreements for Notes with interest payable in foreign currencies will be applied as specified in the applicable Terms Document.

(c) Other Deposits to the Interest Funding sub-Accounts.

(i) Class C Reserve Account. Withdrawals made from the Class C Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.23(a) will be deposited into the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account on the Distribution Date.

(ii) Class D Reserve Account. Withdrawals made from the Class D Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.30(a) will be deposited into the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account on the Distribution Date.

(iii) Asset Sales Proceeds. Asset Sales Proceeds received by the Issuer pursuant to Section 3.20(c)(ii) for any Tranche of Notes will be deposited into the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account on the date of receipt by the Issuer.

(iv) Other Amounts. This Indenture Supplement or the Terms Document for any Tranche may include additional amounts which are to be deposited into the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account on the Distribution Date.

 

-29-


Section 3.05. Allocations of Reductions to the Nominal Liquidation Amount Due to Investor Charge-Offs. On each Distribution Date when there is an Investor Charge-Off with respect to the related Monthly Period, the amount of such Investor Charge-Off will be allocated (and reallocated) on that date to each Tranche of Notes as set forth in this Section. In the case of each Tranche of Notes, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of each such Tranche of Notes will be reduced by an amount equal to the amounts that are allocated or reallocated to that Tranche of Notes pursuant to this Section 3.05, less the amounts that are reallocated from that Tranche of Notes to other Notes pursuant to this Section 3.05.

(a) Initial Allocation. Initially, the amount of each Investor Charge-Off will be allocated to each Tranche of Outstanding Notes in the Card Series pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Card Series Notes, each as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period. Any such allocation (or portion thereof) that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Outstanding Notes in the Card Series as set forth in this clause (a), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (a)) of any Tranche of Notes be reduced below zero.

(b) Reallocation from Class A Notes. (i) Immediately after giving effect to clause (a) above, the amount allocated to each Tranche of Class A Notes pursuant to clause (a) above, subject to the limitation in clause (e) below, will be reallocated to the Class B Notes, in an amount (not less than zero) not to exceed:

(x) the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, minus

(y) the product of (A) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and (B) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (b)(i)(x) above and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class B Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business of the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(ii) The amount allocated to each Tranche of Class A Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and not reallocated to the Class B Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (b)(i) above and clause (e) below, subject to the limitation in clause (e) below, will be reallocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount (not less than zero) not to exceed:

(x) the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, minus

(y) the product of (A) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and (B) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (b)(ii)(x) above and the denominator of which is the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class C Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

 

-30-


(iii) The amount allocated to each Tranche of Class A Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and not reallocated to the Class B Notes or the Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clauses (b)(i) and (b)(ii) above and clause (e) below, subject to the limitation in clause (e) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount (not less then zero) not to exceed:

(x) the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, minus

(y) the product of (A) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and (B) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (b)(iii)(x) above and the denominator of which is the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class D Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(c) Reallocation from Class B Notes. (i) Immediately after giving effect to clause (b) above, the amount allocated to each Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to clause (a) above or reallocated to such Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to clause (b)(i) above, subject to the limitation in clause (e) below, will be reallocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount (not less than zero) not to exceed:

(x) the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, minus

(y) the sum of:

(A) the product of (1) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and (2) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (c)(i)(x) above and the denominator of which is the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class C Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, plus

(B) the product of (1) the aggregate amount reallocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (b)(ii) above and (B) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (c)(i)(x) above and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(ii) The amount allocated to each Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to clause (a) above or reallocated to such Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to clause (b)(i) above and not

 

-31-


reallocated to the Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (c)(i) above and clause (e) below, subject to the limitation in clause (e) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount (not less than zero) not to exceed:

(x) the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, minus

(y) the sum of:

(A) the product of (1) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and (2) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (c)(ii)(x) above and the denominator of which is the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class D Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, plus

(B) the product of (1) the aggregate amount reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clause (b)(iii) above and (B) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (c)(ii)(x) above and the denominator of which is the aggregate Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(d) Reallocation from Class C Notes. Immediately after giving effect to clause (c) above, the amount allocated to each Tranche of Class C Notes pursuant to clause (a) above or reallocated to such Tranche of Class C Notes pursuant to clause (b)(ii) or (c)(i) above, subject to the limitation in clause (e) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount (not less than zero) not to exceed:

(x) the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, minus

(y) the sum of:

(A) the product of (1) the aggregate amount allocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clause (a) above and (2) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (d)(x) above and the denominator of which is the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class D Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period, plus

(B) the product of (1) the aggregate amount reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clauses (b)(iii) and (c)(ii) above and (2) a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount determined pursuant to clause (d)(x) above and

 

-32-


the denominator of which is the aggregate Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class C Notes in the Card Series as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(e) (i) The amount reallocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (b)(i) above will be applied to each Tranche of Class B Notes outstanding as of the last day of the preceding Monthly Period pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Class B Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class B Notes in the Card Series, each as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period. Any such reallocation (or portion thereof) that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Class B Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Class B Notes as set forth in this clause (e)(i), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (e)(i)) of any Tranche of Class B Notes be reduced below zero.

(ii) The amount reallocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (b)(ii) or (c)(i) above, in each case, will be applied to each Tranche of Class C Notes outstanding as of the last day of the preceding Monthly Period pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class C Notes in the Card Series, in each case, as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period. Any such reallocation (or portion thereof) that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Class C Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Class C Notes as set forth in this clause (e)(ii), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (e)(ii)) of any Tranche of Class C Notes be reduced below zero.

(iii) The amount reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clause (b)(iii), (c)(ii) or (d) above, in each case, will be applied to each Tranche of Class D Notes outstanding as of the last day of the preceding Monthly Period pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Class D Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class D Notes in the Card Series, in each case, as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period. Any such reallocation (or portion thereof) that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Class D Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Class D Notes as set forth in this clause (e)(iii), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (e)(iii)) of any Tranche of Class D Notes be reduced below zero.

Section 3.06. Allocations of Reimbursements of Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits. If, as of any Distribution Date, there are Card Series Finance Charge Amounts available pursuant to Section 3.01(g) to reimburse any Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits as of such Distribution Date, such funds will be allocated to each Tranche of Notes as follows:

(a) first, to each Tranche of Class A Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit thereof to the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficits of all Tranches of Class A Notes, but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such a Tranche of Notes be increased above the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche;

 

-33-


(b) second, to each Tranche of Class B Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit thereof to the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit of all Tranches of Class B Notes, but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such a Tranche of Notes be increased above the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche;

(c) third, to each Tranche of Class C Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit thereof to the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit of all Tranches of Class C Notes, but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such a Tranche of Notes be increased above the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche; and

(d) fourth, to each Tranche of Class D Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit thereof to the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit of all Tranches of Class D Notes, but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such a Tranche of Notes be increased above the Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche.

Section 3.07. Application of Card Series Principal Amounts. On each Distribution Date, the Indenture Trustee will apply Card Series Principal Amounts as follows:

(a) Class A Interest Funding Account Shortfalls. First, with respect to each Monthly Period, if after giving effect to deposits to be made with respect to such Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01(a) any Tranche of Class A Notes has not received the full amount targeted to be deposited pursuant to Section 3.02 with respect to that Monthly Period, then Card Series Principal Amounts (in an amount not to exceed the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation, the Class C Principal Allocation and the Class D Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period) will be allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account of each such Tranche of Class A Notes pro rata based on, in the case of each such Tranche of Class A Notes, the lesser of the following amounts:

(i) the amount of the deficiency in the targeted amount to be deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class A Notes; and

(ii) an amount equal to the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes (determined after giving effect to Section 3.05, but prior to giving effect to this Section 3.07).

(b) Class B Interest Funding Account Shortfalls. Second, with respect to each Monthly Period, if after giving effect to deposits to be made with respect to such Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01(b) any Tranche of Class B Notes has not received the full amount targeted to be deposited pursuant to Section 3.02 with respect to that Monthly Period, then Card Series Principal Amounts (in an amount, not less than zero, not to exceed the sum of the Class B

 

-34-


Principal Allocation, the Class C Principal Allocation and the Class D Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period minus the greater of (x) the Class B Principal Allocation for such Monthly Period and (y) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts applied pursuant to clause (a) above) will be allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account of each such Tranche of Class B Notes pro rata based on, in the case of each such Tranche of Class B Notes, the lesser of the following amounts:

(i) the amount of the deficiency in the targeted amount to be deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class B Notes; and

(ii) an amount equal to the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes (determined after giving effect to Sections 3.05 and 3.08(a) through (c)).

(c) Class C Interest Funding Account Shortfalls. Third, with respect to each Monthly Period, if after giving effect to deposits to be made with respect to such Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01(c) any Tranche of Class C Notes has not received the full amount targeted to be deposited pursuant to Section 3.02 with respect to that Monthly Period, then Card Series Principal Amounts (in an amount, not less than zero, not to exceed the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation, the Class C Principal Allocation and the Class D Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period minus the greater of (x) the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation and the Class C Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period and (y) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts applied pursuant to clauses (a) and (b) above) will be allocated to the Interest Funding sub-Account of each such Tranche of Class C Notes pro rata based on, in the case of each such Tranche of Class C Notes, the lesser of the following amounts:

(i) the amount of the deficiency in the targeted amount to be deposited into the Interest Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class C Notes; and

(ii) an amount equal to the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes (determined after giving effect to Sections 3.05 and 3.08(a) through (e)).

(d) Class A Servicing Fee Shortfalls. Fourth, with respect to each Monthly Period, if there is a Servicing Fee Shortfall allocated to any Tranche of Class A Notes pursuant to Section 3.09, then Card Series Principal Amounts (in an amount, not less than zero, not to exceed the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation, the Class C Principal Allocation and the Class D Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period minus the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts reallocated pursuant to clauses (a) through (c) above) will be paid to the Servicer in an amount equal to, and allocated to each such Tranche of Class A Notes pro rata based on, in the case of each such Tranche of Class A Notes, the lesser of the following amounts:

(i) the amount of the Servicing Fee Shortfall allocated to such Tranche of Class A Notes; and

(ii) an amount equal to the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes (determined after giving effect to Sections 3.05 and 3.08(a) through (f)).

 

-35-


(e) Class B Servicing Fee Shortfalls. Fifth, with respect to each Monthly Period, if there is a Servicing Fee Shortfall allocated to any Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to Section 3.09, then Card Series Principal Amounts (in an amount, not less than zero, not to exceed the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation, the Class C Principal Allocation and the Class D Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period minus the greater of (x) the Class B Principal Allocation for such Monthly Period and (y) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts reallocated pursuant to clauses (a) through (d) above) will be paid to the Servicer in an amount equal to, and allocated to each such Tranche of Class B Notes pro rata based on, in the case of each such Tranche of Class B Notes, the lesser of the following amounts:

(i) the amount of the remaining Servicing Fee Shortfall allocated to such Tranche of Class B Notes; and

(ii) an amount equal to the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes (determined after giving effect to Sections 3.05 and 3.08(a) through (i)).

(f) Class C Servicing Fee Shortfalls. Sixth, with respect to each Monthly Period, if there is a Servicing Fee Shortfall allocated to any Tranche of Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.09, then Card Series Principal Amounts (in an amount, not less than zero, not to exceed the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation, the Class C Principal Allocation and the Class D Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period minus the greater of (x) the sum of the Class B Principal Allocation and the Class C Principal Allocation, each for such Monthly Period and (y) the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts reallocated pursuant to clauses (a) through (e) above) will be paid to the Servicer in an amount equal to, and allocated to each such Tranche of Class C Notes pro rata based on, in the case of each such Tranche of Class C Notes, the lesser of the following amounts:

(i) the amount of the Servicing Fee Shortfall allocated to such Tranche of Class C Notes; and

(ii) an amount equal to the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes (determined after giving effect to Sections 3.05 and 3.08(a) through (k)).

(g) Principal Funding Account. Seventh, to make the targeted deposits to the Principal Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.10;

(h) Shared Excess Principal Amounts. Eighth, to be treated as Shared Excess Principal Amounts for application in accordance with Section 3.28; and

 

-36-


(i) Transferor. Ninth, to the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or, provided that the conditions set forth in Section 10.02 of the Trust Agreement with respect to transfers of a portion of the Beneficial Interest are met, to the designee of the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest as though such designee were a transferee of such portion.

Section 3.08. Allocation of Reductions of Nominal Liquidation Amount of Subordinated Notes from Reallocations of Card Series Principal Amounts to Cover Interest Funding Account Shortfalls or Servicing Fee Shortfalls. On each Distribution Date when Card Series Principal Amounts are deposited in the Interest Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Notes or paid to the Servicer pursuant to Section 3.07, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of Subordinated Notes will be reduced on that date as set forth in this Section. In the case of each Tranche of Notes, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of each such Tranche of Notes will be reduced by an amount equal to the amounts of such deposits or payments which are allocated or reallocated to that Tranche of Notes, less the amount of Card Series Principal Amounts that are reallocated from that Tranche of Notes to other Notes.

(a) Class A Interest Funding Account Shortfalls. (i) Immediately after giving effect to Section 3.07(a), the amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(a), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class B Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(ii) The amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(a), and not reallocated to the Class B Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (a)(i) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(iii) The amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(a), and not reallocated to the Class B Notes or Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clauses(a)(i) and (a)(ii) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

(b) (i) Immediately after giving effect to clause (a) above, the amount allocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (a)(i), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clause (a) above.

(ii) The amount allocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (a)(i) and not reallocated to the Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (b)(i) above

 

-37-


and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clause (a) above.

(c) Immediately after giving effect to clause (b) above, the amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (a)(iii) plus the amount reallocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (b)(i) above, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) and (b) above.

(d) Class B Interest Funding Account Shortfalls. (i) Immediately after giving effect to Section 3.07(b), the amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(b), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (c) above.

(ii) The amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(b), and not reallocated to the Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (d)(i) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (c) above.

(e) Immediately after giving effect to clause (d) above, the amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (d)(i), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (d) above.

(f) Class C Interest Funding Account Shortfalls. Immediately after giving effect to Section 3.07(c), the amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(c), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (e) above.

(g) Class A Servicing Fee Shortfalls. (i) Immediately after giving effect to Section 3.07(d), the amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(d), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class B Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (f) above.

 

-38-


(ii) The amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(d), and not reallocated to the Class B Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (g)(i) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (f) above.

(iii) The amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(d), and not reallocated to the Class B Notes or Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clauses(g)(i) and (g)(ii) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (f) above.

(h) (i) Immediately after giving effect to clause (g) above, the amount reallocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (g)(i), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (g) above.

(ii) The amount allocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (g)(i) and not reallocated to the Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (h)(i) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (g) above.

(i) Immediately after giving effect to clause (h) above, the amount allocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (g)(iii) plus the amount reallocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (h)(i) above, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (h) above.

(j) Class B Servicing Fee Shortfalls. (i) Immediately after giving effect to Section 3.07(e), the amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(e), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class C Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (i) above.

(ii) The amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(e), and not reallocated to the Class C Notes due to the limitations set forth in clause (j)(i) above and clause (m) below, subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (i) above.

 

-39-


(k) Immediately after giving effect to clause (j) above, the amount reallocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (j)(i), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be reallocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (j) above.

(l) Class C Servicing Fee Shortfalls. Immediately after giving effect to Section 3.07(f), the amount of Card Series Principal Amount applied pursuant to Section 3.07(f), subject to the limitation in clause (m) below, will be allocated to the Class D Notes, in an amount not to exceed the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes after giving effect to clauses (a) through (k) above.

(m) General. (i) The amount allocated to the Class B Notes pursuant to clause (a)(i) or (g)(i) above will be applied to each Tranche of Class B Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Class B Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class B Notes in the Card Series, with respect to clause (a)(i), after giving effect to Section 3.05, and with respect to clause (g)(i), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (f) above. Any such allocation that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Class B Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Class B Notes as set forth in this clause (m)(i), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (m)(i)) of any Tranche of Class B Notes be reduced below zero.

(ii) The amount allocated or reallocated to the Class C Notes pursuant to clause (a)(ii), (b)(i), (d)(i), (g)(ii), (h)(i) or (j)(i) above will be applied to each Tranche of Class C Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class C Notes in the Card Series, with respect to clauses (a)(ii) and (b)(i), after giving effect to Section 3.05, with respect to clause (d)(i), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (c) above, with respect to clauses (g)(ii) and (h)(i), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (f) above, and with respect to clause (j)(i), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (i) above. Any such allocation that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Class C Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Class C Notes as set forth in this clause (m)(ii), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (m)(ii)) of any Tranche of Class C Notes be reduced below zero.

(iii) The amount allocated or reallocated to the Class D Notes pursuant to clause (a)(iii), (b)(ii), (c), (d)(ii), (e), (f), (g)(iii), (h)(ii), (i), (j)(ii), (k) or (l) above will be applied to each Tranche of Class D Notes pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal

 

-40-


Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Class D Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all the Class D Notes in the Card Series, with respect to clauses (a)(iii), (b)(ii) and (c), after giving effect to Section 3.05, with respect to clauses (d)(ii) and (e), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (c) above, with respect to clause (f), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (e) above, with respect to clauses (g)(iii), (h)(ii) and (i), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (f) above, with respect to clauses (j)(ii) and (k), after giving effect to Section 3.05 and clauses (a) through (i) above, and with respect to clause (l), after giving effect to clauses (a) through (k) above. Any such allocation that would otherwise have reduced the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Class D Notes below zero will be reallocated to the remaining Tranches of Class D Notes as set forth in this clause (m)(iii), but in no event will the Nominal Liquidation Amount (after giving effect to this clause (m)(iii)) of any Tranche of Class D Notes be reduced below zero.

Section 3.09. Allocation of Servicing Fee Shortfalls. On each Distribution Date, if after giving effect to payments to be made with respect to the related Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01(d), the Servicer has not received the full amount to be paid pursuant to Section 3.01(d), the aggregate amount of such shortfall will be allocated to each Tranche of Outstanding Notes in the Card Series pro rata based on the ratio of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Notes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the Card Series Notes, each as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period.

Section 3.10. Targeted Deposits of Card Series Principal Amounts to the Principal Funding Account. With respect to any Monthly Period, the amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Notes will be the sum of (i) the amount determined pursuant to clause (a), (b), (c), (d) or (e) below with respect to such Tranche for such Monthly Period, as applicable, or if more than one such clause is applicable, the highest amount determined pursuant to any one of such clauses, and (ii) any deposit targeted pursuant to clause (i) with respect to such Tranche for any prior Monthly Period but for which the full targeted deposit was not made, but in no case more than the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche (computed immediately before giving effect to such deposit but after giving effect to any Investor Charge-Offs and any reallocations of Card Series Principal Amounts on such date).

(a) Principal Payment Date. With respect to the Monthly Period immediately preceding each Principal Payment Date for a Tranche of Notes, the deposit targeted for that Tranche of Notes, unless otherwise specified in the related Terms Document, is equal to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of that Tranche of Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the Monthly Period preceding such Monthly Period (determined after giving effect to any Investor Charge-Offs and any reallocations, payments or deposits of Card Series Principal Amounts occurring on the following Distribution Date).

(b) Budgeted Deposits.

(i) Subject to Section 3.10(d), with respect to each Monthly Period, beginning with the Accumulation Commencement Date, the deposit targeted to be made into the

 

-41-


Principal Funding sub-Account for that Tranche will be the Accumulation Period Amount for that Tranche specified in the applicable Terms Document, or if no such amount is specified, beginning with the twelfth Monthly Period before the Monthly Period in which the Expected Principal Payment Date of that Tranche of Notes occurs, an amount equal to one-twelfth of the expected Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Notes as of such Expected Principal Payment Date.

(ii) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in clause (i), on or before the Distribution Date immediately preceding the first Business Day of the month that is twelve (12) months prior to the Expected Principal Payment Date of any Tranche of Notes, and each determination date thereafter until the Accumulation Commencement Date, the Issuer will determine the “Accumulation Period Length” which will equal the number of whole months such that the Accumulation Period Amount for such Tranche for the Monthly Period immediately preceding the Expected Principal Payment Date, when aggregated with the Accumulation Period Amounts for such Tranche for each preceding Monthly Period, will equal or exceed the Initial Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche; provided, however, that the Accumulation Period Length will not be determined to be less than one month; provided further, however, that the determination of the Accumulation Period Length may be changed at any time if the Note Rating Agencies provide prior written confirmation that a Ratings Effect will not occur with respect to such change.

(c) Prefunding of the Principal Funding Account of Senior Classes. If the Issuer determines as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period with respect to any Class A Notes, Class B Notes or Class C Notes that, after giving effect to all allocations and payments with respect to that Monthly Period, the Prefunding Target Amount of that Tranche will be greater than zero, the targeted deposit to the Principal Funding sub-Account for the affected Tranches will be the Prefunding Target Amounts for such Tranche.

(d) Event of Default, Early Redemption Event, Other Optional or Mandatory Redemption. If any Tranche of Notes has been accelerated during a Monthly Period after the occurrence of an Event of Default, or if an Early Redemption Event with respect to any Tranche of Notes occurs during such Monthly Period, or with respect to the Monthly Period immediately preceding any other date fixed for any other optional or mandatory redemption of any Tranche of Notes, the deposit targeted for that Tranche of Notes with respect to that Monthly Period and each following Monthly Period is equal to Nominal Liquidation Amount of that Tranche of Notes as of the close of business on the last day of the preceding Monthly Period (after taking into account any reallocations, payments or deposits occurring on the following Distribution Date).

(e) Amounts Owed to Derivative Counterparties. If a Tranche of Outstanding Dollar Notes or foreign currency Notes that has a Performing or non-Performing Derivative Agreement for principal provides for a payment to the applicable Derivative Counterparty, the deposit targeted for that Tranche of Notes on each Distribution Date with respect to any payment to the Derivative Counterparty will be specified in the related Terms Document.

 

-42-


Section 3.11. Allocations among Principal Funding sub-Accounts. Subject to the restrictions of Section 3.15, the aggregate amount of the deposits to be made to the Principal Funding Account for each Tranche of Notes pursuant to Section 3.10 for each Monthly Period will be allocated, and a portion deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account for each Tranche of Notes, as follows:

(a) Card Series Principal Amounts Equal to Targeted Amount. Subject to clause (c) below, if Card Series Principal Amounts remaining after giving effect to Sections 3.07(a) through (f) are equal to the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding Account for all Tranches of Notes pursuant to Section 3.10, then that targeted amount is deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account established for each Tranche.

(b) Card Series Principal Amounts Are Less Than Targeted Amounts. Subject to clause (c) below, if Card Series Principal Amounts remaining after giving effect to Sections 3.07(a) through (f) are less than the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding Account for all Tranches of Notes pursuant to Section 3.10, then the amount available will be deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account established for each Tranche in the following priority:

(i) first, the amount available will be allocated to the Class A Notes pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class A Notes pursuant to Section 3.10, to (B) the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for all Tranches of Class A Notes pursuant to Section 3.10;

(ii) second, the amount available after the application in clause (i) above will be allocated to the Class B Notes, pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class B Notes pursuant to Section 3.10, to (B) the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for all Tranches of Class B Notes pursuant to Section 3.10;

(iii) third, the amount available after the applications in clauses (i) and (ii) above will be allocated to the Class C Notes, pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.10, to (B) the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for all Tranches of Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.10; and

(iv) fourth, the amount available after the applications in clauses (i) through (iii) above will be allocated to the Class D Notes, pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.10, to (B) the aggregate amount targeted to be deposited into the Principal Funding sub-Account for all Tranches of Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.10.

 

-43-


(c) Reallocation of Deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of Subordinated Notes. If the restrictions of Section 3.15(a) prevent the deposit of Card Series Principal Amounts into the Principal Funding sub-Account of any Subordinated Note, the aggregate amount of Card Series Principal Amounts available to make the targeted deposit for such Tranche of Subordinated Notes will be allocated first, to each Tranche of Class A Notes pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class A Notes to (B) the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series, second, if applicable, to each Tranche of Class B Notes pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for such Tranche of Class B Notes to (B) the Required Subordinated Amount of Subordinated Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series and, third, if applicable, to each Tranche of Class C Notes pro rata based on the ratio of (A) the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for such Tranche of Class C Notes to (B) the Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class C Notes in the Card Series.

Section 3.12. Amounts to be Treated as Card Series Principal Amounts; Payments Received from Derivative Counterparties for Principal; Other Deposits to Principal Funding sub-Accounts. The following deposits and payments will be made on the following dates:

(a) Amounts to be Treated as Card Series Principal Amounts. In addition to Asset Pool 1 Principal Amounts allocated to the Card Series pursuant to Section 3.3 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement, the following amounts shall be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts for application in accordance with this Article III for any Monthly Period:

(i) Reallocated Card Series Finance Charge Amounts. Card Series Principal Amounts will include Card Series Finance Charge Amounts reallocated to be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.01(f) or 3.01(g).

(ii) Dollar Payments from Derivative Counterparties for Principal. Dollar payments received under Derivative Agreements for principal for any Tranche of Notes will be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts.

(iii) Shared Excess Principal Amounts. Any Shared Excess Principal Amounts allocable to the Card Series will be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.28(a).

(iv) Other Amounts. The Terms Document for any Tranche of Notes may include additional amounts which are to be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts for any Distribution Date.

(b) Payments Received from Derivative Counterparties. Payments received under Derivative Agreements for Notes with principal payable in foreign currencies will be applied as specified in the applicable Terms Document.

 

-44-


(c) Class C Reserve sub-Account. Withdrawals made from the Class C Reserve sub-Account for any Tranche of Class C Notes pursuant to Section 3.23(b) will be deposited into the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account on the Distribution Date.

(d) Class D Reserve sub-Account. Withdrawals made from the Class D Reserve sub-Account for any Tranche of Class D Notes pursuant to Section 3.30(b) will be deposited into the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account on the Distribution Date.

(e) Asset Sales Proceeds. Asset Sales Proceeds received pursuant to Section 3.20(c)(i) for any Tranche of Notes will be deposited into the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account on the date of receipt by the Issuer.

Section 3.13. Withdrawals from Interest Funding Account. Withdrawals made pursuant to this Section 3.13 with respect to any Tranche of Notes will be made from the Interest Funding sub-Account established for that Tranche only after all allocations and reallocations have been made pursuant to Sections 3.02, 3.03, 3.04 and 3.07. In no event will the aggregate amount of the withdrawals from an Interest Funding sub-Account for any month be more than the amount on deposit in the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account. A single Tranche of Notes may be entitled to more than one of the following withdrawals in any month.

(a) Withdrawals for Dollar Notes. On each Interest Payment Date (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to each Tranche of Dollar Notes, an amount equal to the interest due on the applicable Tranche of Notes on such Interest Payment Date (including any overdue and additional interest with respect to prior Interest Payment Dates) will be withdrawn from that Interest Funding sub-Account and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent(s) or as otherwise provided in the applicable Terms Document.

(b) Withdrawals for Foreign Currency Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for Interest. On each Interest Payment Date (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to a Tranche of foreign currency Notes that has a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, the amount specified in the applicable Terms Document will be withdrawn from that Interest Funding sub-Account and, if so specified in the applicable Terms Document, converted to the applicable foreign currency at the Spot Exchange Rate and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent(s) or as otherwise provided in the applicable Terms Document.

(c) Withdrawals for Discount Notes. On each applicable Principal Payment Date, with respect to each Tranche of Discount Notes, an amount equal to the amount of the accretion of principal of that Tranche of Notes from the prior Principal Payment Date (or, in the case of the first Principal Payment Date, the date of issuance of that Tranche) to but excluding the applicable Principal Payment Date will be withdrawn from that Interest Funding sub-Account and invested in the Invested Amount of any Collateral Certificate in Asset Pool 1 pursuant to Section 3.17.

(d) Withdrawals for Payments to Derivative Counterparties. On each date on which a payment is required to be made to the Derivative Counterparty under the applicable Derivative Agreement (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to any Tranche of

 

-45-


Notes which has a Performing or non-Performing Derivative Agreement for interest, an amount equal to the amount of the payment to be made to the Derivative Counterparty under the applicable Derivative Agreement (including any overdue payment and any additional interest on overdue payments) will be withdrawn from that Interest Funding sub-Account and paid to the applicable Derivative Counterparty or as otherwise provided in the applicable Terms Document.

(e) Excess Amounts. After payment in full of any Tranche of Notes, any amount remaining on deposit in the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account will be first, allocated among and deposited to the Interest Funding sub-Account of the Tranches of Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.03(b), second, allocated among and deposited to the Principal Funding sub-Account of the Tranches of Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.11(b), and third, paid to the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or, provided that the conditions set forth in Section 10.02 of the Trust Agreement with respect to transfers of a portion of the Beneficial Interest are met, to the designee of the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest as though such designee were a transferee of such portion.

If the aggregate amount available for withdrawal from an Interest Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Notes is less than all withdrawals required to be made from that Interest Funding sub-Account for that Tranche in a month after giving effect to all deposits, then the amounts on deposit in the Interest Funding sub-Account will be withdrawn and, if payable to more than one Person, applied pro rata based on the amounts of the withdrawals required to be made.

Section 3.14. Withdrawals from Principal Funding Account . Withdrawals made pursuant to this Section 3.14 with respect to any Tranche of Notes will be made from the Principal Funding sub-Accounts established for that Tranche only after all allocations have been made pursuant to Sections 3.10, 3.11 and 3.12. In no event will the amount of the withdrawal be more than the amount on deposit in the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account. A single Tranche may be entitled to more than one of the following withdrawals with respect to any Monthly Period.

(a) Withdrawals for Dollar Notes with no Derivative Agreement for Principal. On each applicable Principal Payment Date (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to each Tranche of Dollar Notes that has no Derivative Agreement for principal, an amount equal to the principal due on the applicable Tranche of Notes on the applicable Principal Payment Date will be withdrawn from such Principal Funding sub-Account and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent(s) or as otherwise provided by the applicable Terms Document.

(b) Withdrawals for Dollar or Foreign Currency Notes with Performing Derivative Agreements for Principal. On each date on which a payment is required under the applicable Derivative Agreement (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to any Tranche of Notes that has a Performing Derivative Agreement for principal, an amount equal to the amount of the payment to be made under the applicable Derivative Agreement will be withdrawn from such Principal Funding sub-Account and paid to the applicable Derivative Counterparty or as otherwise provided by the applicable Terms Document. The Issuer will direct the applicable Derivative Counterparty to remit its payments under the applicable Derivative Agreement to the applicable Paying Agent(s) or as otherwise provided by the applicable Terms Document.

 

-46-


(c) Withdrawals for Dollar Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for Principal. On each applicable Principal Payment Date (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to each Tranche of Dollar Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for principal, the amount specified in the applicable Terms Document will be withdrawn from such Principal Funding sub-Account and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent(s) or as otherwise provided by the applicable Terms Document.

(d) Withdrawals for Foreign Currency Notes with non-Performing Derivative Agreements for Principal. On each Principal Payment Date (or as specified in the applicable Terms Document) with respect to a Tranche of foreign currency Notes that has a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for principal, the amount specified in the applicable Terms Document will be withdrawn from such Principal Funding sub-Account and, if so specified in the applicable Terms Document, converted to the applicable foreign currency at the Spot Exchange Rate and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent(s) or as otherwise provided by the applicable Terms Document.

(e) Withdrawal of Prefunding Excess Amount. If the Issuer on any date determines with respect to any Class of Class A Note, Class B Notes or Class C Notes that, after giving effect to all issuances, deposits, allocations, reallocations and payments on such date, the Prefunding Excess Amount of that Class is greater than zero, that amount will be withdrawn from the Principal Funding sub-Account of that Class of Notes and first, allocated among and deposited to the Principal Funding sub-Account of the Tranches of Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.11(b), and then, paid to the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or, provided that the conditions set forth in Section 10.02 of the Trust Agreement with respect to transfers of a portion of the Beneficial Interest are met, to the designee of the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest as though such designee were a transferee of such portion.

(f) Legal Maturity Date. On the Legal Maturity Date of any Tranche, after giving effect to any deposits, allocations, reallocations, sales of Collateral or other payments to be made on that date, amounts on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account of any Tranche of a Subordinated Class of Notes will be applied to pay principal of that Tranche, to make a payment under a Derivative Agreement with respect to principal of that Tranche or to make other payments as specified in the related Terms Document.

(g) Excess Amounts. Upon payment in full of any Tranche of Notes, any remaining amount on deposit in the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account will be first, allocated among and deposited to the Interest Funding sub-Account of the Tranches of Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.03(b), second, allocated among and deposited to the Principal Funding sub-Account of the Tranches of Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.11(b), and third, paid to the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or, provided that the conditions set forth in Section 10.02 of the Trust Agreement with respect to transfers of a portion of the Beneficial Interest are met, to the designee of the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest as though such designee were a transferee of such portion.

 

-47-


If the aggregate amount available for withdrawal from a Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Notes is less than all withdrawals required to be made from that Principal Funding sub-Account for that Tranche in a month, then the amounts on deposit will be withdrawn and, if payable to more than one Person, applied pro rata based on the amounts of the withdrawals required to be made.

Section 3.15. Limit on Deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of Subordinated Note; Limit on Repayments of all Tranches.

(a) Limit on Deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of Subordinated Notes.

(i) No Card Series Principal Amounts will be deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account of any Tranche of Class B Notes of the Card Series, unless, after giving effect to such deposit and any reductions and reallocations on such date, including any resulting changes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount, the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all Class B Notes in the Card Series (other than the Class B Notes for which such deposit is targeted) is at least equal to the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series.

(ii) No Card Series Principal Amounts will be deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account of any Tranche of Class C Notes of the Card Series and no funds will be released from a Class C Reserve sub-Account to pay principal on any Tranche of Class C Notes, unless, after giving effect to such deposit or release and any reductions and reallocations on such date, including any resulting changes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount, the following conditions are satisfied:

(x) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all Class C Notes in the Card Series (other than the Class C Notes for which such deposit is targeted) is at least equal to the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series; and

(y) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all Class C Notes in the Card Series (other than the Class C Notes for which such deposit is targeted) is at least equal to the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series.

(iii) No Card Series Principal Amounts will be deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account of any Tranche of Class D Notes of the Card Series and no funds will be released from a Class D Reserve sub-Account to pay principal on any Tranche of Class D Notes, unless, after giving effect to such deposit or release and any reductions and reallocations on such date, including any resulting changes to the Nominal Liquidation Amount, the following conditions are satisfied:

(x) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all Class D Notes in the Card Series (other than the Class D Notes for which such deposit is targeted) is at least equal to the Class A Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class A Notes in the Card Series;

 

-48-


(y) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all Class D Notes in the Card Series (other than the Class D Notes for which such deposit is targeted) is at least equal to the Class B Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class B Notes in the Card Series; and

(z) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of all Class D Notes in the Card Series (other than the Class D Notes for which such deposit is targeted) is at least equal to the Class C Available Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Class C Notes in the Card Series.

(iv) Notwithstanding anything in the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement or this Indenture Supplement to the contrary, Card Series Principal Amounts will be deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account of a Subordinated Note, if and only to the extent that such deposit is not contrary to clause (a)(i), (a)(ii) or (a)(iii) above and (ii) the Prefunding Target Amount for each Senior Class of Notes is zero.

(v) This Section 3.15(a) shall not prevent deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of a Tranche of Subordinated Notes on the Legal Maturity Date of such Tranche (or, if the Legal Maturity Date of such Tranche is not a Distribution Date, on the Distribution Date immediately preceding such Legal Maturity Date).

(b) Limit on Repayments of all Tranches. No amounts on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class A Notes or Class B Notes will be applied to pay principal of that Tranche or to make a payment under a Derivative Agreement with respect to principal of that Tranche in excess of the highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of that Tranche (or, in the case of foreign currency notes, such other amount that may be specified in the related Terms Document). In the case of any Tranche of Class C Notes, no amounts on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account or, if applicable, a Class C Reserve sub-Account for any such Tranche will be applied to pay principal of that Tranche or to make a payment under a Derivative Agreement with respect to principal of that Tranche in excess of the highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of that Tranche (or, in the case of foreign currency notes, such other amount that may be specified in the related Terms Document). In the case of any Tranche of Class D Notes, no amounts on deposit in a Principal Funding sub-Account or, if applicable, a Class D Reserve sub-Account for any such Tranche will be applied to pay principal of that Tranche or to make a payment under a Derivative Agreement with respect to principal of that Tranche in excess of the highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of that Tranche (or, in the case of foreign currency notes, such other amount that may be specified in the related Terms Document).

 

-49-


Section 3.16. Calculation of Nominal Liquidation Amount. On or prior to each Distribution Date, the Issuer shall calculate the Nominal Liquidation Amount of each Tranche of Outstanding Notes in the Card Series, which shall be the following amount:

(a) as of the date of issuance of such Tranche of Notes, the Initial Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Notes; and

(b) thereafter, the sum of, without duplication:

(i) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche of Notes immediately after the prior date of determination; plus

(ii) the aggregate amount of any increases in the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Card Series Notes during the current Monthly Period due to the issuance of additional Notes of such Tranche of Card Series Notes since the prior date of determination; plus

(iii) with respect to any Tranche of Discount Notes, the aggregate amount of any accretions of principal on that Tranche paid to the Master Trust for investment in the Invested Amount pursuant to Section 3.17 since the prior date of determination; plus

(iv) the aggregate amount withdrawn from the Principal Funding sub-Account pursuant to Section 3.14(e) for such Tranche since the prior date of determination; plus

(v) such Tranche’s allocable share of all reimbursements of its Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit pursuant to Section 3.01(g) since the prior date of determination determined as set forth in Section 3.06; minus

(vi) such Tranche’s allocable share of all reallocations of Card Series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.07 since the prior date of determination, determined as set forth in Section 3.08; minus

(vii) the amount of the reduction of the Nominal Liquidation Amount of such Tranche resulting from an allocation of Investor Charge-Offs since the prior date of determination, determined as set forth in Section 3.05; minus

(viii) the amount deposited in the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche (after giving effect to any deposits, allocations, reallocations or withdrawals to be made on that day) since the prior date of determination;

provided, however, that (1) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of a Tranche of Notes may never be less than zero, (2) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of any Tranche of Notes may never be greater than the Outstanding principal amount of such Tranche and (3) the Nominal Liquidation Amount of any Tranche of Notes that has caused a sale of Collateral pursuant to Section 3.20 will be zero.

 

-50-


The Nominal Liquidation Amount for the Card Series will be the sum of the Nominal Liquidation Amounts of all of the Tranches of Notes of the Card Series.

Section 3.17. Reinvestment in the COMT Collateral Certificate. The amount of principal accreted on any Tranche of Discount Notes available pursuant to Section 3.13(c) will be paid to the Issuer to increase the Invested Amount of any Collateral Certificate in Asset Pool 1.

Section 3.18. Netting of Deposits and Payments. The Issuer, in its sole discretion, may make all deposits to Interest Funding sub-Accounts and Principal Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Sections 3.02 and 3.10 with respect to any Monthly Period net of, and after giving effect to, (a) all reallocations to be made pursuant to Section 3.07, (b) all payments to be made to Derivative Counterparties pursuant to Sections 3.13 and 3.14, (c) all reinvestments in the Invested Amount of the COMT Collateral Certificate to be made pursuant to Section 3.17 and (d) all payments to the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or its designee pursuant to Section 3.07(i).

Section 3.19. Pro rata Payments within a Tranche. All payments of principal, interest or other amounts to Holders of the Notes of a single Tranche will be made pro rata based on the Stated Principal Amount of their Notes.

Section 3.20. Sale of Collateral for Accelerated Notes.

(a) (i) If a Tranche of Notes has been accelerated pursuant to Section 602 of the Indenture following an Event of Default, the Indenture Trustee may, and at the direction of the Majority Holders of that Tranche of Notes will, sell Collateral (or interests therein) pledged for the benefit of Holders the Asset Pool 1 Notes in an amount up to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the affected Tranche plus any accrued, past due or additional interest on the affected Tranche.

(ii) Such a sale will be permitted only if at least one of the following conditions is met:

(A) the Holders of 90% of the aggregate Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of the accelerated Tranche of Notes consent;

(B) the net proceeds of such sale (plus amounts on deposit in the applicable sub-Accounts and payments to be received from any applicable Derivative Agreement, any Supplemental Credit Enhancement Provider or any Supplemental Liquidity Provider) would be sufficient to pay all amounts due on the accelerated Tranche of Notes; or

(C) the Indenture Trustee determines that the funds to be allocated to the accelerated Tranche of Notes, including (1) Card Series Finance Charge Amounts and Card Series Principal Amounts allocable to the accelerated Tranche of Notes, (2) payments to be received under any applicable Derivative Agreement, Supplemental Credit Enhancement Agreement or Supplemental

 

-51-


Liquidity Agreement and (3) amounts on deposit in the applicable sub-Accounts, may not be sufficient on any ongoing basis to make payments on the accelerated Tranche of Notes as such payments would have become due if such obligations had not been declared due and payable, and the Holders of 66 23% of the principal amount of the accelerated Tranche of Notes consent to the sale.

(iii) In the case of an acceleration of a Tranche of Notes of a Subordinated Class, if the provisions of Section 3.15 would prevent the payment of the accelerated Tranche of subordinated Notes, such sale will be delayed until a level of prefunding of the Principal Funding sub-Accounts for the Senior Classes of Notes of that Series has been reached such that the amount of such accelerated Tranche is no longer required to provide subordination for the Senior Classes of Notes.

(b) If the Nominal Liquidation Amount with respect to any Tranche of Notes is greater than zero on its Legal Maturity Date (after giving effect to any adjustments, deposits and distributions otherwise to be made on that Legal Maturity Date), the Indenture Trustee shall sell Collateral (or interests therein) pledged for the benefit of the Holders of the Asset Pool 1 Notes on that Legal Maturity Date in an amount up to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of the affected Tranche plus any accrued, past due and additional interest on the affected Tranche.

(c) Sales proceeds received with respect to a Tranche of Notes pursuant to clause (a) or (b) will be allocated in the following priority:

(i) first, to be deposited in the Principal Funding sub-Account for that Tranche of Notes, an amount up to the amount that would be necessary to increase the aggregate amount on deposit in such sub-Account to the principal amount for such Tranche of Notes (notwithstanding any limitation in Section 3.10 to the contrary); and

(ii) second, to be deposited in the Interest Funding sub-Account of that Tranche of Notes, the balance of such sales proceeds.

(d) Any amount remaining on deposit in the Interest Funding sub-Account for a Tranche of Notes that has caused a sale of Collateral pursuant to this Section 3.20 after final payment thereof pursuant to Section 3.5 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement will be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts.

Section 3.21. Calculation of Prefunding Target Amount.

(a) The Prefunding Target Amount for any Tranche of Class A Notes for any day during any Monthly Period means an amount, not less than zero, equal to the sum of the following amounts:

(i) for each Tranche of Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes greater than zero, the product of (x) the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the

 

-52-


related Distribution Date) times (y) one minus a fraction (which shall not exceed one) the numerator of which is the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Tranches of Outstanding Class B Notes (other than Tranches of Class B Notes which have (A) had Early Redemption Events or other mandatory or optional redemption events in which such Tranches are to be redeemed in full in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, (B) had Events of Default in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, or (C) reached or are expected to reach their final or only Expected Principal Payment Date in or with respect to that Monthly Period or earlier Monthly Periods) and the denominator of which is the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes for all Tranches of Class A Notes of which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date);

(ii) for each Tranche of Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes greater than zero, the product of (x) the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) times (y) one minus a fraction (which shall not exceed one) the numerator of which is the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Tranches of Outstanding Class C Notes (other than Tranches of Class C Notes which have (A) had Early Redemption Events or other mandatory or optional redemption events in which such Tranches are to be redeemed in full in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, (B) had Events of Default in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, or (C) reached or are expected to reach their final or only Expected Principal Payment Date in or with respect to that Monthly Period or earlier Monthly Periods) and the denominator of which is the sum of (1) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class A Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period which have a Class A Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes equal to zero and (2) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (in each case, taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date); and

(iii) for each Tranche of Class A Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes greater than zero, the product of (x) the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class A Notes as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) times (y) one minus a fraction (which shall not exceed one) the numerator of which is the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Tranches of Outstanding Class D Notes (other than Tranches of Class D Notes which have (A) had Early Redemption Events or other mandatory or optional redemption events in which such Tranches are to be redeemed in full in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, (B) had Events of Default in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, or (C) reached or are expected to reach their final or only Expected Principal Payment Date in or with respect to that Monthly Period or earlier Monthly Periods) and the denominator of which is the greater of (1) the sum of (X) the aggregate Required

 

-53-


Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class A Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period which have a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes equal to zero and (Y) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (in each case, taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) and (2) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date).

(b) The Prefunding Target Amount for any Tranche of Class B Notes for any day during any Monthly Period means an amount, not less than zero, equal to the sum of the following amounts:

(i) for each Tranche of Class B Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes greater than zero, the product of (x) the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class B Notes as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) times (y) one minus a fraction (which shall not exceed one) the numerator of which is the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Tranches of Outstanding Class C Notes (other than Tranches of Class C Notes which have (A) had Early Redemption Events or other mandatory or optional redemption events in which such Tranches are to be redeemed in full in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, (B) had Events of Default in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, or (C) reached or are expected to reach their final or only Expected Principal Payment Date in or with respect to that Monthly Period or earlier Monthly Periods) and the denominator of which is the sum of (1) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class A Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period which have a Class A Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes equal to zero and (2) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class C Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (in each case, taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date); and

(ii) for each Tranche of Class B Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes greater than zero, the product of (x) the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class B Notes as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) times (y) one minus a fraction (which shall not exceed one) the numerator of which is the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Tranches of Outstanding Class D Notes (other than Tranches of Class D Notes which have (A) had Early Redemption Events or other mandatory or optional redemption events in which such Tranches are to be redeemed in full in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, (B) had Events of Default in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, or (C) reached or are expected to reach their final or only Expected Principal

 

-54-


Payment Date in or with respect to that Monthly Period or earlier Monthly Periods) and the denominator of which is the greater of (1) the sum of (X) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class A Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period which have a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes equal to zero and (Y) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (in each case, taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) and (2) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date).

(c) The Prefunding Target Amount for any Tranche of Class C Notes with a Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes greater than zero for any day during any Monthly Period means an amount, not less than zero, equal to the product of (x) the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class C Notes as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) times (y) one minus a fraction (which shall not exceed one) the numerator of which is the aggregate Adjusted Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of all Tranches of Outstanding Class D Notes (other than Tranches of Class D Notes which have (A) had Early Redemption Events or other mandatory or optional redemption events in which such Tranches are to be redeemed in full in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, (B) had Events of Default in or with respect to any preceding Monthly Period, or (C) reached or are expected to reach their final or only Expected Principal Payment Date in or with respect to that Monthly Period or earlier Monthly Periods) and the denominator of which is the greater of (1) the sum of (X) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class A Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period which have a Required Subordinated Amount of Class B Notes equal to zero and (Y) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class B Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (in each case, taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date) and (2) the aggregate Required Subordinated Amount of Class D Notes for all Tranches of Class C Notes which are Outstanding as of the end of the preceding Monthly Period (taking into consideration any deposits or withdrawals to be made on the related Distribution Date).

(d) On any day during any Monthly Period on which the Prefunding Target Amount for any Tranche of senior Notes first exceeds zero, the Issuer will notify the Master Trust pursuant to Section 4.05 of the Series 2002-CC Supplement and the Note Rating Agencies of such event.

Section 3.22. Targeted Deposits to the Class C Reserve Account.

(a) The aggregate deposit targeted to be made to the Class C Reserve Account with respect to each Distribution Date is an amount equal to the sum of Class C Reserve sub-Account deposits, if any, targeted to be made for each specified Tranche of Class C Notes. The amount of any such deposit, the aggregate amount targeted to be on deposit after giving effect to any such

 

-55-


deposit and the circumstances that require that a deposit be made will be set forth in the Terms Document for such Tranche of Class C Notes. Unless another time is specified for making such deposits in the Terms Document for each such Tranche of Class C Notes, these deposits will be made on each Distribution Date.

(b) If the amount of funds available for a Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.01(i) is at least equal to the aggregate amount of the deposits targeted by clause (a) above, then the full amount of each such deposit will be made.

(c) If the amount of funds available for a Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.01(i) is less than the aggregate amount of deposits targeted by clause (a) above, then the amount available will be allocated to each Tranche of Class C Notes to the extent of its targeted deposit to the applicable Class C Reserve sub-Account pro rata based on the ratio of the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for all the Class C Notes in the Card Series that have a targeted deposit to its Class C Reserve sub-Account for such Monthly Period; provided, however, that any excess identified in this clause (c), including in the application of this proviso, will be allocated to each Tranche of Class C Notes which has a remaining targeted deposit to its Class C Reserve sub-Account up to the amount of such remaining targeted deposit pro rata based on the ratio of the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for such Tranche of Class C Notes to the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for all the Class C Notes in the Card Series that have a remaining targeted deposit to its Class C Reserve sub-Account for such Monthly Period.

Section 3.23. Withdrawals from the Class C Reserve Account. Withdrawals for any Tranche of Class C Notes will be made from the applicable Class C Reserve sub-Account as specified below.

(a) Payments of Interest; Payments with Respect to Derivative Agreements for Interest, Accretion on Discount Notes. If the amount on deposit in the Interest Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class C Notes is insufficient to pay in full the amounts for which withdrawals are required under Section 3.13, on such payment date an amount equal to that deficiency will be withdrawn from the Class C Reserve sub-Account for such Tranche of Class C Notes and deposited into that Interest Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class C Notes.

(b) Payments of Principal; Payments with Respect to Derivative Agreements for Principal. If, on and after the earliest to occur of (i) the date on which any Tranche of Class C Notes are accelerated pursuant to Section 602 of the Indenture following an Event of Default with respect to such Tranche of Class C Notes, (ii) any date on or after the Expected Principal Payment Date on which the amount on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class C Notes plus the aggregate amount on deposit in the Class C Reserve sub-Account for such Tranche of the Class C Notes equals or exceeds the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class C Notes, provided deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class C Notes are permitted pursuant to Section 3.15, and (iii) the Legal Maturity Date for any Tranche of Class C Notes, the amount on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class C Notes is insufficient to pay in full the

 

-56-


amounts for which withdrawals are required under Section 3.14, an amount equal to that deficiency will be withdrawn from that Class C Reserve sub-Account for such Tranche of Class C Notes and deposited into that Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class C Notes on the Distribution Date before the date of the applicable withdrawal required pursuant to Section 3.14.

(c) Withdrawal of Excess Amounts. If on any Distribution Date with respect to which no Class C Notes have been accelerated, the aggregate amount on deposit in the Class C Reserve Account exceeds the amount required to be on deposit in such Class C Reserve Account, the amount of such excess will be withdrawn from the Class C Reserve Account and first, allocated among and deposited to the Class C Reserve sub-Account of the Tranches of Class C Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.22(c), and then, applied in accordance with the provisions of, and the priority set forth in, Sections 3.01(j) through (m). Upon payment in full of any Tranche of Class C Notes, any amount remaining on deposit in the applicable Class C Reserve sub-Account will be applied in accordance with the preceding sentence.

Section 3.24. Targeted Deposits to the Accumulation Reserve Account.

(a) The aggregate deposit targeted to be made to the Accumulation Reserve Account with respect to each Monthly Period is an amount equal to the sum of Accumulation Reserve sub-Account deposits, if any, targeted to be made for each specified Tranche of Notes. The amount of any such deposit, the aggregate amount targeted to be on deposit after giving effect to any such deposit and the circumstances that require that a deposit be made will be set forth in the Terms Document for such Tranche of Notes. Unless another time is specified for making such deposits in the Terms Document for each such Tranche of Notes, these deposits will be made on each Distribution Date.

(b) If the amount of funds available for a Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01(h) is at least equal to the aggregate amount of the deposits targeted by clause (a) above, then the full amount of each such deposit will be made.

(c) If the amount of funds available for a Monthly Period pursuant to Section 3.01(h) is less than the aggregate amount of deposits targeted by clause (a) above, then the amount available will be allocated to each Tranche of Notes to the extent of its targeted deposit to the applicable Accumulation Reserve sub-Account pro rata based on the ratio of the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for such Tranche of Notes to the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for all Tranches of Notes in the Card Series that have a targeted deposit to its Accumulation Reserve sub-Account for such Monthly Period; provided, however, that any excess identified in this clause (c), including in the application of this proviso, will be allocated to each Tranche of Notes which has a remaining targeted deposit to its Accumulation Reserve sub-Account up to the amount of such remaining targeted deposit pro rata based on the ratio of the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for such Tranche of Notes to the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for all the Tranches of Notes in the Card Series that have a remaining targeted deposit to its Accumulation Reserve sub-Account for such Monthly Period.

 

-57-


Section 3.25. Withdrawals from the Accumulation Reserve Account. Withdrawals for any Tranche of Notes will be made from the applicable Accumulation Reserve sub-Account as specified below.

(a) Interest. On or prior to each Distribution Date, the Issuer will calculate the PFA Accumulation Earnings Shortfall (if any) for the Principal Funding sub-Account for each Tranche of Notes. If there is any PFA Accumulation Earnings Shortfall for any Principal Funding sub-Account for that Distribution Date or any prior Distribution Date for any Tranche of Notes, the Issuer will withdraw such amount from the applicable Accumulation Reserve sub-Account, to the extent available, for treatment as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for such Monthly Period.

(b) Payment to Issuer. If on any Distribution Date the aggregate amount on deposit in the Accumulation Reserve Account exceeds the amount required to be on deposit in the Accumulation Reserve Account, the amount of such excess will be withdrawn from the Accumulation Reserve Account and applied in accordance with Section 3.01(i) through (m).

Section 3.26. Computation of Interest.

(a) Unless otherwise provided as contemplated in Section 301 of the Indenture, (i) interest on the Notes computed at a fixed rate will be calculated on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months and (ii) interest on Notes computed on the basis of a floating or periodic rate will be calculated on the basis of a 360-day year for the actual number of days elapsed.

(b) Unless otherwise specified in this Indenture Supplement or the applicable Terms Document, interest for any period will be calculated from and including the first day of such period, to but excluding the last day of such period.

Section 3.27. Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing.

(a) Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts allocable to the Card Series on any Distribution Date shall be treated as Card Series Finance Charge Amounts for such Distribution Date.

(b) Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts allocable to the Card Series with respect to any Distribution Date shall mean an amount equal to the Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall, if any, with respect to the Card Series for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that if the aggregate amount of Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts for all Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A for such Distribution Date is less than the Aggregate Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall for such Distribution Date, then Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts allocable to the Card Series on such Distribution Date shall equal the product of (i) Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts for all Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A for such Distribution Date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall with respect to the Card Series for such Distribution Date and

 

-58-


the denominator of which is the Aggregate Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfall for all Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A for such Distribution Date.

(c) On any Distribution Date, the amount of Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts available pursuant to Section 3.01(l) shall be allocated:

(i) first, to Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes with Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Indenture Supplements) in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A;

(ii) second, to the extent available after the allocation pursuant to Section 3.27(c)(i), to Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes with Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Indenture Supplements) not included in Excess Finance Charge Amounts Sharing Group A;

(iii) third, to the extent available after the allocation pursuant to Section 3.27(c)(ii), to the Master Trust for distribution to Series of Investor Certificates issued pursuant to the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement with Finance Charge Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Series Supplements); and

(iv) fourth, to the extent available after the allocation pursuant to Section 3.27(c)(iii), to Series of Notes with Series Finance Charge Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Indenture Supplements) not secured by Asset Pool 1.

Section 3.28. Excess Available Principal Amount Sharing.

(a) Shared Excess Principal Amounts allocable to the Card Series on any Distribution Date shall be treated as Card Series Principal Amounts for such Distribution Date.

(b) Shared Excess Principal Amounts allocable to the Card Series with respect to any Distribution Date shall mean an amount equal to the Series Principal Amounts Shortfall, if any, with respect to the Card Series for such Distribution Date; provided, however, that if the aggregate amount of Shared Excess Principal Amounts for all Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A for such Distribution Date is less than the Aggregate Series Principal Amounts Shortfall for such Distribution Date, then Shared Excess Principal Amounts allocable to the Card Series on such Distribution Date shall equal the product of (i) Shared Excess Principal Amounts for all Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A for such Distribution Date and (ii) a fraction, the numerator of which is the Series Principal Amounts Shortfall with respect to the Card Series for such Distribution Date and the denominator of which is the Aggregate Series Principal Amounts Shortfall for all Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Series in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A for such Distribution Date.

(c) On any Distribution Date, the amount of Shared Excess Principal Amounts available pursuant to Section 3.07(h) shall be allocated:

(i) first, to Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes with Series Principal Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Indenture Supplements) in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A;

 

-59-


(ii) second, to the extent available after the allocation pursuant to Section 3.28(c)(ii), to Series of Asset Pool 1 Notes with Series Principal Amounts Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Indenture Supplements) not included in Excess Principal Amounts Sharing Group A; and

(iii) third, to the extent available after the allocation pursuant to Section 3.28(c)(iii), to the Master Trust for distribution to Series of Investor Certificates issued pursuant to the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement with Principal Shortfalls (as such term is defined in the related Series Supplements).

Section 3.29. Targeted Deposits to the Class D Reserve Account.

(a) The aggregate deposit targeted to be made to the Class D Reserve Account with respect to each Distribution Date is an amount equal to the sum of Class D Reserve sub-Account deposits, if any, targeted to be made for each specified Tranche of Class D Notes. The amount of any such deposit, the aggregate amount targeted to be on deposit after giving effect to any such deposit and the circumstances that require that a deposit be made will be set forth in the Terms Document for such Tranche of Class D Notes. Unless another time is specified for making such deposits in the Terms Document for each such Tranche of Class D Notes, these deposits will be made on each Distribution Date.

(b) If the amount of funds available for a Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.01(j) is at least equal to the aggregate amount of the deposits targeted by clause (a) above, then the full amount of each such deposit will be made.

(c) If the amount of funds available for a Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.01(j) is less than the aggregate amount of deposits targeted by clause (a) above, then the amount available will be allocated to each Tranche of Class D Notes to the extent of its targeted deposit to the applicable Class D Reserve sub-Account pro rata based on the ratio of the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for such Tranche of Class D Notes to the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for all the Class D Notes in the Card Series that have a targeted deposit to its Class D Reserve sub-Account for such Monthly Period; provided, however, that any excess identified in this clause (c), including in the application of this proviso, will be allocated to each Tranche of Class D Notes which has a remaining targeted deposit to its Class D Reserve sub-Account up to the amount of such remaining targeted deposit pro rata based on the ratio of the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for such Tranche of Class D Notes to the Floating Allocation Amount for such Monthly Period for all the Class D Notes in the Card Series that have a remaining targeted deposit to its Class D Reserve sub-Account for such Monthly Period.

 

-60-


Section 3.30. Withdrawals from the Class D Reserve Account. Withdrawals for any Tranche of Class D Notes will be made from the applicable Class D Reserve sub-Account as specified below.

(a) Payments of Interest; Payments with Respect to Derivative Agreements for Interest, Accretion on Discount Notes. If the amount on deposit in the Interest Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class D Notes is insufficient to pay in full the amounts for which withdrawals are required under Section 3.13, on such payment date an amount equal to that deficiency will be withdrawn from the Class D Reserve sub-Account for such Tranche of Class D Notes and deposited into that Interest Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class D Notes.

(b) Payments of Principal; Payments with Respect to Derivative Agreements for Principal. If, on and after the earliest to occur of (i) the date on which any Tranche of Class D Notes are accelerated pursuant to Section 602 of the Indenture following an Event of Default with respect to such Tranche of Class D Notes, (ii) any date on or after the Distribution Date immediately preceding the Expected Principal Payment Date on which the amount on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class D Notes plus the aggregate amount on deposit in the Class D Reserve sub-Account for such Tranche of the Class D Notes equals or exceeds the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of such Tranche of Class D Notes, provided deposits to the Principal Funding sub-Account of such Tranche of Class D Notes are permitted pursuant to Section 3.15, and (iii) the Legal Maturity Date for any Tranche of Class D Notes, the amount on deposit in the Principal Funding sub-Account for any Tranche of Class D Notes is insufficient to pay in full the amounts for which withdrawals are required under Section 3.14, an amount equal to that deficiency will be withdrawn from that Class D Reserve sub-Account for such Tranche of Class D Notes and deposited into that Principal Funding sub-Account for such Tranche of Class D Notes on the Distribution Date before the date of the applicable withdrawal required pursuant to Section 3.14.

(c) Withdrawal of Excess Amounts. If on any Distribution Date with respect to which no Class D Notes have been accelerated, the aggregate amount on deposit in the Class D Reserve Account exceeds the amount required to be on deposit in such Class D Reserve Account, the amount of such excess will be withdrawn from the Class D Reserve Account and first, allocated among and deposited to the Class D Reserve sub-Account of the Tranches of Class D Notes in the manner, order and priority set forth in Section 3.29(c), and then, applied in accordance with the provisions of, and the priority set forth in, Sections 3.01(k) through (m). Upon payment in full of any Tranche of Class D Notes, any amount remaining on deposit in the applicable Class D Reserve sub-Account will be applied in accordance with the preceding sentence.

[END OF ARTICLE III]

 

-61-


ARTICLE IV

Early Redemption of Notes

Section 4.01. Early Redemption Events.

(a) In addition to the events identified as Early Redemption Events in Section 1101 of the Indenture, each of the following events will be an “Early Redemption Event” with respect to the Card Series Notes:

(i) if for any month, the average of the Excess Spread Amounts for the three preceding Monthly Periods is less than the Required Excess Spread Amount for such month; or

(ii) the occurrence of any Pay Out Event as defined in the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement or any Pay Out Event pursuant to Section 6.01 of the Series 2002-CC Supplement, or, if the Note Rating Agencies require upon the addition of any Collateral Certificate (other than the COMT Collateral Certificate) to Asset Pool 1, the occurrence of a Pay Out Event (as such term is defined in the related Pooling and Servicing Agreement and Series Supplement) with respect to any Collateral Certificate that has been added to Asset Pool 1.

(b) In addition, the Terms Document for any Tranche of Notes may list additional events which are “Early Redemption Events” with respect to such Tranche of Notes.

[END OF ARTICLE IV]

 

-62-


ARTICLE V

Issuer Accounts and Investments

Section 5.01. Issuer Accounts.

(a) On or before the Closing Date, the Indenture Trustee will cause to be established and maintained five Eligible Deposit Accounts denominated as follows: the “Interest Funding Account,” “Principal Funding Account,” the “Accumulation Reserve Account,” the “Class C Reserve Account” and the “Class D Reserve Account” in the name of the Indenture Trustee, bearing a designation clearly indicating that the funds deposited therein are held for the benefit of the Card Series Noteholders (or, in the case of the Class C Reserve Account, for the benefit of the Class C Noteholders or, in the case of the Class D Reserve Account, for the benefit of the Class D Noteholders). The Interest Funding Account, the Principal Funding Account, the Accumulation Reserve Account, the Class C Reserve Account and the Class D Reserve Account constitute Supplemental Issuer Accounts, shall be maintained in accordance with Article IV of the Indenture and the Asset Pool 1 Supplement, and shall be under the sole dominion and control of the Indenture Trustee for the benefit of the Card Series Noteholders (or, in the case of the Class C Reserve Account, for the benefit of the Class C Noteholders or, in the case of the Class D Reserve Account, for the benefit of the Class D Noteholders). If, at any time, the institution holding either the Interest Funding Account, the Principal Funding Account, the Accumulation Reserve Account, the Class C Reserve Account or the Class D Reserve Account ceases to be an Eligible Institution, the Issuer will within ten (10) Business Days (or such longer period, not to exceed thirty (30) calendar days, as to which each Note Rating Agency may consent) establish a new Interest Funding Account, Principal Funding Account, Accumulation Reserve Account, Class C Reserve Account or the Class D Reserve Account, as the case may be, that is an Eligible Deposit Account and shall transfer any cash and other property to such new Interest Funding Account, Principal Funding Account, Accumulation Reserve Account, Class C Reserve Account or Class D Reserve Account, as the case may be. From the date such new Interest Funding Account, Principal Funding Account, Accumulation Reserve Account, Class C Reserve Account or Class D Reserve Account is established, it will be the “Interest Funding Account,” “Principal Funding Account,” “Accumulation Reserve Account,” “Class C Reserve Account” or a “Class D Reserve Account,” as the case may be. Each Tranche of Notes will have its own sub-Account within the Interest Funding Account, the Principal Funding Account, the Accumulation Reserve Account, the Class C Reserve Account and the Class D Reserve Account. The Interest Funding Account, the Principal Funding Account, the Accumulation Reserve Account, the Class C Reserve Account and the Class D Reserve Account will receive deposits pursuant to Article III.

(b) Notwithstanding any provision of Section 403(a) of the Indenture to the contrary, any prefunded amounts on deposit in the Principal Funding Account will be invested in Eligible Investments that will mature no later than the following Business Day.

(c) All payments to be made from time to time by the Indenture Trustee to Noteholders out of funds in the Interest Funding Account, the Principal Funding Account, the Accumulation Reserve Account, the Class C Reserve Account or Class D Reserve Account pursuant to this

 

-63-


Indenture Supplement will be made by the Indenture Trustee to the Paying Agent not later than 12:00 noon (New York City time) on the applicable Interest Payment Date or Principal Payment Date but only to the extent of Card Series Finance Charge Amounts in the applicable sub-Account or as otherwise provided in Article III.

(d) On each Distribution Date, all interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) accrued since the preceding Distribution Date on funds on deposit in the Class C Reserve Account will be retained in the Class C Reserve Account (to the extent that the sum of the amount on deposit in the Class C Reserve Account with respect to the related Monthly Period is less than the required balance for the Class C Reserve Account for that Monthly Period) and the excess, if any, will be paid to the Issuer.

(e) On each Distribution Date, all interest and earnings (net of losses and investment expenses) accrued since the preceding Distribution Date on funds on deposit in the Class D Reserve Account will be retained in the Class D Reserve Account (to the extent that the sum of the amount on deposit in the Class D Reserve Account with respect to the related Monthly Period is less than the required balance for the Class D Reserve Account for that Monthly Period) and the excess, if any, will be paid to the Issuer.

[END OF ARTICLE V]

 

-64-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Indenture Supplement to be duly executed all as of the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,
By:   DEUTSCHE BANK TRUST COMPANY DELAWARE, as Owner Trustee and not in its individual capacity
By:  

/s/ Michele HY Voon

  Name: Michele HY Voon
  Title: Attorney-in-fact
By:  

/s/ Susan Barstock

  Name: Susan Barstock
  Title: Attorney-in-fact

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

as Indenture Trustee and not in its individual capacity

By:  

/s/ Michael D. Commisso

  Name: Michael D. Commisso
  Title: Vice President

 

-65-


EXHIBIT A-1

[FORM OF] CLASS A NOTE

UNLESS THIS NOTE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION (“DTC”), TO THE ISSUER OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY NOTE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.

THE HOLDER OF THIS NOTE BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF COVENANTS AND AGREES THAT IT WILL NOT AT ANY TIME INSTITUTE AGAINST THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR OR THE MASTER TRUST, OR JOIN IN ANY INSTITUTION AGAINST THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR OR THE MASTER TRUST, OF, ANY BANKRUPTCY PROCEEDINGS UNDER ANY UNITED STATES FEDERAL OR STATE BANKRUPTCY OR SIMILAR LAW IN CONNECTION WITH ANY OBLIGATIONS RELATING TO THE NOTES OR THE INDENTURE.

THE HOLDER OF THIS NOTE, BY ACCEPTANCE OF THIS NOTE, AND EACH HOLDER OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST IN THIS NOTE, BY THE ACQUISITION OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST THEREIN, AGREE TO TREAT THE NOTES AS INDEBTEDNESS FOR APPLICABLE FEDERAL, STATE, AND LOCAL INCOME AND FRANCHISE TAX LAW AND FOR PURPOSES OF ANY OTHER TAX IMPOSED ON OR MEASURED BY INCOME.

 

A-1-1


REGISTERED    up to $            *
No.         CUSIP NO.             

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

[Floating Rate]

CARD SERIES CLASS A NOTE

Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, a statutory trust created under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred to as the “Issuer”), for value received, hereby promises to pay to CEDE & CO., or registered assigns, subject to the following provisions, a principal sum of                      payable on the                       Payment Date (the “Expected Principal Payment Date”), except as otherwise provided below or in the Indenture; provided, however, that the entire unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the                       Payment Date (the “Legal Maturity Date”). Interest will accrue on this Note at the rate of          and shall be due and payable on each Interest Payment Date from the Monthly Interest Accrual Date in the related Monthly Period (or, in the case of the first Transfer Date, from the date of issuance of this Note) to but excluding the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date after the end of that Monthly Period. Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year [of twelve 30-day months] [and the actual number of days elapsed]. Such principal of and interest on this Note shall be paid in the manner specified on the reverse hereof.

The principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts. All payments made by the Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this Note.

Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully set forth on the face of this Note.

Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.

 

* Denominations of $1,000 and in integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

 

A-1-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuer has caused this instrument to be signed, manually or in facsimile, by its Authorized Officer.

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST, as Issuer
By:   CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, as Beneficiary and not in its individual capacity
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Date:                    , 20[    ]

 

A-1-3


INDENTURE TRUSTEE’S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is one of the Notes designated above and referred to in the within-mentioned Indenture.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, not in its individual capacity but solely as Indenture Trustee
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Date:                        , 20[    ]

 

A-1-4


[REVERSE OF NOTE]

This Note is one of the Notes of a duly authorized issue of Notes of the Issuer, designated as its [Floating Rate] Asset Backed Notes (herein called the “Notes”), all issued under an Indenture dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture”), as supplemented by an Asset Pool 1 Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Asset Pool 1 Supplement, as amended by Amendment No. 1 thereto, dated as of March 1, 2008, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Asset Pool 1 Supplement”), as further supplemented by an Indenture Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture Supplement, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture Supplement”), between the Issuer and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”, which term includes any successor Indenture Trustee under the Indenture), to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of the Notes. The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture. All terms used in this Note that are defined in the Indenture, as supplemented or amended, shall have the meanings assigned to them in or pursuant to the Indenture, as so supplemented or amended.

The Class B Notes, the Class C Notes and the Class D Notes will also be issued under the Indenture.

The Notes are and will be equally and ratably secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor as provided in the Indenture and the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Principal of the Notes is expected to be paid on the Expected Principal Payment Date in an amount described on the face hereof.

As described above, the entire unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the Legal Maturity Date.

On any day occurring on or after the date on which the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of any Tranche of Notes is reduced to less than 5% of its highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount, the Servicer or any Affiliate thereof has the right, but not the obligation, to redeem such tranche of Notes in whole but not in part, pursuant to Section 1102 of the Indenture. The redemption price will be an amount equal to the Outstanding principal amount of such Tranche, plus interest accrued and unpaid or principal accreted and unpaid on such Tranche to but excluding the date of redemption.

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Indenture, the Beneficiary, on behalf of the Trust, may from time to time issue, or direct the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, to issue, one or more Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes.

On each Payment Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to each Noteholder of record on the related Record Date (except for the final distribution with respect to this Note) such

 

A-1-5


Noteholder’s pro rata share of the amounts held by the Paying Agent that are allocated and available on such Payment Date to pay interest and principal on the Notes. Final payments of this Note will be made only upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the office or offices therein specified.

[Payments of interest on this Note due and payable on each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note (or one or more Predecessor Notes) on the Note Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of the clearing agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account designated by such nominee. Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for notation of payment. Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note (or any one or more Predecessor Notes) effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all future Holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted hereon. If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture, for payment in full of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date, then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed within five days of such Payment Date and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the Indenture Trustee’s principal Corporate Trust Office or at the office of the Indenture Trustee’s agent appointed for such purposes located in the City of New York. On any payment of interest or principal being made, details of such payment shall be entered by the Indenture Trustee on behalf of the Issuer in Schedule A hereto.]

As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at the office or agency designated by the Issuer pursuant to the Indenture, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly executed by, the Holder hereof or his attorney duly authorized in writing, with such signature guaranteed by a commercial bank or trust company located, or having a correspondent located, in the City of New York or the city in which the Corporate Trust Office is located, or a member firm of a national securities exchange, and such other documents as the Indenture Trustee may require, and thereupon one or more new Notes of authorized denominations and in the same aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or transferees. No service charge will be charged for any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note, but the transferor may be required to pay a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection with any such registration of transfer or exchange.

Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note, covenants and agrees that by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that it will not at any time institute against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the

 

A-1-6


Issuer, or join in any institution against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation proceedings, or other proceedings under any United States Federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the Indenture or any Derivative Agreement.

Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture) is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be overdue, and neither the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee nor any such agent shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the Holders of the Notes under the Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the Holders of Notes representing not less than 66 23 of the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of each affected Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the Holders of Notes representing specified percentages of the Outstanding Amount of the Notes, on behalf of the Holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the Indenture and their consequences. Any such consent or waiver by the Holder of this Note (or any one of more Predecessor Notes) shall be conclusive and binding upon such Holder and upon all future Holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such consent or waiver is made upon this Note. The Indenture also permits the Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in the Indenture without the consent of Holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

The term “Issuer” as used in this Note includes any successor to the Issuer under the Indenture.

The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of Notes under the Indenture.

The Notes are issuable only in registered form in denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations therein set forth.

THIS NOTE AND THE INDENTURE WILL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on this Note at the times, place, and rate, and in the coin or currency herein prescribed.

 

A-1-7


Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note covenant and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee on the Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in connection herewith or therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director, employee or agent of the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or the Owner Trustee or of any successor or assign of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity except as any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the Owner Trustee has no such obligations in its individual capacity). The Holder of this Note by the acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement and the Indenture Supplement in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the Holder shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the Indenture or in this Note.

 

A-1-8


ASSIGNMENT

Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee

 

 

 

FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto

 

(name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.

 

Dated:  

 

   

*

      Signature Guaranteed:

 

* NOTE: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any change whatsoever.

 

A-1-9


SCHEDULE A

PART I

INTEREST PAYMENTS

 

Interest Payment Date

     Date of
Payment
     Total Amount
of Interest
Payable
     Amount of
Interest Paid
     Confirmation of
payment by or on
behalf of the Trust

First

                   

Second

                   

[continue numbering until the appropriate number of interest payment dates for the Notes is reached]

 

A-1-10


PART II

PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS

 

Date of Payment

   Total Amount Payable    Total Amount Paid    Confirmation of payment by
or on behalf of the Trust
        
        

Date of Payment

   Total Amount Payable    Total Amount Paid    Confirmation of payment by
or on behalf of the Trust
        
        

[continue numbering until the appropriate number of installment dates for the Notes is reached]

 

A-1-11


EXHIBIT A-2

[FORM OF] CLASS B NOTE

UNLESS THIS NOTE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION (“DTC”), TO THE ISSUER OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY NOTE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.

THE HOLDER OF THIS NOTE BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF COVENANTS AND AGREES THAT IT WILL NOT AT ANY TIME INSTITUTE AGAINST THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR OR THE MASTER TRUST, OR JOIN IN ANY INSTITUTION AGAINST THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR OR THE MASTER TRUST, OF, ANY BANKRUPTCY PROCEEDINGS UNDER ANY UNITED STATES FEDERAL OR STATE BANKRUPTCY OR SIMILAR LAW IN CONNECTION WITH ANY OBLIGATIONS RELATING TO THE NOTES OR THE INDENTURE.

THE HOLDER OF THIS NOTE, BY ACCEPTANCE OF THIS NOTE, AND EACH HOLDER OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST IN THIS NOTE, BY THE ACQUISITION OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST THEREIN, AGREE TO TREAT THE NOTES AS INDEBTEDNESS FOR APPLICABLE FEDERAL, STATE, AND LOCAL INCOME AND FRANCHISE TAX LAW AND FOR PURPOSES OF ANY OTHER TAX IMPOSED ON OR MEASURED BY INCOME.

 

A-2-1


REGISTERED    up to $            *
No.         CUSIP NO.             

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

[Floating Rate]

CARD SERIES CLASS B NOTE

Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, a statutory trust created under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred to as the “Issuer”), for value received, hereby promises to pay to CEDE & CO., or registered assigns, subject to the following provisions, a principal sum of                      payable on the                       Payment Date (the “Expected Principal Payment Date”), except as otherwise provided below or in the Indenture; provided, however, that the entire unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the                       Payment Date (the “Legal Maturity Date”). Interest will accrue on this Note at the rate of          and shall be due and payable on each Interest Payment Date from the Monthly Interest Accrual Date in the related Monthly Period (or, in the case of the first Transfer Date, from the date of issuance of this Note) to but excluding the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date after the end of that Monthly Period. Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year [of twelve 30-day months] [and the actual number of days elapsed]. Such principal of and interest on this Note shall be paid in the manner specified on the reverse hereof.

The principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts. All payments made by the Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this Note.

Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully set forth on the face of this Note.

Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.

 

* Denominations of $1,000 and in integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

 

A-2-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuer has caused this instrument to be signed, manually or in facsimile, by its Authorized Officer.

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,
as Issuer
By:   CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, as Beneficiary and not in its individual capacity
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Date:                        , 20[    ]

 

A-2-3


INDENTURE TRUSTEE’S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is one of the Notes designated above and referred to in the within-mentioned Indenture.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, not in its individual capacity but solely as Indenture Trustee
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Date:                        , 20[    ]

 

A-2-4


[REVERSE OF NOTE]

This Note is one of the Notes of a duly authorized issue of Notes of the Issuer, designated as its [Floating Rate] Asset Backed Notes (herein called the “Notes”), all issued under an Indenture dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture”), as supplemented by an Asset Pool 1 Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Asset Pool 1 Supplement, as amended by Amendment No. 1 thereto, dated as of March 1, 2008, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Asset Pool 1 Supplement”), as further supplemented by an Indenture Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture Supplement, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture Supplement”), between the Issuer and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”, which term includes any successor Indenture Trustee under the Indenture), to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of the Notes. The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture. All terms used in this Note that are defined in the Indenture, as supplemented or amended, shall have the meanings assigned to them in or pursuant to the Indenture, as so supplemented or amended.

The Class A Notes, the Class C Notes and the Class D Notes will also be issued under the Indenture.

The Notes are and will be equally and ratably secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor as provided in the Indenture and the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Principal of the Notes is expected to be paid on the Expected Principal Payment Date in an amount described on the face hereof.

As described above, the entire unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the Legal Maturity Date.

On any day occurring on or after the date on which the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of any Tranche of Notes is reduced to less than 5% of its highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount, the Servicer or any Affiliate thereof has the right, but not the obligation, to redeem such tranche of Notes in whole but not in part, pursuant to Section 1102 of the Indenture. The redemption price will be an amount equal to the Outstanding principal amount of such Tranche, plus interest accrued and unpaid or principal accreted and unpaid on such Tranche to but excluding the date of redemption.

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Indenture, the Beneficiary, on behalf of the Trust, may from time to time issue, or direct the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, to issue, one or more Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes.

On each Payment Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to each Noteholder of record on the related Record Date (except for the final distribution with respect to this Note) such

 

A-2-5


Noteholder’s pro rata share of the amounts held by the Paying Agent that are allocated and available on such Payment Date to pay interest and principal on the Notes. Final payments of this Note will be made only upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the office or offices therein specified.

[Payments of interest on this Note due and payable on each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note (or one or more Predecessor Notes) on the Note Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of the clearing agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account designated by such nominee. Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for notation of payment. Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note (or any one or more Predecessor Notes) effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all future Holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted hereon. If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture, for payment in full of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date, then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed within five days of such Payment Date and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the Indenture Trustee’s principal Corporate Trust Office or at the office of the Indenture Trustee’s agent appointed for such purposes located in the City of New York. On any payment of interest or principal being made, details of such payment shall be entered by the Indenture Trustee on behalf of the Issuer in Schedule A hereto.]

As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at the office or agency designated by the Issuer pursuant to the Indenture, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly executed by, the Holder hereof or his attorney duly authorized in writing, with such signature guaranteed by a commercial bank or trust company located, or having a correspondent located, in the City of New York or the city in which the Corporate Trust Office is located, or a member firm of a national securities exchange, and such other documents as the Indenture Trustee may require, and thereupon one or more new Notes of authorized denominations and in the same aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or transferees. No service charge will be charged for any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note, but the transferor may be required to pay a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection with any such registration of transfer or exchange.

Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note, covenants and agrees that by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that it will not at any time institute against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the

 

A-2-6


Issuer, or join in any institution against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation proceedings, or other proceedings under any United States Federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the Indenture or any Derivative Agreement.

Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture) is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be overdue, and neither the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee nor any such agent shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the Holders of the Notes under the Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the Holders of Notes representing not less than 66 23 of the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of each affected Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the Holders of Notes representing specified percentages of the Outstanding Amount of the Notes, on behalf of the Holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the Indenture and their consequences. Any such consent or waiver by the Holder of this Note (or any one of more Predecessor Notes) shall be conclusive and binding upon such Holder and upon all future Holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such consent or waiver is made upon this Note. The Indenture also permits the Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in the Indenture without the consent of Holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

The term “Issuer” as used in this Note includes any successor to the Issuer under the Indenture.

The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of Notes under the Indenture.

The Notes are issuable only in registered form in denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations therein set forth.

THIS NOTE AND THE INDENTURE WILL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on this Note at the times, place, and rate, and in the coin or currency herein prescribed.

 

A-2-7


Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note covenant and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee on the Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in connection herewith or therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director, employee or agent of the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or the Owner Trustee or of any successor or assign of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity except as any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the Owner Trustee has no such obligations in its individual capacity). The Holder of this Note by the acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement and the Indenture Supplement in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the Holder shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the Indenture or in this Note.

 

A-2-8


ASSIGNMENT

Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee

 

 

 

FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto

 

(name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.

 

Dated:  

 

   

*

      Signature Guaranteed:

 

* NOTE: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any change whatsoever.

 

A-2-9


SCHEDULE A

PART I

INTEREST PAYMENTS

 

Interest Payment Date

     Date of
Payment
     Total Amount
of Interest
Payable
     Amount of
Interest Paid
     Confirmation of
payment by or on
behalf of the Trust

First

                   

Second

                   

[continue numbering until the appropriate number of interest payment dates for the Notes is reached]

 

A-2-10


PART II

PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS

 

Date of Payment

   Total Amount Payable    Total Amount Paid    Confirmation of payment by
or on behalf of the Trust
        
        

Date of Payment

   Total Amount Payable    Total Amount Paid    Confirmation of payment by
or on behalf of the Trust
        
        

[continue numbering until the appropriate number of installment dates for the Notes is reached]

 

A-2-11


EXHIBIT A-3

[FORM OF] CLASS C NOTE

UNLESS THIS NOTE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION (“DTC”), TO THE ISSUER OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY NOTE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.

THE HOLDER OF THIS NOTE BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF COVENANTS AND AGREES THAT IT WILL NOT AT ANY TIME INSTITUTE AGAINST THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR OR THE MASTER TRUST, OR JOIN IN ANY INSTITUTION AGAINST THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR OR THE MASTER TRUST, OF, ANY BANKRUPTCY PROCEEDINGS UNDER ANY UNITED STATES FEDERAL OR STATE BANKRUPTCY OR SIMILAR LAW IN CONNECTION WITH ANY OBLIGATIONS RELATING TO THE NOTES OR THE INDENTURE.

THE HOLDER OF THIS NOTE, BY ACCEPTANCE OF THIS NOTE, AND EACH HOLDER OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST IN THIS NOTE, BY THE ACQUISITION OF A BENEFICIAL INTEREST THEREIN, AGREE TO TREAT THE NOTES AS INDEBTEDNESS FOR APPLICABLE FEDERAL, STATE, AND LOCAL INCOME AND FRANCHISE TAX LAW AND FOR PURPOSES OF ANY OTHER TAX IMPOSED ON OR MEASURED BY INCOME.

 

A-3-1


REGISTERED      up to $            *   
No.           CUSIP NO.               

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

[Floating Rate]

CARD SERIES CLASS C NOTE

Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, a statutory trust created under the laws of the State of Delaware (herein referred to as the “Issuer”), for value received, hereby promises to pay to CEDE & CO., or registered assigns, subject to the following provisions, a principal sum of                     payable on the                      Payment Date (the “Expected Principal Payment Date”), except as otherwise provided below or in the Indenture; provided, however, that the entire unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the                      Payment Date (the “Legal Maturity Date”). Interest will accrue on this Note at the rate of         and shall be due and payable on each Interest Payment Date from the Monthly Interest Accrual Date in the related Monthly Period (or, in the case of the first Transfer Date, from the date of issuance of this Note) to but excluding the first Monthly Interest Accrual Date after the end of that Monthly Period. Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year [of twelve 30-day months] [and the actual number of days elapsed]. Such principal of and interest on this Note shall be paid in the manner specified on the reverse hereof.

The principal of and interest on this Note are payable in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts. All payments made by the Issuer with respect to this Note shall be applied first to interest due and payable on this Note as provided above and then to the unpaid principal of this Note.

Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully set forth on the face of this Note.

Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by the Indenture Trustee whose name appears below by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture referred to on the reverse hereof, or be valid or obligatory for any purpose.

 

* Denominations of $1,000 and in integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof.

 

A-3-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuer has caused this instrument to be signed, manually or in facsimile, by its Authorized Officer.

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,
as Issuer
By:   CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, as Beneficiary and not in its individual capacity
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Date:                    , 20[    ]

 

A-3-3


INDENTURE TRUSTEE’S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is one of the Notes designated above and referred to in the within-mentioned Indenture.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, not in its individual capacity but solely as Indenture Trustee
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:
Date:                    ,20[    ]

 

A-3-4


[REVERSE OF NOTE]

This Note is one of the Notes of a duly authorized issue of Notes of the Issuer, designated as its [Floating Rate] Asset Backed Notes (herein called the “Notes”), all issued under an Indenture dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture”), as supplemented by an Asset Pool 1 Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Asset Pool 1 Supplement, as amended by Amendment No. 1 thereto, dated as of March 1, 2008, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Asset Pool 1 Supplement”), as further supplemented by an Indenture Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture Supplement, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture Supplement”), between the Issuer and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”, which term includes any successor Indenture Trustee under the Indenture), to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of the Notes. The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture. All terms used in this Note that are defined in the Indenture, as supplemented or amended, shall have the meanings assigned to them in or pursuant to the Indenture, as so supplemented or amended.

The Class A Notes, the Class B Notes and the Class D Notes will also be issued under the Indenture.

The Notes are and will be equally and ratably secured by the collateral pledged as security therefor as provided in the Indenture and the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

Principal of the Notes is expected to be paid on the Expected Principal Payment Date in an amount described on the face hereof.

As described above, the entire unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be due and payable on the Legal Maturity Date.

On any day occurring on or after the date on which the aggregate Nominal Liquidation Amount of any Tranche of Notes is reduced to less than 5% of its highest Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount, the Servicer or any Affiliate thereof has the right, but not the obligation, to redeem such tranche of Notes in whole but not in part, pursuant to Section 1102 of the Indenture. The redemption price will be an amount equal to the Outstanding principal amount of such Tranche, plus interest accrued and unpaid or principal accreted and unpaid on such Tranche to but excluding the date of redemption.

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Indenture, the Beneficiary, on behalf of the Trust, may from time to time issue, or direct the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, to issue, one or more Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes.

On each Payment Date, the Paying Agent shall distribute to each Noteholder of record on the related Record Date (except for the final distribution with respect to this Note) such

 

A-3-5


Noteholder’s pro rata share of the amounts held by the Paying Agent that are allocated and available on such Payment Date to pay interest and principal on the Notes. Final payments of this Note will be made only upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the office or offices therein specified.

[Payments of interest on this Note due and payable on each Payment Date, together with the installment of principal, if any, to the extent not in full payment of this Note, shall be made by check mailed to the Person whose name appears as the Registered Holder of this Note (or one or more Predecessor Notes) on the Note Register as of the close of business on each Record Date, except that with respect to Notes registered on the Record Date in the name of the nominee of the clearing agency (initially, such nominee to be Cede & Co.), payments will be made by wire transfer in immediately available funds to the account designated by such nominee. Such checks shall be mailed to the Person entitled thereto at the address of such Person as it appears on the Note Register as of the applicable Record Date without requiring that this Note be submitted for notation of payment. Any reduction in the principal amount of this Note (or any one or more Predecessor Notes) effected by any payments made on any Payment Date shall be binding upon all future Holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof, whether or not noted hereon. If funds are expected to be available, as provided in the Indenture, for payment in full of the then remaining unpaid principal amount of this Note on a Payment Date, then the Indenture Trustee, in the name of and on behalf of the Issuer, will notify the Person who was the Registered Holder hereof as of the Record Date preceding such Payment Date by notice mailed within five days of such Payment Date and the amount then due and payable shall be payable only upon presentation and surrender of this Note at the Indenture Trustee’s principal Corporate Trust Office or at the office of the Indenture Trustee’s agent appointed for such purposes located in the City of New York. On any payment of interest or principal being made, details of such payment shall be entered by the Indenture Trustee on behalf of the Issuer in Schedule A hereto.]

As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain limitations set forth therein, the transfer of this Note may be registered on the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at the office or agency designated by the Issuer pursuant to the Indenture, duly endorsed by, or accompanied by a written instrument of transfer in form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee duly executed by, the Holder hereof or his attorney duly authorized in writing, with such signature guaranteed by a commercial bank or trust company located, or having a correspondent located, in the City of New York or the city in which the Corporate Trust Office is located, or a member firm of a national securities exchange, and such other documents as the Indenture Trustee may require, and thereupon one or more new Notes of authorized denominations and in the same aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or transferees. No service charge will be charged for any registration of transfer or exchange of this Note, but the transferor may be required to pay a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection with any such registration of transfer or exchange.

Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note, covenants and agrees that by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that it will not at any time institute against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the

 

A-3-6


Issuer, or join in any institution against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation proceedings, or other proceedings under any United States Federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the Indenture or any Derivative Agreement.

Prior to the due presentment for registration of transfer of this Note, the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer or the Indenture Trustee may treat the Person in whose name this Note (as of the day of determination or as of such other date as may be specified in the Indenture) is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, whether or not this Note be overdue, and neither the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee nor any such agent shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

The Indenture permits, with certain exceptions as therein provided, the amendment thereof and the modification of the rights and obligations of the Issuer and the rights of the Holders of the Notes under the Indenture at any time by the Issuer with the consent of the Holders of Notes representing not less than 66 23 of the Outstanding Dollar Principal Amount of each affected Series, Class or Tranche of Notes. The Indenture also contains provisions permitting the Holders of Notes representing specified percentages of the Outstanding Amount of the Notes, on behalf of the Holders of all the Notes, to waive compliance by the Issuer with certain provisions of the Indenture and certain past defaults under the Indenture and their consequences. Any such consent or waiver by the Holder of this Note (or any one of more Predecessor Notes) shall be conclusive and binding upon such Holder and upon all future Holders of this Note and of any Note issued upon the registration of transfer hereof or in exchange hereof or in lieu hereof whether or not notation of such consent or waiver is made upon this Note. The Indenture also permits the Indenture Trustee to amend or waive certain terms and conditions set forth in the Indenture without the consent of Holders of the Notes issued thereunder.

The term “Issuer” as used in this Note includes any successor to the Issuer under the Indenture.

The Issuer is permitted by the Indenture, under certain circumstances, to merge or consolidate, subject to the rights of the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of Notes under the Indenture.

The Notes are issuable only in registered form in denominations as provided in the Indenture, subject to certain limitations therein set forth.

THIS NOTE AND THE INDENTURE WILL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH AND GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

No reference herein to the Indenture and no provision of this Note or of the Indenture shall alter or impair the obligation of the Issuer, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and interest on this Note at the times, place, and rate, and in the coin or currency herein prescribed.

 

A-3-7


Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note covenant and agrees that no recourse may be taken, directly or indirectly, with respect to the obligations of the Issuer, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee on the Notes or under the Indenture or any certificate or other writing delivered in connection herewith or therewith, against (i) the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, (ii) any owner of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or (iii) any partner, owner, beneficiary, agent, officer, director, employee or agent of the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer or the Owner Trustee or of any successor or assign of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity, any holder of a beneficial interest in the Issuer, the Owner Trustee or the Indenture Trustee or of any successor or assign of the Indenture Trustee or the Owner Trustee in its individual capacity except as any such Person may have expressly agreed (it being understood that the Owner Trustee has no such obligations in its individual capacity). The Holder of this Note by the acceptance hereof agrees that, except as expressly provided in the Indenture, the Asset Pool 1 Supplement and the Indenture Supplement in the case of an Event of Default under the Indenture, the Holder shall have no claim against any of the foregoing for any deficiency, loss or claim therefrom; provided, however, that nothing contained herein shall be taken to prevent recourse to, and enforcement against, the assets of the Issuer for any and all liabilities, obligations and undertakings contained in the Indenture or in this Note.

 

A-3-8


ASSIGNMENT

Social Security or taxpayer I.D. or other identifying number of assignee

 

                                        

FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto

 

(name and address of assignee)

the within Note and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints attorney, to transfer said Note on the books kept for registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.

 

Dated:  

 

     

*

        Signature Guaranteed:

 

* NOTE: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any change whatsoever.

 

A-3-9


SCHEDULE A

PART I

INTEREST PAYMENTS

 

Interest Payment Date

     Date of
Payment
     Total Amount
of Interest
Payable
     Amount of
Interest Paid
     Confirmation of
payment by or on
behalf of the Trust

First

                   

Second

                   

[continue numbering until the appropriate number of interest payment dates for the Notes is reached]

 

A-3-10


PART II

PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS

 

Date of Payment

   Total Amount Payable    Total Amount Paid    Confirmation of payment by
or on behalf of the Trust
        
        

Date of Payment

   Total Amount Payable    Total Amount Paid    Confirmation of payment by
or on behalf of the Trust
        
        

[continue numbering until the appropriate number of installment dates for the Notes is reached]

 

A-3-11


EXHIBIT A-4

[FORM OF] CLASS D VARIABLE FUNDING NOTE

THIS CLASS D NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”) OR ANY APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAW OF ANY STATE AND MAY NOT BE OFFERED, SOLD, PLEDGED OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT IN A TRANSACTION EXEMPT FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT AND APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES OR “BLUE SKY” LAWS TO ANY PERSON WHO THE HOLDER REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER WITHIN THE MEANING THEREOF IN RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT (“RULE 144A”) IN COMPLIANCE WITH RULE 144A OR A PERSON WHO IS AN INSTITUTIONAL “ACCREDITED INVESTOR” AS DEFINED IN RULE 501(a)(1), (2), (3) OR (7) UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, IN EACH CASE IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE CERTIFICATION AND OTHER REQUIREMENTS SPECIFIED IN THE INDENTURE SUPPLEMENT. NONE OF THE ISSUER, THE TRANSFEROR, THE SERVICER, THE TRANSFER AGENT, NOTE REGISTRAR OR THE INDENTURE TRUSTEE IS OBLIGATED TO REGISTER THE CLASS D NOTES UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OR ANY OTHER SECURITIES OR “BLUE SKY” LAW.

EACH PURCHASER REPRESENTS AND WARRANTS, FOR THE BENEFIT OF CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST, THAT SUCH PURCHASER IS NOT (1) AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN (AS DEFINED IN SECTION 3(3) OF THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED (ERISA)) WHICH IS SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF ERISA, (2) A PLAN (AS DEFINED IN SECTION 4975(e)(1) OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED (THE CODE) WHICH IS SUBJECT TO SECTION 4975 OF THE CODE, OR (3) AN ENTITY WHOSE UNDERLYING ASSETS INCLUDE PLAN ASSETS BY REASON OF ANY SUCH PLAN’S INVESTMENT IN THE ENTITY (UNLESS REGISTERED UNDER THE INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT OF 1940, AS AMENDED).

NEITHER THIS CLASS D NOTE NOR ANY INTEREST HEREIN MAY BE TRANSFERRED TO AN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLAN, TRUST OR ACCOUNT WHICH IS SUBJECT TO THE EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCOME SECURITY ACT OF 1974, AS AMENDED, OR SECTION 4975 OF THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986, AS AMENDED.

ANY TRANSFER OF A DIRECT OR INDIRECT INTEREST IN THIS CLASS D NOTE IS SUBJECT TO THE PROVISIONS OF THE INDENTURE, THE ASSET POOL SUPPLEMENT, THE INDENTURE SUPPLEMENT AND THE TERMS DOCUMENT AND SUBJECT TO CERTAIN LIMITATIONS THEREIN SET FORTH.

 

A-3-1


REGISTERED

No. R-1

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

CARD SERIES CLASS D VARIABLE FUNDING NOTE

Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust (herein referred to as the “Issuer” or the “Trust”), a Delaware statutory trust governed by a Second Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of January 13, 2006, for value received, hereby promises to pay to CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, or registered assigns, subject to the following provisions, the principal sum as determined in accordance with Indenture dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture”), as supplemented by an Asset Pool 1 Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Asset Pool 1 Supplement, as amended by Amendment No. 1 thereto, dated as of March 1, 2008, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Asset Pool 1 Supplement”), as further supplemented by an Indenture Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture Supplement, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture Supplement”), as further supplemented by the Class D Terms Document dated as of October 9, 2002 (the “Terms Document”), each between the Issuer and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Indenture Trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”). The Issuer will pay interest and principal in accordance with the Terms Document.

Reference is made to the further provisions of this Note set forth on the reverse hereof, which shall have the same effect as though fully set forth on the face of this Note.

Unless the certificate of authentication hereon has been executed by or on behalf of the Indenture Trustee, by manual signature, this Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture, the Asset Pool Supplement, the Indenture Supplement or the Terms Document referred to on the reverse hereof, or be valid for any purpose.

THIS CLASS D NOTE IS SUBORDINATED TO THE EXTENT NECESSARY TO FUND PAYMENTS ON THE CLASS A NOTES, THE CLASS B NOTES AND THE CLASS C NOTES TO THE EXTENT SPECIFIED IN THE INDENTURE SUPPLEMENT.

 

A-3-2


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Issuer has caused this Class D Note to be duly executed.

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST,
as Issuer
By:   DEUTSCHE BANK TRUST COMPANY DELAWARE, not in its individual capacity but solely as Owner Trustee under the Trust Agreement
By:  

 

  Name:  
  Title:  
Date:                    , 20[    ]

 

A-3-3


INDENTURE TRUSTEE’S CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION

This is one of the Class D Notes described in the within-mentioned Indenture.

 

THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,
as Indenture Trustee
By:  

 

  Authorized Signatory

 

A-3-4


CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

CARD SERIES

CARD SERIES CLASS D VARIABLE FUNDING NOTE

Summary of Terms and Conditions

This Note is one of the Notes of a duly authorized issue of Notes of the Issuer, designated as its [Floating Rate] Asset Backed Notes (herein called the “Notes”), all issued under an Indenture dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture”), as supplemented by an Asset Pool 1 Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Asset Pool 1 Supplement, as amended by Amendment No. 1 thereto, dated as of March 1, 2008, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Asset Pool 1 Supplement”), as further supplemented by an Indenture Supplement dated as of October 9, 2002 (such Indenture Supplement, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, and as further supplemented or amended, is herein called the “Indenture Supplement”), between the Issuer and The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee (the “Indenture Trustee”, which term includes any successor Indenture Trustee under the Indenture), to which Indenture and all indentures supplemental thereto reference is hereby made for a statement of the respective rights and obligations thereunder of the Issuer, the Indenture Trustee and the Holders of the Notes. The Notes are subject to all terms of the Indenture. All terms used in this Note that are defined in the Indenture, as supplemented or amended, shall have the meanings assigned to them in or pursuant to the Indenture, as so supplemented or amended.

The Class A Notes, the Class B Notes and the Class C Notes will also be issued under the Master Indenture, the Asset Pool Supplement and the Indenture Supplement.

The Noteholder, by its acceptance of this Note, agrees that it will look solely to the property of the Issuer allocated to the payment of this Note for payment hereunder and that the Indenture Trustee is not liable to the Noteholders for any amount payable under the Note or the Indenture or, except as expressly provided in the Indenture, subject to any liability under the Indenture.

This Note does not purport to summarize the Indenture and reference is made to the Indenture for the interests, rights and limitations of rights, benefits, obligations and duties evidenced thereby, and the rights, duties and immunities of the Indenture Trustee.

The principal sum of this Note is described in the Terms Document.

Subject to the terms and conditions of the Indenture, the Beneficiary, on behalf of the Trust, may from time to time issue, or direct the Owner Trustee, on behalf of the Trust, to issue, one or more Series, Classes or Tranches of Notes.

 

A-3-5


Interest and principal payments shall be made in accordance with the Terms Document.

This Note does not represent an obligation of, or an interest in or the assets of, the Transferor, the Servicer or any Affiliate thereof, other than the Issuer.

Each Noteholder or Note Owner, by acceptance of a Note or, in the case of a Note Owner, a beneficial interest in a Note, covenants and agrees that by accepting the benefits of the Indenture that it will not at any time institute against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the Issuer, or join in any institution against the Transferor, the Master Trust or the Issuer of, any bankruptcy, reorganization, arrangement, insolvency or liquidation proceedings, or other proceedings under any United States Federal or state bankruptcy or similar law in connection with any obligations relating to the Notes, the Indenture or any Derivative Agreement.

The transfer of this Note shall be registered in the Note Register upon surrender of this Note for registration of transfer at any office or agency maintained by the Note Registrar accompanied by a written instrument of transfer, in a form satisfactory to the Indenture Trustee or the Note Registrar, duly executed by the Class D Noteholder or such Class D Noteholder’s attorney, and duly authorized in writing with such signature guaranteed, and thereupon one or more new Class D Notes in any authorized denominations of like aggregate principal amount will be issued to the designated transferee or transferees.

As provided in the Indenture and subject to certain limitations therein set forth, Class D Notes are exchangeable for new Class D Notes in any authorized denominations and of like aggregate principal amount, upon surrender of such Notes to be exchanged at the office or agency of the Note Registrar. No service charge may be imposed for any such exchange but the Issuer or Note Registrar may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in connection therewith.

The Issuer, the Transferor, the Indenture Trustee and any agent of the Issuer, Transferor or the Indenture Trustee shall treat the person in whose name this Note is registered as the owner hereof for all purposes, and neither the Issuer, the Transferor, the Indenture Trustee nor any agent of the Issuer, Transferor or the Indenture Trustee shall be affected by notice to the contrary.

THIS CLASS D NOTE SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

 

A-3-6


ASSIGNMENT

Social Security or other identifying number of assignee                                         

FOR VALUE RECEIVED, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto                                                              

                                                                                                                                                (name and address of assignee)

the within certificate and all rights thereunder, and hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints                     , attorney, to transfer said certificate on the books kept for registration thereof, with full power of substitution in the premises.

 

Dated:  

 

   

 

  1/
      Signature Guaranteed:  
     

 

 

 

1/ NOTE: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name of the registered owner as it appears on the face of the within Note in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or any charge whatsoever.

 

A-3-7


EXHIBIT B

[FORM OF] CARD SERIES SCHEDULE TO PAYMENT INSTRUCTIONS

 

 

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST, CARD SERIES

MONTHLY PERIOD ENDING                  ,         

 

 

Capitalized terms used in this notice have their respective meanings set forth in the Indenture and the Indenture Supplement. Unless otherwise qualified, references herein to certain sections and subsections are references to the respective sections and subsections of the Indenture Supplement. This instruction is delivered pursuant to Section 5.3 of the Asset Pool 1 Supplement.

The Servicer does hereby instruct the Issuer to instruct the Indenture Trustee, and the Issuer does hereby instruct the Indenture Trustee, to make the following allocations and payments for the related Monthly Period on                  ,         , which date is a Transfer Date under the COMT Pooling and Servicing Agreement, in aggregate amounts set forth below in respect of the following amounts:

 

I. Allocations and Payments of Card series Finance Charge Amounts.

 

A. Allocation of Card series Finance Charge Amounts pursuant to Section 3.01, to be applied on each Distribution Date by the Indenture Trustee in the following priority:

 

1.   

Amount of targeted deposits paid to the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Amount paid in respect of the Card series Servicing Fee to the Servicer

   $                
     

 

 

 
3.   

Amount paid in respect of any previously due and unpaid Card series Servicing Fee to the Servicer

   $                
     

 

 

 
4.   

Amount of targeted deposits with respect to the Class D Notes to the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.02

   $                
     

 

 

 
5.   

Amount to be treated as Card series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.07 in an amount equal to the Card series Defaulted Amount, if any

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

B-1


6.   

Amount to be treated as Card series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.07 in an amount equal to the Nominal Liquidation Amount Deficit, if any

   $                
     

 

 

 
7.   

Amount to make the target deposit to the Accumulation Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.24

   $                
     

 

 

 
8.   

Amount to make the target deposit to the Class C Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.22, if any

   $                
     

 

 

 
9.   

Amount to make the target deposit to the Class D Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.29, if any

   $                
     

 

 

 
10.   

Amount paid or deposited as required by the terms document of any class or tranche of Card series Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
11.   

Amount to be treated as Shared Excess Finance Charge Amounts for application in accordance with Section 3.27

   $                
     

 

 

 
12.   

Amount paid or deposited as required by the terms document of any class or tranche of Card series Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
13.   

Amount to paid to the holder of Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest or the designee of the holder of the Asset Pool 1 Transferor Interest

   $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

B. Allocations of deposits to Interest Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.03:

 

1.   

Payments to Interest Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.03:

  
  

a.

  

[Class/Tranche]

   $                
        

 

 

 
  

b.

  

[Class/Tranche]

   $                
        

 

 

 
     

Total

   $                
        

 

 

 

 

C. Payments and deposits pursuant to Section 3.04, to be received on the following dates:

 

1.   

Withdrawals from the Class C Reserve Account deposited into the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account on the related Transfer Date pursuant to Section 3.23(a)

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

As of the date of receipt, Receivables Sales Proceeds deposited in the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account as of the date of receipt by the Issuer

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

B-2


D. Withdrawals from the Interest Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.13, to be made by the Indenture Trustee on the following dates:

 

1.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Interest Funding sub-Accounts and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent on each Interest Payment Date, with respect to each tranche of Dollar Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Interest Funding sub-Accounts and converted to the applicable foreign currency at the Spot Exchange Rate and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent for Foreign Currency Notes with a non-Performing Derivative Agreement

   $                
     

 

 

 
3.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Interest Funding sub-Accounts and invested in the Investor Interest of the Collateral Certificate on each Principal Payment Date, with respect to each tranche of Discount Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
4.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Interest Funding sub-Accounts and paid to the applicable Derivative Party as specified in the applicable Derivative Agreement, with respect to each tranche of Notes which has a Performing Derivative Agreement for interest

   $                
     

 

 

 
5.   

Amount paid to the Issuer

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

II. Allocations and Payments of Card series.

 

A. Re-allocation of Card series Principal Amounts pursuant to Section 3.07(a) to be applied on the next Distribution Date by the Indenture Trustee:

 

1.   

Reallocated Class C Principal Collections:

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Reallocated Class B Principal Collections:

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

B-3


B. Targeted Deposits of Card series Principal Amounts to the Principal Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.10, to be made by the Indenture Trustee on the following dates:

 

1.   

On the applicable Principal Payment Date prior to any payment, the Nominal Liquidation Amount for the related tranche of Notes:

  
   a. [Class/Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $     
     

 

 

 
2   

In the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account for the related tranche of Notes, the Controlled Accumulation Amount or the amount specified in Section 3.10(b)(ii):

  
   a. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
   b. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $     
     

 

 

 
3   

In the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account, the Prefunding Target Amount for the Card Series on the related Distribution Date:

  
   a. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
   b. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $     
     

 

 

 
4.   

In the case of an Event of Default, Early Redemption Event or other optional or mandatory redemption, on the applicable Distribution Date, the Nominal Liquidation Amount for the related Tranche of Notes:

  
   a. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
   b. [Class/Tranche]    $     
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $     
     

 

 

 

 

B-4


C. Payments and deposits pursuant to Section 3.12, to be received on the following dates:

 

1.   

Withdrawals from the Class C Reserve Account deposited into the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account on the related Distribution Date pursuant to Section 3.23(b)

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

As of the date of receipt, Receivables Sales Proceeds received pursuant to Section 3.20(c)(i) deposited in the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account as of the date of receipt by the Issuer

   $     
     

 

 

 

 

D. Reallocations of deposits to Principal Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.11:

 

1.   

Payments to Principal Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.11(b)(i) for the Class A Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Payments to Principal Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.11(b)(ii) for the Class B Notes

   $     
     

 

 

 
3.   

Payments to Principal Funding sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.11(b)(iii) for the Class C Notes

   $     
     

 

 

 

 

E. Withdrawals from the Principal Funding Account pursuant to Section 3.14, to be made by the Indenture Trustee on the following dates:

 

1.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Principal Funding sub-Accounts and remitted to the applicable Paying Agent on each Principal Payment Date, with respect to each tranche of Dollar Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Principal Funding sub-Accounts and paid to the applicable Derivative Party as specified in the applicable Derivative Agreement, with respect to each tranche of Notes which has a Performing Derivative Agreement for Principal

   $     
     

 

 

 

 

B-5


3.   

Dollar amount withdrawn from the applicable Principal Funding sub-Accounts and converted to the applicable foreign currency at the Spot Exchange Rate pursuant to the applicable Derivative Agreement, with respect to each tranche of Notes which has a non-Performing Derivative Agreement for principal

   $                
     

 

 

 
4.   

Amount of Prefunding Excess Amount withdrawn from the Principal Funding sub-Accounts and paid to the Master Trust to increase the Invested Amount of the Collateral Certificate

   $                
     

 

 

 
5.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Principal Funding sub-Accounts on the Legal Maturity Date of any tranche and applied to pay principal of that tranche or paid to the applicable Derivative Party for that tranche as specified in the applicable Derivative Agreement

   $                
     

 

 

 
6.   

Amount paid to the Issuer

  

 

F.

  Amount of principal accreted on all tranches of Discount Notes and paid to the Master Trust pursuant to Section 3.17(a)    $                
    

 

 

 

 

G. Allocations of reductions from Investor Charge-Offs to the Nominal Liquidation Amount of subordinated classes pursuant to Section 3.05:

 

1.   

Initial allocation of Investor Charge-Offs to each tranche of Outstanding Notes

   $                
     

 

 

 
   Class A    $                
     

 

 

 
   Class B    $                
     

 

 

 
   Class C    $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Amount reallocated to the Class D Notes, subject to the restrictions set forth in Section 3.05(d)

   $                
     

 

 

 
3.   

Amount reallocated to the Class C Notes, subject to the restrictions set forth in Section 3.05(c)

   $                
     

 

 

 
4.   

Amount reallocated to the Class B Notes, subject to the restrictions set forth in Section 3.05(b)

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

H.

  Net proceeds from sales of Receivables for Accelerated Notes pursuant to Section 3.20    $                
    

 

 

 

 

B-6


III. Targeted deposits to, and withdrawals of funds on deposit from, the Class C Reserve Account.

 

A. Targeted deposit to the Class C Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.22(a):

 

B. Deposits to the Class C Reserve sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.22:

 

1.    Sum of the Class C Reserve sub-Account deposits for each applicable tranche of Outstanding Notes:   
   a. [Class/Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. [Class/Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

C. Withdrawals from the Class C Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.23:

 

1.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Class C Reserve sub-Account and deposited in the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account pursuant to Section 3.23(a):

  
   a. Interest Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. Interest Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Amount withdrawn from the Class C Reserve sub-Account and deposited in the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account pursuant to Section 3.23(b):

  
   a. Principal Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. Principal Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 
3.   

Amounts paid to the Issuer pursuant to Section 3.23(c)

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

B-7


IV. Targeted deposits to, and withdrawals of funds on deposit from, the Class D Reserve Account.

 

A. Targeted deposit to the Class D Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.29(a):

 

B. Deposits to the Class D Reserve sub-Accounts pursuant to Section 3.29:

 

1.   

Sum of the Class D Reserve sub-Account deposits for each applicable tranche of Outstanding Notes:

  
   a. [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

C. Withdrawals from the Class D Reserve Account pursuant to Section 3.30:

 

1.   

Amount withdrawn from the applicable Class D Reserve sub-Account and deposited in the applicable Interest Funding sub-Account pursuant to Section 3.30(a):

  
   a. Interest Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. Interest Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 
2.   

Amount withdrawn from the Class D Reserve sub-Account and deposited in the applicable Principal Funding sub-Account pursuant to Section 3.30(b):

  
   a. Principal Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
   b. Principal Funding sub-Account for [Tranche]    $                
     

 

 

 
  

Total

   $                
     

 

 

 
3.   

Amounts paid to the Issuer pursuant to Section 3.30(c)

   $                
     

 

 

 

 

B-8


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has duly executed and delivered this Certificate this      day of             ,         .

 

CAPITAL ONE BANK,
as Administrator
By:  

 

  Name:
  Title:

 

B-9


EXHIBIT C

[FORM OF] CARD SERIES SCHEDULE TO

MONTHLY NOTEHOLDERS’ STATEMENT

Date:                  ,         

CAPITAL ONE MULTI-ASSET EXECUTION TRUST

MONTHLY PERIOD ENDING                  ,         

Reference is made to the Amended and Restated Series 2002-CC Supplement (the “Series 2002-CC Supplement”), dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated on March 17, 2016 between Capital One Funding, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company (“Funding”), as Transferor, Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, a national banking association (the “Bank”), as Servicer, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Trustee, and the Indenture (the “Indenture”), dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016 between Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, as Issuer, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as Indenture Trustee. Terms used herein and not defined herein have the meanings ascribed to them in the Series 2002-CC Supplement, the Indenture and the related Indenture Supplements, as applicable.

The following computations are prepared with respect to the Transfer Date of                  ,          and with respect to the performance of the Trust during the related Monthly Period.

[TO BE PROVIDED]

 

C-1


STATE OF DELAWARE    )   
   )    ss:
COUNTY OF CASTLE    )   

On this      day of             , 20[    ], before me personally came                     , a              of                     , to me known to be the person described in and who executed the foregoing instrument, and duly acknowledged that [he][she] executed the same for the purposes therein contained, and acknowledged the same to be [his][her] free act and deed.

 

 

Name

 

[Notarial Seal]

 

C-2


STATE OF NEW YORK    )   
   )    ss:
COUNTY OF NEW YORK    )   

On the      day of             , 20[    ], before me personally came                      to me known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say that s/he is the                      of The Bank of New York Mellon, one of the entities described in and which executed the foregoing instrument; that s/he signed his/her name to the said instrument and that s/he has been authorized by The Bank of New York Mellon to execute the foregoing instrument.

 

 

Notary Public

My Commission Expires

 

 

 

 

Notarial Seal

 

C-3

EX-4.6 7 d125824dex46.htm EXHIBIT 4.6 Exhibit 4.6

EXHIBIT 4.6

 

 

 

ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEW AGREEMENT

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,

as Transferor

and

CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,

as Servicer and in its individual capacity

and

CLAYTON FIXED INCOME SERVICES LLC,

as Asset Representations Reviewer

 

 

CAPITAL ONE MASTER TRUST

Dated as of March 17, 2016

 

 

 

 

 


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

SECTION    HEADING    PAGE  

ARTICLE I.

  

DEFINITIONS

     2   

Section 1.01.

  

Definitions

     2   

Section 1.02.

  

Additional Definitions

     2   

ARTICLE II.

  

ENGAGEMENT; ACCEPTANCE

     5   

Section 2.01.

  

Engagement; Acceptance

     5   

Section 2.02.

  

Independence of the Asset Representations Reviewer

     6   

ARTICLE III.

  

DUTIES OF THE ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEWER

     6   

Section 3.01.

  

Review Scope

     6   

Section 3.02.

  

Review Notices

     6   

Section 3.03.

  

Review Materials

     7   

Section 3.04.

  

Missing or Incomplete Materials

     7   

Section 3.05.

  

The Asset Representations Review

     7   

Section 3.06.

  

Review Period

     8   

Section 3.07.

  

Completion of Review for Certain Review Receivables

     8   

Section 3.08.

  

Duplicative Test

     8   

Section 3.09.

  

Termination of Review

     8   

Section 3.10.

  

Review Report

     8   

Section 3.11.

  

Review and Procedure Limitations

     9   

Section 3.12.

  

Review Systems

     10   

Section 3.13.

  

Representatives

     10   

Section 3.14.

  

Dispute Resolution

     10   

Section 3.15.

  

Records Retention

     10   

ARTICLE IV.

  

PAYMENTS TO ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEWER

     11   

Section 4.01.

  

Asset Representations Reviewer Fees

     11   

Section 4.02.

  

Reimbursable Expenses

     11   

ARTICLE V.

  

OTHER MATTERS PERTAINING TO THE ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEWER

     11   

Section 5.01.

  

Representations and Warranties of the Asset Representations Reviewer

     11   

Section 5.02.

  

Limitation of Liability

     12   

Section 5.03.

  

Indemnification of Asset Representations Reviewer

     13   

Section 5.04.

  

Indemnification by Asset Representations Reviewer

     13   

Section 5.05.

  

Covenants

     14   

Section 5.06.

  

Inspections of Asset Representations Reviewer

     14   

 

-i-


ARTICLE VI.

  

REMOVAL, RESIGNATION

     15   

Section 6.01.

  

Removal of Asset Representations Reviewer

     15   

Section 6.02.

  

Appointment of Successor

     15   

Section 6.03.

  

Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Asset Representations Reviewer

     16   

Section 6.04.

  

Asset Representations Reviewer Not to Resign

     16   

Section 6.05.

  

Delegation of Obligations

     17   

ARTICLE VII.

  

TREATMENT OF CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION

     17   

Section 7.01.

  

Confidential Information

     17   

Section 7.02.

  

Safeguarding Personally Identifiable Information

     19   

ARTICLE VIII.

  

TERMINATION

     22   

Section 8.01.

  

Termination of Agreement

     22   

ARTICLE IX.

  

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

     22   

Section 9.01.

  

Amendment

     22   

Section 9.02.

  

Notices

     23   

Section 9.03.

  

Entire Agreement; Severability Clause

     24   

Section 9.04.

  

Counterparts

     24   

Section 9.05.

  

Governing Law

     24   

Section 9.06.

  

Captions

     25   

Section 9.07.

  

Waivers

     25   

Section 9.08.

  

Assignment

     25   

Section 9.09.

  

Benefit of This Agreement; Third-Party Beneficiaries

     25   

Section 9.10.

  

Exhibits

     25   

Section 9.11.

  

Nonpetition Covenant

     25   

EXHIBITS

Exhibit A

 

-ii-


ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEW AGREEMENT

This ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEW AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”), entered into as of the 17th day of March, 2016, by and among CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, a Virginia limited liability company (together with its successors and assigns, “Funding”), as Transferor (the “Transferor”), CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, a national banking association, in its individual capacity (together with its successors and assigns, “Capital One”), and as Servicer (the “Servicer”), and Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, as Asset Representations Reviewer (the “Asset Representations Reviewer”).

WHEREAS, in the normal course of its business Capital One originates and acquires credit card accounts and receivables in such credit card accounts.

WHEREAS, Capital One sells the receivables (the “Receivables”) arising in a subset of the credit card accounts (such subset, the “Accounts”) that it owns to Funding, pursuant to the Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 1, 2002, as amended and restated as of July 1, 2007, and as amended on March 1, 2008 and March 17, 2016, among Capital One and Funding (that agreement, as amended, together with each predecessor agreement, as the same may in the future be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “Receivables Purchase Agreement”).

WHEREAS, Funding securitizes the Receivables that it buys from Capital One by selling the Receivables to The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (the “COMT Trustee”) of the Capital One Master Trust (“COMT”), pursuant to the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016, among Funding, the Servicer and the COMT Trustee (that agreement, together with each predecessor agreement, as the same may in the future be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “Pooling and Servicing Agreement”). COMT is a common law trust formed pursuant to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. Pursuant to the Amended and Restated Series 2002-CC Supplement, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of March 17, 2016, among the Transferor, the Servicer and the COMT Trustee (as the same has been and may in the future be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time, the “Series 2002-CC Supplement”), COMT issued the Series 2002-CC Certificate representing an undivided interest in the pool of Receivables held by the COMT Trustee (the “Collateral Certificate”); that Collateral Certificate is currently held by Capital One Multi-asset Execution Trust, a Delaware statutory trust (the “Note Issuer”) as collateral for notes that have been and will be issued from time to time by the Note Issuer (the “Notes”).

WHEREAS, the Servicer has determined to engage the Asset Representations Reviewer to perform reviews of certain Receivables and, to the extent necessary to such reviews, the related Accounts for compliance with certain representations and warranties made by Capital One and Funding, as applicable, about the Receivables.


NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual agreements herein contained and other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, intending to be legally bound hereby, agree as follows:

ARTICLE I.

DEFINITIONS

Section 1.01. Definitions. Capitalized terms used but not defined in this Agreement have the meanings ascribed to those terms in (i) the Receivables Purchase Agreement, (ii) the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, or (iii) the Series 2002-CC Supplement, as applicable.

Section 1.02. Additional Definitions. Whenever used in this Agreement, the following words and phrases shall have the following meanings:

ABS Issuance Date” means any date, following the date of this Agreement, on which (i) any Investor Certificate is issued by COMT or (ii) any Note is issued by the Note Issuer.

Accounts” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Agreement” has the meaning specified in the first paragraph of this Agreement.

ARR Indemnified Person” has the meaning stated in Section 5.03.

Asset Representations Reviewer” has the meaning specified in the first paragraph of this Agreement.

Business Day” shall have the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Capital One” has the meaning specified in the first paragraph of this Agreement

Capital One Indemnified Person” has the meaning stated in Section 5.04.

Client Records” has the meaning stated in Section 3.15.

Collateral Certificate” has meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

COMT” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

COMT Trustee” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Confidential Information” has the meaning stated in Section 7.01(a).

Debtor Relief Laws” shall have the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

 

-2-


Disclosing Party” has the meaning stated in Section 7.01(a).

Dispute Resolution Agreement” means the Dispute Resolution Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016, by and among Funding, Capital One and the COMT Trustee, as the same may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

Dispute Resolution Proceeding” means any proceeding under Section 2.12 of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, Section 6.03 of the Receivables Purchase Agreement, or Section 2.01 of the Dispute Resolution Agreement.

Disqualification Event” has the meaning stated in Section 6.01(a).

Eligible Asset Representations Reviewer” means a Person who (i) is not affiliated with Capital One, the Transferor, the Servicer, the COMT Trustee, the Indenture Trustee, the Owner Trustee, or any of their respective affiliates, and (ii) was not engaged, nor affiliated with a Person that was engaged, by Capital One, the Transferor, or any underwriter of the Investor Certificates or Notes to perform due diligence work on the Receivables or the Accounts in connection with the closing for an issuance of such Investor Certificates or Notes.

Eligible Representations” shall mean those representations identified within the “Tests” included in Exhibit A.

Engagement Date” means March 17, 2016.

Final Review Report” has the meaning stated in Section 3.10.

Funding” has the meaning specified in the first paragraph of this Agreement.

Governmental Authority” shall have the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Indenture” means the Indenture, dated as of October 9, 2002, as amended and restated as of January 13, 2006 and March 17, 2016, between the Note Issuer and the Indenture Trustee, together with each predecessor agreement, as the same may in the future be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.

Indenture Trustee” means The Bank of New York Mellon, as indenture trustee under the Indenture.

Insolvency Event” means the Asset Representations Reviewer shall consent to the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, bankruptcy, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings of or relating to the Asset Representations Reviewer or relating to all or substantially all of its property, or a decree or order of a court or agency or supervisory authority having jurisdiction in the premises for the appointment of a conservator, receiver, trustee or liquidator in any insolvency, bankruptcy, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings, or

 

-3-


for the winding up or liquidation of its affairs, shall have been entered against the Asset Representations Reviewer; or the Asset Representations Reviewer shall admit in writing its inability to pay its debts generally as they become due, file a petition to take advantage of any applicable insolvency, bankruptcy or reorganization statute, make an assignment for the benefit of its creditors or voluntarily suspend payment of its obligations.

Investor Certificate” has the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Investor Certificateholder” has the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Note Issuer” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Notes” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Obligor” has the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Personally Identifiable Information,” or “PII,” has the meaning stated in Section 7.02(a).

Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Preliminary Review Report” has the meaning stated in Section 3.10.

Receivables” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Receivables Purchase Agreement” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Receiving Party” has the meaning stated in Section 7.01(a).

Representatives” has the meaning stated in Section 7.01(a).

Representing Party” has the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Receivables Purchase Agreement, or the Dispute Resolution Agreement, as applicable.

Requesting Party” has the meaning specified in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Receivables Purchase Agreement, or the Dispute Resolution Agreement, as applicable.

Review” means the performance by the Asset Representations Reviewer of the procedures listed under “Tests” in Exhibit A for the Review Receivables and Review Accounts, as further described in Article III.

 

-4-


Review Accounts” means those Accounts identified by the Servicer as requiring a Review by the Asset Representations Reviewer following receipt of a Review Notice pursuant to Section 3.02.

Review Fee” has the meaning stated in Section 4.01(b).

Review Materials” means, for a Review, the documents, data, and other information listed in Exhibit A.

Review Notice” has the meaning stated in Section 3.02.

Review Receivables” means those Receivables identified by the Servicer as requiring a Review by the Asset Representations Reviewer following receipt of a Review Notice pursuant to Section 3.02.

Review Report” means each of the Preliminary Review Report and the Final Review Report.

Security Breach” has the meaning stated in Section 7.02(d).

Series 2002-CC Supplement” has the meaning specified in the recitals of this Agreement.

Servicer” has the meaning specified in the first paragraph of this Agreement.

Supplemental Review Materials” has the meaning stated in Section 3.10.

Tests” mean the procedures listed in Exhibit A as applied to the process described in Section 3.05.

Test Complete” has the meaning stated in Section 3.07.

Test Fail” has the meaning stated in Section 3.05.

Test Incomplete” has the meaning stated in Section 3.04.

Test Pass” has the meaning stated in Section 3.05.

Transferor” has the meaning specified in the first paragraph of this Agreement.

ARTICLE II.

ENGAGEMENT; ACCEPTANCE

Section 2.01. Engagement; Acceptance. The Servicer engages Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC to act as the Asset Representations Reviewer. The Asset Representations Reviewer accepts the engagement and agrees to perform the obligations of the Asset Representations Reviewer on the terms stated in this Agreement.

 

-5-


Section 2.02. Independence of the Asset Representations Reviewer. The Asset Representations Reviewer will be an independent contractor and will not be subject to the supervision of the Transferor, Capital One or the Servicer for the manner in which it accomplishes the performance of its obligations under this Agreement. The Asset Representations Reviewer will have no authority to act for or represent the Transferor or the Servicer and is not being appointed as, and will not be considered, an agent of the Transferor, Capital One or the Servicer. Nothing in this Agreement will make the Asset Representations Reviewer and any of the Transferor, Capital One or the Servicer, members of any partnership, joint venture or other separate entity or impose any liability as such on any of them.

ARTICLE III.

DUTIES OF THE ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEWER

Section 3.01. Review Scope. The Review is designed to determine whether the Review Receivables and Review Accounts were not in compliance with the Eligible Representations.

The Review is not designed to determine any of the following:

(a) Reason for delinquency;

(b) Creditworthiness of the Obligor, either at the time of the Review or as of the Review Receivable or Review Account creation date;

(c) Overall quality of any Review Receivable or Review Account;

(d) Whether the Servicer has serviced any Review Receivable or Review Account in compliance with the Pooling and Servicing Agreement;

(e) Whether noncompliance with the representations or warranties constitutes a breach of the provisions of either the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the Receivables Purchase Agreement;

(f) Whether the Review Receivables or Review Accounts were in compliance with the representations and warranties set forth in the Receivables Purchase Agreement or the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, except as expressly described in this Agreement; or

(g) To establish cause, materiality or recourse for any Test Fail.

Section 3.02. Review Notices. Upon receipt of a notice (a “Review Notice”) from the Servicer pursuant to the terms of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and upon obtaining access to any Review Materials as provided in Section 3.03, the Asset Representations Reviewer

 

-6-


will start its Review. Once the Review Notice is issued, the Servicer will deliver a current list that identifies each Review Account and the balance of the Review Receivables to the Asset Representations Reviewer within twenty (20) days.

The Asset Representations Reviewer is not obligated to verify (i) whether the Servicer properly determined that a Review Notice was required or (ii) the accuracy or completeness of the list of Review Accounts or the balance of the Review Receivables made available by the Servicer.

Section 3.03. Review Materials. The Servicer will give the Asset Representations Reviewer access to the Review Materials for all of the Review Receivables and Review Accounts within sixty (60) days after issuance of the Review Notice in one or more of the following ways: (i) by providing access to the Servicer’s receivables systems, either remotely or at an office of the Servicer, (ii) by electronic posting to a password-protected website to which the Asset Representations Reviewer has access, (iii) by providing originals or photocopies at an office of the Servicer where the documents relating to the Receivables and the related Accounts are located or (iv) in another manner agreed to by each of the Servicer and the Asset Representations Reviewer. The Servicer may redact or remove Personally Identifiable Information from the Review Materials without changing the meaning or usefulness of the Review Materials for the Review.

If the Servicer provides access to the Review Materials at one of its offices, such access will be afforded without charge but only (i) upon reasonable notice, (ii) during normal business hours, (iii) subject to the Servicer’s normal security and confidentiality procedures and (iv) at offices designated by the Servicer.

Section 3.04. Missing or Incomplete Materials. Upon obtaining access to the Review Materials, the Asset Representations Reviewer will review the Review Materials to determine if any documents, data, or other information are missing or incomplete and, as a result, are insufficient for the Asset Representations Reviewer to perform any Test. If the Asset Representations Reviewer determines that there are any such missing or incomplete documents, data, or other information, the Asset Representations Reviewer will notify the Servicer promptly, and in any event no more than twenty (20) days after obtaining access to the Review Materials, specifying what information is missing or incomplete. The Servicer will have thirty (30) days to provide the Asset Representations Reviewer access to the missing or incomplete documents, data or other information. If access to the missing or incomplete documents, data, or other information has not been provided by the Servicer within thirty (30) days from the date that the Asset Representations Reviewer gave notice of such documents, data, or other information’s absence or incompleteness, the Asset Representations Reviewer will identify the associated Tests as “Test Incomplete.”

Section 3.05. The Asset Representations Review. When required under the terms of this Agreement, the Asset Representations Reviewer will perform a Review. In the course of a Review, the Asset Representations Reviewer will use the Review Materials provided or made available by the Servicer pursuant to Sections 3.03 and 3.04, as well as any Supplemental Review Materials provided or made available pursuant to Section 3.10. For each Test, the Asset Representations Reviewer will determine if the Test has been satisfied (a “Test Pass”) or if the Test has not been satisfied (a “Test Fail”).

 

-7-


Section 3.06. Review Period. (a) The Asset Representations Reviewer will complete the Review within ninety (90) days of receiving access to substantially all of the Review Materials as provided in Section 3.03, or such longer period of time (not to exceed an additional thirty (30) days) as the parties to this Agreement may agree. If additional Review Materials are made available to the Asset Representations Reviewer as described in Section 3.04, the Review period will be extended for an additional thirty (30) days beyond the period determined in accordance with the preceding sentence.

(b) If Supplemental Review Materials are made available to the Asset Representations Reviewer as described in Section 3.10, the Review period will be re-opened and the Asset Representations Reviewer will complete the Review on the basis of such Supplemental Review Materials within thirty (30) days of receiving access to those Supplemental Review Materials, or such longer period of time (not to exceed an additional fifteen (15) days) as the parties to this Agreement may agree.

Section 3.07. Completion of Review for Certain Review Receivables. Following the delivery of the list of Review Accounts and the balance of the Review Receivables, and before the delivery of any Review Report by the Asset Representations Reviewer, the Servicer may notify the Asset Representations Reviewer if the Review Receivables with respect to any Review Account have been paid in full by the related Obligor or repurchased by the Transferor or purchased by the Servicer according to the terms of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement. Upon receipt of such notice, the Asset Representations Reviewer will immediately terminate all Tests of such Review Receivables and related Review Accounts and the Review of such Review Receivables and related Review Accounts will be considered complete (a “Test Complete”). In this case, each Review Report will indicate a Test Complete for such Review Receivables and related Review Accounts and the related reason.

Section 3.08. Duplicative Test. If any Review Receivable or Review Account was included in a prior Review, the Asset Representations Reviewer will not perform any Tests on it, but will include the results of the previous Tests in each Review Report for the current Review. If the same Test is required for more than one Eligible Representation, the Asset Representations Reviewer will perform the Test only once for each Review Receivable or Review Account but will report the results of the Test for each applicable representation or warranty on each Review Report.

Section 3.09. Termination of Review. If a Review is in process and the Invested Amount of all Investor Certificates will be reduced to zero on the next Distribution Date, the Servicer will notify the Asset Representations Reviewer no less than ten (10) days before that Distribution Date. On receipt of such notice, the Asset Representations Reviewer will terminate the Review immediately and will not be obligated to deliver any Review Report.

Section 3.10. Review Report. Within ten (10) days following the end of the Review period described in Section 3.06(a), the Asset Representations Reviewer will provide the

 

-8-


Servicer with a preliminary Review Report (a “Preliminary Review Report”) setting out each preliminary Test result (i.e., Test Pass, Test Fail or Test Complete) for the Review Receivables and Review Accounts. The Servicer will provide the Preliminary Review Report to the Transferor and Capital One within two (2) Business Days of the Servicer’s receipt of the report. If, within thirty (30) days of the date that the Transferor and Capital One receive the Preliminary Review Report, the Servicer receives additional documents, data, or other information (collectively, “Supplemental Review Materials”) to potentially refute any finding in the Preliminary Review Report, the Servicer will within two (2) Business Days of its receipt, make such Supplemental Review Materials available to the Asset Representations Reviewer in one or more of the ways set forth in Section 3.03. The Asset Representations Reviewer will then consider such Supplemental Review Materials and, within ten (10) days following the end of the Review period described in Section 3.06(b), either confirm or revise its Preliminary Review Report and provide the Servicer and the COMT Trustee with a final Review Report (a “Final Review Report”) setting out each final Test result (i.e., Test Pass, Test Fail or Test Complete) for the Review Receivables and Review Accounts.

If, within forty (40) days after the date that the Asset Representations Reviewer provided its Preliminary Review Report to the Servicer, the Servicer has not made available to the Asset Representations Reviewer Supplemental Review Materials to potentially refute a finding in the Preliminary Review Report, within ten (10) days following such fortieth (40th) day, the Asset Representations Reviewer will provide the Servicer and the COMT Trustee with a Final Review Report (which will be based on the findings set forth in the Preliminary Review Report). The Servicer will provide the Final Review Report to the Transferor and Capital One within two (2) Business Days of receipt of the report.

Each Review Report will include a summary containing the information required to be included in COMT’s or the Note Issuer’s Form 10-D report for the Monthly Period in which the Final Review Report is provided to the Servicer and the COMT Trustee. No Review Report shall contain any PII in any form relating to Obligors, as determined by the Asset Representations Reviewer with the concurrence of the Servicer. Upon reasonable request of the Servicer, the Asset Representations Reviewer will provide additional detail on the preliminary or final Test results.

Section 3.11. Review and Procedure Limitations. (a) The Asset Representations Reviewer will have no obligation (i) to determine whether a Delinquency Trigger has occurred, (ii) to determine whether the required percentage of Investor Certificateholders has voted to direct a Review, (iii) to determine which Accounts and/or Receivables are subject to a Review, (iv) to obtain or confirm the validity of the Review Materials, (v) except to the extent of its express obligations under Section 3.04, to obtain missing or incomplete documents, data, or other information, or (vi) to take any action or cause any other party to take any action under the Pooling and Servicing Agreement to enforce any remedies for breaches of representations or warranties about the Eligible Representations.

(b) The Asset Representations Reviewer will be required to perform only the Tests provided in Exhibit A in consideration of the Review Materials and any Supplemental Review Materials and will have no obligation to perform additional testing procedures on the Review

 

-9-


Receivables or Review Accounts, or, subject to Sections 3.04 and 3.10, to consider any additional information provided by any party. The Asset Representations Reviewer will have no obligation to provide reporting or information in addition to that expressly set forth in this Agreement. However, the Asset Representations Reviewer may review and report on additional information that it determines in good faith to be material to its performance under this Agreement.

Section 3.12. Review Systems. The Asset Representations Reviewer will maintain and utilize an electronic case management system to manage the Tests and provide systematic control over each step in the Review process and ensure consistency and repeatability among the Tests.

Section 3.13. Representatives.

(a) Servicer Representative. The Servicer will provide reasonable access to one or more designated representatives to respond to reasonable requests and inquiries made by the Asset Representations Reviewer in its completion of a Review.

(b) Asset Representations Review Representative. The Asset Representations Reviewer will provide reasonable access to one or more designated representatives to respond to reasonable requests and inquiries made by the Servicer during the Asset Representations Reviewer’s completion of a Review. The Asset Representations Reviewer will have no obligation to respond to requests or inquiries made by any Person not party to this Agreement.

Section 3.14. Dispute Resolution. If a Receivable that was Reviewed by the Asset Representations Reviewer is the subject of a Dispute Resolution Proceeding, the Asset Representations Reviewer will participate in the Dispute Resolution Proceeding on request of a party to the proceeding. The reasonable out-of-pocket expenses of the Asset Representations Reviewer for its participation in any Dispute Resolution Proceeding will be paid by a party to the Dispute Resolution Proceeding as determined (i) if the Requesting Party selects mediation as the resolution method, as mutually agreed upon by the Representing Party and the Requesting Party as part of the mediation, and (ii) if the Requesting Party selects arbitration as the resolution method, in accordance with the final determination of the arbitrator.

Section 3.15. Records Retention. The Asset Representations Reviewer will maintain copies of Review Materials, Supplemental Review Materials, Review Reports and internal work papers and correspondence (collectively the “Client Records”) for a period of three (3) years after the termination of this Agreement. At the expiration of the retention period, the Asset Representations Reviewer shall return all Client Records to the Servicer. Upon the return of the Client Records, the Asset Representations Reviewer shall have no obligation to retain such Client Records or to respond to inquiries concerning the related Review.

 

-10-


ARTICLE IV.

PAYMENTS TO ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEWER

Section 4.01. Asset Representations Reviewer Fees.

(a) Annual Fee. As compensation for its activities hereunder, the Asset Representations Reviewer shall be entitled to receive an annual fee (the “Annual Fee”) equal to the amount separately agreed to by the Servicer and the Asset Representations Reviewer with respect to each annual period prior to the termination of this Agreement. The Annual Fee will be initially payable on the date of this Agreement and then payable annually on each anniversary of the date of this Agreement upon receipt of a detailed invoice.

(b) Review Fee. Following the completion of a Review and delivery of the Final Review Report and a detailed invoice, the Asset Representations Reviewer shall be entitled to a fee equal to the amount separately agreed to by the Servicer and the Asset Representations Reviewer (the “Review Fee”).

Section 4.02. Reimbursable Expenses. If the Servicer provides access to the Review Materials at one of its offices, the Servicer will reimburse the Asset Representations Reviewer for its reasonable travel expenses incurred in connection with the Review after receipt of a detailed invoice for such expenses. If the Asset Representations Reviewer participates in a Dispute Resolution Proceeding under Section 3.14 and its reasonable expenses for participating in the proceeding are not paid by a party to the Dispute Resolution Proceeding within ninety (90) days after the end of the proceeding, the Servicer will reimburse the Asset Representations Reviewer for such expenses upon receipt of a detailed invoice. If the Servicer makes any payment under this Section 4.02 and the Asset Representations Reviewer later collects any of the amounts for which the payments were made to it from others, the Asset Representations Reviewer will promptly repay the amounts to the Servicer.

ARTICLE V.

OTHER MATTERS PERTAINING TO THE ASSET REPRESENTATIONS REVIEWER

Section 5.01. Representations and Warranties of the Asset Representations Reviewer. The Asset Representations Reviewer hereby makes the following representations and warranties as of each ABS Issuance Date:

(a) Organization and Good Standing. The Asset Representations Reviewer is a limited liability company duly formed and validly existing in good standing under the laws of the State of Delaware, with the power and authority to own its properties and to conduct its business as such properties are currently owned and such business is presently conducted, and has the power, authority and legal right to perform its obligations under this Agreement.

 

-11-


(b) Due Qualification. The Asset Representations Reviewer is duly qualified to do business and has obtained all necessary licenses and approvals in all jurisdictions in which the ownership or lease of property or the conduct of its business shall require such qualifications.

(c) Due Authorization. The execution, delivery and performance by the Asset Representations Reviewer of this Agreement have been duly authorized by the Asset Representations Reviewer by all necessary limited liability company action on the part of the Asset Representations Reviewer and this Agreement will remain, from the time of its execution, an official record of the Asset Representations Reviewer.

(d) Binding Obligation. This Agreement constitutes a legal, valid and binding obligation of the Asset Representations Reviewer enforceable in accordance with its terms subject to bankruptcy, insolvency and other similar laws affecting creditors’ rights generally and subject to equitable principles.

(e) No Violation. The execution and delivery of this Agreement by the Asset Representations Reviewer, and the performance by the Asset Representations Reviewer of the obligations contemplated by this Agreement and the fulfillment by the Asset Representations Reviewer of the terms hereof applicable to the Asset Representations Reviewer, will not conflict with, violate, result in any breach of any of the material terms and provisions of, or constitute (with or without notice or lapse of time or both) a default under, any Requirements of Law applicable to the Asset Representations Reviewer or any indenture, contract, agreement, or other instrument to which the Asset Representations Reviewer is a party or by which it is bound.

(f) No Proceedings. There are no proceedings or investigations pending or, to the best knowledge of the Asset Representations Reviewer, threatened against the Asset Representations Reviewer before any court, regulatory body, administrative agency or other tribunal or governmental instrumentality seeking to prevent the issuance of any Investor Certificates or Notes or the consummation of any of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, seeking any determination or ruling that, in the reasonable judgment of the Asset Representations Reviewer, would materially and adversely affect the performance by the Asset Representations Reviewer of its obligations under this Agreement, or seeking any determination or ruling that would materially and adversely affect the validity or enforceability of this Agreement.

(g) Eligibility. The Asset Representations Reviewer is an Eligible Asset Representations Reviewer.

Section 5.02. Limitation of Liability. The Asset Representations Reviewer will not be liable to any Person for any action taken, or not taken, in good faith under this Agreement or for errors in judgment; provided, however, that the Asset Representations Reviewer will be liable for its willful misconduct, bad faith or negligence in performing its obligations under this Agreement. In no event will the Asset Representations Reviewer be liable for special, indirect, or consequential losses or damages (including lost profit), even if the Asset Representations Reviewer has been advised of the likelihood of the loss or damage and regardless of the form of action.

 

-12-


Section 5.03. Indemnification of Asset Representations Reviewer. (a) The Servicer will indemnify the Asset Representations Reviewer and its officers, directors, employees and agents (each, an “ARR Indemnified Person”), for all reasonable and documented costs, expenses, losses, damages and liabilities resulting from any third-party claim arising out of the performance of the Asset Representations Reviewer’s obligations under this Agreement (including the reasonable and documented costs and expenses of defending itself against any loss, damage or liability), but excluding any cost, expense, loss, damage or liability resulting from (i) the Asset Representations Reviewer’s willful misconduct, bad faith or negligence or (ii) the Asset Representations Reviewer’s breach of any of its representations, warranties or covenants in this Agreement.

(b) In case any such action, investigation or proceeding will be brought involving an ARR Indemnified Person, the Servicer will assume the defense thereof, including the employment of counsel and the payment of all expenses. The Asset Representations Reviewer will have the right to employ separate counsel in any such action, investigation or proceeding and to participate in the defense thereof and the reasonable and documented fees and expenses of such counsel will be paid by the Servicer.

(c) The indemnification set forth herein will survive the termination of this Agreement and the resignation or removal of the Servicer.

(d) If the Servicer makes any payment under this Section 5.03 and the ARR Indemnified Person later collects any of the amounts for which the payments were made to it from others, the ARR Indemnified Person will promptly repay the amounts to the Servicer.

Section 5.04. Indemnification by Asset Representations Reviewer. (a) To the fullest extent permitted by law, the Asset Representations Reviewer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer, and each of their officers, directors, successors, assigns, legal representatives, agents, and servants (each, a “Capital One Indemnified Person”), from and against any and all liabilities, obligations, losses, damages, penalties, taxes, claims, actions, investigations, proceedings, costs, expenses or disbursements (including reasonable legal fees and expenses) of any kind and nature whatsoever that may be imposed on, incurred by, or asserted at any time against a Capital One Indemnified Person (whether or not also indemnified against by any other person) that arose out of the willful misconduct, bad faith or negligence of the Asset Representations Reviewer in the performance of its obligations and duties under this Agreement; provided, however, that the Asset Representations Reviewer shall not be liable for or required to indemnify a Capital One Indemnified Person from and against expenses arising or resulting from the Capital One Indemnified Person’s own willful misconduct, bad faith or negligence.

(b) In case any such action, investigation or proceeding will be brought involving a Capital One Indemnified Person, the Asset Representations Reviewer will assume the defense thereof, including the employment of counsel and the payment of all expenses. The Transferor,

 

-13-


Capital One and the Servicer each will have the right to employ separate counsel in any such action, investigation or proceeding and to participate in the defense thereof and the reasonable fees and expenses of such counsel will be paid by the Asset Representations Reviewer.

(c) The indemnification set forth herein will survive the termination of this Agreement and the resignation or removal of the Asset Representations Reviewer.

Section 5.05. Covenants. The Asset Representations Reviewer covenants and agrees that:

(a) Eligibility. It will notify the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer promptly if at any time during the term of this Agreement, it ceases to be an Eligible Asset Representations Reviewer.

(b) Review Systems; Personnel. It will maintain business process management and/or other systems necessary to ensure that it can perform each Test and, on execution of this Agreement, will load each Test into these systems. The Asset Representations Reviewer will ensure that these systems allow for each Review Account and the related Review Materials to be individually tracked and stored as contemplated by this Agreement. The Asset Representations Reviewer will maintain adequate staff that is properly trained to conduct Reviews as required by this Agreement.

(c) Compliance with Obligations. It will comply with each of its obligations under this Agreement.

(d) Outstanding Investor Certificates or Notes. In determining whether the requisite percentage of Investor Certificateholders have given any direction, notice, or consent under the terms of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Series 2002-CC Supplement, or this Agreement, any Investor Certificates or Notes owned by it or any of its affiliates will be disregarded and deemed not to be outstanding.

Section 5.06. Inspections of Asset Representations Reviewer. The Asset Representations Reviewer agrees that, with reasonable prior notice not more than once during any year, it will permit authorized representatives of the Servicer, Capital One and the Transferor, during the Asset Representations Reviewer’s normal business hours, to examine and review the books of account, records, reports and other documents and materials of the Asset Representations Reviewer relating to (a) the performance of the Asset Representations Reviewer’s obligations under this Agreement, (b) payments of fees and expenses of the Asset Representations Reviewer for its performance and (c) a claim made by the Asset Representations Reviewer under this Agreement. In addition, the Asset Representations Reviewer will permit the Servicer’s, Capital One’s and the Transferor’s representatives to make copies and extracts of any of those documents and to discuss them with the Asset Representations Reviewer’s officers and employees. Each of the Servicer, Capital One and the Transferor will, and will cause its authorized representatives to, hold in confidence the information, except if disclosure may be required by law or if the Servicer, Capital One or the Transferor reasonably determines that it is required to make the disclosure under this Agreement or any other transaction document relating to any Investor Certificate or Note. The Asset Representations Reviewer will maintain all relevant books, records, reports and other documents and materials for a period of three (3) years after the termination of its obligations under this Agreement.

 

-14-


ARTICLE VI.

REMOVAL, RESIGNATION

Section 6.01. Removal of Asset Representations Reviewer. (a) If any one of the following events (each a “Disqualification Event”) shall occur:

(i) the Asset Representations Reviewer ceases to be an Eligible Asset Representations Reviewer;

(ii) any failure by the Asset Representations Reviewer duly to observe or perform in any material respect any other covenant or agreement of the Asset Representations Reviewer set forth in this Agreement; or

(iii) an Insolvency Event occurs.

then, the Servicer may or, in the case of Section 6.01(a)(i), shall remove the Asset Representations Reviewer by delivery of a written instrument to that effect.

(b) The Servicer may also remove the Asset Representations Reviewer by delivery of a written instrument to that effect on or after the fifth anniversary of the Engagement Date, upon sixty (60) days’ written notice (or such shorter notice period as the parties to this Agreement may agree) from the Servicer to the Asset Representations Reviewer, Capital One, the Transferor, and the COMT Trustee.

(c) The Servicer may also remove the Asset Representations Reviewer by delivery of a written instrument to that effect if (A) another entity, directly or indirectly, in a single transaction or series of related transactions, acquires control of Capital One or its parent Capital One Financial Corporation, (“COFC”) or all or substantially all of the assets of Capital One or COFC; (B) COFC is merged with or into another entity; or (C) in a single transaction or series of related transactions, COFC acquires control of an entity that is substantially similar in size to COFC.

(d) Any removal of the Asset Representations Reviewer shall not take effect until a successor Asset Representations Reviewer is appointed in accordance with Section 6.02. Any expenses incurred by the Servicer in connection with replacing the Asset Representations Reviewer following any Disqualification Event shall be reimbursed by the removed Asset Representations Reviewer promptly upon delivery by the Servicer of a detailed invoice.

Section 6.02. Appointment of Successor. Upon the removal of the Asset Representations Reviewer pursuant to Section 6.01 or a permitted resignation of the Asset Representations Reviewer pursuant to Section 6.04, the Servicer shall use commercially reasonable efforts to appoint a successor Asset Representations Reviewer, who shall be an Eligible Asset

 

-15-


Representations Reviewer, by written instrument signed by the Servicer, Capital One, the Transferor, the resigning Asset Representations Reviewer, and such successor Asset Representations Reviewer. If a successor Asset Representations Reviewer has not been appointed within sixty (60) days after the giving of written notice of such resignation or the delivery of the written instrument with respect to such removal, the Asset Representations Reviewer or the Servicer may apply to any court of competent jurisdiction to appoint a successor Asset Representations Reviewer to act until such time, if any, as a successor Asset Representations Reviewer has been appointed as above provided. Any successor Asset Representations Reviewer so appointed by such court will immediately and without further act be superseded by any successor Asset Representations Reviewer appointed as above provided.

Section 6.03. Merger or Consolidation of, or Assumption of the Obligations of, the Asset Representations Reviewer. Any Person (a) into which the Asset Representations Reviewer is merged or consolidated, (b) resulting from any merger or consolidation to which the Asset Representations Reviewer is a party or (c) succeeding to the business of the Asset Representations Reviewer, if that Person is an Eligible Asset Representations Reviewer, will be the successor to the Asset Representations Reviewer under this Agreement.

If the Asset Representations Reviewer is not the surviving entity, such successor shall expressly assume, by an agreement supplemental hereto, executed by, and delivered to, the Servicer, Capital One, and the Transferor, in a form satisfactory to the Servicer, Capital One, and the Transferor, the performance of every covenant and obligation of the Asset Representations Reviewer, as applicable hereunder (to the extent that any right, covenant or obligation of the Asset Representations Reviewer, as applicable hereunder, is inapplicable to the successor entity, such successor entity shall be subject to such covenant or obligation, or benefit from such right, as would apply, to the extent practicable, to such successor entity); and the Asset Representations Reviewer shall have delivered to the Servicer, Capital One, and the Transferor an officer’s certificate of the Asset Representations Reviewer to the effect that such consolidation, merger, conveyance or transfer and such supplemental agreement comply with this Section 6.03, that the successor Asset Representations Reviewer is an Eligible Asset Representations Reviewer, and that all conditions precedent herein provided for relating to such transaction have been complied with and an Opinion of Counsel that such supplemental agreement is legal, valid and binding with respect to the Asset Representations Reviewer.

Section 6.04. Asset Representations Reviewer Not to Resign. The Asset Representations Reviewer shall not resign from the obligations and duties hereby imposed on it, except:

(a) Upon determination that (i) the performance of its duties hereunder is no longer permissible under applicable law and (ii) there is no reasonable action that the Asset Representations Reviewer could take to make the performance of its duties hereunder permissible under applicable law;

(b) On or after the fifth anniversary of the Engagement Date, upon one (1) year’s written notice (or such shorter notice period as the parties to this Agreement may agree) from the Asset Representations Reviewer to the Servicer, Capital One, the Transferor, and the COMT Trustee; or

(c) Upon a failure by the Servicer to pay any material amount due under Article IV when such amount becomes due and payable, and continuance of such non-payment for a period of sixty (60) days following the date on which such amount became due and payable.

 

-16-


Any such determination permitting the resignation of the Asset Representations Reviewer shall be evidenced as to clause (a)(i) above by an opinion of counsel and as to clause (a)(ii) by an officer’s certificate of the Asset Representations Reviewer, each to such effect delivered to the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer. No resignation under this Section 6.04 shall become effective until a successor Asset Representations Reviewer shall have assumed the responsibilities and obligations of the Asset Representations Reviewer in accordance with Section 6.02. Any reasonable expenses incurred by the Servicer in connection with replacing the Asset Representations Reviewer following the Asset Representations Reviewer’s resignation under Section 6.04(b) shall be reimbursed by the resigning Asset Representations Reviewer promptly upon delivery by the Servicer of a detailed invoice.

Section 6.05. Delegation of Obligations. The Asset Representations Reviewer may not delegate or subcontract its obligations under this Agreement to any Person without the consent of the Capital One, the Transferor, and the Servicer. Any such delegation or subcontracting to which Capital One, the Transferor, and the Servicer have consented shall not relieve the Asset Representations Reviewer of its liability and responsibility with respect to such obligations, and shall not constitute a resignation within the meaning of Section 6.04.

ARTICLE VII.

TREATMENT OF CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION

Section 7.01. Confidential Information.

(a) Confidential Information Defined. For the purposes of this Agreement, “Confidential Information” means information that (i) is identified as non-public, confidential or proprietary information or (ii) a reasonable person would deem to be non-public, confidential or proprietary information of a party (the “Disclosing Party”) that is disclosed to the other party (the “Receiving Party”) by the Disclosing Party or any of its Representatives in connection with the performance of this Agreement, including but not limited to (a) business or technical processes, formulae, source codes, object code, product designs, sales, cost and other unpublished financial information, customer information, product and business plans, projections, marketing data or strategies, trade secrets, intellectual property rights, know-how, expertise, methods and procedures for operation, information about employees, customer names, business or technical proposals, and any other information that is or should reasonably be understood to be confidential or proprietary to the Disclosing Party, (b) Personally Identifiable Information and (c) Review Materials. The foregoing definition of Confidential Information applies to: (i) all such information, whether tangible or intangible and regardless of the medium in which it is stored or presented; and (ii) all copies of such information, as well as all memoranda, notes, summaries, analyses, computer records, and other materials prepared by the Receiving Party or any of its employees, agents, advisors, directors, officers, accountants, auditors and subcontractors, or those of its Affiliates (collectively “Representatives”) to the extent they contain or reflect the Confidential Information.

 

-17-


(b) Use of Confidential Information. Each party acknowledges that during the term of this Agreement it may be exposed to or acquire Confidential Information of the other party or its Affiliates. The Receiving Party shall hold the Confidential Information of the Disclosing Party in strict confidence and will not disclose such information except to its Representatives who have a need to know such information in connection with the performance of this Agreement and who are informed by the Receiving Party of the confidential nature of the Confidential Information and are directed by the Receiving Party to treat the Confidential Information in a manner consistent with the terms of this Agreement. The Receiving Party shall be responsible for the breach of this Agreement by any of its Representatives. The Receiving Party will hold and protect the Disclosing Party’s Confidential Information using the same degree of care that it uses to protect its own confidential, non-public and/or proprietary information, but in no event with less than a commercially reasonable standard of care.

(c) Exceptions. Confidential Information shall not include, and this Agreement imposes no obligations with respect to, information that:

(i) was, at the time of disclosure to the Receiving Party, in the public domain or, after disclosure to the Receiving Party, has become part of the public domain through no act or omission of the Receiving Party;

(ii) was in the possession of the Receiving Party, without confidentiality restrictions, at the time of disclosure to the Receiving Party hereunder;

(iii) was or hereafter is independently developed by a party outside of this Agreement and without use of, reference to, access to, or reliance on any Confidential Information of the other party; or

(iv) was lawfully and independently obtained by the Receiving Party from a third party who, to the knowledge of the Receiving Party after reasonable inquiry, is not subject to an obligation of confidentiality or otherwise prohibited from disclosing or transmitting the information to the Receiving Party.

The foregoing exceptions shall not apply to any Personally Identifiable Information, which shall remain confidential in all circumstances, except as required or permitted to be disclosed by applicable law, statute, or regulation.

(d) Disclosure by Operation of Law. If any party or any of its Representatives is requested or required (orally or in writing, by law, regulation or interrogatory, request for information or documents, court order, subpoena, deposition, administrative proceedings, inspection, audit, civil investigative demand or other legal, governmental or regulatory process) to disclose all or any part of any Confidential Information, such party shall (i) to the extent permitted by law, rule and regulation, promptly notify the other party of the existence, terms and circumstances surrounding such request; (ii) consult with the other party on the advisability of

 

-18-


taking legally available steps to resist or narrow such request and cooperate with such party on any steps it considers advisable; and (iii) if disclosure of the Confidential Information is required or deemed advisable, exercise commercially reasonable efforts to obtain an order, stipulation or other reliable assurance that confidential treatment shall be accorded to such portion of the Confidential Information to be disclosed. Each party shall reimburse the other party for reasonable legal fees and expenses incurred in connection with such party’s efforts to comply with this section. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, the Servicer and its Affiliates may disclose Confidential Information, without notice to the Asset Representations Reviewer, to any governmental agency, regulatory authority or self-regulatory authority (including, without limitation, bank and securities examiners) having or claiming to have authority to regulate or oversee any aspect of the Servicer’s business or that of its Affiliates in connection with the exercise of such authority or claimed authority.

(e) Return of Confidential Information. Upon the written request of the Disclosing Party, the Receiving Party shall return or destroy all Confidential Information to the Disclosing Party provided to it pursuant to this Agreement; provided, however, (i) the Receiving Party shall be permitted to retain copies of the Disclosing Party’s Confidential Information solely for archival, audit, disaster recovery, legal, and/or regulatory purposes or, if longer, for the period of time set forth in Section 3.15, and (ii) the Receiving Party shall be permitted to retain copies of the Disclosing Party’s Confidential Information to the extent it would be unreasonably burdensome to destroy such Confidential Information (such as archived computer records); provided further, that (x) any Confidential Information so retained will remain subject to the obligations and restrictions contained in this Agreement, notwithstanding any termination hereof, and (y) the Receiving Party will not use the retained Confidential Information for any other purpose.

(f) Remedies. Each of the parties acknowledges that all Confidential Information of the other party is considered to be proprietary and of competitive value, and in many instances, trade secrets. Each of the parties hereto agrees that because of the unique nature of such Confidential Information, any breach of this Section by it or its Representatives would cause irreparable harm to the Disclosing Party and that money damages and other remedies available at law in the event of a breach would not be adequate to compensate the Disclosing Party for any such breach. Accordingly, each party shall be entitled, without the requirement of posting a bond or other security, to equitable relief, including, without limitation, injunctive relief and specific performance, as a remedy for any such breach. Such relief shall be in addition to, and not in lieu of, all other remedies available to such party, whether under this Agreement, at law or in equity.

Section 7.02. Safeguarding Personally Identifiable Information.

(a) Definition. Personally Identifiable Information, or PII, means information in any format about an identifiable individual, including, name, address, phone number, e-mail address, account number(s), identification number(s), any other actual or assigned attribute associated with or identifiable to an individual and any information that when used separately or in combination with other information could identify an individual, as further described in § 501(b) of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act and the Interagency Guidelines Establishing Standards for Safeguarding Customer Information (12 C.F.R. Section 208, Appendix D-2), that is provided or made available to the Asset Representations Reviewer in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

-19-


(b) Use of PII. The Servicer does not grant the Asset Representations Reviewer any rights to PII except as provided in this Agreement. The Asset Representations Reviewer will use PII only to perform its obligations under this Agreement or as specifically directed in writing by the Servicer and will only reproduce PII to the extent necessary for these purposes. The Asset Representations Reviewer must comply with all laws applicable to PII and the Asset Representations Reviewer’s business, including any legally required codes of conduct, including those relating to privacy, security and data protection. The Asset Representations Reviewer will protect and secure PII. The Asset Representations Reviewer will implement privacy or data protection policies and procedures that comply with applicable law and this Agreement. The Asset Representations Reviewer will implement and maintain reasonable and appropriate practices, procedures and systems, including administrative, technical and physical safeguards to (i) protect the security, confidentiality and integrity of PII, (ii) ensure against anticipated threats or hazards to the security or integrity of PII, (iii) protect against unauthorized access to or use of PII and (iv) otherwise comply with its obligations under this Agreement. These safeguards include a written data security plan, employee training, information access controls, restricted disclosures, systems protections (e.g., intrusion protection, data storage protection and data transmission protection) and physical security measures.

(c) Additional Limitations. In addition to the use and protection requirements described in Section 7.02(b), the Asset Representations Reviewer’s disclosure of PII is also subject to the following requirements:

(i) The Asset Representations Reviewer will not disclose PII to its personnel or allow its personnel access to PII except (A) for the Asset Representations Reviewer personnel who require PII to perform a Review, (B) with the prior consent of the Servicer or (C) as required by applicable law. When permitted, the disclosure of or access to PII will be limited to the specific information necessary for the individual to complete the assigned task. The Asset Representations Reviewer will inform personnel with access to PII of the confidentiality requirements in this Agreement and train its personnel with access to PII on the proper use and protection of PII.

(ii) The Asset Representations Reviewer will not sell, disclose, provide or exchange PII with or to any third party without the prior consent of the Servicer.

(d) Notice of Breach. The Asset Representations Reviewer will notify the Servicer immediately if it discovers there has been (i) a data security event that did compromise, or could have compromised, the security of PII, or (ii) any event that did result, or could have resulted, in the unauthorized access to or use of the PII, irrespective of whether the unauthorized access or use relates to external parties or Representatives of the Asset Representation Reviewer ((i) and (ii) collectively known as a “Security Breach”) and, where applicable, immediately take action to prevent any further breach. Should a Security Breach occur, the Asset Representations Reviewer shall cooperate with the Servicer to respond to the Security Breach or to otherwise protect PII, including but not limited to, by enabling the Servicer to implement expeditiously its own data

 

-20-


security breach response program. Should a Security Breach occur, the Asset Representations Reviewer will commence all reasonable efforts to investigate and correct the causes and remediate the results thereof, and, following discovery of any such event, provide the Servicer with such further information and assistance as may be reasonably requested.

(e) Return or Disposal of PII. Except where return or disposal is prohibited by applicable law, promptly on the earlier of the completion of the Review or the request of the Servicer, all PII in any medium in the Asset Representations Reviewer’s possession or under its control will be (i) destroyed in a manner that prevents its recovery or restoration or (ii) if so directed by the Servicer, returned to the Servicer without the Asset Representations Reviewer retaining any actual or recoverable copies, in both cases, without charge to the Servicer. Where the Asset Representations Reviewer retains PII, the Asset Representations Reviewer will limit the Asset Representations Reviewer’s further use or disclosure of PII to that required by applicable law.

(f) Compliance; Modification. The Asset Representations Reviewer will cooperate with and provide information to the Servicer regarding the Asset Representations Reviewer’s compliance with this Section 7.02. The Asset Representations Reviewer and the Servicer agree to modify this Section 7.02 as necessary for either party to comply with applicable law.

(g) Audit of Asset Representations Reviewer. The Asset Representations Reviewer will permit the Servicer and its authorized representatives to audit the Asset Representations Reviewer’s compliance with this Section 7.02 during the Asset Representations Reviewer’s normal business hours on reasonable advance notice to the Asset Representations Reviewer, and not more than once during any year unless circumstances necessitate additional audits. The Servicer agrees to make reasonable efforts to schedule any audit described in this Section 7.02 with the inspections described in Section 5.06. The Asset Representations Reviewer will also permit the Servicer during normal business hours on reasonable advance written notice to audit any service providers used by the Asset Representations Reviewer to fulfill the Asset Representations Reviewer’s obligations under this Agreement.

(h) Affiliates and Third Parties. If the Asset Representations Reviewer processes the PII of the Servicer’s Affiliates or a third party when performing a Review, and if such Affiliate or third party is identified to the Asset Representations Reviewer, such Affiliate or third party is an intended third-party beneficiary of this Section 7.02, and this Agreement is intended to benefit the Affiliate or third party. The Affiliate or third party may enforce the PII related terms of this Section 7.02 against the Asset Representations Reviewer as if each were a signatory to this Agreement.

(i) Material Breach. Any breach of this Section shall be considered a material breach of this Agreement.

 

-21-


ARTICLE VIII.

TERMINATION

Section 8.01. Termination of Agreement. This Agreement will terminate, except for obligations under Sections 5.03 and 5.04 and Article VII, on the earlier to occur of (i) the payment in full of all outstanding Investor Certificates or (ii) the removal of the Asset Representations Reviewer pursuant to Section 6.01 or the permitted resignation of the Asset Representations Reviewer pursuant to Section 6.04 (which removal or resignation, for the avoidance of doubt, shall not take effect until the appointment of a successor Asset Representations Reviewer in accordance with Section 6.02).

ARTICLE IX.

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

Section 9.01. Amendment. (a) This Agreement may be amended by the Asset Representations Reviewer, the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer, without the consent of any of the Investor Certificateholders, (i) to comply with any change in any applicable federal or state law, to cure any ambiguity, to correct or supplement any provisions in this Agreement or for the purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions in this Agreement, including the content of any Exhibit to this Agreement; provided, however, that if such action is taken after the issuance of any tranche of Notes that is registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission on Form SF-3, such action shall not, in the reasonable belief of the Transferor, as evidenced by an officer’s certificate of the Transferor delivered to Capital One, the Servicer, and the COMT Trustee, adversely affect in any material respect the interests of any Investor Certificateholder whose consent has not been obtained, or (ii) to correct any manifest error in the terms of this Agreement as compared to the terms expressly set forth in an applicable prospectus.

(b) This Agreement may also be amended from time to time by the Asset Representations Reviewer, the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer, with the consent of the Investor Certificateholders holding more than 50% of the aggregate unpaid principal amount of all outstanding Investor Certificates, for the purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of this Agreement or of modifying in any manner the rights or interests of the Investor Certificateholders.

(c) It shall not be necessary for the consent of Investor Certificateholders to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment or consent, but it shall be sufficient if such consent shall approve the substance thereof.

(d) Each of the Asset Representations Reviewer, the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer may, but shall not be obligated to, execute and deliver such amendment that affects its rights, powers, duties or immunities hereunder.

(e) Prior notice of any amendment of this Agreement contemplated by this Section 9.01 shall be provided to each Rating Agency.

 

-22-


Section 9.02. Notices. All notices hereunder shall be given by United States certified or registered mail, by facsimile or by other telecommunication device capable of creating written record of such notice and its receipt. Notices hereunder shall be effective when received and shall be addressed to the respective parties hereto at the addresses set forth below, or at such other address as shall be designated by any party hereto in a written notice to each other party pursuant to this Section.

If to the Asset Representations Reviewer, to:

Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC

1700 Lincoln Street, Suite 2600

Denver, CO 80203

Attn: SVP, Surveillance

With a copy to:

Clayton Fixed Income Services LLC

c/o Clayton Holdings LLC

100 Beard Sawmill Road

Shelton, CT 06484

Attn: General Counsel

If to the Transferor, to:

Capital One Funding, LLC

140 East Shore Drive, Room 1071-B

Glen Allen, VA 23059

Attention: Assistant Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets

With a copy to:

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association

1680 Capital One Drive

McLean, VA 22102

Attention: Managing Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets

If to Capital One, to:

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association

1680 Capital One Drive

McLean, VA 22102

Attention: General Counsel

 

-23-


With a copy to:

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association

1680 Capital One Drive

McLean, VA 22102

Attention: Managing Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets

If to the Servicer, to:

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association

1680 Capital One Drive

McLean, VA 22102

Attention: General Counsel

With a copy to:

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association

1680 Capital One Drive

McLean, VA 22102

Attention: Managing Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets

If to the COMT Trustee, to:

The Bank of New York Mellon

101 Barclay Street, Floor 7 West

New York, New York 10286

Attention: Corporate Trust Administration — Asset Backed Securities

Section 9.03. Entire Agreement; Severability Clause. This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement among the Asset Representations Reviewer, the Transferor, Capital One and the Servicer. All prior representations, statements, negotiations and undertakings with regard to the subject matter hereof are superseded hereby.

If any term or provision of this Agreement or the application thereof to any person or circumstance shall, to any extent, be invalid or unenforceable, the remaining terms and provisions of this Agreement, or the application of such terms or provisions to persons or circumstances other than those as to which it is held invalid or unenforceable, shall not be affected thereby, and each term and provision of this Agreement shall be valid and enforced to the fullest extent permitted by law.

Section 9.04. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed simultaneously in any number of counterparts. Each counterpart shall be deemed to be an original, and all such counterparts shall constitute one and the same instrument.

Section 9.05. Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT

 

-24-


REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 9.06. Captions. The captions used herein are for the convenience of reference only and not part of this Agreement, and shall in no way be deemed to define, limit, describe or modify the meanings of any provision of this Agreement.

Section 9.07. Waivers. No term or provision of this Agreement may be waived or modified unless such waiver or modification is in writing, signed by the party against whom such waiver or modification is sought to be enforced.

Section 9.08. Assignment. This Agreement may not be assigned by the Asset Representations Reviewer except as permitted under Section 6.03 hereof.

Section 9.09. Benefit of This Agreement; Third-Party Beneficiaries. This Agreement is for the benefit of and will be binding on the parties to this Agreement and their permitted successors and assigns. Except as provided in Section 7.02(h), no other Person will have any right or obligation under this Agreement.

Section 9.10. Exhibits. The exhibits to this Agreement are hereby incorporated and made a part hereof and are an integral part of this Agreement.

Section 9.11. Nonpetition Covenant. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, notwithstanding any prior termination of this Agreement, none of the Servicer, Capital One or the Asset Representations Reviewer shall, prior to the date which is one year and one day after the termination of the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, acquiesce, petition or otherwise invoke or cause Funding, COMT, or the Note Issuer to invoke the process of any Governmental Authority for the purpose of commencing or sustaining a case against Funding, COMT, or the Note Issuer under any Debtor Relief Law or appointing a receiver, conservator, liquidator, assignee, trustee, custodian, sequestrator or other similar official of any of Funding, COMT, or the Note Issuer, or any substantial part of its property, or ordering the winding-up or liquidation of the affairs of Funding, COMT, or the Note Issuer.

 

-25-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Transferor, Capital One, the Servicer and the Asset Representations Reviewer have caused their names to be signed hereto by their respective officers thereunto duly authorized as of the date first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, as Transferor
By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

  Name:   Eric D. Bauder
  Title:   Assistant Vice President
CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, as Servicer and in its individual capacity
By:  

/s/ Daniel H. Rosen

  Name:   Daniel H. Rosen
  Title:   Managing Vice President, Treasury
CLAYTON FIXED INCOME SERVICES LLC, as Asset Representations Reviewer
By:  

/s/ Robert Harris

  Name:   Robert Harris
  Title:   Secretary

[Signature Page to Asset Representations Review Agreement]


Exhibit A

Representation (1)1

2.04(a)(vii) On the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each related Additional Account is an Eligible Account.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Account is an Eligible Account.

 

  a. Confirm that the testing of each of Representations 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 in this Exhibit A resulted in a Test Pass.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

1 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 1 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-1


Representation (2)2

(a) The “Eligible Account” is in existence and maintained by the Account Owner.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Account is a credit card account maintained by Capital One.

 

  a. Confirm that the Review Accounts are set forth in the Asset Selection Report.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

2 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 2 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-2


Representation (3)3

(b) The “Eligible Account” is payable in United States dollars.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Account is payable in United States dollars.

 

  a. Confirm that the currency indicator in the Asset Selection Report for each of the Review Accounts on the Account List contained in the Asset Selection Report is United States Dollars.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

3 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 3 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-3


Representation (4)4

(c) The “Eligible Account” has not been identified by the Account Owner as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) No Review Account was identified as lost or stolen.

 

  a. Confirm that no Review Account had a data indicator indicating that the account was lost or stolen.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

4 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 4 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-4


Representation (5)5

(d) The Obligor on the “Eligible Account” has provided, as his or her current billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address).

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) The billing address for each Review Account was located in the United States, its territories or possessions, or a military address.

 

  a. Review the Geographic Report from the Asset Selection Report.

 

  b. Confirm all billing addresses were in the United States, its territories or possessions, or a military address.

 

  c. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

5 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 5 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-5


Representation (6)6

(e) The “Eligible Account” has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or the Pooling and Servicing Agreement).

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) No Review Account has Receivables that have been sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to anyone else.

 

  a. Confirm that no Review Account was flagged as having been sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to another party prior to the addition date.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

6 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 6 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-6


Representation (7)7

(f) Except as provided in the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the “Eligible Account” does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) No Receivable in a Review Account has been charged off.

 

  a. Review the Asset Selection Report

 

  b. Confirm that no Review Account flagged as charged off was transferred to the trust.

 

  c. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

7 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 7 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-7


Representation (8)8

(g) The “Eligible Account” does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Transferor, the Account Owner or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) No Receivable in a Review Account has been identified as fraudulent.

 

  a. Confirm that no Review Account had a data indicator indicating the Review Receivables were fraudulent.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

8 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 8 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-8


Representation (9)9

(h) The “Eligible Account” relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Account Owner or by the Transferor in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) No Review Account was coded as in bankruptcy.

 

  a. Confirm that no Review Account had a data indicator indicating the borrower was in active bankruptcy.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

9 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 9 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-9


Representation (10)10

(i) The “Eligible Account” is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) The borrower for each Review Account has not requested a discontinuance of responsibility.

 

  a. Confirm that no Review Account had a data indicator indicating the borrower had requested discontinuance of responsibility.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

10 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 10 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-10


Representation (11)11

(j) The “Eligible Account” does not have any Receivables that give rise to any claim against any Governmental Authority.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Account does not have any Receivables that give rise to any claim against any Governmental Authority.

 

  a. Confirm that no Review Account had a data indicator indicating that the customer on any Account was a corporate entity, or anything other than an individual person

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

11 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 11 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-11


Representation (12)12

2.04(a)(viii) On the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each Receivable then existing in each related Additional Account is an Eligible Receivable.

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Receivable is an Eligible Receivable.

 

  a. Confirm that the testing of each of Representations 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21 and 22 in this Exhibit A resulted in a Test Pass.

 

  ii) If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

12 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 12 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-12


Representation (13)13

(a) The “Receivable” has arisen in an “Eligible Account.”

Documents

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Receivable arose in an Eligible Account.

 

  a. Confirm that each Account in which each Review Receivable has arisen is an Eligible Account based on the performance of the procedures set forth in Representations 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 in this Exhibit A.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

13 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 13 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-13


Representation (14)14

(b) The “Receivable” was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders.

Documents

Compliance Policy

Regulatory Policies and Procedures

Form of Capital One Customer Agreement

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Receivable was created, in all material respects, in compliance with all Requirements of Law applicable to the applicable Account Owner.

 

  a. Review the Compliance Policy and the Regulatory Policies and Procedures.

 

  i. Confirm the procedures in (i)(a) above include the following:

 

  1. Overview of the process including identification of laws (including changes to existing laws), analysis of laws, determination of impact, and implementation to appropriate business units.

 

  b. Validate that the procedures in (i)(a) above were followed.

 

  i. Regulatory changes or additions made between [November 2015] and the date of the Review Notice will be in scope. The Asset Representation Reviewer will select one regulatory change or addition from each calendar year between [November 2015] and the date of the Review Notice.

 

  ii. The Asset Representation Reviewer will then track the selected regulatory change through Capital One’s processes for implementation.

 

14 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 14 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-14


  c. Confirm that the updated Compliance Policy and the Regulatory Policies and Procedures were cascaded to each relevant line of business and made available to any employee seeking the information.

 

  d. Confirm that internal controls reflect regulatory changes in scope through monitoring results and testing.

 

  ii) Each Review Account was created under a Form of Capital One Customer Agreement that complies, in all material respects, with all Requirements of Law applicable to such Account Owner.

 

  a. The Asset Representations Reviewer will confirm that contracts were updated based on the Compliance Policy the Compliance Policy and the Regulatory Policies and Procedures.

 

  iii) If the documentation provided indicates that the Compliance Policy was followed, then Test Pass.

 

A-15


Representation (15)15

(c) All material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Account Owner or the Transferor in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Account Owner or the Transferor of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect.

Documents

Capital One Bank (USA), National Association Federal Banking Charter [Charter No. 24828]

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Capital One as the Seller has all consents, licenses, approvals and authorizations required.

 

  a. Locate the document(s) listed above.

 

  b. Conduct an interview with the appropriate Capital One employee regarding the outcome of any recent audits or reviews conducted by a Governmental Authority and confirm that no Governmental Authority has taken any action against Capital One that would prevent it from executing, delivering or performing its obligations under the Customer Agreements subject to the Asset Selection Report, or that any such action has been resolved in a manner that would not prevent Capital One from executing, delivering or performing its obligations under such Customer Agreements.

 

  c. Review the documents above and confirm with Capital One during the interview process that no evidence exists and that they are valid and have not been revoked.

 

  d. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

15 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 15 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-16


Representation (16)16

(d) As to the “Receivable”, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor or the Trustee will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (including a prior Lien of the Account Owner but excluding any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Transferor is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto).

Documents

Pooling and Servicing Agreement

Receivables Purchase Agreement

UCC Filing Certificates for Virginia and Delaware

Lien Search Report

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Transferor or Trustee had good and marketable title to each Review Receivable, free and clear of all Liens at the time of transfer.

 

  a. Review the Lien Searches.

 

  i. confirm that all UCC filings are listed on the Lien Search Report.

 

  ii. confirm that the debtor is listed as Capital One (Bank), National Association or any of its predecessors, successors or assigns.

 

  b. Review the UCC Filing Certificates for Virginia and Delaware, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and the Receivables Purchase Agreement.

 

  i. Confirm that the filings were completed to the appropriate party as defined by the Agreements.

 

  c. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

16 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 16 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-17


Representation (17)17

(f) At and after the time of transfer to the Trustee the Receivable is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity).

Documents

Form of Capital One Customer Agreement

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Receivable is a legal, valid and binding payment obligation.

 

  a. Confirm that the Account in which each Review Receivable arose is an Eligible Account based on the performance of the procedures set forth in Representations 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 in this Exhibit A.

 

  b. Confirm that testing of Representation 14 in this Exhibit A related to Compliance with Law resulted in a Test Pass.

 

  c. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

17 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 17 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-18


Representation (18)18

(g) The Receivable constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC.

Documents

Pooling and Servicing Agreement

Receivables Purchase Agreement

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Confirm that the Review Receivable is a right to payment of a monetary obligation, whether or not earned by performance, arising out of the use of a credit or charge card or information contained on or for use with the card, as described under Article 9-102 of the Virginia and New York UCCs.

 

  a. Confirm that there were no issues resulting in the related Accounts being deemed not to be Eligible Accounts as of any addition date from the testing of Representations 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 set forth in this Exhibit A.

 

  b. If confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

18 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 18 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-19


Representation (19)19

(h) At the time of its transfer to the Trustee the Receivable has not been waived or modified.

Documents

Form of Capital One Customer Agreement

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Each Review Receivable has not been waived or modified.

 

  a. Confirm that each Review Receivable is a legal, valid and binding payment obligation based on the performance of the procedures set forth in Representation 17 in this Exhibit A, and the performance of the other procedures set forth therein (including with respect to Eligible Account status and Compliance with Law).

 

  b. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

19 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 19 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-20


Representation (20)20

(i) At the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Receivable is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity).

Documents

Form of Capital One Customer Agreement

Asset Selection Report

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) No Review Receivable is subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor.

 

  a. Confirm that each Review Receivable is a legal, valid and binding payment obligation based on the performance of the procedures set forth in Representation 17 in this Exhibit A, and the performance of the other procedures set forth therein (including with respect to Eligible Account status and Compliance with Law).

 

  b. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

20 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 20 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-21


Representation (21)21

(j) At the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled with respect to the Receivable.

Documents

Pooling and Servicing Agreement

Receivables Purchase Agreement

Form of Capital One Customer Agreement

UCC Filing Certificates for Virginia and Delaware

Asset Selection Report

Lien Searches

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) The Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled with respect to the Review Receivable.

 

  a. Confirm that the related Review Receivable constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC based on the performance of the procedures set forth in Representation 18 in this Exhibit A, and the performance of the other procedures set forth therein (including with respect to Eligible Account status).

 

  b. Confirm that the Transferor or Trustee had good and marketable title to each Review Receivable, free and clear of all Liens at the time of transfer, and that Transferor did not take any action which, or fail to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders in the Reviewed Receivable, based on the performance of the procedures set forth in Representations 16 and 22 in this Exhibit A.

 

  c. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

21 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 21 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-22


Representation (22)22

(k) At the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders in the Receivable.

Documents

Pooling and Servicing Agreement

Receivables Purchase Agreement

UCC Filing Certificates for Virginia and Delaware

Asset Selection Report

Lien Searches

Procedures to be Performed

 

  i) Transferor did not take any action which, or fail to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders in the Reviewed Receivable.

 

  a. Review the Lien Searches.

 

  i. confirm that all UCC filings are listed on the Lien Search Report.

 

  ii. confirm that the debtor is listed as Capital One (Bank), National Association or any of its predecessors, successors or assigns.

 

  b. Review the UCC Filing Certificates for Virginia and Delaware, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and the Receivables Purchase Agreement.

 

  i. Confirm that the filings were completed to the appropriate party as defined by the Agreements.

 

  c. If the above tests are confirmed, then Test Pass.

 

22 Due to amendments and restatements effected by predecessor agreements to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Receivables Purchase Agreement, more than one representation and warranty will be tested, along with this representation and warranty, during a Review. See Schedule 22 to this Exhibit A for a complete list of representations and warranties contained in the current agreement and each predecessor agreement that will be tested by applying the procedures described immediately below the text of this representation under “Procedures to be Performed.”

 

A-23


Schedule 1 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

Section 2.04(a)(vii) On the Trust Cut-off Date, each Account was an Eligible Account and, in the case of Additional Accounts, on the Additional Cut-Off Date with respect thereto, each such Account will be an Eligible Account.

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

Section 2.04(a)(vii) On the Trust Cut-Off Date, each Account was an Eligible Account and, in the case of Additional Accounts, on the Additional Cut-Off Date with respect thereto, each such Account will be an Eligible Account.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

Section 2.04(a)(vii) On the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each related Additional Account is an Eligible Account.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

Section 2.04(a)(vii) On the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each related Additional Account is an Eligible Account.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

Section 2.04(a)(vii) On the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each related Additional Account is an Eligible Account.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007, and March 17, 2016.

Section 2.04(a)(vii) On the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each related Additional Account is an Eligible Account.

 

Sch 1 - 1


Schedule 1 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

Section 4.02(a)(vi) On the cut-off date related to its date of designation as an “Account” under the Prior PSA, with respect to each Initial Account, and on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, with respect to each Additional Account, each such Account is an Eligible Account.

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

Section 4.02(a)(vi) on the cut-off date related to its date of designation as an “Account” under the Prior PSA, with respect to each Initial Account, and on the applicable Additional Cut- Off Date, with respect to each Additional Account, each such Account is an Eligible Account.

 

Sch 1 - 2


Schedule 2 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (a)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(a) is in existence and maintained with the Seller on the Trust Cut-Off Date or the Addition Date, as the case may be;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(a) is in existence and maintained with the Seller on the Trust Cut-Off Date or the Addition Date, as the case may be;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(a) is in existence and maintained by the Account Owner;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(a) is in existence and maintained by the Account Owner;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(a) is in existence and maintained by the Account Owner;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(a) is in existence and maintained by the Account Owner;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (a)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002

(a) which is in existence and maintained by Capital One;

 

Sch 2 - 1


Schedule 2 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(a) which is in existence and maintained by Capital One;

 

Sch 2 - 2


Schedule 3 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (b)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(b) is payable in United States dollars;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(b) is payable in United States dollars;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(b) is payable in United States dollars;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(b) is payable in United States dollars;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(b) is payable in United States dollars;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(b) is payable in United States dollars;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (b)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002

(b) which is payable in United States dollars;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(b) which is payable in United States dollars;

 

Sch 3 - 1


Schedule 4 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (c)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(c) has not been identified as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been reported to the Seller as having been lost or stolen;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(c) has not been identified as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been reported to such Seller as having been lost or stolen;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated August 1, 2002.

(c) has not been identified by the Account Owner as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated January 13, 2006.

(c) has not been identified by the Account Owner as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement July 1, 2007.

(c) has not been identified by the Account Owner as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement March 17, 2016.

(c) has not been identified by the Account Owner as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (c)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(c) which has not been identified by Capital One as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen;

 

Sch 4 - 1


Schedule 4 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(c) which has not been identified by Capital One as an account the credit cards or checks, if any, with respect to which have been lost or stolen;

 

Sch 4 - 2


Schedule 5 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (d)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(d) the Obligor of which has provided, as his or her current billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address);

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(d) the Obligor of which has provided, as his or her current billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States (or its territories or possessions or a military address);

 

Sch 5 - 1


Schedule 5 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (d)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States or its territories or possessions or a military address;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(d) the Obligor on which has provided, as his or her most recent billing address, an address located in the United States or its territories or possessions or a military address;

 

Sch 5 - 2


Schedule 6 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (e)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to this Agreement);

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to this Agreement);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or this Agreement);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or this Agreement);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or this Agreement);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(e) has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to the Receivables Purchase Agreements, the Prior PSA or this Agreement);

 

Sch 6 - 1


Schedule 6 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (e)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(e) which has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to this Agreement or the Prior PSA);

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(e) which has not been, and does not have any Receivables which have been, sold, pledged, assigned or otherwise conveyed to any Person (except pursuant to this Agreement or the Prior PSA);

 

Sch 6 - 2


Schedule 7 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (f)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(f) except as provided below, does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

 

Sch 7 - 1


Schedule 7 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (f)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(f) which does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(f) which does not have any Receivables which are Defaulted Receivables;

 

Sch 7 - 2


Schedule 8 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (g)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Seller or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by such Seller or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Transferor, the Account Owner or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Transferor, the Account Owner or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Transferor, the Account Owner or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(g) does not have any Receivables which have been identified by the Transferor, the Account Owner or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

 

Sch 8 - 1


Schedule 8 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (g)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(g) which does not have any Receivables which have been identified by Capital One or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(g) which does not have any Receivables which have been identified by Capital One or the relevant Obligor as having been incurred as a result of the fraudulent use of any related credit card or check;

 

Sch 8 - 2


Schedule 9 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (h)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Seller in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Seller in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Account Owner or by the Transferor in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Account Owner or by the Transferor in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Account Owner or by the Transferor in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(h) relates to an Obligor who is not identified by the Account Owner or by the Transferor in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

 

Sch 9 - 1


Schedule 9 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (h)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(h) which relates to an Obligor who is not identified by Capital One in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(h) which relates to an Obligor who is not identified by Capital One in its computer files as being the subject of a voluntary or involuntary bankruptcy proceeding;

 

Sch 9 - 2


Schedule 10 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (i)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

 

Sch 10 - 1


Schedule 10 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (i)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(i) which is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(i) is not an account with respect to which the Obligor has requested discontinuance of responsibility;

 

Sch 10 - 2


Schedule 11 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (j)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

Not applicable.

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

Not applicable.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

Not applicable.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

Not applicable.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(j) does not have any Receivables that give rise to any claim against any Governmental Authority;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(j) does not have any Receivables that give rise to any claim against any Governmental Authority;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE ACCOUNT” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (j)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

Not applicable.

 

Sch 11 - 1


Schedule 11 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(j) which does not have any Receivables that give rise to any claim against any Governmental Authority;

 

Sch 11 - 2


Schedule 12 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

Section 2.04(a)(viii) on the Trust Cut-off date, each Receivable then existing was an Eligible Receivable and, in the case of Additional Accounts, on the Addition Date with respect thereto, each Receivable contained therein will be an Eligible Receivable;

Section 2.04(a)(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable, such Receivable will be an Eligible Receivable;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

Section 2.04(a)(viii) on the Trust Cut-off date, each Receivable then existing was an Eligible Receivable and, in the case of Additional Accounts, on the Addition Date with respect thereto, each Receivable contained therein will be an Eligible Receivable;

Section 2.04(a)(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable, such Receivable will be an Eligible Receivable;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

Section 2.04(a)(viii) on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each Receivable then existing in each related Additional Account is an Eligible Receivable;

Section 2.04(a)(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable transferred by the Transferor to the Trustee, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

Section 2.04(a)(viii) on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each Receivable then existing in each related Additional Account is an Eligible Receivable;

Section 2.04(a)(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable transferred by the Transferor to the Trustee, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

Section 2.04(a)(viii) on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each Receivable then existing in each related Additional Account is an Eligible Receivable;

 

Sch 12 - 1


Schedule 12 to Exhibit A

 

Section 2.04(a)(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable transferred by the Transferor to the Trustee, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

Section 2.04(a)(viii) on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, each Receivable then existing in each related Additional Account is an Eligible Receivable;

Section 2.04(a)(ix) upon the creation of any new Receivable transferred by the Transferor to the Trustee, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

Section 4.02(a)(vii) on the Initial Cut-Off Date, with respect to each Initial Account, and on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, with respect to each Additional Account, each Receivable contained in such Account on such applicable date and sold to Funding by Capital One is an Eligible Receivable;

Section 4.02(a)(viii) as of the date of the creation of any new Receivable sold to Funding by Capital One, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

Section 4.02(a)(vii) on the Initial Cut-Off Date, with respect to each Initial Account, and on the applicable Additional Cut-Off Date, with respect to each Additional Account, each Receivable contained in such Account on such applicable date and sold to Funding by Capital One is an Eligible Receivable;

Section 4.02(a)(viii) as of the date of the creation of any new Receivable sold to Funding by Capital One, such Receivable is an Eligible Receivable;

 

Sch 12 - 2


Schedule 13 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (a)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(a) which has arisen under an Eligible Account;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(a) which has arisen under an Eligible Account;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (a)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

 

Sch 13 - 1


Schedule 13 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(a) which has arisen in an Eligible Account;

 

Sch 13 - 2


Schedule 14 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (b)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Seller, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Seller, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Seller, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the applicable Seller, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

 

Sch 14 - 1


Schedule 14 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material aspects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders, and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to the Account Owner, the failure to comply with which would have a material adverse effect on Investor Certificateholders;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (b)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material respects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to Capital One and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to Capital One;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(b) which was created in compliance in all material respects with the Lending Guidelines and all Requirements of Law applicable to Capital One and pursuant to a Lending Agreement which complies with all Requirements of Law applicable to Capital One;

 

Sch 14 - 2


Schedule 15 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (c)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Seller in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Seller of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect as of such date of creation of such Receivable;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by a Seller in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by such Seller of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect as of such date of creation of such Receivable;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Account Owner or the Transferor in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Account Owner or the Transferor of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Account Owner or the Transferor in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Account Owner or the Transferor of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

 

Sch 15 - 1


Schedule 15 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Account Owner or the Transferor in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Account Owner or the Transferor of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by the Account Owner or the Transferor in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by the Account Owner or the Transferor of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (c)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by Capital One in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by Capital One of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(c) with respect to which all material consents, licenses, approvals or authorizations of, or registrations or declarations with, any Governmental Authority required to be obtained, effected or given by Capital One in connection with the creation of such Receivable or the execution, delivery and performance by Capital One of its obligations, if any, under the related Lending Agreement have been duly obtained, effected or given and are in full force and effect;

 

Sch 15 - 2


Schedule 16 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (d)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, the Seller or the Trust, will have good and marketable title free and clear of all Liens (other than any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Seller is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, the applicable Seller or the Trust will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (other than any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if such Seller is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor or the Trustee will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (including a prior Lien of the Account Owner but excluding any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Transferor is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor or the Trustee will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (including a prior Lien of the Account Owner but excluding any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Transferor is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

 

Sch 16 - 1


Schedule 16 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor or the Trustee will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (including a prior Lien of the Account Owner but excluding any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Transferor is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(d) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor or the Trustee will have good and marketable title, free and clear of all Liens (including a prior Lien of the Account Owner but excluding any Lien for municipal or other local taxes if such taxes are not then due and payable or if the Transferor is then contesting the validity thereof in good faith by appropriate proceedings and has set aside on its books adequate reserves with respect thereto);

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (d)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(d) as to which, at the time of its sale of such Receivable to Funding, Capital One has good and marketable title thereto and which itself is free and clear of all Liens;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(d) as to which, at the time of its sale of such Receivable to Funding, Capital One has good and marketable title thereto and which itself is free and clear of all Liens;

 

Sch 16 - 2


Schedule 17 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (f)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trust is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship· or other similar laws, now or hereafter in effect, affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights’ in general and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity) or matters as to which the Servicer is required by Section 3.09 to make an adjustment;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trust is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship or other similar laws, now or hereafter in effect, affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights in general and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity) or matters as to which the Servicer is required by Section 3.09 to make an adjustment;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trustee is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trustee is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

 

Sch 17 - 1


Schedule 17 to Exhibit A

 

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trustee is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(f) which at and after the time of transfer to the Trustee is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, legally enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (f)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(f) which is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(f) which is the legal, valid and binding payment obligation of the Obligor thereon, enforceable against such Obligor in accordance with its terms, except as such enforceability may be limited by applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

 

Sch 17 - 2


Schedule 18 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (g)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(g) which constitutes either an “account” or a “general intangible” under and as defined in Article 9 of the UCC;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(g) which constitutes either an “account” or a “general intangible” under and as defined in Article 9 of the UCC;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the New York UCC and the Virginia UCC;

 

Sch 18 - 1


Schedule 18 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (g)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the UCC as then in effect in the State of New York and the Commonwealth of Virginia;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(g) which constitutes an “account” as defined in Article 9 of the UCC as then in effect in the State of New York and the Commonwealth of Virginia;

 

Sch 18 - 2


Schedule 19 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (h)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, has not been waived or modified except as permitted in accordance with Section 3.03(h);

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, has not been waived or modified except as permitted in accordance with Section 3.03(h)

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, has not been waived or modified;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, has not been waived or modified;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, has not been waived or modified;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(h) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, has not been waived or modified;

 

Sch 19 - 1


Schedule 19 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (h)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(h) which, at the time of its sale to Funding, has not been waived or modified;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(h) which, at the time of its sale to Funding, has not been waived or modified;

 

Sch 19 - 2


Schedule 20 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (i)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship or other similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights in general and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity) or matters as to which the Servicer is required by Section 3.09 to make an adjustment;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium, receivership, conservatorship or other similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights in general and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity) or matters as to which the Servicer is required by Section 3.09 to make an adjustment;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity);;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of

 

Sch 20 - 1


Schedule 20 to Exhibit A

 

usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity);

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(i) which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or equity);

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (i)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(i) which, at the time of its sale to Funding, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(i) which, at the time of its sale to Funding, is not subject to any right of rescission, setoff, counterclaim or any other defense of the Obligor (including the defense of usury), other than defenses arising out of applicable Debtor Relief Laws and except as such enforceability may be limited by general principles of equity (whether considered in a suit at law or in equity);

 

Sch 20 - 2


Schedule 21 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (j)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, the Seller has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled at the time it is transferred to the Trust;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, the applicable Seller has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled at the time it is transferred to the Trust;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(j) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled;

 

Sch 21 - 1


Schedule 21 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (j)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(j) as to which, at the time of its sale to Funding, Capital One has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled under the Lending Agreement;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(j) as to which, at the time of its sale to Funding, Capital One has satisfied all obligations on its part to be fulfilled under the Lending Agreement;

 

Sch 21 - 2


Schedule 22 to Exhibit A

 

POOLING AND SERVICING AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (k)

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993.

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, the Seller has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein;

Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of April 9, 2001.

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, the applicable Seller has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trust, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002.

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002 and January 13, 2006.

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006 and July 1, 2007.

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein;

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement dated as of September 30, 1993, as amended and restated as of August 1, 2002, January 13, 2006, July 1, 2007 and March 17, 2016.

(k) as to which, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, the Transferor has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its transfer to the Trustee, impair in any material respect the rights of the Trust or the Certificateholders therein;

 

Sch 22 - 1


Schedule 22 to Exhibit A

 

RECEIVABLES PURCHASE AGREEMENT — “ELIGIBLE RECEIVABLE” DEFINITION

CLAUSE (k)

Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of August 1, 2002.

(k) as to which, at the time of its sale to Funding, Capital One has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its sale to Funding, impair in any material respect the rights of Funding therein;

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement dated as of July 1, 2007.

(k) as to which, at the time of its sale to Funding, Capital One has not taken any action which, or failed to take any action the omission of which, would, at the time of its sale to Funding, impair in any material respect the rights of Funding therein;

 

Sch 22 - 2

EX-4.7 8 d125824dex47.htm EXHIBIT 4.7 Exhibit 4.7

EXHIBIT 4.7

DISPUTE RESOLUTION AGREEMENT

THIS DISPUTE RESOLUTION AGREEMENT, dated as of March 17, 2016 (this “Agreement”) is by and among CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC, in its individual capacity (“Funding”), CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, in its individual capacity (the “Bank”), and THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON, as Trustee (the “Trustee”).

BACKGROUND

WHEREAS, Signet Bank/Virginia, a Virginia banking corporation (“Signet/Virginia”), as seller (in such capacity, along with its successors in such capacity, the “Seller”) and servicer (in such capacity, along with its successors in such capacity, the “Servicer”), and The Bank of New York Mellon (under its predecessor name, The Bank of New York), a New York banking corporation, as trustee (in such capacity on behalf of the Capital One Master Trust (under its predecessor name, the Signet Master Trust), or its successor in interest, or any successor trustee appointed as provided therein, the “Trustee”), entered into a pooling and servicing agreement, dated as of September 30, 1993 (as the same was amended by Amendment No. 1 to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of May 17, 1994, between Signet/Virginia, as Seller and Servicer, and the Trustee, the “Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement”);

WHEREAS, commencing in November 1994, Signet Banking Corporation (“Signet”) and Signet/Virginia, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Signet, engaged in a series of transactions that, in February 1995, culminated with Signet divesting its ownership interest in Capital One Financial Corporation, a bank holding company incorporated in Delaware (“COFC”) (including Capital One Bank, a Virginia banking corporation and subsidiary of COFC (“Capital One Bank”)), by means of a tax-free distribution to Signet’s stockholders (the “Spin-off”);

WHEREAS, in connection with the Spin-off, Capital One Bank became a party to the Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement, as the Seller and the Servicer, and the Signet Master Trust’s name was changed to the Capital One Master Trust (the “Master Trust”);

WHEREAS, the Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement was subsequently amended by Amendment No. 2 to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of May 23, 1995, Amendment No. 3 to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of October 15, 1997, Amendment No. 4 to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of April 24, 1998, Amendment No. 5 to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of January 25, 2000, Amendment No. 6 to the Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of October 13, 2000 (the Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement, as amended by Amendments No. 2 through Amendment No. 6, and as otherwise supplemented or modified, the “Original Amended Pooling and Servicing Agreement”), each between the Capital One Bank, as Seller and Servicer, and the Trustee;


WHEREAS, the Original Amended Pooling and Servicing Agreement was amended and restated on April 9, 2001 (the “Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement”) for the purpose of, among other things, adding Capital One, F.S.B., a federal savings bank (“F.S.B.”), as an additional Seller, and as amended and restated on April 9, 2001 was among Capital One Bank, as a Seller and as Servicer, F.S.B., as a Seller, and the Trustee;

WHEREAS, Capital One Bank and F.S.B., each as a Seller under the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, determined to substitute Funding, as transferor (in such capacity, along with its successors in such capacity, the “Transferor”) to the Master Trust in place of Capital One Bank and F.S.B., as Sellers to the Master Trust;

WHEREAS, in connection with the substitution of Funding as Transferor to the Master Trust in place of Capital One Bank and F.S.B. as Sellers to the Master Trust, (i) Funding and Capital One Bank entered into the receivable purchase agreement, dated as of August 1, 2002 (the “C.O.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement”), relating to the sale of credit card receivables by Capital One Bank to Funding and (ii) Funding and F.S.B. entered into a receivable purchase agreement, dated as of August 1, 2002 (the “F.S.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement”), relating to the sale of credit card receivables by F.S.B. to Funding;

WHEREAS, in connection with the substitution of Funding as Transferor to the Master Trust in place of Capital One Bank and F.S.B. as Sellers to the Master Trust, Funding, as Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee amended and restated the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement through the execution and delivery of an Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of August 1, 2002, among the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee (the “Second Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement”);

WHEREAS, pursuant to the terms of the Second Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Transferor assigned, set over and otherwise conveyed to the Trustee all of the Transferor’s rights, remedies, powers, privileges and claims under or with respect to the C.O.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement and the F.S.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement;

WHEREAS, the Second Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement was amended and restated by an Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of January 13, 2006, among the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee (the “Third Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement”) to, among other things, comply with newly-enacted regulatory requirements;

WHEREAS, on July 1, 2007, F.S.B. transferred its small business credit card accounts to Capital One Bank and F.S.B. merged with and into Capital One Bank (the “Merger”), with Capital One Bank being the surviving entity;

WHEREAS, in connection with the Merger, Funding and F.S.B. terminated the F.S.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement and, prior to such termination, F.S.B. had not transferred any receivables to Funding pursuant to the F.S.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement;

 

-2-


WHEREAS, in connection with the Merger, (i) the C.O.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement was amended and restated by an Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of July 1, 2007, between Capital One Bank and Funding (as the same was amended by the First Amendment to Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, dated as of March 1, 2008, the “Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement”) and (ii) the Third Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement was amended and restated by an Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of July 1, 2007 (as the same was amended by the First Amendment to Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of March 1, 2008, and the Second Amendment to Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of July 15, 2010, the “Fourth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement”), among the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee, in each case for the purpose of, among other things, allowing receivables from non-consumer revolving credit accounts owned by Capital One Bank, including small business revolving credit accounts, to be conveyed from Capital One Bank to Funding, and from Funding to the Master Trust;

WHEREAS, on March 1, 2008, Capital One Bank was converted from a Virginia banking corporation to a national banking association, and in connection with such conversion Capital One Bank became the Bank;

WHEREAS, by operation of law, all of the assets and rights of Capital One Bank became vested in the Bank, and the Bank assumed all of the liabilities and obligations of Capital One Bank;

WHEREAS, (i) as successor by conversion to Capital One Bank as Seller under the Original Amended Pooling and Servicing Agreement and the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, (ii) by virtue of Capital One Bank’s succession by merger to F.S.B., as successor in interest to F.S.B. as a Seller under the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, and (iii) by virtue of Capital One Bank’s succession to Signet/Virginia, as successor in interest to Signet/Virginia as Seller under the Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Bank may have the obligation to repurchase from the Trustee applicable credit card receivables if any of the Predecessor PSA Repurchase Obligations (as defined below) so require;

WHEREAS, as successor by conversion to Capital One Bank under the C.O.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement and the Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, the Bank may have the obligation to repurchase from Funding applicable credit card receivables if any of the Predecessor RPA Repurchase Obligations (as defined below) so require;

WHEREAS, in order to comply with certain newly-enacted regulatory requirements, the Transferor, the Servicer and the Trustee entered into an Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement, dated as of March 17, 2016 (as the same may be amended, supplemented or otherwise modified, the “Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement”); and

WHEREAS, the parties to this Agreement desire to enter into this Agreement for the purpose of agreeing to dispute resolution terms that will apply if there is a dispute concerning any of the Predecessor PSA Repurchase Obligations or any of the Predecessor RPA Repurchase Obligations, as applicable (as each term as defined below, respectively).

 

-3-


NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the promises and the agreements contained herein, the parties hereto agree as follows:

ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS

Section 1.01. Capitalized Terms. Capitalized terms used in this Agreement and not otherwise defined shall have the meanings ascribed thereto in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

AAA” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.01(b)(i).

Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the initial paragraph of this Agreement.

Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Bank” has the meaning set forth in the initial paragraph of this Agreement.

Business Days” has the meaning set forth in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Capital One Bank” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

C.O.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of the Agreement.

Fourth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

F.S.B.” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

F.S.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

 

-4-


Funding” has the meaning set forth in the initial paragraph of this Agreement.

Holder” has the meaning set forth in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Master Trust” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Merger” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Original Amended Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Person” has the meaning set forth in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Predecessor PSA Repurchase Obligations” shall mean, collectively, any of the obligations to repurchase receivables pursuant to subsection 2.05(a) or Section 2.06 of the Original Pooling and Servicing Agreement, subsection 2.05(a) or Section 2.06 of the Original Amended Pooling and Servicing Agreement, or subsection 2.05(a) or Section 2.06 of the Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Predecessor RPA Repurchase Obligations” shall mean collectively, any of the obligations to repurchase receivables pursuant to Section 6.01 or 6.02 of the C.O.B. Receivables Purchase Agreement or Section 6.01 or 6.02 of the Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement.

Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional” has the meaning set forth in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Receivable” has the meaning set forth in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Representing Party” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.01(a).

Requesting Party” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.01(a).

Rules” has the meaning set forth in Section 2.01(b)(i).

Second Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Servicer” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

 

-5-


Spin-off” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Third Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Transferor” has the meaning set forth in the Background section of this Agreement.

Transferor Interest” has the meaning set forth in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement.

Trustee” has the meaning set forth in the initial paragraph of this Agreement.

ARTICLE II

DISPUTE RESOLUTION

Section 2.01. Dispute Resolution.

(a) If any Receivable is subject to repurchase pursuant to any of the Predecessor PSA Repurchase Obligations or any of the Predecessor RPA Repurchase Obligations, which repurchase is not resolved in accordance with the terms of the agreement under which such repurchase obligation arose, within 180 days after notice is delivered to the Bank under the terms of such applicable agreement, the party requesting repurchase of such Receivable (the “Requesting Party”) will have the right to refer the matter, at its discretion, to either third-party mediation (including nonbinding arbitration) or binding arbitration pursuant to this Section 2.01 and the Bank is hereby deemed to consent to the selected resolution method. At the end of the 180-day period described above, the Representing Party (as defined below) may provide notice informing the Requesting Party of the status of its request or, in the absence of any such notice, the Requesting Party may presume that its request remains unresolved. The Requesting Party must provide written notice of its intention to refer the matter to mediation or arbitration to the Bank as the party responsible for such repurchase (in such capacity, the “Representing Party”) within 30 calendar days following such 180th day. The Representing Party agrees to participate in the resolution method selected by the Requesting Party.

(b) If the Requesting Party selects mediation as the resolution method, the following provisions will apply:

(i) The mediation will be administered by the American Arbitration Association (the “AAA”) pursuant to its Commercial Arbitration Rules and Mediation Procedures in effect at the time the mediation is initiated (the “Rules”); provided, that if any of the Rules are inconsistent with the procedures for the mediation or arbitration stated in the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement or the Amended and Restated Receivables Purchase Agreement, the procedures in such applicable document will control.

 

-6-


(ii) The mediator must be a Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional. Upon being supplied a list, by the AAA, of at least ten potential mediators that are each Qualified Dispute Resolution Professionals, each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will have the right to exercise two peremptory challenges within 14 days and to rank the remaining potential mediators in order of preference. The AAA will select the mediator from the remaining potential mediators on the list, respecting the preference choices of the parties to the extent possible.

(iii) Each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will use commercially reasonable efforts to begin the mediation within 10 Business Days of the selection of the mediator and to conclude the mediation within 30 days of the start of the mediation.

(iv) The fees and expenses of the mediation will be allocated as mutually agreed by the Requesting Party and the Representing Party as part of the mediation.

(v) A failure by the Requesting Party and the Representing Party to resolve a disputed matter through mediation shall not preclude either party from seeking a resolution of such matter through the initiation of a judicial proceeding in a court of competent jurisdiction, subject to subsection 2.01(d) below.

(c) If the Requesting Party selects arbitration as the resolution method, the following provisions will apply:

(i) The arbitration will be held in accordance with the United States Arbitration Act, notwithstanding any choice of law provision in this Agreement, and under the auspices of the AAA and in accordance with the Rules.

(ii) If the repurchase request specified in subsection 2.01(a) involves the repurchase of an aggregate amount of Receivables of less than 5% of the total Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the date of such repurchase request, a single arbitrator will be used. That arbitrator must be a Qualified Dispute Resolution Professional. Upon being supplied a list of at least ten potential arbitrators that are each Qualified Dispute Resolutions Professionals by the AAA, each of the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will have the right to exercise two peremptory challenges within 14 days and to rank the remaining potential arbitrators in order of preference. The AAA will select the arbitrator from the remaining potential arbitrators on the list respecting the preference choices of the parties to the extent possible.

(iii) If the repurchase request specified in subsection 2.01(a) involves the repurchase of an aggregate amount of Receivables equal to or in excess of 5% of the total Principal Receivables in the Trust as of the date of such repurchase request, a three-arbitrator panel will be used. The arbitral panel will consist of three Qualified Dispute Resolution Professionals, (A) one to be appointed by the Requesting Party within five Business Days of providing notice to the Representing Party of its selection of arbitration,

 

-7-


(B) one to be appointed by the Representing Party within five Business Days of the Requesting Party’s appointment of an arbitrator, and (C) the third, who will preside over the arbitral panel, to be chosen by the two party-appointed arbitrators within five Business Days of the Representing Party’s appointment. If any party fails to appoint an arbitrator or the two party-appointed arbitrators fail to appoint the third within the relevant time periods, then the appointments will be made by the AAA pursuant to the Rules.

(iv) Each arbitrator selected for any arbitration will abide by the Code of Ethics for Arbitrators in Commercial Disputes in effect at the time the arbitration is initiated. Prior to accepting an appointment, each arbitrator must promptly disclose any circumstances likely to create a reasonable inference of bias or conflict of interest or likely to preclude completion of the hearings within the prescribed time schedule. Any arbitrator selected may be removed by the AAA for cause consisting of actual bias, conflict of interest or other serious potential for conflict.

(v) The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that after consulting with the parties, the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable, will devise procedures and deadlines for the arbitration, to the extent not already agreed to by the parties, with the goal of expediting the proceeding and completing the arbitration within 30 days after appointment of the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable. The arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will have the authority to schedule, hear, and determine any and all motions, including dispositive and discovery motions, in accordance with New York law then in effect (including prehearing and post hearing motions), and will do so on the motion of any party to the arbitration. Notwithstanding any other discovery that may be available under the Rules, unless otherwise agreed by the parties, each party to the arbitration will be limited to the following discovery in the arbitration:

(A) Consistent with the expedited nature of arbitration, the Requesting Party and the Representing Party will, upon the written request of the other party, promptly provide the other with copies of documents relevant to the issues raised by any claim or counterclaim on which the producing party may rely in support of or in opposition to the claim or defense.

(B) At the request of a party, the arbitrator or arbitral panel, as applicable, shall have the discretion to order examination by deposition of witnesses to the extent the arbitrator or arbitral panel deems such additional discovery relevant and appropriate. Depositions shall be limited to a maximum of three (3) per party and shall be held within thirty (30) calendar days of the making of a request. Additional depositions may be scheduled only with the permission of the arbitrator or arbitral panel, and for good cause shown. Each deposition shall be limited to a maximum of three (3) hours’ duration. All objections are reserved for the arbitration hearing except for objections based on privilege and proprietary or confidential information.

 

-8-


(C) Any dispute regarding discovery, or the relevance or scope thereof, shall be determined by the arbitrator or arbitral panel, which determination shall be conclusive.

(D) All discovery shall be completed within sixty (60) calendar days following the appointment of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable; provided, that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will have the ability to grant the parties, or either of them, additional discovery to the extent that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, determines good cause is shown that such additional discovery is reasonable and necessary.

(vi) The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will resolve the dispute in accordance with the terms of this Agreement, and may not modify or change this Agreement in any way. The arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will not have the power to award punitive damages or consequential damages in any arbitration conducted. The Requesting Party and the Representing Party each agree that it is their intention that in its final determination, the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will determine and award the costs of the arbitration (including the fees of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, cost of any record or transcript of the arbitration, and administrative fees) and reasonable attorneys’ fees to the parties as determined by the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, must be consistent with the provisions of this Agreement, including Section 3.04, and in its reasonable discretion. The determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will be in writing and counterpart copies will be promptly delivered to the parties. The determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, may be reconsidered once by the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, upon the motion and at the expense of either party. Following that single reconsideration, the determination of the arbitrator or the arbitral panel, as applicable, will be final and non-appealable and may be entered in and may be enforced in, any court of competent jurisdiction.

(vii) By selecting binding arbitration, the Requesting Party is giving up the right to sue in court, including the right to a trial by jury.

(viii) No Person may bring a putative or certified class action to arbitration.

(d) The following provisions will apply to both mediations and arbitrations:

(i) Any mediation or arbitration will be held in New York, New York.

(ii) Notwithstanding this dispute resolution provision, the parties will have the right to seek provisional or ancillary relief from a competent court of law, including a temporary restraining order, preliminary injunction or attachment order, provided such relief would otherwise be available by law.

 

-9-


(iii) The details and/or existence of any unfulfilled repurchase request specified in subsection 2.01(a) above, any informal meetings, mediations or arbitration proceedings, including all offers, promises, conduct and statements, whether oral or written, made in the course of the parties’ attempt to informally resolve an unfulfilled repurchase request, and any discovery taken in connection with any arbitration, will be confidential, privileged and inadmissible for any purpose, including impeachment, in any mediation, arbitration or litigation, or other proceeding; provided, however, that any discovery taken in any arbitration will be admissible in that particular arbitration. Such information will be kept strictly confidential and will not be disclosed or discussed with any third party (excluding a party’s attorneys, experts, accountants and other agents and representatives, as reasonably required in connection with the related resolution procedure), except as otherwise required by law, regulatory requirement or court order. If any party to a resolution procedure receives a subpoena or other request for information from a third party (other than a governmental regulatory body) for such confidential information, the recipient will promptly notify the other party to the resolution procedure and will provide the other party with the opportunity to object to the production of its confidential information. Notwithstanding anything in this Section 2.01 to the contrary, any discovery taken in connection with any arbitration pursuant to subsection 2.01(c) above will be admissible in such arbitration.

 

-10-


ARTICLE III

MISCELLANEOUS

Section 3.01. Term. This Agreement shall continue until the earlier of (a) the termination of the Master Trust under Article XII of the Fifth Amended and Restated Pooling and Servicing Agreement and (b) the written agreement of all of the parties to this Agreement.

Section 3.02. Headings. Section headings in this Agreement are included herein for convenience of reference only and shall not constitute part of this Agreement for any other purpose.

Section 3.03. Amendments. The Agreement only can be modified in a written document executed by Funding, the Bank and the Trustee; provided, that prior notice of any such modification shall be provided to each Rating Agency.

Section 3.04. Liability of the Transferor; Nonpetition Covenant.

(a) The Transferor shall be liable in accordance herewith to the extent of the obligations specifically undertaken by the Transferor; provided, however, that to the extent the Transferor’s liabilities constitute monetary claims against the Transferor, such claims shall only constitute a monetary claim against the Transferor to the extent the Transferor has funds sufficient to make payment on such liabilities from amounts paid to it as Holder of the Transferor Interest.

(b) Notwithstanding any prior termination of this Agreement, to the fullest extent permitted by law, each of the Bank and the Trustee must not file, commence, join, or acquiesce in a petition or a proceeding, or cause Funding to file, commence, join, or acquiesce in a petition or a proceeding, that causes (a) Funding to be a debtor under any Debtor Relief Law or (b) a trustee, conservator, receiver, liquidator, or similar official to be appointed for Funding or any substantial part of any of its property.

Section 3.05. Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK, WITHOUT REFERENCE TO ITS CONFLICT OF LAW PROVISIONS, AND THE OBLIGATIONS, RIGHTS AND REMEDIES OF THE PARTIES HEREUNDER SHALL BE DETERMINED IN ACCORDANCE WITH SUCH LAWS.

Section 3.06. Notices. All demands, notices, instructions, directions and communications under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given if personally delivered at, mailed by certified mail, return receipt requested and postage prepaid, sent by facsimile transmission, or sent by electronic mail or by such other means acceptable to the recipient (i) in the case of Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, to Capital One Bank (USA), National Association, 1680 Capital One Drive, McLean, VA 22102, Attention: General Counsel, with a copy to Managing Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets, (ii) in the case of Capital One Funding, LLC, to Capital One Funding, LLC, 140 East Shore

 

-11-


Drive, Room 1071-B, Glen Allen, Virginia 23059, Attention: Assistant Vice President, Treasury Capital Markets, (iii) in the case of the Trustee, to The Bank of New York Mellon, 101 Barclay Street, 7W, New York, New York 10286, Attention: Corporate Trust Administration-Asset Backed Securities (facsimile no. 212-815-2493), and (iv) to any other Person as specified in any Supplement; or, as to each party, at such other address, facsimile number or electronic mail address as shall be designated by such party in a written notice to each other party.

Section 3.07. Severability. If any part of the Agreement is held to be invalid or otherwise unenforceable, the rest of this Agreement will be considered severable and will continue in full force.

Section 3.08. Further Assurances. Each party must take all actions that are reasonably requested by each other party hereto to effect more fully the purposes of this Agreement.

Section 3.09. Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts and by separate parties hereto on separate counterparts, each of which when executed shall be deemed an original, but all such counterparts taken together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

[Signature Page Follows]

 

-12-


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Funding, the Bank and the Trustee have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by their respective officers as of the day and year first above written.

 

CAPITAL ONE FUNDING, LLC,
By:  

/s/ Eric D. Bauder

  Name: Eric D. Bauder
  Title: Assistant Vice President
CAPITAL ONE BANK (USA), NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,
By:  

/s/ Daniel H. Rosen

  Name: Daniel H. Rosen
  Title: Managing Vice President, Treasury
THE BANK OF NEW YORK MELLON,

Not in its individual capacity,

but solely as Trustee

By:  

/s/ Michael D. Commisso

  Name: Michael D. Commisso
  Title: Vice President

[Signature Page to Dispute Resolution Agreement]